Page 897
Components For Removal And Installation Part 2 Of 2
Diagram Information and Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 4851
Brake Pad: Service and Repair
Front Brake Components (4WD)
REPLACEMENT
1. Remove front wheel. 2. Inspect pad lining thickness.
3. Remove these parts:
- Clip.
- 2 pins.
- Anti-rattle spring.
- 2 brake pads.
- 4 anti-squeal shims.
CAUTION: The anti-rattle spring can be used again provided that they have sufficient rebound, no
deformation, cracks or wear, and have had all rust, dirt and foreign particles cleaned off.
4. Install new pads.
CAUTION: When replacing worn pads, the anti-squeal shims must be replaced together with the
pads.
(a) Draw out a small amount of brake fluid from the reservoir.
Page 2871
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Front
Front Speed Sensor Components
REMOVAL
1. Remove speed sensor.
Disconnect Speed Sensor Connector
(a) Disconnect the speed sensor connector. (b) Remove the 2 clamp bolts holding the sensor
harness from the steering knuckle, upper arm and side rail.
Remove Clamp Bolts
(c) Remove the speed sensor installation bolt from the steering knuckle.
Torque: 8.0 Nm (82 kg.cm 71 inch lbs.)
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. After installation, check speed sensor signal.
CAUTION: Make sure that:
Page 3754
Shift Indicator: Description and Operation
Previous automatic transmissions have selected each gear shift using mechanically controlled
throttle hydraulic pressure, governor hydraulic pressure and lock-up hydraulic pressure. The
Electronically Controlled Transmission, however, electrically controls the governor pressure and
lock-up pressure through the solenoid valve. Control of the solenoid valve by the Engine Control
Module based on the input signals from each sensor makes smooth driving possible by shift
selection for each gear which is most appropriate to the driving conditions at that time.
1. GEAR SHIFT OPERATION
During driving, the Engine Control Module selects the shift for each gear which is most appropriate
to the driving conditions, based on input signals from the Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor to
TERMINAL THW of the Engine Control Module and also the input signals to TERMINAL SP2+ of
the Engine Control Module from the Vehicle Speed Sensor devoted to the Electronically Controlled
Transmission. Current is then output to the Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid. When
shifting to 1st speed, current flows from TERMINAL S1 of the Engine Control Module -->
TERMINAL 1 of the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid --> GROUND, and continuity
to the No.1 solenoid causes the shift.
For 2nd speed, current flows from TERMINAL S1 of the Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 1 of
the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid --> GROUND, and from TERMINAL S2 of the
Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 2 of the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid -->
GROUND. and continuity to Solenoid No.1 and No.2 causes the shift.
For 3rd speed. there is no continuity to No.1 solenoid, only to No.2 causing the shift. Shifting into
4th speed (Overdrive) takes place when there is no continuity to either No.1 or No.2 Solenoid.
2. LOCK-UP OPERATION
When the Engine Control Module judges from each signal that lock-up operation conditions have
been met, current flows from TERMINAL SL of the Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 3 of the
Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid --> GROUND, causing continuity to the lock-up
solenoid and causing lock-up operation.
3. STOP LIGHT SW CIRCUIT
If the brake pedal is depressed (Stop Light SW ON) when driving in lock-up condition, a signal is
input to TERMINAL BK of the Engine Control Module, the Engine Control Module operates and
continuity to the lock-up solenoid is cut.
4. OVERDRIVE CIRCUIT
^ O/D Main SW ON When the O/D main SW is turned ON, a signal is input to TERMINAL OD2 of
the Engine Control Module and Engine Control Module operation causes gear shift when the
conditions for overdrive are met.
^ O/D Main SW OFF When the O/D main SW is turned to OFF, the current flowing through the O/D
OFF indicator light flows through the O/D main SW to GROUND, causing the indicator light to light
up. At the same time, a signal is input to TERMINAL OD2 of the Engine Control Module and
Engine Control Module operation prevents shift into overdrive.
5. A/T OIL TEMP. WARNING
When the A/T Oil Temp. Sensor affixed to the transmission case detects that the fluid temp. is
150°C (302°F) or more, the Engine Control Module operates and the current flowing through the
GAUGE fuse flows to the A/T Oil Temp. warning light --> TERMINAL OIL-W of the Engine Control
Module --> Ground, so that the warning light lights up, informing that the Oil Temp. is high. When
the Oil Temp. drops to 120°C (248°F) or less, the Engine Control Module stops operating and the
warning light goes out.
Page 751
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2715
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 677
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer's complaint.
Page 4368
Electronically Controlled Transmission And A/T Indicator (Part 3 Of 3)
Page 1164
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Engine Oil
API Classification ................................................................................................... SH Energy
Conserving II, SJ Energy Conserving, or ILAC Multigrade Above 0° F (-18°C) ..................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
... 10W-30 All Temperatures ................................................................................................................
.......................................................................................... 5w-30
Page 895
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 2274
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 4719
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Specifications
Catalytic Converter: Specifications
TWC to Front Exhaust Pipe 46 ft.lb
TWC to Tailpipe 35 ft.lb
Page 2699
Oxygen Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Heated Oxygen Sensor to Exhaust Pipe 14 ft.lb
Locations
Shift Interlock Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 193
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Supercharger - Squeak/Rattle Noises From Idler Pulley
Idler Pulley: All Technical Service Bulletins Supercharger - Squeak/Rattle Noises From Idler Pulley
REF.: 3.4L V6 SUPERCHARGER
NO.: SC001-00
DATE: AUGUST 1, 2000
MODEL: 4Runner, Tacoma, T100, and Tundra with 3.4L V6.
SUPERCHARGER DRIVE-BELT IDLER PULLEY
Due to a possible out-of-tolerance condition on the idler pulley shaft, some pulleys may have
bearings that spin on the inner shaft and may cause a squeaking or rattling noise. The
supercharger may be perfectly fine and the source of the noise may simply be the idler pulley
PART NUMBER INFORMATION
PRODUCTION EFFECTIVE:
Supercharger Assemblies with Serial Numbers from: 10481
to: 10990
CHECK PROCEDURE:
This condition can be verified by removing the supercharger drive belt and checking the movement
of the pulley on the shaft The pulley should not slide fore and aft on the shaft.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE:
Loosen the drive belt. Remove the idler plate assembly. Retain all the hardware. Remove the idler
pulley sub-assembly from the idler plate assembly. Replace it with the supplied new idler pulley
sub-assembly. Replace the idler plate assembly and all of the hardware. The tightening torques are
shown in the table.
Reinstall and tension the drive belt to 120-ft lbs. for a new belt or 80 ft lbs. for a used belt (any belt
used for more than 10 minutes).
WARRANTY INFORMATION:* * The idler pulley assembly is warrantable only for 12 months from
the point-of-first-sale. If the supercharger assembly was dealer installed, then TRD matches the
balance of the new vehicle powertrain warranty.
Page 8
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 543
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Electrical Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Cold Hot
Between Terminals NE+ and NE- 1,630 - 2,740 ohms at 14 - 122 deg F 2,065 - 3,225 ohms at 122
- 212 deg F
Page 2295
Components For Removal And Installation Part 2 Of 2
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
KNOCK SENSORS REMOVAL
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT 2. REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE 3. REMOVE INTAKE AIR
CONNECTOR 4. REMOVE HIGH-TENSION CORDS WITH IGNITION COILS 5. REMOVE FUEL
PRESSURE REGULATOR 6. REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY 7. REMOVE WATER
BYPASS PIPE AND KNOCK SENSOR WIRE
Testing and Inspection
Shift Interlock Control Module: Testing and Inspection
Shift Lock ECU, Harness Side: Floor Shift
Floor Shift:
Inspect shift lock control ECU. Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage at terminal.
HINT: Do not disconnect the ECU connector.
Page 4436
6. Inspect reverse idler gear and shift arm clearance.
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the reverse idler gear and shift arm.
Standard Clearance: 0.05-0.35 mm (0.0020-0.0138 inch) Maximum Clearance: 0.50 mm (0.0197
inch)
If the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the shift arm or reverse idler gear.
Page 3045
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
The No.1 vehicle speed sensor outputs a 4-pulse signal for every revolution of the rotor shaft,
which is rotated by the transmission output shaft via the driven gear.
After this signal is converted into a more precise rectangular waveform by the waveform shaping
circuit inside the combination meter, it is then transmitted to the ECM. The ECM determines the
vehicle speed based on the frequency of these pulse signals.
The No.2 vehicle speed sensor detects the rotation speed of the transmission output shaft and
sends signals to the ECM. The ECM determines the vehicle speed based on these signals.
An AC voltage is generated in the No.2 vehicle speed sensor coil as the rotor mounted on the
output shaft rotates, and this voltage is sent to the ECM.
The gear shift point and lock-up timing are controlled by the ECM based on the signals from this
vehicle speed sensor and the throttle position sensor signal.
If the No.2 vehicle speed sensor malfunctions, the ECM uses input signals from the No.1 vehicle
speed sensor as a back-up signal.
Page 576
Page 1182
6. Check fluid pressure reading with valve opened.
a. With the engine idling, open the valve fully. b. Measure the fluid pressure at engine speeds of
1,000 RPM and 3,000 RPM.
Fluid pressure difference: 490 kPa (71 psi) or less
NOTICE: Do not turn the steering wheel.
7. Check pressure reading with steering wheel turned to full lock. With the engine idling and valve
fully opened, turn the wheel to full lock.
Fluid pressure: 8,336 kPa (1,209) Minimum
NOTICE: ^
Do not maintain lock position for more than 10 seconds.
^ Do not let the fluid temperature become too high.
8. Disconnect SST.
a. Disconnect the SST. b. Connect the pressure feed tube.
9. Bleed power steering system.
10. Install air cleaner assembly. Tighten the 3 bolts.
Page 2254
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4206
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 4164
f. Apply adhesive Part No. 08833-00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE 242 or equivalent to 2 or
3 threads of the mount bolt end.
g. Tighten the shaft retainer with the 2 bolts.
Torque to 24 Nm (17 ft. lbs.)
h. Using a pin punch and hummer, install the slotted spring pin to the shift fork.
i. shift the fork deeply and keep the differential lock condition.
j. Install the steel ball, spring and spring seat.
k. Clean the threads of 2 plugs and plug holes with toluene or trichloroethylene. l.
Apply adhesive Part No. 08833-00080, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE 242, or equivalent, to the
plug threads.
m. Using a hexagon wrench, install and tighten the screw plugs.
Torque to 22 Nm (16 ft. lbs.)
Disassembly
Counter Gear: Service and Repair Disassembly
Remove hub sleeve No.3, shifting key and spring from synchronizer ring. a. Remove the
synchronizer ring assembly from the hub sleeve No.3.
b. Turn the reverse synchronizer pull ring.
c. Remove the reverse synchronizer ring and 5th synchronizer ring from the synchronizer pull ring
and cone ring.
Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications
OIL PRESSURE (NORMAL OPERATING TEMPERATURE)
At Idle Speed .......................................................................................................................................
........................................ 29 kPa (4.3 psi) or more At 3,000 rpm .......................................................
.................................................................................................................... 245 - 520 kPa (36 - 75
psi)
Page 67
WIRING DIAGRAM
Inspection Procedure / ECT Communication Circuit - Solenoid #2 (1 Of 5)
Inspection Procedure / ECT Communication Circuit - Solenoid #2 (2 Of 5)
Diagram Information and Instructions
Data Link Connector: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 177
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 2923
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - O2 Sensor Monitor Threshold
Values
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS SS002-03
December 17, 2003
Title O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05)
Models All '96 - '03, '04 Corolla, ECHO, Matrix, Sienna & Scion xA & xB
Introduction
This Service Bulletin contains Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Monitor threshold values for all models from
1996 to 2003 and some 2004 models. Starting in 2004, the O2S Monitor threshold values can be
found in the repair manual. These values are used when analyzing the O2S test results to
determine the O2S condition.
Applicable Vehicles ^
All 1996 - 2003 model year Toyota vehicles.
^ 2004 model year Corolla, ECHO, Matrix and Sienna vehicles.
^ 2004 model year Scion xA and xB vehicles.
Function Description
Checking O2S Test Results
To view O2S test results, the O2S Monitor must be completed and the test results must be
checked within the same key cycle. If the ignition key is cycled OFF, the O2S test results will be set
to the minimum or maximum limits, and all test results will be erased. The O2S test results are
stored in the ECU (SAE term: Powertrain Control Module/PCM) when the monitor is completed.
The test results are static and will not change once the monitor is complete.
The process for checking 02S test results is described in the following three basic steps:
1. Completing the O2S Readiness Monitor.
2. Accessing O2S Test Results.
3. Comparing O2S Test Results to Failure Thresholds.
Required SSTs
NOTE:
Additional Diagnostic Tester Kits, Program Cards or other SSTs may be ordered by calling
SPX-OTC at 1-800-933-8335.
Warranty Information
Completing O2S Readiness Monitor
1. Clear any stored Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) using the Toyota Diagnostic Tester.
Page 2596
Step 2
Step 3
Step 4
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Electrical Specifications
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Measure Terminals THA - E2 10 - 20 K ohms at -4 deg F
4 - 7 K ohms at 32 deg F
2 - 3 K ohms at 68 deg F
0.9 - 1.3 K ohms at 104 deg F
0.4 - 0.7 K ohms at 140 deg F
0.2 - 0.4 K ohms at 176 deg F
Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Light Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 3180
EGR Temperature Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Note: Except Model VZN170 (Long wheel base 4WD Pickup)
EGR Sensor to EGR Valve 14 ft.lb
Page 3444
Throttle Body: Testing and Inspection Component Inspection
THROTTLE BODY INSPECTION
1. CLEAN THROTTLE BODY
(a) Using a soft brush and carburetor cleaner. clean the cast parts.
(b) Using compressed air, clean all the passages and apertures.
NOTICE: To prevent deterioration. do not clean the throttle position sensor and IAC valve.
2. INSPECT THROTTLE VALVE
(a) Apply vacuum to the throttle opener. (b) Check that there is no clearance between the throttle
stop screw and throttle lever when the throttle valve is fully closed.
Throttle valve fully closed angle: 10°
3. INSPECT THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
(a) Apply vacuum to the throttle opener (b) Insert a thickness gauge between the throttle stop
screw and stop lever.
Ohmmeter Connection
Reference
Page 2984
Page 3891
Position Of Parts In Engine Compartment (Part 1 Of 2) (Fig 24)
Page 2805
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Camshaft Position Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSPECTION
NOTICE: "Cold" and "Hot" in these sentences express the temperature of the sensors themselves.
"Cold" is from -10°C (14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
1. DISCONNECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR CONNECTOR
2. INSPECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals.
Resistance:
Cold: 835 - 1,400 Ohms Hot: 1,060 - 1,645 Ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the camshaft position sensor.
3. RECONNECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR CONNECTOR
Locations
Page 899
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Knock sensors are fitted one each to the right bank and left bank of the cylinder block to detect
engine knocking. This sensor contains a piezoelectric element which generates a voltage when it
becomes deformed, which occurs when the cylinder block vibrates due to knocking. If engine
knocking occurs, ignition timing is retarded to suppress it.
Page 2510
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 4257
b. Using a press, remove the rear axle shaft with the bearing retainer from the backing plate. c.
Remove the SST.
4. Inspect axle shaft. If the rear axle shaft or flange are damaged or worn, or if runout is greater
than the maximum, replace the rear axle shaft.
Maximum shaft runout: 2.0 mm (0.079 inch) Maximum flange runout: 0.1 mm (0.004 inch)
5. Remove outer oil seal. Using SST 09308-00010, remove the oil seal.
6. Replace rear axle bearing.
a. Using SST 09223-56010, 09950-60010 (09951-00560), remove the bearing.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 942
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 2368
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 596
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Figure 1
Reference
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The intake air temp. sensor is built into the air flow meter and senses the intake air temperature. A
thermistor built in the sensor changes the resistance value according to the intake air temperature.
The lower the intake air temperature, the greater the thermistor resistance value and the higher the
intake air temperature, the lower the thermistor resistance value (See Fig.1.). The intake air
temperature sensor is connected to the ECM (See below). The 5 V power source voltage in the
ECM is applied to the intake air temperature sensor from the terminal THA via a resistor R. That is,
the resistor R and the intake air temperature sensor are connected in series. When the resistance
value of the intake air temperature sensor changes in accordance with changes in the intake air
temperature, the potential at terminal THA also changes. Based on this signal, the ECM increases
the fuel injection volume to improve driveability during cold engine operation.
Page 3221
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2804
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 754
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 4005
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 2364
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Service and Repair
Front Crankshaft Seal: Service and Repair
NOTE: There are 2 methods (A and B) to replace the oil seal which are as follows:
A. If oil pump is removed from cylinder block.
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
(b) Using Special Service Tool (SST) Transmission Bearing Replacer # 09309 - 37010 or
equivalent and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until its
surface is flush with the oil pump body edge.
(c) Apply Multipurpose (MP) grease to the oil seal lip.
B. If oil pump is installed to cylinder block.
(a) Using a knife, cut off the oil seal lip.
(b) Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the crankshaft. Tape the screwdriver tip.
(c) Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
(d) Using SST Transmission Bearing Replacer # 09309 - 37010 or equivalent and a hammer, tap in
the oil seal until its surface is flush with the
oil pump body edge.
Page 3253
D. Start the engine. After the engine has stalled, turn the ignition switch OFF.
E. Disable the fuel return line by blocking the line or installing the appropriate plug in the return
outlet, if applicable.
NOTE:
Do NOT clamp plastic lines.
F. Install the device adapter to the fuel line and then secure the swivel fitting on the end of the
hose.
G. Make sure the ball valve on the device is turned OFF (valve handle is crosswise to device).
Screw the can of EFI cleaner (P/N 00289-1PF14) onto the device can adapter.
H. Open the valve on the device, start the vehicle, and allow it to run until the engine stalls.
I. Turn the ball valve OFF and remove the empty can.
J. Place a shop towel over the can adapter and slowly open the ball valve to depressurize the
system.
K. Remove supply and return line adapters, reconnect vehicle fuel supply and return lines
(replacing any fuel line gaskets and seals), and connect the fuel pump electrical connector.
L. Before starting the vehicle, pressurize the fuel system and check for leaks.
Run the engine for 4 - 5 minutes, and then snap the throttle several times to dislodge any carbon
that may remain in the system.
2. Add 1 can of Toyota Non-Pressurized Fuel Injector Cleaner Fuel Tank Additive (P/N
08813-0080DS) to the fuel tank.
3. Road test the vehicle to verify normal operation.
Page 382
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 1888
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
System Schematic
Sensor Cut-Away
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The mass air flow meter uses a platinum hot wire. The hot wire air flow meter consists of a
platinum hot wire, thermistor and a control circuit installed in a plastic housing. The hot wire air flow
meter works on the principle that the hot wire and thermistor located in the intake air bypass of the
housing detect any changes in the intake air temperature. The hot wire is maintained at the set
temperature by controlling the current flow through the hot wire. This current flow is then measured
as the output voltage of the air flow meter. The circuit is constructed so that the platinum hot wire
and thermistor provide a bridge circuit, with the power transistor controlled so that the potential of
(A) and (B) remains equal to maintain the set temperature.
Page 2256
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 1401
If the valve stem tip is worn, resurface the tip with a grinder or replace the valve.
CAUTION: Do not grind off more than the minimum.
Page 3073
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Locations
ABS Main Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 3099
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 186
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 2662
Page 3460
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2651
Applicable Vehicles
Page 438
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 4058
Clutch Disc: Testing and Inspection
1. Inspect clutch disc for wear or damage using calipers, measure the rivet head depth.
Minimum rivet depth: 0.3 mm (0.012 inch)
If necessary, replace the clutch disc.
2. Inspect clutch disc runout.
Using a dial indicator, check the disc runout.
Maximum Runout: 0.8 mm (0.031 inch)
If necessary, replace the clutch disc.
Page 4794
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Rear
Rear Speed Sensor Components
REMOVAL
1. Remove speed sensor.
Disconnect Speed Sensor Connector
(a) Disconnect the speed sensor connector, and pull out the sensor wire harness with grommet. (b)
Remove the 5 resin clips, 2 clamp set bolts and 2 nuts holding the sensor wire harness from the
side rail, fuel tank and axle housing.
Remove Clamp Bolts
(c) Remove the 2 mountings bolt and speed sensor.
Torque: 8.0 Nm (71 inch lbs.)
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. After installation, check speed sensor signal.
CAUTION: Make sure that: There are no foreign objects on the sensor or the part of the axle end to which the sensor is to be
installed.
- The sensor is installed flat against the knuckle when you tighten the bolt.
- When installing the resin clips, use new ones.
Page 494
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 295
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Testing and Inspection
EGR Backpressure Transducer: Testing and Inspection
EGR VACUUM MODULATOR INSPECTION
1. DISCONNECT VACUUM HOSES FROM EGR VACUUM MODULATOR
Disconnect these vacuum hoses: (1) Vacuum hose from R port (2) Vacuum hose from Q port (3)
Vacuum hose from P port
2. INSPECT EGR VACUUM MODULATOR OPERATION
(a) Block ports P and R with your finger.
(b) Blow air into port Q and check that the air passes through to the air filter side freely. (c) Start the
engine and maintain speed at 3,500 RPM.
(d) Repeat the above test. Check that there is a strong resistance to air flow.
3. RECONNECT VACUUM HOSES TO EGR VACUUM MODULATOR
Connect the vacuum hoses: (1) Vacuum hose to R port (2) Vacuum hose to Q port (3) Vacuum
hose to P port
Page 1072
(c) Install the starter wire bracket with the 2 bolts.
13. Install crankshaft pulley.
(a) Align the pulley set key with the key groove of the pulley, and slide the pulley.
(b) Using SST Crankshaft Pulley Holding Tool # 09213 - 54015 (Bolt # 90119 - 08216), Companion
Flange Holding Tool # 09330 - 00021 or
equivalents, install and torque the bolt. Torque: 250 Nm (184 ft. lbs.)
14. Install fan bracket.
(a) Install the fan bracket with the bolt and nut.
(b) Install the PS pump adjusting strut with the nut.
15. Install No. 2 timing belt cover.
(a) Check that the timing belt cover gasket has no cracks or peeling, etc. If the gasket has cracks
or peeling, etc., replace it using these steps: ^
Using a screwdriver and gasket scraper, remove all the old gasket material.
^ Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the loose material.
^ Remove the backing paper from a new gasket and install the gasket evenly to the part of the
timing belt cover shaded black in the illustration.
(b) Install the timing belt cover with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.)
(c) Connect the 4 high-tension cord clamps and camshaft position sensor connector to the No. 2
timing belt cover.
16. Install oil dipstick and guide.
(a) Install a new O-ring to the dipstick guide.
(b) Install the oil dipstick and guide to the cylinder block. (c)
Install the bolt to the generator bracket. Torque: 8 Nm (71 inch lbs.)
17. w/ A/C: Install A/C compressor bracket.
Torque: 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.)
18. w/ A/C: Connect A/C compressor to engine. 19. Connect PS pump to engine. 20. Install fan
with fluid coupling and fan pulleys.
Page 1290
this, these steps should be carried out.
A. Intake.
(a) Apply new engine oil to the thrust portion and journal of the camshaft.
(b) Place the intake camshaft at 90° angle of timing mark (1 dot mark) on the cylinder head. (c)
Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
(d) Install the oil seal to the camshaft. (e)
Remove any old packing FIPG material.
(f) Apply seal packing to the No. 1 bearing cap as shown. Seal packing: Part No. 08826 - 00080 or
equivalent.
(g) Install the 5 bearing caps in their proper locations. (h) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the
threads and under the heads of the bearing cap bolts.
Page 3583
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 711
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 4467
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 3417
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Testing and Inspection
Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Inspect relay operation.
a. Jack up the vehicle. b. Use a heater main relay and connect it, as shown below. c. Rotate the
tire and check that differential lock has occurred. if operation is not as specified, replace the
actuator.
2. Inspect Diff. Lock control switch continuity. Inspect the switch continuity between terminal 1 to
terminal 4.
HINT: If it is not continuity, replace the switch.
3. Inspect Diff. Lock position switch.
a. Check that there is continuity between terminals when the switch is pushed (differential
connected position). b. Check that there is no continuity when the switch is free (differential
disconnected position).
HINT: If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
4. Inspect transfer 4WD switch. 5. Inspect vehicle speed sensor.
Page 2736
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2976
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 1288
Camshaft: Service and Repair Installation
1. Install camshafts of RH cylinder head.
CAUTION: Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level
while it is being installed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head receiving
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
these steps should be carried out.
A. Intake.
(a) Apply new engine oil to the thrust portion and journal of the camshaft.
(b) Place the intake camshaft at 90° angle of timing mark (2 dot marks) on the cylinder head. (c)
Apply Multipurpose (MP) grease to a new oil seal lip.
(d) Install the oil seal to the camshaft. (e)
Remove any old packing Formed In Place Gasket (FIPG) material.
(f) Apply seal packing to the No. 1 bearing cap as shown. Seal packing: Part No. 08826 - 00080 or
equivalent.
(g) Install the 5 bearing caps in their proper locations. (h) Apply a light coat of engine oil on the
threads and under the heads of the bearing cap bolts.
Page 2198
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 3116
Catalytic Converter: Testing and Inspection
EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY INSPECTION
1. CHECK CONNECTIONS FOR LOOSENESS OR DAMAGE 2. CHECK CLAMPS FOR
WEAKNESS, CRACKS OR DAMAGE.
THREE - WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER INSPECTION CHECK FOR DENTS OR DAMAGE
If any part of the protector is damaged or dented to the extent that it contacts the three-way
catalytic converter. repair or replace it.
HEAT INSULATOR INSPECTION
1. CHECK HEAT INSULATOR FOR DAMAGE 2. CHECK FOR ADEQUATE CLEARANCE
BETWEEN CATALYTIC CONVERTER AND HEAT INSULATOR
Brakes - Pad Knock Noise
Brake Pad: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Pad Knock Noise
BRAKES BR005-97
March 14, 1997
Title: 4RUNNER AND TACOMA 4X4 BRAKE PAD KNOCK NOISE
Models: '97 4Runner, & '97 Tacoma
Introduction
A brake pad modification has been made on 4Runner and Tacoma 4x4 models to reduce pad
knocking noise. This problem usually occurs upon first pedal application after changing driving
direction (i.e. forward to reverse).
Affected Vehicles
^ 1997 4Runner starting VINs: JT3GM84R * V0004296 JT3HM84R * V0007803 JT3GN86R *
V0010776 JT3HN86R * V0027427 JT3HN87R * V0027427
^ 1997 Tacoma (4x4) starting VIN 4TA **** N * VZ220360
Modification Detail
The steel backing plate of the brake pad was widened from 119.3 mm to 119.55 mm in order to
reduce the pad movement in the brake caliper.
Parts Information
MODEL PART NUMBER
4Runner 04465-35190
Tacoma (4x4) 04465-35080
Page 4421
b. Install the synchronizer inner ring, middle ring and outer ring to each gear.
c. Check the braking effect of the synchronizer ring. turn the synchronizer ring in one direction
while pushing it to the gear cone. check that the
ring locks. If it does not lock, replace the synchronizer ring.
d. Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the synchronizer ring back and gear
spline end.
Minimum Clearance: 0.8 mm (0.031 inch)
If the clearance is less than the minimum, replace the synchronizer ring.
4. Inspect shift fork and hub sleeve clearance.
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the hub sleeve and shift fork.
Maximum Clearance: 1.0 mm (0.039 inch)
If the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the shift fork or hub sleeve.
Page 1214
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 2414
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 4620
Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 3196
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
PRECAUTION
1. BEFORE WORKING ON FUEL SYSTEM, DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (-) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
HINT: Any diagnostic trouble code retained by the computer will be erased when the negative (-)
terminal cable is removed from the battery. Therefore, if necessary, read the diagnosis before
removing the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery.
2. DO NOT SMOKE OR WORK NEAR AN OPEN FLAME WHEN WORKING ON FUEL SYSTEM
FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE PROCEDURE
WHEN DISCONNECTING THE HIGH FUEL PRESSURE LINE, A LARGE AMOUNT OF
GASOLINE WILL SPILL OUT, SO OBSERVE THESE PROCEDURES:
(1) Disconnect the fuel pump connector. (2) Start the engine. After the engine has stopped on its
own, turn the ignition switch to LOCK.
(3) Put a container under the connection. (4) Slowly loosen the connection. (5) Disconnect the
connection. (6) Plug the connection with a rubber plug.
WHEN CONNECTING THE FLARE NUT OR UNION BOLT ON THE HIGH PRESSURE PIPE
UNION, OBSERVE THESE PROCEDURES:
Union Bolt Type:
- Always use 2 new gaskets.
- Tighten the union bolt by hand.
- Tighten the union bolt to the specified torque.
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf)
Flare Nut Type: Apply a light coat of engine oil to the flare nut and tighten the flare nut by hand.
Page 4633
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
2-4 Selector Switch
Inspect 2-4 selector switch continuity. Test continuity between terminals 1 and 2.
Switch position: Specified condition.
OFF: No continuity. ON: Continuity.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the shift lever knob.
Page 2647
Page 112
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 836
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2001
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Automatic Transmission
Input Shaft: Service and Repair Automatic Transmission
NOTE: For removal and installation procedures refer to "Transfer Case, Service and Repair."
DISASSEMBLY
Remove oil seal rings remove the 2 oil seal rings.
INSPECTION
Inspect input shaft. a. Using a micrometer, measure the outer diameter of the input shaft journal
surface.
Minimum Diameter: 47.59 mm (1.8736 inch)
b. Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter of the input shaft bushing.
Maximum Inside Diameter: 39.14 mm (1.5409 inch)
If the inside diameter exceeds the Maximum, replace the input shaft.
ASSEMBLY
Install oil seal rings install the 2 oil seal rings.
Electrical Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Resistance Cold Resistance Hot
835 - 1,400 ohms at 14 - 122 deg F 1,060 - 1,645 ohms at 122 - 212 deg F
Page 445
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 4146
4. Measure drive pinion preload. Using a torque wrench, measure the preload of backlash between
the drive pinion and ring gear.
Preload (at starting): 0.5 - 0.8 Nm (4.3 - 6.9 inch lbs.)
5. Check total preload. Using a torque wrench, measure the preload with the teeth of the drive
pinion and ring gear in contact.
Total preload (at starting): Drive pinion preload plus 0.4 - 0.6 Nm (3.5 - 5.2 inch lbs.)
If necessary, disassemble and inspect the differential.
6. Check tooth contact between ring gear and drive pinion.
Without Differential Lock
Capacity Specifications
Fluid - M/T: Capacity Specifications
M/T Fluid ..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................ 2.2L (4.6 pints)
Page 3631
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2939
CHART 12
CHART 13
Page 1111
Hose/Line HVAC: Specifications
REFRIGERANT LINES
Receiver x Liquid tube: ........................................................................................................................
.......................................................................... 6.0 N.m (61 kg.cm, 53 in.lb)
Condenser x Discharge tube: ..............................................................................................................
...................................................................................... 10 N.m (100 kg.cm, 7 ft.lb)
Condenser x Liquid tube: .....................................................................................................................
............................................................................. 14 N.m (140 kg.cm, 10 ft.lb)
Compressor x Discharge tube: ............................................................................................................
........................................................................................ 10 N.m (100 kg.cm, 7 ft.lb)
Compressor x Suction tube: ................................................................................................................
.................................................................................... 10 N.m (100 kg.cm, 7 ft.lb)
Cooling unit x Liquid tube: ...................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 14 N.m (140 kg.cm, 10 ft.lb)
Cooling unit x Suction tube: .................................................................................................................
................................................................................. 32 N.m (330 kg.cm, 24 ft.lb)
Expansion valve x Evaporator: ............................................................................................................
...................................................................................... 5.4 N.m (55 kg.cm, 48 in.lb)
Suction line: .........................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 32 N.m (330 kg.cm, 24 ft.lb)
Liquid line: ...........................................................................................................................................
....................................................... 14 N.m (140 kg.cm, 10 ft.lb)
Page 4663
Locations-J/B No.3 Behind The Instrument Panel Center (Fig 22)
Parts Location
Parts Location
Page 890
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3954
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 4799
Loosen/Tighten Bleeder Plug
Insert other end of the tube in a half-full container of brake fluid.
NOTE: Begin air bleeding from the wheel cylinder with the longest hydraulic line.
4. Bleed brake line.
(a) Slowly depress the brake pedal several times. (b) While an assistant depresses the pedal,
loosen the bleeder plug until fluid starts to run out. Then tighten the bleeder plug. (c) Repeat this
procedure until there are no more air bubbles in the fluid.
Bleeder plug tightening torque: 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs.)
5. Repeat procedure for each wheel. 6. Bleed Load Sensing Proportioning (LSP) & By-Pass Valve
(BV).
LOAD SENSING PROPORTIONING AND BY-PASS VALVE (LSP & BV) ON-VEHICLE
INSPECTION
HINT: Pre runner is described below.
RZN191L-TRPDKAB, RZN196LCRPDKAB, VZN195L-CRPDKAB
1. SET REAR AXLE LOAD
Rear axle load (includes vehicle weight):
2. INSTALL LSP & BV GAUGE (SST) AND BLEED AIR SST 09709-29018
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSPECTION
NOTICE: "Cold" and "Hot" in these sentences express the temperature of the sensors themselves.
"Cold" is from -10°C (14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals.
Resistance:
Cold: 1,630 - 2,740 Ohms Hot: 2,065 - 3,225 Ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the crank shaft position sensor.
Page 750
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Electrical Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Resistance Cold Resistance Hot
835 - 1,400 ohms at 14 - 122 deg F 1,060 - 1,645 ohms at 122 - 212 deg F
Page 633
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Bank 1/Bank 2 O2 Sensor
identification
ENGINE EG034-07
Title: ENGINE BANK 1 AND BANK 2 A/F AND O2 IDENTIFICATION
Models: '93 - '08 Applicable Models
June 28, 2007
The information contained in this TSB supercedes TSB No. EG037-04. TSB No. EG037-04 is now
obsolete and should be discarded.
Introduction
This service bulletin provides information on the proper identification of engine bank 1 and engine
bank 2 for correct A/F sensor and oxygen sensor replacement.
This bulletin contains information that identifies engine bank 1 and engine bank 2 on the following
engines: 1AZ-FE, 2AZ-FE, 2AZ-FE (PZEV), 1GR-FE, 2GR-FE, 2GR-FSE, 2JZ-GE, 1MZ-FE,
3MZ-FE, 1UR-FSE, 3UR-FE, 2UZ-FE, 3UZ-FE, 5VZ-FE, and 1ZZ-FE.
^ Bank 1 (B1) refers to the bank that includes cylinder No. 1.
^ Bank 2 (B2) refers to the bank opposite bank 1.
^ Sensor 1 (S1) refers to the sensor that is located before the catalytic converters.
^ Sensor 2 (S2) refers to the sensor that is located after the catalytic converters.
Warranty Information
Diagram Information and Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 4500
Page 2286
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 3770
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 2683
CHART 24
Page 748
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 4721
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3214
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 1810
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 2593
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The rotary solenoid type IAC valve is located in front of the intake air chamber and intake air
bypassing the throttle valve is directed to the IAC valve through a passage. In this way the intake
air volume bypassing the throttle valve is regulated, controlling the engine speed. The ECM
operates only the IAC valve to perform idle-up and provide feedback for the target idling speed and
a VSV for idle up control is also added (for air conditioning).
Page 2082
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2650
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Bank 1/Bank 2 O2 Sensor
identification
ENGINE EG034-07
Title: ENGINE BANK 1 AND BANK 2 A/F AND O2 IDENTIFICATION
Models: '93 - '08 Applicable Models
June 28, 2007
The information contained in this TSB supercedes TSB No. EG037-04. TSB No. EG037-04 is now
obsolete and should be discarded.
Introduction
This service bulletin provides information on the proper identification of engine bank 1 and engine
bank 2 for correct A/F sensor and oxygen sensor replacement.
This bulletin contains information that identifies engine bank 1 and engine bank 2 on the following
engines: 1AZ-FE, 2AZ-FE, 2AZ-FE (PZEV), 1GR-FE, 2GR-FE, 2GR-FSE, 2JZ-GE, 1MZ-FE,
3MZ-FE, 1UR-FSE, 3UR-FE, 2UZ-FE, 3UZ-FE, 5VZ-FE, and 1ZZ-FE.
^ Bank 1 (B1) refers to the bank that includes cylinder No. 1.
^ Bank 2 (B2) refers to the bank opposite bank 1.
^ Sensor 1 (S1) refers to the sensor that is located before the catalytic converters.
^ Sensor 2 (S2) refers to the sensor that is located after the catalytic converters.
Warranty Information
Page 2138
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 812
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2349
b. Turn the crankshaft 2/3 of a revolution (240°), and check only the valves indicated in the
illustration. Measure the valve clearance.
c. Turn the crankshaft a further 2/3 of a revolution (240°), and check only the valves indicated in the
illustration.
Measure the valve clearance.
5. ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
a. Remove the adjusting shim.
1. Turn the camshaft so that the cam lobe for the valve to be adjusted faces up. 2. Turn the valve
lifter with a screwdriver so that the notches are perpendicular to the camshaft.
3. Using Special Service Tool (SST) (A), press down the valve lifter and place SST (B) between the
camshaft and valve lifter. Remove SST
(A). SST 09248-55040 (09248-05410, 09248-05420)
Environmental Impact Information
Engine Oil: Environmental Impact Information
CAUTION:
- In order to preserve the environment, used oil and used oil filters must be disposed of only at
designated disposal sites.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 4168
1.50 mm (0.0590 inch) 1.55 mm (0.0610 inch) 1.60 mm (0.0630 inch) 1.65 mm (0.0650 inch) 1.70
mm (0.0669 inch) 1.75 mm (0.0689 inch) 1.80 mm (0.0709 inch) 1.85 mm (0.0728 inch) 1.90 mm
(0.0748 inch)
HINT: Select thrust washers which will ensure that the backlash is within the specifications.
b. Install the side gears with the thrust washers, pinion gears, pinion gear thrust washers and
pinion shaft.
HINT: Align the holes of the differential case and pinion shaft.
c. Using a dial indicator, measure the side gear backlash with holding one pinion gear toward the
case.
Backlash: 0.05 - 0.20 mm (0.0020 - 0.0079 inch)
If the backlash is not within the specification, replace the thrust washers.
d. Using a pin punch and hammer, drive in the straight pin through the holes in the differential case
and pinion shaft e. Using a chisel and hammer, stake the out side of the differential case pin hole.
2. Install side bearings. Using SST 09950-60010 (09951-00480, 09951-00640) 09950-70010
(09951-07150) and a press, install the side bearings
into the differential case.
3. Install ring gear on differential case.
a. Clean the contact surfaces of the differential case and ring gear.
Page 2931
O2S Application Table
O2S Failure Threshold Charts
Service and Repair
Oil Filter: Service and Repair
WARNING:
- Prolonged and repeated contact with mineral oil will result in the removal of natural fats from the
skin, leading to dryness, irritation and dermatitis. In addition, used engine oil contains potentially
harmful contaminants which may cause skin cancer.
- Care should be taken, therefore, when changing engine oil to minimize the frequency and length
of time your skin is exposed to used engine oil. Protective clothing and gloves, that cannot be
penetrated by oil, should be worn. Wash your skin thoroughly with soap and water, or use
waterless hand cleaner, to remove any used engine oil. Do not use gasoline, thinners, or solvents.
CAUTION:
- In order to preserve the environment, used oil and used oil filters must be disposed of only at
designated disposal sites.
1. Drain engine oil.
(a) Remove the oil filler cap.
(b) Remove the oil drain plug and drain the oil into a container.
2. Replace oil filter.
(a) Using Special Service Tool (SST) Oil Filter Wrench # 09228 - 07501 or equivalent, remove the
oil filter.
(b) Clean the oil filter contact surface on the oil filter mounting. (c)
Lubricate the filter rubber gasket with clean engine oil.
(d) Tighten the oil filter by hand until the rubber gasket contacts the seat of the filter mounting.
(e) Then using SST Oil Filter Wrench # 09228 - 07501 or equivalent, tighten it an additional 3/4 turn
to seat the filter.
3. Fill with engine oil.
(a) Clean and install the oil drain plug with a new gasket. Torque: 39 Nm (29 ft. lbs.)
(b) Fill with new engine oil.
Page 3861
Second Brake
Page 2784
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT AIR CLEANER CAP FROM MAF METER
2. REMOVE MAF METER
(a) Disconnect the MAF meter connector. (b) Remove the 2 bolts and MAF meter.
Torque: 6.9 N.m (72 kgf.cm, 61 in.lbf)
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Specifications
Camshaft: Specifications
DIMENSIONS
Cam Lobe Height:
Intake
...........................................................................................................................................................
42.31 - 42.41 mm (1.6657 - 1.6697 inch) Exhaust
........................................................................................................................................................
41.96 - 42.06 mm (1.6520 - 1.6559 inch)
Circle Runout:
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
.................................... 0.06 mm (0.0024 inch)
Journal Diameter:
Standard
.................................................................................................................................................. 26.949
- 26.965 mm (1.0610 - 1.0616 inch)
Journal Oil Clearance:
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
.................................... 0.10 mm (0.0039 inch) Standard
......................................................................................................................................................
0.035 - 0.072 mm (0.0014 - 0.0028 inch)
Thrust Clearance:
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
.................................... 0.12 mm (0.0047 inch) Standard
......................................................................................................................................................
0.033 - 0.080 mm (0.0013 - 0.0031 inch)
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Timing Pulley To Camshaft .................................................................................................................
............................................... 110 Nm (81 ft. lbs.)
Page 2088
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 2692
CHART 30
Page 4596
a. Turn the ring and push it in to check the braking action.
b. Measure the clearance between the synchronizer ring back and the input shaft spline end.
Standard Clearance: 1.05-1.85 mm (0.0413-0.0728 inch) Minimum Clearance: 0.80 mm (0.0315
inch)
If the clearance is less than the minimum, replace the synchronizer ring.
ASSEMBLY
Install oil seal rings install the 2 oil seal rings.
HINT: ^
Apply gear oil to the oil seal ring.
^ hang securely to eliminate clearance.
Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Specifications
Between Terminals Measured Resistance
At Clearance: 0 mm (0 in.) VTA - E2 0.2 - 5.7 K ohms
Throttle Fully Opened VTA - E2 2.0 - 10.2 K ohms
At all Times VC - E2 2.5 - 5.9 K ohms
Ohmmeter Connection
Page 2228
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2587
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 934
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Electrical Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Cold Hot
Between Terminals NE+ and NE- 1,630 - 2,740 ohms at 14 - 122 deg F 2,065 - 3,225 ohms at 122
- 212 deg F
Page 2316
- Using SST, tighten the flare nut to specified torque. (SST 09631-22020)
HINT: Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 30 cm (11.81 in.).
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf) Torque for using SST: 28 N.m (285 kgf.cm, 21 ft.lbf)
NOTICE: Do not rotate the fuel pipe, when tightening the flare nut.
Page 4537
Location Of Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness (Fig 38)
Ground Points
Ground Points
Page 1552
Timing Belt Tensioner: Testing and Inspection
INSPECTION
1. Visually check the seal portion of the tensioner for oil leakage.
NOTE: If there is only the faintest trace of oil on the seal on the push rod side, the tensioner is all
right. If leakage is found, replace the tensioner.
2. Hold the tensioner with both hands and push the push rod strongly as shown to check that it
doesn't move.
If the push rod moves, replace the tensioner.
CAUTION: Never hold the tensioner push rod facing downward.
3. Measure the protrusion of the push rod from the housing end.
Protrusion: 10.0 - 10.8 mm (0.394 - 0.425 inch) If the protrusion is not as specified, replace the
tensioner.
Page 692
Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2635
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 2144
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 3944
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 2792
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 4053
2. CHECK BALL
3. STRAINER, SPRING AND VALVE
Page 124
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 687
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 3002
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 3462
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 1958
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2774
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 903
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Components For Removal And Installation Part 1 Of 2
Page 283
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 4616
J: 2.50-2.55 mm (0.0984-0.1004 inch) K: 2.55-2.60 mm (0.1004-0.1024 inch) L: 2.60-2.65 mm
(0.1024-0.1043 inch) M: 2.65-2.70 mm (0.1043-0.1063 inch) N: 2.70-2.75 mm (0.1063-0.1083 inch)
P: 2.75-2.80 mm (0.1083-0.1102 inch) Q: 2.80-2.85 mm (0.1102-0.1122 inch) R: 2.85-2.90 mm
(0.1122-0.1142 inch) S: 2.90-2.95 mm (0.1142-0.1161 inch) T: 2.95-3.00 mm (0.1161-0.1181 inch)
U: 3.00-3.05 mm (0.1181-0.1201 inch)
Page 3290
Components For Removal And Installation Part 2 Of 2
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR REMOVAL
1. REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE 2. REMOVE INTAKE AIR CONNECTOR 3. DISCONNECT
FUEL RETURN HOSE FROM FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
CAUTION: Put a shop rag under the pressure regulator.
4. REMOVE FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
(a) Remove holding bolt the engine wire to the LH cylinder head cover.
(b) Disconnect the protector from the bracket on the RH cylinder head cover and lift up the engine
wire.
Page 2428
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 1831
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
EFI MAIN RELAY INSPECTION
1. REMOVE EFI MAIN RELAY (Marking: EFI) 2. INSPECT EFI MAIN RELAY
A. Inspect relay continuity
(a) Using an ohmmeter. check that there is continuity between terminals 1 and 2.
If there is no continuity. replace the relay.
(b) Check that there is no continuity between terminals and 5.
If there is continuity. replace the relay.
B. Inspect relay operation
(a) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 1 and 2. (b) Using an ohmmeter, check that
there is continuity between terminals 3 and 5.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
3. REINSTALL EFI MAIN RELAY
Testing and Inspection
Backup Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection
BACK-UP LIGHT RELAY INSPECTION
INSPECT RELAY CONTINUITY
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
Page 1825
Step 7
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Page 1253
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Rear
HUB BOLT REPLACEMENT
1. Remove wheel and brake drum. 2. Remove hub bolt.
Using SST, 09650-17011
3. Install hub bolt.
Install a washer and nut to a new hub bolt as shown and install the hub bolt with torquing the nut.
4. Install brake drum and wheel.
Torque to 110 Nm (83 ft. lbs.)
Page 1626
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
Coolant Classification Type:
Ethylene Glycol Based
Diagram Information and Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2433
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 833
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2223
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2074
Page 3288
Components For Removal And Installation Part 2 Of 2
Page 2957
Specifications
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Specifications
At Cold At Hot
Terminals +B and RSC or RSO 17.0 - 24.5 ohms at 14 - 122 deg F 21.5 - 28.5 ohms at 122 - 212
deg F
Page 4841
^ Type "A": Has a projection on the upper and lower side of the brake pad. (See illustration.)
^ Type "B": Has a flat upper and lower edge on the brake pad backing plate.
Type "A" Brake Pad
A. Remove the anti-squeal spring, clip and pad guide pin.
B. Remove the brake pads with the anti-squeal shims.
C. Clean any dust from the brake pads.
D. Apply a small amount of the disc brake caliper grease (1-2 mm thick) to the areas indicated in
the illustration.
NOTE:
Do NOT apply grease to the friction surfaces of the brake pads or the disc rotor.
E. Install the brake pads with the anti-squeal shims.
NOTE:
Clean excess grease from the brake pads and caliper.
F. Install the pad guide pin, clip and anti-squeal spring.
G. Install the wheel assembly.
Page 3525
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 4302
ASSEMBLY
HINT: When replacing the propeller shaft, install the new parts facing, as shown in the illustration.
1. Install center support bearing on intermediate shaft.
Install the center support bearing and spacer.
HINT: Install the center support bearing with the cutout toward the rear.
2. Install flange on intermediate shaft.
a. Coat the splines of the intermediate shaft with MP grease. b. Place the flange on the shaft and
align the matchmarks.
HINT: If replacing either the center flange or intermediate shaft, reassemble them so that the front
flange yoke of the intermediate shaft and the rear flange yoke of the propeller shaft are facing in
the same direction.
c. Install the spacer.
Page 4714
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Door Lock Control Relay Inspection
Power Door Lock Relay: Testing and Inspection Door Lock Control Relay Inspection
DOOR LOCK CONTROL RELAY INSPECTION
1. INSPECT RELAY CIRCUIT
Disconnect the connector from the relay and inspect the connector on the wire harness side, as
shown in the chart.
Page 2967
Oxygen Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Heated Oxygen Sensor to Exhaust Pipe 14 ft.lb
Page 2067
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - Oxygen Sensor Modified
ENGINE EG011-99
October 15, 1999
Title: 5VZ OXYGEN SENSOR IMPROVEMENT
Models: '96 - '99 Tacoma
Introduction
The design of the 5VZ Oxygen Sensor inner cover has been changed to reduce the possibility of
moisture contacting the ceramic element.
Applicable Vehicles
^ 1996-1999 model year Tacomas built before the VIN listed.
Repair Procedure Please refer to the appropriate repair manual for diagnostic and installation
information for the Oxygen Sensor.
Part Number Information
Warranty Information
Applicable Warranty*: This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in
effect for 36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in-service date.
Coverage is extended to 36 months or 50,000 miles, whichever occurs first, in the states of
California and Massachusetts due to state emissions warranty legislation.
Page 3764
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 2881
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Figure 1
Reference
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The intake air temp. sensor is built into the air flow meter and senses the intake air temperature. A
thermistor built in the sensor changes the resistance value according to the intake air temperature.
The lower the intake air temperature, the greater the thermistor resistance value and the higher the
intake air temperature, the lower the thermistor resistance value (See Fig.1.). The intake air
temperature sensor is connected to the ECM (See below). The 5 V power source voltage in the
ECM is applied to the intake air temperature sensor from the terminal THA via a resistor R. That is,
the resistor R and the intake air temperature sensor are connected in series. When the resistance
value of the intake air temperature sensor changes in accordance with changes in the intake air
temperature, the potential at terminal THA also changes. Based on this signal, the ECM increases
the fuel injection volume to improve driveability during cold engine operation.
Specifications
Clutch Slave Cylinder: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Bleeder Plug ........................................................................................................................................
............................................. 11 N.m (96 inch lbs.) Release Cylinder Installation Bolt
.................................................................................................................................................. 13
N.m (108 inch lbs.)
Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Signal: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 1286
Camshaft: Service and Repair Disassembly
1. Disassemble exhaust camshafts.
(a) Mount the hexagonal wrench head portion of the camshaft in a vise.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
(b) Using Special Service Tool (SST) Variable Pin Wrench Set # 09960 - 10010 (Variable Pin
Wrench Arm Assembly # 09962 - 01000, Pin 5 #
09963 - 00500) or equivalents, turn the sub-gear clockwise and remove the service bolt.
(c) Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
(d) Remove these parts:
- Wave washer.
- Camshaft sub-gear.
- Camshaft gear spring.
NOTE: Arrange the camshaft sub-gears and gear springs (RH and LH side).
Page 2129
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 1693
Required SSTs
Radiator Cap Identification Procedure
1. Use the illustration below to identify the vehicle's radiator cap type and kPa rating.
2. Proceed to the required inspection procedure for the radiator cap and kPa rating.
Radiator Cap Inspection Procedure
Type: N-cap, 88 kPa
1. Remove coolant and any foreign material on rubber points "A," "B," and "C."
2. Check that points "A," "B," and "C" are not deformed, cracked, or swollen.
3. Check that points "C" and "D" are not stuck together.
4. Apply engine coolant to points "B" and "C" before using the radiator cap tester.
^ Radiator Cap Tester: Snap-On/Sun P/N SVTS262A (or equivalent)
Page 1210
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Testing and Inspection
Shift Interlock Control Module: Testing and Inspection
Shift Lock ECU, Harness Side: Floor Shift
Floor Shift:
Inspect shift lock control ECU. Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage at terminal.
HINT: Do not disconnect the ECU connector.
Page 4548
Differential: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 4921
Using Special Service Tool (SST) # 09023 - 00100, disconnect the 5 brake lines from the Anti-Lock
Brake System (ABS) actuator. Torque: 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.)
2. Disconnect connectors.
Disconnect the 2 connectors from the actuator.
3. Remove control relay from actuator bracket. 4. Remove ABS actuator.
(a) Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts and ABS actuator assembly.
Torque: 19 Nm (14 ft. lbs.)
(b) Remove the bolt and connector clamp. (c) Remove the 3 nuts and ABS actuator from the
actuator bracket.
Torque: 5.4 Nm (48 inch lbs.)
(d) Remove the 3 holders and cushions from the ABS actuator.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. After installation, fill brake reservoir with brake fluid,
bleed brake system. Refer to Brakes. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair Check for leaks.
Page 3166
Fillpipe Restrictor: Testing and Inspection
Remove the fuel filler cap and check the fillpipe restrictor for tampering. On models with more that
one fuel tank, check each tank filler tube.
Page 540
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 3059
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 1879
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 814
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 653
CHART 11
Page 53
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3710
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Recommended Spark Plugs
ND K16TR11
NGK BKR5EKB-11
Page 1647
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Specifications
Canister Purge Solenoid: Specifications
Resistance 29 - 33 ohms at 68 deg F
Page 944
Page 2251
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 4387
Counter Gear: Service and Repair Bearing Replacement
If necessary, replace counter gear front bearing. a. Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap
ring.
b. Using SST 09950-00020 and a press, remove the bearing. c. Replace the side race.
d. Using a socket wrench and press, install a new bearing and side race.
Page 786
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2951
CHART 24
Page 1460
Engine Oil: Service and Repair
WARNING:
- Prolonged and repeated contact with mineral oil will result in the removal of natural fats from the
skin, leading to dryness, irritation and dermatitis. In addition, used engine oil contains potentially
harmful contaminants which may cause skin cancer.
- Care should be taken, therefore, when changing engine oil to minimize the frequency and length
of time your skin is exposed to used engine oil. Protective clothing and gloves, that cannot be
penetrated by oil, should be worn. Wash your skin thoroughly with soap and water, or use
waterless hand cleaner, to remove any used engine oil. Do not use gasoline, thinners, or solvents.
CAUTION:
- In order to preserve the environment, used oil and used oil filters must be disposed of only at
designated disposal sites.
1. Drain engine oil.
(a) Remove the oil filler cap.
(b) Remove the oil drain plug and drain the oil into a container.
2. Replace oil filter.
(a) Using Special Service Tool (SST) Oil Filter Wrench # 09228 - 07501 or equivalent, remove the
oil filter.
(b) Clean the oil filter contact surface on the oil filter mounting. (c)
Lubricate the filter rubber gasket with clean engine oil.
(d) Tighten the oil filter by hand until the rubber gasket contacts the seat of the filter mounting.
(e) Then using SST Oil Filter Wrench # 09228 - 07501 or equivalent, tighten it an additional 3/4 turn
to seat the filter.
3. Fill with engine oil.
(a) Clean and install the oil drain plug with a new gasket. Torque: 39 Nm (29 ft. lbs.)
(b) Fill with new engine oil.
Page 1044
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: If there is lack of power, excessive oil consumption or poor fuel economy, measure the
compression pressure.
1. Warm up and stop engine.
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature.
2. Remove ignition coils. 3. Remove spark plugs.
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the 6 spark plugs.
4. Check cylinder compression pressure.
(a) Insert a compression gauge into the spark plug hole.
(b) Fully open the throttle. (c)
While cranking the engine, measure the compression pressure.
NOTE: Always use a fully charged battery to obtain engine revolutions of 250 rpm or more.
(d) Repeat steps (a) through (c) for each cylinder.
NOTE: This measurement must be done in as short a time as possible.
Compression pressure: 1,200 kPa (174 psi) or more. Minimum pressure: 1,000 kPa (145 psi)
Difference between each cylinder: 100 kPa (15 psi) or less.
(e) If the cylinder compression in one or more cylinders is low, pour a small amount of engine oil
into the cylinder through the spark plug hole and repeat steps (a) through (c) for cylinders with low
compression. If adding oil helps the compression, it is likely that the piston rings and/or cylinder bore are worn or
damaged.
- If pressure stays low, a valve may be sticking or seating is improper, or there may be leakage
past the gasket.
5. Reinstall spark plugs.
Torque: 20 Nm (14 ft. lbs.)
6. Reinstall ignition coils.
Locations
Shift Interlock Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Electrical Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Cold Hot
Between Terminals NE+ and NE- 1,630 - 2,740 ohms at 14 - 122 deg F 2,065 - 3,225 ohms at 122
- 212 deg F
Page 851
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Crankshaft Sensor to Oil Pump 69 in.lb
Page 729
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSPECTION
NOTICE: "Cold" and "Hot" in these sentences express the temperature of the sensors themselves.
"Cold" is from -10°C (14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals.
Resistance:
Cold: 1,630 - 2,740 Ohms Hot: 2,065 - 3,225 Ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the crank shaft position sensor.
Page 3854
Forward Clutch
Page 818
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The throttle position sensor is mounted in the throttle body and detects the throttle valve opening
angle. When the throttle valve is fully closed, a voltage of approximately 0.7 V is applied to terminal
VTA of the ECM. The voltage applied to the terminals VTA of the ECM increases in proportion to
the opening angle of the throttle valve and becomes approximately 2.7 ~ 5.2 V when the throttle
valve is fully opened. The ECM judges the vehicle driving conditions from these signals input from
terminals VTA and uses them as one of the conditions for deciding the air-fuel ratio correction,
power increase correction and fuel-cut control etc.
Page 58
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 2086
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Knock Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 3694
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Testing and Inspection
Evaporative Vapor Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR INSPECTION
1. INSPECT POWER SOURCE VOLTAGE OF VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the vapor pressure sensor connector. (b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage between connector terminals VC and E2 of the wiring
harness side.
Voltage: 4.5 - 5.5 V
(d) Turn the ignition switch to LOCK. (e) Reconnect the vapor pressure sensor connector.
2. INSPECT POWER OUTPUT OF VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON. (b) Disconnect the vacuum hose from the vapor pressure sensor.
(c) Connect a voltmeter to terminals PTNK and E2 of the ECM and measure the output voltage
under ambient atmospheric pressure.
- Apply vacuum (2.0 kPa, 15 mm Hg. 0.59 in.Hg) to the vapor pressure sensor.
Voltage: 1.3 - 2.1 V
- Release the vacuum from the vapor pressure sensor.
Voltage: 3.0 - 3.6 V
- Apply pressure (1.5 kPa, 15 gf/sq.cm, 0.22 psi) to the vapor pressure sensor.
Voltage: 4.2 - 4.8 V
(d) Reconnect the vacuum hose to the vapor pressure sensor.
Page 1900
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 1172
Engine Oil: Service and Repair
WARNING:
- Prolonged and repeated contact with mineral oil will result in the removal of natural fats from the
skin, leading to dryness, irritation and dermatitis. In addition, used engine oil contains potentially
harmful contaminants which may cause skin cancer.
- Care should be taken, therefore, when changing engine oil to minimize the frequency and length
of time your skin is exposed to used engine oil. Protective clothing and gloves, that cannot be
penetrated by oil, should be worn. Wash your skin thoroughly with soap and water, or use
waterless hand cleaner, to remove any used engine oil. Do not use gasoline, thinners, or solvents.
CAUTION:
- In order to preserve the environment, used oil and used oil filters must be disposed of only at
designated disposal sites.
1. Drain engine oil.
(a) Remove the oil filler cap.
(b) Remove the oil drain plug and drain the oil into a container.
2. Replace oil filter.
(a) Using Special Service Tool (SST) Oil Filter Wrench # 09228 - 07501 or equivalent, remove the
oil filter.
(b) Clean the oil filter contact surface on the oil filter mounting. (c)
Lubricate the filter rubber gasket with clean engine oil.
(d) Tighten the oil filter by hand until the rubber gasket contacts the seat of the filter mounting.
(e) Then using SST Oil Filter Wrench # 09228 - 07501 or equivalent, tighten it an additional 3/4 turn
to seat the filter.
3. Fill with engine oil.
(a) Clean and install the oil drain plug with a new gasket. Torque: 39 Nm (29 ft. lbs.)
(b) Fill with new engine oil.
Page 1746
Water Pump: Testing and Inspection
1. Inspect water pump.
(a) Visually check the drain hole for coolant leakage. If leakage is found, replace the water pump. If
engine coolant has leaked onto the timing belt, replace the timing belt.
(b) Turn the pulley, and check that the water pump bearing moves smoothly and quietly.
If necessary, replace the water pump.
2. Inspect fluid coupling.
(a) Remove the 4 nuts and fan from the fluid coupling.
(b) Check the fluid coupling for damage and silicon oil leakage.
If necessary, replace the fluid coupling.
(c) Install the fan and fluid coupling with the 4 nuts. Torque: 7.4 Nm (65 inch lbs.)
3. Inspect fan pulley bracket.
Check the turning smoothness of the fan pulley. If necessary, replace the fan pulley bracket.
4. Inspect timing belt. Refer to Engine.
Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Dimmer Switch: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
INSPECT LIGHT CONTROL RHEOSTAT
STEP TYPE: w/o Tachometer (DLX Grade M/T Vehicle)
Gradually turn the rheostat knob from the bright side to dark side, check that the resistance
between terminals increases from approximately 0 to 9.0 Ohms. If operation is not as specified,
replace the rheostat.
NON-STEP TYPE: w/Tachometer (DLX Grade M/T Vehicle)
1. Turn the rheostat knob OFF and check that there is no continuity between terminals. (Rheostat
knob turned to fully counterclockwise) 2. Gradually, turn the rheostat knob from the dark side to
bright side and check that the resistance decreases from 10 to 0 Ohms. (Rheostat knob
turned to clockwise) If operation is not as specified, replace the rheostat.
ELECTRICAL TYPE: w/ All A/T Vehicle and SR5 Grade M/T Vehicle
1. Connect terminals 1 and 3 through a 3.4 W test bulb. 2. Connect the positive (+) lead from the
battery to terminal 1 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 2. 3. Turn the rheostat knob to fully
counterclockwise and check that the test bulb goes out. 4. Gradually turn the rheostat knob to
clockwise and check that the test bulb brightness changes from dark to bright.
If operation is not as specified, replace the rheostat.
Page 3587
Components For Removal And Installation Part 2 Of 2
Page 3739
P 1 PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW
4-Ground: Approx. 12 Volts with ignition SW ON position
O 4-B, S 4-A O/D MAIN SW
A-5-A-10, B-1-B-3: Open with O/D main SW at ON position Open with O/D main SW at OFF
position
S 5-A, B STOP LIGHT SW
A-1-A-2, B-1-B-2: Closed with Brake Pedal Depressed
E 5-A, E 6-D, E 7-C, E 8-B ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
S1-E1: 9-14 Volts
S2, SL-E1: 0-1.5 Volts
BK-E1: 7.5-14 Volts with Brake Pedal Depressed 0-1.5 Volts with Brake Pedal Released
THW-E2: 0.2-1.0 Volts with Coolant Temp. 80° C (176° F)
OIL-E2: 4-5 Volts with fluid Temp. 20° C (68° F)
IDL-E2:
0-3 Volts with Throttle Valve fully closed 9-14 Volts with Throttle Valve open
VTA-E2: 0.3-0.8 Volts with Throttle Valve fully closed 3.2-4.9 Volts with Throttle Valve fully open
VCC-E2: 4.5-5.5 Volts
OD1-E1: 4.5-5.5 Volts
OD2-E1: 9-14 Volts O/D main SW turned ON 0 Volts O/D main SW turned OFF
SP1-E1: Pulse Generation with vehicle moving
2-E1: 10-14 Volts with Shift Lever at 2 position 0-2 Volts with shift lever at expect 2 position
L-E1: 10-14 Volts with Shift Lever at L position 0-2 Volts with Shift Lever at expect L position
L4-E1: 10-14 Volts with Transfer Shift at H2 or H4 position 0 Volts with Transfer shift at L4 position
OIL-W-E1: 0.1-4.9 Volts
+B-E1: 9-14 Volts
BATT-E1: 9-14 Volts
Splice Points
Splice Points
Page 136
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 2657
^ O2S TEST RESULTS
A list of the available oxygen sensors will be displayed.
2. Select the desired oxygen sensor and press Enter.
NOTE:
The monitor result of the A/F sensor will not be displayed. If you select "Bank 1-Sensor 1" or Bank
2-Sensor 1" for a vehicle equipped with an A/F sensor, the Diagnostic Tester will display "No
parameter to display."
3. Compare the test results with the values listed in the Failure Threshold Chart.
* Although this procedure references the Toyota Diagnostic Tester, the O2S test results can be
checked using a generic OBD II scantool. Refer to your OBD II scantool operator's manual for
specific procedures.
Comparing O2S Test Results to Failure Thresholds
1. Determine the correct O2S Failure Threshold Chart for your vehicle by looking in the "O2S
Application Table," in this bulletin.
2. Select appropriate year, model, and engine for specified O2S Failure Threshold Chart.
3. Compare O2S test results with the specified O2S Failure Threshold Chart. It may be necessary
to convert O2S test results to a specific measurement unit using the conversion factor that is
supplied in the specified table. See example.
Example:
Page 3269
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Standard Value of ECM Terminals
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection Standard Value of ECM Terminals
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 1 Of 2
Page 4427
c. While pushing the 3 shifting keys, install the clutch hub No.1 to the reverse gear, as shown.
3. Install 3rd gear and hub sleeve No.2 on output shaft.
a. Apply gear oil to the shaft and needle roller bearing. b. Place the synchronizer ring on the gear
and align the ring slots with the shifting keys.
c. Install the needle roller bearing in the 3rd gear.
d. Using a press, install the 3rd gear and hub sleeve No.2.
4. Install snap ring.
a. Select a snap ring that will allow minimum axial play.
Mark A: 1.80-1.85 mm (0.0709-0.0728 inch) Mark B: 1.85-1.90 mm (0.0728-0.0748 inch) Mark C:
1.90-1.95 mm (0.0748-0.0768 inch) Mark D: 1.95-2.00 mm (0.0768-0.0787 inch) Mark E: 2.00-2.05
mm (0.0787-0.0807 inch) Mark F: 2.05-2.10 mm (0.0807-0.0827 inch) Mark G: 2.10-2.15 mm
(0.0827-0.0846 inch)
b. Using a snap ring expander, install the snap ring.
5. Inspect 3rd gear thrust clearance. 6. Install 2nd gear and reverse gear.
a. Apply gear oil to the shaft and needle roller bearing. b. Place the synchronizer ring on the gear
and align the ring slots with the shifting keys. c. Align the projection of the synchronizer inner ring
with the slots of the clutch hub No.1. d. Install the needle roller bearing in the 2nd gear.
Page 1757
Catalytic Converter: Service and Repair
CATALYTIC CONVERTER REPLACEMENT
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE CENTER EXHAUST PIPE
Remove the 4 bolts, TWC joint retainer. center exhaust pipe and 2 gasket.
Torque: 62 N.m (632 kgf.cm. 40 ft.lbf)
INSTALLATION HINT: Place 2 new gaskets on the front exhaust and tail pipes. and temporarily
install the center exhaust pipe.
Testing and Inspection
Evaporative Vapor Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR INSPECTION
1. INSPECT POWER SOURCE VOLTAGE OF VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the vapor pressure sensor connector. (b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage between connector terminals VC and E2 of the wiring
harness side.
Voltage: 4.5 - 5.5 V
(d) Turn the ignition switch to LOCK. (e) Reconnect the vapor pressure sensor connector.
2. INSPECT POWER OUTPUT OF VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON. (b) Disconnect the vacuum hose from the vapor pressure sensor.
(c) Connect a voltmeter to terminals PTNK and E2 of the ECM and measure the output voltage
under ambient atmospheric pressure.
- Apply vacuum (2.0 kPa, 15 mm Hg. 0.59 in.Hg) to the vapor pressure sensor.
Voltage: 1.3 - 2.1 V
- Release the vacuum from the vapor pressure sensor.
Voltage: 3.0 - 3.6 V
- Apply pressure (1.5 kPa, 15 gf/sq.cm, 0.22 psi) to the vapor pressure sensor.
Voltage: 4.2 - 4.8 V
(d) Reconnect the vacuum hose to the vapor pressure sensor.
Page 1058
Page 379
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 586
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2968
Page 1173
Oil grade:
API grade SH, Energy-Conserving II multigrade engine oil or ILSAC multigrade engine oil.
Recommended viscosity is as shown in the illustration with SAE 5W-30 being the preferred engine
oil.
Oil capacity:
Drain and refill
w/o Oil filter change: 4.9 liters (5.2 US qts.) w/ Oil filter change: 5.2 liters (5.5 US qts.)
Dry fill: 5.9 Liters (6.2 US qts.)
(c) Reinstall the oil filler cap.
4. Start engine and check for oil leaks. 5. Check engine oil level.
Page 3095
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 2648
Engine Bank Identification
Page 1419
Drive Belt: Tools and Equipment
Belt Tension Gauge:
Nippondenso BTG-20 (95506-00020) or Borroughs No.BT-33-73F
Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSPECTION
NOTICE: "Cold" and "Hot" in these sentences express the temperature of the sensors themselves.
"Cold" is from -10°C (14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals.
Resistance:
Cold: 1,630 - 2,740 Ohms Hot: 2,065 - 3,225 Ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the crank shaft position sensor.
Page 662
CHART 22
Page 3270
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 4747
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
2-4 Selector Switch
Inspect 2-4 selector switch continuity. Test continuity between terminals 1 and 2.
Switch position: Specified condition.
OFF: No continuity. ON: Continuity.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the shift lever knob.
Page 1591
5. RECONNECT HIGH-TENSION CORDS TO IGNITION COILS
(a) Assemble the holder and grommet.
(b) Align the spline of the ignition coil with the spline of the holder and push in the cord.
NOTICE: Check that the holder is correctly installed to the grommet and distributor cap as shown in
the illustration.
(c) Check that the lock claw of the holder is engaged by lightly pulling the holder.
6. RECONNECT HIGH-TENSION CORDS TO SPARK PLUGS 7. REINSTALL AIR CLEANER
HOSE
Page 2806
Page 3106
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Electrical Specifications
EGR Temperature Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Note: Except Model VZN170 (Long wheel base 4WD Pickup)
Resistance 64 - 97 K ohms at 122 deg F
11 - 16 K ohms at 212 deg F
2 - 4 K ohms at 302 deg F
Page 1829
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 4138
Washer thickness:
2.00 - 2.02 mm (0.0787 - 0.0795 inch) 2.03 - 2.05 mm (0.0799 - 0.0807 inch) 2.06 - 2.08 mm
(0.0811 - 0.0819 inch) 2.09 - 2.11 mm (0.0823 - 0.0831 inch) 2.12 - 2.14 mm (0.0835 - 0.0843 inch)
2.15 - 2.17 mm (0.0846 - 0.0854 inch) 2.18 - 2.20 mm (0.0858 - 0.0866 inch) 2.21 - 2.23 mm
(0.0870 - 0.0878 inch) 2.24 - 2.26 mm (0.0882 - 0.0890 inch) 2.27 - 2.29 mm (0.0894 - 0.0902 inch)
2.30 - 2.32 mm (0.0906 - 0.0913 inch) 2.33 - 2.35 mm (0.0917 - 0.0925 inch) 2.36 - 2.38 mm
(0.0929 - 0.0937 inch) 2.39 - 2.41 mm (0.0941 - 0.0949 inch) 2.42 - 2.44 mm (0.0953 - 0.0961 inch)
2.45 - 2.47 mm (0.0965 - 0.0972 inch) 2.48 - 2.50 mm (0.0976 - 0.0984 inch) 2.51 - 2.53 mm
(0.0988 - 0.0996 inch) 2.54 - 2.56 mm (0.1000 - 0.1008 inch) 2.57 - 2.59 mm (0.1012 - 0.1020 inch)
2.60 - 2.62 mm (0.1024 - 0.1031 inch) 2.63 - 2.65 mm (0.1035 - 0.1043 inch) 2.66 - 2.68 mm
(0.1047 - 0.1055 inch) 2.69 - 2.71 mm (0.1059 - 0.1067 inch) 2.72 - 2.74 mm (0.1071 - 0.1079 inch)
2.75 - 2.77 mm (0.1083 - 0.1091 inch) 2.78 - 2.80 mm (0.1094 - 0.1102 inch)
12. Measure total preload. Using a torque wrench, measure the preload with the teeth of the drive
pinion and ring gear in contact.
Total preload (at starting):
Drive pinion preload plus 0.4 - 0.6 Nm (3.5 - 5.2 inch lbs.)
13. Inspect tooth contact between ring gear and drive pinion.
a. Remove the side bearing retainer and differential case.
b. Coat 3 or 4 teeth at three different positions on the ring gear with red lead. c. Install the
differential case and side bearing retainer.
Torque to 69 Nm (51 ft. lbs.)
d. Hold the companion flange firmly and rotate the ring gear in both directions. e. Remove the side
bearing retainer and differential case.
Page 1396
ADJUSTING SHIM SELECTION CHART (EXHAUST)
Page 3271
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 2943
CHART 18
CHART 19
Diagram Information and Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 660
Page 1877
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 885
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Specifications
Brake Pedal Assy: Specifications
DIMENSIONS
Pedal Freeplay ....................................................................................................................................
......................................... 3-6 mm (0.12-0.24 inch) Pedal Height
..............................................................................................................................................................
159.1-169.1 mm (6.262-6.657 inch) Reserve Distance [1] ..................................................................
........................................................................................................... 72 mm (2.83 inch) Switch To
Pedal Clearance
............................................................................................................................................... 0.5-2.4
mm (0.020-0.094 inch)
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Push rod lock nut torque: .....................................................................................................................
................................................. 25 Nm (19 ft. lbs.)
[1] From asphalt sheet @ 490 N (110 lbs.)
Page 4015
Torque: 5.4 Nm (55 kgf-cm, 48 inch lbs.)
8. CONNECT NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
Page 1455
Engine Oil: Technician Safety Information
WARNING:
- Prolonged and repeated contact with mineral oil will result in the removal of natural fats from the
skin, leading to dryness, irritation and dermatitis. In addition, used engine oil contains potentially
harmful contaminants which may cause skin cancer.
- Care should be taken, therefore, when changing engine oil to minimize the frequency and length
of time your skin is exposed to used engine oil. Protective clothing and gloves, that cannot be
penetrated by oil, should be worn. Wash your skin thoroughly with soap and water, or use
waterless hand cleaner, to remove any used engine oil. Do not use gasoline, thinners, or solvents.
Page 3636
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 3892
Position Of Parts In Engine Compartment (Part 2 Of 2) (Fig 25)
Specifications
Band: Specifications
SECOND COAST BRAKE
Piston Stroke .......................................................................................................................................
.............................. 1.5 - 3.0 mm (0.059 - 0.118 inch) Piston Rod Length ...........................................
.................................................................................................................................... 72.9 mm
(2.870 inch)
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................................... 71.4 mm (2.811 inch)
Specifications
Water Pump: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Water Pump To Cylinder Block
..................................................................................................................................................... 20
Nm (14 ft. lbs.) Water Inlet To Water Pump
............................................................................................................................................................
20 Nm (14 ft. lbs.)
Page 3234
Fillpipe Restrictor: Testing and Inspection
Remove the fuel filler cap and check the fillpipe restrictor for tampering. On models with more that
one fuel tank, check each tank filler tube.
Page 2021
Page 2387
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 161
Step 7
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Electrical Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Electrical Specifications
Resistance 10 - 20 K ohms at -4 deg F
4 - 7 K ohms at 32 deg F
2 - 3 K ohms at 68 deg F
0.9 - 1.3 K ohms at 104 deg F
0.4 - 0.7 K ohms at 140 deg F
0.2 - 0.4 K ohms at 176 deg F
Page 1539
10. w/ A/C: Disconnect A/C compressor from engine. 11. w/ A/C: Remove A/C compressor bracket.
Remove the 5 bolts and A/C compressor bracket.
12. Remove oil dipstick and guide.
Remove the bolt, oil dipstick, guide and O-ring.
13. Remove No. 2 timing belt cover.
(a) Disconnect the camshaft position sensor connector, 3 high-tension cord clamps and PS pump
hose from the No. 2 timing belt cover.
(b) Remove the 6 bolts and No. 2 timing belt cover.
14. Remove fan bracket.
(a) Remove the nut and PS pump adjusting strut.
(b) Remove the bolt, nut, and fan bracket.
15. Remove crankshaft pulley.
(a) Using Special Service Tool (SST) Crankshaft Pulley Holding Tool # 09213 - 54015 (Bolt 90119 08216) and Companion Flange Holding Tool # 09330 - 00021 or equivalents, loosen the pulley
bolt.
(b) Remove the SST, pulley bolt and pulley.
NOTE: If necessary, remove the pulley with SST Puller C Set # 09950 - 50010 (Hanger 150 #
09551 - 05010, Slide Arm # 09552 - 05010, Center Bolt 150 # 09553 - 05020, Claw No. 3 # 09554 05030) or equivalents and service bolt.
Page 4262
5. Disconnect brake line and parking brake cable. Using SST 09751-36011, disconnect the brake
line from the wheel cylinder.
Installation Hint: Torque to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.)
6. Remove rear axle shaft assembly.
a. Remove the 4 backing plate mounting nuts.
Installation Hint: Torque to 68 Nm (50 ft. lbs.)
b. Pull out the rear axle shaft assembly from the rear axle housing.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the oil seal.
7. Remove o-ring from rear axle housing.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
HINT: After installation, bleed brake system and check ABS speed sensor signal.
Inspection and Repair
INSPECTION AND REPAIR
1. w/ ABS: Remove bearing retainer (differential side) and ABS speed sensor rotor.
a. Attach 4 nuts to the serration bolts and remove the serration bolts from the backing plate using a
hammer.
NOTICE: Do not reuse the nuts previously removed from the vehicle.
b. Grind the retainer and sensor rotor surfaces using grinder, then chisel them out with a chisel. c.
Attach washers and nut to the serration bolts, then torque the nuts to install the serration bolts to
the backing plate. d. Remove the 4 nuts from the serration:ion bolts.
2. Remove snap ring from axle. shaft Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
Page 134
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 1073
Torque: 5.4 Nm (48 inch lbs.)
21. Install No. 2 fan shroud. 22. Install and adjust drive belt for generator. 23. w/ A/C: install and
adjust drive belt for A/C compressor. 24. Install and adjust drive belt for PS pump. 25. Connect
upper radiator hose. 26. Fill engine with coolant. 27. Start engine check for leaks. 28. Install engine
under cover. 29. Perform road test.
Check for abnormal noise, shock, slippage, correct shift points and smooth operation.
30. Recheck engine coolant level.
Page 3386
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 4540
Locations-J/B No.3 Behind The Instrument Panel Center (Fig 22)
Parts Location
Parts Location
Page 3260
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 2972
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
A/C - Liquid Tube Improvement
Hose/Line HVAC: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Liquid Tube Improvement
AC007-97 HEATING & AIR CONDITIONING
December 5, 1997
Title: A/C LIQUID TUBE IMPROVEMENT
Models: '95 - '97 Tacoma
Introduction
The air conditioning Liquid Tube on Tacoma has been changed:
^ The shape and length of Liquid Tube # 1 has been changed to reduce vibrations transmitted by
condenser movement.
^ Additional condenser brackets with horizontal braces have replaced the previous supply parts to
reduce condenser movement.
Affected Vehicles
1995 - 1997 model year Tacomas.
Parts Information
APPLICATION PART NUMBER PART NAME
'95 - '96 L4 & V6 88840-35080 Liquid Tube Repair Kit
1997 L4 & V6 88840-35090 Liquid Tube Repair Kit
Contents of Parts Kits
Page 4660
Location Of Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness, Ground Points (Fig 32)
Location Of Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness, Ground Points (Fig 36)
Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Page 299
6. INSPECT ECT SENSOR
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Resistance: Refer to the graph
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the ECT sensor.
7. REINSTALL ECT SENSOR
(a) Install a new gasket to the ECT sensor. (b) Using a 19 mm deep socket, install the ECT sensor.
Torque: 20 N.m (200 kgf.cm, 14 ft.lbf)
(c) Connect the ECT sensor connector.
8. REINSTALL FUEL PIPE
Install the fuel pipe with 4 new gaskets and the 2 union bolts.
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm. 25 ft.lbf)
9. REINSTALL NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER
10. RECONNECT UPPER RADIATOR HOSE TO WATER OUTLET 11. REFILL WITH ENGINE
COOLANT
Bolt Inspection
Connecting Rod: Testing and Inspection Bolt Inspection
1. Install the cap nut to the connecting rod bolt. Check that the cap nut can be turned easily by
hand to the end of the thread. 2. If the cap nut cannot be turned easily, measure the outside
diameter of the compressed thread with a vernier caliper.
Standard outside diameter: 7.860 - 8.000 mm (0.3094 - 0.3150 inch) Minimum outside diameter:
7.600 mm (0.2992 inch)
NOTE: If the location of minimum diameter cannot be judged by visual inspection, measure the
outer diameter at the location shown in the illustration. If the outside diameter is less than
minimum, replace the connecting rod and rod cap nut as a set.
Page 943
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 678
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - Oxygen Sensor Improvement
ENGINE EG006-99
Title: 5VZ OXYGEN SENSOR IMPROVEMENT
Models: '96 - '99 Tacoma
June 18, 1999
Introduction The design of the 5VZ Oxygen Sensor inner cover has been changed 10 reduce the
possibility of moisture contacting the ceramic element.
Affected Vehicles ^
1996-1999 model year Tacomas built before the VINs listed below.
Repair Procedure Please refer to the appropriate repair manual for diagnostic and installation
information for the Oxygen Sensor.
Part Number Information
Electrical Specifications
EGR Temperature Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Note: Except Model VZN170 (Long wheel base 4WD Pickup)
Resistance 64 - 97 K ohms at 122 deg F
11 - 16 K ohms at 212 deg F
2 - 4 K ohms at 302 deg F
Diagram Information and Instructions
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 676
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - Oxygen Sensor Modified
ENGINE EG011-99
October 15, 1999
Title: 5VZ OXYGEN SENSOR IMPROVEMENT
Models: '96 - '99 Tacoma
Introduction
The design of the 5VZ Oxygen Sensor inner cover has been changed to reduce the possibility of
moisture contacting the ceramic element.
Applicable Vehicles
^ 1996-1999 model year Tacomas built before the VIN listed.
Repair Procedure Please refer to the appropriate repair manual for diagnostic and installation
information for the Oxygen Sensor.
Part Number Information
Warranty Information
Applicable Warranty*: This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in
effect for 36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in-service date.
Coverage is extended to 36 months or 50,000 miles, whichever occurs first, in the states of
California and Massachusetts due to state emissions warranty legislation.
Page 2293
Knock Sensor: Oscilloscope Patterns and Waveforms
Page 2658
A. The Diagnostic Tester displays 17" as a value of the Time $81" (see illustration).
B. Find the Conversion Factor value of Time $81" in the O2S Failure Threshold chart. 0.3906 is
specified for Time $81 in this chart.
C. Multiply "17" in step "A" by 0.3906 (Conversion Factor) in step "B."
17 x 0.3906 = 6.6%
D. If the answer is within the Standard Value of TEST LIMIT, the Time $81" can be confirmed to be
normal.
NOTE:
^ "LOW SW V" indicates the O2S voltage when the O2S status changes from rich to lean.
^ "HIGH SW V" indicates the O2S voltage when the O2S status changes from lean to rich.
^ If the O2S voltage is lower than "LOW SW V," the O2S status is lean.
^ If the O2S voltage is higher than "HIGH SW V," the O2S status is rich.
NOTE:
Before the O2S Monitor completes or after the ignition switch is turned OFF, the Diagnostic Tester
displays the viewable upper limit or a lower limit of the test value (example: 0 V, 1.275 V, Os
[seconds], 10.2s, 0 and 255).
Door Unlock Detection Switch
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection Door Unlock Detection Switch
INSPECT DRIVER'S DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION SWITCH CONTINUITY
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
INSPECT PASSENGER'S DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION SWITCH CONTINUITY
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Page 1188
Refrigerant: Service Precautions
PRECAUTION
1. DO NOT HANDLE REFRIGERANT IN AN ENCLOSED AREA OR NEAR AN OPEN FLAME
2. ALWAYS WEAR EYE PROTECTION
3. BE CAREFUL THAT LIQUID REFRIGERANT DOES NOT GET IN YOUR EYES OR ON YOUR
SKIN
If liquid refrigerant gets in your eyes or on your skin: a. Wash the area with lots of cool water.
CAUTION: Do not rub your eyes or skin.
b. Apply clean petroleum jelly to the skin. c. Go immediately to a physician or hospital for
professional treatment.
4. NEVER HEAT CONTAINER OR EXPOSE IT NAKED FLAME
5. BE CAREFUL NOT TO DROP CONTAINER AND NOT TO APPLY PHYSICAL SHOCKS TO IT
6. DO NOT OPERATE COMPRESSOR WITHOUT ENOUGH REFRIGERANT IN REFRIGERANT
SYSTEM
If there is not enough refrigerant in the refrigerant system. oil lubrication will be insufficient and
compressor burnout may occur, so take care to avoid this.
7. DO NOT OPEN HIGH PRESSURE MANIFOLD VALVE WHILST COMPRESSOR IS
OPERATING
If the high pressure valve is opened, refrigerant flows in the reverse direction and could cause the
charging cylinder to rupture, so open and close the low pressure valve only.
Page 135
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
With Automatic Disconnecting Differential
Output Shaft: Service and Repair With Automatic Disconnecting Differential
NOTE: For removal and installation procedures refer to "Transfer Case, Service and Repair."
DISASSEMBLY
Page 2517
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR REMOVAL
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the crankshaft position sensor connector. (b) Remove the bolt crankshaft position
sensor.
Torque: 7.8 N.m (80 kgf.cm, 69 in.lbf)
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 3096
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 1853
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2832
Page 1499
Intake Manifold: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications
INTAKE MANIFOLD VACUUM
At Idle Speed .......................................................................................................................................
.............................. 60 kPa (17.7 inch Hg) or more
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Knock Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
KNOCK SENSOR INSPECTION
1. REMOVE KNOCK SENSORS
See: Service and Repair
2. INSPECT KNOCK SENSORS
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between the terminal and body. If there is
continuity, replace the sensor.
Page 4413
Input Shaft: Service and Repair
NOTE: For removal and installation procedures refer to "Manual Transmission/Transaxle, Service
and Repair."
If necessary, replace input shaft bearing. a. Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
b. Using a press, remove the bearing.
c. Using SST 09506-35010 and a press, install a new bearing.
d. Select a snap ring that will allow minimum axial play.
Mark A: 2.10-2.15 mm (0.0827-0.0846 inch) Mark B: 2.15-2.20 mm (0.0846-0.0866 inch) Mark C:
2.20-2.25 mm (0.0866-0.0886 inch) Mark D: 2.25-2.30 mm (0.0886-0.0906 inch) Mark E: 2.30-2.35
mm (0.0906-0.0925 inch) Mark F: 2.35-2.40 mm (0.0925-0.0945 inch) Mark G: 2.40-2.45 mm
(0.0945-0.0965 inch)
e. Using a snap ring expander, install the snap ring.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2858
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The crankshaft position sensor, which detects the engine speed and crankshaft angle signal (NE
signal), has been installed on the oil pump body. The NE signal plate has 34 teeth. The NE signal
sensor generates 34 signals for every engine revolution. The ECM detects the standard crankshaft
angle based on the G signals and the actual crankshaft angle and the engine speed by the NE
signals.
Page 973
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Window Switch
INSPECT POWER WINDOW SWITCH CONTINUITY
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
Page 1142
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
A/T Fluid
Type .....................................................................................................................................................
.................................. DEXRON II or DEXRON III
Page 76
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 2104
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 837
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Specifications
Output Shaft: Specifications
Rear Output Shaft Assembly
Drive Sprocket Thrust Clearance
Standard
..............................................................................................................................................................
0.10-0.25 mm (0.0039-0.0098 inch) Maximum ....................................................................................
............................................................................................ 0.25 mm (0.0098 inch)
Rear Output Shaft Journal Surface (Minimum)
Part A ...................................................................................................................................................
.................................. 27.98 mm (1.1016 inch) Part B .........................................................................
............................................................................................................ 36.98 mm (1.4561 inch)
Drive Sprocket Radial Clearance
Standard
..........................................................................................................................................................
0.010-0.055 mm (0.0004-0.0022 inch) Maximum ................................................................................
............................................................................................... 0.055 mm (0.0022 inch)
Front Drive Shift Fork To Clutch Sleeve Clearance:
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
........................................ 1.0 mm (0.039 inch)
High and Low Shift Fork To Sleeve Clearance:
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
........................................ 1.0 mm (0.039 inch)
Page 3075
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 2960
CHART 30
Page 892
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 4485
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Front
Front Speed Sensor Components
REMOVAL
1. Remove speed sensor.
Disconnect Speed Sensor Connector
(a) Disconnect the speed sensor connector. (b) Remove the 2 clamp bolts holding the sensor
harness from the steering knuckle, upper arm and side rail.
Remove Clamp Bolts
(c) Remove the speed sensor installation bolt from the steering knuckle.
Torque: 8.0 Nm (82 kg.cm 71 inch lbs.)
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. After installation, check speed sensor signal.
CAUTION: Make sure that:
Page 3911
Shift Indicator: Description and Operation
Previous automatic transmissions have selected each gear shift using mechanically controlled
throttle hydraulic pressure, governor hydraulic pressure and lock-up hydraulic pressure. The
Electronically Controlled Transmission, however, electrically controls the governor pressure and
lock-up pressure through the solenoid valve. Control of the solenoid valve by the Engine Control
Module based on the input signals from each sensor makes smooth driving possible by shift
selection for each gear which is most appropriate to the driving conditions at that time.
1. GEAR SHIFT OPERATION
During driving, the Engine Control Module selects the shift for each gear which is most appropriate
to the driving conditions, based on input signals from the Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor to
TERMINAL THW of the Engine Control Module and also the input signals to TERMINAL SP2+ of
the Engine Control Module from the Vehicle Speed Sensor devoted to the Electronically Controlled
Transmission. Current is then output to the Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid. When
shifting to 1st speed, current flows from TERMINAL S1 of the Engine Control Module -->
TERMINAL 1 of the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid --> GROUND, and continuity
to the No.1 solenoid causes the shift.
For 2nd speed, current flows from TERMINAL S1 of the Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 1 of
the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid --> GROUND, and from TERMINAL S2 of the
Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 2 of the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid -->
GROUND. and continuity to Solenoid No.1 and No.2 causes the shift.
For 3rd speed. there is no continuity to No.1 solenoid, only to No.2 causing the shift. Shifting into
4th speed (Overdrive) takes place when there is no continuity to either No.1 or No.2 Solenoid.
2. LOCK-UP OPERATION
When the Engine Control Module judges from each signal that lock-up operation conditions have
been met, current flows from TERMINAL SL of the Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 3 of the
Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid --> GROUND, causing continuity to the lock-up
solenoid and causing lock-up operation.
3. STOP LIGHT SW CIRCUIT
If the brake pedal is depressed (Stop Light SW ON) when driving in lock-up condition, a signal is
input to TERMINAL BK of the Engine Control Module, the Engine Control Module operates and
continuity to the lock-up solenoid is cut.
4. OVERDRIVE CIRCUIT
^ O/D Main SW ON When the O/D main SW is turned ON, a signal is input to TERMINAL OD2 of
the Engine Control Module and Engine Control Module operation causes gear shift when the
conditions for overdrive are met.
^ O/D Main SW OFF When the O/D main SW is turned to OFF, the current flowing through the O/D
OFF indicator light flows through the O/D main SW to GROUND, causing the indicator light to light
up. At the same time, a signal is input to TERMINAL OD2 of the Engine Control Module and
Engine Control Module operation prevents shift into overdrive.
5. A/T OIL TEMP. WARNING
When the A/T Oil Temp. Sensor affixed to the transmission case detects that the fluid temp. is
150°C (302°F) or more, the Engine Control Module operates and the current flowing through the
GAUGE fuse flows to the A/T Oil Temp. warning light --> TERMINAL OIL-W of the Engine Control
Module --> Ground, so that the warning light lights up, informing that the Oil Temp. is high. When
the Oil Temp. drops to 120°C (248°F) or less, the Engine Control Module stops operating and the
warning light goes out.
Testing and Inspection
Hazard Warning Switch: Testing and Inspection
HAZARD WARNING SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT SWITCH CONTINUITY
Reference
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Page 352
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 2188
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER INSPECTION
1. INSPECT MAF METER RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals THA and E2.
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the MAF meter.
2. INSPECT MAF METER OPERATION
(a) Connect the MAF meter connector.
(b) Using a voltmeter, connect the positive (+) tester probe to terminal VG and negative (-) tester
probe to terminal E3. (c) Blow air into the MAF meter and check that the voltage fluctuates.
If operation is not as specified. replace the MAF meter.
(d) Disconnect the MAF meter connector.
Service and Repair
Solenoid: Service and Repair
1. Remove A.D.D. switch. 2. Remove sleeve fork pin.
a. Using a hexagon wrench, remove the screw plug. b. Using a pin punch and a hammer, remove
the pin through the hole of clutch case cover.
3. Separate actuator from clutch case cover and remove sleeve fork. Using a hexagon wrench,
remove the screw plug.
b. Remove the spring seat, spring and steel ball. c. Remove the 2 bolts and actuator from the
clutch case cover. d. Separate the actuator from the clutch case cover and remove the sleeve fork.
e. Remove the O-ring from the actuator.
4. Install sleeve fork and actuator into clutch case cover.
a. Install a new O-ring to the actuator. b. Coat the O-ring with MP grease. c. Place the sleeve fork
and install the actuator to the clutch case cover. d. Torque the 2 bolts.
Torque to 21 Nm (15 ft. lbs.)
e. Install the steel ball, spring and spring seat. f.
Coat the threads of screw plug with FIPG.
FIPG: Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281, or equivalent.
g. Using a hexagon wrench, install the screw plug.
Torque to 13 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
5. Install sleeve fork pin.
a. Using a pin punch and a hammer, install the pin through the hole of clutch case cover. b. Coat
the threads of screw plug with FIPG: Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281, or equivalent. c.
Using a hexagon wrench, install the screw plug.
Torque to 20 Nm (14 ft. lbs.)
6. Install A.D.D. switch. Install a new gasket and indicator switch.
Torque to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
Brakes - Pad Clicking Noise
Brake Pad: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Pad Clicking Noise
BRAKES BR004-00
October 20, 2000
Title: BRAKE PAD CLICKING NOISE
Models: '90- '00 All Models
Introduction A clicking type noise may be noticed when first applying the brakes after changing
vehicle travel direction (Drive/Forward to Reverse, Reverse to Drive/Forward). This is a normal
noise caused by the required brake pad-to-caliper clearances. When the direction of travel is
changed, the brake pads may "shift" towards the new direction of travel. When the brake pad
contacts the caliper, a clicking noise may be heard.
To minimize this clicking noise, a disc brake caliper grease has been made available for use during
brake service/maintenance operations. Under normal usage conditions this grease should be
effective for a period of 6 months to 1 year.
Applicable Vehicles ^
1990 - 2000 model year Toyota vehicles, all models.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Application Procedure There are two types of brake calipers: floating and fixed. Check the type of
brake caliper installed on the vehicle by removing the wheel assembly.
1. Floating Type Brake Caliper
A. Lift up or remove the brake caliper and suspend it securely.
HINT:
Do not disconnect the flexible hose from the brake caliper.
B. If equipped with anti-squeal spring: Remove the anti-squeal springs.
C. Remove the brake pads with anti-squeal shims.
D. Remove the pad support plates from the torque plate. Clean any dust from the pad support
plates, torque plates and brake pads.
Page 3860
Overdrive Direct Clutch
Page 2897
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 1067
05010, Center Bolt 150 # 09553 - 05020, Claw No. 1 # 09554 - 05010) or equivalents and service
bolt to remove the crankshaft timing pulley.
Page 4490
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 886
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 2220
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 1904
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2678
CHART 21
Page 708
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 2039
CHART 2
CHART 3
CHART 4
Page 873
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR REMOVAL
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the crankshaft position sensor connector. (b) Remove the bolt crankshaft position
sensor.
Torque: 7.8 N.m (80 kgf.cm, 69 in.lbf)
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Electrical Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Resistance Cold Resistance Hot
835 - 1,400 ohms at 14 - 122 deg F 1,060 - 1,645 ohms at 122 - 212 deg F
Page 2227
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 1755
Catalytic Converter: Description and Operation
View: Typical Catalytic Converter
View: Typical Catalytic Converter
Catalytic converters are used to convert carbon monoxide (CO), hydrocarbon (HC) and oxides of
nitrogen (NOx) into water vapor (H2O), carbon dioxide (CO2) and nitrogen (N2). The catalysts
used to create these conversions are platinum, palladium and rhodium (depending on type of
converter).
During engine operation, all of the exhaust gases flow through the converter where a chemical
change takes place. This change causes the temperature inside the converter to be higher than the
temperature of the exhaust gases when they leave the engine. Due to this increase in heat the
converter is insulated so that its outside temperature is about the same temperature as the muffler.
However, due to its solid mass, the converter remains hot much longer than the muffler. The body
of the catalytic converter is made of stainless steel designed to last the life of the vehicle. Catalytic
converters maybe of the monolith or pellet type.
Although all vehicles with a catalytic converter must use unleaded fuel, small amounts of leaded
fuel can be used in case of an emergency. To prevent adding leaded fuel, the fuel tank filler nozzle
has a built-in restrictor.
The conventional Oxidizing Catalytic (OC) converter, uses platinum and palladium, included as a
fine coating on the substrate, to reduce harmful exhaust fumes.
The Three-Way Catalytic (TWC) converter, contains platinum and palladium as conventional
oxidizing agents in addition to rhodium.
The Warm-Up (WU) converter, is installed in the exhaust system ahead of the main converter. This
converter operates on the same principle as the main converter, but it reacts more rapidly to
incoming gases. It is especially effective in converting gases immediately after start up.
Page 514
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4602
Page 526
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR REMOVAL
1. REMOVE NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER 2. REMOVE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the camshaft position sensor connector.
(b) Remove the bolts and camshaft position sensor.
Torque: 7.8 N.m (80 kgf.cm, 69 in.lbf)
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 1270
- Right Side Cylinder Head Intake Camshaft
- Right Side Cylinder Head Exhaust Camshaft
- Left Side Cylinder Head Intake Camshaft
- Left Side Cylinder Head Exhaust Camshaft
Page 1610
Adjusting Shim Selection Chart (Intake)
Page 2753
Step 7
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Page 4828
^ Type "A": Has a projection on the upper and lower side of the brake pad. (See illustration.)
^ Type "B": Has a flat upper and lower edge on the brake pad backing plate.
Type "A" Brake Pad
A. Remove the anti-squeal spring, clip and pad guide pin.
B. Remove the brake pads with the anti-squeal shims.
C. Clean any dust from the brake pads.
D. Apply a small amount of the disc brake caliper grease (1-2 mm thick) to the areas indicated in
the illustration.
NOTE:
Do NOT apply grease to the friction surfaces of the brake pads or the disc rotor.
E. Install the brake pads with the anti-squeal shims.
NOTE:
Clean excess grease from the brake pads and caliper.
F. Install the pad guide pin, clip and anti-squeal spring.
G. Install the wheel assembly.
Page 2101
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 1841
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 4001
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2080
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 1542
05010, Center Bolt 150 # 09553 - 05020, Claw No. 1 # 09554 - 05010) or equivalents and service
bolt to remove the crankshaft timing pulley.
Page 2410
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3303
(b) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between terminals +B and FP.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
3. REINSTALL CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
Description and Operation
Acceleration/Deceleration Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This sensor detects deceleration on the vehicle. The sensor signal is used in Anti-Lock Brake
System (ABS) control. If the sensor functions abnormally, the ABS warning light comes on but the
ABS still operates.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2008
Page 1280
Using a vernier caliper, measure the free distance between the spring end. Free distance: 18.2 18.8 mm (0.712 - 0.740 inch) If the free distance is not as specified, replace the gear spring.
5. Inspect camshaft journal oil clearance.
(a) Clean the bearing caps and camshaft journals.
(b) Place the camshafts on the cylinder head.
(c) Lay a strip of Plastigage across each of the camshaft journals.
(d) Install the bearing caps.
Torque: 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
CAUTION: Do not turn the camshaft.
(e) Remove the bearing caps.
(f) Measure the Plastigage at its widest point. Standard oil clearance: 0.035 - 0.072 mm (0.0014 0.0028 inch) Maximum oil clearance: 0.10 mm (0.0039 inch) If the oil clearance is greater than the
maximum, replace the camshaft. If necessary, replace the bearing caps and cylinder head as a set.
(g) Completely remove the Plastigage.
6. Inspect camshaft thrust clearance.
(a) Install the camshafts.
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance while moving the camshaft back and forth.
Standard thrust clearance: 0.033 - 0.080 mm (0.0013 - 0.0031 inch) Maximum thrust clearance:
0.12 mm (0.0047 inch) If the thrust clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the camshaft. If
necessary, replace the bearing caps and cylinder head as a set.
7. Inspect camshaft gear backlash.
(a) Install the camshafts without installing the exhaust camshaft sub-gear.
Page 3349
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Component Inspection
IAC VALVE INSPECTION
INSPECT IAC VALVE OPERATION
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal +B and negative (-) lead to terminal
RSO and check that the valve is closed.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal +B and negative (-) lead to terminal
RSO and check that the valve is open.
If operation is not as specified, replace the IAC valve.
On-Vehicle Inspection
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1. INSPECT IAC VALVE OPERATION
(a) Initial conditions:
- Engine at normal operating temperature
- Idle speed checked correctly
- Transmission in neutral position
- A/C switch OFF
(b) Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the DLC1. SST 09843-18020 (c) After engine
speed is kept at approx. 1000 rpm for 5 seconds, check that it returns to idle speed.
If the engine speed operation is not as specified, check the IAC valve, wiring and ECM.
(d) Remove the SST from the DLC1. SST 09843-18020
2. INSPECT IAC VALVE RESISTANCE
NOTICE: Cold and Hot in the following sentences express the temperature of the coils themselves.
Cold is from - 10°C (14°F) to 50°C (122°F)
Testing and Inspection
Door Switch: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT DOOR COURTESY SWITCH CONTINUITY
1. Check that there is no continuity between terminal and the switch body in the ON position
(switch pin released/opened door). 2. Check that there is continuity between terminal and the
switch body in the OFF position (switch pin pushed in/closed door).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
Page 221
B. Inspect relay operation
a. Apply battery voltage across terminals 1 and 2. b. Check that there is continuity between
terminals 3 and 5.
If operation is not as described, replace the relay.
3. REINSTALL STARTER RELAY
Page 634
Applicable Vehicles
Page 4403
Fluid - M/T: Fluid Type Specifications
M/T Fluid
Grade ...................................................................................................................................................
................................................................... API GL-5
Viscosity ..............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................. SAE 75W-90
Page 1377
- Using SST, tighten the flare nut to specified torque. (SST 09631-22020)
HINT: Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 30 cm (11.81 in.).
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf) Torque for using SST: 28 N.m (285 kgf.cm, 21 ft.lbf)
NOTICE: Do not rotate the fuel pipe, when tightening the flare nut.
Page 1740
Thermostat: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: The thermostat is numbered according to the valve opening temperature.
(a) Immerse the thermostat in water and gradually heat the water.
(b) Check the valve opening temperature and valve lift.
Valve opening temperature: 80° - 84° C (176° -183° F) Valve lift: At 95° C (203° F): 8.5 mm (0.335
inch) or more. If the valve opening temperature and valve lift are not within specifications, replace
the thermostat.
(c) Check that the valve is fully closed when the thermostat is at low temperatures (below 40° C
(104° F)). If not tight, replace the thermostat.
Page 556
Page 2359
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
MAF Meter to Air Cleaner Cap 61 in.lb
Page 3006
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The throttle position sensor is mounted in the throttle body and detects the throttle valve opening
angle. When the throttle valve is fully closed, a voltage of approximately 0.7 V is applied to terminal
VTA of the ECM. The voltage applied to the terminals VTA of the ECM increases in proportion to
the opening angle of the throttle valve and becomes approximately 2.7 ~ 5.2 V when the throttle
valve is fully opened. The ECM judges the vehicle driving conditions from these signals input from
terminals VTA and uses them as one of the conditions for deciding the air-fuel ratio correction,
power increase correction and fuel-cut control etc.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Knock Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 3047
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
ON-VEHICLE REPAIR
1 DISCONNECT NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
2. REMOVE NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
a. Remove the bolt and No.1 vehicle speed sensor assembly. b. Remove the speedometer driven
gear and O-ring from the No.1 vehicle speed sensor.
3. INSTALL NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
a. Coat a new O-ring with ATF. b. Install the O-ring and speedometer driven gear to the No.1
vehicle speed sensor. c. Install the No.1 vehicle speed sensor to the extension housing and torque
the bolt.
Torque: 16 Nm (160 kgf-cm, 12 ft. lbs.)
4. CONNECT NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR 5. DISCONNECT NO.2 VEHICLE
SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
6. REMOVE NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
a. Remove the bolt and No.2 vehicle speed sensor. b. Remove the O-ring from the No.2 vehicle
speed sensor.
7. INSTALL NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
a. Coat a new O-ring with ATF and install it to the No.2 vehicle speed sensor. b. Install the No.2
vehicle speed sensor and torque the bolt.
Page 3248
- Using SST, tighten the flare nut to specified torque. (SST 09631-22020)
HINT: Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 30 cm (11.81 in.).
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf) Torque for using SST: 28 N.m (285 kgf.cm, 21 ft.lbf)
NOTICE: Do not rotate the fuel pipe, when tightening the flare nut.
Page 2024
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Bank 1/Bank 2 O2 Sensor
identification
ENGINE EG034-07
Title: ENGINE BANK 1 AND BANK 2 A/F AND O2 IDENTIFICATION
Models: '93 - '08 Applicable Models
June 28, 2007
The information contained in this TSB supercedes TSB No. EG037-04. TSB No. EG037-04 is now
obsolete and should be discarded.
Introduction
This service bulletin provides information on the proper identification of engine bank 1 and engine
bank 2 for correct A/F sensor and oxygen sensor replacement.
This bulletin contains information that identifies engine bank 1 and engine bank 2 on the following
engines: 1AZ-FE, 2AZ-FE, 2AZ-FE (PZEV), 1GR-FE, 2GR-FE, 2GR-FSE, 2JZ-GE, 1MZ-FE,
3MZ-FE, 1UR-FSE, 3UR-FE, 2UZ-FE, 3UZ-FE, 5VZ-FE, and 1ZZ-FE.
^ Bank 1 (B1) refers to the bank that includes cylinder No. 1.
^ Bank 2 (B2) refers to the bank opposite bank 1.
^ Sensor 1 (S1) refers to the sensor that is located before the catalytic converters.
^ Sensor 2 (S2) refers to the sensor that is located after the catalytic converters.
Warranty Information
Page 333
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 857
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Locations
Headlamp Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 355
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 1517
5. Select a new guide bushing (STD size or O/S 0.05).
If the bushing bore diameter of the cylinder head is greater than 11.027 mm (0.4341 inch), machine
the bushing bore to these dimensions: 11.050 - 11.077 mm (0.4350 - 0.4361 inch) If the bushing
bore diameter of the cylinder head is greater than 11.077 mm (0.4361 inch), replace the cylinder
head.
6. Gradually heat the cylinder head to 80° - 100° C (176° - 212° F).
7. Using SST Valve Guide Bushing Remover & Replacer Set # 09201 - 10000 (Valve Guide
Bushing Remover & Replacer 6 # 09201 - 01060),
Handle Set # 09950 - 70010 (Handle 150 # 09951 - 07150) or equivalents and a hammer, tap in a
new guide bushing until the snap ring makes contact with the cylinder head.
8. Using a sharp 6 mm reamer, ream the guide bushing to obtain the standard specified clearance
between the guide bushing and valve stem.
Page 4461
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Electrical Specifications
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Measure Terminals THA - E2 10 - 20 K ohms at -4 deg F
4 - 7 K ohms at 32 deg F
2 - 3 K ohms at 68 deg F
0.9 - 1.3 K ohms at 104 deg F
0.4 - 0.7 K ohms at 140 deg F
0.2 - 0.4 K ohms at 176 deg F
Page 1905
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 872
Page 310
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 3016
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 1974
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 4271
The design of the rear axle seal has been changed from a flat face to an angled face for part
number 90310-50006 and part number 90310-56002.
Installation Procedure
Sequoia
To properly install Rear Axle Oil Seal part number 90310-56002, use the following SSTs and a
hammer to install the new oil seal:
^ SST P/N 09950-60020-01 (09951-00730-01) - Replacer 73
^ SST P/N 09951-70010-01 (09951-07150-01) - Handle
Tacoma & Tundra
To properly install Rear Axle Oil Seal part number 90310-56006, use the following SSTs and a
hammer to install the new oil seal:
^ SST P/N 09950-60020-01 (09951-00710) - Replacer 71
^ SST P/N 09951-70010-01 (09951-07150-01) - Handle
Page 4717
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 2891
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2057
CHART 24
Page 2123
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 512
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2824
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Locations
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor Location
Page 4197
Fluid - Differential: Fluid Type Specifications
Front Differential
TYPE....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ GL-5* CAPACITY Front ..............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. 1.1L (2.3 pints) With A.D.D [1] ..........................................................................................................
.................................................................................... 1.2L (2.4 pints) VISCOSITY Below -18° C (0°
F) .........................................................................................................................................................
............................... 80W, 80W-90 Above -18° C (0° F) ......................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... 90 With A.D.D
..............................................................................................................................................................
................................................. 75W-90
[1] Automatic Disconnecting Differential
Oil Type and Viscosity
Differential
Type .....................................................................................................................................................
......................................................... Hypoid gear oil Grade ................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... API
GL-5
Viscosity:
Front (w/ADD) ......................................................................................................................................
........................................................... SAE 75W-90
Front (without ADD) Above 0° F (-18° C) ............................................................................................
....................................................................................................... SAE 90 Below 0° F (18° C) .........
..............................................................................................................................................................
....... SAE 80W or 80W-90
Rear Above 0° F (-18° C) ....................................................................................................................
............................................................................... SAE 90 Below 0° F (18° C) .................................
............................................................................................................................................. SAE 80W
or 80W-90
Special Service Materials
w/ Differential Lock: Shaft Retainer X Differential Carrier ....................................................................
............................................................................................................. [1] Actuator x Differential
Carrier ..................................................................................................................................................
........................................ [1] Shift Fork Shaft Set Bolt ........................................................................
........................................................................................................................... [2] Pinion Shaft Pin ..
..............................................................................................................................................................
................................................. [2] Shaft Retainer Bolt .......................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [3] Screw Plug
..............................................................................................................................................................
........................................................... [3] w/o Differential Lock: Ring Gear Set Bolts .........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................... [4]
[1]: Part No. 08826-00090; Seal Packing 1281, THREE BOND 1281 FIPG, or equivalent. [2]: Part
No. 08833-00070; Adhesive 1324, THREE BOND 1324, or equivalent. [3]: Part No. 08833-00080;
Adhesive 1344, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE 242, or equivalent [4]: Part No. 08833-00100:
THREE BOND 1360K, or equivalent
Page 4852
(b) Press in the pistons with a monkey wrench handle or equivalent.
NOTE: Tape the monkey wrench handle before use.
- Always change the pad on one wheel at a time as there is a possibility of the opposite piston
flying out.
- If the piston is difficult to push in, loosen the bleeder plug and push in the piston while letting
some brake fluid escape.
(c) Install the 4 anti-squeal shims to new pads.
NOTE: Apply disc brake grease to both sides of the inner anti-squeal shims, see EXPLODED
VIEW of system.
(d) Install the 2 pads.
CAUTION: There should be no oil or grease adhering to the friction surfaces of the pads or the
disc.
5. Install anti-rattle spring and 2 pins. 6. Install clip. 7. Install front wheel. 8. Check that fluid level is
at max line.
Page 332
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 1959
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 3869
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
A/T Fluid
Type .....................................................................................................................................................
.................................. DEXRON II or DEXRON III
Page 2507
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3741
operation causes gear shift when the conditions for overdrive are met.
^ O/D Main SW OFF When the O/D main SW is turned to OFF, the current flowing through the O/D
OFF indicator light flows through the O/D main SW to GROUND, causing the indicator light to light
up. At the same time, a signal is input to TERMINAL OD2 of the Engine Control Module and
Engine Control Module operation prevents shift into overdrive.
5. A/T OIL TEMP. WARNING
When the A/T Oil Temp. Sensor affixed to the transmission case detects that the fluid temp. is
150°C (302°F) or more, the Engine Control Module operates and the current flowing through the
GAUGE fuse flows to the A/T Oil Temp. warning light --> TERMINAL OIL-W of the Engine Control
Module --> Ground, so that the warning light lights up, informing that the Oil Temp. is high. When
the Oil Temp. drops to 120°C (248°F) or less, the Engine Control Module stops operating and the
warning light goes out.
Page 3964
Torque: 5.4 Nm (55 kgf-cm, 48 inch lbs.)
8. CONNECT NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
Page 3345
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The rotary solenoid type IAC valve is located in front of the intake air chamber and intake air
bypassing the throttle valve is directed to the IAC valve through a passage. In this way the intake
air volume bypassing the throttle valve is regulated, controlling the engine speed. The ECM
operates only the IAC valve to perform idle-up and provide feedback for the target idling speed and
a VSV for idle up control is also added (for air conditioning).
Page 3709
Spark Plug: Specifications Torque Specification
Spark Plug x Cylinder Head ................................................................................................................
......................................................................... 18 Nm
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Camshaft Position Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSPECTION
NOTICE: "Cold" and "Hot" in these sentences express the temperature of the sensors themselves.
"Cold" is from -10°C (14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
1. DISCONNECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR CONNECTOR
2. INSPECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals.
Resistance:
Cold: 835 - 1,400 Ohms Hot: 1,060 - 1,645 Ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the camshaft position sensor.
3. RECONNECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR CONNECTOR
Page 3536
Page 3019
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2620
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 65
Inspection Procedure / ECU Power Source Circuit (1 Of 3)
Inspection Procedure / ECU Power Source Circuit (2 Of 3)
Diagram Information and Instructions
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 816
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Specifications
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Knock Sensor to Cylinder Block 29 ft.lb
Page 2732
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2672
CHART 14
Page 4348
Locations-J/B No.3 Behind The Instrument Panel Center (Fig 22)
Parts Location
Parts Location
Service and Repair
Oil Filter: Service and Repair
WARNING:
- Prolonged and repeated contact with mineral oil will result in the removal of natural fats from the
skin, leading to dryness, irritation and dermatitis. In addition, used engine oil contains potentially
harmful contaminants which may cause skin cancer.
- Care should be taken, therefore, when changing engine oil to minimize the frequency and length
of time your skin is exposed to used engine oil. Protective clothing and gloves, that cannot be
penetrated by oil, should be worn. Wash your skin thoroughly with soap and water, or use
waterless hand cleaner, to remove any used engine oil. Do not use gasoline, thinners, or solvents.
CAUTION:
- In order to preserve the environment, used oil and used oil filters must be disposed of only at
designated disposal sites.
1. Drain engine oil.
(a) Remove the oil filler cap.
(b) Remove the oil drain plug and drain the oil into a container.
2. Replace oil filter.
(a) Using Special Service Tool (SST) Oil Filter Wrench # 09228 - 07501 or equivalent, remove the
oil filter.
(b) Clean the oil filter contact surface on the oil filter mounting. (c)
Lubricate the filter rubber gasket with clean engine oil.
(d) Tighten the oil filter by hand until the rubber gasket contacts the seat of the filter mounting.
(e) Then using SST Oil Filter Wrench # 09228 - 07501 or equivalent, tighten it an additional 3/4 turn
to seat the filter.
3. Fill with engine oil.
(a) Clean and install the oil drain plug with a new gasket. Torque: 39 Nm (29 ft. lbs.)
(b) Fill with new engine oil.
Page 294
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
A/T - Chatter When Shifted From R to P/N
Valve Body: Customer Interest A/T - Chatter When Shifted From R to P/N
TRANSMISSION & CLUTCH TC001-98
FEBRUARY 13, 1998
TITLE: A340E, A343F "R" TO "P/N" CHATTER
MODELS: '97-'98 TACOMA, 4RUNNER, T-100 & LAND CRUISER
Introduction
Some Tacoma, 4Runner, T-100 and Land Cruisers with A340E, A340F or A343F automatic
transmissions may produce a chatter noise when shifted out of Reverse into either Neutral or Park.
To prevent this noise, a check ball has been added to the valve body as indicated in the illustration.
Affected Vehicles 1997-98 model year Tacoma, 4Runner, T-100 and Land Cruiser with A340E, A340F or A343F
automatic transmissions with serial numbers from 97H*-00001 through 97K*-99999.
Parts Information
OLD PART NUMBER NEW PART NUMBER PART NAME 35495-22020
Same Ball, Check, No. 1
35433-30064 Same Valve Body Gasket No. 1
35434-30076 Same Valve Body Gasket No. 2
Warranty Information
Applicable Warranty: This repair Is covered under the Toyota Powertrain Warranty. This warranty is
in effect for 60 months or 60,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in service date.
Repair Procedure
1. Disassembly:
A. Remove valve body as described in the Repair Manual for the vehicle being serviced. B. Turn
over and remove 25 bolts.
Page 2944
CHART 20
Page 3037
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Vehicle - Towing Guide.
Towing Information: Technical Service Bulletins Vehicle - Towing Guide.
BULLETIN NUMBER: AX001-00
DATE: March 17, 2000
TITLE: TOYOTA "DINGHY" TOWING GUIDE
MODELS: All Models
INTRODUCTION The chart on the next page indicates which Toyota vehicles can be Dinghy towed
(towed with four wheels on the ground) behind a Motorhome
CAUTION: Dinghy towing a vehicle behind a Motorhome requires special towing equipment and
accessories. Please see your Motorhome Manufacturer/Service Outlet for recommended towing
equipment.
Warranty Information
WARRANTY INFORMATION
APPLICABLE VEHICLES
Page 3579
Knock Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 905
8. REMOVE KNOCK SENSORS
Using SST. remove the knock sensor. SST 09817-16011
KNOCK SENSOR INSTALLATION
1. REINSTALL KNOCK SENSORS
Using SST, install the knock sensor. SST 09817-16011
Torque: 39 N.m (400 kgf.cm. 29 ft.lbf)
2. REINSTALL WATER BYPASS PIPE AND KNOCK SENSOR WIRE 3. REINSTALL INTAKE
MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY 4. REINSTALL FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR 5. REINSTALL
HIGH-TENSION CORDS WITH IGNITION COILS 6. REINSTALL INTAKE AIR CONNECTOR 7.
REINSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE 8. REFILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT 9. RECHECK ENGINE
COOLANT LEVEL
Page 3103
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Service and Repair
Solenoid: Service and Repair
1. Remove A.D.D. switch. 2. Remove sleeve fork pin.
a. Using a hexagon wrench, remove the screw plug. b. Using a pin punch and a hammer, remove
the pin through the hole of clutch case cover.
3. Separate actuator from clutch case cover and remove sleeve fork. Using a hexagon wrench,
remove the screw plug.
b. Remove the spring seat, spring and steel ball. c. Remove the 2 bolts and actuator from the
clutch case cover. d. Separate the actuator from the clutch case cover and remove the sleeve fork.
e. Remove the O-ring from the actuator.
4. Install sleeve fork and actuator into clutch case cover.
a. Install a new O-ring to the actuator. b. Coat the O-ring with MP grease. c. Place the sleeve fork
and install the actuator to the clutch case cover. d. Torque the 2 bolts.
Torque to 21 Nm (15 ft. lbs.)
e. Install the steel ball, spring and spring seat. f.
Coat the threads of screw plug with FIPG.
FIPG: Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281, or equivalent.
g. Using a hexagon wrench, install the screw plug.
Torque to 13 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
5. Install sleeve fork pin.
a. Using a pin punch and a hammer, install the pin through the hole of clutch case cover. b. Coat
the threads of screw plug with FIPG: Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281, or equivalent. c.
Using a hexagon wrench, install the screw plug.
Torque to 20 Nm (14 ft. lbs.)
6. Install A.D.D. switch. Install a new gasket and indicator switch.
Torque to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
Page 3203
Idle Speed: Adjustments
1. Initial conditions.
(a) Engine coolant at normal operating temperature.
(b) Air cleaner installed. (c)
All pipes and hoses of air induction system connected.
(d) All accessories switched OFF. (e)
All vacuum lines properly connected.
NOTE: All vacuum hoses for Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) systems, etc. should be properly
connected.
(f) Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection (SFI) system wiring connectors fully plugged.
(g) Ignition timing set correctly. (h) Transmission in neutral position. (i)
A/C switch is OFF.
2. Connect TOYOTA hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool or equivalent. 3. Inspect idle speed.
(a) Race the engine speed at 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
(b) Check the idle speed.
Idle speed: 700 +/- 50 rpm
NOTE: If the idle speed is not as specified, check the Idle Air Control (IAC) valve and air intake
system.
4. Disconnect TOYOTA hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool or equivalent.
Page 436
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 2440
Page 1720
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2783
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER INSPECTION
1. INSPECT MAF METER RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals THA and E2.
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the MAF meter.
2. INSPECT MAF METER OPERATION
(a) Connect the MAF meter connector.
(b) Using a voltmeter, connect the positive (+) tester probe to terminal VG and negative (-) tester
probe to terminal E3. (c) Blow air into the MAF meter and check that the voltage fluctuates.
If operation is not as specified. replace the MAF meter.
(d) Disconnect the MAF meter connector.
Page 4002
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Specifications
Drain Plug: Specifications
Drain Plug ............................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 37 N.m (27 ft. lbs.)
Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Locations
Automatic Differential Disconnect (A.D.D.) Component Locations
Page 1939
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A thermistor built into the engine coolant temperature sensor changes the resistance value
according to the engine coolant temperature. The structure of the sensor and connection to the
ECM is the same as in the intake air temp. circuit malfunction.
Page 2879
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Diagrams
Combination Switch
Page 1220
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 4818
2. Remove pistons from cylinder.
(a) Prepare the wooden plate to hold the pistons. (b) Place the plate between the pistons and insert
a pad at one side. (c) Use compressed air to remove the pistons alternately from the cylinder.
WARNING: Do not place your fingers in front of the piston when using compressed air.
3. Remove piston seals.
Using a screwdriver, remove the 4 piston seals from the cylinder.
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.
NOTE: Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to the parts indicated by arrows in EXPLODED
VIEW.
Pressure Specification
Fuel Pressure: Specifications Fuel System Pressure
Fuel System Pressure
Idle Pressure - No Vacuum 38 to 44 PSI psi
Idle Pressure - With Vacuum 33-38 PSI
5 Minutes After Ignition Off 21 PSI or More
Page 3559
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 1850
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 1356
Piston Ring: Testing and Inspection
1. Insert the piston ring into the cylinder bore. 2. Using a piston, push the piston ring a little beyond
the bottom of the ring travel, 115 mm (4.53 inch) from the top of the cylinder block.
3. Using a feeler gauge, measure the end gap.
Ring end gap:
STD:
No. 1: 0.300 - 0.500 mm (0.0118 - 0.0197 inch) No. 2: 0.400 - 0.600 mm (0.0157 - 0.0236 inch) Oil
(side rail): 0.150 - 0.550 mm (0.0059 - 0.0217 inch)
Maximum:
No. 1: 1.100 mm (0.0433 inch) No. 2: 1.200 mm (0.0472 inch) Oil (side rail): 1.150 mm (0.0453
inch)
If the end gap is greater than the maximum, replace the piston ring. If the end gap is greater than
the maximum, even with a new piston ring, rebore all the 6 cylinders or replace the cylinder block.
Page 4266
HUB BOLT REPLACEMENT
1. Remove wheel and brake drum. 2. Remove hub bolt.
Using SST, 09650-17011
3. Install hub bolt.
Install a washer and nut to a new hub bolt as shown and install the hub bolt with torquing the nut.
4. Install brake drum and wheel.
Torque to 110 Nm (83 ft. lbs.)
Page 846
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR REMOVAL
1. REMOVE NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER 2. REMOVE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the camshaft position sensor connector.
(b) Remove the bolts and camshaft position sensor.
Torque: 7.8 N.m (80 kgf.cm, 69 in.lbf)
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 209
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
NOTICE:
^ Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU and various computers unless absolutely
necessary. (If the IC terminals are touched, the IC may be destroyed by static electricity.)
^ Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When replacing parts, replace with new parts.
^ Never reuse the airbag sensor assembly involved in a collision when the airbag has deployed.
^ Never repair a sensor in order to reuse it.
Wire Harness
1. REMOVE THESE PARTS:
a. Lower center cover b. ABS ECU
2. REMOVE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
a. Disconnect the connector.
NOTICE: Removal of the connector is done with the sensor assembly installed.
b. Using a torx wrench, remove the 3 screws and the airbag sensor assembly.
Torx wrench: T40 (Part No. 09042-00020 or locally manufactured tool)
3. INSTALL AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
a. Using a torx wrench, install the airbag sensor assembly with the 3 screws.
Torx wrench: T40 (Part No. 09042-00020 or locally manufactured tool) Torque: 21 N.m (210 kgf
cm, 15 ft.lbf)
b. Connect the connector.
NOTICE: ^
Installation of the connector is done with the sensor assembly installed.
^ Make sure the sensor assembly is installed to the specified torque.
^ If the sensor assembly has been dropped, or there are cracks, dents or other defects in the case,
bracket or connector, replace the sensor assembly with a new one.
^ When installing the sensor assembly, take care that the SRS wiring does not interfere with other
parts and is not pinched between other parts.
^ After installation, shake the sensor assembly to check that there is no looseness,
4. INSTALL THE REMOVED PARTS
Page 3025
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch goes on when the shift lever is in the N or P shift position. When it
goes on terminal NSW of the ECM is grounded to body ground via the starter relay, thus the
terminal NSW voltage becomes 0 V. When the shift lever is in the D, 2, L or R position, the
park/neutral position switch goes off, so the voltage of ECM, terminal NSW becomes battery
voltage, the voltage of the ECM internal power source.
If the shift lever is moved from the N position to the D position, this signal is used for air-fuel ratio
correction and for idle speed control (estimated control), etc.
Page 248
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection Door Lock Control Switch
DRIVER'S DOOR LOCK CONTROL SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT SWITCH CONTINUITY If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
PASSENGER'S DOOR LOCK CONTROL SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT SWITCH CONTINUITY If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Page 568
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 1940
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
ECT SENSOR INSPECTION
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT 2. DISCONNECT UPPER RADIATOR HOSE FROM WATER
OUTLET 3. REMOVE NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER 4. REMOVE FUEL PIPE 5. REMOVE ECT
SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the ECT sensor connector.
(b) Using a 19 mm deep socket wrench. remove the ECT sensor and gasket.
Locations
One Touch 2-4 Selector System
Page 2583
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 3744
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 1209
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 4905
2. Install Load Sensing Proportioning Valve (LSPV) gauge, Special Service Tool (SST) # 09709 29017, and bleed air.
3. Raise front brake pressure to 7,845 kPa (1,138 psi) and check rear brake fluid pressure.
Rear brake fluid pressure: 5,325 ± 490 kPa (772 ± 71 psi).
NOTE: The brake pedal should not be depressed twice and/or returned while setting to the
specified pressure. Read the value of rear pressure 2 seconds after adjusting the specified fluid
pressure. If the brake pressure is incorrect, adjust the fluid pressure.
4. If necessary, adjust fluid pressure.
(a) Adjust the length of the No.2 shackle.
Low pressure: Lengthen A. High pressure: Shorten A. Initial set: 120 mm (4.72 inch) Adjustment
range: 114 - 126 mm (4.49 - 4.96 inch)
NOTE: One turn of the nut changes the fluid pressure as shown in the following specification. 52
kPa (7.5 psi)
(b) If the pressure cannot be adjusted by the No.2 shackle, raise or lower the valve body.
Low pressure - Lower body High pressure - Raise body
(c) Torque the nuts.
Torque: 13 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
(d) Adjust the length of the No.1 shackle again. If it cannot be adjusted, inspect the valve housing.
Page 3933
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Supercharger - Squeak/Rattle Noises From Idler Pulley
Idler Pulley: Customer Interest Supercharger - Squeak/Rattle Noises From Idler Pulley
REF.: 3.4L V6 SUPERCHARGER
NO.: SC001-00
DATE: AUGUST 1, 2000
MODEL: 4Runner, Tacoma, T100, and Tundra with 3.4L V6.
SUPERCHARGER DRIVE-BELT IDLER PULLEY
Due to a possible out-of-tolerance condition on the idler pulley shaft, some pulleys may have
bearings that spin on the inner shaft and may cause a squeaking or rattling noise. The
supercharger may be perfectly fine and the source of the noise may simply be the idler pulley
PART NUMBER INFORMATION
PRODUCTION EFFECTIVE:
Supercharger Assemblies with Serial Numbers from: 10481
to: 10990
CHECK PROCEDURE:
This condition can be verified by removing the supercharger drive belt and checking the movement
of the pulley on the shaft The pulley should not slide fore and aft on the shaft.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE:
Loosen the drive belt. Remove the idler plate assembly. Retain all the hardware. Remove the idler
pulley sub-assembly from the idler plate assembly. Replace it with the supplied new idler pulley
sub-assembly. Replace the idler plate assembly and all of the hardware. The tightening torques are
shown in the table.
Reinstall and tension the drive belt to 120-ft lbs. for a new belt or 80 ft lbs. for a used belt (any belt
used for more than 10 minutes).
WARRANTY INFORMATION:* * The idler pulley assembly is warrantable only for 12 months from
the point-of-first-sale. If the supercharger assembly was dealer installed, then TRD matches the
balance of the new vehicle powertrain warranty.
Page 2875
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 1701
Radiator Cap: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove radiator cap.
WARNING: To avoid the danger of being burned, do not remove the radiator cap while the engine
and radiator are still hot, as fluid and steam can be blown out under pressure.
2. Inspect radiator cap.
NOTE: If the radiator cap contaminations, always rinse it with water.
Using a radiator cap tester, pump the tester and measure the relief valve opening pressure.
Standard opening pressure: 74 - 103 kPa (10.7 - 14.9 psi) Minimum opening pressure: 59 kPa (8.5
psi)
NOTE: Use the tester's maximum reading as the opening pressure.
If the opening pressure is less than minimum, replace the radiator cap.
3. Reinstall radiator cap.
Page 2797
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2480
Cranking Signal: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 4679
Shift Indicator: Connector Views
Electronically Controlled Transmission And A/T Indicator-Connectors
Page 3491
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 3945
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Capacity Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
A/T
Engine Coolant ....................................................................................................................................
............................................. 9.5 liters (10.0 US qts.)
M/T
Engine Coolant ....................................................................................................................................
.............................................. 9.7 liters (10.3 US qts.)
Specifications
Clutch Disc: Specifications
Disc Rivet Head Depth:
Minimum ..............................................................................................................................................
............................................. 0.3 mm (0.012 inch)
Disc Runout:
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
.............................................. 0.8 mm (0.031 inch)
Page 1096
Oil grade:
API grade SH, Energy-Conserving II multigrade engine oil or ILSAC multigrade engine oil.
Recommended viscosity is as shown in the illustration with SAE 5W-30 being the preferred engine
oil.
Oil capacity:
Drain and refill
w/ Oil filter change: 5.2 liters (5.5 US qts.)
(c) Reinstall the oil filler cap.
4. Start engine and check for oil leaks. 5. Check engine oil level.
Page 1936
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 2918
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Bank 1/Bank 2 O2 Sensor
identification
ENGINE EG034-07
Title: ENGINE BANK 1 AND BANK 2 A/F AND O2 IDENTIFICATION
Models: '93 - '08 Applicable Models
June 28, 2007
The information contained in this TSB supercedes TSB No. EG037-04. TSB No. EG037-04 is now
obsolete and should be discarded.
Introduction
This service bulletin provides information on the proper identification of engine bank 1 and engine
bank 2 for correct A/F sensor and oxygen sensor replacement.
This bulletin contains information that identifies engine bank 1 and engine bank 2 on the following
engines: 1AZ-FE, 2AZ-FE, 2AZ-FE (PZEV), 1GR-FE, 2GR-FE, 2GR-FSE, 2JZ-GE, 1MZ-FE,
3MZ-FE, 1UR-FSE, 3UR-FE, 2UZ-FE, 3UZ-FE, 5VZ-FE, and 1ZZ-FE.
^ Bank 1 (B1) refers to the bank that includes cylinder No. 1.
^ Bank 2 (B2) refers to the bank opposite bank 1.
^ Sensor 1 (S1) refers to the sensor that is located before the catalytic converters.
^ Sensor 2 (S2) refers to the sensor that is located after the catalytic converters.
Warranty Information
Page 196
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Diagram Information and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Specifications
Coolant Drain Plug: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Drain Plug To Cylinder Block ...............................................................................................................
................................................ 39 Nm (29 ft. lbs.)
Page 372
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Locations
Relay Box: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 664
CHART 23
Page 2015
8. REMOVE KNOCK SENSORS
Using SST. remove the knock sensor. SST 09817-16011
KNOCK SENSOR INSTALLATION
1. REINSTALL KNOCK SENSORS
Using SST, install the knock sensor. SST 09817-16011
Torque: 39 N.m (400 kgf.cm. 29 ft.lbf)
2. REINSTALL WATER BYPASS PIPE AND KNOCK SENSOR WIRE 3. REINSTALL INTAKE
MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY 4. REINSTALL FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR 5. REINSTALL
HIGH-TENSION CORDS WITH IGNITION COILS 6. REINSTALL INTAKE AIR CONNECTOR 7.
REINSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE 8. REFILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT 9. RECHECK ENGINE
COOLANT LEVEL
Page 185
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Specifications
Speedometer Gear: Specifications
Speedometer Driven Gear Set Bolt
................................................................................................................................................... 11.5
N.m (96 inch lbs.)
Page 2033
Page 869
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The crankshaft position sensor, which detects the engine speed and crankshaft angle signal (NE
signal), has been installed on the oil pump body. The NE signal plate has 34 teeth. The NE signal
sensor generates 34 signals for every engine revolution. The ECM detects the standard crankshaft
angle based on the G signals and the actual crankshaft angle and the engine speed by the NE
signals.
Page 4131
Differential Carrier
INSPECTION
1. Check runout of companion flange. Using a dial indicator, measure the vertical and lateral runout
of the companion flange. If the runout is greater
Page 4906
5. If necessary, check valve body.
(a) Assemble the valve body in the uppermost position.
NOTE: When the brakes are applied, the piston will move down about 0.8 mm (0.03 inch). Even at
this time, the piston should not make contact with or move the load sensing spring.
(b) In this position, check the rear brake pressure.
- With the front pressure @ 1,960 kPa (285 psi) the rear pressure should be 1,960 kPa (285 psi).
- With the front pressure @ 3,920 kPa (570 psi) the rear pressure should be 2,352 kPa ± 196 (342
± 28.5 psi).
- With the front pressure @ 6,860 kPa (997.5 psi) the rear pressure should be 2,940 kPa ± 343
(427.5 ± 50 psi).
NOTE: If the measured value is not within standard, replace the valve body.
Page 2807
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The camshaft position sensor, which detects the crankshaft angle signal (G signal), has been
installed on the front of right bank cylinder head. The timing rotor has been integrated with the right
bank camshaft timing pulley. When the camshafts rotate, the protrusion on the timing rotor and the
air gap on the pick up coil change, causing fluctuations, in the magnetic field and generating an
electromotive force in the pick up coil. The NE signal plate has 34 teeth and is mounted on the
crankshaft. The NE signal sensor generates 34 signals for every engine revolution. The ECM
detects the standard crankshaft angle based on the 6 signals and the actual crankshaft angle and
the engine speed by the NE signals.
Page 4552
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 4554
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 2534
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 1627
Coolant: Testing and Inspection
COOLANT CHECK
1. Check engine coolant level at radiator reservoir.
The engine coolant level should be between the "LOW" and "FULL" lines, when the engine is cold.
If low, check for leaks and add engine coolant up to the "FULL" line.
2. Check engine coolant quality.
(a) Remove the radiator cap from the water outlet.
WARNING: To avoid the danger of being burned, do not remove the radiator cap while the engine
and radiator are still hot, as fluid and steam can be blown out under pressure.
(b) There should not be any excessive deposits of rust or scale around the radiator cap or radiator
filler hole, and the coolant should be free from
oil. If excessively dirty, clean the coolant passages and replace the coolant.
(c) Reinstall the radiator cap.
Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Pressure:
Minimum [1] .........................................................................................................................................
........................................ 1,000 kPa (145 psi) Standard [1] ................................................................
..................................................................................................... 1,200 kPa (174 psi) or more
Pressure Difference:
Between Each Cylinder
..........................................................................................................................................................
100 kPa (15 psi) or less
[1] @ 250 rpm
Page 2178
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2758
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 3003
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 1823
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection Related Diagnostic Procedures
ECM Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the ignition switch is turned ON, battery positive voltage is applied to the coil, closing the
contacts of the EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and supplying power to the terminal +B of the ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Step 1
Step 2
Page 142
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 618
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Knock sensors are fitted one each to the right bank and left bank of the cylinder block to detect
engine knocking. This sensor contains a piezoelectric element which generates a voltage when it
becomes deformed, which occurs when the cylinder block vibrates due to knocking. If engine
knocking occurs, ignition timing is retarded to suppress it.
Page 855
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 2511
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Specifications
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Mechanical: Specifications Setting Specifications
Setting Specifications
Actuator Setting Speed 900 - 1,950 rpm
Page 3696
Components For Removal And Installation Part 2 Of 2
Page 3011
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 1406
4. Using a plastic-faced hammer, lightly tap the valve stem tip to ensure a proper fit.
Page 2246
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 683
Page 1977
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 808
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2120
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 2825
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Specifications
Clutch Fluid: Specifications
Fluid Type FMVSS No. 116 DOT 3 Brake Fluid
Page 119
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 593
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 4608
If the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the shift fork or clutch sleeve.
ASSEMBLY
1. Install front drive clutch sleeve onto drive sprocket.
a. Install the front drive clutch sleeve onto the drive sprocket.
HINT: Make sure to install the clutch sleeve in the correct direction.
b. Install the 3 shifting keys and 2 springs.
NOTICE: Install the key springs positioned so that their end gaps are not in line.
2. Install drive sprocket with front drive clutch sleeve assembly, spacer and bearing.
a. Apply gear oil to the shaft and needle roller bearing. b. Place the synchronizer ring on the spline
and align the ring slots with the shifting keys. Install the needle roller bearing in the drive sprocket.
d. Install the drive sprocket with the front drive clutch sleeve assembly.
3. Inspect drive sprocket thrust clearance.
Using a feeler gauge, measure the drive sprocket thrust clearance.
Standard Clearances. 0.10-0.25 mm (0.0039-0.0098 inch)
Page 492
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 1068
Timing Belt: Service and Repair Timing Belt Installation
1. Install crankshaft timing pulley.
(a) Align the pulley set key with the key groove of the timing pulley and slide on the timing pulley.
(b) Slide on the timing pulley, facing the flange side inward.
2. Install No. 1 idler pulley.
(a) Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, install the No. 1 idler pulley with the plate washer and bolt.
Torque: 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.)
(b) Check that the pulley bracket moves smoothly.
3. Install No. 2 idler pulley.
(a) Install the No. 2 idler pulley with the bolt. Torque: 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
(b) Check that the No. 2 idler pulley moves smoothly.
4. Install LH camshaft timing pulley.
(a) Face the flange side of the timing pulley outward.
(b) Align the knock pin on the camshaft with the knock pin groove of the timing pulley, and slide on
the timing pulley.
(c) Using Special Service Tool (SST) Variable Pin Wrench Set # 09960 - 10010 (Variable Pin
Wrench Arm Assembly # 09962 - 01000, Pin 10 # 09963 - 01000) or equivalents, install the pulley
bolt. Torque: 110 Nm (81 ft. lbs.)
5. Install RH camshaft timing pulley.
(a) Face the flange side of the timing pulley outward.
(b) Align the knock pin on the camshaft with the knock pin groove of the timing pulley, and slide on
the timing pulley.
Page 3273
Fuel Injector: Exploded Views
Components For Removal And Installtion Part 1 Of 2
Page 4664
Position Of Parts In Engine Compartment (Part 1 Of 2) (Fig 24)
Page 2248
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 2145
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4151
c. Using SST 09950-30010 (09951-03010, 09953-03010, 09954-03010, 09955-03030,
09956-03050), remove the companion flange.
2. Remove front oil seal. Using SST 09308-10010, remove the oil seal from the differential carrier.
3. Remove front bearing and bearing spacer.
a. Using SST 09556-22010, remove the bearing from the drive pinion. b. Remove the 2 washers
and bearing spacer.
4. Remove differential case.
a. Place matchmarks on the bearing cap and differential carrier. b. Remove the 4 bolts and bearing
cap.
c. Using SST 09504-22011 and a hammer, remove the 2 side bearing plate washers.
HINT: Measure the plate washer and note the thickness.
Page 314
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2796
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 937
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 4857
Brake Rotor/Disc: Adjustments
DISC RUNOUT
1. Remove the hub nuts and disc. Reinstall the disc 1/6 of a turn round from its original position on
the hub. Install and torque the hub nuts.
Remeasure the disc runout. Make a note of the runout and the disc's position on the hub.
2. Repeat (1) until the disc has been installed on the 4 remaining hub positions. 3. If the minimum
runout recorded in (1) and (2) is less than the maximum disc runout, install the disc in that position.
4. If the minimum runout recorded in (1) and (2) is greater than the maximum disc runout, replace
the disc.
Page 614
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 995
c. Turn the left and right rack ends an amount to adjust the toe-in.
HINT: Try to adjust the camber and caster to the center value.
d. Tighten the rack end lock nuts.
Torque to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.)
e. Place the boot on the seat and clip it.
HINT: Ensure that the boots are not twisted.
f. Inspect the wheel angle. Turn the steering wheel fully, and measure the turning angle. If wheel
angle deviates from the specifications, readjust the toe-in and wheel angle within the specifications.
At this time, the left-right error lengths of the tie rod end may be less than 1.5 mm (0.059 inch).
Locations
Ignition Switch
Oil Level Check
Engine Oil: Testing and Inspection Oil Level Check
1. The oil level should be between the "L" and "F" marks on the dipstick. 2. If low, check for
leakage and add oil up to the "F" mark.
Page 3442
Ohmmeter Connection
Reference
(c) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between each terminal. (d) Reconnect the sensor
connector.
3. M/T:
INSPECT DASHPOT (DP) (a) Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature. (b)
Check idle speed.
Idle speed: 700 ± 50 rpm
(c) Remove the cap, filter and separator from the DP.
(d) Maintain engine speed at 2,500 rpm or more.
(e) Plug the VTV hole with your finger. (f) Release the throttle valve. (g) Check the DP is set.
DP setting speed: 1,800 - 2,200 rpm
(h) If the setting speed is not as specified, adjust it with the DP adjusting screw. (i) Remove your
finger from the hole and check that the engine returns to idle speed in approx. 1 second. (j)
Reinstall DP separator, filter and cap.
Page 2861
Page 391
Oil Pressure Sender: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT LOW OIL PRESSURE WARNING SWITCH
1. Disconnect the connector from the switch. 2. Check that there is continuity between terminal and
ground with the engine stopped. 3. Check that there is no continuity between terminal and ground
with the engine running.
HINT: Oil pressure should be over 49 kPa (0.5 kg/Sq.cm, 7.1 psi).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
Page 2586
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 1309
Connecting Rod: Testing and Inspection Oil Clearance
1. Remove connecting rod caps and check oil clearance.
(a) Using a punch or numbering stamp, mark the connecting rod and cap to ensure correct
reassembly.
(b) Remove the connecting rod cap nuts.
(c) Using a plastic-faced hammer, lightly tap the connecting rod bolts and lift off the connecting rod
cap.
NOTE: Keep the lower bearing inserted with the connecting rod cap.
(d) Cover the connecting rod bolts with a short piece of hose to protect the crankshaft from
damage.
(e) Clean the crank pin and bearing.
(f) Check the crank pin and bearing for pitting and scratches. If the crank pin or bearing is
damaged, replace the bearings. If necessary, grind or replace the crankshaft.
(g) Lay a strip of Plastigage across the crank pin. (h) Install the connecting rod cap with the 2 nuts.
Torque:
Page 4726
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 2404
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 3035
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 2555
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 936
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2412
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Tightening Specifications
Flex Plate: Specifications Tightening Specifications
Sequence
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Drive Plate To Crankshaft: 83 N.m (61 ft. lbs.)
Page 4556
Differential: Electrical Diagrams
Rear Differential Lock (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 458
Combination Switch: Adjustments
After inspecting the Combination Switch, adjust the Spiral Cable.
Center the spiral cable and then do the following.
1. Check that the front wheels are facing straight ahead. 2. Turn the cable counterclockwise by
hand until it becomes harder to turn the cable.
3. Then rotate the cable clockwise about three turns to align the mark.
NOTE: The cable will rotate about three turns to either left or right of the center.
A/C
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection A/C
DRIVE BELT TENSION INSPECTION
1. INSPECT DRIVE BELTS INSTALLATION CONDITION
Check that the drive belt fits properly in the ribbed grooves.
2. INSPECT DRIVE BELT TENSION
Using a belt tension gauge, check the drive belt tension.
Drive belt tension:
New belt: 160 ± 25 lb Used belt: 100 ± 20 lb
HINT: "New belt" refers to a belt which has been used less than 5 minutes on a running engine.
- "Used belt" refers to a belt which has used on a running engine for 5 minutes or more.
- After installing the drive belt, check that it fits properly in the ribbed grooves.
Page 595
Page 2978
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 1820
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 2 Of 2
Page 797
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER INSPECTION
1. INSPECT MAF METER RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals THA and E2.
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the MAF meter.
2. INSPECT MAF METER OPERATION
(a) Connect the MAF meter connector.
(b) Using a voltmeter, connect the positive (+) tester probe to terminal VG and negative (-) tester
probe to terminal E3. (c) Blow air into the MAF meter and check that the voltage fluctuates.
If operation is not as specified. replace the MAF meter.
(d) Disconnect the MAF meter connector.
Page 343
Clutch Switch: Testing and Inspection
CLUTCH SWITCH CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the clutch pedal is depressed, the clutch switch sends a signal to the cruise control ECU.
When the signal is input to the cruise control ECU during cruise control driving, the cruise control
ECU cancels cruise control.
Park / Neutral Position Switch
WIRING DIAGRAM
Inspection Procedure / Clutch Switch Circuit (1 Of 4)
Locations
Relay Box: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Service Precautions
Fuel Pressure Release: Service Precautions
WARNING: Adhere to the following procedures any time the fuel system is being worked on in
order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury:
- Keep a dry chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher near the work area.
- Place a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the work area.
- Work in a well-ventilated area. Do not smoke, and keep sparks and open flames away.
- Wear eye protection.
- Use caution when working near the catalytic converter to prevent the possibility of burns or fire.
(The temperatures within the converter can exceed 537°C (1000°F).)
- Relieve the fuel system pressure prior to disconnecting fuel system components.
- Disconnect the negative battery cable except for tests where battery voltage is required.
- Use a suitable container to store or catch fuel.
- Do not replace fuel pipe with fuel hose.
- Plug all disconnected fuel line fittings and hoses.
- After making any fuel system repairs ALWAYS inspect for fuel leaks.
- If available, use system bleed (schrader) valve to relieve fuel system pressure.
Testing and Inspection
Leak Detection Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE (VSV) FOR VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR INSPECTION
1. REMOVE VSV
(a) Disconnect the connector and 3 EVAP hoses from the VSV. (b) Remove the bolt and VSV.
2. INSPECT VSV
A. Inspect VSV for open circuit
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between the terminals.
Resistance: At 20°C (68°F): 37 - 44 ohm
If there is no continuity, replace the VSV
B. Inspect VSV for ground
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between each terminal and the body. If there
is continuity, replace the VSV.
C. Inspect VSV operation
(a) Check that air flows from ports E to P and does not flow from ports E to F. (b) Apply battery
voltage across the terminals.
Page 3490
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 1064
10. w/ A/C: Disconnect A/C compressor from engine. 11. w/ A/C: Remove A/C compressor bracket.
Remove the 5 bolts and A/C compressor bracket.
12. Remove oil dipstick and guide.
Remove the bolt, oil dipstick, guide and O-ring.
13. Remove No. 2 timing belt cover.
(a) Disconnect the camshaft position sensor connector, 3 high-tension cord clamps and PS pump
hose from the No. 2 timing belt cover.
(b) Remove the 6 bolts and No. 2 timing belt cover.
14. Remove fan bracket.
(a) Remove the nut and PS pump adjusting strut.
(b) Remove the bolt, nut, and fan bracket.
15. Remove crankshaft pulley.
(a) Using Special Service Tool (SST) Crankshaft Pulley Holding Tool # 09213 - 54015 (Bolt 90119 08216) and Companion Flange Holding Tool # 09330 - 00021 or equivalents, loosen the pulley
bolt.
(b) Remove the SST, pulley bolt and pulley.
NOTE: If necessary, remove the pulley with SST Puller C Set # 09950 - 50010 (Hanger 150 #
09551 - 05010, Slide Arm # 09552 - 05010, Center Bolt 150 # 09553 - 05020, Claw No. 3 # 09554 05030) or equivalents and service bolt.
Page 3487
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Engine Controls - A/F And O2 Sensor Identification
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - A/F And O2 Sensor Identification
T-SB-0398-09
December 23, 2009
Engine Bank 1 and Bank 2 A/F and 02 Identification
Service Category Engine/Hybrid System
Section Engine Control
Market USA
Applicability
TSB SUPERSESSION NOTICE
The information contained in this TSB supersedes TSB No. EG034-07.
^ Applicability has been updated to include 2009 - 2010 model year vehicles and 2006 - 2010
model year Highlander HV.
TSB No. EG034-07 is Obsolete and any printed versions should be discarded. Be sure to review
the entire content of this service bulletin before proceeding.
Introduction
This service bulletin provides information on the proper identification of engine bank 1 and engine
bank 2 for correct A/F sensor and oxygen sensor replacement.
This bulletin contains information that identifies engine bank 1 and engine bank 2 on the following
engines: 1AZ-FE, 2AZ-FE, 2AZ-FE (PZEV), 1GR-FE, 2GR-FE, 2JZ-GE, 1MZ-FE, 3MZ-FE,
1UR-FE, 3UR-FE, 2UZ-FE 5VZ-FE and 1ZZ-FE.
^ Bank 1 (B1) refers to the bank that includes cylinder No. 1.
^ Bank 2 (B2) refers to the bank opposite bank 1.
^ Sensor 1 (S1) refers to the sensor that is located before the catalytic converters.
^ Sensor 2 (S2) refers to the sensor that is located after the catalytic converters.
Warranty Information
Page 2148
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
TMC Made
Universal Joint: Service and Repair TMC Made
REPLACEMENT
Page 3672
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR REMOVAL
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the crankshaft position sensor connector. (b) Remove the bolt crankshaft position
sensor.
Torque: 7.8 N.m (80 kgf.cm, 69 in.lbf)
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 1568
Idle Speed: Specifications
Idle Speed 700 +/- 50 rpm
Page 4046
3. TURN OVER ASSEMBLY AND REMOVE 25 BOLTS
4. LIFT OFF UPPER VALVE BODY AND PLATE AS A SINGLE UNIT
Hold the valve body plate to the upper valve body.
HINT: Be careful that the check balls and strainer do not fall out.
VALVE BODY ASSEMBLY
1. POSITION NEW NO.1 GASKET ON UPPER VALVE BODY
Align a new No.1 gasket at each bolt hole.
2. POSITION VALVE BODY PLATE ON NO.1 GASKET
Align the plate at each bolt hole.
3. POSITION NEW NO.2 GASKET ON PLATE
Align a new No.2 gasket at each bolt hole.
Electrical Specifications
Fuel Injector: Electrical Specifications Resistance
Resistance
Resistance Between Terminals 13.8 ohms
Specifications
Catalytic Converter: Specifications
TWC to Front Exhaust Pipe 46 ft.lb
TWC to Tailpipe 35 ft.lb
Page 3803
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
The No.1 vehicle speed sensor outputs a 4-pulse signal for every revolution of the rotor shaft,
which is rotated by the transmission output shaft via the driven gear.
After this signal is converted into a more precise rectangular waveform by the waveform shaping
circuit inside the combination meter, it is then transmitted to the ECM. The ECM determines the
vehicle speed based on the frequency of these pulse signals.
The No.2 vehicle speed sensor detects the rotation speed of the transmission output shaft and
sends signals to the ECM. The ECM determines the vehicle speed based on these signals.
An AC voltage is generated in the No.2 vehicle speed sensor coil as the rotor mounted on the
output shaft rotates, and this voltage is sent to the ECM.
The gear shift point and lock-up timing are controlled by the ECM based on the signals from this
vehicle speed sensor and the throttle position sensor signal.
If the No.2 vehicle speed sensor malfunctions, the ECM uses input signals from the No.1 vehicle
speed sensor as a back-up signal.
Page 3282
(d) Remove the 2 O-rings and 2 grommets from each injector.
INJECTORS INSTALLATION
1. TEMPORARILY INSTALL INJECTORS AND DELIVERY PIPES
(a) Install 2 new grommets to each injector. (b) Apply a light coat of spindle oil or gasoline to 2 new
O-rings and install them to each injector.
(c) While turning the injector clockwise and counter clockwise. push it to the delivery pipes. Install
the 6 injectors. (d) Position the injector connector outward.
(e) Place the 4 spacers in position on the intake manifold. (f) Place the delivery pipes with the 6
injectors in position on the intake manifold.
(g) Temporarily install the 4 bolts holding the delivery pipes to the intake manifold.
(h) Check that the injectors rotate smoothly.
HINT: If injectors do not rotate smoothly, the probable cause is incorrect installation of O-rings.
Replace the O-rings.
(i) Position the injector connector outward.
2. CONNECT INJECTOR CONNECTORS
Page 4541
Position Of Parts In Engine Compartment (Part 1 Of 2) (Fig 24)
Page 3736
Position Of Parts In Instrument Panel (1 Of 2) (Fig 28)
Page 1747
Water Pump: Service and Repair
Page 2810
Page 1048
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
INSPECTION
HINT: Inspect and adjust the valve clearance when the engine is cold.
1. REMOVE INTAKE AIR CONNECTOR 2. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVERS 3. SET NO.1
CYLINDER TO TDC/COMPRESSION
a. Turn the crankshaft pulley, and align its groove with the timing mark "0" of the No.1 timing belt
cover.
b. Check that the timing marks (1 dot) of the camshaft drive and driven gears are in straight line on
the cylinder heads surface as shown in the
illustration. If not, turn the crankshaft 1 revolution (360°) and align the marks.
4. INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE
a. Check only those valves indicated in the illustration.
1. Using a thickness gauge, measure the clearance between the valve lifter and camshaft.
Valve Clearance (Cold):
2. Record out of specification valve clearance measurements. They will be used later to determine
the required replacement adjusting shim.
Page 2396
Page 1889
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER INSPECTION
1. INSPECT MAF METER RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals THA and E2.
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the MAF meter.
2. INSPECT MAF METER OPERATION
(a) Connect the MAF meter connector.
(b) Using a voltmeter, connect the positive (+) tester probe to terminal VG and negative (-) tester
probe to terminal E3. (c) Blow air into the MAF meter and check that the voltage fluctuates.
If operation is not as specified. replace the MAF meter.
(d) Disconnect the MAF meter connector.
Specifications
EGR Tube: Specifications
Except VZN170 Models.
EGR Pipe to LH Exhaust Manifold 14 ft.lb
EGR Pipe Stays to Cylinder Head 71 in.lb
Page 1812
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 1 Of 2
Page 2149
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Diagram Information and Instructions
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 1049
b. Turn the crankshaft 2/3 of a revolution (240°), and check only the valves indicated in the
illustration. Measure the valve clearance.
c. Turn the crankshaft a further 2/3 of a revolution (240°), and check only the valves indicated in the
illustration.
Measure the valve clearance.
5. ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
a. Remove the adjusting shim.
1. Turn the camshaft so that the cam lobe for the valve to be adjusted faces up. 2. Turn the valve
lifter with a screwdriver so that the notches are perpendicular to the camshaft.
3. Using Special Service Tool (SST) (A), press down the valve lifter and place SST (B) between the
camshaft and valve lifter. Remove SST
(A). SST 09248-55040 (09248-05410, 09248-05420)
Page 1650
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 4677
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 3632
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2917
A/F and 02 Sensor Identification
Page 2180
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3890
Locations-J/B No.3 Behind The Instrument Panel Center (Fig 22)
Parts Location
Parts Location
Page 4120
4. Measure drive pinion preload. Using a torque wrench, measure the preload of backlash between
the drive pinion and ring gear.
Preload (at starting): 0.5 - 0.8 Nm (4.3 - 6.9 inch lbs.)
5. Check total preload. Using a torque wrench, measure the preload with the teeth of the drive
pinion and ring gear in contact.
Total preload (at starting): Drive pinion preload plus 0.4 - 0.6 Nm (3.5 - 5.2 inch lbs.)
If necessary, disassemble and inspect the differential.
6. Check tooth contact between ring gear and drive pinion.
Without Differential Lock
Page 3079
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 3701
Knock Sensor: Oscilloscope Patterns and Waveforms
Page 2930
Page 3399
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER INSPECTION
1. INSPECT MAF METER RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals THA and E2.
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the MAF meter.
2. INSPECT MAF METER OPERATION
(a) Connect the MAF meter connector.
(b) Using a voltmeter, connect the positive (+) tester probe to terminal VG and negative (-) tester
probe to terminal E3. (c) Blow air into the MAF meter and check that the voltage fluctuates.
If operation is not as specified. replace the MAF meter.
(d) Disconnect the MAF meter connector.
Page 2405
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Testing and Inspection
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
Inspect shift lock solenoid.
a. Disconnect the solenoid connector. b. Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance at each
terminal.
Standard Resistance 20-28 ohms.
If resistance value is not as specified. Replace the solenoid.
c. Apply battery positive voltage at each terminal. At this time, confirm that the solenoid operates. If
the solenoid does not operate, replace the
solenoid.
Page 4309
Use a grease gun to apply multi-purpose grease to the No. 1, 2, 3, 7 and the slip yoke grease
fittings. Apply molybdenum disulfide lithium base chassis grease, NLGI No. 2, to the No. 4, 5, and 6
grease fittings (double cardan joint).
Page 1340
Piston: Testing and Inspection Inspect Oil Clearance
NOTE: There are 3 sizes of the standard piston diameter, marked "1", "2" and "3" accordingly. The
mark is stamped on the piston top.
1. Using a micrometer, measure the piston diameter at right angles to the piston pin center line, 26
mm (1.02 inch) from the piston head.
Piston diameter:
STD:
Mark "1": 93.356 - 93.666 mm (3.6754 - 3.6758 inch) Mark "2": 93.367 - 93.376 mm (3.6759 3.6762 inch) Mark "3": 93.377 - 93.389 mm (3.6763 - 3.6766 inch)
O/S 0.50: 93.856 - 93.886 mm (3.6951 - 3.6963 inch)
2. Measure the cylinder bore diameter in the thrust directions. 3. Subtract the piston diameter
measurement from the cylinder bore diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance: 0.134 - 0.154 mm (0.0053 - 0.0060 inch) Maximum oil clearance: 0.174 mm
(0.0069 inch) If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace all the 6 pistons. If necessary,
rebore all the 6 cylinders or replace the cylinder block.
NOTE: (Use new cylinder block): Use a piston with the same number mark as the cylinder bore
diameter marked on the cylinder block.
Page 1986
Page 337
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2117
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 666
CHART 24
Page 3999
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 1097
Oil Filter: Tools and Equipment
Toyota Oil Filter Wrench Set
AST tool# TOY 300
This set includes our tool numbers TOY640, TOY730, and M0219. With the TOY300 you have
every gas engine Toyota/Lexus model covered between 1980 and 2009.
- Covers all Toyota and Lexus vehicles 1980-2009, based on factory filters.
Contact AST for pricing.
Assenmacher Specialty Tools 1-800-525-2943
This Kit Contains the Following Tools:
TOY 640 - Toyota Oil Filter Wrench
Locations
Fusible Link: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Electrical Specifications
Oxygen Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Bank 1: Sensor 1, Terminals +B & HT 11 - 16 ohms at 68 deg F
Bank 1: Sensor 2, Terminals +B & HT 11 - 16 ohms at 68 deg F
Bank 1 Sensor 1
Bank 1 Sensor 2
Page 4043
Upper Valve Body
Capacity Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
A/T Fluid
A340F
Dry capacity .........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 8.0 Qt Drain and Refill ................................................
................................................................................................................................................. 2.0L
(2.1 Qt)
Specifications
Engine Accessory Bracket: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Generator Bracket To LH Cylinder Head
.......................................................................................................................................... 18.5 Nm
(14 ft. lbs.) Generator Adjusting Bar To Cylinder Block
..................................................................................................................................... 42.0 Nm (31 ft.
lbs.) Power Steering Pump Bracket To RH Cylinder
Head..........................................................................................................................18.5 Nm (14 ft.
lbs.) Engine Rear Mount Bracket
To Engine Rear Mount Insulator
................................................................................................................................................. 18.0
Nm (13 ft. lbs.) To Frame Crossmember
..............................................................................................................................................................
58.0 Nm (43 ft. lbs.)
Engine Mount Bracket To Cylinder Block
........................................................................................................................................ 44.0 Nm (32
ft. lbs.) No. 2 Idler Pulley Bracket To Cylinder Block
.................................................................................................................................. 38.0 Nm (28 ft.
lbs.)
Page 1859
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 3654
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Testing and Inspection
Brake Warning Indicator: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT BRAKE WARNING LIGHT
1. Disconnect the connectors from the level warning switch and parking brake switch. 2. Connect
terminals on the wire harness side connector of the level warning switch connector. 3. Turn the
ignition switch ON and check that the warning light lights up.
If the warning light does not light up, test the bulb.
Page 4533
Differential: Capacity Specifications
For capacity and fluid type information relating to the Transfer Case assembly, please refer to
Transfer Case Fluid; Specifications.
Oil Level Check
Engine Oil: Testing and Inspection Oil Level Check
1. The oil level should be between the "L" and "F" marks on the dipstick. 2. If low, check for
leakage and add oil up to the "F" mark.
Page 3340
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 4127
a. Using a chisel and a hammer, unstake the nut. b. Using SST 09330-00021 to hold the flange,
remove the nut.
c. Using SST 09950-30010 (09951-03010, 09953-03010, 09954-03010, 09955-03030,
09956-03020), remove the companion flange.
7. Remove oil seal and oil slinger.
a. Using SST 09308-10010, remove the oil seal. b. Remove the oil slinger.
8. Remove rear bearing and bearing spacer.
a. Using SST 09556-22010, remove the rear bearing from the drive pinion. b. Remove the bearing
spacer.
9. Remove side bearing retainer. Remove the 10 bolts and tap out the retainer with a plastic
hammer.
10. Remove differential case assembly. 11. Remove drive pinion from differential carrier.
Page 2199
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2258
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 834
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2000
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2486
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 4159
d. Install the shift fork in the groove of the sleeve holding it by hand and install the case in the
carrier.
HINT: Make sure that there is backlash between the ring gear and drive pinion.
9. Install bearing caps. Align the matchmarks on the cap and carrier. Screw in the 2 bearing cap
bolts 2 or 3 turns and press down the bearing cap by
hand.
HINT: If the bearing cap does not fit tightly on the carrier, the adjusting nuts are not threaded
properly. Reinstall the adjusting nuts if necessary.
10. Adjust side bearing preload.
a. Torque the 4 bearing cap bolts to the specified torque, then loosen them to the point where the
adjusting nuts can be turned by hand.
Torque to 78 Nm (58 ft. lbs.)
b. Fully tighten the 4 bearing cap bolts by hand.
c. Using the SST 09616-30020, torque the adjusting nut on the ring gear side until the ring has a
backlash of about 0.2 mm (0.008 inch).
d. While turning the ring gear, use the SST 09616-30020 to fully tighten the adjusting nut on the
drive pinion side. after the bearings are settled,
loosen the adjusting nut on the drive pinion side.
Page 4411
Input Shaft: Application and ID
Input Shaft Snap Ring Thickness
Mark A .................................................................................................................................................
............... 2.10-2.15 mm (0.0827-0.0846 inch) Mark B ........................................................................
........................................................................................ 2.15-2.20 mm (0.0846-0.0866 inch) Mark C
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. 2.20-2.25 mm (0.0866-0.0886 inch) Mark D .....................................................................................
........................................................................... 2.25-2.30 mm (0.0886-0.0906 inch) Mark E ............
....................................................................................................................................................
2.30-2.35 mm (0.0906-0.0925 inch) Mark F ........................................................................................
......................................................................... 2.35-2.40 mm (0.0925-0.0945 inch) Mark G .............
...................................................................................................................................................
2.40-2.45 mm (0.0945-0.0965 inch)
Page 3797
Page 384
Vehicle Speed Sensor Circuit
Page 824
Camshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Cam Sensor to Cylinder Head 69 in.lb
Page 3688
Knock Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 545
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 237
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 4000
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2189
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT AIR CLEANER CAP FROM MAF METER
2. REMOVE MAF METER
(a) Disconnect the MAF meter connector. (b) Remove the 2 bolts and MAF meter.
Torque: 6.9 N.m (72 kgf.cm, 61 in.lbf)
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 585
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 4428
e. Using a press, install the 2nd gear assembly and reverse gear assembly.
7. Install snap ring.
a. Select a snap ring that will allow minimum axial clay.
Mark A: 2.30-2.35 mm (0.0906-0.0925 inch) Mark B: 2.35-2.40 mm (0.0925-0.0945 inch) Mark C:
2.40-2.45 mm (0.0945-0.0965 inch) Mark D: 2.45-2.50 mm (0.0965-0.0984 inch) Mark E: 2.50-2.55
mm (0.0984-0.1004 inch) Mark F: 2.55-2.60 mm (0.1004-0.1024 inch) Mark G: 2.60-2.65 mm
(0.1024-0.1043 inch)
b. Using a screwdriver and hammer, install the snap ring.
8. Install spacer and 1st gear assembly.
a. Install the spacer on the output shaft. b. Apply gear oil to the needle roller bearing. c. Assemble
the 1st gear, synchronizer ring and needle roller bearing. d. Install the assembly on the output shaft
with the synchronizer ring slots aligned with the shifting keys.
9. Install straight pin and 1st gear thrust washer.
Install the 1st gear thrust washer onto the output-shaft with the straight pin aligned with the 1st
gear-thrust washer.
Electrical Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Resistance Cold Resistance Hot
835 - 1,400 ohms at 14 - 122 deg F 1,060 - 1,645 ohms at 122 - 212 deg F
Page 443
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4503
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
ON-VEHICLE REPAIR
1 DISCONNECT NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
2. REMOVE NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
a. Remove the bolt and No.1 vehicle speed sensor assembly. b. Remove the speedometer driven
gear and O-ring from the No.1 vehicle speed sensor.
3. INSTALL NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
a. Coat a new O-ring with ATF. b. Install the O-ring and speedometer driven gear to the No.1
vehicle speed sensor. c. Install the No.1 vehicle speed sensor to the extension housing and torque
the bolt.
Torque: 16 Nm (160 kgf-cm, 12 ft. lbs.)
4. CONNECT NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR 5. DISCONNECT NO.2 VEHICLE
SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
6. REMOVE NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
a. Remove the bolt and No.2 vehicle speed sensor. b. Remove the O-ring from the No.2 vehicle
speed sensor.
7. INSTALL NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
a. Coat a new O-ring with ATF and install it to the No.2 vehicle speed sensor. b. Install the No.2
vehicle speed sensor and torque the bolt.
Page 2799
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2439
Specifications
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Specifications
DIMENSIONS
Diameter:
Bore
.........................................................................................................................................................
31.000 - 31.018 mm (1.2205 - 1.2212 inch) Lifter
.......................................................................................................................................................
30.966 - 30.976 mm (1.2191 - 1.2195 inch)
Oil Clearance:
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
.................................... 0.08 mm (0.0031 inch) Standard
......................................................................................................................................................
0.024 - 0.052 mm (0.0009 - 0.0020 inch)
Page 2745
Engine Control-Connectors
Page 4816
Remove the 2 mounting bolts and remove the caliper. Torque: 123 Nm (90 ft. lbs.)
4. Remove these parts:
- Clip.
- 2 pins.
- Anti-rattle spring.
- 2 pads.
- 4 anti-squeal shims.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
NOTE: After installation: Fill brake reservoir with brake fluid, bleed brake system. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair
- Check for leaks.
Page 1347
Piston: Service and Repair Assembly
1. Assemble piston and connecting rod.
(a) Using a small screwdriver, install a new snap ring on one side of the piston pin hole.
NOTE: Be sure that end gap of the snap ring is not aligned with the pin hole cutout portion of the
piston.
(b) Gradually heat the piston to 60° C (140° F). (c)
Coat the piston pin with engine oil.
(d) Align the front marks of the piston and connecting rod, and push in the piston pin with your
thumb. (e)
Using a small screwdriver, install a new snap ring on the other side of the piston pin hole.
NOTE: Be sure that end gap of the snap ring is not aligned with the pin hole cutout portion of the
piston.
2. Install piston rings.
(a) Install the oil ring expander and 2 side rails by hand.
(b) Using a piston ring expander, install the 2 compression rings with the code mark facing upward.
Code Mark:
No. 1: "1R" or "T" No. 2: "2R" or "T"
Page 4234
Front Axle Hub / 4WD
Electrical Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Cold Hot
Between Terminals NE+ and NE- 1,630 - 2,740 ohms at 14 - 122 deg F 2,065 - 3,225 ohms at 122
- 212 deg F
Page 791
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2819
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 4468
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Locations
Actuator Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Pressure:
Minimum [1] .........................................................................................................................................
........................................ 1,000 kPa (145 psi) Standard [1] ................................................................
..................................................................................................... 1,200 kPa (174 psi) or more
Pressure Difference:
Between Each Cylinder
..........................................................................................................................................................
100 kPa (15 psi) or less
[1] @ 250 rpm
Page 2769
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 3943
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 2195
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 4621
Planetary Gears: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: For removal and installation procedures refer to "Transfer Case, Service and Repair."
INSPECTION
1. Inspect pinion gear thrust clearance using a feeler gauge, measure the planetary pinion gear
thrust clearance.
Standard Clearance: 0.11-0.84 mm (0.0043-0.0331 inch) Maximum Clearance: 0.84 mm (0.0331
inch)
If the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the planetary gear assembly.
2. Inspect planetary pinion gear radial clearance.
Using a dial indicator, measure the radial clearance of the planetary pinion gear.
Standard Clearance: 0.009-0.038 mm (0.0004-0.0015 inch) Maximum Clearance: 0.038 mm
(0.0015 inch)
If the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the planetary gear assembly.
Page 4462
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Capacity Specifications
Lubricant
Page 1987
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Figure 1
Reference
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The intake air temp. sensor is built into the air flow meter and senses the intake air temperature. A
thermistor built in the sensor changes the resistance value according to the intake air temperature.
The lower the intake air temperature, the greater the thermistor resistance value and the higher the
intake air temperature, the lower the thermistor resistance value (See Fig.1.). The intake air
temperature sensor is connected to the ECM (See below). The 5 V power source voltage in the
ECM is applied to the intake air temperature sensor from the terminal THA via a resistor R. That is,
the resistor R and the intake air temperature sensor are connected in series. When the resistance
value of the intake air temperature sensor changes in accordance with changes in the intake air
temperature, the potential at terminal THA also changes. Based on this signal, the ECM increases
the fuel injection volume to improve driveability during cold engine operation.
Specifications
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Knock Sensor to Cylinder Block 29 ft.lb
Page 2959
CHART 29
Page 1909
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 360
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 47
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 2545
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 3151
EGR Temperature Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Note: Except Model VZN170 (Long wheel base 4WD Pickup)
EGR Sensor to EGR Valve 14 ft.lb
Page 3505
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR REMOVAL
1. REMOVE NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER 2. REMOVE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the camshaft position sensor connector.
(b) Remove the bolts and camshaft position sensor.
Torque: 7.8 N.m (80 kgf.cm, 69 in.lbf)
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 2173
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 2139
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Electrical Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Electrical Specifications
Resistance 10 - 20 K ohms at -4 deg F
4 - 7 K ohms at 32 deg F
2 - 3 K ohms at 68 deg F
0.9 - 1.3 K ohms at 104 deg F
0.4 - 0.7 K ohms at 140 deg F
0.2 - 0.4 K ohms at 176 deg F
Page 1871
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
MAF Meter to Air Cleaner Cap 61 in.lb
Page 2474
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 4534
Differential: Fluid Type Specifications
For capacity and fluid type information relating to the Transfer Case assembly, please refer to
Transfer Case Fluid; Specifications.
Page 2077
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 3526
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 4920
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Service and Repair
ABS Actuator Components
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect brake lines.
Disconnect Brake Lines
Specifications
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Attaching Nuts .....................................................................................................................................
................................................. 19 Nm (14 ft. lbs.) Bracket Attaching Nuts ........................................
............................................................................................................................. 5.4 Nm (48 inch
lbs.) Brake Line Union .........................................................................................................................
......................................................... 15 Nm (11 ft.lbs.)
Page 4903
Load Sensing Proportioning And By-Pass Valve Components
Page 4781
Depress MOTOR Switch And Brake Pedal
(h) Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few seconds. (i) Depress the brake pedal and hold it
for about 15 seconds. As you hold the pedal down, push the MOTOR switch for a few seconds.
Check that
the brake pedal does not pulsate.
(j) Release the brake pedal.
7. Push MOTOR switch.
Depress MOTOR Switch
(a) Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few seconds. (b) Stop the engine.
8. Disconnect actuator checker (SST) from actuator.
Disconnect the actuator checker (SST) and sub-wire harnesses (SST) from the actuator, control
relay and body side wire harness. SST 09990-00150, 09990-00200, 09990-00210, 09990 - 00370
9. Connect connectors.
(a) Connect the 2 connectors to the control relay. (b) Connect the connector to the actuator.
10. Clear the Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC).
Component Inspection
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection Component Inspection
1. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR
2. DISCONNECT CONNECTOR OF THERMISTOR
3. CHECK RESISTANCE OF THERMISTOR
Measure resistance between 1 and 2 terminals.
Standard resistance:
1,500 Ohms at 25° C (77° F)
If resistance is not as specified, replace the thermistor.
Page 4169
b. Heat the ring gear to about 100 C (212° F) in boiling water. c. Carefully remove the ring gear
from the water. d. After the moisture on the ring gear has completely evaporated, quickly install the
ring gear to the differential case.
HINT: Align the matchmarks on the ring gear and differential case.
e. After the ring gear cools down enough, torque the set bolts to which thread lock has been
applied.
Thread lock: Part No. 08833 - 00100, THREE BOND 1360K, or equivalent.
Torque to 125 Nm (92 ft. lbs.)
4. Inspect ring gear runout.
a. Install the differential case into the carrier and install the plate washers to where there is no play
in the bearing. b. Install the bearing cap.
c. Using a dial indicator, measure the runout of ring gear.
Maximum runout: 0.05 mm (0.0020 inch)
5. Install drive pinion bearing outer races and adjusting washer.
a. Using SST 09950-60020 (09951-00710), 09950-70010 (09951-07150) and a press, install a new
front bearing outer race to the carrier.
b. Using SST 09950-60020 (09951-00910), 09950-70010 (09951-07150) and a press, install a new
adjusting washer and a new rear bearing
outer race to the carrier.
Page 2407
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2084
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Diagram Information and Instructions
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 66
Inspection Procedure / ECU Power Source Circuit (3 Of 3)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Electronically Controlled Transmission Communication Circuit
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION (ECT) COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT SOLENOID # 2
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When driving uphill under cruise control, in order to reduce shifting due to ON-OFF overdrive
operation and to provide smooth driving, when down
shifting in the electronically controlled transmission occurs, a signal to prevent upshift until the end
of the up hill slope is sent from the cruise control ECU to the electronically controlled transmission.
Terminal ECT of the cruise control ECU detects the shift change signal (output to electronically
controlled transmission No.2 solenoid) from the electronically controlled transmission.
If vehicle speed down, also when terminal electronically controlled transmission of the cruise
control ECU receives down shifting signal, it sends a signal from terminal OD to ECM to cut
overdrive until the end of the uphill slope, and the gear shifts are reduced and gear shift points in
the electronically controlled transmission are changed.
ECT Communication Circuit - Solenoid #2
Page 2748
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 2 Of 2
Page 1858
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 4379
Counter Gear: Testing and Inspection
1. Inspect 5th gear radial clearance.
a. Install the spacer, counter 5th gear and needle roller bearings.
b. Using a dial indicator, measure the counter 5th gear radial clearance.
Standard Clearance: 0.015-0.068 mm (0.0006-0.0027 inch) Maximum Clearance: 0.160 mm
(0.0063 inch)
If the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the gear bearing or shaft.
2. Inspect counter gear.
Using a micrometer, measure the outer diameter of the counter gear journal.
Minimum Diameter: 27.860 mm (1.0968 inch)
If the outer diameter is less than the minimum, replace the counter gear.
3. Inspect 5th synchronizer ring.
a. Check for wear or damage.
Page 3222
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 2618
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 668
Page 75
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 2331
Ignition Cable: Testing and Inspection
HIGH-TENSION CORDS INSPECTION
1. REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE
2. DISCONNECT HIGH-TENSION CORDS FROM SPARK PLUGS
Disconnect the high - tension cords at the rubber boot. DO NOT pull on the cords.
NOTICE: Pulling on or bending the cords may damage the conductor inside.
3. DISCONNECT HIGH-TENSION CORDS FROM IGNITION COILS
(a) Using a screwdriver, lift up the lock claw and disconnect the holder from the ignition coils. (b)
Disconnect the high-tension cord at the grommet.
DO NOT pull on the cord.
NOTICE: Pulling on or bending the cords may damage the conductor inside.
- Do not wipe any of the oil from the grommet after the high-tension cord is disconnected.
4. INSPECT HIGH-TENSION CORD RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance.
Maximum resistance: 25 K ohms per cord
If the resistance is greater than the maximum, check the terminals. If necessary, replace the
high-tension cord.
Page 316
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 865
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 1776
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Federal Emissions Warranty. This warranty is in effect for 36
months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in service date.
*Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer's specific
complaint.
Page 4150
Differential Carrier (3RZ-FE, 5VZ-FE w/o Differential Lock)
DISASSEMBLY
1. Remove companion flange.
a. Using a chisel and hammer, unstake the staked part of the nut. b. Using SST 09330-00021 to
hold the flange, remove the nut.
Page 1842
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
EFI MAIN RELAY INSPECTION
1. REMOVE EFI MAIN RELAY (Marking: EFI) 2. INSPECT EFI MAIN RELAY
A. Inspect relay continuity
(a) Using an ohmmeter. check that there is continuity between terminals 1 and 2.
If there is no continuity. replace the relay.
(b) Check that there is no continuity between terminals and 5.
If there is continuity. replace the relay.
B. Inspect relay operation
(a) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 1 and 2. (b) Using an ohmmeter, check that
there is continuity between terminals 3 and 5.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
3. REINSTALL EFI MAIN RELAY
Page 4217
a. Coat a new oil seal lip with MP grease. b. 2RZ-FE:
Using SST and a hammer, install the oil seal. SST 09554-30011
Oil seal drive in depth: 1.5 mm (0.059 inch)
c. 3RZ-FE, 5VZ-FE w/o Diff. lock:
Using SST and a plastic hammer, install the oil seal until its surface is flush with the differential
carrier end. SST 09316-12010, 09649-17010
Oil seal drive in depth: 0.5 mm (0.020 inch)
HINT: Connect SST with vinyl tape.
d. 3RZ-FE, 5VZ-FE w/ Diff. lock:
Using SST and a hammer, install the oil seal. SST 09214-76011
Oil seal drive in depth: 1.0 mm (0.039 inch)
13. INSTALL COMPANION FLANGE
a. Place the companion flange on the drive pinion. b. Coat the threads of a new nut with hypoid
gear oil. c. Using SST to hold the flange, torque the nut.
SST 09330-00021
Specifications
Pressure Plate: Specifications
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Diaphragm Spring Finger Wear:
Maximum Width ...................................................................................................................................
....................................... 5.0 mm (0.197 inch) Maximum Depth .........................................................
................................................................................................................. 0.6 mm (0.024 inch)
Diaphragm Spring Tip Non-Alignment:
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
........................................ 0.5 mm (0.020 inch)
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Clutch Cover To Flywheel ...................................................................................................................
................................................ 19 N.m (14 ft. lbs.)
Page 2548
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 4261
Rear Axle Shaft (2 Of 2)
REMOVAL
1. Remove rear wheel and brake drum.
Installation Hint: ^
Torque to 110 Nm (83 ft. lbs.)
^ After installation, bleed the brake system and check for leaks.
2. Check bearing backlash and axle shaft deviation.
a. Using a dial indicator, check the backlash in the bearing shaft direction. If it is greater than the
maximum, replace the bearing.
Maximum: 0.7 mm (0.027 inch)
b. Using a dial indicator, check the deviation at the surface of the axle shaft outside the hub bolt. If
it is greater than the maximum, replace the
axle shaft.
Maximum: 0.1 mm (0.0039 inch)
3. w/ ABS: Remove ABS speed sensor from rear axle housing.
Installation Hint: Torque to 8.0 Nm (71 inch lbs.)
4. Remove rear brake assembly.
Page 646
O2S Application Table
O2S Failure Threshold Charts
Page 3341
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 2789
Camshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Cam Sensor to Cylinder Head 69 in.lb
Page 2041
CHART 7
Page 4248
1. Remove free wheel hub cover.
a. Set the control handle to FREE. b. Remove the 6 cover mounting bolts and pull off the cover.
Torque to 10 Nm (7 ft. lbs.)
Installation Hint: Before install the hub cover, apply MP grease to the clutch splines.
c. Remove the gasket.
2. Remove free wheel hub body.
a. Remove the 6 mounting nuts and washers.
Torque to 31 Nm (23 ft. lbs.)
b. Using a brass bar and a hammer, tap on the bolts head and remove the cone washers. c. Pull off
the free wheel hub body. d. Remove the gasket.
INSPECTION
1. Inspect cover, handle and seal. Check the handle moves smoothly. 2. Inspect inner hub. Place
the cover in the body and check that the inner hub turns smoothly.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Removal and Installation
Page 921
Ignition Switch: Testing and Inspection
IGNITION SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT SWITCH CONTINUITY
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Fluid Level Check
Power Steering Fluid: Testing and Inspection Fluid Level Check
1. Keep vehicle level. 2. Check fluid level. With the engine stopped, check the fluid level in the oil
reservoir. If necessary, add fluid.
Fluid: ATF DEXRON II.
HINT: Check that the fluid level is within the HOT LEVEL range on the reservoir cap dipstick. If the
fluid is cold, check that it is within the COLD LEVEL range.
3. Boost fluid temperature. Start the engine and run it at idle. Turn the steering wheel from lock to
lock several times to boost fluid temperature.
Fluid temperature: 80° C (176° F)
4. Check for foaming or emulsification. If there is foaming or emulsification, bleed power steering
system. 5. Check fluid level rise.
a. With the engine idling, measure the fluid level in the oil reservoir. b. Stop the engine.
c. Wait a few minutes and remeasure the fluid level in the reservoir. If a problem is found, bleed
power steering system.
Maximum fluid level rise: 5.0 mm (02inch)
6. Check fluid level.
Page 34
ABS Control (Motor) Relay Circuit Inspection Procedure (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 726
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 3627
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Specifications
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Knock Sensor to Cylinder Block 29 ft.lb
Specifications
Brake Drum: Specifications
Standard Inside Diameter 11.614 in
Maximum Inside Diameter 11.693 in
Page 2674
CHART 16
CHART 17
Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications
Mounting bolt 71 in.lb
Diagram Information and Instructions
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 691
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 623
Components For Removal And Installation Part 2 Of 2
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
KNOCK SENSORS REMOVAL
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT 2. REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE 3. REMOVE INTAKE AIR
CONNECTOR 4. REMOVE HIGH-TENSION CORDS WITH IGNITION COILS 5. REMOVE FUEL
PRESSURE REGULATOR 6. REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY 7. REMOVE WATER
BYPASS PIPE AND KNOCK SENSOR WIRE
Page 3515
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 736
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 4380
b. Install the synchronizer pull ring, cone ring and outer ring to the gear spline piece No.5.
c. Check the braking effect of the synchronizer ring. turn the synchronizer ring in one direction
while pushing it to the gear cone. check that the
ring locks. If it does not lock, replace the synchronizer ring.
4. Inspect shift fork and hub sleeve clearance.
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the hub sleeve and shift fork.
Maximum Clearance: 1.0 mm (0.039 inch)
If the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the shift fork or hub sleeve.
5. Inspect reverse idler gear radial clearance.
Using a dial indicator, measure the reverse idler gear radial clearance.
Standard Clearance: 0.040-0.082 mm (0.0016-0.0032 inch) Maximum Clearance: 0.130 mm
(0.0051 inch)
If the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the reverse idler gear or reverse idler gear shaft.
Page 4358
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Pressure:
Minimum [1] .........................................................................................................................................
........................................ 1,000 kPa (145 psi) Standard [1] ................................................................
..................................................................................................... 1,200 kPa (174 psi) or more
Pressure Difference:
Between Each Cylinder
..........................................................................................................................................................
100 kPa (15 psi) or less
[1] @ 250 rpm
Specifications
Brake Master Cylinder: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Brake Lines...........................................................................................................................................
................................................. 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.) Mounting Nuts.......................................................
.................................................................................................................................. 13 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
Reservoir Set Screw.............................................................................................................................
............................................. 1.5 Nm (13 inch lbs.) Piston Stopper Bolt...............................................
............................................................................................................................ 8.0 Nm (69 inch
lbs.)
Page 2686
CHART 26
Page 1575
- Using SST, tighten the flare nut to specified torque. (SST 09631-22020)
HINT: Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 30 cm (11.81 in.).
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf) Torque for using SST: 28 N.m (285 kgf.cm, 21 ft.lbf)
NOTICE: Do not rotate the fuel pipe, when tightening the flare nut.
Page 2665
CHART 2
CHART 3
CHART 4
Page 4128
12. Remove drive pinion front bearing. Using SST 09950-00020 and a press, remove the bearing
and washer from the drive pinion.
HINT: If the drive pinion or ring gear are damaged replace them as a set.
13. Remove drive pinion bearing outer races.
a. Using a brass bar and a hammer, remove the front bearing outer race.
b. Using SST 09502-12010, 09612-65014 (09612-01020, 09612-01050), remove the rear bearing
outer race.
14. Remove side bearing outer races.
HINT: ^
Measure the plate washer and note the thickness.
^ Tag the bearing outer races to show the location for reassembly.
a. Using SST 09950-60010 (09951-00540), 09550-70010 (09951-01500) and a press, remove the
plate washer and outer race from the bearing
retainer.
Page 3257
Fuel Injector: Capacity Specifications Injector Volume
Injector Volume
Resistance Per Injector Approx. 13.8 ohms
Injection Volume 3.4 - 4.2 cu in. Per 15 seconds
Difference Between Injectors 0.31 or less
Leakage Rate Per Injector 1 drop or less per Minute
Fuel - Idle Speed Increased by Replacement ECM
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Idle Speed Increased by Replacement
ECM
ENGINE EG001-98
FEBRUARY 13, 1998
2RZ ECM IDLE SPEED
MODELS: '95-'97 TACOMA
Introduction Operating logic of 1995-1997 Tacoma ECMs has been revised to improve engine idle
smoothness (with transmission in "D" range) by increasing idle speed (A/C "OFF") from 600 RPM
to 700 RPM. The change has also narrowed the RPM transition between A/C "OFF" and A/C "ON"
engagement.
Affected Vehicles 1995-1997 Tacoma 4x2 equipped with 2RZ-FE four cylinder engine and automatic transmission.
Part Number Information
Production Change Information No production changes have been made.
- This change applies only to replacement ECMs available through parts supply.
Warranty Information
Applicable Warranty: This repair is covered under the Toyota Powertrain Warranty. This warranty Is
in effect for 60 months or 60,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in service date.
Page 4069
Clutch Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Overhaul
DISASSEMBLY
1. Remove reservoir tank.
a. Using a pin punch and hammer, drive out the slotted spring pin. b. Remove the reservoir tank
and grommet.
2. Remove push rod.
Pull back the boot, and using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
3. Remove piston.
ASSEMBLY
1. Coat parts with lithium soap base glycol grease, as shown. 2. Insert piston into cylinder. 3. Install
push rod assembly with snap ring. 4. Install reservoir tank.
a. Install the reservoir tank and a new grommet.
b. Using a pin punch and hammer, drive in the slotted spring pin.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 4555
Rear Differential Lock-Connector
Electrical Specifications
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Measure Terminals THA - E2 10 - 20 K ohms at -4 deg F
4 - 7 K ohms at 32 deg F
2 - 3 K ohms at 68 deg F
0.9 - 1.3 K ohms at 104 deg F
0.4 - 0.7 K ohms at 140 deg F
0.2 - 0.4 K ohms at 176 deg F
Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Specifications
Between Terminals Measured Resistance
At Clearance: 0 mm (0 in.) VTA - E2 0.2 - 5.7 K ohms
Throttle Fully Opened VTA - E2 2.0 - 10.2 K ohms
At all Times VC - E2 2.5 - 5.9 K ohms
Ohmmeter Connection
Page 2921
Engine Bank Identification
Diagram Information and Instructions
Shift Indicator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness
Location Of Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness, Ground Points (Fig 32)
Page 4155
c. Install the side gear to the RH case.
d. Install the 4 pinion gears and pinion gear thrust washers to the spider. e. Install the pinion gear
with spider to the RH case.
f. Using a dial indicator, measure the side gear backlash with holding the side gear and spider.
Standard backlash: 0.05 - 0.20 mm (0.0020 - 0.0079 inch)
If the backlash is not within the specification, install a thrust washer of a different thickness.
Thrust washer thickness:
0.9 mm (0.035 inch) 1.0 mm (0.039 inch) 1.1 mm (0.043 inch) 1.2 mm (0.047 inch) 1.3 mm (0.051
inch)
HINT: ^
Measure at all 4 locations.
^ Measure the backlash at the RH case at the LH case.
g. Install the side gear and side gear thrust washer to the RH case. h. Install the pinion gears and
spider to the RH case. i.
Install the side gear and side gear thrust washer to the RH case.
j. Align the matchmarks on the LH and RH cases.
k. Torque the 8 bolts uniformly, a little at a time.
Torque to 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.)
Page 3745
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2004
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 2870
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 2856
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Locations
ABS Main Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 650
CHART 7
Page 3216
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 621
Knock Sensor: Oscilloscope Patterns and Waveforms
Page 835
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2941
CHART 15
Page 1628
Coolant: Service and Repair
1. Drain engine coolant.
(a) Remove the radiator cap.
WARNING: To avoid the danger of being burned, do not remove the radiator cap while the engine
and radiator are still hot, as fluid and steam can be blown out under pressure.
(b) Loosen the drain plugs, and drain the engine coolant. (c)
Close the drain plugs.
2. Fill engine coolant.
(a) Slowly fill the system with engine coolant. ^
Use a good brand of ethylene-glycol base coolant and mix it according to the manufacturer's
directions.
^ Using coolant which includes more than 50 % ethylene-glycol (but not more than 70 %) is
recommended.
CAUTION: Do not use an alcohol type engine coolant.
- The engine coolant should be mixed with demineralized water or distilled water.
Capacity:
A/T: 9.5 liters (10.0 US qts.) M/T: 9.7 liters (10.3 US qts.)
(b) Reinstall the radiator cap. (c)
Start the engine, and bleed the cooling system.
(d) If necessary, refill the radiator reservoir with coolant until it reaches the "FULL" line.
3. Check engine coolant for leaks.
Page 2219
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 3087
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch goes on when the shift lever is in the N or P shift position. When it
goes on terminal NSW of the ECM is grounded to body ground via the starter relay, thus the
terminal NSW voltage becomes 0 V. When the shift lever is in the D, 2, L or R position, the
park/neutral position switch goes off, so the voltage of ECM, terminal NSW becomes battery
voltage, the voltage of the ECM internal power source.
If the shift lever is moved from the N position to the D position, this signal is used for air-fuel ratio
correction and for idle speed control (estimated control), etc.
Page 1938
Page 2971
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Locations
Back-Up Light Switches / Park Neutral Position Switch
Page 1609
HINT: Apply SST (B) at a slight angle on the side marked with "9" or "7", at the position shown in the
illustration.
- When SST (B) is inserted too deeply, it will get pinched by the shim. To prevent it from being
stuck, insert it gently from the intake side, at a slight angle.
4. Using a small screwdriver and magnetic finger, remove the adjusting shim.
b. Determine the replacement adjusting shim size according to these Formula or Charts:
Page 3753
Electronically Controlled Transmission And A/T Indicator (Part 3 Of 3)
Page 3650
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Crankshaft Sensor to Oil Pump 69 in.lb
Page 361
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 2153
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
ON-VEHICLE REPAIR
1 DISCONNECT NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
2. REMOVE NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
a. Remove the bolt and No.1 vehicle speed sensor assembly. b. Remove the speedometer driven
gear and O-ring from the No.1 vehicle speed sensor.
3. INSTALL NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
a. Coat a new O-ring with ATF. b. Install the O-ring and speedometer driven gear to the No.1
vehicle speed sensor. c. Install the No.1 vehicle speed sensor to the extension housing and torque
the bolt.
Torque: 16 Nm (160 kgf-cm, 12 ft. lbs.)
4. CONNECT NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR 5. DISCONNECT NO.2 VEHICLE
SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
6. REMOVE NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
a. Remove the bolt and No.2 vehicle speed sensor. b. Remove the O-ring from the No.2 vehicle
speed sensor.
7. INSTALL NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
a. Coat a new O-ring with ATF and install it to the No.2 vehicle speed sensor. b. Install the No.2
vehicle speed sensor and torque the bolt.
Locations
ECT Temperature Sender Gauge / Low Oil Pressure Warning Switch
Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2613
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 191
Ignition Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Specifications
Input Shaft: Specifications
Input Shaft
Input Shaft Journal Outer Diameter:
Minimum ..............................................................................................................................................
................................. 47.59 mm (1.8736 inch)
Input Shaft Bushing Diameter:
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
.................................. 39.14 mm (1.5409 inch)
Synchronizer Ring To Sprocket Clearance:
Standard
..............................................................................................................................................................
1.05-1.85 mm (0.0413-0.0728 inch) Minimum .....................................................................................
............................................................................................ 0.80 mm (0.0315 inch)
Page 510
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
Intake 0.13 - 0.23 mm
Exhaust 0.27 - 0.37 mm
Page 1359
Piston Ring: Service and Repair Installation
1. Install the oil ring expander and 2 side rails by hand.
2. Using a piston ring expander, install the 2 compression rings with the code mark facing upward.
Code Mark:
No. 1: "1R" or "T" No. 2: "2R" or "T"
3. Position the piston rings so that the ring ends are as shown.
CAUTION: Do not align the end gaps.
Page 3001
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Specifications
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Knock Sensor to Cylinder Block 29 ft.lb
Page 3793
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2570
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection Related Diagnostic Procedures
ECM Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the ignition switch is turned ON, battery positive voltage is applied to the coil, closing the
contacts of the EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and supplying power to the terminal +B of the ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Step 1
Step 2
Page 4212
8. INSTALL COMPANION FLANGE
a. Place the companion flange on the drive pinion. b. Coat the threads of a new nut with hypoid
gear oil. c. Using SST to hold the flange, torque the nut.
SST 09330-00021
Torque: 108 Nm (1,100 kgf-cm, 80 ft. lbs.)
9. ADJUST DRIVE PINION PRELOAD
Using a torque wrench, measure the preload of the drive pinion using the backlash between the
drive pinion and ring gear.
Preload (at starting): 0.6 - 1.0 Nm (6 - 10 kgf-cm, 5.2 - 8.7 inch lbs.)
If the preload is greater than the specified value, replace the bearing spacer. If the preload is less
than the specified value, retighten the nut 13 Nm (130 kgf-cm, 9 ft. lbs.) a little at a time until the
specified preload is reached.
Torque: 223 Nm (2,275 kgf-cm, 165 ft. lbs.) or less
If the maximum torque is exceeded while retightening the nut, replace the bearing spacer and
repeat the preload adjusting procedure. Do not back off the pinion nut to reduce the preload.
10. STAKE DRIVE PINION NUT 11. INSTALL FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT
12. FILL DIFFERENTIAL WITH HYPOID GEAR OIL
Torque: 39 Nm (400 kgf-cm, 29 ft. lbs.)
w/o A.D.D.:
Oil type: Hypoid gear oil API GL-5 Recommended oil viscosity:
Above -18°C (0 °F) SAE 90 Below -18°C (O°F) SAE 80W or 8OW-90
Capacity: 1.10 liters (1.16 US qts., 0.97 Imp. qts.)
w/A.D.D.:
Oil type: Hypoid gear oil API GL-5 Recommended oil viscosity: SAE 75W-90
Page 63
Cruise Control Module: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Diagnosis Circuit
DIAGNOSIS CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This circuit sends a signal to the ECU that DTC output is required.
Diagnosis Circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
Inspection Procedure / Diagnosis Circuit (1 Of 2)
Page 538
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 592
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 3298
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
FUEL PRESSURE INSPECTION
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
(a) Check the battery positive voltage is above 12 V. (b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable
from the battery. (c) Remove the 6 bolts and disconnect the No.2 timing belt cover.
(d) Remove the union bolt holding the fuel pipe to the delivery pipe and gasket.
CAUTION: Put a shop towel under the delivery pipe.
- Slowly loosen the union bolt.
(e) Install SST (pressure gauge) to the delivery pipe with the 2 gaskets and SST (union and union
bolt). SST 09268-45012
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf)
(f) Wipe off any splattered gasoline.
(g) Connect the TOYOTA hand-held tester to the DLC3. (h) Reconnect the negative (-) terminal
cable to the battery. (i) Turn the ignition switch ON. (j) Measure the fuel pressure.
Fuel pressure: 265 - 304 kPa (2.7 - 3.1 kgf/sq.cm, 38 - 44 psi)
If pressure is high. replace the fuel pressure regulator. If pressure is low, check these parts: Fuel hoses and connections
- Fuel pump
- Fuel filter
- Fuel pressure regulator
(k) Disconnect the TOYOTA hand-held tester from the DLC3.
Page 2868
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Camshaft Position Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSPECTION
NOTICE: "Cold" and "Hot" in these sentences express the temperature of the sensors themselves.
"Cold" is from -10°C (14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
1. DISCONNECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR CONNECTOR
2. INSPECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals.
Resistance:
Cold: 835 - 1,400 Ohms Hot: 1,060 - 1,645 Ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the camshaft position sensor.
3. RECONNECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR CONNECTOR
Page 2560
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 2 Of 2
Page 2726
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 2460
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Capacity Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
A/T Fluid
A340F
Dry capacity .........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 8.0 Qt Drain and Refill ................................................
................................................................................................................................................. 2.0L
(2.1 Qt)
Page 2932
CHART 1
Page 2303
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
FUEL PRESSURE INSPECTION
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
(a) Check the battery positive voltage is above 12 V. (b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable
from the battery. (c) Remove the 6 bolts and disconnect the No.2 timing belt cover.
(d) Remove the union bolt holding the fuel pipe to the delivery pipe and gasket.
CAUTION: Put a shop towel under the delivery pipe.
- Slowly loosen the union bolt.
(e) Install SST (pressure gauge) to the delivery pipe with the 2 gaskets and SST (union and union
bolt). SST 09268-45012
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf)
(f) Wipe off any splattered gasoline.
(g) Connect the TOYOTA hand-held tester to the DLC3. (h) Reconnect the negative (-) terminal
cable to the battery. (i) Turn the ignition switch ON. (j) Measure the fuel pressure.
Fuel pressure: 265 - 304 kPa (2.7 - 3.1 kgf/sq.cm, 38 - 44 psi)
If pressure is high. replace the fuel pressure regulator. If pressure is low, check these parts: Fuel hoses and connections
- Fuel pump
- Fuel filter
- Fuel pressure regulator
(k) Disconnect the TOYOTA hand-held tester from the DLC3.
Page 1009
Idle Speed: Specifications
Idle Speed 700 +/- 50 rpm
Page 4344
Location Of Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness, Ground Points (Fig 36)
Ground Points
Ground Points
Page 1697
Specification:
If the maximum pressure is less than the minimum standard value, replace the radiator cap
sub-assembly.
Type: Compact Cap, 108 kPa
1. Remove coolant and any foreign material on rubber points "A," "B," and "C."
2. Check that points "A" and "B" are not deformed, cracked, or swollen.
3. Check that points "B" and "C" are not stuck together.
4. Apply engine coolant to point "B" before using the radiator cap tester.
^ Radiator Cap Tester: Snap-On/Sun P/N SVTS262A (or equivalent)
5. Before installing the radiator cap tester, use the applicable radiator cap adaptor provided in the
following SST kits in conjunction with the radiator cap tester:
^ SST P/N 09230-00030-01 (09231-10080-01) or 09230-00020-01 (09231-10060-01) or
09230-00050-01 (09231-10110-01)
6. When using the radiator cap tester, tilt it more than 30 degrees.
Page 2369
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3580
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2469
6. INSPECT ECT SENSOR
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Resistance: Refer to the graph
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the ECT sensor.
7. REINSTALL ECT SENSOR
(a) Install a new gasket to the ECT sensor. (b) Using a 19 mm deep socket, install the ECT sensor.
Torque: 20 N.m (200 kgf.cm, 14 ft.lbf)
(c) Connect the ECT sensor connector.
8. REINSTALL FUEL PIPE
Install the fuel pipe with 4 new gaskets and the 2 union bolts.
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm. 25 ft.lbf)
9. REINSTALL NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER
10. RECONNECT UPPER RADIATOR HOSE TO WATER OUTLET 11. REFILL WITH ENGINE
COOLANT
Page 1330
Crankshaft: Testing and Inspection Main Journals and Crank Pins Inspection
1. Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of each main journal and crank pin.
Main journal diameter:
STD: 63.985 - 64.000 mm (2.5191 -2.5197 inch) U/S 0.25: 63.745 - 63.755 mm (2.5096 - 2.5100
inch)
Crank pin diameter:
STD: 54.987 - 55.000 mm (2.1648 - 2.1654 inch) U/S 0.25: 54.745 - 54.755 mm (2.1553 - 2.1557
inch)
If the diameter is not as specified, check the oil clearance.
2. Check each main journal and crank pin for taper and out-of-round as shown.
Maximum taper and out-of-round: 0.002 mm (0.0008 inch) If the taper and out-of-round is greater
than maximum, replace the crankshaft.
Page 1713
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 3519
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2496
Locations
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Locations
One Touch 2-4 Selector System
Page 2854
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 1717
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2036
Page 657
CHART 16
CHART 17
Page 728
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 792
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 3886
Location Of Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness, Ground Points (Fig 36)
Ground Points
Ground Points
Page 1091
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
PRECAUTION
1. BEFORE WORKING ON FUEL SYSTEM, DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (-) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
HINT: Any diagnostic trouble code retained by the computer will be erased when the negative (-)
terminal cable is removed from the battery. Therefore, if necessary, read the diagnosis before
removing the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery.
2. DO NOT SMOKE OR WORK NEAR AN OPEN FLAME WHEN WORKING ON FUEL SYSTEM
FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE PROCEDURE
WHEN DISCONNECTING THE HIGH FUEL PRESSURE LINE, A LARGE AMOUNT OF
GASOLINE WILL SPILL OUT, SO OBSERVE THESE PROCEDURES:
(1) Disconnect the fuel pump connector. (2) Start the engine. After the engine has stopped on its
own, turn the ignition switch to LOCK.
(3) Put a container under the connection. (4) Slowly loosen the connection. (5) Disconnect the
connection. (6) Plug the connection with a rubber plug.
WHEN CONNECTING THE FLARE NUT OR UNION BOLT ON THE HIGH PRESSURE PIPE
UNION, OBSERVE THESE PROCEDURES:
Union Bolt Type:
- Always use 2 new gaskets.
- Tighten the union bolt by hand.
- Tighten the union bolt to the specified torque.
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf)
Flare Nut Type: Apply a light coat of engine oil to the flare nut and tighten the flare nut by hand.
Page 3412
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 3159
Page 2729
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 3952
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Replacement
Clutch Slave Cylinder: Service and Repair Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect clutch line.
Using Special Service Tool (SST) 09023-00100, disconnect the line. use a container to catch the
fluid.
Torque: 15 N.m (11 ft. lbs.)
2. Remove 2 bolts and pull out release cylinder.
Torque: 13 N.m (108 inch lbs.)
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
HINT: After installation, bleed clutch system.
Page 2603
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Mechanical: Testing and Inspection
THROTTLE OPENER INSPECTION
INSPECT THROTTLE OPENER
(a) Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature. (b) Check idle speed.
Idle speed: 700 ± 50 rpm
(c) Disconnect the vacuum hose from the throttle opener and plug the hose end. (d) Check the
throttle opener setting speed.
Throttle opener setting speed: 900 - 1,950 rpm
If the throttle opener setting is not as specified, replace the throttle body.
(e) Stop the engine. (f) Reconnect the vacuum hose to the throttle opener. (g) Start the engine and
check that the idle speed returns to the correct speed.
Electrical Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Electrical Specifications
Resistance 10 - 20 K ohms at -4 deg F
4 - 7 K ohms at 32 deg F
2 - 3 K ohms at 68 deg F
0.9 - 1.3 K ohms at 104 deg F
0.4 - 0.7 K ohms at 140 deg F
0.2 - 0.4 K ohms at 176 deg F
Page 4595
Input Shaft: Service and Repair Manual Transmission
NOTE: For removal and installation procedures refer to "Transfer Case, Service and Repair."
DISASSEMBLY
Remove oil seal rings remove the 2 oil seal rings.
INSPECTION
1. Inspect input shaft.
a. Using a micrometer, measure the outer diameter of the input shaft journal surface.
Minimum Diameter: 47.59 mm (1.8736 inch)
b. Using a dial indicator, measure the inside diameter of the input shaft bushing.
Maximum Inside Diameter: 39.14 mm (1.5409 inch)
If the inside diameter exceeds the Maximum, replace the input shaft.
2. Inspect synchronizer ring.
Page 817
Page 3697
Page 3664
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 3395
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Front Drive Shaft Lock Nut 235 Nm (174 ft.lb)
Page 4073
Page 4568
Fluid Pump: Service and Repair
NOTE: For removal and installation procedures refer to "Transfer Case, Service and Repair."
DISASSEMBLY
1. Check oil pump operation install the oil pump drive gear to the drive rotor, check that the drive
rotor turns smoothly.
2. Remove relief valve and O-ring.
a. Mount the oil pump plate in a vise. b. Remove the relief valve and O-ring from the oil pump body.
Torque: 29.4 N.m (21 ft. lbs.)
INSTALLATION HINT: Coat a new O-ring with gear oil and install it to the oil pump body.
Page 1804
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 3789
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2392
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 4889
Remove the 2 mounting bolts and remove the caliper. Torque: 123 Nm (90 ft. lbs.)
4. Remove these parts:
- Clip.
- 2 pins.
- Anti-rattle spring.
- 2 pads.
- 4 anti-squeal shims.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
NOTE: After installation: Fill brake reservoir with brake fluid, bleed brake system. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair
- Check for leaks.
Page 1561
Fuel Pressure: Specifications Volume Specification
Information not supplied by the manufacturer.
Page 94
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 1806
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 24
If circuit is as specified, inspect the door lock signal and key-off power window signal.
2. INSPECT DOOR LOCK SIGNAL
HINT: When the relay circuit is as specified, inspect the door lock signal.
a. Connect the connector to the relay. b. Connect the positive (+) lead from the voltmeter to
terminal 1 and the negative (-) lead to terminal c. Set the door lock control switch to UNLOCK and
check that the voltage rises from 0 V to battery positive voltage for approximately 0.2
seconds.
d. Reverse the polarity of the voltmeter leads. e. Set the door lock control switch to LOCK and
check that the voltage rises from 0 V to battery positive voltage for approximately 0.2 seconds.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
Page 4767
ABS Main Relay: Description and Operation ABS Control (Solenoid) Relay
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This relay supplies power to each Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) solenoid. After the ignition switch
is turned ON, if the initial check is OK, the relay goes on.
FAIL SAFE FUNCTION
If trouble in the ABS control (solenoid) relay circuit, the Electronic Control Unit (ECU) cuts off
current to the ABS control (solenoid) relay and prohibits ABS control.
Page 525
Page 1782
Applicable Warranty*:
This repair is covered under the Federal Emissions Warranty. This warranty is in effect for 36
months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in service date.
*Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer's specific
complaint.
Page 3082
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Locations
Stop Light System
Page 4283
Center Support: Testing and Inspection
1. Inspect center support bearing for wear or damage.
^ Check that the bearing turns freely. If the bearing is damaged, worn, or does not turn freely,
replace it.
2. Inspect with double cardan joint propeller shaft.
HINT: Double cardan joint is used on 4WD rear propeller shafts.
a. Inspect the shaft for wear or damage. b. Inspect the double cardan joint for wear or damage.
If any problem is found, replace the propeller shaft assembly.
Page 2081
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2696
Warranty Information
Applicable warranty*: This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in
effect for 36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in-service date.
Coverage is extended to 36 months or 50,000 miles, whichever occurs first, in the states of
California and Massachusetts due to state emissions warranty legislation.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer's complaint.
Page 2612
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Service and Repair
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair
If necessary, replace extension housing oil seal. a. Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal. b.
Using SST 09950-60010 (09951-00570), 09950-70010 (09951-07150) and a hammer, drive in a
new oil seal.
Drive in depth: 45.6 ±0.5 mm (1.795 ±0.020 inch)
Page 3078
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 3483
Camshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Cam Sensor to Cylinder Head 69 in.lb
Page 1057
Timing Belt: Diagrams
Page 2257
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 546
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 3500
Page 4362
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 1646
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Specifications
Oil Pan: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Oil Pan To Cylinder Block
.........................................................................................................................................................
5.9 Nm (52 inch lbs.)
Page 2417
Brake Signal: Testing and Inspection
DTC P1520 Stop Light Switch Signal Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This signal is used to detect when the brakes have been applied. The STP signal voltage is the
same as the voltage supplied to the stop lights. The STP signal is used mainly to control the fuel
cut-off engine speed. (The fuel cut-off engine speed is reduced slightly when the vehicle is
braking.)
DETECTING CONDITION
WIRING DIAGRAM
Step 1
Page 2502
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 3415
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 441
Brake Light Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Knock Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Electrical Specifications
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Measure Terminals THA - E2 10 - 20 K ohms at -4 deg F
4 - 7 K ohms at 32 deg F
2 - 3 K ohms at 68 deg F
0.9 - 1.3 K ohms at 104 deg F
0.4 - 0.7 K ohms at 140 deg F
0.2 - 0.4 K ohms at 176 deg F
Page 1953
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 1085
Drive Belt: Tools and Equipment
Belt Tension Gauge:
Nippondenso BTG-20 (95506-00020) or Borroughs No.BT-33-73F
Diagrams
Standard Value Of ECU Terminals
Page 577
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR REMOVAL
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the crankshaft position sensor connector. (b) Remove the bolt crankshaft position
sensor.
Torque: 7.8 N.m (80 kgf.cm, 69 in.lbf)
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 2803
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Firing Order: 1-2-3-4-5-6
Page 62
Inspection Procedure / Main Switch Circuit (Cruise Control Switch) (2 Of 3)
Inspection Procedure / Main Switch Circuit (Cruise Control Switch) (3 Of 3)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Page 1619
REMOVAL
1. Remove timing belt. Refer to Engine. 2. Remove water inlet and thermostat. 3. Disconnect No. 2
oil cooler hose from water pump.
4. Remove water pump.
INSTALLATION
1. Install water pump.
(a) Remove any old packing Formed In Place Gasket (FIPG) material and be careful not to drop
any oil on the contact surfaces of the water pump and cylinder block. ^
Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove all the old packing FIPG material from the gasket
surfaces and sealing groove.
^ Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the loose material.
^ Using a non-residue solvent, clean both sealing surfaces.
(b) Apply seal packing to the water pump groove as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826 - 00100 or equivalent. ^
Install a nozzle that has been cut to a 2 - 3 mm (0.08 - 0.12 inch) opening.
^ Parts must be assembled within 5 minutes of application. Otherwise the material must be
removed and reapplied.
^ Immediately remove nozzle from the tube and reinstall cap.
Page 603
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Specifications
Shifter M/T: Specifications
Shift Lever Housing Set Bolt ................................................................................................................
................................................... 38 N.m (28 ft. lbs.) Control Shift Lever Retainer To:
Transfer Adaptor ..................................................................................................................................
............................................... 18 N.m (13 ft. lbs.)
Page 4354
P 1 PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW
4-Ground: Approx. 12 Volts with ignition SW ON position
O 4-B, S 4-A O/D MAIN SW
A-5-A-10, B-1-B-3: Open with O/D main SW at ON position Open with O/D main SW at OFF
position
S 5-A, B STOP LIGHT SW
A-1-A-2, B-1-B-2: Closed with Brake Pedal Depressed
E 5-A, E 6-D, E 7-C, E 8-B ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
S1-E1: 9-14 Volts
S2, SL-E1: 0-1.5 Volts
BK-E1: 7.5-14 Volts with Brake Pedal Depressed 0-1.5 Volts with Brake Pedal Released
THW-E2: 0.2-1.0 Volts with Coolant Temp. 80° C (176° F)
OIL-E2: 4-5 Volts with fluid Temp. 20° C (68° F)
IDL-E2:
0-3 Volts with Throttle Valve fully closed 9-14 Volts with Throttle Valve open
VTA-E2: 0.3-0.8 Volts with Throttle Valve fully closed 3.2-4.9 Volts with Throttle Valve fully open
VCC-E2: 4.5-5.5 Volts
OD1-E1: 4.5-5.5 Volts
OD2-E1: 9-14 Volts O/D main SW turned ON 0 Volts O/D main SW turned OFF
SP1-E1: Pulse Generation with vehicle moving
2-E1: 10-14 Volts with Shift Lever at 2 position 0-2 Volts with shift lever at expect 2 position
L-E1: 10-14 Volts with Shift Lever at L position 0-2 Volts with Shift Lever at expect L position
L4-E1: 10-14 Volts with Transfer Shift at H2 or H4 position 0 Volts with Transfer shift at L4 position
OIL-W-E1: 0.1-4.9 Volts
+B-E1: 9-14 Volts
BATT-E1: 9-14 Volts
Splice Points
Splice Points
Locations
Page 1295
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT VALVE LIFTERS AND LIFTER BORES
1. Using a caliper gauge, measure the lifter bore diameter of the cylinder head.
Lifter bore diameter: 31.000 - 31.018 mm (1.2205 - 1.2212 inch).
2. Using a micrometer, measure the lifter diameter.
Lifter diameter: 30.966 - 30.976 mm (1.2191 - 1.2195 inch).
3. Subtract the lifter diameter measurement from the lifter bore diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance: 0.024 - 0.052 mm (0.0009 - 0.0020 inch) Maximum oil clearance: 0.08 mm
(0.0031 inch). If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the lifter. If necessary,
replace the cylinder head.
Electrical Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Cold Hot
Between Terminals NE+ and NE- 1,630 - 2,740 ohms at 14 - 122 deg F 2,065 - 3,225 ohms at 122
- 212 deg F
Page 3224
Page 1906
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Fuel - Idle Speed Increased by Replacement ECM
Idle Speed: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Idle Speed Increased by Replacement ECM
ENGINE EG001-98
FEBRUARY 13, 1998
2RZ ECM IDLE SPEED
MODELS: '95-'97 TACOMA
Introduction Operating logic of 1995-1997 Tacoma ECMs has been revised to improve engine idle
smoothness (with transmission in "D" range) by increasing idle speed (A/C "OFF") from 600 RPM
to 700 RPM. The change has also narrowed the RPM transition between A/C "OFF" and A/C "ON"
engagement.
Affected Vehicles 1995-1997 Tacoma 4x2 equipped with 2RZ-FE four cylinder engine and automatic transmission.
Part Number Information
Production Change Information No production changes have been made.
- This change applies only to replacement ECMs available through parts supply.
Warranty Information
Applicable Warranty: This repair is covered under the Toyota Powertrain Warranty. This warranty Is
in effect for 60 months or 60,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in service date.
Page 3889
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Specifications
Ignition Cable: Specifications
Maximum Resistance per Cord 25 K ohms
Page 3635
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 3123
(a) Install the VSV with the screw. (b) Connect the connector and 2 EVAP hoses to the VSV.
Locations
Blower Motor Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 2007
Components For Removal And Installation Part 2 Of 2
Page 4384
d. Turn the reverse synchronizer pull ring, separate the pull ring and cone ring. e. Push the shifting
key and spring, and remove the 3 shifting keys and springs to the reverse synchronizer ring.
Page 4351
Position Of Parts In Instrument Panel (1 Of 2) (Fig 28)
Page 3866
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Fluid Type T-IV Replaces Type T-II
TRANSMISSION & CLUTCH TC003-98
June 19, 1998
Title: AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID TYPE T-IV
Models: ALL MODELS
Introduction
The introduction of Automatic Transmission Fluid type T-IV makes type T-II obsolete. Use type T-IV
for all applications that specify ATF type T-II.
Affected Vehicles
^ All vehicles with Automatic Transmissions specified to use ATF Types T-II or T-IV.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Page 2999
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Service Precautions
Fuel Pressure Release: Service Precautions
WARNING: Adhere to the following procedures any time the fuel system is being worked on in
order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury:
- Keep a dry chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher near the work area.
- Place a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the work area.
- Work in a well-ventilated area. Do not smoke, and keep sparks and open flames away.
- Wear eye protection.
- Use caution when working near the catalytic converter to prevent the possibility of burns or fire.
(The temperatures within the converter can exceed 537°C (1000°F).)
- Relieve the fuel system pressure prior to disconnecting fuel system components.
- Disconnect the negative battery cable except for tests where battery voltage is required.
- Use a suitable container to store or catch fuel.
- Do not replace fuel pipe with fuel hose.
- Plug all disconnected fuel line fittings and hoses.
- After making any fuel system repairs ALWAYS inspect for fuel leaks.
- If available, use system bleed (schrader) valve to relieve fuel system pressure.
Page 2675
CHART 18
CHART 19
Page 3005
Page 3510
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Crankshaft Sensor to Oil Pump 69 in.lb
Page 2718
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
HEATED OXYGEN SENSORS INSPECTION (Bank 1, Sensor 1, Bank 1 Sensor 2)
INSPECT HEATER RESISTANCE OF HEATED OXYGEN SENSORS
(a) Disconnect the oxygen sensor connector.
Bank 1 Sensor 1
Bank 1 Sensor 2
(b) Using an ohmmeter. measure the resistance between the terminals +B and HT.
Resistance: At 20°C (68°F): 11 - 16 ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the sensor.
Torque: 20 N.m (200 kgf.cm, 14 ft.lbf)
(c) Reconnect the oxygen sensor connector.
Page 3317
a. Check the fuel lines for cracks or leakage, and all connections for deformation. b. Check the fuel
tank vapor vent system hoses and connections for looseness, sharp bends or damage.
c. Check the fuel tank for deformation, cracks, fuel leakage or tank band looseness. d. Check the
filler neck for damage or fuel leakage.
e. Hose and pipe connections are as shown in the illustration.
If a problem is found, repair or replace the parts as necessary.
Page 952
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
ON-VEHICLE REPAIR
1 DISCONNECT NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
2. REMOVE NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
a. Remove the bolt and No.1 vehicle speed sensor assembly. b. Remove the speedometer driven
gear and O-ring from the No.1 vehicle speed sensor.
3. INSTALL NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
a. Coat a new O-ring with ATF. b. Install the O-ring and speedometer driven gear to the No.1
vehicle speed sensor. c. Install the No.1 vehicle speed sensor to the extension housing and torque
the bolt.
Torque: 16 Nm (160 kgf-cm, 12 ft. lbs.)
4. CONNECT NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR 5. DISCONNECT NO.2 VEHICLE
SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
6. REMOVE NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
a. Remove the bolt and No.2 vehicle speed sensor. b. Remove the O-ring from the No.2 vehicle
speed sensor.
7. INSTALL NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
a. Coat a new O-ring with ATF and install it to the No.2 vehicle speed sensor. b. Install the No.2
vehicle speed sensor and torque the bolt.
Page 3077
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 783
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 137
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 3951
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 4238
Front Drive Shaft
Page 3443
HINT: Install the filter with the coarser surface facing the atmospheric side (outward).
4. INSPECT THROTTLE OPENER
(a) Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature. (b) Check idle speed.
Idle speed: 700 ± 50 rpm
(c) Disconnect the vacuum hose from the throttle opener and plug the hose end. (d) Check the
throttle opener setting speed.
Throttle opener setting speed: 900 - 1,950 rpm
If the throttle opener setting is not as specified, replace the throttle body.
(e) Stop the engine. (f) Reconnect the vacuum hose to the throttle opener. (g) Start the engine and
check that the idle speed returns to the correct speed.
Page 2411
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 3573
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 499
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT AIR CLEANER CAP FROM MAF METER
2. REMOVE MAF METER
(a) Disconnect the MAF meter connector. (b) Remove the 2 bolts and MAF meter.
Torque: 6.9 N.m (72 kgf.cm, 61 in.lbf)
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Electrical Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Cold Hot
Between Terminals NE+ and NE- 1,630 - 2,740 ohms at 14 - 122 deg F 2,065 - 3,225 ohms at 122
- 212 deg F
Page 1533
Page 810
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 864
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2181
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3528
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The crankshaft position sensor, which detects the engine speed and crankshaft angle signal (NE
signal), has been installed on the oil pump body. The NE signal plate has 34 teeth. The NE signal
sensor generates 34 signals for every engine revolution. The ECM detects the standard crankshaft
angle based on the G signals and the actual crankshaft angle and the engine speed by the NE
signals.
Page 2623
Components For Removal And Installation Part 2 Of 2
Page 1933
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2801
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 883
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Locations
ECT Temperature Sender Gauge / Low Oil Pressure Warning Switch
Page 2444
Page 1741
Thermostat: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Drain engine coolant. 2. Disconnect lower radiator hose. 3. Remove thermostat.
(a) Remove the 3 nuts, water inlet and thermostat with gasket from the water pump.
(b) Remove the gasket from the thermostat.
INSTALLATION
1. Install thermostat.
(a) Place a new gasket to the thermostat.
Page 3311
a. Check the fuel lines for cracks or leakage, and all connections for deformation. b. Check the fuel
tank vapor vent system hoses and connections for looseness, sharp bends or damage.
c. Check the fuel tank for deformation, cracks, fuel leakage or tank band looseness. d. Check the
filler neck for damage or fuel leakage.
e. Hose and pipe connections are as shown in the illustration.
If a problem is found, repair or replace the parts as necessary.
Testing and Inspection
Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Inspect relay operation.
a. Jack up the vehicle. b. Use a heater main relay and connect it, as shown below. c. Rotate the
tire and check that differential lock has occurred. if operation is not as specified, replace the
actuator.
2. Inspect Diff. Lock control switch continuity. Inspect the switch continuity between terminal 1 to
terminal 4.
HINT: If it is not continuity, replace the switch.
3. Inspect Diff. Lock position switch.
a. Check that there is continuity between terminals when the switch is pushed (differential
connected position). b. Check that there is no continuity when the switch is free (differential
disconnected position).
HINT: If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
4. Inspect transfer 4WD switch. 5. Inspect vehicle speed sensor.
Page 1259
Towing Information: Technical Service Bulletins Vehicle - Towing Guide
ACCESSORIES AX004-99
March 19, 1999
Title: TOYOTA "DINGHY" TOWING GUIDE
Models:
All Models
Introduction: The following chart indicates which Toyota vehicles can be Dinghy towed (towed with
four wheels on the ground) behind a Motorhome.
CAUTION:
Dinghy towing 6 vehicle behind a Motorhome requires special towing equipment and accessories.
Please see your Motorhome Manufacturer / Service Outlet for recommended towing equipment.
Affected Vehicles
- All Models
Vehicles that are Dinghy towable will not sustain internal damage to the transmission or transfer
components. The transmission must be placed in the "neutral" position when Dinghy towing.
Dinghy towing these vehicles does not eliminate the possibility of damage to other vehicle systems
(Body, Chassis, Electrical Systems, etc.).
Warranty Information
Testing and Inspection
Clutch Release Bearing: Testing and Inspection
Inspect release bearing.
Turn the bearing by hand while applying force in the axial direction.
HINT: the bearing is permanently lubricated and re-quires no cleaning or lubrication.
If necessary, replace the release bearing.
Page 3641
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The camshaft position sensor, which detects the crankshaft angle signal (G signal), has been
installed on the front of right bank cylinder head. The timing rotor has been integrated with the right
bank camshaft timing pulley. When the camshafts rotate, the protrusion on the timing rotor and the
air gap on the pick up coil change, causing fluctuations, in the magnetic field and generating an
electromotive force in the pick up coil. The NE signal plate has 34 teeth and is mounted on the
crankshaft. The NE signal sensor generates 34 signals for every engine revolution. The ECM
detects the standard crankshaft angle based on the 6 signals and the actual crankshaft angle and
the engine speed by the NE signals.
Page 511
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 1405
Valve: Service and Repair Installation
1. Using Special Service Tool (SST) Valve Stem Oil Seal Replacer # 09201 - 41020 or equivalent,
push in a new oil seal.
NOTE: The intake valve oil seal is sliver and the exhaust valve oil seal is black.
2. Install these parts:
(1) Valve. (2) Spring seat. (3) Valve spring. (4) Spring retainer.
3. Using SST Valve Spring Compressor # 09202 - 70020 (Attachment # 09202 - 00010) or
equivalents, compress the valve spring and place the 2
keepers around the valve stem.
Page 2579
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 3375
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
EFI MAIN RELAY INSPECTION
1. REMOVE EFI MAIN RELAY (Marking: EFI) 2. INSPECT EFI MAIN RELAY
A. Inspect relay continuity
(a) Using an ohmmeter. check that there is continuity between terminals 1 and 2.
If there is no continuity. replace the relay.
(b) Check that there is no continuity between terminals and 5.
If there is continuity. replace the relay.
B. Inspect relay operation
(a) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 1 and 2. (b) Using an ohmmeter, check that
there is continuity between terminals 3 and 5.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
3. REINSTALL EFI MAIN RELAY
Page 1809
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 3061
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4134
2. Assemble differential case.
a. Install the proper thrust washers on the side gears.
Washer thickness:
0.96 - 1.04 mm (0.0378 - 0.0409 inch) 1.06 - 1.14 mm (0.0417 - 0.0449 inch) 1.16 - 1.24 mm
(0.0457 - 0.0488 inch) 1.26 - 1.34 mm (0.0496 - 0.0528 inch)
HINT: Select thrust washers which will ensure that the backlash is within the specifications.
b. Install the side gears, pinion gears, pinion gear thrust washers and pinion shaft in the differential
case.
HINT: Align the holes of the differential case and pinion shaft.
c. Measure the side gear backlash with holding one pinion gear toward the differential case. If the
backlash is not within the specification, install
side gear thrust washers with different thicknesses.
Backlash: 0 - 0.20 mm (0 - 0.0079 inch)
3. Install straight pin and stake differential case.
a. Using a pin punch and a hammer, install the straight pin through the differential case and hole of
the pinion shaft b. Stake the differential case.
4. Install ring gear on differential case.
a. Clean the contact surfaces of the differential case and ring gear.
Page 2687
Page 2100
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 293
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2393
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 249
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection Door Key Lock and Unlock Switch
DOOR KEY LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT SWITCH CONTINUITY
LH: If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
RH:
Page 1030
Page 3796
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 3554
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 35
ABS Control (Motor) Relay Circuit Inspection Procedure (Part 2 Of 2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) control (motor) relay supplies power to the ABS pump motor.
While the ABS is activated, the Electronic Control Unit (ECU) switches the ABS control (motor)
relay ON and operates the ABS pump motor.
FAIL SAFE FUNCTION
If trouble occurs in the ABS control (motor) relay circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS control
(solenoid) relay and prohibits ABS control.
Page 3626
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Supercharger - Squeak/Rattle Noises From Idler Pulley
Supercharger: All Technical Service Bulletins Supercharger - Squeak/Rattle Noises From Idler
Pulley
REF.: 3.4L V6 SUPERCHARGER
NO.: SC001-00
DATE: AUGUST 1, 2000
MODEL: 4Runner, Tacoma, T100, and Tundra with 3.4L V6.
SUPERCHARGER DRIVE-BELT IDLER PULLEY
Due to a possible out-of-tolerance condition on the idler pulley shaft, some pulleys may have
bearings that spin on the inner shaft and may cause a squeaking or rattling noise. The
supercharger may be perfectly fine and the source of the noise may simply be the idler pulley
PART NUMBER INFORMATION
PRODUCTION EFFECTIVE:
Supercharger Assemblies with Serial Numbers from: 10481
to: 10990
CHECK PROCEDURE:
This condition can be verified by removing the supercharger drive belt and checking the movement
of the pulley on the shaft The pulley should not slide fore and aft on the shaft.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE:
Loosen the drive belt. Remove the idler plate assembly. Retain all the hardware. Remove the idler
pulley sub-assembly from the idler plate assembly. Replace it with the supplied new idler pulley
sub-assembly. Replace the idler plate assembly and all of the hardware. The tightening torques are
shown in the table.
Reinstall and tension the drive belt to 120-ft lbs. for a new belt or 80 ft lbs. for a used belt (any belt
used for more than 10 minutes).
WARRANTY INFORMATION:* * The idler pulley assembly is warrantable only for 12 months from
the point-of-first-sale. If the supercharger assembly was dealer installed, then TRD matches the
balance of the new vehicle powertrain warranty.
Page 485
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Knock Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
KNOCK SENSOR INSPECTION
1. REMOVE KNOCK SENSORS
See: Service and Repair
2. INSPECT KNOCK SENSORS
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between the terminal and body. If there is
continuity, replace the sensor.
Page 3567
Page 3905
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 2528
Data Link Connector: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2053
CHART 22
Page 832
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Testing and Inspection
Fuel Filler Cap: Testing and Inspection
FUEL FILLER CAP INSPECTION
1. VISUALLY INSPECT FUEL TANK CAP
Check if the cap and/or gasket are deformed or damaged. If necessary. repair or replace the cap.
Page 3562
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2946
CHART 21
Page 2770
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 2268
Ignition Switch: Testing and Inspection
IGNITION SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT SWITCH CONTINUITY
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Page 1854
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 4295
Use a grease gun to apply multi-purpose grease to the No. 1, 2, 3, 7 and the slip yoke grease
fittings. Apply molybdenum disulfide lithium base chassis grease, NLGI No. 2, to the No. 4, 5, and 6
grease fittings (double cardan joint).
Specifications
Clutch Release Fork: Specifications
Release Fork Support ..........................................................................................................................
..................................................... 47 N.m (35 ft. lbs.)
Page 760
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
The No.1 vehicle speed sensor outputs a 4-pulse signal for every revolution of the rotor shaft,
which is rotated by the transmission output shaft via the driven gear.
After this signal is converted into a more precise rectangular waveform by the waveform shaping
circuit inside the combination meter, it is then transmitted to the ECM. The ECM determines the
vehicle speed based on the frequency of these pulse signals.
The No.2 vehicle speed sensor detects the rotation speed of the transmission output shaft and
sends signals to the ECM. The ECM determines the vehicle speed based on these signals.
An AC voltage is generated in the No.2 vehicle speed sensor coil as the rotor mounted on the
output shaft rotates, and this voltage is sent to the ECM.
The gear shift point and lock-up timing are controlled by the ECM based on the signals from this
vehicle speed sensor and the throttle position sensor signal.
If the No.2 vehicle speed sensor malfunctions, the ECM uses input signals from the No.1 vehicle
speed sensor as a back-up signal.
Electrical Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Electrical Specifications
Resistance 10 - 20 K ohms at -4 deg F
4 - 7 K ohms at 32 deg F
2 - 3 K ohms at 68 deg F
0.9 - 1.3 K ohms at 104 deg F
0.4 - 0.7 K ohms at 140 deg F
0.2 - 0.4 K ohms at 176 deg F
Page 1032
5. RECONNECT HIGH-TENSION CORDS TO IGNITION COILS
(a) Assemble the holder and grommet.
(b) Align the spline of the ignition coil with the spline of the holder and push in the cord.
NOTICE: Check that the holder is correctly installed to the grommet and distributor cap as shown in
the illustration.
(c) Check that the lock claw of the holder is engaged by lightly pulling the holder.
6. RECONNECT HIGH-TENSION CORDS TO SPARK PLUGS 7. REINSTALL AIR CLEANER
HOSE
Specifications
Gear Sensor/Switch: Specifications
4WD-position Switch ...........................................................................................................................
................................................... 37 N.m (27 ft. lbs.) L4 Position Switch .............................................
...................................................................................................................................... 37 N.m (27 ft.
lbs.) Neutral Position Switch ................................................................................................................
........................................................... 37 N.m (27 ft. lbs.)
Electrical Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Resistance Cold Resistance Hot
835 - 1,400 ohms at 14 - 122 deg F 1,060 - 1,645 ohms at 122 - 212 deg F
Page 3013
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 3225
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
System Schematic
Sensor Cut-Away
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The mass air flow meter uses a platinum hot wire. The hot wire air flow meter consists of a
platinum hot wire, thermistor and a control circuit installed in a plastic housing. The hot wire air flow
meter works on the principle that the hot wire and thermistor located in the intake air bypass of the
housing detect any changes in the intake air temperature. The hot wire is maintained at the set
temperature by controlling the current flow through the hot wire. This current flow is then measured
as the output voltage of the air flow meter. The circuit is constructed so that the platinum hot wire
and thermistor provide a bridge circuit, with the power transistor controlled so that the potential of
(A) and (B) remains equal to maintain the set temperature.
Page 513
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 1954
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 521
Page 1659
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
ECT SENSOR INSPECTION
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT 2. DISCONNECT UPPER RADIATOR HOSE FROM WATER
OUTLET 3. REMOVE NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER 4. REMOVE FUEL PIPE 5. REMOVE ECT
SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the ECT sensor connector.
(b) Using a 19 mm deep socket wrench. remove the ECT sensor and gasket.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2046
CHART 14
Testing and Inspection
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT BRAKE FLUID LEVEL WARNING SWITCH CONTINUITY
1. Check that there is no continuity between terminals with the switch OFF (float up). 2. Check that
there is continuity between terminals with the switch ON (float down).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
Page 3685
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 4365
Electronically Controlled Transmission And A/T Indicator-Connectors
Electrical Specifications
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Measure Terminals THA - E2 10 - 20 K ohms at -4 deg F
4 - 7 K ohms at 32 deg F
2 - 3 K ohms at 68 deg F
0.9 - 1.3 K ohms at 104 deg F
0.4 - 0.7 K ohms at 140 deg F
0.2 - 0.4 K ohms at 176 deg F
Page 3056
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 2889
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 4130
18. W/ A.D.D.: Remove bearing. Using a brass bar and a hammer, remove the 2 bearings.
Inspection
Page 2397
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Figure 1
Reference
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The intake air temp. sensor is built into the air flow meter and senses the intake air temperature. A
thermistor built in the sensor changes the resistance value according to the intake air temperature.
The lower the intake air temperature, the greater the thermistor resistance value and the higher the
intake air temperature, the lower the thermistor resistance value (See Fig.1.). The intake air
temperature sensor is connected to the ECM (See below). The 5 V power source voltage in the
ECM is applied to the intake air temperature sensor from the terminal THA via a resistor R. That is,
the resistor R and the intake air temperature sensor are connected in series. When the resistance
value of the intake air temperature sensor changes in accordance with changes in the intake air
temperature, the potential at terminal THA also changes. Based on this signal, the ECM increases
the fuel injection volume to improve driveability during cold engine operation.
Page 964
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
2-4 Selector Switch
Inspect 2-4 selector switch continuity. Test continuity between terminals 1 and 2.
Switch position: Specified condition.
OFF: No continuity. ON: Continuity.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the shift lever knob.
Page 1105
E. Install the new condenser brackets onto the condenser.
Tightening Torque:
6x30 mm: 4.0 ft/lbf (5.4 N.m, 55 Kgf/cm)
6x16 mm: 7.2 ft/lbf (9.8 N.m, 100 Kgf/cm)
6x18 mm: 9.2 ft/lbf (12.6 N.m, 127 Kgf/cm)
CAUTION:
To prevent damage to the condenser's plastic supports please Install the 6 x 16 mm bolts first, the
6 x 18 mm bolts second, and the 6 x 30 mm bolts last.
2. Replace Liquid Tube # 1:
A. Remove original liquid tube # 1.
B. Install the new plastic clamp eight rows down and 110 mm in from the left as illustrated and then
install new liquid tube, retaining the
Page 1799
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 3880
Page 2954
CHART 26
Page 3794
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 3904
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
A/C Belt
Drive Belt: Specifications A/C Belt
DRIVE BELT
New belt ...............................................................................................................................................
............................................................... 160 ± 25 lb.
Used belt .............................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 100 ± 20 lb.
Page 2205
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Supercharger - Squeak/Rattle Noises From Idler Pulley
Supercharger: Customer Interest Supercharger - Squeak/Rattle Noises From Idler Pulley
REF.: 3.4L V6 SUPERCHARGER
NO.: SC001-00
DATE: AUGUST 1, 2000
MODEL: 4Runner, Tacoma, T100, and Tundra with 3.4L V6.
SUPERCHARGER DRIVE-BELT IDLER PULLEY
Due to a possible out-of-tolerance condition on the idler pulley shaft, some pulleys may have
bearings that spin on the inner shaft and may cause a squeaking or rattling noise. The
supercharger may be perfectly fine and the source of the noise may simply be the idler pulley
PART NUMBER INFORMATION
PRODUCTION EFFECTIVE:
Supercharger Assemblies with Serial Numbers from: 10481
to: 10990
CHECK PROCEDURE:
This condition can be verified by removing the supercharger drive belt and checking the movement
of the pulley on the shaft The pulley should not slide fore and aft on the shaft.
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE:
Loosen the drive belt. Remove the idler plate assembly. Retain all the hardware. Remove the idler
pulley sub-assembly from the idler plate assembly. Replace it with the supplied new idler pulley
sub-assembly. Replace the idler plate assembly and all of the hardware. The tightening torques are
shown in the table.
Reinstall and tension the drive belt to 120-ft lbs. for a new belt or 80 ft lbs. for a used belt (any belt
used for more than 10 minutes).
WARRANTY INFORMATION:* * The idler pulley assembly is warrantable only for 12 months from
the point-of-first-sale. If the supercharger assembly was dealer installed, then TRD matches the
balance of the new vehicle powertrain warranty.
Testing and Inspection
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY INSPECTION
1. REMOVE CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY 2. INSPECT CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
A. Inspect relay continuity
(a) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between terminals ST and E1
If there no continuity, replace the relay.
(b) Check that there is continuity between terminals +B and FC.
If there no continuity, replace the relay.
(c) Check that there is no continuity between terminals +B and FP.
If there no continuity, replace the relay.
B. Inspect relay operation
(a) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals ST and E1.
Page 3588
Page 838
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 2713
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2135
Page 2064
CHART 28
Page 3859
Overdrive Brake
Page 655
CHART 14
Page 2588
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 4789
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications
Mounting Bolt 71 in.lb
Page 166
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 4317
7: 2.400-2.450 mm (0.0945-0.0965 inch) 8: 2.450-2.500 mm (0.0965-0.0984 inch)
b. Using a hammer, tap the yoke until there is no clearance between the bearing outer race and
snap ring.
7. Check spider bearing.
^ Check that the spider baring moves smoothly.
^ Check the spider bearing axial play.
Bearing axial play: Maximum 0.05 mm (0.0020 inch)
HINT: Install new spider bearings on the shaft side in the procedure described above.
Page 1982
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 4149
6. Check drive pinion preload. Using a torque wrench, measure the preload of backlash between
the drive pinion and ring gear.
Preload (at starting): 0.6 - 0.9 Nm (5.7 - 8.3 inch lbs.)
7. Check total preload. Using a torque wrench, measure the preload with the teeth of the drive
pinion and ring gear in contact.
Total preload (at starting): Drive pinion preload plus: 0.4 - 0.6 Nm (3.5 - 5.2 inch lbs.)
If necessary, disassemble and inspect the differential.
Disassembly
Page 2126
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2744
Engine Control-Connectors
Page 3109
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
ON-VEHICLE REPAIR
1 DISCONNECT NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
2. REMOVE NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
a. Remove the bolt and No.1 vehicle speed sensor assembly. b. Remove the speedometer driven
gear and O-ring from the No.1 vehicle speed sensor.
3. INSTALL NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
a. Coat a new O-ring with ATF. b. Install the O-ring and speedometer driven gear to the No.1
vehicle speed sensor. c. Install the No.1 vehicle speed sensor to the extension housing and torque
the bolt.
Torque: 16 Nm (160 kgf-cm, 12 ft. lbs.)
4. CONNECT NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR 5. DISCONNECT NO.2 VEHICLE
SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
6. REMOVE NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
a. Remove the bolt and No.2 vehicle speed sensor. b. Remove the O-ring from the No.2 vehicle
speed sensor.
7. INSTALL NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
a. Coat a new O-ring with ATF and install it to the No.2 vehicle speed sensor. b. Install the No.2
vehicle speed sensor and torque the bolt.
With ABS
Brake Master Cylinder: Service and Repair With ABS
Master Cylinder Components
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect level warning switch connector. 2. Take out fluid with syringe.
CAUTION: Do not let brake fluid remain on a painted surface. Wash it off immediately.
3. Disconnect brake lines.
Using Special Service Tool (SST) # 09023-00100, disconnect the 5 brake lines.
Page 4543
Position Of Parts In Instrument Panel (1 Of 2) (Fig 28)
Page 2933
CHART 2
CHART 3
CHART 4
Page 807
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 3993
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 3029
Electrode Gap Specification
Spark Plug: Specifications Electrode Gap Specification
Electrode Gap
Correct Gap .........................................................................................................................................
...................................................... 1.1 mm (0.043 in.)
Page 2481
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4045
Valve Body: Service and Repair
VALVE BODY
COMPONENTS
VALVE BODY DISASSEMBLY
1. UNBOLT AND REMOVE DETENT SPRING
2. REMOVE MANUAL VALVE
Page 396
Air Conditioning Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL OF A/C SWITCH
Using a screw driver, pry loose the clip and remove the A/C switch.
REMOVAL HINT: Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
A/C SWITCH INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 1275
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications Tightening Specifications
Camshaft Timing Pulley
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
......................... 110 N-m (1,100 kgf-cm, 91 ft-lbf)
Page 9
Antenna Relay: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT ANTENNA MOTOR CONTROL RELAY CIRCUIT
Disconnect the connector from the relay and inspect the connector on wire harness side, as shown
in the chart.
If circuit is as specified, replace the relay.
Page 3695
Knock Sensor: Exploded Views
Components For Removal And Installation Part 1 Of 2
Specifications
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Knock Sensor to Cylinder Block 29 ft.lb
Page 1718
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4868
Brake Shoe: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 4 Measuring Brake Shoe Lining Thickness
LINING THICKNESS
1. Using a ruler, measure the shoe lining thickness.
- Standard thickness: 6.0 mm (0.236 inch)
- Minimum thickness: 1.0 mm (0.039 inch)
2. If the shoe lining is less than the minimum, or shows signs of uneven wear, replace the brake
shoes.
NOTE: If any of the brake shoes have to be replaced, replace all of the rear brake shoes in order to
maintain even braking.
3. Inspect brake lining and drum for proper contact.
NOTE: If the contact between the brake lining and drum is improper, repair the lining with a brake
shoe grinder, or replace the brake shoe assembly.
Page 1279
Camshaft: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT CAMSHAFTS
1. Inspect camshaft for runout.
(a) Place the camshaft on V-blocks.
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the circle runout at the center journal.
Maximum circle runout: 0.06 mm (0.0024 inch) If the circle runout is greater than the maximum,
replace the camshaft.
2. Inspect cam lobes.
Using a micrometer, measure the cam lobe height. Standard cam lobe height:
Intake: 42.31 - 42.41 mm (1.6657 - 1.6697 inch) Exhaust: 41.96 - 42.06 mm (1.6520 - 1.6559 inch)
Minimum cam lobe height:
Intake: 42.16 mm (1.6598 inch) Exhaust: 41.81 mm (1.6461 inch)
If the cam lobe height is greater than the maximum, replace the camshaft.
3. Inspect camshaft journals.
Using a micrometer, measure the journal diameter. Journal diameter: 26.949 - 26.965 mm (1.0610
- 1.0616 inch) If the journal diameter is not as specified, check the oil clearance.
4. Inspect camshaft gear spring.
Page 207
Airbag Sensor Assembly
Page 809
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 3997
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 446
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Removal
Valve: Service and Repair Removal
1. Using Special Service Tool (SST) Valve Spring Compressor # 09202 - 70020 (Attachment #
09202 - 00010) or equivalents, compress the valve
spring and remove the 2 keepers.
2. Remove these parts:
- Spring retainer.
- Valve spring.
- Valve.
3. Using needle-nose pliers, remove the oil seal.
4. Using compressed air and a magnetic finger, remove the spring seat by blowing air.
NOTE: Arrange the valves, valve springs, spring seats and spring retainers in the correct order.
Page 828
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Specifications
Evaporative Emission Control Canister: Specifications
Evaporative Canister Bracket to Body 23 ft.lb
Locations
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 3291
(c) Remove the 2 bolts. and pull out the pressure regulator. (d) Remove the O-ring from the
pressure regulator.
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR INSTALLATION
1. INSTALL FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
(a) Apply a light coat of gasoline to a new O-ring and install it to the pressure regulator. (b) Attach
the pressure regulator to the LH delivery pipe.
(c) Check that the pressure regulator rotates smoothly.
NOTICE: If it does not rotate smoothly, the O-ring may be pinched, so remove the pressure
regulator and repeat steps (a) to (c) above.
(d) Install the pressure regulator with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8 N.m (80 kgf.cm. 71 in.lbf)
(e) Install the engine wire with the bolt.
2. CONNECT FUEL RETURN HOSE TO FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
NOTICE: Be sure to insert the hose up to the stopper and clip it.
3. INSTALL INTAKE AIR CONNECTOR 4. INSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE 5. CHECK FOR FUEL
LEAKS
Page 3651
Page 2948
Page 4245
NOTICE: Do not scratch the serration of the speed sensor rotor.
5. w/ Free wheel hub: Install new lock nut.
a. Using SST 09318 - 12010, install and torque a new nut to the axle hub.
Torque to 274 Nm (203 ft. lbs.)
b. Using a chisel and hammer, stake the nut.
6. w/o Free wheel hub: Install bearing spacer. Using SST 09950-60010 (09951-00650),
09950-70010 (09951-07150) and a press, install the bearing
spacer.
7. Install new oil seal (Inside).
a. Using SST 09527-17011 and a plastic hammer, install a new oil seal (inside).
HINT: Strike the SST on its circumference evenly.
b. Coat MP grease to the oil seal lip.
Front Wheel Hub Bolt
Page 896
Knock Sensor: Exploded Views
Components For Removal And Installation Part 1 Of 2
Page 2275
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 2069
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - Oxygen Sensor Improvement
ENGINE EG006-99
Title: 5VZ OXYGEN SENSOR IMPROVEMENT
Models: '96 - '99 Tacoma
June 18, 1999
Introduction The design of the 5VZ Oxygen Sensor inner cover has been changed 10 reduce the
possibility of moisture contacting the ceramic element.
Affected Vehicles ^
1996-1999 model year Tacomas built before the VINs listed below.
Repair Procedure Please refer to the appropriate repair manual for diagnostic and installation
information for the Oxygen Sensor.
Part Number Information
Page 1973
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
How to Read Adjustment Chart
Alignment: Service and Repair How to Read Adjustment Chart
Adjustment Chart
HOW TO READ ADJUSTMENT CHART
a. Find the wheel alignment standard value applicable for the particular model. b. Mark the selected
standard value on the adjustment chart.
Electrical Specifications
EGR Temperature Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Note: Except Model VZN170 (Long wheel base 4WD Pickup)
Resistance 64 - 97 K ohms at 122 deg F
11 - 16 K ohms at 212 deg F
2 - 4 K ohms at 302 deg F
Page 298
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
ECT SENSOR INSPECTION
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT 2. DISCONNECT UPPER RADIATOR HOSE FROM WATER
OUTLET 3. REMOVE NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER 4. REMOVE FUEL PIPE 5. REMOVE ECT
SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the ECT sensor connector.
(b) Using a 19 mm deep socket wrench. remove the ECT sensor and gasket.
Page 297
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A thermistor built into the engine coolant temperature sensor changes the resistance value
according to the engine coolant temperature. The structure of the sensor and connection to the
ECM is the same as in the intake air temp. circuit malfunction.
Page 3804
Transmission Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Vehicle NO.2 Speed Sensor Inspection Procedure
- Remove NO.2 vehicle speed sensor. - Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of NO.2
vehicle speed sensor.
Resistance: 560 Ohms to 680 Ohms
- Check voltage between terminals 1 and 2 of the NO.2 speed sensor when a magnet is put close
to the front end of the NO.2 vehicle speed sensor
then taken away quickly.
- Voltage is generated intermittenly.
Note: The voltages generated is extremely low.
Page 4728
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch goes on when the shift lever is in the N or P shift position. When it
goes on terminal NSW of the ECM is grounded to body ground via the starter relay, thus the
terminal NSW voltage becomes 0 V. When the shift lever is in the D, 2, L or R position, the
park/neutral position switch goes off, so the voltage of ECM, terminal NSW becomes battery
voltage, the voltage of the ECM internal power source.
If the shift lever is moved from the N position to the D position, this signal is used for air-fuel ratio
correction and for idle speed control (estimated control), etc.
Pressure Specification
Fuel Pressure: Specifications Fuel System Pressure
Fuel System Pressure
Idle Pressure - No Vacuum 38 to 44 PSI psi
Idle Pressure - With Vacuum 33-38 PSI
5 Minutes After Ignition Off 21 PSI or More
Page 2040
CHART 5
CHART 6
Page 1855
Ignition Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 68
Inspection Procedure / ECT Communication Circuit - Solenoid #2 (3 Of 5)
Inspection Procedure / ECT Communication Circuit - Solenoid #2 (4 Of 5)
Inspection Procedure / ECT Communication Circuit - Solenoid #2 (5 Of 5)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Locations
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
A/C Belt
Drive Belt: Specifications A/C Belt
DRIVE BELT
New belt ...............................................................................................................................................
............................................................... 160 ± 25 lb.
Used belt .............................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 100 ± 20 lb.
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Knock Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
KNOCK SENSOR INSPECTION
1. REMOVE KNOCK SENSORS
See: Service and Repair
2. INSPECT KNOCK SENSORS
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between the terminal and body. If there is
continuity, replace the sensor.
Page 4842
Type "B" Brake Pad
A. Remove the clip, pins and anti-rattle spring/pad retainer clip.
B. Remove the brake pads with the anti-squeal shims.
C. Clean any dust from the brake pads.
D. Apply a small amount of the disc brake caliper grease (1-2 mm thick) to the areas indicated in
the illustration.
NOTE:
Do NOT apply grease to the friction surfaces of the brake pads or the disc rotor.
E. Install the brake pads with the anti-squeal shims.
NOTE:
Clean excess grease from the brake pads and caliper.
F. Install the pad guide pin, clip and anti-squeal spring.
G. Install the wheel assembly.
Page 2296
8. REMOVE KNOCK SENSORS
Using SST. remove the knock sensor. SST 09817-16011
KNOCK SENSOR INSTALLATION
1. REINSTALL KNOCK SENSORS
Using SST, install the knock sensor. SST 09817-16011
Torque: 39 N.m (400 kgf.cm. 29 ft.lbf)
2. REINSTALL WATER BYPASS PIPE AND KNOCK SENSOR WIRE 3. REINSTALL INTAKE
MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY 4. REINSTALL FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR 5. REINSTALL
HIGH-TENSION CORDS WITH IGNITION COILS 6. REINSTALL INTAKE AIR CONNECTOR 7.
REINSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE 8. REFILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT 9. RECHECK ENGINE
COOLANT LEVEL
Page 1548
Torque: 5.4 Nm (48 inch lbs.)
21. Install No. 2 fan shroud. 22. Install and adjust drive belt for generator. 23. w/ A/C: install and
adjust drive belt for A/C compressor. 24. Install and adjust drive belt for PS pump. 25. Connect
upper radiator hose. 26. Fill engine with coolant. 27. Start engine check for leaks. 28. Install engine
under cover. 29. Perform road test.
Check for abnormal noise, shock, slippage, correct shift points and smooth operation.
30. Recheck engine coolant level.
Page 1961
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Locations
Page 1611
Adjusting Shim Selection Chart (Exhaust)
Page 2202
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2668
CHART 8
CHART 9
Page 520
Page 1930
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Testing and Inspection
Fuel Gauge Sender: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT FUEL SENDER GAUGE RESISTANCE
Measure the resistance between terminals 2 and 3.
68 L
57 L
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the sender gauge.
Page 712
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 761
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Vehicle NO.2 Speed Sensor Inspection Procedure
- Remove NO.2 vehicle speed sensor. - Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of NO.2
vehicle speed sensor.
Resistance: 560 Ohms to 680 Ohms
- Check voltage between terminals 1 and 2 of the NO.2 speed sensor when a magnet is put close
to the front end of the NO.2 vehicle speed sensor
then taken away quickly.
- Voltage is generated intermittenly.
Note: The voltages generated is extremely low.
Page 3342
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Electrode Gap Specification
Spark Plug: Specifications Electrode Gap Specification
Electrode Gap
Correct Gap .........................................................................................................................................
...................................................... 1.1 mm (0.043 in.)
Page 4249
Front Drive Shaft
REMOVAL
1. Remove front wheel.
Torque to 1 10 Nm (83 ft. lbs.)
2. Drain differential oil. 3. w/o Free wheel hub: remove drive shaft lock nut.
a. Using a screwdriver, remove the grease cap. b. Remove the cotter pin and lock cap. c. While
apply the brakes, remove the lock nut.
Torque to 235 Nm (174 ft. lbs.)
4. w/ Free wheel hub: remove free wheel hub.
Page 4345
Location Of Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness, Ground Points (Fig 32)
Location Of Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness, Ground Points (Fig 36)
Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Page 3055
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 1654
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 1671
** Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer's specific
complaint
Parts Information
Repair Procedure
Replace the Cowl Top Louver and the Heater Unit.
Page 2564
Engine Control-Connectors
Page 2995
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 2624
Page 686
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Locations
Fuse Block: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 4205
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 4347
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Page 713
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2552
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4612
1. Inspect drive sprocket thrust clearance.
Using a feeler gauge, measure the drive sprocket thrust clearance.
Standard Clearance: 0.10-0.25 mm (0.0039-0.0098 inch) Maximum Clearance: 0.25 mm (0.0098
inch) f the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the drive sprocket.
2. Remove high and low clutch sleeve assembly.
a. Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring. b. Remove the clutch sleeve and 3 shifting
keys. c. Using a press, remove the clutch hub, 2 key springs and key retainer.
3. Remove bearing, spacer and drive sprocket with front drive clutch sleeve.
a. Using SST 09555-55010 and a press, remove the bearing.
b. Remove these parts.
^ Spacer and ball.
^ Drive sprocket with front drive clutch sleeve.
^ Needle roller bearing.
c. Remove the front drive clutch sleeve from the drive.
INSPECTION
Page 3384
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 4547
Location Of Splice Points (Fig 38)
System Outline
This system frees or locks the Rear Differential according to the position of the Diff. Lock Control
SW. The differential will lock only when the Rear Diff. Lock Detection SW is ON and the vehicle
speed is at 8 kph (5 mph) or less.
When the Rear Diff. Lock SW is switched from OFF position to ON position. The current flows to
TERMINAL 4 of the 4WD control ECU. If the limit SW on the lock side inside the Rear Diff. Lock
Motor is ON at this time, until the limit SW is turned OFF, the current flows from the 4WD fuse to
TERMINAL 5 of the 4WD Control ECU --> TERMINAL 3 --> TERMINAL 3 of the Rear Diff. Lock
Motor TERMINAL 2 TERMINAL --> 2 of the 4WD Control ECU --> TERMINAL 7 --> GROUND.
This drives the Rear Diff. Lock Motor and locks the rear differential. When the rear differential
locks. the rear diff. lock detection SW turns ON, lighting up the rear diff. lock indicator light in the
combination meter. When the rear diff. lock SW is switched from ON position to OFF position,
current to TERMINAL 4 of the 4WD control ECU is cut OFF. If the limit SW ON the free side inside
the rear diff. lock motor is ON, until the limit SW is turned OFF the current flows from the 4WD fuse
to TERMINAL 5 of the 4WD control ECU --> TERMINAL 2 --> TERMINAL 2 of the rear diff. lock
motor --> TERMINAL 3 --> TERMINAL 3 of the 4WD control ECU --> TERMINAL 7 --> GROUND.
This drives the rear diff. lock motor and frees the rear differential. When the rear differential is free,
the rear diff. lock detection SW and the rear diff. lock indicator light in the combination meter are
turned OFF.
The diff. lock indicator light flashes when:
^ The rear diff. lock SW is switched to ON position during differential lock prohibition conditions
(vehicle speed above 8 kph (5 mph)).
^ The rear diff. lock detection SW is turned OFF during operation of the rear diff. lock motor.
Removal and Installation
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
Front Brake Components (4WD)
REMOVAL
1. Remove front wheel.
2. Disconnect flexible hose.
Remove the union bolt and 2 gaskets from the caliper, then disconnect the flexible hose from the
caliper. Torque: 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.)
CAUTION: Install the flexible hose lock securely in the lock hole in the caliper.
3. Remove caliper.
Page 3018
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 1937
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 2302
Fuel Pressure: Specifications Volume Specification
Information not supplied by the manufacturer.
Page 1964
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The crankshaft position sensor, which detects the engine speed and crankshaft angle signal (NE
signal), has been installed on the oil pump body. The NE signal plate has 34 teeth. The NE signal
sensor generates 34 signals for every engine revolution. The ECM detects the standard crankshaft
angle based on the G signals and the actual crankshaft angle and the engine speed by the NE
signals.
Replacement
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Service and Repair Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Remove front propeller shaft.
a. Place matchmarks on the propeller shaft and differential flanges. b. Remove the 4 nuts, bolts
and washers.
Torque: 74 N.m (54 ft. lbs.)
c. Suspend the front side of the propeller shaft. d. Place matchmarks on the propeller shaft and
transfer flanges. e. Remove the 4 nuts and washers.
Torque: 74 N.m (54 ft. lbs.)
f. Remove the front propeller shaft.
2. Remove rear propeller shaft.
a. Place matchmarks on the propeller shaft and transfer flanges. b. Remove the 4 nuts and
washers.
Torque: 74 N.m (54 ft. lbs.)
c. Place matchmarks on the propeller shaft and differential flanges. d. Remove the 4 nuts, bolts
and washers.
Torque: 74 N.m (54 ft. lbs.)
e. 3-joint type:
Remove the 2 bolts and center support bearing from the frame crossmember.
Torque: 36 N.m (27 ft. lbs.)
f. Remove the rear propeller shaft.
Page 4316
Yoke: Bearing With drill mark: With color mark (Red) No drill mark: No color mark
5. Install spider bearings.
a. Apply MP grease to a new spider and bearings.
NOTICE: Be careful not to apply too much grease.
b. Align the matchmarks on the yoke and shaft.
c. Fit the spider into the yoke. d. Using SST 09332-25010, install new bearings on the spider.
e. Using SST, adjust both bearings so that the snap ring grooves are at Maximum and equal
widths.
TMC
6. Install snap rings.
a. Install 2 new snap rings of equal thickness which will allow 0-0.05 mm (0-0.0020 inch) axial play.
HINT: Do not reuse the snap rings.
Mark: Thickness 1: 2.100-2.150 mm (0.0827-0.0846 inch) 2: 2.150-2.200 mm (0.0846-0.0866 inch)
3: 2.200-2.250 mm (0.0866-0.0886 inch) Brown: 2.250-2.300 mm (0.0886-0.0906 inch) Blue:
2.300-2.350 mm (0.0906-0.0925 inch) 6: 2.350-2.400 mm (0.0925-0.0945 inch)
Electrical Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Resistance Cold Resistance Hot
835 - 1,400 ohms at 14 - 122 deg F 1,060 - 1,645 ohms at 122 - 212 deg F
Page 519
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 3493
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Engine Controls - A/F And O2 Sensor Identification
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - A/F And O2 Sensor Identification
T-SB-0398-09
December 23, 2009
Engine Bank 1 and Bank 2 A/F and 02 Identification
Service Category Engine/Hybrid System
Section Engine Control
Market USA
Applicability
TSB SUPERSESSION NOTICE
The information contained in this TSB supersedes TSB No. EG034-07.
^ Applicability has been updated to include 2009 - 2010 model year vehicles and 2006 - 2010
model year Highlander HV.
TSB No. EG034-07 is Obsolete and any printed versions should be discarded. Be sure to review
the entire content of this service bulletin before proceeding.
Introduction
This service bulletin provides information on the proper identification of engine bank 1 and engine
bank 2 for correct A/F sensor and oxygen sensor replacement.
This bulletin contains information that identifies engine bank 1 and engine bank 2 on the following
engines: 1AZ-FE, 2AZ-FE, 2AZ-FE (PZEV), 1GR-FE, 2GR-FE, 2JZ-GE, 1MZ-FE, 3MZ-FE,
1UR-FE, 3UR-FE, 2UZ-FE 5VZ-FE and 1ZZ-FE.
^ Bank 1 (B1) refers to the bank that includes cylinder No. 1.
^ Bank 2 (B2) refers to the bank opposite bank 1.
^ Sensor 1 (S1) refers to the sensor that is located before the catalytic converters.
^ Sensor 2 (S2) refers to the sensor that is located after the catalytic converters.
Warranty Information
Page 2636
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 3947
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 159
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection Related Diagnostic Procedures
ECM Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the ignition switch is turned ON, battery positive voltage is applied to the coil, closing the
contacts of the EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and supplying power to the terminal +B of the ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Step 1
Step 2
Diagram Information and Instructions
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 4243
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the oil seal and drive shaft boot.
HINT: When it is difficult to disconnect the drive shaft, tap the drive shaft with a plastic hammer.
INSTALLATION
^ Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
HINT: After installation, bleed brake system, check ABS speed sensor signal and front wheel
alignment.
Disassembly / Assembly
DISASSEMBLY
1. Remove oil seal (inside).
a. Clamp the axle hub in a soft jaw vise.
HINT: Close vise until it holds hub bolts. Do not tighten further.
b. Using a screwdriver, remove the oil seal (inside).
2. w/ Free wheel hub: Remove lock nut and ABS speed sensor rotor/spacer.
a. Using a hammer and a chisel, loosen the staked part of the lock nut.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the bushing.
b. Using SST 09318-12010, remove the lock nut. c. Remove the ABS speed sensor rotor/spacer.
NOTICE: Take care not to scratch the serration of the speed sensor rotor.
3. Remove axle hub from steering knuckle.
a. Remove the 4 bolts and shift the brake dust cover towards the hub side (outside).
b. Using SST 09710-30021 (09710-03051), 09950-40010 (09951-04020, 09952-04010,
09953-04020, 09954-04010, 09955-04030,
09957-04010, 09958-04010), remove the axle hub from the steering knuckle.
c. w/o Free wheel hub: Remove the bearing spacer and ABS speed sensor rotor/spacer.
4. Remove oil seal (Outside). Using a screwdriver, remove the oil seal (outside) from the steering
knuckle.
5. Remove bearing from steering knuckle.
a. Using snap ring pliers, remove the snap ring.
Page 231
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 734
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Specifications
Engine Mount: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Engine Rear Mounting Bracket
To Front Crossmember .......................................................................................................................
............................................. 58 Nm (43 ft. lbs.) To Engine Rear Mounting Insulator
................................................................................................................................................ 18 Nm
(13 ft. lbs.)
Engine Front Mounting Insulator To Frame
.......................................................................................................................................... 38 Nm (28
ft. lbs.) Engine Hanger No. 2 To RH Cylinder Head
......................................................................................................................................... 40 Nm (30
ft. lbs.) Engine Mounting Bracket To Cylinder Block
....................................................................................................................................... 44 Nm (32 ft.
lbs.)
Page 2772
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 1836
(b) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between terminals +B and FP.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
3. REINSTALL CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
Page 2980
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2820
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 560
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 3400
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT AIR CLEANER CAP FROM MAF METER
2. REMOVE MAF METER
(a) Disconnect the MAF meter connector. (b) Remove the 2 bolts and MAF meter.
Torque: 6.9 N.m (72 kgf.cm, 61 in.lbf)
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 4296
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Specifications
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Propeller Shaft Runout:
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
........................................ 0.8 mm (0.031 inch)
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Front Differential To Propeller Shaft
................................................................................................................................................... 74
N.m (54 ft. lbs.) Propeller Shaft To Transfer ........................................................................................
......................................................................... 74 N.m (54 ft. lbs.) Rear Differential To Propeller
Shaft ....................................................................................................................................................
74 N.m (54 ft. lbs.)
Specifications
Valve: Specifications
VALVE CLEARANCE (COLD)
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
................ 0.13 - 0.23 mm (0.006 - 0.009 inch) Exhaust .....................................................................
........................................................................................... 0.27 - 0.37 mm (0.011 - 0.014 inch)
ADJUSTING SHIM (FOR REPAIR PART)
Mark 2.500 ...........................................................................................................................................
................................. 2.500 mm (0.0984 inch) Mark 2.550 ..................................................................
.......................................................................................................... 2.550 mm (0.1004 inch) Mark
2.600 ....................................................................................................................................................
........................ 2.600 mm (0.1024 inch) Mark 2.650 ...........................................................................
................................................................................................. 2.650 mm (0.1043 inch) Mark 2.700 ..
..............................................................................................................................................................
............ 2.700 mm (0.1063 inch) Mark 2.750 .......................................................................................
..................................................................................... 2.750 mm (0.1083 inch) Mark 2.800 ..............
..............................................................................................................................................................
2.800 mm (0.1102 inch) Mark 2.850 ....................................................................................................
........................................................................ 2.850 mm (0.1122 inch) Mark 2.900 ...........................
................................................................................................................................................. 2.900
mm (0.1142 inch) Mark 2.950 ..............................................................................................................
.............................................................. 2.950 mm (0.1161 inch) Mark 3.000 .....................................
....................................................................................................................................... 3.000 mm
(0.1181 inch) Mark 3.050 .....................................................................................................................
....................................................... 3.050 mm (0.1201 inch) Mark 3.100 ............................................
................................................................................................................................ 3.100 mm
(0.1220 inch) Mark 3.150 .....................................................................................................................
....................................................... 3.150 mm (0.1240 inch) Mark 3.200 ............................................
................................................................................................................................ 3.200 mm
(0.1260 inch) Mark 3.250 .....................................................................................................................
....................................................... 3.250 mm (0.1280 inch) Mark 3.300 ............................................
................................................................................................................................ 3.300 mm
(0.1299 inch)
VALVE OVERALL LENGTH
STD:
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
............................ 95.15 mm (3.7461 inch) Exhaust ............................................................................
................................................................................................ 94.90 mm (3.7362 inch)
Minimum:
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
............................ 94.60 mm (3.7244 inch) Exhaust ............................................................................
................................................................................................ 94.40 mm (3.7165 inch)
VALVE FACE ANGLE .........................................................................................................................
..................................................................... 44.5°
STEM DIAMETER
Intake
...........................................................................................................................................................
5.970 - 5.985 mm (0.2350 - 0.2356 inch) Exhaust
........................................................................................................................................................
5.965 - 5.980 mm (0.2348 - 0.2354 inch)
STEM OIL CLEARANCE
STD:
Intake
.....................................................................................................................................................
0.025 - 0.060 mm (0.0010 - 0.0024 inch) Exhaust
.................................................................................................................................................. 0.030
- 0.065 mm (0.0012 - 0.0026 inch)
Maximum:
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 0.08 mm (0.0031 inch) Exhaust ............................................................................
.................................................................................................. 0.10 mm (0.0039 inch)
MARGIN THICKNESS
STD .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................ 1.0 mm (0.039 inch) Maximum ...................................................................
.................................................................................................................. 0.5 mm (0.020 inch)
Page 4715
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 4549
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2629
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Components For Removal And Installation Part 1 Of 2
Page 2070
Warranty Information
Applicable warranty*: This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in
effect for 36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in-service date.
Coverage is extended to 36 months or 50,000 miles, whichever occurs first, in the states of
California and Massachusetts due to state emissions warranty legislation.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer's complaint.
Page 1608
b. Turn the crankshaft 2/3 of a revolution (240°), and check only the valves indicated in the
illustration. Measure the valve clearance.
c. Turn the crankshaft a further 2/3 of a revolution (240°), and check only the valves indicated in the
illustration.
Measure the valve clearance.
5. ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
a. Remove the adjusting shim.
1. Turn the camshaft so that the cam lobe for the valve to be adjusted faces up. 2. Turn the valve
lifter with a screwdriver so that the notches are perpendicular to the camshaft.
3. Using Special Service Tool (SST) (A), press down the valve lifter and place SST (B) between the
camshaft and valve lifter. Remove SST
(A). SST 09248-55040 (09248-05410, 09248-05420)
Diagram Information and Instructions
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 3887
Location Of Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness, Ground Points (Fig 32)
Location Of Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness, Ground Points (Fig 36)
Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Page 4247
Front Axle Hub / 4WD
REMOVAL
Page 758
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 2981
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Specifications
Crankshaft: Specifications
DIMENSIONS
Thrust Clearance
STD
.............................................................................................................................................................
0.020 - 0.220 mm (0.0008 - 0.0087 inch) Maximum ............................................................................
................................................................................................... 0.300 mm (0.0118 inch)
Thrust Washer Thickness
STD
.............................................................................................................................................................
2.440 - 2.490 mm (0.0961 - 0.0980 inch)
Main Journal Oil Clearance
No. 1
STD
.......................................................................................................................................................
0.020 - 0.038 mm (0.0008 - 0.0015 inch) U/S 0.25
................................................................................................................................................ 0.019 0.059 mm (0.0007 - 0.0023 inch)
Others
STD
.......................................................................................................................................................
0.024 - 0.042 mm (0.0009 - 0.0017 inch) U/S 0.25
................................................................................................................................................ 0.023 0.063 mm (0.0009 - 0.0025 inch)
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
.................................... 0.08 mm (0.0031 inch)
Main Journal Diameter
STD ...................................................................................................................................................
63.985 - 64.000 mm (2.5191 - 2.5197 inch) U/S 0.25
............................................................................................................................................ 63.745 63.755 mm (2.5096 - 2.5100 inch)
Main Bearing Center Wall Thickness
No. 1:
Mark 1
................................................................................................................................................... 1.991
- 1.994 mm (0.0784 - 0.0785 inch) Mark 2
................................................................................................................................................... 1.994
- 1.997 mm (0.0785 - 0.0786 inch) Mark 3
................................................................................................................................................... 1.997
- 2.000 mm (0.0786 - 0.0787 inch) Mark 4
................................................................................................................................................... 2.000
- 2.003 mm (0.0787 - 0.0789 inch) Mark 5
................................................................................................................................................... 2.003
- 2.006 mm (0.0789 - 0.0790 inch)
Others:
Mark 1
................................................................................................................................................... 1.989
- 1.992 mm (0.0783 - 0.0784 inch) Mark 2
................................................................................................................................................... 1.992
- 1.995 mm (0.0784 - 0.0785 inch) Mark 3
................................................................................................................................................... 1.995
- 1.998 mm (0.0785 - 0.0787 inch) Mark 4
................................................................................................................................................... 1.998
- 2.001 mm (0.0787 - 0.0788 inch) Mark 5
................................................................................................................................................... 2.001
- 2.004 mm (0.0788 - 0.0789 inch)
Crank Pin Diameter
STD
.........................................................................................................................................................
54.987 - 55.000 mm (2.1648 - 2.1654 inch) U/S 0.25
.................................................................................................................................................. 54.745
- 54.755 mm (2.1553 - 2.1557 inch)
Circle Runout
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
.................................... 0.06 mm (0.0024 inch)
Main Journal Taper And Out-Of-Round
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
.................................... 0.02 mm (0.0008 inch)
Crank Pin Taper And Out-Of-Round
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
.................................... 0.02 mm (0.0008 inch)
Electrical Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Electrical Specifications
Resistance 10 - 20 K ohms at -4 deg F
4 - 7 K ohms at 32 deg F
2 - 3 K ohms at 68 deg F
0.9 - 1.3 K ohms at 104 deg F
0.4 - 0.7 K ohms at 140 deg F
0.2 - 0.4 K ohms at 176 deg F
Page 1225
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 2215
Camshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Cam Sensor to Cylinder Head 69 in.lb
Page 4160
e. Place a dial indicator on the top of the adjusting nut on the ring gear side. f.
Adjust the side bearing for zero preload by tightening the other adjusting nut until the pointer on the
indicator begins to move.
g. Torque the adjusting nut 1 - 1.5 notches from the zero preload position.
h. Using a dial indicator, adjust the ring gear backlash until it is within specification.
Backlash: 0.13 - 0.18 mm (0.0051 - 0.0071 inch)
HINT: The backlash is adjusted by turning the left and right adjusting nuts equal amounts. For
example, loosen the nut on the left side one notch and torque the nut on the right side one notch.
i. Torque the bearing cap bolts.
Torque to 78 Nm (58 ft. lbs.)
j. Recheck the ring gear backlash.
Backlash: 0.13 - 0.18 mm (0.0051 - 0.0071 inch)
k. Using a torque wrench, measure the preload with the teeth of the drive pinion and ring gear in
contact.
Total preload (starting): Drive pinion preload plus 0.4 - 0.6 Nm (3.5 - 5.2 inch lbs.)
Page 4229
Axle Shaft: Capacity Specifications
Joint Grease Capacity:
Outboard (Color = Black)
................................................................................................................................... 215 - 235
grams (7.58 - 8.29 ounce) Inboard (Color = Yellow)
................................................................................................................................... 230 - 250
grams (8.11 - 8.82 ounce)
Diagram Information and Instructions
Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 3381
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
MAF Meter to Air Cleaner Cap 61 in.lb
Page 856
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 1563
(l) Reinstall the No.2 timing belt cover with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 9 N.m (90 kgf.cm, 80 in.lbf)
(m)Start the engine.
(n) Disconnect the vacuum sensing hose from the fuel pressure regulator. and plug the hose end.
(o) Measure the fuel pressure at idle.
Fuel pressure 265 - 304 kPa (2.7 - 3.1 kgf/sq.cm, 38 - 44 psi)
(p) Stop the engine. (q) Check that the fuel pressure remains as specified for 5 minutes after the
engine has stopped.
Fuel pressure: 147 kPa (1.5 kgf/sq.cm. 21 psi) or more
If pressure is not as specified. check the fuel pump, pressure regulator and/or injectors.
(r) After checking fuel pressure, disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery and
carefully remove the SST to prevent gasoline from
splashing. SST 09268-45012
(s) Remove the other union bolt. 3 gaskets and fuel pipe from the delivery pipes. (t) Reinstall the
fuel pipe with 4 new gaskets and the 2 union bolts.
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf)
(u) Reconnect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery. (v) Check for fuel leakage.
Page 782
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 694
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 535
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 1369
HINT: Apply SST (B) at a slight angle on the side marked with "9" or "7", at the position shown in the
illustration.
- When SST (B) is inserted too deeply, it will get pinched by the shim. To prevent it from being
stuck, insert it gently from the intake side, at a slight angle.
4. Using a small screwdriver and magnetic finger, remove the adjusting shim.
b. Determine the replacement adjusting shim size according to these Formula or Charts:
Page 887
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Testing and Inspection
Fuel Gauge Sender: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT FUEL SENDER GAUGE RESISTANCE
Measure the resistance between terminals 2 and 3.
68 L
57 L
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the sender gauge.
Page 3264
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2282
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2454
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 208
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
Airbag Sensor Assembly
The airbag sensor assembly is mounted on the floor inside the console box. The airbag sensor
assembly consists of an airbag sensor, safing sensor, diagnosis circuit and ignition control, drive
circuit, etc. It receives signals from the airbag sensors and judges whether the SRS must be
activated or not.
Page 667
CHART 25
Page 2185
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 140
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 4369
Shift Indicator: Description and Operation
Previous automatic transmissions have selected each gear shift using mechanically controlled
throttle hydraulic pressure, governor hydraulic pressure and lock-up hydraulic pressure. The
Electronically Controlled Transmission, however, electrically controls the governor pressure and
lock-up pressure through the solenoid valve. Control of the solenoid valve by the Engine Control
Module based on the input signals from each sensor makes smooth driving possible by shift
selection for each gear which is most appropriate to the driving conditions at that time.
1. GEAR SHIFT OPERATION
During driving, the Engine Control Module selects the shift for each gear which is most appropriate
to the driving conditions, based on input signals from the Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor to
TERMINAL THW of the Engine Control Module and also the input signals to TERMINAL SP2+ of
the Engine Control Module from the Vehicle Speed Sensor devoted to the Electronically Controlled
Transmission. Current is then output to the Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid. When
shifting to 1st speed, current flows from TERMINAL S1 of the Engine Control Module -->
TERMINAL 1 of the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid --> GROUND, and continuity
to the No.1 solenoid causes the shift.
For 2nd speed, current flows from TERMINAL S1 of the Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 1 of
the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid --> GROUND, and from TERMINAL S2 of the
Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 2 of the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid -->
GROUND. and continuity to Solenoid No.1 and No.2 causes the shift.
For 3rd speed. there is no continuity to No.1 solenoid, only to No.2 causing the shift. Shifting into
4th speed (Overdrive) takes place when there is no continuity to either No.1 or No.2 Solenoid.
2. LOCK-UP OPERATION
When the Engine Control Module judges from each signal that lock-up operation conditions have
been met, current flows from TERMINAL SL of the Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 3 of the
Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid --> GROUND, causing continuity to the lock-up
solenoid and causing lock-up operation.
3. STOP LIGHT SW CIRCUIT
If the brake pedal is depressed (Stop Light SW ON) when driving in lock-up condition, a signal is
input to TERMINAL BK of the Engine Control Module, the Engine Control Module operates and
continuity to the lock-up solenoid is cut.
4. OVERDRIVE CIRCUIT
^ O/D Main SW ON When the O/D main SW is turned ON, a signal is input to TERMINAL OD2 of
the Engine Control Module and Engine Control Module operation causes gear shift when the
conditions for overdrive are met.
^ O/D Main SW OFF When the O/D main SW is turned to OFF, the current flowing through the O/D
OFF indicator light flows through the O/D main SW to GROUND, causing the indicator light to light
up. At the same time, a signal is input to TERMINAL OD2 of the Engine Control Module and
Engine Control Module operation prevents shift into overdrive.
5. A/T OIL TEMP. WARNING
When the A/T Oil Temp. Sensor affixed to the transmission case detects that the fluid temp. is
150°C (302°F) or more, the Engine Control Module operates and the current flowing through the
GAUGE fuse flows to the A/T Oil Temp. warning light --> TERMINAL OIL-W of the Engine Control
Module --> Ground, so that the warning light lights up, informing that the Oil Temp. is high. When
the Oil Temp. drops to 120°C (248°F) or less, the Engine Control Module stops operating and the
warning light goes out.
Testing and Inspection
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
Inspect shift lock solenoid.
a. Disconnect the solenoid connector. b. Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance at each
terminal.
Standard Resistance 20-28 ohms.
If resistance value is not as specified. Replace the solenoid.
c. Apply battery positive voltage at each terminal. At this time, confirm that the solenoid operates. If
the solenoid does not operate, replace the
solenoid.
Page 2558
Page 3266
Fuel Injector: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 30
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Specifications
Reverse Idler Gear: Specifications
Reverse Idler Gear Radial Clearance
Standard Clearance
......................................................................................................................................... 0.040-0.082
mm (0.0016-0.0032 inch) Maximum Clearance
..............................................................................................................................................................
0.130 mm (0.0051 inch)
Reverse Idler Gear And Shift Arm Clearance
Standard
..............................................................................................................................................................
0.05-0.35 mm (0.0020-0.0138 inch) Maximum ....................................................................................
............................................................................................. 0.50 mm (0.0197 inch)
Page 4875
Wheel Cylinder: Service and Repair
Rear Brake Components (4WD)
REPLACEMENT
1. Remove wheel and tire. 2. Remove brake drum, brake shoes, and hardware. 3. Disconnect the
brake line. Use a container to catch the brake fluid. 4. Install in reverse order of removal, noting the
following:
- Brake line torque 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.)
- Mounting bolts 10 Nm (7 ft. lbs.)
- Bleed brake system. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair
OVERHAUL
Remove these parts from the wheel cylinder. 1. 2 boots. 2. 2 pistons. 3. 2 piston cups. 4. Spring.
NOTE: Assemble in the reverse order.
Page 2060
CHART 26
Page 1908
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2005
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 1941
6. INSPECT ECT SENSOR
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Resistance: Refer to the graph
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the ECT sensor.
7. REINSTALL ECT SENSOR
(a) Install a new gasket to the ECT sensor. (b) Using a 19 mm deep socket, install the ECT sensor.
Torque: 20 N.m (200 kgf.cm, 14 ft.lbf)
(c) Connect the ECT sensor connector.
8. REINSTALL FUEL PIPE
Install the fuel pipe with 4 new gaskets and the 2 union bolts.
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm. 25 ft.lbf)
9. REINSTALL NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER
10. RECONNECT UPPER RADIATOR HOSE TO WATER OUTLET 11. REFILL WITH ENGINE
COOLANT
Page 1882
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Testing and Inspection
Evaporative Vapor Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR INSPECTION
1. INSPECT POWER SOURCE VOLTAGE OF VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the vapor pressure sensor connector. (b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage between connector terminals VC and E2 of the wiring
harness side.
Voltage: 4.5 - 5.5 V
(d) Turn the ignition switch to LOCK. (e) Reconnect the vapor pressure sensor connector.
2. INSPECT POWER OUTPUT OF VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON. (b) Disconnect the vacuum hose from the vapor pressure sensor.
(c) Connect a voltmeter to terminals PTNK and E2 of the ECM and measure the output voltage
under ambient atmospheric pressure.
- Apply vacuum (2.0 kPa, 15 mm Hg. 0.59 in.Hg) to the vapor pressure sensor.
Voltage: 1.3 - 2.1 V
- Release the vacuum from the vapor pressure sensor.
Voltage: 3.0 - 3.6 V
- Apply pressure (1.5 kPa, 15 gf/sq.cm, 0.22 psi) to the vapor pressure sensor.
Voltage: 4.2 - 4.8 V
(d) Reconnect the vacuum hose to the vapor pressure sensor.
Page 2367
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 757
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 3683
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 2083
Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 3972
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 4558
Differential: Description and Operation
This system frees or locks the Rear Differential according to the position of the Diff. Lock Control
SW. The differential will lock only when the Rear Diff. Lock Detection SW is ON and the vehicle
speed is at 8 kph (5 mph) or less.
When the Rear Diff. Lock SW is switched from OFF position to ON position. The current flows to
TERMINAL 4 of the 4WD control ECU. If the limit SW on the lock side inside the Rear Diff. Lock
Motor is ON at this time, until the limit SW is turned OFF, the current flows from the 4WD fuse to
TERMINAL 5 of the 4WD Control ECU --> TERMINAL 3 --> TERMINAL 3 of the Rear Diff. Lock
Motor TERMINAL 2 TERMINAL --> 2 of the 4WD Control ECU --> TERMINAL 7 --> GROUND.
This drives the Rear Diff. Lock Motor and locks the rear differential. When the rear differential
locks. the rear diff. lock detection SW turns ON, lighting up the rear diff. lock indicator light in the
combination meter. When the rear diff. lock SW is switched from ON position to OFF position,
current to TERMINAL 4 of the 4WD control ECU is cut OFF. If the limit SW ON the free side inside
the rear diff. lock motor is ON, until the limit SW is turned OFF the current flows from the 4WD fuse
to TERMINAL 5 of the 4WD control ECU --> TERMINAL 2 --> TERMINAL 2 of the rear diff. lock
motor --> TERMINAL 3 --> TERMINAL 3 of the 4WD control ECU --> TERMINAL 7 --> GROUND.
This drives the rear diff. lock motor and frees the rear differential. When the rear differential is free,
the rear diff. lock detection SW and the rear diff. lock indicator light in the combination meter are
turned OFF.
The diff. lock indicator light flashes when:
^ The rear diff. lock SW is switched to ON position during differential lock prohibition conditions
(vehicle speed above 8 kph (5 mph)).
^ The rear diff. lock detection SW is turned OFF during operation of the rear diff. lock motor.
Page 2457
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 1382
Valve Cover: Specifications
Uniformly tighten. 6 N.m (53 inch lbs)
Electrical Specifications
Ignition Coil: Electrical Specifications
Cold Resistance Hot Resistance
Primary Coil 0.67 - 1.05 ohms at 14 - 122 deg F 0.85 - 1.23 ohms at 122 - 212 deg F
Secondary Coil 9.3 - 16.0 K ohms at 14 - 122 deg F 11.7 - 18.8 K ohms at 122 - 212 deg F
Page 3676
Ignition Switch: Testing and Inspection
IGNITION SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT SWITCH CONTINUITY
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Page 69
Cruise Control Module: Pinout Values and Diagnostic Parameters
Standard Values Of ECU Terminals (1 Of 2) 5VZ-FE
Page 2663
O2S Application Table
O2S Failure Threshold Charts
Page 1082
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection Alternator
GENERATOR DRIVE BELT
INSPECT DRIVE BELT
1. Visually check the belt for excessive wear, frayed cords etc.
HINT: Cracks on the ribbed side of the belt are considered acceptable.
If the belt has chunks missing from the ribs, it should be replaced.
2. Using a belt tension gauge, check the drive belt tension.
Belt tension gauge:
Nippondenso BTG 20 (95506-00020) or Borroughs No. BT-33-73F
Drive belt tension:
New belt: 160 ± 25 lb Used belt: 100 ± 20 lb
If necessary, adjust the drive belt tension.
HINT: New belt" refers to a belt which has been used less than 5 minutes on a running engine.
- "Used belt" refers to a belt which has been used on a running engine for 5 minutes or more.
- After installing the drive belt, check that it fits properly in the ribbed grooves. Check with your
hand to confirm that the belt has not slipped out of the groove on the bottom of the crank pulley.
- After installing a new belt, run the engine for approx. 5 minutes and then recheck the tension.
Testing and Inspection
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT WASHER LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
1. Check that there is no continuity between terminals with the switch OFF (float up). 2. Check that
there is continuity between terminals with the switch ON (float down).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Camshaft Position Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSPECTION
NOTICE: "Cold" and "Hot" in these sentences express the temperature of the sensors themselves.
"Cold" is from -10°C (14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
1. DISCONNECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR CONNECTOR
2. INSPECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals.
Resistance:
Cold: 835 - 1,400 Ohms Hot: 1,060 - 1,645 Ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the camshaft position sensor.
3. RECONNECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR CONNECTOR
Page 2907
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Components For Removal And Installation Part 1 Of 2
Specifications
Oil Cooler: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Oil Cooler Union To Cylinder Block
............................................................................................................................................. 30 Nm
(22 ft. lbs.) Oil Cooler To Relief Valve
............................................................................................................................................................
59 Nm (43 ft. lbs.) Oil Cooler Union Bolt To Cylinder Block
...................................................................................................................................... 59 Nm (43 ft.
lbs.)
Page 3310
Fuel Return Line: Testing and Inspection
COMPONENTS
CAUTION:
- Always use new gaskets when replacing the fuel tank or component parts.
- Apply the proper torque to all tightened parts.
INSPECTION
INSPECT FUEL TANK AND LINE
Page 2475
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 4388
e. Select a snap ring that will allow minimum axial play.
Mark A: 2.00-2.05 mm (0.0787-0.0807 inch) Mark B: 2.05-2.10 mm (0.0807-0.0827 inch) Mark C:
2.10-2.15 mm (0.0827-0.0846 inch) Mark D: 2.15-2.20 mm (0.0846-0.0866 inch) Mark E: 2.20-2.25
mm (0.0866-0.0886 inch) Mark F: 2.25-2.30 mm (0.0886-0.0906 inch)
f. Using a snap ring expander, install the snap ring.
Specifications
Output Shaft: Specifications
Gear Thrust Clearance
Standard
1st gear
..........................................................................................................................................................
0.15-0.45 mm (0.0059-0.0177 inch) 2nd and 3rd gears
.......................................................................................................................................... 0.10-0.25
mm (0.0039-0.0098 inch)
Maximum
1st gear ................................................................................................................................................
............................... 0.50 mm (0.0197 inch) 2nd and 3rd gears ..........................................................
..................................................................................................... 0.30 mm (0.0118 inch)
Gear Radial Clearance
Standard:
1st Gear
.....................................................................................................................................................
0.020-0.073 mm (0.0008-0.0029 inch) 2nd and 3rd Gears
..................................................................................................................................... 0.015-0.068
mm (0.0006-0.0027 inch)
Maximum:
1st Gear ...............................................................................................................................................
............................. 0.160 mm (0.0063 inch) 2nd and 3rd Gears
............................................................................................................................................................
0.160 mm (0.0063 inch)
Output Shaft Journal
Minimum Diameter:
1st gear ................................................................................................................................................
........................... 38.860 mm (1.5299 inch) 2nd gear .........................................................................
................................................................................................ 46.860 mm (1.8449 inch) 3rd gear .....
..............................................................................................................................................................
....... 37.860 mm (1.4905 inch)
Shaft Runout.
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
.................................... 0.06 mm (0.0024 inch)
Clearance Between The Synchronizer Ring Back And Gear Spline End.
Minimum ..............................................................................................................................................
....................................... 0.8 mm (0.031 inch)
Flange Thickness ................................................................................................................................
........................................... 4.70 mm (0.1850 inch)
Engine Controls - A/F And O2 Sensor Identification
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - A/F And O2 Sensor Identification
T-SB-0398-09
December 23, 2009
Engine Bank 1 and Bank 2 A/F and 02 Identification
Service Category Engine/Hybrid System
Section Engine Control
Market USA
Applicability
TSB SUPERSESSION NOTICE
The information contained in this TSB supersedes TSB No. EG034-07.
^ Applicability has been updated to include 2009 - 2010 model year vehicles and 2006 - 2010
model year Highlander HV.
TSB No. EG034-07 is Obsolete and any printed versions should be discarded. Be sure to review
the entire content of this service bulletin before proceeding.
Introduction
This service bulletin provides information on the proper identification of engine bank 1 and engine
bank 2 for correct A/F sensor and oxygen sensor replacement.
This bulletin contains information that identifies engine bank 1 and engine bank 2 on the following
engines: 1AZ-FE, 2AZ-FE, 2AZ-FE (PZEV), 1GR-FE, 2GR-FE, 2JZ-GE, 1MZ-FE, 3MZ-FE,
1UR-FE, 3UR-FE, 2UZ-FE 5VZ-FE and 1ZZ-FE.
^ Bank 1 (B1) refers to the bank that includes cylinder No. 1.
^ Bank 2 (B2) refers to the bank opposite bank 1.
^ Sensor 1 (S1) refers to the sensor that is located before the catalytic converters.
^ Sensor 2 (S2) refers to the sensor that is located after the catalytic converters.
Warranty Information
Page 3337
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3894
Position Of Parts In Instrument Panel (2 Of 2) (Fig 29)
Relay Blocks
Relay Blocks
Page 2580
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 3355
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Mechanical: Testing and Inspection
THROTTLE OPENER INSPECTION
INSPECT THROTTLE OPENER
(a) Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature. (b) Check idle speed.
Idle speed: 700 ± 50 rpm
(c) Disconnect the vacuum hose from the throttle opener and plug the hose end. (d) Check the
throttle opener setting speed.
Throttle opener setting speed: 900 - 1,950 rpm
If the throttle opener setting is not as specified, replace the throttle body.
(e) Stop the engine. (f) Reconnect the vacuum hose to the throttle opener. (g) Start the engine and
check that the idle speed returns to the correct speed.
Page 1370
Adjusting Shim Selection Chart (Intake)
Page 1927
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 3488
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 4233
Axle Shaft: Locations Axle Shaft Assembly, Constant Velocity Type
Front Drive Shaft
Page 845
Page 3457
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 953
Torque: 5.4 Nm (55 kgf-cm, 48 inch lbs.)
8. CONNECT NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
Page 4727
Page 2750
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 2 Of 2
Page 4215
a. Using a chisel and hammer, loosen the staked part of the nut. b. Using SST to hold the flange,
remove the nut.
SST 09330-00021
c. Using SST, remove the companion flange.
SST 09950-30011 (09951-03010, 09953-03010, 09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03020,
09956-03050)
4. REMOVE OIL SEAL
Using SST, remove the oil seal. SST 09350-32014 (09308-10010)
5. Except 3RZ-FE, 5VZ-FE w/o Diff. lock:
REMOVE OIL SLINGER
6. REMOVE FRONT BEARING
Using SST, remove the front bearing from the drive pinion. SST 09556-22010
Locations
Fuse: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 149
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 2 Of 2
Page 1890
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT AIR CLEANER CAP FROM MAF METER
2. REMOVE MAF METER
(a) Disconnect the MAF meter connector. (b) Remove the 2 bolts and MAF meter.
Torque: 6.9 N.m (72 kgf.cm, 61 in.lbf)
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 2531
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 570
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 2878
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 549
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
ECT SENSOR INSPECTION
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT 2. DISCONNECT UPPER RADIATOR HOSE FROM WATER
OUTLET 3. REMOVE NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER 4. REMOVE FUEL PIPE 5. REMOVE ECT
SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the ECT sensor connector.
(b) Using a 19 mm deep socket wrench. remove the ECT sensor and gasket.
Page 457
Combination Switch: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT LIGHT CONTROL SWITCH CONTINUITY
Reference
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Page 2848
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2066
CHART 30
Page 1106
original clamp.
Tightening Torque:
@Receiver: 4.0 ft/lbf (5.4 N.m, 55 Kgf/cm)
@Condenser: 7.2 ft/lbf (9.8 N.m, 100 Kgf/cm)
C. Install 40 x 70 mm packing on Liquid Tube No.2 as illustrated. The seam should face forward as
shown.
3. Perform Gas Charge and Leak Check procedures as explained in the A/C Installation Manual.
Page 1617
Water Pump: Service and Repair
Page 4699
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 3909
Electronically Controlled Transmission And A/T Indicator (Part 2 Of 3)
Specifications
Synchronizer Ring: Specifications
Synchronizer Ring To Gear Clearance:
Minimum ..............................................................................................................................................
............................................. 0.8 mm (0.031 inch)
Page 108
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 3557
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 3520
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 4683
Electronically Controlled Transmission And A/T Indicator (Part 3 Of 3)
Page 1811
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Knock Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
KNOCK SENSOR INSPECTION
1. REMOVE KNOCK SENSORS
See: Service and Repair
2. INSPECT KNOCK SENSORS
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between the terminal and body. If there is
continuity, replace the sensor.
Page 2693
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - Oxygen Sensor Modified
ENGINE EG011-99
October 15, 1999
Title: 5VZ OXYGEN SENSOR IMPROVEMENT
Models: '96 - '99 Tacoma
Introduction
The design of the 5VZ Oxygen Sensor inner cover has been changed to reduce the possibility of
moisture contacting the ceramic element.
Applicable Vehicles
^ 1996-1999 model year Tacomas built before the VIN listed.
Repair Procedure Please refer to the appropriate repair manual for diagnostic and installation
information for the Oxygen Sensor.
Part Number Information
Warranty Information
Applicable Warranty*: This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in
effect for 36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in-service date.
Coverage is extended to 36 months or 50,000 miles, whichever occurs first, in the states of
California and Massachusetts due to state emissions warranty legislation.
Page 2670
CHART 11
Page 3746
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Mechanical Specifications
Differential: Mechanical Specifications
Straight Screw Plug For Ring Gear
...................................................................................................................................................... 18.6
N.m (14 ft. lbs.)
Page 4662
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Electrical Specifications
Oxygen Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Bank 1: Sensor 1, Terminals +B & HT 11 - 16 ohms at 68 deg F
Bank 1: Sensor 2, Terminals +B & HT 11 - 16 ohms at 68 deg F
Bank 1 Sensor 1
Bank 1 Sensor 2
Valve Cover Oil Baffle - Damage Prevention
Valve Cover: Technical Service Bulletins Valve Cover Oil Baffle - Damage Prevention
ENGINE EG007-02
Title: GENERAL MAINTENANCE TIP
Models: All '93 - '03 Models
March 22, 2002
Introduction
To help prevent unnecessary complications during the oil fill process, no undue load should be
placed on the oil baffle attached to the inside of the valve cover (see illustration). This baffle is
designed to deflect oil and should not be used to support the weight of heavy oil fill devices. These
devices can place stress on the baffle, and bend or break it during the oil fill process.
Applicable Vehicles ^
All 1993 - 2003 model year Toyota vehicles.
Oil Filling Procedure
Please take measures to ensure that the baffle is not damaged during the oil fill process. If it does
become damaged, repair it before any collateral damage occurs.
Warranty Information
Page 784
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 2850
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 3790
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Specifications
Clutch: Specifications
OVERDRIVE DIRECT CLUTCH
Clutch Drum Bushing Inside Diameter, Maximum
.......................................................................................................................... 27.11 mm (1.0673
inch) Overdrive Direct Clutch Piston Stroke
Tacoma, 4 Runner
................................................................................................................................................. 1.77 2.07 mm (0.0697 - 0.0815 inch) Previa Toyota T100, Land Cruiser
........................................................................................................................ 1.85 - 2.15 mm
(0.0728 - 0.0846 inch)
Overdrive Planetary Gear Bushing, Maximum
................................................................................................................................ 11.27 mm
(0.4437 inch) Planetary Pinion Gear Thrust Clearance
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
.................. 0.20 - 0.60 mm (0.0079 - 0.0236 inch) Maximum .............................................................
.......................................................................................................................... 1.00 mm (0.0394
inch)
DIRECT CLUTCH
Piston Stroke
Tacoma, 4 Runner
................................................................................................................................................. 1.03 1.33 mm (0.0405 - 0.0524 inch) Previa, Toyota T100, Land Cruiser
....................................................................................................................... 1.37 - 1.60 mm (0.0539
- 0.0630 inch)
Drum Bushing Inside Diameter
.......................................................................................................................................................
53.99 mm (2.1256 inch)
FORWARD CLUTCH
Pack Clearance
Tacoma, 4 Runner
................................................................................................................................................. 0.40 0.80 mm (0.0157 - 0.0315 inch) Previa, Toyota T100
.............................................................................................................................................. 0.50 0.90 mm (0.0197 - 0.0354 inch) Land Cruiser
..........................................................................................................................................................
0.60 - 1.00 mm (0.0236 - 0.0394 inch)
OVERDRIVE BRAKE Piston Stroke
Tacoma, 4 Runner
................................................................................................................................................. 1.32 1.62 mm (0.0520 - 0.0638 inch) Previa, Toyota T100
.............................................................................................................................................. 1.40 1.70 mm (0.0551 - 0.0069 inch) Land Cruiser
..........................................................................................................................................................
1.75 - 2.05 mm (0.0689 - 0.0807 inch)
SECOND BRAKE Pack Clearance
Tacoma, 4 Runner
................................................................................................................................................. 0.50 1.76 mm (0.0197 - 0.0693 inch) Previa, Toyota T100, Land Cruiser
....................................................................................................................... 0.62 - 1.98 mm (0.0244
- 0.0780 inch)
FIRST AND REVERSE BRAKE Pack Clearance
Tacoma, 4 Runner
................................................................................................................................................. 0.50 1.02 mm (0.0197 - 0.0402 inch) Previa, Toyota T100
.............................................................................................................................................. 0.60 1.12 mm (0.0244 - 0.0441 inch) Land Cruiser
..........................................................................................................................................................
0.70 - 1.22 mm (0.0276 - 0.0480 inch)
Page 2105
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 313
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2337
Spark Plug: Specifications Torque Specification
Spark Plug x Cylinder Head ................................................................................................................
......................................................................... 18 Nm
Page 904
Components For Removal And Installation Part 2 Of 2
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
KNOCK SENSORS REMOVAL
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT 2. REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE 3. REMOVE INTAKE AIR
CONNECTOR 4. REMOVE HIGH-TENSION CORDS WITH IGNITION COILS 5. REMOVE FUEL
PRESSURE REGULATOR 6. REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY 7. REMOVE WATER
BYPASS PIPE AND KNOCK SENSOR WIRE
Page 3903
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Testing and Inspection
Temperature Gauge: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE RECEIVER GAUGE OPERATION
1. Disconnect the connector from the sender gauge. 2. Turn the ignition switch ON and check that
the receiver gauge needle indicates COOL.
3. Ground terminal on the wire harness side connector through a 3.4 W test bulb. 4. Turn the
ignition switch ON, and check that the bulb lights up and the receiver gauge needle moves to the
hot side.
If operation is as specified, replace the sender gauge. Then, recheck the system.
If operation is not as specified, measure the receiver gauge resistance.
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE RECEIVER GAUGE RESISTANCE
Measure the resistance between terminals.
Page 362
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 2778
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2781
Page 4310
Universal Joint: Specifications
Spider Bearing Axial Play ....................................................................................................................
............................................. 0.05 mm (0.0020 inch) Bearing Cup Outer Diameter:
Mark
None
............................................................................................................................................................
29.008-29-021 mm (1.1420-1.1426 inch) Red
..............................................................................................................................................................
29.028-29-041 mm (1.1428-1.1433 inch)
Bearing Hole Inner Diameter:
Mark
None
............................................................................................................................................................
29.000-29.020 mm (1.1417-1.1425 inch) Drill
.............................................................................................................................................................
29.021-29.042 mm (1.1426-1.1434 inch)
Page 3410
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 4487
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Testing and Inspection
Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Inspect relay operation.
a. Jack up the vehicle. b. Use a heater main relay and connect it, as shown below. c. Rotate the
tire and check that differential lock has occurred. if operation is not as specified, replace the
actuator.
2. Inspect Diff. Lock control switch continuity. Inspect the switch continuity between terminal 1 to
terminal 4.
HINT: If it is not continuity, replace the switch.
3. Inspect Diff. Lock position switch.
a. Check that there is continuity between terminals when the switch is pushed (differential
connected position). b. Check that there is no continuity when the switch is free (differential
disconnected position).
HINT: If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
4. Inspect transfer 4WD switch. 5. Inspect vehicle speed sensor.
Page 3537
Ignition Cable: Testing and Inspection
HIGH-TENSION CORDS INSPECTION
1. REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE
2. DISCONNECT HIGH-TENSION CORDS FROM SPARK PLUGS
Disconnect the high - tension cords at the rubber boot. DO NOT pull on the cords.
NOTICE: Pulling on or bending the cords may damage the conductor inside.
3. DISCONNECT HIGH-TENSION CORDS FROM IGNITION COILS
(a) Using a screwdriver, lift up the lock claw and disconnect the holder from the ignition coils. (b)
Disconnect the high-tension cord at the grommet.
DO NOT pull on the cord.
NOTICE: Pulling on or bending the cords may damage the conductor inside.
- Do not wipe any of the oil from the grommet after the high-tension cord is disconnected.
4. INSPECT HIGH-TENSION CORD RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance.
Maximum resistance: 25 K ohms per cord
If the resistance is greater than the maximum, check the terminals. If necessary, replace the
high-tension cord.
Page 1696
1. Remove coolant and any foreign material on rubber points "A," "B," and "C."
2. Check that points "A" and "B" are not deformed, cracked, or swollen.
3. Check that points "B" and "C" are not stuck together.
4. Apply engine coolant to point "B" before using the radiator cap tester.
^ Radiator Cap Tester: Snap-On/Sun P/N SVTS262A (or equivalent)
5. Before installing the radiator cap tester, use the applicable radiator cap adaptor provided in the
following SST kits in conjunction with the radiator cap tester:
^ SST P/N 09230-00030-01 (09231-10080-01) or 09230-00020-01 (09231-10060-01) or
09230-00050-01(09231-10110-01
6. When using the radiator cap tester, tilt it more than 30 degrees.
7. Pump the radiator cap tester several times, and check the maximum pressure.
Pumping speed: 1 pump/second
HINT:
Stop pumping when the valve opens and read the gauge. The gauge must be within the standard
values listed below when the pressure valve opens. The cap is considered OK when the pressure
holds steady or falls very slowly, but holds within the standard values listed below for one minute.
Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications
Mounting bolt 71 in.lb
Page 107
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 4539
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Page 1224
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 2200
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2823
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 542
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4590
Page 4902
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications
- With the front pressure @ 1,960 kPa (285 psi) the rear pressure should be 1,960 kPa (285 psi).
- With the front pressure @ 3,920 kPa (570 psi) the rear pressure should be 2,352 kPa ± 196 (342
± 28.5 psi).
- With the front pressure @ 6,860 kPa (997.5 psi) the rear pressure should be 2,940 kPa ± 343
(427.5 ± 50 psi).
Page 3656
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 3494
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Description and Operation
Fillpipe Restrictor: Description and Operation
Fillpipe Restrictor
The fillpipe restrictor is used to prevent leaded fuel from being added to the fuel tank. The gasoline
pump for unleaded fuel has a smaller nozzle. The fillpipe restrictor will only allow the unleaded type
nozzle to be inserted into the fuel tank.
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
One Touch 2-4 Selector System
Page 4044
Lower Valve Body
Page 2230
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 737
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 3102
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 1535
(a) Visually check the seal portion of the tensioner for oil leakage.
NOTE: If there is only the faintest trace of oil on the seal on the push rod side, the tensioner is all
right. If leakage is found, replace the tensioner.
(b) Hold the tensioner with both hands and push the push rod strongly as shown to check that it
doesn't move.
If the push rod moves, replace the tensioner.
CAUTION: Never hold the tensioner push rod facing downward.
(c) Measure the protrusion of the push rod from the housing end. Protrusion: 10.0 - 10.8 mm (0.394
- 0.425 inch) If the protrusion is not as specified, replace the tensioner.
Page 2735
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 1978
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 4827
E. Apply a small amount of the disc brake caliper grease (1-2 mm thick) to both sides of the pad
support plates.
NOTE:
Do NOT apply grease to the friction surfaces of the brake pads or the disc rotor.
F. If the pad support plate is fixed to the torque plate with adhesive tape, perform the operation
according to the flow chart.
G. Apply a small amount of the disc brake caliper grease (1-2 mm thick) to the caliper as indicated
in the illustration.
H. Install the brake pads with the anti-squeal shims.
I. If equipped with anti-squeal spring: Install the anti-squeal springs.
J. Press the piston in firmly and install the brake caliper.
NOTE: ^
Clean excess grease. from brake pad and caliper.
^ Do NOT apply grease to the friction surfaces of the brake pads or the disc rotor.
K. Install the wheel assembly.
2. Fixed Type Brake Caliper There are two types of brake pads:
Page 652
CHART 10
Connecting Rod
Connecting Rod: Specifications Connecting Rod
DIMENSIONS
Thrust Clearance
Standard
......................................................................................................................................................
0.150 - 0.330 mm (0.0059 - 0.0130 inch) Maximum ............................................................................
................................................................................................... 0.380 mm (0.0150 inch)
Bearing Center Wall Thickness
Mark 1
.........................................................................................................................................................
1.484 - 1.488 mm (0.0584 - 0.0586 inch) Mark 2
.........................................................................................................................................................
1.488 - 1.492 mm (0.0586 - 0.0587 inch) Mark 3
.........................................................................................................................................................
1.492 - 1.496 mm (0.0587 - 0.0589 inch)
Oil Clearance
Standard
......................................................................................................................................................
0.024 - 0.053 mm (0.0009 - 0.0021 inch) U/S 0.25
......................................................................................................................................................
0.023 - 0.069 mm (0.0009 - 0.0027 inch) Maximum ............................................................................
..................................................................................................... 0.08 mm (0.0031 inch)
Rod Bend
Maximum Per 100 mm (3.94 inch)
.......................................................................................................................................... 0.05 mm
(0.0020 inch)
Rod Twist
Maximum Per 100 mm (3.94 inch)
.......................................................................................................................................... 0.15 mm
(0.0059 inch)
Bushing Inside Diameter
..............................................................................................................................22.005 - 22.017
mm (0.8663 - 0.8668 inch)
Piston Pin Diameter
.................................................................................................................................... 21.997 22.009 mm (0.8660 - 0.8665 inch)
Bushing Oil Clearance
Standard
......................................................................................................................................................
0.005 - 0.011 mm (0.0002 - 0.0004 inch) Maximum ............................................................................
..................................................................................................... 0.05 mm (0.0020 inch)
Bolt Outer Diameter
Standard
......................................................................................................................................................
7.860 - 8.000 mm (0.3094 - 0.3150 inch) Minimum .............................................................................
.................................................................................................. 7.600 mm (0.2992 inch)
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Connecting Rod Cap To Connecting Rod
1st Pass ...............................................................................................................................................
............................................ 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) 2nd Pass ...................................................................
.................................................................................................................... Turn Additional 90°
Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Locations
ECT Temperature Sender Gauge / Low Oil Pressure Warning Switch
Page 2034
Page 716
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 3578
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 3581
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4424
2. Inspect each gear radial clearance.
Using a dial indicator, measure the radial clearance of each gear.
Standard Clearance:
1st Gear: 0.020-0.073 mm (0.0008-0.0029 inch) 2nd and 3rd Gears: 0.015-0.068 mm
(0.0006-0.0027 inch)
Maximum Clearance:
1st Gear: 0.160 mm (0.0063 inch) 2nd and 3rd Gears: 0.160 mm (0.0063 inch)
If the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the gear, needle roller bearing or shaft.
3. Remove 5th gear, output shaft center bearing and 1st gear assembly.
a. Using a press, remove the 5th gear, center bearing, thrust washer and 1st gear. b. Remove the
synchronizer ring. c. Remove the straight pin and needle roller bearing. d. Remove the spacer.
4. Remove reverse gear assembly and 1st gear assembly.
a. Using 2 screwdrivers and a hammer, tap out the snap ring. b. Using a press, remove the reverse
gear assembly and 2nd gear assembly. c. Remove the needle roller bearing.
5. Remove reverse gear, shifting key and spring from clutch hub No.1
a. Remove the reverse gear from the clutch hub No.1. b. Push the shifting key spring with a
screwdriver, remove the 3 shifting keys and key springs.
Page 160
Step 3
Step 4
Step 5
Step 6
Page 4765
ABS Control (Motor) Relay Circuit Inspection Procedure (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 4615
4. Insert high and low clutch hub onto clutch sleeve.
a. Install the clutch hub and 3 shifting keys onto the clutch sleeve. b. Install the-2-shifting key
springs under the shifting keys.
NOTICE: Install the key springs positioned so that their end gaps are not in line.
5. Install high and low clutch hub assembly.
Using SST 09316-60011 (09316-00011) and a hammer, drive in a new key retainer.
NOTICE: Be careful not to deform or damage the key retainer.
b. Using a press, install the high and low clutch hub assembly.
6. Install snap ring.
Select a snap ring that will allow minimum axial play and install it to the shaft.
Mark: Thickness A: 2.10-2.15 mm (0.0827-0.0846 inch) B: 2.15-2.20 mm (0.0846-0.0866 inch) C:
2.20-2.25 mm (0.0866-0.0886 inch) D: 2.25-2.30 mm (0.0886-0.0906 inch) E: 2.30-2.35 mm
(0.0906-0.0925 inch) F: 2.35-2.40 mm (0.0925-0.0945 inch) G: 2.40-2.45 mm (0.0945-0.0965 inch)
H: 2.45-2.50 mm (0.0965-0.0984 inch)
Page 3667
Page 858
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 4440
Reverse Idler Gear: Service and Repair Assembly
Install synchronizer ring assembly to hub sleeve No.3. a. Put the key spring to the hole of the
shifting key. b. Push the 3 shifting keys with the 3 key springs to the reverse synchronizer ring.
c. Install the synchronizer cone ring to synchronizer pull ring and turn the pull ring.
d. Install the 5th synchronizer ring. e. Install the reverse synchronizer ring.
Page 4557
Rear Differential Lock (Part 2 Of 2)
Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 1648
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 1956
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 1284
(a) Uniformly loosen and remove the 10 bearing cap bolts, in several passes, in the sequence
shown.
(b) Remove the 5 bearing caps, oil seal and intake camshaft.
2. Remove camshafts of LH cylinder head.
CAUTION: Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level
while it is being removed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head receiving
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
these steps should be carried out.
A. Exhaust:
(a) Align the timing marks (1 dot mark) of the camshaft drive and driven gears by turning the
camshaft with a wrench.
(b) Secure the exhaust camshaft sub-gear to the main gear with a service bolt (See step (c) in step
A in step 25).
(c) Uniformly loosen and remove the 8 bearing cap bolts, in several passes, in the sequence
shown.
(d) Remove the 4 bearing caps and exhaust camshaft.
B. Intake:
(a) Uniformly loosen and remove the 10 bearing cap bolts, in several passes, in the sequence
shown.
(b) Remove the 5 bearing caps, oil seal and intake camshaft.
NOTE:
Page 536
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 3330
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 1471
Oil grade:
API grade SH, Energy-Conserving II multigrade engine oil or ILSAC multigrade engine oil.
Recommended viscosity is as shown in the illustration with SAE 5W-30 being the preferred engine
oil.
Oil capacity:
Drain and refill
w/ Oil filter change: 5.2 liters (5.5 US qts.)
(c) Reinstall the oil filler cap.
4. Start engine and check for oil leaks. 5. Check engine oil level.
Page 3497
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 648
CHART 2
CHART 3
CHART 4
Page 3501
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The camshaft position sensor, which detects the crankshaft angle signal (G signal), has been
installed on the front of right bank cylinder head. The timing rotor has been integrated with the right
bank camshaft timing pulley. When the camshafts rotate, the protrusion on the timing rotor and the
air gap on the pick up coil change, causing fluctuations, in the magnetic field and generating an
electromotive force in the pick up coil. The NE signal plate has 34 teeth and is mounted on the
crankshaft. The NE signal sensor generates 34 signals for every engine revolution. The ECM
detects the standard crankshaft angle based on the 6 signals and the actual crankshaft angle and
the engine speed by the NE signals.
Page 1649
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 3021
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 3595
8. REMOVE KNOCK SENSORS
Using SST. remove the knock sensor. SST 09817-16011
KNOCK SENSOR INSTALLATION
1. REINSTALL KNOCK SENSORS
Using SST, install the knock sensor. SST 09817-16011
Torque: 39 N.m (400 kgf.cm. 29 ft.lbf)
2. REINSTALL WATER BYPASS PIPE AND KNOCK SENSOR WIRE 3. REINSTALL INTAKE
MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY 4. REINSTALL FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR 5. REINSTALL
HIGH-TENSION CORDS WITH IGNITION COILS 6. REINSTALL INTAKE AIR CONNECTOR 7.
REINSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE 8. REFILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT 9. RECHECK ENGINE
COOLANT LEVEL
Page 3586
Knock Sensor: Exploded Views
Components For Removal And Installation Part 1 Of 2
Page 3348
Step 2
Step 3
Step 4
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Page 3692
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 3057
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 341
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 3127
Evaporative Emission Control Canister: Testing and Inspection
CHARCOAL CANISTER INSPECTION
1. REMOVE CHARCOAL CANISTER 2. REMOVE VSV
3. VISUALLY INSPECT CHARCOAL CANISTER
Look for cracks or damage.
4. CHECK FOR CLOGGED FILTER. AND STUCK CHECK VALVE AND DIAPHRAGM
(a) Install the plugs to ports A and B.
(b) While holding port C closed, blow air (1.47 kPa, 15gf/sq.cm. 0.21 psi) into port D and check that
air flows from port E.
(c) While holding port C and port E closed, blow air (1.47 kPa. 15 gf/sq.cm, 0.21 psi) into port D
and check that air does not flow from port F.
(d) Apply vacuum (2.94 kPa, 22 mmHg, 0.87 in.Hg) to port C. check that the vacuum does not
decrease when port F is closed and check that the
vacuum decreases when port F is released.
Page 695
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 3748
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 322
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Testing and Inspection
STOP LIGHT SWITCH CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the brake is on, battery positive voltage normally applies through the STOP fuse and stop
light switch to terminal STP- of the ECU, and the ECU turns the cruise control off.
A fail-safe function is provided so that cancel functions normally, even if there is a malfunction in
the stop light signal circuit.
If the harness connected to terminal STP- has an open circuit, terminal STP- will have battery
positive voltage and the cruise control will be turned off.
Also, when the brake is on, the magnetic clutch is cut mechanically by the stop light switch, turning
the cruise control off.
Stop Light Switch Circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
Inspection Procedure / Stop Light Switch Circuit (1 Of 4)
Page 329
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2340
6. ADJUST ELECTRODE GAP
Carefully bend the outer electrode to obtain the correct electrode gap.
Correct electrode gap: 1.1 mm (0.043 in.)
7. REINSTALL SPARK PLUGS
Torque: 18 N.m (180 kgf.cm, 13 ft.lbf)
8. REINSTALL IGNITION COILS 9. RECONNECT HIGH-TENSION CORDS
Removal
Piston: Service and Repair Removal
1. Remove piston and connecting rod assemblies.
(a) Using a ridge reamer, remove the all carbon from the top of the cylinder.
(b) Cover the connecting rod bolts with a short piece of hose to protect the crankshaft from
damage. (c)
Push the piston, connecting rod assembly and upper bearing through the top of the cylinder block.
NOTE: ^
Keep the bearings, connecting rod and cap together.
^ Arrange the piston and connecting rod assemblies in correct order.
Page 4152
d. Remove the differential case and bearing outer race from the carrier.
HINT: Tag the bearing outer races to show the location for reassembly.
5. Remove drive pinion.
6. Remove drive pinion rear bearing. Using SST 09950-00020 and a press, remove the bearing
from the drive pinion.
HINT: If the drive pinion or ring gear are damaged, replace them as a set.
7. Remove front and rear bearing outer races. Using a brass bar and a hammer, remove the outer
races and adjusting washer from the carrier.
NOTICE: Do not remove the outer races except when replacing the bearings.
HINT: Measure the adjusting washer and note the thickness.
8. Remove ring gear.
a. Place matchmarks on the ring gear and differential case. b. Remove the 12 ring gear set bolts. c.
Using a plastic hammer, tap on the ring gear to separate it from the differential case.
9. Check differential case runout.
a. Install the differential case in the differential carrier.
Page 3086
Page 1700
Radiator Cap: Specifications
RELIEF VALVE OPENING PRESSURE
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
.......................... 74 - 103 kPa (10.7 - 14.9 psi) Minimum ...................................................................
.......................................................................................................................... 59 kPa (8.5 psi)
Page 2794
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 2798
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 4167
Differential Carrier (3RZ-FE, 5VZ-FE w/o Differential Lock)
1. Assemble differential case.
a. Install the proper thrust washer to the side gears.
Washer thickness:
Page 605
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Locations
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor Location
Capacity Specifications
Fluid - Differential: Capacity Specifications
Front Differential
TYPE....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ GL-5* CAPACITY Front ..............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. 1.10L (1.16 Qt) With A.D.D [1] ..........................................................................................................
................................................................................... 1.15L (1.22 Qt) VISCOSITY Below -18° C (0°
F) .........................................................................................................................................................
............................... 80W, 80W-90 Above -18° C (0° F) ......................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... 90 With A.D.D
..............................................................................................................................................................
................................................. 75W-90
[1] Automatic Disconnecting Differential
Rear Differential
Rear Differential Fluid Capacity*
4WD Extra Long Model: 2.05L (2.17 Qt) w/ Differential Lock Short Model: 2.65L (2.80 Qt) w/
Differential Lock Extra Long Model: 2.95L (3.18 Qt) w/o Differential Lock: 2.55L (2.69 Qt)
Fluid level should be less than 0.20 in (5mm) below the fill plug.
*Capacities are approximate
Page 1860
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 3267
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 1149
Fluid - M/T: Fluid Type Specifications
M/T Fluid
Grade ...................................................................................................................................................
................................................................... API GL-5
Viscosity ..............................................................................................................................................
.............................................................. SAE 75W-90
Page 2445
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR REMOVAL
1. REMOVE NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER 2. REMOVE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the camshaft position sensor connector.
(b) Remove the bolts and camshaft position sensor.
Torque: 7.8 N.m (80 kgf.cm, 69 in.lbf)
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 2243
Page 3871
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair
1. Operate vehicle, allow transmission fluid temperature to reach 158-176 °F.
2. Position vehicle on level surface, apply parking brake.
3. Allow engine to idle, depress brake pedal, then move shift lever through all positions.
4. Remove transaxle dipstick, wipe clean, then replace.
5. Remove again, then check fluid level in HOT range.
NOTICE: Do not overfill.
(a) Check the fluid condition. If the fluid smells burnt or is black, replace it.
(b) Replace the ATF.
(1) Remove the drain plug and drain the fluid. (2) Reinstall the drain plug securely.
7. On A340D units: Dry capacity is 6.9 US quarts. Drain and Refill: 2.4 Liters (2.5 US qts, 2.1 Imp.
qts.)
8. On A340E units: Dry capacity is 7.6 US quarts. Drain and Refill: 1.6 Liters (1.7 US qts, 1.4 Imp.
qts.)
9. On A340F units: Dry capacity 1996 9.3 US quarts. Dry capacity 1997-99 10.7 US quarts. Drain
and Refill: 2.0 Liters (2.1 US qts, 1.8 Imp. qts.)
10. On A340H units, dry capacity for transaxle and transfer is 10.9 US quarts.
Page 4434
Reverse Idler Gear: Testing and Inspection
1. Inspect 5th gear radial clearance.
a. Install the spacer, counter 5th gear and needle roller bearings.
b. Using a dial indicator, measure the counter 5th gear radial clearance.
Standard Clearance: 0.015-0.068 mm (0.0006-0.0027 inch) Maximum Clearance: 0.160 mm
(0.0063 inch)
If the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the gear bearing or shaft.
2. Inspect counter gear.
Using a micrometer, measure the outer diameter of the counter gear journal.
Minimum Diameter: 27.860 mm (1.0968 inch)
If the outer diameter is less than the minimum, replace the counter gear.
3. Inspect 5th synchronizer ring.
a. Check for wear or damage.
Page 2895
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Diagram Information and Instructions
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 3407
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 435
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Shift Indicator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness
Location Of Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness, Ground Points (Fig 32)
Specifications
Fuel Pressure Regulator: Specifications
Fuel Pressure Regulator to Fuel Rail 71 in.lb
Page 4076
Clutch Slave Cylinder: Service and Repair Overhaul
DISASSEMBLY
1. Pull out boot with push rod.
2. Remove piston.
Using compressed air, remove the piston with the spring from the cylinder.
ASSEMBLY
1. Coat piston with lithium soap base glycol grease, as shown. 2. Install piston with spring into
cylinder. 3. Install boot with push rod to cylinder.
Page 2945
Page 147
Page 3924
Rear Planetary Gear
Page 564
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2711
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 548
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A thermistor built into the engine coolant temperature sensor changes the resistance value
according to the engine coolant temperature. The structure of the sensor and connection to the
ECM is the same as in the intake air temp. circuit malfunction.
Page 1522
Oil Pressure Sender: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT LOW OIL PRESSURE WARNING SWITCH
1. Disconnect the connector from the switch. 2. Check that there is continuity between terminal and
ground with the engine stopped. 3. Check that there is no continuity between terminal and ground
with the engine running.
HINT: Oil pressure should be over 49 kPa (0.5 kg/Sq.cm, 7.1 psi).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
Page 2737
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Testing and Inspection
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY INSPECTION
1. REMOVE CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY 2. INSPECT CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
A. Inspect relay continuity
(a) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between terminals ST and E1
If there no continuity, replace the relay.
(b) Check that there is continuity between terminals +B and FC.
If there no continuity, replace the relay.
(c) Check that there is no continuity between terminals +B and FP.
If there no continuity, replace the relay.
B. Inspect relay operation
(a) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals ST and E1.
Page 3628
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Locations
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor Location
Page 172
(b) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between terminals +B and FP.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
3. REINSTALL CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
Specifications
Intake Air Plenum: Specifications
DIMENSIONS
Air Intake Chamber:
Warpage (Maximum)
.........................................................................................................................................................
0.10 mm (0.0039 inch)
Intake Air Connector:
Warpage (Maximum)
.........................................................................................................................................................
0.10 mm (0.0039 inch)
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Air Intake Chamber To Intake Air Connector
................................................................................................................................ 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
Air Intake Chamber Stay To LH Cylinder Head
.............................................................................................................................. 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
Intake Air Connector To Intake Manifold
...................................................................................................................................... 18 Nm (13 ft.
lbs.)
Page 2597
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Component Inspection
IAC VALVE INSPECTION
INSPECT IAC VALVE OPERATION
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal +B and negative (-) lead to terminal
RSO and check that the valve is closed.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal +B and negative (-) lead to terminal
RSO and check that the valve is open.
If operation is not as specified, replace the IAC valve.
On-Vehicle Inspection
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1. INSPECT IAC VALVE OPERATION
(a) Initial conditions:
- Engine at normal operating temperature
- Idle speed checked correctly
- Transmission in neutral position
- A/C switch OFF
(b) Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the DLC1. SST 09843-18020 (c) After engine
speed is kept at approx. 1000 rpm for 5 seconds, check that it returns to idle speed.
If the engine speed operation is not as specified, check the IAC valve, wiring and ECM.
(d) Remove the SST from the DLC1. SST 09843-18020
2. INSPECT IAC VALVE RESISTANCE
NOTICE: Cold and Hot in the following sentences express the temperature of the coils themselves.
Cold is from - 10°C (14°F) to 50°C (122°F)
Page 4800
3. RAISE FRONT BRAKE PRESSURE TO 7,845 kPa (8Q kgf/cm2, 1,138 psi) AND CHECK REAR
BRAKE PRESSURE
Rear brake pressure
HINT The brake pedal should not be depressed twice and/or returned while setting to the specified
pressure. Read the value of rear brake pressure 2 seconds after adjusting the specified fluid
pressure. If the brake pressure is incorrect adjust the fluid pressure.
4. IF NECESSARY, ADJUST FLUID PRESSURE
(a) Adjust the length of the No.2 shackle.
Low pressure - Lengthen A High pressure - Shorten A
Initial set
Adjustment range
HINT: One turn of the nut changes the fluid pressure as shown in the following table.
Rear brake pressure:
(b) If the pressure cannot be adjusted by the No.2 shackle, raise or lower the valve body.
Low pressure - Lower body High pressure - Raise body
(c) Torque the nuts. Torque: 13 N.m (130 kgf.cm, 9 ft.lbf) (d) Adjust the length of the No.1 shackle
again. If it cannot be adjusted, inspect the valve housing.
Page 2110
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 3272
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications
OIL PRESSURE (NORMAL OPERATING TEMPERATURE)
At Idle Speed .......................................................................................................................................
........................................ 29 kPa (4.3 psi) or more At 3,000 rpm .......................................................
.................................................................................................................... 245 - 520 kPa (36 - 75
psi)
Page 2477
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Environmental Impact Information
Engine Oil: Environmental Impact Information
CAUTION:
- In order to preserve the environment, used oil and used oil filters must be disposed of only at
designated disposal sites.
Page 1814
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 1 Of 2
Page 4934
Brake Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Without ABS
NOTE: For cars with ABS see ABS Master Cylinder. See:
Master Cylinder Components
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect level warning switch connector. 2. Take out fluid with syringe.
CAUTION: Do not let brake fluid remain on a painted surface. Wash it off immediately.
3. Disconnect brake lines.
Page 4066
Page 4098
Pilot Bearing: Service and Repair
If necessary, replace pilot bearing.
a. Remove the 2 bolts at diametrically opposite points. b. Using SST 09303-35011, remove the
pilot bearing.
c. Using SST 09304-30012 and hammer, install the pilot bearing.
HINT: After assembling the pilot bearing to the hub, install sure that it rotates smoothly.
d. Install 2 new bolts.
Torque: 85 N.m (63 ft. lbs.)
Page 1907
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2926
A. The Diagnostic Tester displays 17" as a value of the Time $81" (see illustration).
B. Find the Conversion Factor value of Time $81" in the O2S Failure Threshold chart. 0.3906 is
specified for Time $81 in this chart.
C. Multiply "17" in step "A" by 0.3906 (Conversion Factor) in step "B."
17 x 0.3906 = 6.6%
D. If the answer is within the Standard Value of TEST LIMIT, the Time $81" can be confirmed to be
normal.
NOTE:
^ "LOW SW V" indicates the O2S voltage when the O2S status changes from rich to lean.
^ "HIGH SW V" indicates the O2S voltage when the O2S status changes from lean to rich.
^ If the O2S voltage is lower than "LOW SW V," the O2S status is lean.
^ If the O2S voltage is higher than "HIGH SW V," the O2S status is rich.
NOTE:
Before the O2S Monitor completes or after the ignition switch is turned OFF, the Diagnostic Tester
displays the viewable upper limit or a lower limit of the test value (example: 0 V, 1.275 V, Os
[seconds], 10.2s, 0 and 255).
Testing and Inspection
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE SWITCH CONTINUITY
1. Check that there is continuity between terminals with the switch ON (switch pin released). 2.
Check that there is no continuity between terminals with the switch OFF (switch pin pushed in).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
Page 148
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 1 Of 2
Page 3280
Fuel Injector: Service and Repair
Components For Removal And Installtion Part 1 Of 2
Page 141
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3856
Clutch: Diagrams
Direct Clutch
Page 2413
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Diagram Information and Instructions
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Diagram Information and Instructions
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 1199
Loosen/Tighten Bleeder Plug
Insert other end of the tube in a half-full container of brake fluid.
NOTE: Begin air bleeding from the wheel cylinder with the longest hydraulic line.
4. Bleed brake line.
(a) Slowly depress the brake pedal several times. (b) While an assistant depresses the pedal,
loosen the bleeder plug until fluid starts to run out. Then tighten the bleeder plug. (c) Repeat this
procedure until there are no more air bubbles in the fluid.
Bleeder plug tightening torque: 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs.)
5. Repeat procedure for each wheel. 6. Bleed Load Sensing Proportioning (LSP) & By-Pass Valve
(BV).
LOAD SENSING PROPORTIONING AND BY-PASS VALVE (LSP & BV) ON-VEHICLE
INSPECTION
HINT: Pre runner is described below.
RZN191L-TRPDKAB, RZN196LCRPDKAB, VZN195L-CRPDKAB
1. SET REAR AXLE LOAD
Rear axle load (includes vehicle weight):
2. INSTALL LSP & BV GAUGE (SST) AND BLEED AIR SST 09709-29018
Page 3763
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 3110
Torque: 5.4 Nm (55 kgf-cm, 48 inch lbs.)
8. CONNECT NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
Page 321
Stop Light Switch Circuit
Page 841
Page 4136
b. Using SST 09950-60020 (09951-007903, 09950-70010 (09951-07150) and a press, install the
bearing outer race. c. Install a new plate washer to the differential carrier.
d. Using SST 09950-60020 (09951-00790), 09950-70010 (09951-07150) and a press, install the
bearing outer race.
7. Install drive pinion front and rear bearing outer races. Using SST 09570-22011, install the outer
races.
8. Install drive pinion front bearing.
a. Install the washer on the drive pinion.
HINT: First fit a washer with the same thickness as the washer which was removed, then after
checking the tooth contact pattern, replace the washer with one of a different thickness if
necessary.
b. Using SST 09506-30012 and a press, install the front bearing onto the drive pinion.
9. Temporarily adjust drive pinion preload.
a. Install the drive pinion and oil slinger.
HINT: Assemble the spacer and oil seal after adjusting the ring gear tooth contact pattern.
Page 2950
Capacity Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
A/T
Engine Coolant ....................................................................................................................................
............................................. 9.5 liters (10.0 US qts.)
M/T
Engine Coolant ....................................................................................................................................
.............................................. 9.7 liters (10.3 US qts.)
Page 3058
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2438
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 487
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 3634
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2344
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: If there is lack of power, excessive oil consumption or poor fuel economy, measure the
compression pressure.
1. Warm up and stop engine.
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature.
2. Remove ignition coils. 3. Remove spark plugs.
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the 6 spark plugs.
4. Check cylinder compression pressure.
(a) Insert a compression gauge into the spark plug hole.
(b) Fully open the throttle. (c)
While cranking the engine, measure the compression pressure.
NOTE: Always use a fully charged battery to obtain engine revolutions of 250 rpm or more.
(d) Repeat steps (a) through (c) for each cylinder.
NOTE: This measurement must be done in as short a time as possible.
Compression pressure: 1,200 kPa (174 psi) or more. Minimum pressure: 1,000 kPa (145 psi)
Difference between each cylinder: 100 kPa (15 psi) or less.
(e) If the cylinder compression in one or more cylinders is low, pour a small amount of engine oil
into the cylinder through the spark plug hole and repeat steps (a) through (c) for cylinders with low
compression. If adding oil helps the compression, it is likely that the piston rings and/or cylinder bore are worn or
damaged.
- If pressure stays low, a valve may be sticking or seating is improper, or there may be leakage
past the gasket.
5. Reinstall spark plugs.
Torque: 20 Nm (14 ft. lbs.)
6. Reinstall ignition coils.
Page 2795
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 3191
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
FUEL PRESSURE INSPECTION
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
(a) Check the battery positive voltage is above 12 V. (b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable
from the battery. (c) Remove the 6 bolts and disconnect the No.2 timing belt cover.
(d) Remove the union bolt holding the fuel pipe to the delivery pipe and gasket.
CAUTION: Put a shop towel under the delivery pipe.
- Slowly loosen the union bolt.
(e) Install SST (pressure gauge) to the delivery pipe with the 2 gaskets and SST (union and union
bolt). SST 09268-45012
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf)
(f) Wipe off any splattered gasoline.
(g) Connect the TOYOTA hand-held tester to the DLC3. (h) Reconnect the negative (-) terminal
cable to the battery. (i) Turn the ignition switch ON. (j) Measure the fuel pressure.
Fuel pressure: 265 - 304 kPa (2.7 - 3.1 kgf/sq.cm, 38 - 44 psi)
If pressure is high. replace the fuel pressure regulator. If pressure is low, check these parts: Fuel hoses and connections
- Fuel pump
- Fuel filter
- Fuel pressure regulator
(k) Disconnect the TOYOTA hand-held tester from the DLC3.
Page 4126
b. Using a hammer handle, remove the actuator.
2. Remove differential tube.
W/ A.D.D.: a. Remove the 4 torx bolts. Torx socket E14 (Part No. 09044-00010 or locally
manufactured tool) b. Using a plastic hammer, tap on the differential tube to remove it. c. Remove
the sleeve. d. Remove the O-ring from the differential tube.
W/O A.D.D.: a. Remove the 4 bolts. b. Using a plastic hammer, tap on the differential tube to
remove it.
3. W/ A.D.D.: Remove clutch case.
a. Remove the 2 torx bolts. Torx socket E14 (Part No.09044 - 00010 or locally manufactured tool)
b. Using a plastic hammer, tap on the clutch case to remove it.
4. Remove side oil seal. Using SST 09308-00010, remove the side oil seal.
5. W/ A.D.D.: Remove intermediate shaft No. 1. Using SST 09350-20015, 09950-40010
(09951-04010, 09952-04010, 09953-04020, 09954-04010,
09955-04010, 09957-04010, 09958-04010), remove the intermediate shaft No. 1.
6. Remove companion flange.
Page 1590
Ignition Cable: Testing and Inspection
HIGH-TENSION CORDS INSPECTION
1. REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE
2. DISCONNECT HIGH-TENSION CORDS FROM SPARK PLUGS
Disconnect the high - tension cords at the rubber boot. DO NOT pull on the cords.
NOTICE: Pulling on or bending the cords may damage the conductor inside.
3. DISCONNECT HIGH-TENSION CORDS FROM IGNITION COILS
(a) Using a screwdriver, lift up the lock claw and disconnect the holder from the ignition coils. (b)
Disconnect the high-tension cord at the grommet.
DO NOT pull on the cord.
NOTICE: Pulling on or bending the cords may damage the conductor inside.
- Do not wipe any of the oil from the grommet after the high-tension cord is disconnected.
4. INSPECT HIGH-TENSION CORD RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance.
Maximum resistance: 25 K ohms per cord
If the resistance is greater than the maximum, check the terminals. If necessary, replace the
high-tension cord.
Page 484
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 861
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Specifications
Case: Specifications
Transmission Case To:
Transfer Adaptor ..................................................................................................................................
............................................... 37 N.m (27 ft. lbs.) Front Bearing Adapter ...........................................
.............................................................................................................................. 17 N.m (12 ft. lbs.)
Extension Housing ...............................................................................................................................
................................................ 37 N.m (27 ft. lbs.) Straight Screw Plug .............................................
................................................................................................................................ 19 N.m (14 ft.
lbs.) Clutch Housing ............................................................................................................................
........................................................ 36 N.m (27 ft. lbs.)
Page 2834
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
ECT SENSOR INSPECTION
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT 2. DISCONNECT UPPER RADIATOR HOSE FROM WATER
OUTLET 3. REMOVE NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER 4. REMOVE FUEL PIPE 5. REMOVE ECT
SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the ECT sensor connector.
(b) Using a 19 mm deep socket wrench. remove the ECT sensor and gasket.
Page 3461
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2664
CHART 1
Page 4323
HINT: When replacing the rear propeller shaft spider on 4WD vehicles, be sure that the grease
fitting assembly hole is facing in the direction shown in the illustration.
Page 3048
Torque: 5.4 Nm (55 kgf-cm, 48 inch lbs.)
8. CONNECT NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
Page 4385
Counter Gear: Service and Repair Assembly
Install synchronizer ring assembly to hub sleeve No.3. a. Put the key spring to the hole of the
shifting key. b. Push the 3 shifting keys with the 3 key springs to the reverse synchronizer ring.
c. Install the synchronizer cone ring to synchronizer pull ring and turn the pull ring.
d. Install the 5th synchronizer ring. e. Install the reverse synchronizer ring.
Page 4107
^ If there are 2 alignment pins present the transmissionltransaxle assembly may be installed
following the applicable Repair Manual procedure.
NOTE:
A missing alignment pin may result in failure of the transmissionltransaxle assembly.
2. Install the missing alignment pin(s).
^ Refer to the applicable Repair Manual procedure for location of the cylinder block rear side
alignment pins.
NOTE
In the Repair Manual, the alignment pin is referred to as a "straight pin."
Page 1331
Crankshaft: Testing and Inspection Thrust Clearance
INSPECTION
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance while prying the crankshaft back and forth with
a screwdriver. Standard thrust clearance: 0.020 - 0.220 mm (0.0008 - 0.0087 inch) Maximum thrust
clearance: 0.300 mm (0.0118 inch) If the thrust clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
thrust washers as a set. Thrust washer thickness: 2.440 - 2.490 mm (0.0961 - 0.0980 inch)
Page 2030
2. Start the engine.
3. Perform the drive pattern to run and complete the Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Monitor.
HINT:
The 02S Monitor is completed when the following conditions are met:
^ Two (2) minutes or more passed after the engine start.
^ The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) is 167°F (75°C) or more.
^ Cumulative running time at 30 mph (48 km/h) or more exceeds 6 minutes.
^ Vehicle is in closed loop.
^ The fuel-cut is operated for 8 seconds or more (for Rear O2S Monitor).
A. Allow the engine to idle for two minutes.
B. Warm up the engine until the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) reaches 167°F (75°C).
C. Drive the vehicle over 30 mph (48 km/h) for more than 40 seconds.
D. Stop the vehicle and allow the engine to idle for more than 20 seconds.
E. Repeat steps C and D at least 8 times in one driving cycle. (Do not cycle the ignition key.)
In addition, perform the following steps for the Rear O2S Readiness Monitor:
A. Select second gear.
B. Allow the vehicle to run at 30 mph (48 km/h) or more.
C. Keep the accelerator pedal "off-idle" for more than 10 seconds.
D. Immediately after step C, release the accelerator pedal for at least 10 seconds without
depressing the brake pedal (to execute the fuel-cut).
E. Decelerate the vehicle until the vehicle speed reaches less than 6mph (10km/h).
F. Repeat steps B - E at least twice in one driving cycle.
Accessing O2S Test Results
1. On the Diagnostic Tester* screen, select the following menus:
^ DIAGNOSTICS
^ CARB OBD II
Page 4165
24. Measure distance between sleeve and differential case end side. Measure distance between
the sleeve and tip of the differential case when
differential is free and locked.
Standard distance:
LOCK: 17.44 - 18.86 mm (0.6866 - 0.7425 inch) FREE: 32.40 - 33.90 mm (1.2756 - 1.3346 inch)
25. Install indicator switch. Install the indicator switch with a new gasket.
Torque to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
26. Install actuator.
a. Check that the outermost rack tooth of the shift fork is virtually above the center line of the
actuator installation hole.
Page 2225
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4678
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 1816
Engine Control-Connectors
Page 4594
HINT: ^
Apply gear oil to the oil seal ring.
^ hang securely to eliminate clearance.
Page 1010
Idle Speed: Adjustments
1. Initial conditions.
(a) Engine coolant at normal operating temperature.
(b) Air cleaner installed. (c)
All pipes and hoses of air induction system connected.
(d) All accessories switched OFF. (e)
All vacuum lines properly connected.
NOTE: All vacuum hoses for Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) systems, etc. should be properly
connected.
(f) Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection (SFI) system wiring connectors fully plugged.
(g) Ignition timing set correctly. (h) Transmission in neutral position. (i)
A/C switch is OFF.
2. Connect TOYOTA hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool or equivalent. 3. Inspect idle speed.
(a) Race the engine speed at 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
(b) Check the idle speed.
Idle speed: 700 +/- 50 rpm
NOTE: If the idle speed is not as specified, check the Idle Air Control (IAC) valve and air intake
system.
4. Disconnect TOYOTA hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool or equivalent.
Page 656
CHART 15
Page 3805
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
ON-VEHICLE REPAIR
1 DISCONNECT NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
2. REMOVE NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
a. Remove the bolt and No.1 vehicle speed sensor assembly. b. Remove the speedometer driven
gear and O-ring from the No.1 vehicle speed sensor.
3. INSTALL NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
a. Coat a new O-ring with ATF. b. Install the O-ring and speedometer driven gear to the No.1
vehicle speed sensor. c. Install the No.1 vehicle speed sensor to the extension housing and torque
the bolt.
Torque: 16 Nm (160 kgf-cm, 12 ft. lbs.)
4. CONNECT NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR 5. DISCONNECT NO.2 VEHICLE
SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
6. REMOVE NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
a. Remove the bolt and No.2 vehicle speed sensor. b. Remove the O-ring from the No.2 vehicle
speed sensor.
7. INSTALL NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
a. Coat a new O-ring with ATF and install it to the No.2 vehicle speed sensor. b. Install the No.2
vehicle speed sensor and torque the bolt.
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
One Touch 2-4 Selector System
Page 4882
3. RAISE FRONT BRAKE PRESSURE TO 7,845 kPa (8Q kgf/cm2, 1,138 psi) AND CHECK REAR
BRAKE PRESSURE
Rear brake pressure
HINT The brake pedal should not be depressed twice and/or returned while setting to the specified
pressure. Read the value of rear brake pressure 2 seconds after adjusting the specified fluid
pressure. If the brake pressure is incorrect adjust the fluid pressure.
4. IF NECESSARY, ADJUST FLUID PRESSURE
(a) Adjust the length of the No.2 shackle.
Low pressure - Lengthen A High pressure - Shorten A
Initial set
Adjustment range
HINT: One turn of the nut changes the fluid pressure as shown in the following table.
Rear brake pressure:
(b) If the pressure cannot be adjusted by the No.2 shackle, raise or lower the valve body.
Low pressure - Lower body High pressure - Raise body
(c) Torque the nuts. Torque: 13 N.m (130 kgf.cm, 9 ft.lbf) (d) Adjust the length of the No.1 shackle
again. If it cannot be adjusted, inspect the valve housing.
Page 1346
Piston: Service and Repair Cleaning
1. Using a gasket scraper, remove the carbon from the piston top.
2. Using a groove cleaning tool or broken ring, clean the piston ring grooves.
3. Using solvent and a brush, thoroughly clean the piston.
CAUTION: Do not use a wire brush.
Page 1903
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 1597
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Recommended Spark Plugs
ND K16TR11
NGK BKR5EKB-11
Page 1800
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 3516
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Specifications
Clutch Pedal Assembly: Specifications
Pedal Height
From Floor Panel
........................................................................................................................................................
70.0-180.0 mm (6.692-7.086 inch) From Asphalt Sheet
...................................................................................................................................................
167.0-177.0 mm (6.574-6.968 inch)
Pedal Freeplay ....................................................................................................................................
................................. 5.0-15.0 mm (0.197-0.591 inch) Push Rod Play At Pedal Top
..................................................................................................................................................
1.0-5.0 mm (0.039-0.197 inch) Clutch Release Point From:
Pedal Full Stroke End Position
............................................................................................................................................ 25 mm
(0.098 inch) Or More
Page 1874
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 1726
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
ECT SENSOR INSPECTION
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT 2. DISCONNECT UPPER RADIATOR HOSE FROM WATER
OUTLET 3. REMOVE NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER 4. REMOVE FUEL PIPE 5. REMOVE ECT
SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the ECT sensor connector.
(b) Using a 19 mm deep socket wrench. remove the ECT sensor and gasket.
Specifications
Brake Caliper: Specifications
Line Union 22 ft.lb
Mounting Bolt 90 ft.lb
Testing and Inspection
General Module: Testing and Inspection
INTEGRATION RELAY INSPECTION
Integration Relay Inspection
1. INSPECT KEY UNLOCK WARNING OPERATION
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 1 2. (b) Connect the negative (-) lead
from the battery to terminals 5, 7 and 1 0. (c) Check the chime sounds.
Integration Relay Inspection
(d) Disconnect the negative (-) lead from the battery to terminal 10. (e) Check that the chime stops
sounding.
Integration Relay Inspection
(f) Connect the negative (-) lead from the battery to terminal 10. (g) Connect the positive (+) lead
from the battery to terminal 6. (h) Check that the chime stops sounding.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
Page 4439
d. Turn the reverse synchronizer pull ring, separate the pull ring and cone ring. e. Push the shifting
key and spring, and remove the 3 shifting keys and springs to the reverse synchronizer ring.
Page 630
Page 3963
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
ON-VEHICLE REPAIR
1 DISCONNECT NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
2. REMOVE NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
a. Remove the bolt and No.1 vehicle speed sensor assembly. b. Remove the speedometer driven
gear and O-ring from the No.1 vehicle speed sensor.
3. INSTALL NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
a. Coat a new O-ring with ATF. b. Install the O-ring and speedometer driven gear to the No.1
vehicle speed sensor. c. Install the No.1 vehicle speed sensor to the extension housing and torque
the bolt.
Torque: 16 Nm (160 kgf-cm, 12 ft. lbs.)
4. CONNECT NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR 5. DISCONNECT NO.2 VEHICLE
SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
6. REMOVE NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
a. Remove the bolt and No.2 vehicle speed sensor. b. Remove the O-ring from the No.2 vehicle
speed sensor.
7. INSTALL NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
a. Coat a new O-ring with ATF and install it to the No.2 vehicle speed sensor. b. Install the No.2
vehicle speed sensor and torque the bolt.
Page 3817
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
2-4 Selector Switch
Inspect 2-4 selector switch continuity. Test continuity between terminals 1 and 2.
Switch position: Specified condition.
OFF: No continuity. ON: Continuity.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the shift lever knob.
Check Fit Between Piston and Piston Pin
Piston: Testing and Inspection Check Fit Between Piston and Piston Pin
Try to move the piston back and forth on the piston pin. If any movement is felt, replace the piston
and pin as a set.
Testing and Inspection
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY INSPECTION
1. REMOVE CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY 2. INSPECT CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
A. Inspect relay continuity
(a) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between terminals ST and E1
If there no continuity, replace the relay.
(b) Check that there is continuity between terminals +B and FC.
If there no continuity, replace the relay.
(c) Check that there is no continuity between terminals +B and FP.
If there no continuity, replace the relay.
B. Inspect relay operation
(a) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals ST and E1.
Locations
Ignition Switch
Page 1984
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 1878
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Bleeding the Brake System
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Bleeding the Brake System
CAUTION: Do not let brake fluid remain on a painted surface. Wash it off immediately.
NOTE: If any work is done on the brake system or if air is suspected in the brake lines, bleed the
system of air.
Fill Brake Reservoir
BRAKE FLUID BLEEDING
1. Fill brake reservoir with brake fluid.
Check the fluid level in the reservoir after bleeding each wheel. Add fluid, if necessary. Fluid:
SAEJ17O3 or FMVSS No.116 DOT 3
2. Bleed master cylinder.
NOTE: If the master cylinder has been disassembled or if the reservoir becomes empty, bleed the
air from the master cylinder.
(a) Disconnect the brake lines from the master cylinder.
(b) Slowly depress the brake pedal and hold it.
(c) Block off the outlet plugs with your fingers, and release the Brake Pedal. (d) Repeat (b) and (c)
3 or 4 times.
3. Connect vinyl tube to brake caliper or wheel cylinder bleeder plug.
Page 3589
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Knock sensors are fitted one each to the right bank and left bank of the cylinder block to detect
engine knocking. This sensor contains a piezoelectric element which generates a voltage when it
becomes deformed, which occurs when the cylinder block vibrates due to knocking. If engine
knocking occurs, ignition timing is retarded to suppress it.
Page 2196
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 3906
Shift Indicator: Connector Views
Electronically Controlled Transmission And A/T Indicator-Connectors
Page 2740
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 1 Of 2
Page 4722
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Diagram Information and Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 3278
(g) Connect the TOYOTA hand-held tester to the DLC3. (h) Turn the ignition switch ON and
TOYOTA hand-held tester main switch ON.
NOTICE: Do not start the engine.
(i) Select the active test mode on the TOYOTA hand- held tester. (j) Please refer to the TOYOTA
hand - held tester operator's manual for further details.
(k) If you have no TOYOTA hand-held tester, connect the positive (+) and negative (-) leads from
the battery to the fuel pump connector. (i) Connect SST (wire) to the injector and battery for 15
seconds. and measure the injection volume with a graduated cylinder. Test each injector
2 or 3 times. SST 09842-30070
Volume: 56 - 69 ohms (3.4 - 4.2 cu in.) per 15 sec.
Difference between each injector: 6 cu.cm (0.4 cu in.) or less
If the ignition volume is not as specified, replace the injector.
3. INSPECT LEAKAGE
(a) In the condition above, disconnect the test probes of SST (wire) from the battery and check the
fuel leakage from the injector. SST
09842-30070
Fuel drop: 1 drop or less per minute
(b) Turn the ignition switch to LOCK. (c) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery.
(d) Remove SST. SST 09268-41045 (e) Disconnect the TOYOTA hand-held tester from the DLC3.
Page 2106
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Diagram Information and Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 613
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 4917
Depress MOTOR Switch
(b) Turn the selector switch of the actuator checker to "FRONT" position. (c) Push and hold in the
MOTOR switch for a few seconds. (d) Depress the brake pedal and hold it until the step (g) is
completed.
Depress POWER Switch
(e) Push the POWER switch, and check that the brake pedal does not go down.
CAUTION: Do not keep the POWER switch pushed down for more than 10 seconds.
(f) Release the switch, and check that the pedal goes down.
Depress MOTOR Switch
(g) Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few seconds, and check that the pedal returns. (h)
Release the brake pedal.
Depress MOTOR Switch And Brake Pedal
(i) Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few seconds.
Page 4778
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Testing and Inspection
ABS ACTUATOR INSPECTION
1. Inspect battery positive voltage.
Battery positive voltage: 10-14 Volts.
2. Disconnect connectors.
Disconnect Connector
(a) Disconnect the connector from the actuator. (b) Disconnect the 2 connectors from the control
relay.
3. Connect actuator checker Special Service Tool (SST) to actuator.
Sub-Wire Harness C And Sub-Wire Harness E
(a) Connect the actuator checker (SST) to the actuator, control relay and body side wire harnesses
through the sub - wire harnesses C and E (SST),
as shown. SST 09990-00150, 09990-00200,09990-00210
(b) Connect the red cable of the checker to the battery positive (+) terminal and black cable to the
negative (-) terminal. Connect the black cable of
the sub-wire harnesses to the battery negative (-) terminal or body ground.
(c) Place the "SHEET L" (SST) on the actuator checker.
SST 09990 - 00370
4. Inspect brake actuator operation.
(a) Start the engine, and run it at idle.
Testing and Inspection
Temperature Gauge: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE RECEIVER GAUGE OPERATION
1. Disconnect the connector from the sender gauge. 2. Turn the ignition switch ON and check that
the receiver gauge needle indicates COOL.
3. Ground terminal on the wire harness side connector through a 3.4 W test bulb. 4. Turn the
ignition switch ON, and check that the bulb lights up and the receiver gauge needle moves to the
hot side.
If operation is as specified, replace the sender gauge. Then, recheck the system.
If operation is not as specified, measure the receiver gauge resistance.
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE RECEIVER GAUGE RESISTANCE
Measure the resistance between terminals.
Page 2874
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2056
Page 3336
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 344
Inspection Procedure / Clutch Switch Circuit (2 Of 4)
Inspection Procedure / Clutch Switch Circuit (3 Of 4)
Inspection Procedure / Clutch Switch Circuit (4 Of 4)
Page 644
Diagram Information and Instructions
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Electrical Specifications
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Measure Terminals THA - E2 10 - 20 K ohms at -4 deg F
4 - 7 K ohms at 32 deg F
2 - 3 K ohms at 68 deg F
0.9 - 1.3 K ohms at 104 deg F
0.4 - 0.7 K ohms at 140 deg F
0.2 - 0.4 K ohms at 176 deg F
Page 1114
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair
Refrigerant Lines
REFRIGERANT LINES REPLACEMENT
1. DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM REFRIGERATION SYSTEM
2. REPLACE FAULTY TUBE OR HOSE
NOTE: Cap the open fittings immediately to keep moisture or dirt out of the system.
3. TORQUE CONNECTIONS TO SPECIFIED TORQUE
NOTE: Connections should not be torqued tighter than the specified torqued.
Receiver x Liquid tube
Torque: 6.0 N.m (61 kg.cm, 53 in.lb)
Condenser x Discharge tube
Torque: 10 N.m (100 kg.cm, 7 ft.lb)
Condenser x Liquid tube
Torque: 14 N.m (140 kg.cm, 10 ft.lb)
Compressor x Discharge tube
Torque: 10 N.m (100 kg.cm, 7 ft.lb)
Compressor x Suction tube
Torque: 10 N.m (100 kg.cm, 7 ft.lb)
Cooling unit x Liquid tube
Torque: 14 N.m (140 kg.cm, 10 ft.lb)
Cooling unit x Suction tube
Torque: 32 N.m (330 kg.cm, 24 ft.lb)
Expansion valve x Evaporator
Torque: 5.4 N.m (55 kg.cm, 48 in.lb)
Suction line
Torque: 32 N.m (330 kg.cm, 24 ft.lb)
Liquid line
Torque: 14 N.m (140 kg.cm, 10 ft.lb)
Page 1300
Connecting Rod Bearing: Service and Repair
1. Using Special Service Tool (SST) Connecting Rod Bushing Remover & Replacer # 09222 30010 or equivalent and a press, press out the
bushing.
2. Align the oil holes of a new bushing and the connecting rod. 3. Using SST Connecting Rod
Bushing Remover & Replacer # 09222 - 30010 or equivalent and a press, press in the bushing.
4. Using a pin hole grinder, hone the bushing to obtain the standard specified clearance between
the bushing and piston pin.
5. Check the piston pin fit at normal room temperature. Coat the piston pin with engine oil, and
push it into the connecting rod with your thumb.
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSPECTION
NOTICE: "Cold" and "Hot" in these sentences express the temperature of the sensors themselves.
"Cold" is from -10°C (14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals.
Resistance:
Cold: 1,630 - 2,740 Ohms Hot: 2,065 - 3,225 Ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the crank shaft position sensor.
Page 2751
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection Related Diagnostic Procedures
ECM Power Source Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the ignition switch is turned ON, battery positive voltage is applied to the coil, closing the
contacts of the EFI main relay (Marking: EFI) and supplying power to the terminal +B of the ECM.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Step 1
Step 2
Page 1946
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Crankshaft Sensor to Oil Pump 69 in.lb
Exhaust System - Manifold Heat Shield Rattle Noise
Heat Shield: Customer Interest Exhaust System - Manifold Heat Shield Rattle Noise
Engine
EG004-00
June 2, 2000
Title: EXHAUST MANIFOLD HEAT SHIELD RATTLE NOISE
Models: '95 - '00 Tacoma
Introduction
Some Tacoma vehicles may experience a rattle noise caused by the exhaust manifold heat shield.
Two wire mesh grommets and a reinforcement patch on the underside have been added to reduce
the possibility of the exhaust manifold heat shield rattle noise.
Applicable Vehicles
^ 1995 - 2000 model year Tacoma vehicles (except CA Spec.) equipped with 2RZ-FE or 3RZ-FE
engines produced before the VINs listed.
Production Change Information
Parts Information Repair Procedure
1. Inspect the Exhaust Manifold Heat Shield for cracking around the 2 bolts and 2 studs.
2. If cracking is found, replace the Exhaust Manifold Heat Shield, Bolts, Washers, Studs, and Nuts
in specified quantities.
3. Insert 2 bolts. (P/N 90110-06894)
4. Reuse studs/nuts in the specified areas.
Warranty Information
Page 2902
Page 3749
Shift Indicator: Connector Views
Electronically Controlled Transmission And A/T Indicator-Connectors
Page 2044
CHART 11
Page 2880
Page 377
Vehicle Speed Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Valve Body Assembly
Valve Body Assembly
Page 2666
CHART 5
CHART 6
Page 863
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 339
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 3698
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Knock sensors are fitted one each to the right bank and left bank of the cylinder block to detect
engine knocking. This sensor contains a piezoelectric element which generates a voltage when it
becomes deformed, which occurs when the cylinder block vibrates due to knocking. If engine
knocking occurs, ignition timing is retarded to suppress it.
Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Specifications
Between Terminals Measured Resistance
At Clearance: 0 mm (0 in.) VTA - E2 0.2 - 5.7 K ohms
Throttle Fully Opened VTA - E2 2.0 - 10.2 K ohms
At all Times VC - E2 2.5 - 5.9 K ohms
Ohmmeter Connection
Page 2176
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Front Differential Carrier
Differential Carrier: Testing and Inspection Front Differential Carrier
Differential Carrier
Page 932
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 2028
A/F and 02 Sensor Identification
Page 2677
Testing and Inspection
EGR Backpressure Transducer: Testing and Inspection
EGR VACUUM MODULATOR INSPECTION
1. DISCONNECT VACUUM HOSES FROM EGR VACUUM MODULATOR
Disconnect these vacuum hoses: (1) Vacuum hose from R port (2) Vacuum hose from Q port (3)
Vacuum hose from P port
2. INSPECT EGR VACUUM MODULATOR OPERATION
(a) Block ports P and R with your finger.
(b) Blow air into port Q and check that the air passes through to the air filter side freely. (c) Start the
engine and maintain speed at 3,500 RPM.
(d) Repeat the above test. Check that there is a strong resistance to air flow.
3. RECONNECT VACUUM HOSES TO EGR VACUUM MODULATOR
Connect the vacuum hoses: (1) Vacuum hose to R port (2) Vacuum hose to Q port (3) Vacuum
hose to P port
Page 2020
Applicable Vehicles
Page 273
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Rear
Rear Speed Sensor Components
REMOVAL
1. Remove speed sensor.
Disconnect Speed Sensor Connector
(a) Disconnect the speed sensor connector, and pull out the sensor wire harness with grommet. (b)
Remove the 5 resin clips, 2 clamp set bolts and 2 nuts holding the sensor wire harness from the
side rail, fuel tank and axle housing.
Remove Clamp Bolts
(c) Remove the 2 mountings bolt and speed sensor.
Torque: 8.0 Nm (71 inch lbs.)
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. After installation, check speed sensor signal.
CAUTION: Make sure that: There are no foreign objects on the sensor or the part of the axle end to which the sensor is to be
installed.
- The sensor is installed flat against the knuckle when you tighten the bolt.
- When installing the resin clips, use new ones.
Page 51
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 4297
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Testing and Inspection
Inspect propeller shaft and intermediate shafts for damage or runout.
Using a dial indicator, check the runout of shafts.
Maximum Runout: 0.8 mm (0.031 inch)
If shaft runout is greater than Maximum, replace the shaft.
Page 4293
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Propeller Shaft Joint Grease/Fittings
DRIVELINE & DIFFERENTIAL DL001-99
Title: PROPELLER SHAFT JOINT GREASE
Models: '96-'99 4Runner 4WD, '95-'99 Tacoma 4WD, '98-'99 PreRunner, & '00 Tundra 4WD
August 27, 1999
Introduction
This Service Bulletin provides the location of the grease fittings for the propeller shaft joints as well
as the type of grease to use with each fitting location. See the Scheduled Maintenance Guide of
each vehicle for recommended lubrication intervals.
Applicable Vehicles
^ 1996-1999 4Runner 4WD, 1995-1999 Tacoma 4WD, 1998-1999 PreRunnner, & 2000 Tundra
4WD
Warranty Information
Procedure for 4Runner
Use a grease gun to apply multi-purpose grease to the No. 1, 2, 3, 7 and 8 grease fittings. Apply
molybdenum disulfide lithium base chassis grease, NLGI No. 2, to the No. 4, 5 and 6 grease fittings
(double cardan joint).
Locations
Ignition Switch
Page 2963
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - Oxygen Sensor Improvement
ENGINE EG006-99
Title: 5VZ OXYGEN SENSOR IMPROVEMENT
Models: '96 - '99 Tacoma
June 18, 1999
Introduction The design of the 5VZ Oxygen Sensor inner cover has been changed 10 reduce the
possibility of moisture contacting the ceramic element.
Affected Vehicles ^
1996-1999 model year Tacomas built before the VINs listed below.
Repair Procedure Please refer to the appropriate repair manual for diagnostic and installation
information for the Oxygen Sensor.
Part Number Information
Disassembly
Reverse Idler Gear: Service and Repair Disassembly
Remove hub sleeve No.3, shifting key and spring from synchronizer ring. a. Remove the
synchronizer ring assembly from the hub sleeve No.3.
b. Turn the reverse synchronizer pull ring.
c. Remove the reverse synchronizer ring and 5th synchronizer ring from the synchronizer pull ring
and cone ring.
Capacity Specifications
Fluid - Transfer Case: Capacity Specifications
Transfer Case
Refill .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 2.2 Pt
Page 1719
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2175
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 236
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 1660
6. INSPECT ECT SENSOR
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Resistance: Refer to the graph
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the ECT sensor.
7. REINSTALL ECT SENSOR
(a) Install a new gasket to the ECT sensor. (b) Using a 19 mm deep socket, install the ECT sensor.
Torque: 20 N.m (200 kgf.cm, 14 ft.lbf)
(c) Connect the ECT sensor connector.
8. REINSTALL FUEL PIPE
Install the fuel pipe with 4 new gaskets and the 2 union bolts.
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm. 25 ft.lbf)
9. REINSTALL NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER
10. RECONNECT UPPER RADIATOR HOSE TO WATER OUTLET 11. REFILL WITH ENGINE
COOLANT
Service Precautions
Fuel Pressure Release: Service Precautions
WARNING: Adhere to the following procedures any time the fuel system is being worked on in
order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury:
- Keep a dry chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher near the work area.
- Place a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the work area.
- Work in a well-ventilated area. Do not smoke, and keep sparks and open flames away.
- Wear eye protection.
- Use caution when working near the catalytic converter to prevent the possibility of burns or fire.
(The temperatures within the converter can exceed 537°C (1000°F).)
- Relieve the fuel system pressure prior to disconnecting fuel system components.
- Disconnect the negative battery cable except for tests where battery voltage is required.
- Use a suitable container to store or catch fuel.
- Do not replace fuel pipe with fuel hose.
- Plug all disconnected fuel line fittings and hoses.
- After making any fuel system repairs ALWAYS inspect for fuel leaks.
- If available, use system bleed (schrader) valve to relieve fuel system pressure.
Page 1171
Engine Oil: Testing and Inspection Oil Quality Check
1. Check engine oil quality.
Check the oil for deterioration, entry of water, discoloring or thinning. If the oil quality is visibly poor,
replace it.
2. Oil grade:
API grade SH, Energy-Conserving II multigrade engine oil or ILSAC multigrade engine oil.
Recommended viscosity is as shown in the illustration. SAE 5W-30 being the preferred engine oil.
Page 1115
4. EVACUATE AIR IN REFRIGERATION SYSTEM AND CHARGE WITH REFRIGERANT
Specified amount:
600 ± 50 g (21.16 ± 1.76 oz.)
5. INSPECT FOR LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT
Using a gas leak detector, check for leakage of refrigerant.
6. INSPECT AIR CONDITIONING OPERATION
Page 3492
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 672
Page 1310
1st pass: 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) 2nd pass: Turn additional 90°
CAUTION: Do not turn the crankshaft.
(i) Remove the 2 nuts and connecting rod cap. (See procedure (b) and (c) above).
(j) Measure the Plastigage at its widest point. Standard oil clearance:
STD: 0.024 - 0.053 mm (0.0009 - 0.0021 inch) U/S 0.25: 0.023 - 0.069 mm (0.0009 - 0.0027 inch)
Maximum oil clearance: 0.08 mm (0.0031 inch) If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum,
replace the bearings. If necessary, grind or replace the crankshaft.
NOTE: If using a standard bearing, replace with one having the same number marked on the
connecting rod cap. There are 3 sizes of standard bearings, marked "1", "2" and "3" accordingly.
Reference: Standard bearing center wall thickness:
Mark "1": 1.484 - 1.488 mm (0.0584 - 0.0586 inch) Mark "2": 1.488 - 1.492 mm (0.0586 - 0.0587
inch) Mark "3": 1.492 - 1.496 mm (0.0587 - 0.0589 inch)
(k) Completely remove the Plastigage.
Page 3104
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 717
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2125
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 1417
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection Power Steering
TENSION CHECK
Using a belt tension gauge, check the tension.
Belt tension gauge:
Nippondenso BTG-20 (95506-00020) or Borroughs No.BT-33-73F
Drive belt tension:
New belt: 135 - 180 lbs. Used belt: 85 - 120 lbs.
NOTICE: After installing the belt, check that it fits properly in the ribbed grooves.
HINT: New belt refers to a belt which has been less than 5 minutes on a running engine.
- Used belt refers to a belt which has been used on a running engine for 5 minutes or more.
Page 401
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection On Vehicle Inspections
ON VEHICLE INSPECTION
INSPECT THERMISTOR RESISTANCE
1. Place the thermistor in cold water, and while changing the temperature of the water, measure
resistance at the connector and at the same time,
measure temperature of the water with a thermometer.
2. Compare the 2 readings on the chart.
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the thermistor.
Page 2441
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The camshaft position sensor, which detects the crankshaft angle signal (G signal), has been
installed on the front of right bank cylinder head. The timing rotor has been integrated with the right
bank camshaft timing pulley. When the camshafts rotate, the protrusion on the timing rotor and the
air gap on the pick up coil change, causing fluctuations, in the magnetic field and generating an
electromotive force in the pick up coil. The NE signal plate has 34 teeth and is mounted on the
crankshaft. The NE signal sensor generates 34 signals for every engine revolution. The ECM
detects the standard crankshaft angle based on the 6 signals and the actual crankshaft angle and
the engine speed by the NE signals.
Page 2684
CHART 25
Diagram Information and Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2012
Knock Sensor: Oscilloscope Patterns and Waveforms
Page 4263
3. Remove rear axle shaft from backing plate.
a. Position SST 09521-25011 on the backing plate with 4 nuts.
b. Using a press, remove the rear axle shaft with the bearing retainer from the backing plate. c.
Remove the SST.
4. Inspect axle shaft. If the rear axle shaft or flange are damaged or worn, or if runout is greater
than the maximum, replace the rear axle shaft.
Maximum shaft runout: 2.0 mm (0.079 inch) Maximum flange runout: 0.1 mm (0.004 inch)
5. Remove outer oil seal. Using SST 09308-00010, remove the oil seal.
Page 2456
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Specifications
Wheel Fastener: Specifications
Tightening Torque 83 ft.lb
Page 3629
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 2660
Page 4483
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 3558
Ignition Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Brake Light Switch: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
INSPECT STOP LIGHT SWITCH CONTINUITY
w/o Cruise Control:
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
w/ Cruise Control:
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Page 3617
Specifications
Valve Guide: Specifications
VALVE GUIDE OIL CLEARANCE
STD:
Intake
.....................................................................................................................................................
0.025 - 0.060 mm (0.0010 - 0.0024 inch) Exhaust
.................................................................................................................................................. 0.030
- 0.065 mm (0.0012 - 0.0026 inch)
Maximum:
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 0.08 mm (0.0031 inch) Exhaust ............................................................................
.................................................................................................. 0.10 mm (0.0039 inch)
Page 4012
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
The No.1 vehicle speed sensor outputs a 4-pulse signal for every revolution of the rotor shaft,
which is rotated by the transmission output shaft via the driven gear.
After this signal is converted into a more precise rectangular waveform by the waveform shaping
circuit inside the combination meter, it is then transmitted to the ECM. The ECM determines the
vehicle speed based on the frequency of these pulse signals.
The No.2 vehicle speed sensor detects the rotation speed of the transmission output shaft and
sends signals to the ECM. The ECM determines the vehicle speed based on these signals.
An AC voltage is generated in the No.2 vehicle speed sensor coil as the rotor mounted on the
output shaft rotates, and this voltage is sent to the ECM.
The gear shift point and lock-up timing are controlled by the ECM based on the signals from this
vehicle speed sensor and the throttle position sensor signal.
If the No.2 vehicle speed sensor malfunctions, the ECM uses input signals from the No.1 vehicle
speed sensor as a back-up signal.
Page 158
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 2 Of 2
Page 3785
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 3279
Page 3081
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3042
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 3344
Page 3556
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 739
Page 4256
3. Install hub bolt.
Install a washer and nut to a new hub bolt as shown and install the hub bolt with torquing the nut.
4. Install brake drum and wheel.
Torque to 110 Nm (83 ft. lbs.)
Inspection and Repair
INSPECTION AND REPAIR
1. w/ ABS: Remove bearing retainer (differential side) and ABS speed sensor rotor.
a. Attach 4 nuts to the serration bolts and remove the serration bolts from the backing plate using a
hammer.
NOTICE: Do not reuse the nuts previously removed from the vehicle.
b. Grind the retainer and sensor rotor surfaces using grinder, then chisel them out with a chisel. c.
Attach washers and nut to the serration bolts, then torque the nuts to install the serration bolts to
the backing plate. d. Remove the 4 nuts from the serration:ion bolts.
2. Remove snap ring from axle. shaft Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring.
3. Remove rear axle shaft from backing plate.
a. Position SST 09521-25011 on the backing plate with 4 nuts.
Page 3265
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 3283
3. INSTALL FUEL PIPE AND TIGHTENING DELIVERY PIPE HOLDING BOLTS
(a) Install the fuel pipe with 4 new gaskets and the 2 union bolts.
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf)
(b) Tighten the 4 bolts holding the delivery pipes to the intake manifold.
Torque: 13 N.m (130 kgf.cm, 10 ft.lbf)
4. CONNECT FUEL INLET PIPE
(a) Temporarily install the union and 2 new gaskets. and connect the fuel pipe. (b) Install the clamp
bolt.
Torque: 8 N.m (80 kgf.cm, 71 in.lbf)
(c) Tighten the union bolt.
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf)
5. INSTALL FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR
6. VISUALLY INSPECT AIR ASSIST LINES AND CONNECTIONS
Look for loose connections, sharp bends or damage.
7. INSTALL INTAKE AIR CONNECTOR 8. INSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE 9. CHECK FOR FUEL
LEAKS
A/C
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection A/C
DRIVE BELT TENSION INSPECTION
1. INSPECT DRIVE BELTS INSTALLATION CONDITION
Check that the drive belt fits properly in the ribbed grooves.
2. INSPECT DRIVE BELT TENSION
Using a belt tension gauge, check the drive belt tension.
Drive belt tension:
New belt: 160 ± 25 lb Used belt: 100 ± 20 lb
HINT: "New belt" refers to a belt which has been used less than 5 minutes on a running engine.
- "Used belt" refers to a belt which has used on a running engine for 5 minutes or more.
- After installing the drive belt, check that it fits properly in the ribbed grooves.
Page 1069
(c) Using SST Variable Pin Wrench Set # 09960 - 10010 (Variable Pin Wrench Arm Assembly #
09962 - 01000, Pin 10 # 09963 - 01000) or equivalents, install the pulley bolt. Torque: 110 Nm (81
ft. lbs.)
6. Set No. 1 cylinder to Top Dead Center (TDC)/compression.
(a) Crankshaft Timing Pulley Position: ^
Temporarily install the crankshaft pulley bolt to the crankshaft.
^ Turn the crankshaft, and align the timing marks of the crankshaft timing pulley and oil pump body.
(b) Camshaft Timing Pulley Positions:
Using SST Variable Pin Wrench Set # 09960 - 10010 (Variable Pin Wrench Arm Assembly # 09962
- 01000, Pin 10 # 09963 - 01000) or equivalents, turn the camshaft pulley, align the timing marks of
the timing pulley and No. 3 timing belt cover.
7. Install timing belt.
CAUTION: The engine should be cold.
(a) Remove any oil or water on the pulleys, and keep them clean.
CAUTION: Only wipe the pulleys; do not use any cleansing agent.
(b) Face the front mark on the timing belt forward. (c)
Align the installation mark on the timing belt with the timing mark of the crankshaft timing pulley.
(d) Align the installation marks on the timing belt with the timing marks of the camshaft timing
pulleys.
Page 4544
Position Of Parts In Instrument Panel (2 Of 2) (Fig 29)
Page 4034
Springs / Lower Valve Body
Page 410
Troubleshooting / Meter, Gauges And Illumination
Page 3080
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3584
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 7
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 2802
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 4426
Output Shaft: Service and Repair Assembly
HINT: coat all of the sliding and rotating surfaces with gear oil before assembly.
1. Install clutch hub No.2 into hub sleeve No.2
a. Install the clutch hub No.2 and shifting keys to the hub sleeve No.2.
b. Install the shifting key springs under the shifting keys.
NOTICE: position the key springs so that their end gaps are not in line.
2. Install clutch hub No.1 into reverse gear.
a. Install the 3 shifting key springs to the clutch hub No.1.
b. While pushing the shifting key spring with a screw-driver, install the 3 shifting keys.
Drivetrain - Drive/Axle Shaft Replacement Precautions
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Drive/Axle Shaft Replacement
Precautions
TRANSMISSION & CLUTCH TC003-07
Title: DRIVESHAFT ASSEMBLY REPLACEMENT
Models: '90 - '07 Toyota
Introduction The purpose of this bulletin is to provide information regarding anti-corrosion grease
that is present on replacement driveshaft assemblies. It is important to remove this grease prior to
installing the hub nut to prevent overtightening. This also applies when reusing an old driveshaft
that may have come into contact with oil or foreign matter.
Applicable Vehicles
^ 1990 - 2007 model year Toyota vehicles.
Required Tools & Material
Repair Procedure
Clean the threaded area of the driveshaft with Toyota Brake Cleaner (or equivalent) to remove the
anti-corrosion grease, oil, or foreign matter before installing the driveshaft into the vehicle.
NOTE:
A new axle hub nut may be required when installing the driveshaft. Check the Repair Manual
procedure for more information.
Warranty Information
Locations
Actuator Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 280
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Mechanical Specifications
ECT sensor to Intake Manifold 14 ft.lb
Page 495
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 286
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 4258
b. Using SST 09515-30010, 09950-60020 (09951-00890), install a new bearing.
7. Install new outer oil seal.
a. Using SST 09950-60010 (09951-00610), 09950-70010 (09951-07150), install a new oil seal. b.
install 4 nuts to the serration bolts. c. Using a hammer, remove the serration bolts and remove the
bearing case. d. Position the backing plate on a new bearing case and, using 2 socket wrenches,
install the serration bolts. Install a new bearing and oil seal
(outer side).
8. Replace bearing case.
a. Remove the oil seal (outer side) and bearing. b. Install 4 nuts to the serration bolts. c. using a
hammer, remove the serration bolts and the bearing case.
d. Position the backing plate on a new bearing case and, using 2 socket wrenches, install the
serration bolts. e. Install a new bearing and outer oil seal.
9. Replace oil seal (inner side).
a. Using SST 09308-00010, remove the oil seal.
Page 2841
Mechanical Specifications
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Mechanical Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Assembly To Shackle No.1 .................................................................................................................
................................................. 29 Nm (22 ft. lbs.) Bracket to Frame .................................................
................................................................................................................................. 29 Nm (22 ft.
lbs.) Mounting Nut ...............................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 13 Nm (9 ft. lbs.) Shackle No.1 To Shackle No.2
.............................................................................................................................................................
25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) Shackle No.2 To Shackle Bracket
..........................................................................................................................................................
13 Nm (9 ft. lbs.) Spring Assembly Nut ...............................................................................................
............................................................................. 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
Description and Operation
Acceleration/Deceleration Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This sensor detects deceleration on the vehicle. The sensor signal is used in Anti-Lock Brake
System (ABS) control. If the sensor functions abnormally, the ABS warning light comes on but the
ABS still operates.
Page 1653
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 3043
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 4579
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
2-4 Selector Switch
Inspect 2-4 selector switch continuity. Test continuity between terminals 1 and 2.
Switch position: Specified condition.
OFF: No continuity. ON: Continuity.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the shift lever knob.
Page 4337
Flywheel: Testing and Inspection
Inspect flywheel runout.
Using a dial indicator, check the flywheel runout.
Maximum Runout: 0.1 mm (0.004 inch)
If necessary, replace the flywheel.
Page 4918
(j) Depress the brake pedal and hold it for about 15 seconds. As you hold the pedal down. push the
MOTOR switch for a few seconds. Check that
the brake pedal does not pulsate.
(k) Release the brake pedal.
5. Inspect the other wheels.
(a) Change the connection of the actuator checker (SST) to the sub-wire harness E (SST) from the
sub-wire harness MAIN connector to the SUB
connector, or vice versa.
(b) Repeating (c) to (j) of the step 4, check the actuator operation similarly.
6. Inspect the rear wheel.
Depress MOTOR Switch And Brake Pedal
(a) Turn the selector switch to the "REAR" position. (b) Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a
few seconds. (c) Depress the brake pedal and hold it until the step (g) is completed.
Depress POWER Switch
(d) Push the REAR switch while pressing the POWER switch. and check that the brake pedal does
not go down.
CAUTION: Do not keep the POWER switch pushed down for more than 10 seconds.
(e) Release the REAR switch then the POWER switch, and check that the brake pedal goes down.
Depress MOTOR Switch
(f) Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few seconds, and check that the pedal returns. (g)
Release the brake pedal.
Page 54
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4515
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
2-4 Selector Switch
Inspect 2-4 selector switch continuity. Test continuity between terminals 1 and 2.
Switch position: Specified condition.
OFF: No continuity. ON: Continuity.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the shift lever knob.
Page 3065
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 1913
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The camshaft position sensor, which detects the crankshaft angle signal (G signal), has been
installed on the front of right bank cylinder head. The timing rotor has been integrated with the right
bank camshaft timing pulley. When the camshafts rotate, the protrusion on the timing rotor and the
air gap on the pick up coil change, causing fluctuations, in the magnetic field and generating an
electromotive force in the pick up coil. The NE signal plate has 34 teeth and is mounted on the
crankshaft. The NE signal sensor generates 34 signals for every engine revolution. The ECM
detects the standard crankshaft angle based on the 6 signals and the actual crankshaft angle and
the engine speed by the NE signals.
Page 4834
Warranty Information
NOTE:
Replacement of the front brake pad kit and/or shims is limited to correction of a problem based
upon a customer's complaint and subject to all of the provisions of Toyota Warranty Policy Bulletin
POL94-18, dated October 10, 1994.
Page 2107
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 312
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 4757
ABS Warning Light Circuit Inspection Procedure (Part 2 Of 2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
If the Electronic Control Unit (ECU) detects trouble, it lights the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
warning light while at the same time prohibiting ABS control. At this time, the ECU records a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) in memory. After removing the short pin of the Data Link
Connector (DLC)1, connect terminals Tc and E1 of the DLC1 to make the ABS warning light blink
and output the DTC.
Troubleshooting in accordance with the chart for each trouble symptom.
Testing and Inspection
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT SEAT BELT BUCKLE SWITCH CONTINUITY
1. Check that there is continuity between terminals on the switch side connector with the switch ON
(belt unfastened). 2. Check that there is no continuity between terminals on the switch side
connector with the switch OFF (belt fastened).
If operation is not as specified, replace the seat belt inner.
Page 2459
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 4661
Junction Block And Wire Harness Connector
Page 2388
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2614
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 1721
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Integration Relay
Key Reminder Switch: Testing and Inspection Integration Relay
INTEGRATION RELAY INSPECTION
INSPECT RELAY CIRCUIT
Remove the relay from the junction block No.1 and inspect the connectors on the junction block
side.
If circuit is as specified, try replacing the relay with a new one.
If circuit is not as specified, inspect the circuits connected to other parts.
Page 2816
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Mechanical Specifications
ECT sensor to Intake Manifold 14 ft.lb
Page 4141
If the maximum torque is exceeded while retightening the nut, replace the bearing spacer and
repeat the preload procedure. Do not back off the nut to reduce the preload.
New bearing preload (at starting): 1.2 - 1.9 Nm (10.4 - 16.5 inch lbs.)
Reused bearing preload (at starting): 0.6 - 1.0 Nm (5.2 - 8.7 inch lbs.) If the preload is greater than
the specification, replace the bearing spacer.
20. Install differential case. 21. Install side bearing retainer.
a. Remove any old FIPG material and be careful not to drop oil on the contact surfaces of the
differential carrier and side bearing retainer. b. Clean contacting surfaces of any residual FIPG
material using gasoline or alcohol.
c. Apply FIPG: Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281, or equivalent, to the side bearing
retainer, as shown.
HINT: Install the side bearing retainer within 10 minutes after applying FIPG.
d. Install the side bearing retainer with the 10 bolts.
Torque to 69 Nm (51 ft. lbs.)
22. Check total preload. 23. Recheck ring gear backlash. 24. Recheck tooth contact between ring
gear and drive pinion. 25. Check runout of companion flange. 26. Stake drive pinion nut.
27. Install side oil seal. Using SST 09608-32010 and a hammer, install a new oil seal until its
surface is flush with the differential carrier end.
Side oil seal drive in depth: 0 mm (0 inch)
b. Coat the oil seal lip with MP geese.
28. W/ A.D.D.: Install intermediate shaft.
Page 2739
Page 2026
Page 4156
2. Install side bearings. Using SST 09950-60010 (09951-00480, 09951-00550), 09950-60020
(09951-00730) and a press, install the side bearings on
the differential case.
3. Install ring gear on differential case.
a. Clean the contact surfaces of the differential case and ring gear.
b. Heat the ring gear to about 100° C (212° F) in boiling water. c. Carefully remove the ring gear
from the water. d. After the moisture on the ring gear has completely evaporated, quickly install the
ring gear to the differential case.
e. Align the matchmarks on the ring gear and differential case. f.
Temporarily install new lock plates and set bolts.
g. After the ring gear cools down enough, tighten the set bolts uniformly and a little at a time.
Torque to 97 Nm (71 ft. lbs.)
h. Using a drift. punch and hammer, stake the lock plates.
HINT: Stake one claw flush with the fiat surface of the bolt. For the claw contacting the protruding
portion of the bolt, stake the half on the tightening side.
4. Check ring gear runout.
a. Install the differential case onto the carrier and tighten the adjusting nut just to where there is no
play in the bearings.
Exhaust System - Manifold Heat Shield Rattle Noise
Heat Shield: All Technical Service Bulletins Exhaust System - Manifold Heat Shield Rattle Noise
Engine
EG004-00
June 2, 2000
Title: EXHAUST MANIFOLD HEAT SHIELD RATTLE NOISE
Models: '95 - '00 Tacoma
Introduction
Some Tacoma vehicles may experience a rattle noise caused by the exhaust manifold heat shield.
Two wire mesh grommets and a reinforcement patch on the underside have been added to reduce
the possibility of the exhaust manifold heat shield rattle noise.
Applicable Vehicles
^ 1995 - 2000 model year Tacoma vehicles (except CA Spec.) equipped with 2RZ-FE or 3RZ-FE
engines produced before the VINs listed.
Production Change Information
Parts Information Repair Procedure
1. Inspect the Exhaust Manifold Heat Shield for cracking around the 2 bolts and 2 studs.
2. If cracking is found, replace the Exhaust Manifold Heat Shield, Bolts, Washers, Studs, and Nuts
in specified quantities.
3. Insert 2 bolts. (P/N 90110-06894)
4. Reuse studs/nuts in the specified areas.
Warranty Information
Testing and Inspection
Control Module HVAC: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT AMPLIFIER CIRCUIT
1. Disconnect the amplifier connector and inspect the connector on wire harness side, as shown in
the chart.
Test conditions: -
Ignition switch ON
- Temperature control lever MAX COOL
- Blower control lever HI
If circuit is as specified, try replacing the amplifier with a new one. If the circuit is not as specified,
inspect the circuits connected to other parts.
2. Connect the connector to A/C amplifier and inspect wire harness side connector from the back
side, as shown.
Test conditions: Ignition switch ON
- A/C switch ON
- Temperature control dial MAX COOL
- Blower control lever HI
- Install manifold gauge set
If circuit is as specified, try replacing the amplifier with a new one. If the circuit is not as specified,
inspect the circuits connected to other parts.
Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Specifications
Between Terminals Measured Resistance
At Clearance: 0 mm (0 in.) VTA - E2 0.2 - 5.7 K ohms
Throttle Fully Opened VTA - E2 2.0 - 10.2 K ohms
At all Times VC - E2 2.5 - 5.9 K ohms
Ohmmeter Connection
Page 4869
Brake Shoe: Service and Repair
Rear Brake Components (4WD)
REMOVAL
1. Remove rear wheel. 2. Remove brake drum.
NOTE: If the brake drum cannot be removed easily, do the following steps.
(a) Remove the adjusting hole plug in the backing plate.
(b) Insert a screwdriver through the hole in the backing plate, and hold the automatic adjusting
lever away from the adjusting bolt. (c) Using another screwdriver, reduce the brake shoe
adjustment by turning the adjusting bolt.
3. Remove rear shoe.
Page 2375
Page 3901
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 1543
Timing Belt: Service and Repair Timing Belt Installation
1. Install crankshaft timing pulley.
(a) Align the pulley set key with the key groove of the timing pulley and slide on the timing pulley.
(b) Slide on the timing pulley, facing the flange side inward.
2. Install No. 1 idler pulley.
(a) Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, install the No. 1 idler pulley with the plate washer and bolt.
Torque: 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.)
(b) Check that the pulley bracket moves smoothly.
3. Install No. 2 idler pulley.
(a) Install the No. 2 idler pulley with the bolt. Torque: 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
(b) Check that the No. 2 idler pulley moves smoothly.
4. Install LH camshaft timing pulley.
(a) Face the flange side of the timing pulley outward.
(b) Align the knock pin on the camshaft with the knock pin groove of the timing pulley, and slide on
the timing pulley.
(c) Using Special Service Tool (SST) Variable Pin Wrench Set # 09960 - 10010 (Variable Pin
Wrench Arm Assembly # 09962 - 01000, Pin 10 # 09963 - 01000) or equivalents, install the pulley
bolt. Torque: 110 Nm (81 ft. lbs.)
5. Install RH camshaft timing pulley.
(a) Face the flange side of the timing pulley outward.
(b) Align the knock pin on the camshaft with the knock pin groove of the timing pulley, and slide on
the timing pulley.
Page 4154
Differential Carrier (3RZ-FE, 5VZ-FE w/Differential Lock)
1. Assemble differential case.
a. Apply all of the sliding and rotating surfaces with gear oil.
b. Install the side gear thrust washer to the side gear.
Testing and Inspection
Dashpot: Testing and Inspection
DASHPOT (DP) INSPECTION - M/T ONLY
INSPECT DASHPOT (DP) (a) Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature. (b)
Check idle speed.
Idle speed: 700 ± 50 rpm
(c) Remove the cap, filter and separator from the DP.
(d) Maintain engine speed at 2,500 rpm or more.
(e) Plug the VTV hole with your finger. (f) Release the throttle valve. (g) Check the DP is set.
DP setting speed: 1,800 - 2,200 rpm
(h) If the setting speed is not as specified, adjust it with the DP adjusting screw. (i) Remove your
finger from the hole and check that the engine returns to idle speed in approx. 1 second. (j)
Reinstall DP separator, filter and cap.
HINT: Install the filter with the coarser surface facing the atmospheric side (outward).
Page 3062
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2038
CHART 1
Page 2615
Knock Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 888
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 3100
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 1980
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2752
Step 3
Step 4
Step 5
Step 6
Page 1458
Engine Oil: Testing and Inspection Oil Pressure Check
1. Check engine oil quality.
Check the oil for deterioration, entry of water, discoloring or thinning. If the oil quality is visibly poor,
replace it.
2. Check engine oil level.
The oil level should be between the "L" and "F" marks on the dipstick. If low, check for leakage and
add oil up to the "F" mark.
3. Remove oil pressure switch.
Using Special Service Tool (SST) Oil Pressure Switch Socket # 09816 - 30010 or equivalent,
remove the oil pressure switch.
4. Install oil pressure gauge. 5. Start engine.
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature.
6. Measure oil pressure.
Oil pressure:
At idle speed: 29 kPa (4.3 psi) or more At 3,000 rpm: 245 - 520 kPa (36 - 75 psi)
7. Turn engine off. 8. Remove oil pressure gauge. 9. Install oil pressure switch.
(a) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the oil pressure switch. Adhesive: Part No. 08833 - 00080,
THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE 242 or equivalent.
(b) Using SST Oil Pressure Switch Socket # 09816 - 30010 or equivalent, install the oil pressure
switch.
10. Start engine and check for leaks.
Page 707
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 1178
Power Steering Fluid: Fluid Type Specifications
LUBRICATION
Lubricant Type Power Steering ...........................................................................................................
................................................................................. Dexron II/IIE/III
Page 815
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 2589
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 665
Page 531
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Mechanical Specifications
ECT sensor to Intake Manifold 14 ft.lb
Page 2487
Page 3338
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 675
CHART 30
Page 3438
Throttle Body: Specifications
Throttle Body to Intake (Nuts) 13 ft.lb
Throttle Body to Intake (Bolts) 13 ft.lb
Page 4883
5. IF NECESSARY, CHECK VALVE BODY
(a) Assemble the valve body in the uppermost position.
HINT: When the brakes are applied, the position will move down about 0.8 mm (0.03 in.). Even at
this time, the piston should not make contact with or move the load sensing spring.
(b) In this position, check the rear brake pressure. if the measured value is not within the standard,
replace the valve body.
Page 3687
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Standard Value of ECM Terminals
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection Standard Value of ECM Terminals
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 1 Of 2
Specifications
Wheel Cylinder: Specifications
Brake line 11 ft.lb
Mounting bolts 7 ft.lb
Page 4736
Torque: 5.4 Nm (55 kgf-cm, 48 inch lbs.)
8. CONNECT NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
Page 3998
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 4360
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 3394
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 4433
Page 3553
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 3637
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 4177
2. Install dust deflector to companion flange. Using SST 09726-40010 and a press, install a new
dust deflector.
Without Differential Lock
1. Remove dust deflector. Using SST 09950-00020, a socket wrench and a press, remove the dust
deflector.
2. Install new dust deflector. Using SST 09523-36010 and a press, install a new dust deflector.
Page 4166
b. Ensure that the matchmarks of the pinion of the actuator is in the extent between 0 - 5 degrees
clockwise above the center line of the actuator.
NOTICE:
^ If the matchmarks is not in this extent, rotate the pinion to be matched.
^ Don't supply the battery positive voltage directly between terminals.
^ If the matchmarks come to the extension limit of the rotation, don't electrify moreover.
c. Install a new O-ring to the actuator. d. Apply a light coat of gear oil on the O-ring. e. Apply MP
grease to the gear part.
f. Insert the actuator so that the long hole on the actuator side fits with the knock pin on the carrier
side.
HINT: Don't damage the O-ring of the actuator.
g. Align the actuator with the long hole and rotate the actuator counterclockwise when the knock
pin reaches the right-hand side. h. Install the actuator to the differential carrier with the bolt so that
the outermost rack tooth of the shift fork will fit the matchmarks of the pinion
of the actuator.
Torque to 26 Nm (20 ft. lbs.)
Without Differential Lock
Service and Repair
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair
CAUTION:
* Work must be started 90 seconds after the ignition switch is turned to the "LOCK" position and
the negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from
the battery. (The SRS is equipped with a back-up power source so that if work is started within 90
seconds of disconnecting the negative (-) terminal cable of the battery, the SRS may be deployed.)
* When the negative (-) terminal cable is disconnected from the battery, the memory of the clock
and audio system will be canceled. So before starting
work, make a record of the contents memorized in the audio memory system. When work is
finished, reset the audio systems as before and adjust the clock. To avoid erasing the memory of
each memory system, never use a backup power supply from outside the vehicle.
* Before repairs, remove the airbag sensor if shocks are likely to be applied to the sensor during
repairs. * Do not expose the steering wheel pad, front passenger airbag assembly, airbag sensor
assembly or front airbag sensor directly to hot air or flames.
AIR BAG SYSTEM DISARMING
The Air Bag/Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) incorporates a backup energy source that
maintains sufficient deployment voltage for up to 90 seconds after the ignition is turned Off and the
battery has been disconnected. Before disconnecting battery, note radio station settings, since all
vehicle memory will be lost. Never use a backup power source from outside the vehicle.
1. Turn ignition to Lock, then disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnection before beginning service or diagnostic procedures.
AIR BAG SYSTEM ARMING
1. Ensure ignition is in Lock position.
2. Connect battery ground cable.
3. Wait at least 10 seconds before turning ignition from Lock position.
4. Turn ignition to ACC or On position and ensure SRS lamp lights, then goes off after
approximately six seconds. If lamp remains lit, an SRS condition is indicated. Refer to Diagnosis
and Testing.
Page 3734
Position Of Parts In Engine Compartment (Part 1 Of 2) (Fig 24)
Application and ID
Valve Spring Shim: Application and ID
ADJUSTING SHIM SELECTION CHART (INTAKE)
Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 3795
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 3638
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 3091
Diagram Information and Instructions
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2793
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 50
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Axle Shaft, Conventional Fixed/Floating
Axle Shaft: Locations Axle Shaft, Conventional Fixed/Floating
Rear Axle Shaft (1 Of 2)
Locations
Antenna Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 486
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures
DTC P0505 Idle Control System Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The rotary solenoid type IAC valve is located in front of the intake air chamber and intake air
bypassing the throttle valve is directed to the IAC valve through a passage. In this way the intake
air volume bypassing the throttle valve is regulated, controlling the engine speed. The ECM
operates only the IAC valve to perform idle-up and provide feedback for the target idling speed and
a VSV for idle up control is also added (for air conditioning).
DETECTING CONDITION
WIRING DIAGRAM
Step 1
Page 709
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 3538
5. RECONNECT HIGH-TENSION CORDS TO IGNITION COILS
(a) Assemble the holder and grommet.
(b) Align the spline of the ignition coil with the spline of the holder and push in the cord.
NOTICE: Check that the holder is correctly installed to the grommet and distributor cap as shown in
the illustration.
(c) Check that the lock claw of the holder is engaged by lightly pulling the holder.
6. RECONNECT HIGH-TENSION CORDS TO SPARK PLUGS 7. REINSTALL AIR CLEANER
HOSE
Page 4700
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 4417
Page 3703
Components For Removal And Installation Part 2 Of 2
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
KNOCK SENSORS REMOVAL
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT 2. REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE 3. REMOVE INTAKE AIR
CONNECTOR 4. REMOVE HIGH-TENSION CORDS WITH IGNITION COILS 5. REMOVE FUEL
PRESSURE REGULATOR 6. REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY 7. REMOVE WATER
BYPASS PIPE AND KNOCK SENSOR WIRE
Page 945
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch goes on when the shift lever is in the N or P shift position. When it
goes on terminal NSW of the ECM is grounded to body ground via the starter relay, thus the
terminal NSW voltage becomes 0 V. When the shift lever is in the D, 2, L or R position, the
park/neutral position switch goes off, so the voltage of ECM, terminal NSW becomes battery
voltage, the voltage of the ECM internal power source.
If the shift lever is moved from the N position to the D position, this signal is used for air-fuel ratio
correction and for idle speed control (estimated control), etc.
Page 3663
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2122
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Mechanical Specifications
Axle Shaft: Mechanical Specifications
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Axle Shaft Deviation [1]
................................................................................................................................................... 0.7
mm (0.027 inch) Maximum Deviation [2] .............................................................................................
..................................................................... 0.1 mm (0.0039 inch) Maximum Bearing Backlash [1]
........................................................................................................................................................ 0.7
mm (0.027 inch) Maximum Flange Runout .........................................................................................
......................................................................... 0.1 mm (0.004 inch) Maximum Shaft Runout ............
.........................................................................................................................................................
2.0 mm (0.079 inch) Maximum
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Backing Plate To Shaft Mounting Nuts
................................................................................................................................................ 68 Nm
(50 ft. lbs.)
[1]: Measured in the bearing shaft direction. [2]: At the surface of the axle shaft outside the hub
bolt.
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
One Touch 2-4 Selector System
Page 2423
Camshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Cam Sensor to Cylinder Head 69 in.lb
Page 840
Page 3893
Position Of Parts In Instrument Panel (1 Of 2) (Fig 28)
Page 2403
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 1078
Drive Belt: Specifications Alternator Belt
GENERATOR / SERVICE DATA
DRIVE BELT
New belt
2RZ-FE, 3RZ-FE:
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 165 ± 10 lb.
5VZ-FE:
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 160 ± 25 lb.
Used belt
2RZ-FE, 3RZ-FE:
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 115 ± 20 lb.
5VZ-FE:
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 100 ± 20 lb.
Page 4671
operation causes gear shift when the conditions for overdrive are met.
^ O/D Main SW OFF When the O/D main SW is turned to OFF, the current flowing through the O/D
OFF indicator light flows through the O/D main SW to GROUND, causing the indicator light to light
up. At the same time, a signal is input to TERMINAL OD2 of the Engine Control Module and
Engine Control Module operation prevents shift into overdrive.
5. A/T OIL TEMP. WARNING
When the A/T Oil Temp. Sensor affixed to the transmission case detects that the fluid temp. is
150°C (302°F) or more, the Engine Control Module operates and the current flowing through the
GAUGE fuse flows to the A/T Oil Temp. warning light --> TERMINAL OIL-W of the Engine Control
Module --> Ground, so that the warning light lights up, informing that the Oil Temp. is high. When
the Oil Temp. drops to 120°C (248°F) or less, the Engine Control Module stops operating and the
warning light goes out.
Page 2898
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 4672
Shift Indicator: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2771
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 1803
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Electrical Specifications
EGR Temperature Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Note: Except Model VZN170 (Long wheel base 4WD Pickup)
Resistance 64 - 97 K ohms at 122 deg F
11 - 16 K ohms at 212 deg F
2 - 4 K ohms at 302 deg F
Page 4486
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 4805
Brake Pedal Assy: Adjustments
BRAKE PEDAL INSPECTION
Check Pedal Height
1. Check pedal height.
Pedal height from asphalt sheet: 159.1 - 169.1 mm (6.262 - 6.657 inch)
2. IF necessary, adjust pedal height.
(a) Disconnect the connector from the stop light switch. (b) Loosen the stop light switch lock nut
and remove the stop light switch. (c) Loosen the push rod lock nut. (d) Adjust the pedal height by
turning the pedal push rod. (e) Tighten the push rod lock nut.
Torque: 25 Nm (19 ft. lbs.)
(f) Install the stop light switch and turn it until it lightly contacts the pedal stopper. (g) Turn the stop
light switch back one turn.
Check Clearance (A) Between Stop Light Switch And Pedal
(h) Check the clearance (A) between the stop light switch and pedal.
Clearance: 0.5 - 2.4 mm (0.020 - 0.094 inch)
(i) Tighten the stop light switch lock nut. (j) Connect the connector to the stop light switch. (k)
Check that the stop lights come on when the brake pedal is depressed, and go off when the brake
pedal is released. (l) After adjusting the pedal height, check the pedal freeplay.
NOTE: If clearance (A) between the stop light switch and the pedal stopper has been adjusted
correctly, the pedal freeplay will meet the specifications.
3. Check pedal freeplay.
(a) Stop the engine and depress the brake pedal several times until there is no more vacuum left in
the booster.
Page 3514
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 2581
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 288
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 732
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 4909
4. Set rear axle load. 5. Set valve body.
(a) When pulling down the load sensing spring, confirm that the valve piston moves down
smoothly.
(b) Position the valve body so that the valve piston lightly contacts the load sensing spring. (c)
Tighten the valve body mounting nuts.
Torque: 13 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
6. Bleed brake system. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair 7. Check and adjust LSP & BV
fluid pressure.
Page 153
Engine Control-Connectors
Page 2855
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 2402
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
On models with serviceable wheel bearings, use a Lithium Multipurpose Grease.
Page 1801
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 4502
Transmission Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Vehicle NO.2 Speed Sensor Inspection Procedure
- Remove NO.2 vehicle speed sensor. - Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of NO.2
vehicle speed sensor.
Resistance: 560 Ohms to 680 Ohms
- Check voltage between terminals 1 and 2 of the NO.2 speed sensor when a magnet is put close
to the front end of the NO.2 vehicle speed sensor
then taken away quickly.
- Voltage is generated intermittenly.
Note: The voltages generated is extremely low.
Page 2143
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 4038
Upper Valve Body / Strainer
Page 4301
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Service and Repair Overhaul
DISASSEMBLY
1. Separate propeller shaft and intermediate shaft.
a. Place matchmarks on the flanges. b. Remove the 4 nuts, bolts and washers.
2. Remove center support bearing from intermediate shaft.
a. Using a chisel and hammer, loosen the staked part of the nut. b. Using Special Service Tool
(SST) 09930-00021 to hold the flange, remove the nut and spacer. c. Place matchmarks on the
flange and shaft.
d. Using SST 09950-30010 (09951-03010, 09953-03010, 09954-03010, 09955-03030,
09956-03020), remove the flange from the intermediate
shaft.
e. Remove the spacer.
3. Remove center support bearing.
4. Remove sleeve yoke from propeller shaft.
a. Place matchmarks on the sleeve yoke and shaft. b. Pull out the sleeve yoke from the shaft. c.
Remove the dust cover from the shaft.
Page 2208
Page 3691
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Inspection For Runout
Crankshaft: Testing and Inspection Inspection For Runout
1. Place the crankshaft on V - blocks. 2. Using a dial indicator, measure the circle runout at the No.
2 and No. 3 journal.
Maximum circle runout: 0.06 mm (0.0024 inch) If the circle runout is greater than maximum,
replace the crankshaft.
Page 4211
4. REMOVE OIL SEAL AND OIL SLINGER
a. Using SST, remove the oil seal.
SST 09350-32014 (09308-10010)
b. Remove the oil slinger.
5. REMOVE REAR BEARING AND BEARING SPACER
a. Using SST, remove the rear bearing from the drive pinion.
SST 09556-22010
b. Remove the bearing spacer.
6. INSTALL BEARING SPACER, REAR BEARING AND OIL SLINGER
a. Install a new bearing spacer and place the rear bearing and oil slinger.
b. Using SST and the companion flange, install the rear bearing, then remove the companion
flange.
SST 09950-30011 (09951-03010, 09953-03010, 09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03020)
7. INSTALL OIL SEAL
a. Coat a new oil seal lip with MP grease. b. Using SST and a hammer, install the oil seal.
SST 09554-22010
Oil seal drive in depth: 4.5 mm (0.177 inch)
Page 3268
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 1189
8. BE CAREFUL NOT TO OVERCHARGE SYSTEM WITH REFRIGERANT
If refrigerant is overcharged, it causes problems such as insufficient cooling, poor fuel economy,
engine overheating etc.
9. SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS)
The Vehicle is equipped with an SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) such as the driver airbag
and front passenger airbag. Failure to carry out service operations in the correct sequence could
cause the SRS to unexpectedly deployed during servicing. possibly leading to a serious accident.
Before servicing (including removal or installation of parts, inspection or replacement). be sure to
read each step/warning carefully, then follow the correct procedure described.
Page 3333
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 3729
Location Of Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness, Ground Points (Fig 36)
Ground Points
Ground Points
Page 3983
Throttle Valve Cable/Linkage: Adjustments
Adjustment
1. Check that the throttle valve is fully closed. 2. Check that the inner cable is not slack.
3. Measure the distance between the outer cable end and stopper on the cable.
Standard distance: 0 - 1 mm (0.0 - 0.04 in.)
If the distance is not the standard, adjust the cable by the adjusting nuts.
Page 1341
Piston: Testing and Inspection Inspect Ring Groove Clearance
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between new piston ring and the wall of the piston
ring groove. Ring groove clearance:
No. 1: 0.0.040 - 0.080 mm (0.0016 - 0.0031 inch) No. 2: 0.030 - 0.070 mm (0.0012 - 0.0028 inch)
If the clearance is not as specified, replace the piston.
A/T - Chatter When Shifted From R to P/N
Valve Body: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Chatter When Shifted From R to P/N
TRANSMISSION & CLUTCH TC001-98
FEBRUARY 13, 1998
TITLE: A340E, A343F "R" TO "P/N" CHATTER
MODELS: '97-'98 TACOMA, 4RUNNER, T-100 & LAND CRUISER
Introduction
Some Tacoma, 4Runner, T-100 and Land Cruisers with A340E, A340F or A343F automatic
transmissions may produce a chatter noise when shifted out of Reverse into either Neutral or Park.
To prevent this noise, a check ball has been added to the valve body as indicated in the illustration.
Affected Vehicles 1997-98 model year Tacoma, 4Runner, T-100 and Land Cruiser with A340E, A340F or A343F
automatic transmissions with serial numbers from 97H*-00001 through 97K*-99999.
Parts Information
OLD PART NUMBER NEW PART NUMBER PART NAME 35495-22020
Same Ball, Check, No. 1
35433-30064 Same Valve Body Gasket No. 1
35434-30076 Same Valve Body Gasket No. 2
Warranty Information
Applicable Warranty: This repair Is covered under the Toyota Powertrain Warranty. This warranty is
in effect for 60 months or 60,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in service date.
Repair Procedure
1. Disassembly:
A. Remove valve body as described in the Repair Manual for the vehicle being serviced. B. Turn
over and remove 25 bolts.
Page 2236
Page 2563
Engine Control-Connectors
Page 4668
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (Canada) (Fig 19)
Service Hints
E 2 ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
1, 2, 3-Ground: Approx 13 Ohms
Page 197
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 1822
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 2 Of 2
Page 120
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 2742
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 1 Of 2
Specifications
Brake Rotor/Disc: Specifications
Front Brake Rotors Standard Thickness 0.866 in
Minimum Thickness 0.787 in
Maximum Runout 0.0028 in
Page 642
Torque Specifications
Fluid Pump: Specifications Torque Specifications
Oil pump x Transmission case ............................................................................................................
...................................................... 22 Nm (16 ft. lbs.) Stator shaft x Oil pump body ...........................
........................................................................................................................................... 10 Nm (7
ft. lbs.)
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Camshaft Position Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSPECTION
NOTICE: "Cold" and "Hot" in these sentences express the temperature of the sensors themselves.
"Cold" is from -10°C (14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
1. DISCONNECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR CONNECTOR
2. INSPECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals.
Resistance:
Cold: 835 - 1,400 Ohms Hot: 1,060 - 1,645 Ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the camshaft position sensor.
3. RECONNECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR CONNECTOR
Page 2201
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 3146
(c) Check that air flows from port E to the filter. If operation is not as specified, replace the VSV.
3. REINSTALL VSV ASSEMBLY
(a) install the VSV assembly with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8 N.m (80 kgf.cm 71 in.lbf)
(b) Connect the 2 connectors and 4 vacuum hoses to the 2 VSV.
Page 2522
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 4303
d. Using SST 09930-00021 to hold the flange, press the bearing into position by tightening down a
new nut.
Torque: 181 N.m (134 ft. lbs.)
e. Loosen the nut. f.
Torque the nut again.
Torque: 69 N.m (51 ft. lbs.)
g. Using a chisel and hammer, stake the nut.
3. Install propeller shaft.
a. Align the matchmarks on the flanges and connect the flanges with 4 bolts, washers and nuts.
HINT: If replacing either the center flange or intermediate shaft, reassemble them so that the front
flange yoke of the intermediate shaft and the rear flange yoke of the propeller shaft are facing in
the same direction.
b. Torque the bolts.
Torque: 74 N.m (54 ft. lbs.)
4. Insert sleeve yoke into propeller shaft.
a. Apply grease to the propeller shaft spline and sleeve yoke sliding surface.
Grease: molybdenum disulfide lithium base chassis grease, NLGI No.2.
b. Install the dust cover to the shaft. c. Align the matchmarks on the yoke and propeller shaft.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Front
Alignment: Specifications Front
Camber, Caster and Steering Axis Inclination
NOTE:
RZN161L - 2.7L engine, SWB VZN160L - 3.4L engine, SWB RZN171L - 2.7L engine, LWB
VZN170L - 3.4L engine, LWB
RZN161L Camber: ..............................................................................................................................
...................................................... 0°15' ± 45' (0.25° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
Caster: .................................................................................................................................................
.................................... 1° 35' ± 45' (1.58° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
Steering Inclination: .............................................................................................................................
.................................... 10° 00' ± 45' (10° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
VZN160L Camber: ...............................................................................................................................
.................................................... 0° 15' ± 45' (0.25° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
Caster: .................................................................................................................................................
.................................... 1° 35' ± 45' (1.58° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
Steering Inclination:
..............................................................................................................................................................
10° 30' ± 45' (10.5° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
RZN171L Camber: ..............................................................................................................................
..................................................... 0° 20' ± 45' (0.33° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
Caster: .................................................................................................................................................
.................................... 1° 45' ± 45' (1.75° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
Steering Inclination:
..............................................................................................................................................................
10° 30' ± 45' (10.5° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
VZN170L Camber: ...............................................................................................................................
.................................................... 0° 20' ± 45' (0.33° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
Caster: .................................................................................................................................................
.................................... 1° 45' ± 45' (1.75° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
Steering Inclination:
..............................................................................................................................................................
10° 30' ± 45' (10.5° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
Toe-In and Wheel Angle
Total Toe-In:
(A + B) = 0° 12' ± 12' (0.02° ± 0.02°) (C - D) = 2 ± 2 mm (0.08 ± 0.08 inch)
Page 4606
1. Inspect drive sprocket thrust clearance.
Using a feeler gauge, measure the drive sprocket thrust clearance.
Standard Clearance: 0.10-0.25 mm (0.0039-0.0098 inch) Maximum Clearance: 0.25 mm (0.0098
inch) f the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the drive sprocket.
2. Remove high and low clutch sleeve assembly.
a. Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring. b. Remove the clutch sleeve and 3 shifting
keys. c. Using a press, remove the clutch hub, 2 key springs and key retainer.
3. Remove bearing, spacer and drive sprocket with front drive clutch sleeve assembly.
a. Using SST 09555-55010 and a press, remove the bearing.
b. Remove these parts.
^ Spacer and ball.
^ Drive sprocket with front drive clutch sleeve assembly.
^ Needle roller bearing.
^ Synchronizer ring.
4. Remove 3-shifting keys and 2 key springs from front drive clutch sleeve.
INSPECTION
Timing Belt Removal
Timing Belt: Service and Repair Timing Belt Removal
Page 565
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2464
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 2625
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Knock sensors are fitted one each to the right bank and left bank of the cylinder block to detect
engine knocking. This sensor contains a piezoelectric element which generates a voltage when it
becomes deformed, which occurs when the cylinder block vibrates due to knocking. If engine
knocking occurs, ignition timing is retarded to suppress it.
Page 3054
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 1053
1. Using a micrometer, measure the thickness of the removed shim. 2. Calculate the thickness of a
new shim so the valve clearance comes within the specified value.
T-Thickness of used shim A-Measured valve clearance N-Thickness of new shim Intake: N = T +
(A - 0.18 mm (0.007 inch)) Exhaust: N = T + (A - 0.32 mm (0.013 inch))
3. Select a new shim with a thickness as close as possible to the calculated values.
HINT: Shims are available in 17 sizes in increments of 0.050 mm (0.0020 inch), from 2.500 mm
(0.0984 inch) to 3.300 mm (0.1299 inch).
c. Install a new adjusting shim.
1. Place a new adjusting shim on the valve lifter, with imprinted numbers facing down.
2. Press down the valve lifter with SST (A), and remove SST (B).
SST 09248-55040 (09248-05410, 09248-05420)
d. Recheck the valve clearance.
6. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVERS 7. INSTALL INTAKE AIR CONNECTOR
Page 1807
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Locations
Automatic Differential Disconnect (A.D.D.) Component Locations
Page 2250
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Specifications
EGR Valve: Specifications
Except VZN170 Models.
EGR Valve to Air Intake Chamber 14 ft.lb
EGR Valve to EGR Pipe 14 ft.lb
Page 4551
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 1981
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2915
Page 2395
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Specifications
Shifter Transfer Case: Specifications
Transmission Shift Control Rod To Shift Lever
...................................................................................................................................... 13 N.m (10 ft.
lbs.) Transmission Shift Lever Assembly
.................................................................................................................................................... 6.0
N.m (53 inch lbs.)
Locations
Tail Lamp Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 315
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Specifications
Camshaft Bearing: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Camshaft Bearing Cap Bolts
...........................................................................................................................................................
16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
TORQUE SEQUENCES
CAMSHAFT BEARING CAP REMOVAL SEQUENCES
- Right Side Cylinder Head Exhaust Camshaft
- Right Side Cylinder Head Intake Camshaft
- Left Side Cylinder Head Exhaust Camshaft
- Left Side Cylinder Head Intake Camshaft
CAMSHAFT BEARING CAP TIGHTENING SEQUENCES
Page 187
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 1658
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A thermistor built into the engine coolant temperature sensor changes the resistance value
according to the engine coolant temperature. The structure of the sensor and connection to the
ECM is the same as in the intake air temp. circuit malfunction.
Fuel - Idle Speed Increased by Replacement ECM
Idle Speed: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Idle Speed Increased by Replacement ECM
ENGINE EG001-98
FEBRUARY 13, 1998
2RZ ECM IDLE SPEED
MODELS: '95-'97 TACOMA
Introduction Operating logic of 1995-1997 Tacoma ECMs has been revised to improve engine idle
smoothness (with transmission in "D" range) by increasing idle speed (A/C "OFF") from 600 RPM
to 700 RPM. The change has also narrowed the RPM transition between A/C "OFF" and A/C "ON"
engagement.
Affected Vehicles 1995-1997 Tacoma 4x2 equipped with 2RZ-FE four cylinder engine and automatic transmission.
Part Number Information
Production Change Information No production changes have been made.
- This change applies only to replacement ECMs available through parts supply.
Warranty Information
Applicable Warranty: This repair is covered under the Toyota Powertrain Warranty. This warranty Is
in effect for 60 months or 60,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in service date.
Page 2437
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 48
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 787
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 631
Engine Bank Identification
Page 284
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 2051
Page 2768
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Testing and Inspection
Air Conditioning Switch: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT A/C SWITCH CONTINUITY
Switch Continuity:
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Illumination Circuit:
If continuity is not as specified, replace the bulb.
Page 373
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 4926
Components
Page 1596
Spark Plug: Specifications Torque Specification
Spark Plug x Cylinder Head ................................................................................................................
......................................................................... 18 Nm
Page 113
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 4441
f. Turn the reverse synchronizer pull ring.
g. while pushing the 3 shifting keys, install the synchronizer ring assembly to the hub sleeve No.3.
Page 1368
b. Turn the crankshaft 2/3 of a revolution (240°), and check only the valves indicated in the
illustration. Measure the valve clearance.
c. Turn the crankshaft a further 2/3 of a revolution (240°), and check only the valves indicated in the
illustration.
Measure the valve clearance.
5. ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
a. Remove the adjusting shim.
1. Turn the camshaft so that the cam lobe for the valve to be adjusted faces up. 2. Turn the valve
lifter with a screwdriver so that the notches are perpendicular to the camshaft.
3. Using Special Service Tool (SST) (A), press down the valve lifter and place SST (B) between the
camshaft and valve lifter. Remove SST
(A). SST 09248-55040 (09248-05410, 09248-05420)
Page 2063
Page 4014
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
ON-VEHICLE REPAIR
1 DISCONNECT NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
2. REMOVE NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
a. Remove the bolt and No.1 vehicle speed sensor assembly. b. Remove the speedometer driven
gear and O-ring from the No.1 vehicle speed sensor.
3. INSTALL NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
a. Coat a new O-ring with ATF. b. Install the O-ring and speedometer driven gear to the No.1
vehicle speed sensor. c. Install the No.1 vehicle speed sensor to the extension housing and torque
the bolt.
Torque: 16 Nm (160 kgf-cm, 12 ft. lbs.)
4. CONNECT NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR 5. DISCONNECT NO.2 VEHICLE
SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
6. REMOVE NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
a. Remove the bolt and No.2 vehicle speed sensor. b. Remove the O-ring from the No.2 vehicle
speed sensor.
7. INSTALL NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
a. Coat a new O-ring with ATF and install it to the No.2 vehicle speed sensor. b. Install the No.2
vehicle speed sensor and torque the bolt.
Page 1322
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove main bearing cap and check oil clearance.
(a) Uniformly loosen and remove the main bearing cap bolts, in several passes, in the sequence
shown.
(b) Using a screwdriver, pry out the main bearing cap and remove the main bearing cap, lower
main bearings and lower thrust washers (No. 2
journal position of main bearing cap only).
NOTE: Keep the lower main bearings and lower thrust washers together with the main bearing cap.
(c) Lift out the crankshaft.
NOTE: Keep the upper main bearings and upper thrust washers together with the cylinder block.
(d) Clean each main journal and bearing. (e)
Check each main journal and bearing for pitting and scratches. If the journal or bearing is
damaged, replace the bearings. If necessary, grind or replace the crankshaft.
(f) Place the crankshaft on the cylinder block.
(g) Lay a strip of Plastigage across each journal. (h) Install the main bearing cap with the 8 bolts.
Page 4051
LOWER VALVE BODY
COMPONENTS
Lower Valve Body
VALVE BODY SPRING SPECIFICATIONS HINT: During reassembly please refer to the spring
specifications below to help you to identify the different springs.
Page 1603
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: If there is lack of power, excessive oil consumption or poor fuel economy, measure the
compression pressure.
1. Warm up and stop engine.
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature.
2. Remove ignition coils. 3. Remove spark plugs.
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the 6 spark plugs.
4. Check cylinder compression pressure.
(a) Insert a compression gauge into the spark plug hole.
(b) Fully open the throttle. (c)
While cranking the engine, measure the compression pressure.
NOTE: Always use a fully charged battery to obtain engine revolutions of 250 rpm or more.
(d) Repeat steps (a) through (c) for each cylinder.
NOTE: This measurement must be done in as short a time as possible.
Compression pressure: 1,200 kPa (174 psi) or more. Minimum pressure: 1,000 kPa (145 psi)
Difference between each cylinder: 100 kPa (15 psi) or less.
(e) If the cylinder compression in one or more cylinders is low, pour a small amount of engine oil
into the cylinder through the spark plug hole and repeat steps (a) through (c) for cylinders with low
compression. If adding oil helps the compression, it is likely that the piston rings and/or cylinder bore are worn or
damaged.
- If pressure stays low, a valve may be sticking or seating is improper, or there may be leakage
past the gasket.
5. Reinstall spark plugs.
Torque: 20 Nm (14 ft. lbs.)
6. Reinstall ignition coils.
Page 4254
Rear Axle Shaft (2 Of 2)
REMOVAL
1. Remove rear wheel and brake drum.
Installation Hint: ^
Torque to 110 Nm (83 ft. lbs.)
^ After installation, bleed the brake system and check for leaks.
2. Check bearing backlash and axle shaft deviation.
a. Using a dial indicator, check the backlash in the bearing shaft direction. If it is greater than the
maximum, replace the bearing.
Maximum: 0.7 mm (0.027 inch)
b. Using a dial indicator, check the deviation at the surface of the axle shaft outside the hub bolt. If
it is greater than the maximum, replace the
axle shaft.
Maximum: 0.1 mm (0.0039 inch)
3. w/ ABS: Remove ABS speed sensor from rear axle housing.
Installation Hint: Torque to 8.0 Nm (71 inch lbs.)
4. Remove rear brake assembly.
Page 2582
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2022
Engine Bank Identification
Page 1154
Fluid - Differential: Fluid Type Specifications
Front Differential
TYPE....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ GL-5* CAPACITY Front ..............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. 1.1L (2.3 pints) With A.D.D [1] ..........................................................................................................
.................................................................................... 1.2L (2.4 pints) VISCOSITY Below -18° C (0°
F) .........................................................................................................................................................
............................... 80W, 80W-90 Above -18° C (0° F) ......................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... 90 With A.D.D
..............................................................................................................................................................
................................................. 75W-90
[1] Automatic Disconnecting Differential
Oil Type and Viscosity
Differential
Type .....................................................................................................................................................
......................................................... Hypoid gear oil Grade ................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... API
GL-5
Viscosity:
Front (w/ADD) ......................................................................................................................................
........................................................... SAE 75W-90
Front (without ADD) Above 0° F (-18° C) ............................................................................................
....................................................................................................... SAE 90 Below 0° F (18° C) .........
..............................................................................................................................................................
....... SAE 80W or 80W-90
Rear Above 0° F (-18° C) ....................................................................................................................
............................................................................... SAE 90 Below 0° F (18° C) .................................
............................................................................................................................................. SAE 80W
or 80W-90
Special Service Materials
w/ Differential Lock: Shaft Retainer X Differential Carrier ....................................................................
............................................................................................................. [1] Actuator x Differential
Carrier ..................................................................................................................................................
........................................ [1] Shift Fork Shaft Set Bolt ........................................................................
........................................................................................................................... [2] Pinion Shaft Pin ..
..............................................................................................................................................................
................................................. [2] Shaft Retainer Bolt .......................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... [3] Screw Plug
..............................................................................................................................................................
........................................................... [3] w/o Differential Lock: Ring Gear Set Bolts .........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................... [4]
[1]: Part No. 08826-00090; Seal Packing 1281, THREE BOND 1281 FIPG, or equivalent. [2]: Part
No. 08833-00070; Adhesive 1324, THREE BOND 1324, or equivalent. [3]: Part No. 08833-00080;
Adhesive 1344, THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE 242, or equivalent [4]: Part No. 08833-00100:
THREE BOND 1360K, or equivalent
Page 1569
Idle Speed: Adjustments
1. Initial conditions.
(a) Engine coolant at normal operating temperature.
(b) Air cleaner installed. (c)
All pipes and hoses of air induction system connected.
(d) All accessories switched OFF. (e)
All vacuum lines properly connected.
NOTE: All vacuum hoses for Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) systems, etc. should be properly
connected.
(f) Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection (SFI) system wiring connectors fully plugged.
(g) Ignition timing set correctly. (h) Transmission in neutral position. (i)
A/C switch is OFF.
2. Connect TOYOTA hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool or equivalent. 3. Inspect idle speed.
(a) Race the engine speed at 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
(b) Check the idle speed.
Idle speed: 700 +/- 50 rpm
NOTE: If the idle speed is not as specified, check the Idle Air Control (IAC) valve and air intake
system.
4. Disconnect TOYOTA hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool or equivalent.
Page 269
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
Speed Sensor Circuit Description
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The speed sensor detects wheel speed and sends the appropriate signals to the Electronic Control
Unit (ECU). These signals are used to control of the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) system. The
front and rear rotors each have 48 serrations. When the Rotors rotate, the magnetic field emitted
by the permanent magnet in the speed sensor generates an AC voltage. Since the frequency of
this AC voltage changes in direct proportion to the speed of the rotor, the frequency is used by the
ECU to detect the speed of each wheel.
FAIL SAFE FUNCTION
If trouble occurs in the speed sensor circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS control (solenoid)
relay and prohibits ABS control.
Page 4213
Capacity: 1.15 liters (1.22 US qts., 1.01 Imp. qts.)
13. INSTALL UNDER COVER
Page 941
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Specifications
Oil Filter Housing: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Oil Filter Union To Cylinder Block
................................................................................................................................................ 25 Nm
(18 ft. lbs.) Oil Hole Cover Plate To Cylinder Block
........................................................................................................................................ 60 Nm (44 ft.
lbs.)
Page 1534
Timing Belt: Testing and Inspection
INSPECTION
1. Inspect timing belt.
CAUTION: Do not bend, twist or turn the timing belt inside out.
- Do not allow the timing belt to come into contact with oil, water or steam.
- Do not utilize timing belt tension when installing or removing the mounting bolt of the camshaft
timing pulley.
If there are any defects as shown in the illustration, check these points: (a)
Premature parting. ^
Check for proper installation.
^ Check the timing cover gasket for damage and proper installation.
(b) If the belt teeth are cracked or damaged, check to see if either camshaft is locked. (c)
If there is noticeable wear or cracks on the belt face, check to see if there are nicks on the side of
the idler pulley lock and water pump.
(d) If there is wear or damage on only one side of the belt, check the belt guide and the alignment
of each pulley. (e)
If there is noticeable wear on the belt teeth, check the timing belt cover for damage and check
gasket has been installed correctly and for foreign material on the pulley teeth. If necessary,
replace the timing belt.
2. Inspect idler pulleys.
(a) Visually check the seal portion of the idler pulley for oil leakage. If leakage is found, replace the
idler pulley.
(b) Check that the idler pulley turns smoothly.
If necessary, replace the idler pulley.
3. Inspect timing belt tensioner.
Page 1120
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer's complaint.
Parts Identification
For parts before the production change, the circular machining marks can be felt by scraping a
fingernail across the pressure feed hose banjo fitting. Machining marks cannot be felt on the new
parts. There is no other identification method to distinguish old style service parts from new ones.
Repair Procedure
Replace Power Steering pressure feed hose and (2) gaskets with new parts.
Recommended repair torque: 40 f-lbs (54 N-m, 550 kgf-cm).
Refer to the appropriate Repair Manual (Section SR - Steering) for additional details.
Service Specifications
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications Service Specifications
DIMENSIONS
Free Distance
..............................................................................................................................................................
18.2 - 18.8 mm (0.712 -0.740 inch) Gear Backlash:
STD
.............................................................................................................................................................
0.020 - 0.200 mm (0.0008 - 0.0079 inch) Maximum ............................................................................
..................................................................................................... 0.30 mm (0.0188 inch)
Page 151
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 2 Of 2
Page 4135
b. Heat the ring gear to about 100° C (212° F) in boiling water. c. Carefully remove the ring gear
from the water. d. after the moisture on the ring gear has completely evaporated, quickly install the
ring gear to the differential case.
HINT: Align the matchmarks on the ring gear and differential case.
e. Temporarily install 5 new lock plates and 10 bolts so that the bolt holes in the ring gear and
differential case are not misaligned. f.
After the ring gear has cooled sufficiently, torque the ring gear set bolts.
Torque to 97 Nm (71 ft. lbs.)
g. Using a hammer and a drift. punch, stake the lock plates.
HINT: Stake one claw flush with the flat surface of the bolt. For the claw contacting the protruding
portion of the bolt, stake only the half portion of the tightening side.
5. Install side bearings. Using SST 09226-10010 and a press, install the bearing into the differential
case.
6. Install side bearing outer races.
HINT: When replacing the side bearings, fit the thinnest washers to each bearing and when reusing
the bearings, fit the washers with the same thickness as removed.
a. Install a new plate washer to the bearing retainer.
Page 1734
w/ Tachometer
w/o Tachometer
HINT: Connect the test leads so that the current from the ohmmeter can flow according to the
above order. This circuit includes the diode.
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the receiver gauge.
Page 447
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 156
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 2 Of 2
Page 2585
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 1935
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2682
Page 2218
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 1688
Radiator: Service and Repair Disassembly and Assembly
DISASSEMBLY
1. Remove No. 1 fan shroud.
Remove the 4 bolts and No. 1 fan shroud.
2. Remove radiator supports.
Using a torx wrench, remove the 4 torx screws and the 2 radiator supports. Torx wrench: T30 (Part
No. 09042 - 00010 or locally manufactured tool) or equivalent.
NOTE: Lift up the floor carpet and loosen the screw.
ASSEMBLY
Assembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.
Page 220
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection
STARTER RELAY INSPECTION
Junction Box And Relay Box
LOCATION: The relay is located in the Relay Block No.2 in the engine compartment.
1. REMOVE STARTER RELAY
2. INSPECT STARTER RELAY
A. Inspect relay continuity
a. Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between terminals 1 and 2.
If there no continuity, replace the relay.
b. Check that there is no continuity between terminals 3 and 5.
If there continuity, replace the relay.
Removal and Installation
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
Front Brake Components (4WD)
REMOVAL
1. Remove front wheel.
2. Disconnect flexible hose.
Remove the union bolt and 2 gaskets from the caliper, then disconnect the flexible hose from the
caliper. Torque: 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.)
CAUTION: Install the flexible hose lock securely in the lock hole in the caliper.
3. Remove caliper.
Locations
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Specifications
Gear Sensor/Switch: Specifications
4WD-position Switch ...........................................................................................................................
................................................... 37 N.m (27 ft. lbs.) L4 Position Switch .............................................
...................................................................................................................................... 37 N.m (27 ft.
lbs.) Neutral Position Switch ................................................................................................................
........................................................... 37 N.m (27 ft. lbs.)
Page 1975
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 3942
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 2035
Page 4363
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Locations
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor Location
Page 1540
16. Remove starter wire bracket and No. 1 timing belt cover.
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and starter wire bracket.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts and timing belt cover.
17. Remove timing belt guide.
18. Set No. 1 cylinder at Top Dead Center (TDC)/compression.
(a) Temporarily install the crankshaft pulley bolt to the crankshaft.
(b) Turn the crankshaft, and align the timing marks of the crankshaft timing pulley and oil pump
body.
CAUTION: Always turn the crankshaft clockwise.
(c) Check that the timing marks of the camshaft timing pulleys and No. 3 timing belt cover are
aligned. If not, turn the crankshaft pulley 1 revolution (360°).
(d) Remove the crankshaft pulley bolt.
19. If reusing timing belt, check installation marks on timing belt.
Check that there are 3 installation marks and front mark on the timing belt. If the installation and
front marks have disappeared, before removing the timing belt, place 3 new installation marks on
the timing belt to match the timing marks of the timing pulleys, and place a new front mark on the
timing belt.
20. Remove timing belt tensioner.
Page 2680
Page 4669
P 1 PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW
4-Ground: Approx. 12 Volts with ignition SW ON position
O 4-B, S 4-A O/D MAIN SW
A-5-A-10, B-1-B-3: Open with O/D main SW at ON position Open with O/D main SW at OFF
position
S 5-A, B STOP LIGHT SW
A-1-A-2, B-1-B-2: Closed with Brake Pedal Depressed
E 5-A, E 6-D, E 7-C, E 8-B ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
S1-E1: 9-14 Volts
S2, SL-E1: 0-1.5 Volts
BK-E1: 7.5-14 Volts with Brake Pedal Depressed 0-1.5 Volts with Brake Pedal Released
THW-E2: 0.2-1.0 Volts with Coolant Temp. 80° C (176° F)
OIL-E2: 4-5 Volts with fluid Temp. 20° C (68° F)
IDL-E2:
0-3 Volts with Throttle Valve fully closed 9-14 Volts with Throttle Valve open
VTA-E2: 0.3-0.8 Volts with Throttle Valve fully closed 3.2-4.9 Volts with Throttle Valve fully open
VCC-E2: 4.5-5.5 Volts
OD1-E1: 4.5-5.5 Volts
OD2-E1: 9-14 Volts O/D main SW turned ON 0 Volts O/D main SW turned OFF
SP1-E1: Pulse Generation with vehicle moving
2-E1: 10-14 Volts with Shift Lever at 2 position 0-2 Volts with shift lever at expect 2 position
L-E1: 10-14 Volts with Shift Lever at L position 0-2 Volts with Shift Lever at expect L position
L4-E1: 10-14 Volts with Transfer Shift at H2 or H4 position 0 Volts with Transfer shift at L4 position
OIL-W-E1: 0.1-4.9 Volts
+B-E1: 9-14 Volts
BATT-E1: 9-14 Volts
Splice Points
Splice Points
Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuel Injector: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2598
and Hot is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
(a) Disconnect the IAC valve connector.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminal +B and other terminals (RSC,
RSO).
Resistance:
Cold: 17.0 - 24.5 ohms Hot: 21.5 - 28.5 ohms
If resistance is not as specified, replace the IAC valve.
(c) Reconnect the IAC valve connector.
3. INSPECT AIR ASSIST SYSTEM
(a) Initial conditions:
- Engine at normal operating temperature
- Idle speed checked correctly
- Transmission in neutral position
- A/C switch OFF
(b) Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the DLC1. SST 09843-18020 (c) After engine
speed is kept at 900 - 1300 rpm for 10 seconds, check that it returns to idle speed. (d) Stop the
engine.
(e) Disconnect the air assist hose from the IAC valve and plug it. (f) Start the engine and check that
the idle speed reaches 500 rpm or below (the engine may stall).
If the idle does not reach 500 rpm or below, check for a leak between the air assist hoses, pipe and
injectors."
(g) Remove the SST from the DLC1. SST 09843-18020 (h) Reconnect the air assist hose to the
IAC valve.
Page 2738
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 674
CHART 29
Mechanical Specifications
Intake Manifold: Mechanical Specifications
Intake Manifold
DIMENSIONS
Warpage (Maximum) ...........................................................................................................................
.................................... 0.10 mm (0.0039 inch)
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Intake Manifold To Cylinder Head
................................................................................................................................................. 18 Nm
(13 ft. lbs.) Intake Manifold Stay To Cylinder Head
......................................................................................................................................... 18 Nm (13
ft. lbs.) Throttle Body To Intake (Nuts)
...................................................................................................................................................... 18
Nm (13 ft. lbs.) Throttle Body To Intake (Bolts)
..................................................................................................................................................... 18
Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
Throttle Body to Intake (Nuts) 13 ft.lb
Throttle Body to Intake (Bolts) 13 ft.lb
Page 363
Cruise Control Switch
Page 2652
Page 4735
Transmission Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
ON-VEHICLE REPAIR
1 DISCONNECT NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
2. REMOVE NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
a. Remove the bolt and No.1 vehicle speed sensor assembly. b. Remove the speedometer driven
gear and O-ring from the No.1 vehicle speed sensor.
3. INSTALL NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
a. Coat a new O-ring with ATF. b. Install the O-ring and speedometer driven gear to the No.1
vehicle speed sensor. c. Install the No.1 vehicle speed sensor to the extension housing and torque
the bolt.
Torque: 16 Nm (160 kgf-cm, 12 ft. lbs.)
4. CONNECT NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR 5. DISCONNECT NO.2 VEHICLE
SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
6. REMOVE NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
a. Remove the bolt and No.2 vehicle speed sensor. b. Remove the O-ring from the No.2 vehicle
speed sensor.
7. INSTALL NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
a. Coat a new O-ring with ATF and install it to the No.2 vehicle speed sensor. b. Install the No.2
vehicle speed sensor and torque the bolt.
Capacity Specifications
Fluid - Transfer Case: Capacity Specifications
Transfer Case
Refill .....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 2.2 Pt
Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Pressure:
Minimum [1] .........................................................................................................................................
........................................ 1,000 kPa (145 psi) Standard [1] ................................................................
..................................................................................................... 1,200 kPa (174 psi) or more
Pressure Difference:
Between Each Cylinder
..........................................................................................................................................................
100 kPa (15 psi) or less
[1] @ 250 rpm
Page 3390
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2482
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3731
Junction Block And Wire Harness Connector
Page 4214
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Rear Differential Pinion Seal
REPLACEMENT
HINT: Pre-runner is the model described below.
RZN191L-TRPDKAB, RZN196L-CRPDKAB, VZN195L-CRPDKAB
1. DRAIN DIFFERENTIAL OIL 2. DISCONNECT REAR PROPELLER SHAFT 3. REMOVE
COMPANION FLANGE
Page 2716
Page 740
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch goes on when the shift lever is in the N or P shift position. When it
goes on terminal NSW of the ECM is grounded to body ground via the starter relay, thus the
terminal NSW voltage becomes 0 V. When the shift lever is in the D, 2, L or R position, the
park/neutral position switch goes off, so the voltage of ECM, terminal NSW becomes battery
voltage, the voltage of the ECM internal power source.
If the shift lever is moved from the N position to the D position, this signal is used for air-fuel ratio
correction and for idle speed control (estimated control), etc.
Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
Intake 0.13 - 0.23 mm
Exhaust 0.27 - 0.37 mm
Page 2524
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 884
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 1849
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 2476
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 673
CHART 28
Fuel System - Fuel Injector Cleaning Procedure
Fuel Injector: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Fuel Injector Cleaning Procedure
PRODUCT GENERAL INFORMATION PG011-05 REVISED
October 13, 2005
Title: FUEL INJECTOR CLEANING
Models: '90 - '06 Toyota & Scion Models With Port Electronic Fuel Injection
TSB REVISION NOTICE:
^ June 9, 2006: In the Required Tools & Material section, part numbers have been updated (TYG
S-Line Device and Toyota Adaptor Pak), and the note with ordering information has been updated.
Previous versions of this TSB should be discarded.
Introduction
Due to fuel quality concerns, some Toyota and Scion vehicles with Port Electronic Fuel Injection
may experience clogged or blocked fuel injectors. The following procedure has been developed to
clean the fuel injectors.
Applicable Vehicles: ^
All 1990 - 2006 Toyota and Scion models equipped with Port Electronic Fuel Vehicles Injection
(EFI).
Required Tools & Material
Warranty Information
Repair Procedure
1. If the fuel injector nozzles are visibly blocked or if the injectors do NOT pass the fuel injector
volume test, complete the fuel injector power flush using the following instructions:
A. Before an injector cleaning is performed, it is recommended that the following items be cleaned
with Toyota Throttle Plate Cleaner (P/N 00289-1TP00):
^ Idle air control device
^ Throttle plate (both sides if possible)
^ Throttle body
B. Bring the engine to operating temperature.
C. Disconnect the fuel pump electrical connector.
Page 1687
Radiator: Service and Repair On-Vehicle Cleaning
Using water or a steam cleaner, remove any mud or dirt from the radiator core.
CAUTION: If using a high pressure type cleaner, be careful not to deform the fins of the radiator
core. (i.e. Maintain a distance between the cleaner nozzle radiator core.)
Page 4294
Procedure for Tacoma & PreRunner
Use a grease gun to apply multi-purpose grease to the No. 1, 2, 3, 7, 8, 9, 13 and 14 grease
fittings. Apply molybdenum disulfide lithium base chassis grease, NLGI No. 2, to the No. 4, 5, 6, 10,
11 and 12 grease fittings (double cardan joint).
Procedure for Tundra
Page 4840
E. Apply a small amount of the disc brake caliper grease (1-2 mm thick) to both sides of the pad
support plates.
NOTE:
Do NOT apply grease to the friction surfaces of the brake pads or the disc rotor.
F. If the pad support plate is fixed to the torque plate with adhesive tape, perform the operation
according to the flow chart.
G. Apply a small amount of the disc brake caliper grease (1-2 mm thick) to the caliper as indicated
in the illustration.
H. Install the brake pads with the anti-squeal shims.
I. If equipped with anti-squeal spring: Install the anti-squeal springs.
J. Press the piston in firmly and install the brake caliper.
NOTE: ^
Clean excess grease. from brake pad and caliper.
^ Do NOT apply grease to the friction surfaces of the brake pads or the disc rotor.
K. Install the wheel assembly.
2. Fixed Type Brake Caliper There are two types of brake pads:
Page 1052
Adjusting Shim Selection Chart (Exhaust)
Page 3455
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 4435
b. Install the synchronizer pull ring, cone ring and outer ring to the gear spline piece No.5.
c. Check the braking effect of the synchronizer ring. turn the synchronizer ring in one direction
while pushing it to the gear cone. check that the
ring locks. If it does not lock, replace the synchronizer ring.
4. Inspect shift fork and hub sleeve clearance.
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the hub sleeve and shift fork.
Maximum Clearance: 1.0 mm (0.039 inch)
If the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the shift fork or hub sleeve.
5. Inspect reverse idler gear radial clearance.
Using a dial indicator, measure the reverse idler gear radial clearance.
Standard Clearance: 0.040-0.082 mm (0.0016-0.0032 inch) Maximum Clearance: 0.130 mm
(0.0051 inch)
If the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the reverse idler gear or reverse idler gear shaft.
Page 2622
Knock Sensor: Exploded Views
Components For Removal And Installation Part 1 Of 2
Page 2394
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 3870
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection
1. Operate vehicle, allow transmission fluid temperature to reach 158-176 °F.
2. Position vehicle on level surface, apply parking brake.
3. Allow engine to idle, depress brake pedal, then move shift lever through all positions.
4. Remove transaxle dipstick, wipe clean, then replace.
5. Remove again, then check fluid level in HOT range.
NOTICE: Do not overfill.
(a) Check the fluid condition. If the fluid smells burnt or is black, replace it.
(b) Replace the ATF.
(1) Remove the drain plug and drain the fluid. (2) Reinstall the drain plug securely.
7. On A340D units: Dry capacity is 6.9 US quarts. Drain and Refill: 2.4 Liters (2.5 US qts, 2.1 Imp.
qts.)
8. On A340E units: Dry capacity is 7.6 US quarts. Drain and Refill: 1.6 Liters (1.7 US qts, 1.4 Imp.
qts.)
9. On A340F units: Dry capacity 1996 9.3 US quarts. Dry capacity 1997-99 10.7 US quarts. Drain
and Refill: 2.0 Liters (2.1 US qts, 1.8 Imp. qts.)
10. On A340H units, dry capacity for transaxle and transfer is 10.9 US quarts.
Page 2949
CHART 23
Page 350
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 3101
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3611
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 1418
Drive Belt: Service and Repair
DRIVE BELT REMOVAL
1. REMOVE PS PUMP DRIVE BELT
2. REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER
3. LOOSEN IDLE PULLEY LOCK NUT
Torque: 39 N.m (400 kg.cm, 29 ft.lb)
4. LOOSEN AND REMOVE COMPRESSOR DRIVE BELT
DRIVE BELT INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
A/T - Torque Converter Bolt Installation Precautions
Flex Plate: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Torque Converter Bolt Installation Precautions
T-SB-0014-11
February 17, 2011
Torque Converter Bolt Installation
Service Category Drivetrain
Section Automatic Transmission/Transaxle
Market USA
Applicability
Introduction
The purpose of this TSB is to provide information regarding the installation of the correct torque
converter bolts during automatic transmission/transaxle assembly replacement. Incorrect torque
converter bolts or missing washers can cause damage to the torque converter assembly. Use the
information in this bulletin when installing an automatic transmission/transaxle assembly.
NOTE
Not all applications will use washers on the torque converter bolts.
Warranty Information
Installation Procedure
^ When removing torque converter bolts and washers take special care that the same bolts and
washers are used when installing the torque converter.
^ Using an incorrect size bolt or washer may cause damage to the torque converter assembly.
Page 199
Ignition Control Module: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A DIS (Direct Ignition System) has been adopted. The DIS improves the ignition timing accuracy,
reduces high-voltage loss and enhances the overall reliability of the ignition system by eliminating
the distributor.
The DIS is a 2-cylinder simultaneous ignition system which ignites 2 cylinders simultaneously with
one ignition coil. In the 2-cylinder simultaneous ignition system, each of the 2 spark plugs is
connected to the end of the secondary winding. High voltage generated in the secondary winding is
applied directly to the 2 spark plugs. The sparks of the 2 spark plugs pass simultaneously from the
center electrode to the ground electrode.
The ECM determines ignition timing and outputs the ignition signals (IGT) for each cylinder. Based
on IGT signals, the igniter controls the primary ignition signals (IGC) for all ignition coils. At the
same time, the igniter also sends an ignition confirmation signal (IGF) as a fail-safe measure to the
ECM.
Page 701
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
HEATED OXYGEN SENSORS INSPECTION (Bank 1, Sensor 1, Bank 1 Sensor 2)
INSPECT HEATER RESISTANCE OF HEATED OXYGEN SENSORS
(a) Disconnect the oxygen sensor connector.
Bank 1 Sensor 1
Bank 1 Sensor 2
(b) Using an ohmmeter. measure the resistance between the terminals +B and HT.
Resistance: At 20°C (68°F): 11 - 16 ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the sensor.
Torque: 20 N.m (200 kgf.cm, 14 ft.lbf)
(c) Reconnect the oxygen sensor connector.
Page 1194
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Type ND-OIL 8
Page 2569
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 2 Of 2
Specifications
Counter Gear: Specifications
Counter 5th Gear Radial Clearance
Standard
..........................................................................................................................................................
0.015-0.068 mm (0.0006-0.0027 inch) Maximum ................................................................................
............................................................................................... 0.160 mm (0.0063 inch)
Counter Gear Roller Bearing Journal Diameter
Minimum ..............................................................................................................................................
............................... 27.860 mm (1.0968 inch)
Page 356
Cruise Control Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 4253
Axle Shaft: Service and Repair Axle Shaft, Conventional Fixed/Floating
Removal and Installation
Rear Axle Shaft (1 Of 2)
Page 219
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Locations
ECT Temperature Sender Gauge / Low Oil Pressure Warning Switch
Page 1079
Drive Belt: Specifications Power Steering Belt
Drive Belt - Power Steering / Tension:
New Belt ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 135 - 180 lbs. Used Belt ...................................................................
............................................................................................................................... 85 - 120 lbs.
Page 2430
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2043
CHART 10
Page 2170
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
MAF Meter to Air Cleaner Cap 61 in.lb
Page 1215
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 3074
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 3145
EGR Control Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE FOR EGR INSPECTION Except Model No. VZN17O - 4wd Long
Wheel Base
1. REMOVE VSV ASSEMBLY
Disconnect the connector and 2 vacuum hoses and remove the 2 bolts and VSV assembly.
2. INSPECT VSV
A. Inspect VSV for open circuit
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between the terminals.
Resistance: At 20°C (68°F): 33 - 39 ohm
If there is no continuity, replace the VSV.
B. Inspect VSV for ground
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between each terminal and the body. If there
is continuity, replace the VSV.
C. Inspect VSV operation
(a) Check that air flows from port E to port G. (b) Apply battery positive voltage across the
terminals.
Page 567
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2616
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2777
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 4725
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 591
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 770
EGR Temperature Sensor: Testing and Inspection
EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR INSPECTION Except Model No. VZN17O - 4wd Long
Wheel Base
1. REMOVE EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
2. INSPECT EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Resistance:
At 50°C (122°F): 84 - 97 K ohms At 100°C (212°F): 11 - 16 K ohms At 150°C (302°F): 2 - 4 K ohms
If the resistance is not as specified. replace the sensor.
3. REINSTALL EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Torque: 20 N.m (200 kgf.cm, 14 ft.lbf)
Page 1934
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Specifications
Between Terminals Measured Resistance
At Clearance: 0 mm (0 in.) VTA - E2 0.2 - 5.7 K ohms
Throttle Fully Opened VTA - E2 2.0 - 10.2 K ohms
At all Times VC - E2 2.5 - 5.9 K ohms
Ohmmeter Connection
Page 3565
Testing and Inspection
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH CONTINUITY
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Page 4675
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Camshaft Position Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSPECTION
NOTICE: "Cold" and "Hot" in these sentences express the temperature of the sensors themselves.
"Cold" is from -10°C (14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
1. DISCONNECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR CONNECTOR
2. INSPECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals.
Resistance:
Cold: 835 - 1,400 Ohms Hot: 1,060 - 1,645 Ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the camshaft position sensor.
3. RECONNECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR CONNECTOR
Page 2811
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR REMOVAL
1. REMOVE NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER 2. REMOVE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the camshaft position sensor connector.
(b) Remove the bolts and camshaft position sensor.
Torque: 7.8 N.m (80 kgf.cm, 69 in.lbf)
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 1038
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Recommended Spark Plugs
ND K16TR11
NGK BKR5EKB-11
Page 2909
8. REMOVE KNOCK SENSORS
Using SST. remove the knock sensor. SST 09817-16011
KNOCK SENSOR INSTALLATION
1. REINSTALL KNOCK SENSORS
Using SST, install the knock sensor. SST 09817-16011
Torque: 39 N.m (400 kgf.cm. 29 ft.lbf)
2. REINSTALL WATER BYPASS PIPE AND KNOCK SENSOR WIRE 3. REINSTALL INTAKE
MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY 4. REINSTALL FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR 5. REINSTALL
HIGH-TENSION CORDS WITH IGNITION COILS 6. REINSTALL INTAKE AIR CONNECTOR 7.
REINSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE 8. REFILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT 9. RECHECK ENGINE
COOLANT LEVEL
Page 1856
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2964
Warranty Information
Applicable warranty*: This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in
effect for 36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in-service date.
Coverage is extended to 36 months or 50,000 miles, whichever occurs first, in the states of
California and Massachusetts due to state emissions warranty legislation.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer's complaint.
Page 2695
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - Oxygen Sensor Improvement
ENGINE EG006-99
Title: 5VZ OXYGEN SENSOR IMPROVEMENT
Models: '96 - '99 Tacoma
June 18, 1999
Introduction The design of the 5VZ Oxygen Sensor inner cover has been changed 10 reduce the
possibility of moisture contacting the ceramic element.
Affected Vehicles ^
1996-1999 model year Tacomas built before the VINs listed below.
Repair Procedure Please refer to the appropriate repair manual for diagnostic and installation
information for the Oxygen Sensor.
Part Number Information
Page 40
Electronic Brake Control Module: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: - Tools Required:
- TOYOTA hand-held tester, or equivalent.
- TOYOTA break-out-box, or equivalent.
Connect Hand-Held Tester And Break-Out-Box
1. Hook up the hand-held tester and break-out-box to the vehicle. 2. Read the ECU input/output
values by following the prompts on the tester screen.
NOTE: Hand-held tester has a "Snapshot" function. This records the measured values and is effective in
the diagnosis of intermittent problems.
Please refer to the hand-held tester/break-out-box operator's manual for further details.
Page 2467
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A thermistor built into the engine coolant temperature sensor changes the resistance value
according to the engine coolant temperature. The structure of the sensor and connection to the
ECM is the same as in the intake air temp. circuit malfunction.
Page 1712
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 2962
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer's complaint.
Page 4563
Fluid - Transfer Case: Fluid Type Specifications
API GL-4 or GL-5
SAE 75W-90
Page 3623
Camshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Cam Sensor to Cylinder Head 69 in.lb
Page 1132
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
Coolant Classification Type:
Ethylene Glycol Based
Page 3671
Page 2667
CHART 7
Page 4724
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Knock Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
KNOCK SENSOR INSPECTION
1. REMOVE KNOCK SENSORS
See: Service and Repair
2. INSPECT KNOCK SENSORS
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between the terminal and body. If there is
continuity, replace the sensor.
Locations
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor Location
Page 4153
b. Using a dial indicator, measure the differential case runout.
Maximum case runout: 0.04 mm (0.0016 inch)
c. Remove the differential case.
10. Remove side bearings. Using SST 09950-40010 (09951-04010, 09952-04010, 09953-04020,
09954-04010, 09955-04060, 09957-04010,
09958-04010), 09950-60010 (09951-00480), remove the side bearings from the differential case.
HINT: Fix the claws of SST to the notch in the differential case.
11. Disassemble differential case assembly.
a. Using a pin punch and a hammer, remove the straight pin. b. Remove these parts from the
differential case:
^ Pinion shaft
^ 2 pinion gears
^ 2 pinion gear thrust washers
^ 2 side gears
^ 2 side gear thrust washers
With Differential Lock
Page 1031
Ignition Cable: Testing and Inspection
HIGH-TENSION CORDS INSPECTION
1. REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE
2. DISCONNECT HIGH-TENSION CORDS FROM SPARK PLUGS
Disconnect the high - tension cords at the rubber boot. DO NOT pull on the cords.
NOTICE: Pulling on or bending the cords may damage the conductor inside.
3. DISCONNECT HIGH-TENSION CORDS FROM IGNITION COILS
(a) Using a screwdriver, lift up the lock claw and disconnect the holder from the ignition coils. (b)
Disconnect the high-tension cord at the grommet.
DO NOT pull on the cord.
NOTICE: Pulling on or bending the cords may damage the conductor inside.
- Do not wipe any of the oil from the grommet after the high-tension cord is disconnected.
4. INSPECT HIGH-TENSION CORD RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance.
Maximum resistance: 25 K ohms per cord
If the resistance is greater than the maximum, check the terminals. If necessary, replace the
high-tension cord.
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
One Touch 2-4 Selector System
A/T - Torque Converter Bolt Installation Precautions
Torque Converter: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Torque Converter Bolt Installation Precautions
T-SB-0014-11
February 17, 2011
Torque Converter Bolt Installation
Service Category Drivetrain
Section Automatic Transmission/Transaxle
Market USA
Applicability
Introduction
The purpose of this TSB is to provide information regarding the installation of the correct torque
converter bolts during automatic transmission/transaxle assembly replacement. Incorrect torque
converter bolts or missing washers can cause damage to the torque converter assembly. Use the
information in this bulletin when installing an automatic transmission/transaxle assembly.
NOTE
Not all applications will use washers on the torque converter bolts.
Warranty Information
Installation Procedure
^ When removing torque converter bolts and washers take special care that the same bolts and
washers are used when installing the torque converter.
^ Using an incorrect size bolt or washer may cause damage to the torque converter assembly.
Page 4050
2. CHECK BALL
3. STRAINER
Page 1985
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 2182
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2611
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 2065
CHART 29
Page 4545
Position Of Parts In Body (Fig 30)
Service Hints
R15 REAR DIFF. LOCK SW
5-2: Closed with the diff. lock SW at ON position
F 7 4WD CONTROL ECU (Disconnected wiring connector from ECU)
7-Ground: Always Continuity
10-Ground: Pulse generation with vehicle moving
5-Ground: 9-14 Volts with the ignition SW ON 1-Ground: About 0 Volts with the rear diff. lock
indicator light ON
9-14 Volts with the rear diff. lock indicator light OFF
R15 REAR DIFF. LOCK MOTOR
2-3: 0.3-100 Ohms
Splice Points
Page 3879
Fluid Pump: Specifications Service Specifications
OIL PUMP
Body Clearance
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
.................. 0.07 - 0.15 mm (0.0028 - 0.0059 inch) Maximum .............................................................
.............................................................................................................................. 0.3 mm (0.012
inch)
Tip Clearance
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
.................. 0.11 - 0.14 mm (0.0043 - 0.0055 inch) Maximum .............................................................
.............................................................................................................................. 0.3 mm (0.012
inch)
Side Clearance
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
.................. 0.02 - 0.05 mm (0.0008 - 0.0020 inch) Maximum .............................................................
.............................................................................................................................. 0.1 mm (0.004
inch)
Pump Body Bushing Inside Diameter
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
........................................ 38.19 mm (1.5035 inch)
Stator Shaft Bushing Inside Diameter
Front Side, Maximum ..........................................................................................................................
........................................ 21.58 mm (0.8496 inch) Rear Side, Maximum ...........................................
........................................................................................................................ 27.08 mm (1.0661
inch)
Page 2006
Knock Sensor: Exploded Views
Components For Removal And Installation Part 1 Of 2
Page 1963
Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Locations
Automatic Differential Disconnect (A.D.D.) Component Locations
Page 3561
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2108
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2714
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Testing and Inspection
ABS Light: Testing and Inspection
ABS Warning Light Circuit Wiring Diagram
Page 2979
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3657
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 1265
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: If there is lack of power, excessive oil consumption or poor fuel economy, measure the
compression pressure.
1. Warm up and stop engine.
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature.
2. Remove ignition coils. 3. Remove spark plugs.
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the 6 spark plugs.
4. Check cylinder compression pressure.
(a) Insert a compression gauge into the spark plug hole.
(b) Fully open the throttle. (c)
While cranking the engine, measure the compression pressure.
NOTE: Always use a fully charged battery to obtain engine revolutions of 250 rpm or more.
(d) Repeat steps (a) through (c) for each cylinder.
NOTE: This measurement must be done in as short a time as possible.
Compression pressure: 1,200 kPa (174 psi) or more. Minimum pressure: 1,000 kPa (145 psi)
Difference between each cylinder: 100 kPa (15 psi) or less.
(e) If the cylinder compression in one or more cylinders is low, pour a small amount of engine oil
into the cylinder through the spark plug hole and repeat steps (a) through (c) for cylinders with low
compression. If adding oil helps the compression, it is likely that the piston rings and/or cylinder bore are worn or
damaged.
- If pressure stays low, a valve may be sticking or seating is improper, or there may be leakage
past the gasket.
5. Reinstall spark plugs.
Torque: 20 Nm (14 ft. lbs.)
6. Reinstall ignition coils.
Page 2385
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 3000
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Heater - Snow Entry Into Heater Unit
Heater Core: Technical Service Bulletins Heater - Snow Entry Into Heater Unit
HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING AC002-99
Title: SNOW ENTRY INTO HEATER UNIT
Models: '96 - '98 Tacoma & 4Runner
February 26, 1999
Introduction
Production changes to the Cowl Top Louver and Heater Unit have been made to improve
resistance to snow entry into the Heater Unit and improve durability of Air Mix Door.
Affected Vehicles ^
All 1996 - 1997 Tacomas and 4Runners
^ 1998 Tacomas and 4Runners starting before the listed VINs:
Warranty Information
Applicable Warranty **:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect for 36 months or
36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in-service date.
Page 114
Tail Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT TAILLIGHT CONTROL RELAY CONTINUITY
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
Page 1167
Engine Oil: Technician Safety Information
WARNING:
- Prolonged and repeated contact with mineral oil will result in the removal of natural fats from the
skin, leading to dryness, irritation and dermatitis. In addition, used engine oil contains potentially
harmful contaminants which may cause skin cancer.
- Care should be taken, therefore, when changing engine oil to minimize the frequency and length
of time your skin is exposed to used engine oil. Protective clothing and gloves, that cannot be
penetrated by oil, should be worn. Wash your skin thoroughly with soap and water, or use
waterless hand cleaner, to remove any used engine oil. Do not use gasoline, thinners, or solvents.
Page 1916
Page 3563
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Testing and Inspection
Evaporative Vapor Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR INSPECTION
1. INSPECT POWER SOURCE VOLTAGE OF VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the vapor pressure sensor connector. (b) Turn the ignition switch ON.
(c) Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage between connector terminals VC and E2 of the wiring
harness side.
Voltage: 4.5 - 5.5 V
(d) Turn the ignition switch to LOCK. (e) Reconnect the vapor pressure sensor connector.
2. INSPECT POWER OUTPUT OF VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON. (b) Disconnect the vacuum hose from the vapor pressure sensor.
(c) Connect a voltmeter to terminals PTNK and E2 of the ECM and measure the output voltage
under ambient atmospheric pressure.
- Apply vacuum (2.0 kPa, 15 mm Hg. 0.59 in.Hg) to the vapor pressure sensor.
Voltage: 1.3 - 2.1 V
- Release the vacuum from the vapor pressure sensor.
Voltage: 3.0 - 3.6 V
- Apply pressure (1.5 kPa, 15 gf/sq.cm, 0.22 psi) to the vapor pressure sensor.
Voltage: 4.2 - 4.8 V
(d) Reconnect the vacuum hose to the vapor pressure sensor.
Page 2505
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2140
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 4251
7. Remove drive shaft. Push the steering knuckle outward and remove the drive shaft
HINT: When it is difficult to disconnect the drive shaft, tap the drive shaft with a plastic hammer.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the oil seal, boots and dust seal.
8. Remove snap ring from inboard shaft.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
HINT: After installation, fill the differential with differential oil.
Disassembly / Assembly
DISASSEMBLY
1. Check drive shaft.
a. Check to see that there is no play in the inboard and outboard joints. b. Check to see that the
inboard joint slides smoothly in the thrust direction. c. Check to see that there is no significant play
in the radial direction of the inboard joint. d. Check the boot for damage.
2. Remove inboard joint boot clamps.
a. Using pliers, draw hooks together and remove the large clamp. b. Using a side cutter, cut the
small boot clamp. c. Slide the inboard joint boot toward the outboard joint.
3. Remove inboard joint tulip.
a. Place matchmarks on the inboard joint and drive shaft b. Remove the inboard joint tulip from the
drive shaft
4. Remove tripod joint from drive shaft.
Page 2252
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Firing Order: 1-2-3-4-5-6
Page 730
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 3015
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2513
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The crankshaft position sensor, which detects the engine speed and crankshaft angle signal (NE
signal), has been installed on the oil pump body. The NE signal plate has 34 teeth. The NE signal
sensor generates 34 signals for every engine revolution. The ECM detects the standard crankshaft
angle based on the G signals and the actual crankshaft angle and the engine speed by the NE
signals.
Page 366
Inspection Procedure / Main Switch Circuit (Cruise Control Switch) (2 Of 3)
Inspection Procedure / Main Switch Circuit (Cruise Control Switch) (3 Of 3)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Page 2373
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 3239
Fuel: Specifications
Fuel Type
Unleaded fuel only, Research Octane Number 91 (Octane Rating 87) or higher.
Page 2877
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Brakes - Pad Knock Noise
Brake Pad: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Pad Knock Noise
BRAKES BR005-97
March 14, 1997
Title: 4RUNNER AND TACOMA 4X4 BRAKE PAD KNOCK NOISE
Models: '97 4Runner, & '97 Tacoma
Introduction
A brake pad modification has been made on 4Runner and Tacoma 4x4 models to reduce pad
knocking noise. This problem usually occurs upon first pedal application after changing driving
direction (i.e. forward to reverse).
Affected Vehicles
^ 1997 4Runner starting VINs: JT3GM84R * V0004296 JT3HM84R * V0007803 JT3GN86R *
V0010776 JT3HN86R * V0027427 JT3HN87R * V0027427
^ 1997 Tacoma (4x4) starting VIN 4TA **** N * VZ220360
Modification Detail
The steel backing plate of the brake pad was widened from 119.3 mm to 119.55 mm in order to
reduce the pad movement in the brake caliper.
Parts Information
MODEL PART NUMBER
4Runner 04465-35190
Tacoma (4x4) 04465-35080
Page 3738
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (Canada) (Fig 19)
Service Hints
E 2 ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
1, 2, 3-Ground: Approx 13 Ohms
Page 3391
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 544
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 3408
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
With Automatic Disconnecting Differential
Page 3414
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 509
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 2554
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 1817
Engine Control-Connectors
Page 1201
5. IF NECESSARY, CHECK VALVE BODY
(a) Assemble the valve body in the uppermost position.
HINT: When the brakes are applied, the position will move down about 0.8 mm (0.03 in.). Even at
this time, the piston should not make contact with or move the load sensing spring.
(b) In this position, check the rear brake pressure. if the measured value is not within the standard,
replace the valve body.
Page 996
Alignment: Tools and Equipment
Equipment Tire pressure gauge Dial indicator with magnetic base Wheel balancer
Specifications
Parking Pawl: Specifications
Parking lock pawl bracket ....................................................................................................................
................................................ 7.4 Nm (65 inch lbs.)
Restraints - OCS System Initialization
Seat Occupant Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - OCS System Initialization
COLLISION REPAIR INFORMATION FOR THE COLLISION REPAIR PROFESSIONAL
TITLE: SRS OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM INITIALIZATION
SECTION: ELECTRICAL BULLETIN # 177
MODELS: ALL EQUIPPED TOYOTA LEXUS and SCION MODELS
DATE: MARCH 2010
Models equipped with a Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Occupant Classification System
(OCS) will enable or disable the passenger front and side airbags based on seat occupancy
passenger weight and seat belt latch engagement.
If an equipped vehicle sustains collision damage or if the front passenger seat or any of the OCS
components are serviced the SRS Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) may illuminate setting a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC).
NOTE:
It is necessary to diagnose and repair the root cause of a SRS or OCS DTC before initializing the
OCS system. If SRS and OCS DTC's are not cleared the system may not operate properly.
Be sure to check and clear DTC's and perform OCS initialization per repair manual instructions
with a Techstream Special Service Tool (SST) or capable diagnostic tester.
Any of the following conditions could set a DTC illuminate the SRS MIL or cause the PASSENGER
AIRBAG light to indicate incorrectly regardless of occupancy:
^ The OCS Electronic Control Unit (ECU) is replaced
^ Accessories such as a seatback tray are installed on the passenger seat
^ The passenger seat is removed and replaced or reinstalled
^ The vehicle is involved in an accident or collision
Model-specific repair manuals can be accessed through the Technical Information System (TIS)
www.techinfo.toyota.com
Page 1416
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection Alternator
GENERATOR DRIVE BELT
INSPECT DRIVE BELT
1. Visually check the belt for excessive wear, frayed cords etc.
HINT: Cracks on the ribbed side of the belt are considered acceptable.
If the belt has chunks missing from the ribs, it should be replaced.
2. Using a belt tension gauge, check the drive belt tension.
Belt tension gauge:
Nippondenso BTG 20 (95506-00020) or Borroughs No. BT-33-73F
Drive belt tension:
New belt: 160 ± 25 lb Used belt: 100 ± 20 lb
If necessary, adjust the drive belt tension.
HINT: New belt" refers to a belt which has been used less than 5 minutes on a running engine.
- "Used belt" refers to a belt which has been used on a running engine for 5 minutes or more.
- After installing the drive belt, check that it fits properly in the ribbed grooves. Check with your
hand to confirm that the belt has not slipped out of the groove on the bottom of the crank pulley.
- After installing a new belt, run the engine for approx. 5 minutes and then recheck the tension.
Page 190
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 1037
Spark Plug: Specifications Torque Specification
Spark Plug x Cylinder Head ................................................................................................................
......................................................................... 18 Nm
Page 2637
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
EFI MAIN RELAY INSPECTION
1. REMOVE EFI MAIN RELAY (Marking: EFI) 2. INSPECT EFI MAIN RELAY
A. Inspect relay continuity
(a) Using an ohmmeter. check that there is continuity between terminals 1 and 2.
If there is no continuity. replace the relay.
(b) Check that there is no continuity between terminals and 5.
If there is continuity. replace the relay.
B. Inspect relay operation
(a) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 1 and 2. (b) Using an ohmmeter, check that
there is continuity between terminals 3 and 5.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
3. REINSTALL EFI MAIN RELAY
Locations
Shift Interlock Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 2973
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 3532
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR REMOVAL
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the crankshaft position sensor connector. (b) Remove the bolt crankshaft position
sensor.
Torque: 7.8 N.m (80 kgf.cm, 69 in.lbf)
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 2835
6. INSPECT ECT SENSOR
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Resistance: Refer to the graph
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the ECT sensor.
7. REINSTALL ECT SENSOR
(a) Install a new gasket to the ECT sensor. (b) Using a 19 mm deep socket, install the ECT sensor.
Torque: 20 N.m (200 kgf.cm, 14 ft.lbf)
(c) Connect the ECT sensor connector.
8. REINSTALL FUEL PIPE
Install the fuel pipe with 4 new gaskets and the 2 union bolts.
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm. 25 ft.lbf)
9. REINSTALL NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER
10. RECONNECT UPPER RADIATOR HOSE TO WATER OUTLET 11. REFILL WITH ENGINE
COOLANT
Page 3463
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 3522
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 1289
(i) Install and uniformly tighten the 10 beaning cap bolts, in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
B. Exhaust.
(a) Apply new engine oil to the thrust portion and journal of the camshaft.
(b) Align the timing marks (2 dot marks) of the camshaft drive and driven gears. (c)
Place the exhaust camshaft on the cylinder head.
(d) Install the 4 bearing caps in their proper locations. (e)
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under the heads of the bearing cap bolts.
(f) Install and uniformly tighten the 8 bearing cap bolts, in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
(g) Remove the service bolt. (h) Align the timing marks (1 dot mark) of the camshaft drive and
driven gears by turning the camshaft with a wrench.
2. Install camshafts of LH cylinder head.
CAUTION: Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level
while it is being installed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head receiving
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid
Page 2160
EGR Temperature Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Note: Except Model VZN170 (Long wheel base 4WD Pickup)
EGR Sensor to EGR Valve 14 ft.lb
Page 517
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 330
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 3004
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 2936
CHART 8
CHART 9
Page 4603
Output Shaft: Application and ID
Select a snap ring that will allow minimum axial play and install it to the shaft.
A: .........................................................................................................................................................
.................... 2.10-2.15 mm (0.0827-0.0846 inch) B: ...........................................................................
................................................................................................... 2.15-2.20 mm (0.0846-0.0866 inch)
C: .........................................................................................................................................................
..................... 2.20-2.25 mm (0.0866-0.0886 inch) D: ..........................................................................
................................................................................................... 2.25-2.30 mm (0.0886-0.0906 inch)
E: .........................................................................................................................................................
..................... 2.30-2.35 mm (0.0906-0.0925 inch) F: ..........................................................................
.................................................................................................... 2.35-2.40 mm (0.0925-0.0945 inch)
G: .........................................................................................................................................................
.................... 2.40-2.45 mm (0.0945-0.0965 inch) H: ...........................................................................
.................................................................................................. 2.45-2.50 mm (0.0965-0.0984 inch)
J: ..........................................................................................................................................................
..................... 2.50-2.55 mm (0.0984-0.1004 inch) K: ..........................................................................
................................................................................................... 2.00-2.05 mm (0.0787-0.0807 inch)
L: ..........................................................................................................................................................
.................... 2.05-2.10 mm (0.0807-0.0827 inch)
Page 1708
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Mechanical Specifications
ECT sensor to Intake Manifold 14 ft.lb
Page 4359
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2255
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 3335
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 547
Page 2685
Page 1159
Fluid - Transfer Case: Fluid Type Specifications
API GL-4 or GL-5
SAE 75W-90
Diagram Information and Instructions
Knock Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2503
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 1808
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 287
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2432
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 4011
Page 3076
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 795
A/T, M/T - Alignment Pin Service Precaution
Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle: Technical Service Bulletins A/T, M/T - Alignment
Pin Service Precaution
T-SB-0053-08
May 8, 2008
Alignment Pin Installation during Transmission/Transaxle Assembly Installation
Service Category Drivetrain
Section Automatic Transmission/Transaxle
Market USA
Applicability
Introduction
The purpose of this TSB is to provide information regarding the installation of alignment pins during
transmission/transaxle assembly installation. Missing alignment pins may result in incorrect
alignment and failure of the transmission/transaxle assembly. Use the information below when
installing a transmission/transaxle assembly.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Repair Procedure
1. Inspect the rear side of the engine block assembly for 2 alignment pins.
^ If there are less than 2 alignment pins present one may have been removed with the
transmission/transaxle assembly. Check the removed assembly for the missing alignment pins. Go
to step 2.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 3895
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (Canada) (Fig 19)
Service Hints
E 2 ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
1, 2, 3-Ground: Approx 13 Ohms
Page 2294
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Components For Removal And Installation Part 1 Of 2
Specifications
Timing Belt Tensioner: Specifications
DIMENSIONS
Protrusion From Housing Side
..............................................................................................................................10.0 - 10.8 mm
(0.394 - 0.425 inch)
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Timing Belt Tensioner To Oil Pump
.............................................................................................................................................. 27 Nm
(20 ft. lbs.)
Page 2085
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 102
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Locations
Actuator Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 2500
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 697
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 4676
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2993
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Testing and Inspection
Shift Interlock Switch: Testing and Inspection
Inspect shift lock control switch.
Inspect that there is continuity between each terminal. If the continuity is not as specified. Replace
the switch.
Testing and Inspection
Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Inspect relay operation.
a. Jack up the vehicle. b. Use a heater main relay and connect it, as shown below. c. Rotate the
tire and check that differential lock has occurred. if operation is not as specified, replace the
actuator.
2. Inspect Diff. Lock control switch continuity. Inspect the switch continuity between terminal 1 to
terminal 4.
HINT: If it is not continuity, replace the switch.
3. Inspect Diff. Lock position switch.
a. Check that there is continuity between terminals when the switch is pushed (differential
connected position). b. Check that there is no continuity when the switch is free (differential
disconnected position).
HINT: If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
4. Inspect transfer 4WD switch. 5. Inspect vehicle speed sensor.
Specifications
Case Adapter: Specifications
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Transfer Adaptor:
Oil Seal Drive In Depth
.................................................................................................................................. 45.6 +/- 0.5 mm
(1.795 +/- 0.020 inch)
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Transfer Adaptor To:
Transmission Case ..............................................................................................................................
........................................... 37 N.m (27 ft. lbs.) Control Shift Lever Retainer
..........................................................................................................................................................
18 N.m (13 ft. lbs.)
Page 144
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2706
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Front Differential Carrier
Differential Carrier: Service and Repair Front Differential Carrier
Disassembly
Differential Carrier
DISASSEMBLY
1. W/ A.D.D.:
Remove A.D.D. actuator.
a. Remove the 4 bolts.
Page 2152
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Vehicle NO.2 Speed Sensor Inspection Procedure
- Remove NO.2 vehicle speed sensor. - Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of NO.2
vehicle speed sensor.
Resistance: 560 Ohms to 680 Ohms
- Check voltage between terminals 1 and 2 of the NO.2 speed sensor when a magnet is put close
to the front end of the NO.2 vehicle speed sensor
then taken away quickly.
- Voltage is generated intermittenly.
Note: The voltages generated is extremely low.
Page 3531
Page 1875
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 2986
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
HEATED OXYGEN SENSORS INSPECTION (Bank 1, Sensor 1, Bank 1 Sensor 2)
INSPECT HEATER RESISTANCE OF HEATED OXYGEN SENSORS
(a) Disconnect the oxygen sensor connector.
Bank 1 Sensor 1
Bank 1 Sensor 2
(b) Using an ohmmeter. measure the resistance between the terminals +B and HT.
Resistance: At 20°C (68°F): 11 - 16 ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the sensor.
Torque: 20 N.m (200 kgf.cm, 14 ft.lbf)
(c) Reconnect the oxygen sensor connector.
Page 103
Headlamp Relay: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT HEADLIGHT CONTROL RELAY CONTINUITY
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
Page 3223
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 3499
Page 1716
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 1321
NOTE: If using a standard bearing, replace with one having the same number. If the number of the
bearing cannot be determined, select the correct bearing by adding together the numbers imprinted
on the cylinder block and crankshaft, then selecting the bearing with the same number as the total.
There are 5 sizes of standard bearings, marked "1", "2", "3", "4", and "5" accordingly.
Reference:
Standard sized bearing center wall thickness: No. 1:
Mark "1" ...............................................................................................................................................
1.991 - 1.994 mm (0.0784 - 0.0785 inch) Mark "2"
............................................................................................................................................... 1.994 1.997 mm (0.0785 - 0.0786 inch) Mark "3"
............................................................................................................................................... 1.997 2.000 mm (0.0786 - 0.0787 inch) Mark "4"
............................................................................................................................................... 2.000 2.003 mm (0.0787 - 0.0789 inch) Mark "5"
............................................................................................................................................... 2.003 2.006 mm (0.0789 - 0.0790 inch)
Others:
Mark "1" ...............................................................................................................................................
1.989 - 1.992 mm (0.0783 - 0.0784 inch) Mark "2"
............................................................................................................................................... 1.992 1.995 mm (0.0784 - 0.0785 inch) Mark "3"
............................................................................................................................................... 1.995 1.998 mm (0.0785 - 0.0787 inch) Mark "4"
............................................................................................................................................... 1.998 2.001 mm (0.0787 - 0.0788 inch) Mark "5"
............................................................................................................................................... 2.001 2.004 mm (0.0788 - 0.0789 inch)
Cylinder block Main journal bore diameter:
Mark "1" ..........................................................................................................................................
68.010 - 68.016 mm (2.6776 - 2.6778 inch) Mark "2"
.......................................................................................................................................... 68.016 68.022 mm (2.6778 - 2.6780 inch) Mark "3"
.......................................................................................................................................... 68.022 68.028 mm (2.6780 - 2.6783 inch)
Crankshaft main journal diameter:
Mark "O" ..........................................................................................................................................
63.996 - 64.000 mm (2.5195 - 2.5197 inch) Mark "1"
.......................................................................................................................................... 63.990 63.996 mm (2.5193 - 2.5195 inch) Mark "2"
.......................................................................................................................................... 63.985 63.990 mm (2.5191 - 2.5193 inch)
Page 2922
A/F and 02 Sensor Identification
Page 3784
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Electrical Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Resistance Cold Resistance Hot
835 - 1,400 ohms at 14 - 122 deg F 1,060 - 1,645 ohms at 122 - 212 deg F
Page 1885
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Testing and Inspection
Headlamp Dimmer Relay: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT HEADLIGHT DIMMER RELAY CONTINUITY
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
Specifications
Gear Sensor/Switch: Specifications
4WD-position Switch ...........................................................................................................................
................................................... 37 N.m (27 ft. lbs.) L4 Position Switch .............................................
...................................................................................................................................... 37 N.m (27 ft.
lbs.) Neutral Position Switch ................................................................................................................
........................................................... 37 N.m (27 ft. lbs.)
Standard Value of ECM Terminals
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection Standard Value of ECM Terminals
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 1 Of 2
Page 3034
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 3955
Page 584
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 1950
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 3711
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
SPARK PLUGS INSPECTION
1. DISCONNECT HIGH -TENSION CORDS 2. REMOVE IGNITION COILS
3. REMOVE SPARK PLUGS
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the 6 spark plugs from the RH and LH cylinder heads.
4. CLEAN SPARK PLUGS
If the electrode has traces of wet carbon, allow it to dry and then clean with a spark plug cleaner.
Air pressure: Below 588 kPa (6 kgf/sq.cm, 85 psi)
Duration: 20 seconds or less
HINT: If there are traces of oil, remove it with gasoline before using the spark plug cleaner.
5. VISUALLY INSPECT SPARK PLUGS
Check the spark plug for thread damage and insulator damage. If abnormal, replace the spark
plug.
Recommended spark plug:
ND: K16TR11 NGK: BKR5EKB-11
Page 2562
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 2 Of 2
Page 2489
Cranking Signal: Testing and Inspection
Starter Signal Circuit
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the engine is cranked, the intake air flow is slow, so fuel vaporization is poor. A rich mixture
is therefore necessary in order to achieve good startability. While the engine is being cranked, the
battery positive voltage is applied to terminal STA of the ECM. The starter signal is mainly used to
increase the fuel injection volume for the starting injection control and after-start injection control.
WIRING DIAGRAM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT: This diagnostic chart is based on the premise that the engine is cranked normally. If the
engine is not cranked, proceed to the matrix chart of problem symptoms.
Step 1
Page 250
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Page 2089
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 3320
(c) Select the active test mode on the TOYOTA hand- held tester. (d) Please refer to the TOYOTA
hand - held tester operators manual for further details. (e) If you have no TOYOTA hand-held
tester, connect the positive (+) and negative (-) leads from the battery to the fuel pump connector.
(f) Pinch the fuel return hose.
The pressure in the high pressure line will rise to approx. 400 kPa (4 kgf/sq.cm, 57 psi). In this
state, check to see that there are no leaks from any part of the fuel system.
NOTICE: Always pinch the hose. Avoid bending as it may cause the hose to crack.
(g) Turn the ignition switch to LOCK. (h) Disconnect the TOYOTA hand-held tester from the DLC3.
Page 2876
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 3122
Canister Purge Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE (VSV) FOR EVAP INSPECTION
1. REMOVE VSV
Disconnect the connector and 2 EVAP hoses and remove the screw and VSV.
2. INSPECT VSV
A. Inspect VSV for open circuit
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between the terminals.
Resistance: At 20°C (68°F): 30 - 34 ohms
If there is no continuity, replace the VSV.
B. Inspect VSV for ground
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between each terminal and the body. If there
is continuity, replace the VSV.
C. Inspect VSV operation
(a) Check that air does not flow from port E to port F. (b) Apply battery positive voltage across the
terminals.
(c) Check that air flows from port E to port F. If operation is not as specified, replace the VSV.
3. REINSTALL VSV
Page 189
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Diagram Information and Instructions
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2938
CHART 11
Page 3576
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Specifications
Clutch Switch: Specifications
Clutch Start Switch:
On-Off Stroke ......................................................................................................................................
.......................... 8 +/- 0.5 mm (0.31 +/- 0.20 inch)
Page 2710
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Specifications
Clutch Fluid: Specifications
Fluid Type FMVSS No. 116 DOT 3 Brake Fluid
Page 569
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2009
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Knock sensors are fitted one each to the right bank and left bank of the cylinder block to detect
engine knocking. This sensor contains a piezoelectric element which generates a voltage when it
becomes deformed, which occurs when the cylinder block vibrates due to knocking. If engine
knocking occurs, ignition timing is retarded to suppress it.
Page 2857
Page 4542
Position Of Parts In Engine Compartment (Part 1 Of 2) (Fig 26)
Diagram Information and Instructions
Cranking Signal: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 515
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4546
Splice Points
Location Of Splice Points (Fig 36)
Page 4361
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 669
CHART 26
Page 1912
Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 3560
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3097
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 4300
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
HINT: Rear propeller shaft 3-joint type:
^ Center bearing center line and the center bearing housing center line must be adjusted within°1
mm of each other in the vehicles longitudinal direction when the vehicle is unloaded.
^ When adjusting the center bearing housing center line, it should be perpendicular to the axis of
front propeller shaft.
HINT: With a grease gun, pump grease into each fitting until it begins to flow around the oil seal.
Testing and Inspection
Shift Interlock Control Module: Testing and Inspection
Shift Lock ECU, Harness Side: Floor Shift
Floor Shift:
Inspect shift lock control ECU. Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage at terminal.
HINT: Do not disconnect the ECU connector.
Page 4356
operation causes gear shift when the conditions for overdrive are met.
^ O/D Main SW OFF When the O/D main SW is turned to OFF, the current flowing through the O/D
OFF indicator light flows through the O/D main SW to GROUND, causing the indicator light to light
up. At the same time, a signal is input to TERMINAL OD2 of the Engine Control Module and
Engine Control Module operation prevents shift into overdrive.
5. A/T OIL TEMP. WARNING
When the A/T Oil Temp. Sensor affixed to the transmission case detects that the fluid temp. is
150°C (302°F) or more, the Engine Control Module operates and the current flowing through the
GAUGE fuse flows to the A/T Oil Temp. warning light --> TERMINAL OIL-W of the Engine Control
Module --> Ground, so that the warning light lights up, informing that the Oil Temp. is high. When
the Oil Temp. drops to 120°C (248°F) or less, the Engine Control Module stops operating and the
warning light goes out.
Page 374
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 4319
Universal Joint: Service and Repair Dana Made
REPLACEMENT
Page 3614
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 1840
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 1899
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Locations
Shift Interlock Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 2691
CHART 29
Page 3098
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 3899
Shift Indicator: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 4083
Clutch Pedal Assembly: Adjustments
1. Check that pedal height is correct.
Pedal height from floor panel: 70.0-180.0 mm (6.692-7.086 inch) Pedal height from asphalt sheet:
67.0-177.0 mm (6.574-6.968 inch)
2. If necessary, adjust pedal height.
Loosen the lock nut and turn the stopper bolt until the height is correct. tighten the lock nut.
3. Check that pedal freeplay and push rod play are correct push in on the pedal until the beginning
of clutch resistance is felt.
Pedal freeplay: 5.0-15.0 mm (0.197-0.591 inch)
Gently push on the pedal until the resistance begins to increase a little.
Push rod play at pedal top: .0-5.0 mm (0.039-0.197 inch)
4. If necessary, adjust pedal freeplay and push rod play.
a. Loosen the lock nut and turn the push rod until the freeplay and push rod play are correct. b.
Tighten the lock nut. c. After adjusting the pedal freeplay, check the pedal height. d. Connect the
air duct and install the lower finish panel.
5. Check clutch release point.
a. Pull the parking brake lever and install wheel stopper. b. Start the engine and idle the engine. c.
Without depressing the clutch pedal, slowly shift the shift lever into reverse position until the gears
contact.
d. Gradually depress the clutch pedal and measure the stroke distance from the point the gear
noise stops (release point) up to the full stroke end
Page 4919
Depress MOTOR Switch And Brake Pedal
(h) Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few seconds. (i) Depress the brake pedal and hold it
for about 15 seconds. As you hold the pedal down, push the MOTOR switch for a few seconds.
Check that
the brake pedal does not pulsate.
(j) Release the brake pedal.
7. Push MOTOR switch.
Depress MOTOR Switch
(a) Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few seconds. (b) Stop the engine.
8. Disconnect actuator checker (SST) from actuator.
Disconnect the actuator checker (SST) and sub-wire harnesses (SST) from the actuator, control
relay and body side wire harness. SST 09990-00150, 09990-00200, 09990-00210, 09990 - 00370
9. Connect connectors.
(a) Connect the 2 connectors to the control relay. (b) Connect the connector to the actuator.
10. Clear the Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC).
Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2048
CHART 16
CHART 17
Page 3577
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 3582
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 1695
1. Remove coolant and any foreign material on rubber points "A," "B," and "C."
2. Check that points "A," "B " and "C" are not deformed, cracked, or swollen.
3. Check that points "C" and "D" are not stuck together.
4. Apply engine coolant to points "B" and "C" before using the radiator cap tester.
^ Radiator Cap Tester: Snap-On/Sun P/N SVTS262A (or equivalent)
5. Before installing the radiator cap tester, use the applicable radiator cap adaptor provided in the
following SST kits in conjunction with the radiator cap tester:
^ SST P/N 09230-00030-01 (09231-10080-01) or 09230-00020-01 (09231-10060-01) or
09230-00050-01(09231-10110-01
6. When using the radiator cap tester, tilt it more than 30 degrees.
7. Pump the radiator cap tester several times, and check the maximum pressure.
Pumping speed: 1 pump/second
HINT:
Stop pumping when the valve opens and read the gauge. The gauge must be within the standard
values listed below when the pressure valve opens. The cap is considered OK when the pressure
holds steady or falls very slowly, but holds within the standard values listed below for one minute.
Specification:
If the maximum pressure is less than the minimum standard value, replace the radiator cap
sub-assembly.
Type: Compact Cap, 88 kPa
Page 192
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
On-Vehicle Inspection
Throttle Body: Testing and Inspection On-Vehicle Inspection
THROTTLE BODY ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1. INSPECT THROTTLE BODY
(a) Check that the throttle linkage moves smoothly.
(b) w/ EGR:
Check the vacuum at each port. Start the engine.
- Check the vacuum with your finger.
2. INSPECT THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
(a) Apply vacuum to the throttle opener. (b) Disconnect the sensor connector.
Testing and Inspection
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT WIPER SWITCH CONTINUITY
w/ Mist Wiper
w/ Intermittent Wiper
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSPECTION
NOTICE: "Cold" and "Hot" in these sentences express the temperature of the sensors themselves.
"Cold" is from -10°C (14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals.
Resistance:
Cold: 1,630 - 2,740 Ohms Hot: 2,065 - 3,225 Ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the crank shaft position sensor.
Specifications
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Specifications
At Cold At Hot
Terminals +B and RSC or RSO 17.0 - 24.5 ohms at 14 - 122 deg F 21.5 - 28.5 ohms at 122 - 212
deg F
Page 1472
Oil Filter: Tools and Equipment
Toyota Oil Filter Wrench Set
AST tool# TOY 300
This set includes our tool numbers TOY640, TOY730, and M0219. With the TOY300 you have
every gas engine Toyota/Lexus model covered between 1980 and 2009.
- Covers all Toyota and Lexus vehicles 1980-2009, based on factory filters.
Contact AST for pricing.
Assenmacher Specialty Tools 1-800-525-2943
This Kit Contains the Following Tools:
TOY 640 - Toyota Oil Filter Wrench
Page 1187
Refrigerant: Fluid Type Specifications
Type R134a
Page 2386
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 1686
(b) Remove the 1 screw, 11 clips and radiator grille.
3. Disconnect upper radiator hose. 4. Disconnect radiator reservoir hose. 5. Disconnect lower
radiator hose. 6. Remove No. 2 fan shroud. 7. A/T: Disconnect oil cooler hoses.
8. Remove radiator.
Remove the 4 bolts and radiator.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
NOTE: Insert the tabs of the radiator support through the radiator service holes.
Torque the 4 bolts and radiator: 12 Nm (8.7 ft. lbs.)
Page 3316
Fuel Supply Line: Testing and Inspection
COMPONENTS
CAUTION:
- Always use new gaskets when replacing the fuel tank or component parts.
- Apply the proper torque to all tightened parts.
INSPECTION
INSPECT FUEL TANK AND LINE
Page 1805
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2671
CHART 12
CHART 13
Page 4501
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
The No.1 vehicle speed sensor outputs a 4-pulse signal for every revolution of the rotor shaft,
which is rotated by the transmission output shaft via the driven gear.
After this signal is converted into a more precise rectangular waveform by the waveform shaping
circuit inside the combination meter, it is then transmitted to the ECM. The ECM determines the
vehicle speed based on the frequency of these pulse signals.
The No.2 vehicle speed sensor detects the rotation speed of the transmission output shaft and
sends signals to the ECM. The ECM determines the vehicle speed based on these signals.
An AC voltage is generated in the No.2 vehicle speed sensor coil as the rotor mounted on the
output shaft rotates, and this voltage is sent to the ECM.
The gear shift point and lock-up timing are controlled by the ECM based on the signals from this
vehicle speed sensor and the throttle position sensor signal.
If the No.2 vehicle speed sensor malfunctions, the ECM uses input signals from the No.1 vehicle
speed sensor as a back-up signal.
Page 3020
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 555
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Crankshaft Sensor to Oil Pump 69 in.lb
Page 194
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 1880
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 4147
Differential Carrier (3RZ-FE, 5VZ-FE w/o Differential Lock)
INSPECTION
1. Check runout of companion flange. Using a dial indicator, measure the vertical and lateral runout
of the companion flange.
Page 1883
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 3161
EGR Valve: Service and Repair
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
EGR VALVE INSPECTION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT 2. REMOVE EGR PIPE 3. REMOVE EGR GAS TEMPERATURE
SENSOR 4. REMOVE EGR VALVE
(a) Disconnect these hoses from the EGR valve:
- Vacuum hose (from VSV for EGR)
- EGR hose (from EGR vacuum modulator)
- Water hose (from water bypass pipe)
- Water bypass hose (from IAC valve)
Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Cruise Control Module: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
MAIN SWITCH CIRCUIT (CRUISE CONTROL SWITCH)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the cruise control main switch is turned off, the cruise control does not operate.
Cruise Control Switch
WIRING DIAGRAM
Inspection Procedure / Main Switch Circuit (Cruise Control Switch) (1 Of 3)
Page 272
- There are no foreign objects on the sensor or the part of the knuckle to which the sensor is to be
installed.
- The sensor is installed flat against the knuckle when you tighten the bolt.
- When installing the resin clips, use new ones.
Specifications
Rear Engine Plate: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Rear Plate To Cylinder Head
..................................................................................................................................................... 8.0
Nm (71 inch lbs.) Rear End Plate To Cylinder Block
............................................................................................................................................. 7.5 Nm
(66 inch lbs.)
Page 3418
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 2465
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 3712
6. ADJUST ELECTRODE GAP
Carefully bend the outer electrode to obtain the correct electrode gap.
Correct electrode gap: 1.1 mm (0.043 in.)
7. REINSTALL SPARK PLUGS
Torque: 18 N.m (180 kgf.cm, 13 ft.lbf)
8. REINSTALL IGNITION COILS 9. RECONNECT HIGH-TENSION CORDS
Page 2840
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Crankshaft Sensor to Oil Pump 69 in.lb
Page 790
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4357
Shift Indicator: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 4418
Output Shaft: Application and ID
Output Shaft Snap Ring Thickness: Clutch Hub No.1
Mark A .................................................................................................................................................
............... 2.30-2.35 mm (0.0906-0.0925 inch) Mark B ........................................................................
........................................................................................ 2.35-2.40 mm (0.0925-0.0945 inch) Mark C
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. 2.40-2.45 mm (0.0945-0.0965 inch) Mark D .....................................................................................
........................................................................... 2.45-2.50 mm (0.0965-0.0984 inch) Mark E ............
....................................................................................................................................................
2.50-2.55 mm (0.0984-0.1004 inch) Mark F ........................................................................................
......................................................................... 2.55-2.60 mm (0.1004-0.1024 inch) Mark G .............
...................................................................................................................................................
2.60-2.65 mm (0.1024-0.1043 inch)
Output Shaft Snap Ring Thickness: Clutch Hub No.2
Mark A .................................................................................................................................................
............... 1.80-1.85 mm (0.0709-0.0728 inch) Mark B ........................................................................
........................................................................................ 1.85-1.90 mm (0.0728-0.0748 inch) Mark C
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. 1.90-1.95 mm (0.0748-0.0768 inch) Mark D .....................................................................................
........................................................................... 1.95-2.00 mm (0.0768-0.0787 inch) Mark E ............
....................................................................................................................................................
2.00-2.05 mm (0.0787-0.0807 inch) Mark F ........................................................................................
......................................................................... 2.05-2.10 mm (0.0807-0.0827 inch) Mark G .............
...................................................................................................................................................
2.10-2.15 mm (0.0827-0.0846 inch)
Output Shaft Snap Ring Thickness, Rear
Mark A .................................................................................................................................................
............... 2.65-2.70 mm (0.1043-0.1063 inch) Mark B ........................................................................
........................................................................................ 2.70-2.75 mm (0.1063-0.1083 inch) Mark C
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. 2.75-2.80 mm (0.1083-0.1102 inch) Mark D .....................................................................................
........................................................................... 2.80-2.85 mm (0.1102-0.1122 inch) Mark E ............
....................................................................................................................................................
2.85-2.90 mm (0.1122-0.1142 inch) Mark F ........................................................................................
......................................................................... 2.90-2.95 mm (0.1142-0.1161 inch) Mark G .............
...................................................................................................................................................
2.95-3.00 mm (0.1161-0.1181 inch) Mark H ........................................................................................
........................................................................ 3.00-3.05 mm (0.1181-0.1201 inch) Mark J ...............
..................................................................................................................................................
3.05-3.10 mm (0.1201-0.1220 inch) Mark K ........................................................................................
........................................................................ 3.10-3.15 mm (0.1220-0.1240 inch) Mark L ...............
.................................................................................................................................................
3.15-3.20 mm (0.1240-0.1260 inch) Mark M .......................................................................................
........................................................................ 3.20-3.25 mm (0.1260-0.1280 inch) Mark N ...............
.................................................................................................................................................
3.25-3.30 mm (0.1280-0.1299 inch) Mark P ........................................................................................
......................................................................... 3.30-3.35 mm (0.1299-0.1319 inch) Mark Q .............
...................................................................................................................................................
3.35-3.40 mm (0.1319-0.1339 inch) Mark R ........................................................................................
........................................................................ 3.40-3.45 mm (0.1339-0.1358 inch) Mark S ...............
..................................................................................................................................................
3.45-3.50 mm (0.1358-0.1378 inch)
Specifications
Planetary Gears: Specifications
FRONT PLANETARY GEAR Maximum Inside Diameter
..............................................................................................................................................................
24.08 mm (0.9480 inch) Planetary Pinion Gear Thrust Clearance
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
.................. 0.20 - 0.60 mm (0.0079 - 0.0236 inch) Maximum .............................................................
.......................................................................................................................... 1.00 mm (0.0394
inch)
PLANETARY SUN GEAR Sun Gear Bushing Inside Diameter, Maximum
.............................................................................................................................. 27.08 mm (1.0661
inch)
REAR PLANETARY GEAR Planetary Pinion Gear Thrust Clearance
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
.................. 0.20 - 0.60 mm (0.0079 - 0.0236 inch) Maximum .............................................................
......................................................................................................................... 1.00 mm (0.0394 inch)
Page 2288
Components For Removal And Installation Part 2 Of 2
Page 1996
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 4350
Position Of Parts In Engine Compartment (Part 2 Of 2) (Fig 25)
Page 4367
Electronically Controlled Transmission And A/T Indicator (Part 2 Of 3)
Page 4756
ABS Warning Light Circuit Inspection Procedure (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 2983
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 1016
- Using SST, tighten the flare nut to specified torque. (SST 09631-22020)
HINT: Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 30 cm (11.81 in.).
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf) Torque for using SST: 28 N.m (285 kgf.cm, 21 ft.lbf)
NOTICE: Do not rotate the fuel pipe, when tightening the flare nut.
Page 2559
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 1 Of 2
Testing and Inspection
Shift Interlock Switch: Testing and Inspection
Inspect shift lock control switch.
Inspect that there is continuity between each terminal. If the continuity is not as specified. Replace
the switch.
Page 3953
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 4260
Rear Axle Shaft (1 Of 2)
Page 3115
Catalytic Converter: Description and Operation
View: Typical Catalytic Converter
View: Typical Catalytic Converter
Catalytic converters are used to convert carbon monoxide (CO), hydrocarbon (HC) and oxides of
nitrogen (NOx) into water vapor (H2O), carbon dioxide (CO2) and nitrogen (N2). The catalysts
used to create these conversions are platinum, palladium and rhodium (depending on type of
converter).
During engine operation, all of the exhaust gases flow through the converter where a chemical
change takes place. This change causes the temperature inside the converter to be higher than the
temperature of the exhaust gases when they leave the engine. Due to this increase in heat the
converter is insulated so that its outside temperature is about the same temperature as the muffler.
However, due to its solid mass, the converter remains hot much longer than the muffler. The body
of the catalytic converter is made of stainless steel designed to last the life of the vehicle. Catalytic
converters maybe of the monolith or pellet type.
Although all vehicles with a catalytic converter must use unleaded fuel, small amounts of leaded
fuel can be used in case of an emergency. To prevent adding leaded fuel, the fuel tank filler nozzle
has a built-in restrictor.
The conventional Oxidizing Catalytic (OC) converter, uses platinum and palladium, included as a
fine coating on the substrate, to reduce harmful exhaust fumes.
The Three-Way Catalytic (TWC) converter, contains platinum and palladium as conventional
oxidizing agents in addition to rhodium.
The Warm-Up (WU) converter, is installed in the exhaust system ahead of the main converter. This
converter operates on the same principle as the main converter, but it reacts more rapidly to
incoming gases. It is especially effective in converting gases immediately after start up.
Page 4891
2. Remove pistons from cylinder.
(a) Prepare the wooden plate to hold the pistons. (b) Place the plate between the pistons and insert
a pad at one side. (c) Use compressed air to remove the pistons alternately from the cylinder.
WARNING: Do not place your fingers in front of the piston when using compressed air.
3. Remove piston seals.
Using a screwdriver, remove the 4 piston seals from the cylinder.
REASSEMBLY
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.
NOTE: Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to the parts indicated by arrows in EXPLODED
VIEW.
Page 2362
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 4142
a. Install a new snap ring to the shaft b. Using a plastic-faced hammer, install the shaft to the
differential case. c. Check that there is 2 - 3 mm (0.08 - 0.12 inch) of play in axial direction. d.
Check that the intermediate shaft will not come out by trying to pull it completely out by hand.
29. W/ A.D.D.: Install clutch case to differential tube.
a. Install a new O-ring to the tube. b. Coat the O-ring with MP grease. c. Install the clutch case to
the tube. d. Torque the 2 torx bolts using Torx socket E14 (Part No. 09044-00010, or locally
manufactured tool).
Torque to 78 Nm (58 ft. lbs.)
30. W/ A.D.D.: Install clutch sleeve. 31. Install differential tube to differential.
a. Remove any old FIPG material and be careful not to drop oil on the contact surfaces of the
differential and clutch case. b. Clean contacting surfaces of any residual FIPG material using
gasoline or alcohol.
c. Apply FIPG: Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281, or equivalent, to the differential, as
shown.
HINT: Install the differential tube within 10 minutes after applying FIPG.
d. Install the differential tube to the differential.
e. Clean the threads of the 4 bolts (W/O A.D.D.) or 2 torx bolts (W/ A.D.D.) and retainer bolt holes
with toluene or trichloroethylene. f.
Apply adhesive Part No. 08833-00070, THREE BOND 1324, or equivalent, to 2 or 3 threads of the
bolts end.
g. Torque the 4 bolts (W/O A.D.D.) or 4 torx bolts (W/ A. D.D.) using Torx socket E14 (Part No.
09044-00010 or locally manufactured tool).
Torque:
W/O A.D.D.: 105 Nm (77 ft. lbs.) W/ A.D.D.: 78 Nm (58 ft. lbs.)
32. W/ A.D.D.: Install A.D.D. actuator.
a. Remove any old FIPG material and be careful not to drop oil on the contact surfaces of the
actuator and clutch case.
Page 2372
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2042
CHART 8
CHART 9
Page 1311
Connecting Rod: Testing and Inspection Thrust Clearance
CHECK CONNECTING ROD THRUST CLEARANCE
Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance while moving the connecting rod back and
forth. Standard thrust clearance: 0.150 - 0.330 mm (0.0059 - 0.0130 inch) Maximum thrust
clearance: 0.380 mm (0.0150 inch) If the thrust clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the
connecting rod assembly. If necessary, replace the crankshaft.
Specifications
Shift Fork: Specifications
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Shift Fork To Hub Sleeve Clearance:
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
........................................ 1.0 mm (0.039 inch)
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Shift Fork To Shift Fork Shaft
.............................................................................................................................................................
20 N.m (14 ft. lbs.)
Diagram Information and Instructions
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 3730
Location Of Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness, Ground Points (Fig 32)
Location Of Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness, Ground Points (Fig 36)
Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Page 2124
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 1764
Exhaust Manifold: Testing and Inspection
INSPECTION
Measure the surfaces contacting the cylinder head for warpage. Maximum warpage: 1.00 mm
(0.0394 inch) If warpage is greater than the maximum, replace the exhaust manifold.
Page 4308
Procedure for Tacoma & PreRunner
Use a grease gun to apply multi-purpose grease to the No. 1, 2, 3, 7, 8, 9, 13 and 14 grease
fittings. Apply molybdenum disulfide lithium base chassis grease, NLGI No. 2, to the No. 4, 5, 6, 10,
11 and 12 grease fittings (double cardan joint).
Procedure for Tundra
Page 798
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT AIR CLEANER CAP FROM MAF METER
2. REMOVE MAF METER
(a) Disconnect the MAF meter connector. (b) Remove the 2 bolts and MAF meter.
Torque: 6.9 N.m (72 kgf.cm, 61 in.lbf)
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 4246
HUB BOLT REPLACEMENT
1. Remove front wheel. 2. Remove brake caliper and disc. 3. Remove hub bolt. Using Special
Service Tool (SST), remove the hub bolt.
4. Install hub bolt.
Install a washer and nut to the hub bolt, as shown in the illustration, and install the hub bolt by
tightening the nut.
5. Install brake disc and caliper. 6. Install front wheel.
Torque: 110 Nm (83 ft. lbs.)
Free Wheel Hub
Page 2059
Page 1725
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A thermistor built into the engine coolant temperature sensor changes the resistance value
according to the engine coolant temperature. The structure of the sensor and connection to the
ECM is the same as in the intake air temp. circuit malfunction.
Page 2937
CHART 10
Diagram Information and Instructions
Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2553
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Main Switch Circuit (Cruise Control Switch)
Cruise Control Switch: Testing and Inspection Main Switch Circuit (Cruise Control Switch)
MAIN SWITCH CIRCUIT (CRUISE CONTROL SWITCH)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the cruise control main switch is turned off, the cruise control does not operate.
Cruise Control Switch
WIRING DIAGRAM
Inspection Procedure / Main Switch Circuit (Cruise Control Switch) (1 Of 3)
Page 1673
Heater Core: Service and Repair
HEATER RADIATOR REMOVAL
Heater Unit
1. REMOVE HEATER UNIT
See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Heater Core Case
2. REMOVE HEATER RADIATOR
a. Remove the 2 screws and the 2 plates. b. Pull the heater radiator out.
HEATER RADIATOR INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 1887
Page 4526
Page 950
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
The No.1 vehicle speed sensor outputs a 4-pulse signal for every revolution of the rotor shaft,
which is rotated by the transmission output shaft via the driven gear.
After this signal is converted into a more precise rectangular waveform by the waveform shaping
circuit inside the combination meter, it is then transmitted to the ECM. The ECM determines the
vehicle speed based on the frequency of these pulse signals.
The No.2 vehicle speed sensor detects the rotation speed of the transmission output shaft and
sends signals to the ECM. The ECM determines the vehicle speed based on these signals.
An AC voltage is generated in the No.2 vehicle speed sensor coil as the rotor mounted on the
output shaft rotates, and this voltage is sent to the ECM.
The gear shift point and lock-up timing are controlled by the ECM based on the signals from this
vehicle speed sensor and the throttle position sensor signal.
If the No.2 vehicle speed sensor malfunctions, the ECM uses input signals from the No.1 vehicle
speed sensor as a back-up signal.
Page 2661
Locations
Horn Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 1994
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 587
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 452
Inspection Procedure / Stop Light Switch Circuit (2 Of 4)
Inspection Procedure / Stop Light Switch Circuit (3 Of 4)
Page 752
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 4143
b. Clean contacting surfaces of any residual FIPG material using gasoline or alcohol.
c. Apply FIPG: Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281, or equivalent, to the clutch case, as
shown.
HINT: Install the actuator within 10 minutes after applying FIPG.
d. Torque the 4 bolts.
Torque to 21 Nm (15 ft. lbs.)
Companion Flange Dust Deflector
1. Remove dust deflector. Using SST 09950 - 00020 and a press, remove the dust deflector.
2. Install new dust deflector. Using SST 09636 - 20010 and a press, install a new dust deflector.
Page 2827
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Specifications
Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip Stick Tube: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Oil Dipstick Guide To Generator Bracket
........................................................................................................................................... 8 Nm (71
inch lbs.)
Page 491
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 935
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Electrical Specifications
Oxygen Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Bank 1: Sensor 1, Terminals +B & HT 11 - 16 ohms at 68 deg F
Bank 1: Sensor 2, Terminals +B & HT 11 - 16 ohms at 68 deg F
Bank 1 Sensor 1
Bank 1 Sensor 2
Page 3517
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSPECTION
NOTICE: "Cold" and "Hot" in these sentences express the temperature of the sensors themselves.
"Cold" is from -10°C (14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals.
Resistance:
Cold: 1,630 - 2,740 Ohms Hot: 2,065 - 3,225 Ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the crank shaft position sensor.
Page 4320
1. Place matchmarks on shaft and yoke.
2. Remove snap rings.
a. Using a brass bar and hammer, slightly tap in the bearing outer races. b. Using pliers, remove
the 4 snap rings from the grooves.
3. Remove spider bearings.
a. Using Special Service Tool (SST) 09332-25010, push out the bearing from the propeller shaft.
HINT: Sufficiently raise the part indicated by a so that it does not come into contact with the
bearing.
b. Clamp the bearing outer race in a vise and tap off the propeller shaft with a hammer.
HINT: Remove the bearing on opposite side in the same procedure.
c. Install the 2 removed bearing outer races to the spider. d. Using SST 09332-25010, push out the
bearing from the yoke. e. Clamp the outer bearing race in a vise and tap off the yoke with a
hammer.
HINT: Remove the bearing on the opposite side in the same procedure.
4. Select spider bearing.
Select the bearing according to whether or not there is a drill mark on the yoke section.
Page 1917
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR REMOVAL
1. REMOVE NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER 2. REMOVE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the camshaft position sensor connector.
(b) Remove the bolts and camshaft position sensor.
Torque: 7.8 N.m (80 kgf.cm, 69 in.lbf)
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 3644
Specifications
Fluid Pan: Specifications
Oil pan x Transmission case ...............................................................................................................
.................................................. 7.4 Nm (65 inch lbs.) Drain Plug .......................................................
......................................................................................................................................... 20 N.m (15
ft. lbs.)
Service and Repair
Gear: Service and Repair
NOTE: For removal and installation procedures refer to "Transfer Case, Service and Repair."
DISASSEMBLY
1. Remove front bearing.
Using a press, remove the front bearing.
2. Remove rear bearing.
Using Special Service Tool (SST) 09555-55010 and a press, remove the rear bearing.
Specifications
Coolant Drain Plug: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Drain Plug To Cylinder Block ...............................................................................................................
................................................ 39 Nm (29 ft. lbs.)
Page 2919
Applicable Vehicles
Page 1997
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2705
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 693
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4718
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Diagram Information and Instructions
Differential: Diagram Information and Instructions
Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness
Location Of Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness, Ground Points (Fig 36)
Page 2370
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 902
Knock Sensor: Oscilloscope Patterns and Waveforms
Page 145
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Specifications
Fuel Rail: Specifications
Fuel Rail to Intake Manifold 10 ft.lb
Page 550
6. INSPECT ECT SENSOR
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Resistance: Refer to the graph
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the ECT sensor.
7. REINSTALL ECT SENSOR
(a) Install a new gasket to the ECT sensor. (b) Using a 19 mm deep socket, install the ECT sensor.
Torque: 20 N.m (200 kgf.cm, 14 ft.lbf)
(c) Connect the ECT sensor connector.
8. REINSTALL FUEL PIPE
Install the fuel pipe with 4 new gaskets and the 2 union bolts.
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm. 25 ft.lbf)
9. REINSTALL NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER
10. RECONNECT UPPER RADIATOR HOSE TO WATER OUTLET 11. REFILL WITH ENGINE
COOLANT
Page 4570
If the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the drive rotor, driven rotor or pump body.
ASSEMBLY
Assembly us in the reverse order of disassembly.
Page 3350
and Hot is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
(a) Disconnect the IAC valve connector.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminal +B and other terminals (RSC,
RSO).
Resistance:
Cold: 17.0 - 24.5 ohms Hot: 21.5 - 28.5 ohms
If resistance is not as specified, replace the IAC valve.
(c) Reconnect the IAC valve connector.
3. INSPECT AIR ASSIST SYSTEM
(a) Initial conditions:
- Engine at normal operating temperature
- Idle speed checked correctly
- Transmission in neutral position
- A/C switch OFF
(b) Using SST, connect terminals TE1 and E1 of the DLC1. SST 09843-18020 (c) After engine
speed is kept at 900 - 1300 rpm for 10 seconds, check that it returns to idle speed. (d) Stop the
engine.
(e) Disconnect the air assist hose from the IAC valve and plug it. (f) Start the engine and check that
the idle speed reaches 500 rpm or below (the engine may stall).
If the idle does not reach 500 rpm or below, check for a leak between the air assist hoses, pipe and
injectors."
(g) Remove the SST from the DLC1. SST 09843-18020 (h) Reconnect the air assist hose to the
IAC valve.
Description and Operation
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
OBD II regulations require that the vehicle's on-board computer lights up the Malfunction Indicator
Lamp (MIL) on the instrument panel when the computer detects a malfunction in the computer itself
or in drive system components which affect vehicle emissions. In addition to the MIL lighting up
when a malfunction is detected, the applicable DTC prescribed by SAE J2012 are recorded in the
ECM memory.
If the malfunction does not reoccur in 3 trips, the MIL goes off but the DTC remain recorded in the
ECM memory.
Page 1657
Removal and Installation
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect shackle No.2 from bracket.
(a) Remove the nut and disconnect the shackle No.2. (b) Remove the cushion retainer, 2 cushions
and collar.
2. Remove LSP & BV assembly.
Disconnect Brake Lines And Mounting Bolts
(a) Using SST, disconnect the brake lines from the valve body.
SST 09023 - 00100
(b) Remove the clip from the flexible hose bracket. (c) Remove the 3 valve bracket mounting bolts,
spacer and flexible hose bracket mounting bolt, and remove the LSP & BV assembly and flexible
hose bracket.
INSTALLATION
1. Install LSP & BV assembly to frame.
Install the 3 valve bracket mounting bolts, spacer and flexible hose bracket mounting bolt with the
LSP & BV assembly and flexible hose bracket. Torque: 29 Nm (22 ft. lbs.)
2. Connect brake line.
Using SST, connect the brake lines. Torque: 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.) SST 09023 - 00100
3. Connect shackle No. 2 bracket.
(a) Set dimension A.
Initial set: 120 mm (4.72 inch)
(c) Tighten the lock nut.
Torque: 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
(c) Connect the shackle No.2 with the 2 cushions and collar to the shackle bracket.
Torque: 13 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
Page 4322
b. Using a hammer, tap the yoke until there is no clearance between the bearing outer race and
snap ring.
7. Check spider bearing.
^ Check that the spider baring moves smoothly.
^ Check the spider bearing axial play.
Bearing axial play: Maximum 0.05 mm (0.0020 inch)
HINT: Install new spider bearings on the shaft side in the procedure described above.
Page 3604
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 488
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2050
CHART 20
Page 2994
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 4024
C. Lift off upper valve body and plate as a single unit holding the valve body plate to the upper
valve body as shown in the illustration.
Caution: Be careful that the check balls and strainer do not fall out.
2. Modification:
A. Turn over the upper valve body, remove plate & gaskets. B. Add new check ball in the location
shown in illustration.
3. Assembly:
A. GReassemble upper and lower valve body halves using new gaskets. B. GInstall 25 bolts to
upper valve body.
Torque: 56 in. lbs. (6.4 N/m, 65 kgf/cm)
Caution: Careful to reinstall the bolts in their proper locations as shown in the illustration.
Bolt Length: A:
38 mm (1.50")
B: 20 mm (0.79")
C: 28 mm (1.10")
C. Complete reassembly as described in the Repair Manual for the vehicle being serviced.
Bleeding the Brake System
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Bleeding the Brake System
CAUTION: Do not let brake fluid remain on a painted surface. Wash it off immediately.
NOTE: If any work is done on the brake system or if air is suspected in the brake lines, bleed the
system of air.
Fill Brake Reservoir
BRAKE FLUID BLEEDING
1. Fill brake reservoir with brake fluid.
Check the fluid level in the reservoir after bleeding each wheel. Add fluid, if necessary. Fluid:
SAEJ17O3 or FMVSS No.116 DOT 3
2. Bleed master cylinder.
NOTE: If the master cylinder has been disassembled or if the reservoir becomes empty, bleed the
air from the master cylinder.
(a) Disconnect the brake lines from the master cylinder.
(b) Slowly depress the brake pedal and hold it.
(c) Block off the outlet plugs with your fingers, and release the Brake Pedal. (d) Repeat (b) and (c)
3 or 4 times.
3. Connect vinyl tube to brake caliper or wheel cylinder bleeder plug.
Page 2896
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 1314
Connecting Rod: Service and Repair Assembly
1. Assemble piston and connecting rod.
(a) Using a small screwdriver, install a new snap ring on one side of the piston pin hole.
NOTE: Be sure that end gap of the snap ring is not aligned with the pin hole cutout portion of the
piston.
(b) Gradually heat the piston to 60° C (140° F). (c)
Coat the piston pin with engine oil.
(d) Align the front marks of the piston and connecting rod, and push in the piston pin with your
thumb. (e)
Using a small screwdriver, install a new snap ring on the other side of the piston pin hole.
NOTE: Be sure that end gap of the snap ring is not aligned with the pin hole cutout portion of the
piston.
Page 2828
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 1071
(a) Turn the crankshaft, and align the timing marks of the crankshaft timing pulley and oil pump
body.
CAUTION: Always turn the crankshaft clockwise.
(b) Check that the timing marks of the RH and LH timing pulleys with the timing marks of the No. 3
timing belt cover as shown in the
illustration. If the marks do not align, remove the timing belt and reinstall it.
(c) Remove the crankshaft pulley bolt.
11. Install timing belt guide.
Install the guide, facing the cup side outward.
12. Install No. 1 timing belt cover and starter wire bracket.
(a) Check that the timing belt cover gaskets has no cracks or peeling, etc. If the gasket has cracks
or peeling, etc., replace it using these steps: ^
Using a screwdriver and gasket scraper, remove all the old gasket material.
^ Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the loose material.
No. 1 Cover (Back)
^ Remove the backing paper from a new gasket and install the gasket evenly to the part of the
timing belt cover shaded black in the illustration.
(b) Install the timing belt cover with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.)
Page 4488
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 3192
(l) Reinstall the No.2 timing belt cover with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 9 N.m (90 kgf.cm, 80 in.lbf)
(m)Start the engine.
(n) Disconnect the vacuum sensing hose from the fuel pressure regulator. and plug the hose end.
(o) Measure the fuel pressure at idle.
Fuel pressure 265 - 304 kPa (2.7 - 3.1 kgf/sq.cm, 38 - 44 psi)
(p) Stop the engine. (q) Check that the fuel pressure remains as specified for 5 minutes after the
engine has stopped.
Fuel pressure: 147 kPa (1.5 kgf/sq.cm. 21 psi) or more
If pressure is not as specified. check the fuel pump, pressure regulator and/or injectors.
(r) After checking fuel pressure, disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery and
carefully remove the SST to prevent gasoline from
splashing. SST 09268-45012
(s) Remove the other union bolt. 3 gaskets and fuel pipe from the delivery pipes. (t) Reinstall the
fuel pipe with 4 new gaskets and the 2 union bolts.
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf)
(u) Reconnect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery. (v) Check for fuel leakage.
Page 4911
Inspect valve piston pin and load sensing spring contact surface for wear. Wear limit: 0.7 mm
(0.028 inch)
REASSEMBLY
1. Assemble these parts to load sensing spring:
(a) Load sensing valve boot. (b) Load sensing spring boot. (c) 4 bushings. (d) 2 rubber plates. (e) 2
collars.
NOTE: Apply lithium soap-base glycol grease to all rubbing areas.
- Do not mistake the valve side for the shackle side of the load sensing spring.
2. Install shackles No.1 and No.2.
(a) Install the lock nut and shackle No.1 to the shackle No.2. (b) Torque the nut.
Torque: 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
3. Install load sensing spring to shackle No.1.
(a) Install the load sensing spring and 2 plate washer to the shackle No.1. (b) Torque the bolt and
nut.
Torque: 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
4. Install load sensing spring to valve body.
Install the load sensing spring to the load sensing valve with the clip.
5. Install valve bracket.
(a) Install the set plate to the valve assembly through the valve bracket and temporarily tighten the
2 valve body mounting nuts. (b) Torque the bolt and nut with the 2 plate washers.
Torque: 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
Page 2506
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4161
11. Inspect tooth contact between ring gear and drive pinion.
a. Coat 3 or 4 teeth at 3 different positions on the ring gear with red lead. b. Hold the companion
flange firmly and rotate the ring gear in both directions.
c. Inspect the tooth pattern. If the teeth are not contacting properly, use the following chart to select
a proper washer for correction.
Thickness:
1.70 mm (0.0669 inch) 1.73 mm (0.0681 inch) 1.76 mm (0.0693 inch) 1.79 mm (0.0705 inch) 1.82
mm (0.0717 inch) 1.85 mm (0.0728 inch) 1.88 mm (0.0740 inch) 1.91 mm (0.0752 inch) 1.94 mm
(0.0764 inch) 1.97 mm (0.0776 inch) 2.00 mm (0.0787 inch) 2.03 mm (0.0799 inch) 2.06 mm
(0.0811 inch) 2.09 mm (0.0823 inch) 2.12 mm (0.0835 inch) 2.15 mm (0.0846 inch) 2.18 mm
(0.0858 inch) 2.21 mm (0.0870 inch) 2.24 mm (0.0882 inch) 2.27 mm (0.0894 inch) 2.30 mm
(0.0906 inch) 2.33 mm (0.0917 inch)
12. Remove companion flange. 13. Remove oil slinger and front bearing. 14. Install bearing spacer
and front bearing.
a. Place a new bearing spacer on the shaft. b. Place the front bearing and oil slinger.
Service Precautions
Fuel Pressure Release: Service Precautions
WARNING: Adhere to the following procedures any time the fuel system is being worked on in
order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury:
- Keep a dry chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher near the work area.
- Place a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the work area.
- Work in a well-ventilated area. Do not smoke, and keep sparks and open flames away.
- Wear eye protection.
- Use caution when working near the catalytic converter to prevent the possibility of burns or fire.
(The temperatures within the converter can exceed 537°C (1000°F).)
- Relieve the fuel system pressure prior to disconnecting fuel system components.
- Disconnect the negative battery cable except for tests where battery voltage is required.
- Use a suitable container to store or catch fuel.
- Do not replace fuel pipe with fuel hose.
- Plug all disconnected fuel line fittings and hoses.
- After making any fuel system repairs ALWAYS inspect for fuel leaks.
- If available, use system bleed (schrader) valve to relieve fuel system pressure.
Page 4148
Maximum vertical runout: 0.09 mm (0.0035 inch) Maximum lateral runout: 0.09 mm (0.0035 inch) If
the runout is not within the specification, replace the companion flange.
2. Check ring gear runout. Using a dial indicator, measure the ring gear runout.
Maximum runout: 0.05 mm (0.0020 inch) If the runout is not within the specification, replace the
ring gear.
3. Check ring gear backlash. Using a dial indicator, measure the ring gear backlash.
Backlash: 0.13 - 0.18 mm (0.0051 - 0.0071 inch)
If the backlash is not within the specification, adjust the side bearing preload or repair as
necessary.
4. Check tooth contact between ring gear and drive pinion.
5. Check side gear backlash. Measure the side gear backlash with holding one pinion gear toward
the case.
Backlash: 0.05 - 0.20 mm (0.0020 - 0.0079 inch)
Page 3017
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 789
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2383
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 645
Page 93
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 2927
Page 1993
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 1323
Torque:
1st pass: 61 Nm (45 ft. lbs.) 2nd pass: Turn additional 90°
CAUTION: Do not turn the crankshaft.
(i) Remove the 8 bolts and main bearing cap. (See procedure (a) and (b) above).
(j) Measure the Plastigage at its widest point. Standard clearance:
No. 1:
STD: 0.020 - 0.038 mm (0.0008 - 0.0015 inch) U/S 0.25: 0.019 - 0.059 mm (0.0007 - 0.0023 inch)
Others:
STD: 0.024 - 0.042 mm (0.0009 - 0.0017 inch) U/S 0.25: 0.023 - 0.063 mm (0.0009 - 0.0025 inch)
Maximum clearance: 0.08 mm (0.0031 inch)
NOTE: If replacing the cylinder block subassembly, the bearing standard clearance will be: No. 1:
0.010 - 0.049 mm (0.0004 - 0.0020 inch) Others: 0.014 - 0.053 mm (0.0006 - 0.0021 inch)
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the bearings. If necessary, grind or
replace the crankshaft.
Page 2694
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer's complaint.
Page 2845
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 559
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 167
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
EFI MAIN RELAY INSPECTION
1. REMOVE EFI MAIN RELAY (Marking: EFI) 2. INSPECT EFI MAIN RELAY
A. Inspect relay continuity
(a) Using an ohmmeter. check that there is continuity between terminals 1 and 2.
If there is no continuity. replace the relay.
(b) Check that there is no continuity between terminals and 5.
If there is continuity. replace the relay.
B. Inspect relay operation
(a) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 1 and 2. (b) Using an ohmmeter, check that
there is continuity between terminals 3 and 5.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
3. REINSTALL EFI MAIN RELAY
Page 2377
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER INSPECTION
1. INSPECT MAF METER RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals THA and E2.
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the MAF meter.
2. INSPECT MAF METER OPERATION
(a) Connect the MAF meter connector.
(b) Using a voltmeter, connect the positive (+) tester probe to terminal VG and negative (-) tester
probe to terminal E3. (c) Blow air into the MAF meter and check that the voltage fluctuates.
If operation is not as specified. replace the MAF meter.
(d) Disconnect the MAF meter connector.
Specifications
Air Bag Control Module: Specifications
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Airbag Sensor Assembly......................................................................................................................
.................................................. 21 Nm (15 ft. lb.)
Testing and Inspection
PCV Valve Hose: Testing and Inspection
PCV HOSES AND CONNECTORS INSPECTION VISUALLY INSPECT HOSES, CONNECTIONS
AND GASKETS
Check for cracks, leaks or damage.
Page 715
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4035
Valve Body: Specifications Tightening Specifications
Upper valve body x Lower valve body
................................................................................................................................................ 6.4 Nm
(56 inch lbs.) Solenoid x Valve body ...................................................................................................
............................................................................ 10 Nm (7 ft. lbs.) Oil strainer x Valve body .............
..............................................................................................................................................................
. 10 Nm (7 ft. lbs.) Detent spring x Valve body ....................................................................................
.................................................................................... 10 Nm (7 ft. lbs.) Valve body x Transmission
case .....................................................................................................................................................
............ 10 Nm (7 ft. lbs.)
Page 4491
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2263
Page 2495
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Crankshaft Sensor to Oil Pump 69 in.lb
Page 489
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 3464
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Locations
Shift Interlock Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 2782
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
System Schematic
Sensor Cut-Away
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The mass air flow meter uses a platinum hot wire. The hot wire air flow meter consists of a
platinum hot wire, thermistor and a control circuit installed in a plastic housing. The hot wire air flow
meter works on the principle that the hot wire and thermistor located in the intake air bypass of the
housing detect any changes in the intake air temperature. The hot wire is maintained at the set
temperature by controlling the current flow through the hot wire. This current flow is then measured
as the output voltage of the air flow meter. The circuit is constructed so that the platinum hot wire
and thermistor provide a bridge circuit, with the power transistor controlled so that the potential of
(A) and (B) remains equal to maintain the set temperature.
Testing and Inspection
Parking Brake Warning Switch: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE SWITCH CONTINUITY
1. Check that there is continuity between terminals with the switch ON (switch pin released). 2.
Check that there is no continuity between terminals with the switch OFF (switch pin pushed in).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
Page 2901
Components For Removal And Installation Part 2 Of 2
Page 198
Page 1925
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 139
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 319
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 1884
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Specifications
Valve Guide Seal: Specifications
DIMENSIONS
Inside Diameter
.................................................................................................................................................. 6.010
- 6.030 mm (0.2366 - 0.2374 inch) Outside Diameter For Repair Part
STD
.........................................................................................................................................................
11.033 - 11.044 mm (0.4344 - 0.4348 inch) O/S 0.05
.................................................................................................................................................. 11.083
- 11.094 mm (0.4363 - 0.4368 inch)
Page 2734
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 831
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Specifications
Exhaust Pipe: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Exhaust Crossover Pipe To Exhaust Manifold
............................................................................................................................... 45 Nm (33 ft. lbs.)
Front Pipe To Exhaust Crossover Pipe
........................................................................................................................................... 48 Nm (35
ft. lbs.) Front Exhaust Pipe Support Bracket To
Front Pipe ............................................................................................................................................
..................................... 44 Nm (33 ft. lbs.) Transmission ....................................................................
......................................................................................................... 44 Nm (33 ft. lbs.)
Locations
ECT Temperature Sender Gauge / Low Oil Pressure Warning Switch
Testing and Inspection
Turn Signal Switch: Testing and Inspection
TURN SIGNAL SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT SWITCH CONTINUITY
Reference
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Page 1694
5. Before installing the radiator cap tester, use the applicable radiator cap adaptor provided in the
following SST kits in conjunction with the radiator cap tester:
^ SST P/N 09230-00030-01 (09231-10080-01) or 09230-00020-01 (09231-10060-01) or
09230-00050-01 (09231-10110-01
6. When using the radiator cap tester, tilt it more than 30 degrees.
7. Pump the radiator cap tester several times, and check the maximum pressure.
Pumping speed: 1 pump/second
HINT:
Stop pumping when the valve opens and read the gauge. The gauge must be within the standard
values listed below when the pressure valve opens. The cap is considered OK when the pressure
holds steady or falls very slowly, but holds within the standard values listed below for one minute.
Specification:
If the maximum pressure is less than the minimum standard value, replace the radiator cap
sub-assembly.
Type: N-cap, 108 kPa
Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2955
Page 629
Applicable Vehicles
Page 3219
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 1645
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 2659
Page 1109
C. Transfer the Pressure Switch.
a. Remove Pressure Switch from Liquid Tube.
b. Using the new O-Ring (P/N 90099-14122) install the Pressure Switch to new Liquid and Suction
Tube Assembly.
Tightening Torque:
7.2 ft/lbf (9.8 N.m, 100 Kgf/cm)
CAUTION:
Use double wrenches when removing or installing the pressure switch.
NOTE:
Lubricate new O-Ring with 134a Compressor oil.
D. Assemble in reverse order.
2. Replacement of Suction Hose:
Tightening Torque:
Page 2435
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2109
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Throttle Valve Angle Specifications
Throttle Body: Specifications Throttle Angle Specifications
Throttle Angle Specifications
Throttle Valve Fully Closed 10 deg
Page 933
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 2183
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2654
A/F and 02 Sensor Identification
Page 1461
Oil grade:
API grade SH, Energy-Conserving II multigrade engine oil or ILSAC multigrade engine oil.
Recommended viscosity is as shown in the illustration with SAE 5W-30 being the preferred engine
oil.
Oil capacity:
Drain and refill
w/o Oil filter change: 4.9 liters (5.2 US qts.) w/ Oil filter change: 5.2 liters (5.5 US qts.)
Dry fill: 5.9 Liters (6.2 US qts.)
(c) Reinstall the oil filler cap.
4. Start engine and check for oil leaks. 5. Check engine oil level.
Specifications
Clutch Switch: Specifications
Clutch Start Switch:
On-Off Stroke ......................................................................................................................................
.......................... 8 +/- 0.5 mm (0.31 +/- 0.20 inch)
Page 4494
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 661
CHART 21
Page 376
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Locations
Actuator Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 4006
Page 3012
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor Location
Electrical Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Electrical Specifications
Resistance 10 - 20 K ohms at -4 deg F
4 - 7 K ohms at 32 deg F
2 - 3 K ohms at 68 deg F
0.9 - 1.3 K ohms at 104 deg F
0.4 - 0.7 K ohms at 140 deg F
0.2 - 0.4 K ohms at 176 deg F
Page 2992
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 3213
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Axle Shaft, Conventional Fixed/Floating
Axle Shaft: Diagrams Axle Shaft, Conventional Fixed/Floating
Rear Axle Shaft (1 Of 2)
Specifications
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Knock Sensor to Cylinder Block 29 ft.lb
Page 4232
Rear Axle Shaft (2 Of 2)
Page 2177
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2079
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 1015
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
PRECAUTION
1. BEFORE WORKING ON FUEL SYSTEM, DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (-) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
HINT: Any diagnostic trouble code retained by the computer will be erased when the negative (-)
terminal cable is removed from the battery. Therefore, if necessary, read the diagnosis before
removing the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery.
2. DO NOT SMOKE OR WORK NEAR AN OPEN FLAME WHEN WORKING ON FUEL SYSTEM
FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE PROCEDURE
WHEN DISCONNECTING THE HIGH FUEL PRESSURE LINE, A LARGE AMOUNT OF
GASOLINE WILL SPILL OUT, SO OBSERVE THESE PROCEDURES:
(1) Disconnect the fuel pump connector. (2) Start the engine. After the engine has stopped on its
own, turn the ignition switch to LOCK.
(3) Put a container under the connection. (4) Slowly loosen the connection. (5) Disconnect the
connection. (6) Plug the connection with a rubber plug.
WHEN CONNECTING THE FLARE NUT OR UNION BOLT ON THE HIGH PRESSURE PIPE
UNION, OBSERVE THESE PROCEDURES:
Union Bolt Type:
- Always use 2 new gaskets.
- Tighten the union bolt by hand.
- Tighten the union bolt to the specified torque.
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf)
Flare Nut Type: Apply a light coat of engine oil to the flare nut and tighten the flare nut by hand.
Page 2141
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 589
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2351
Adjusting Shim Selection Chart (Intake)
Page 2247
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 1466
Oil Cooler: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Drain engine coolant.
2. Disconnect oil cooler hoses.
Disconnect the No. 1 and No. 2 oil cooler hoses.
3. Remove oil cooler.
Remove the union bolt, gaskets, oil cooler and O-ring.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
NOTE: Replace the O-ring with a new part.
- Use a new gasket to the union bolt.
P/S - Pressure Feed Hose Modified
Power Steering Line/Hose: Technical Service Bulletins P/S - Pressure Feed Hose Modified
STEERING ST001-98
April 17, 1997
Title: POWER STEERING PRESSURE FEED HOSE
Models: '97 - '98 Tacoma
Introduction
The Power Steering Pressure Feed Hose for 4 cylinder Tacomas has been changed to improve
sealing effectiveness, and the surface finish (circular machining marks) of the pressure feed hose
banjo fitting has been refined.
Production Change Information
^ 1997 - 1998 Tacoma 4x2 and 4x4 vehicles with 4 cylinder engine.
MODEL ENGINE STARTING VIN
Tacoma 4x2 and 4x4 2RZ-FE and 3RZ-FE 4TA******WZ047962
Required Tools & Materials
TOOLS & MATERIALS QUANTITY
24 mm Open End Wrench 1
Torque Wrench with 24 mm socket 1
Power Steering Fluid (Automatic Transmission Fluid Dextron II or III) 1
Parts Information
CURRENT PART NUMBER PART NAME APPLICATION
44411-04010 Hose, Pressure Feed (4x2) 9609 - 9706
44411-04020 Hose, Pressure Feed (4x2) 9706-Present
44411-04030 Hose, Pressure Feed (4x4) 9706-Present (MTM)
44411-04040 Hose, Pressure Feed (4x4) 9706-Present (ATM)
90430-16242 Gasket, Pressure Feed All
Warranty Information
Applicable Warranty:
This repair Is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect for 36 months or
36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in-service date,
Diagram Information and Instructions
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 3085
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Locations
Daytime Running Lamp Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 2590
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 3896
P 1 PARK/NEUTRAL POSITION SW
4-Ground: Approx. 12 Volts with ignition SW ON position
O 4-B, S 4-A O/D MAIN SW
A-5-A-10, B-1-B-3: Open with O/D main SW at ON position Open with O/D main SW at OFF
position
S 5-A, B STOP LIGHT SW
A-1-A-2, B-1-B-2: Closed with Brake Pedal Depressed
E 5-A, E 6-D, E 7-C, E 8-B ENGINE CONTROL MODULE
S1-E1: 9-14 Volts
S2, SL-E1: 0-1.5 Volts
BK-E1: 7.5-14 Volts with Brake Pedal Depressed 0-1.5 Volts with Brake Pedal Released
THW-E2: 0.2-1.0 Volts with Coolant Temp. 80° C (176° F)
OIL-E2: 4-5 Volts with fluid Temp. 20° C (68° F)
IDL-E2:
0-3 Volts with Throttle Valve fully closed 9-14 Volts with Throttle Valve open
VTA-E2: 0.3-0.8 Volts with Throttle Valve fully closed 3.2-4.9 Volts with Throttle Valve fully open
VCC-E2: 4.5-5.5 Volts
OD1-E1: 4.5-5.5 Volts
OD2-E1: 9-14 Volts O/D main SW turned ON 0 Volts O/D main SW turned OFF
SP1-E1: Pulse Generation with vehicle moving
2-E1: 10-14 Volts with Shift Lever at 2 position 0-2 Volts with shift lever at expect 2 position
L-E1: 10-14 Volts with Shift Lever at L position 0-2 Volts with Shift Lever at expect L position
L4-E1: 10-14 Volts with Transfer Shift at H2 or H4 position 0 Volts with Transfer shift at L4 position
OIL-W-E1: 0.1-4.9 Volts
+B-E1: 9-14 Volts
BATT-E1: 9-14 Volts
Splice Points
Splice Points
Page 3690
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 641
A. The Diagnostic Tester displays 17" as a value of the Time $81" (see illustration).
B. Find the Conversion Factor value of Time $81" in the O2S Failure Threshold chart. 0.3906 is
specified for Time $81 in this chart.
C. Multiply "17" in step "A" by 0.3906 (Conversion Factor) in step "B."
17 x 0.3906 = 6.6%
D. If the answer is within the Standard Value of TEST LIMIT, the Time $81" can be confirmed to be
normal.
NOTE:
^ "LOW SW V" indicates the O2S voltage when the O2S status changes from rich to lean.
^ "HIGH SW V" indicates the O2S voltage when the O2S status changes from lean to rich.
^ If the O2S voltage is lower than "LOW SW V," the O2S status is lean.
^ If the O2S voltage is higher than "HIGH SW V," the O2S status is rich.
NOTE:
Before the O2S Monitor completes or after the ignition switch is turned OFF, the Diagnostic Tester
displays the viewable upper limit or a lower limit of the test value (example: 0 V, 1.275 V, Os
[seconds], 10.2s, 0 and 255).
Page 3662
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3022
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 2226
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2578
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 3467
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The throttle position sensor is mounted in the throttle body and detects the throttle valve opening
angle. When the throttle valve is fully closed, a voltage of approximately 0.7 V is applied to terminal
VTA of the ECM. The voltage applied to the terminals VTA of the ECM increases in proportion to
the opening angle of the throttle valve and becomes approximately 2.7 ~ 5.2 V when the throttle
valve is fully opened. The ECM judges the vehicle driving conditions from these signals input from
terminals VTA and uses them as one of the conditions for deciding the air-fuel ratio correction,
power increase correction and fuel-cut control etc.
Specifications
Brake Fluid: Specifications
Required Brake Fluid SAE DOT3
Page 2283
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2366
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2206
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 3454
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 1219
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 4117
INSPECTION
1. Check runout of companion flange. Using a dial indicator, measure the vertical and lateral runout
of the companion flange. If the runout is greater
than the maximum, replace the companion flange.
Maximum runout: 0.10 mm (0.0039 inch)
2. Check ring gear backlash. Using SST 09564-32011 and a dial indicator, measure the ring gear
backlash. If the backlash is not within the
specification, adjust the side bearing preload or repair as necessary.
Backlash: 0.13 - 0.18 mm (0.0051 - 0.0071 inch)
3. Measure drive pinion preload. Using a torque wrench, measure the preload of backlash between
the drive pinion and ring gear.
Preload (at starting): 0.6 - 1.0 Nm (5.2 - 8.7 inch lbs.)
4. Check total preload. Using a torque wrench, measure the preload with the teeth of the drive
pinion and ring gear in contact. If necessary,
disassemble and inspect the differential.
Total preload (at starting):
Drive pinion preload plus 0.4 - 0.6 Nm (3.5 - 5.2 inch lbs.)
Page 2849
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Diagram Information and Instructions
Knock Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Locations
Page 1066
Alternately loosen the 2 bolts and remove them, then remove the belt tensioner and dust boot.
21. Remove timing belt. 22. Remove RH camshaft timing pulley.
(a) Using SST Variable Pin Wrench Set # 09960 - 10010 (Variable Pin Wrench Arm Assembly #
09962 - 01000, Pin 10 # 09963 - 01000) or equivalents, loosen the pulley bolt.
(b) Remove the bolt, knock pin and camshaft timing pulley with timing belt.
23. Remove LH camshaft timing pulley.
(a) Using SST Variable Pin Wrench Set # 09960 - 10010 (Variable Pin Wrench Arm Assembly #
09962 - 01000, Pin 10 # 09963 - 01000) or equivalents, loosen the pulley bolt.
(b) Remove the bolt, knock pin and camshaft timing pulley.
24. Remove No. 2 idler pulley.
Remove the bolt and No. 2 idler pulley.
25. Remove No. 1 idler pulley.
Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, remove the pivot bolt, No. 1 idler pulley and plate washer.
26. Remove crankshaft timing pulley.
NOTE: If the pulley cannot be removed by hand, use SST Puller C Set # 09950 - 50010 (Hanger
150 # 09551 - 05010, Slide Arm # 09552 -
Page 2888
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 4328
^ Torque the bolts to the specification found in the applicable Repair Manual.
NOTE
In most applications there will be 1 black torque converter bolt, be sure to install this bolt first to aid
in aligning the torque converter to the flywheel assembly.
Page 624
8. REMOVE KNOCK SENSORS
Using SST. remove the knock sensor. SST 09817-16011
KNOCK SENSOR INSTALLATION
1. REINSTALL KNOCK SENSORS
Using SST, install the knock sensor. SST 09817-16011
Torque: 39 N.m (400 kgf.cm. 29 ft.lbf)
2. REINSTALL WATER BYPASS PIPE AND KNOCK SENSOR WIRE 3. REINSTALL INTAKE
MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY 4. REINSTALL FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR 5. REINSTALL
HIGH-TENSION CORDS WITH IGNITION COILS 6. REINSTALL INTAKE AIR CONNECTOR 7.
REINSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE 8. REFILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT 9. RECHECK ENGINE
COOLANT LEVEL
Page 3496
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 4793
- There are no foreign objects on the sensor or the part of the knuckle to which the sensor is to be
installed.
- The sensor is installed flat against the knuckle when you tighten the bolt.
- When installing the resin clips, use new ones.
Page 1672
Heater Core: Testing and Inspection
HEATER RADIATOR INSPECTION
INSPECT FINS FOR BLOCKAGE
If the fins are clogged, clean them with compressed air.
Page 4848
Warranty Information
NOTE:
Replacement of the front brake pad kit and/or shims is limited to correction of a problem based
upon a customer's complaint and subject to all of the provisions of Toyota Warranty Policy Bulletin
POL94-18, dated October 10, 1994.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Shift Indicator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness
Location Of Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness, Ground Points (Fig 32)
Page 1750
(c) Install the water pump with the 7 bolts. Torque: 20 Nm (14 ft. lbs.)
2. Connect No. 2 oil cooler hose. 3. Install thermostat and water inlet. 4. Install timing belt. Refer to
Engine.
Page 2925
^ O2S TEST RESULTS
A list of the available oxygen sensors will be displayed.
2. Select the desired oxygen sensor and press Enter.
NOTE:
The monitor result of the A/F sensor will not be displayed. If you select "Bank 1-Sensor 1" or Bank
2-Sensor 1" for a vehicle equipped with an A/F sensor, the Diagnostic Tester will display "No
parameter to display."
3. Compare the test results with the values listed in the Failure Threshold Chart.
* Although this procedure references the Toyota Diagnostic Tester, the O2S test results can be
checked using a generic OBD II scantool. Refer to your OBD II scantool operator's manual for
specific procedures.
Comparing O2S Test Results to Failure Thresholds
1. Determine the correct O2S Failure Threshold Chart for your vehicle by looking in the "O2S
Application Table," in this bulletin.
2. Select appropriate year, model, and engine for specified O2S Failure Threshold Chart.
3. Compare O2S test results with the specified O2S Failure Threshold Chart. It may be necessary
to convert O2S test results to a specific measurement unit using the conversion factor that is
supplied in the specified table. See example.
Example:
Page 125
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 2365
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 2942
CHART 16
CHART 17
Locations
One Touch 2-4 Selector System
Page 1390
Valve Seat: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT AND CLEAN VALVE SEATS
1. Using a 45° carbide cutter, resurface the valve seats. Remove only enough metal to clean the
seats.
2. Check the valve seating position.
Apply a thin coat of prussian blue (or white lead) to the valve face. Lightly press the valve against
the seat. Do not rotate the valve.
3. Check the valve face and seat for the following:
- If blue appears 360° around the face, the valve is concentric. If not, replace the valve.
- If blue appears 360° around the valve seat, the guide and face are concentric. If not, resurface the
seat.
- Check that the seat contact is in the middle of the valve face with these widths: 1.0 - 1.4 mm
(0.039 - 0.055 inch)
If not, correct the valve seats as follows:
(a) If the seating is too high on the valve face, use 30° and 45° cutters to correct the seat.
(b) If the seating is too low on the valve face, use 60° and 45° cutters to correct the seat.
Page 3949
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4720
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2287
Knock Sensor: Exploded Views
Components For Removal And Installation Part 1 Of 2
Page 4680
Electronically Controlled Transmission And A/T Indicator-Connectors
Page 4265
9. Replace oil seal (inner side).
a. Using SST 09308-00010, remove the oil seal.
b. Using SST 09950-60020 (09951-00710), 09950-70010 (09951-07150), install a new oil seal. c.
Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
10. install rear axle shaft in backing plate.
a. Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip. b. Install the backing plate and bearing retainer on the rear
axle shaft.
c. Using SST and a press, install the rear axle shaft into the backing plate. d. Using snap ring
pliers, install a new snap ring.
11. w/ ABS: Install ABS speed sensor rotor and bearing retainer (differential side). Using SST
09316-60011 (09316-00051) and a press, install a new
sensor rotor and new bearing retainer to the axle shaft.
Standard length: 122.2 ±1.0 mm (4.811 ±0.039 inch)
Hub Bolt Removal and Installation
Specifications
Exhaust Manifold: Specifications
DIMENSIONS
Warpage (Maximum) ...........................................................................................................................
.................................... 1.00 mm (0.0394 inch)
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Exhaust Manifold To Cylinder Head
.............................................................................................................................................. 40 Nm
(30 ft. lbs.)
Page 2906
Knock Sensor: Oscilloscope Patterns and Waveforms
Page 2997
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2058
CHART 25
Page 1098
TOY 730 - 73mm Toyota Oil Filter Wrench
M 0219 - 74mm Oil Filter Wrench
Page 3319
(b) Using SST, tighten the flare nut to specified torque. SST 09631-22020
NOTICE: Do not rotate the fuel pipe, when tightening the flare nut.
Torque:
34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf) 28 N.m (285 kgf.cm, 21 ft.lbf) for using SST
HINT: Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 30 cm (11.81 in.).
3. Observe these precautions when removing and installing the injectors.
(a) Never reuse the O-ring. (b) When placing a new O-ring on the injector, take care not to damage
it in any way. (c) Coat a new O-ring with spindle oil or gasoline before installing-never use engine,
gear or brake oil.
4. Install the injector to the delivery pipe and intake manifold, as shown in the illustration. 5. Check
that there are no fuel leaks after doing maintenance anywhere on the fuel system.
(a) Connect the TOYOTA hand-held tester to the DLC3. (b) Turn the ignition switch ON and push
TOYOTA hand-held tester main switch ON.
NOTICE: Do not start the engine.
Page 1546
(a) Turn the crankshaft, and align the timing marks of the crankshaft timing pulley and oil pump
body.
CAUTION: Always turn the crankshaft clockwise.
(b) Check that the timing marks of the RH and LH timing pulleys with the timing marks of the No. 3
timing belt cover as shown in the
illustration. If the marks do not align, remove the timing belt and reinstall it.
(c) Remove the crankshaft pulley bolt.
11. Install timing belt guide.
Install the guide, facing the cup side outward.
12. Install No. 1 timing belt cover and starter wire bracket.
(a) Check that the timing belt cover gaskets has no cracks or peeling, etc. If the gasket has cracks
or peeling, etc., replace it using these steps: ^
Using a screwdriver and gasket scraper, remove all the old gasket material.
^ Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the loose material.
No. 1 Cover (Back)
^ Remove the backing paper from a new gasket and install the gasket evenly to the part of the
timing belt cover shaded black in the illustration.
(b) Install the timing belt cover with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.)
Page 4218
Torque:
2RZ-FE: 108 Nm (1,100 kgf-cm, 80 ft. lbs.) 3RZ-FE, 5VZ-FE w/o Diff. lock: 147 Nm (1,500 kgf-cm,
109 ft. lbs.) 3RZ-FE, 5VZ-FE w/ Diff. lock: 196 Nm (2,000 kgf-cm, 145 ft. lbs.)
14. ADJUST DRIVE PINION PRELOAD 15. STAKE DRIVE PINION NUT 16. CONNECT REAR
PROPELLER SHAFT
17. FILL DIFFERENTIAL WITH HYPOID GEAR OIL
Torque: 49 Nm (500 kgf-cm, 39 ft. lbs.)
Oil type: Hypoid gear oil API GL-5 Recommended oil viscosity:
Above - 18°C (O°F) SAE 90 Below - 18°C (0°F) SAE 80W or 80W - 90
Capacity
Page 563
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2232
Page 2920
Page 2717
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
Sensor Cut-Away
Reference
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
To obtain a high purification rate for the CO, HC and NOx components of the exhaust gas, a
three-way catalytic converter is used, but for the most efficient use of the three-way catalytic
converter, the air-fuel ratio must be precisely controlled so that it is always close to the
stoichiometric air-fuel ratio.
The oxygen sensor has the characteristic whereby its output voltage changes suddenly in the
vicinity of the stoichiometric air-fuel ratio. This characteristic is used to detect the oxygen
concentration in the exhaust gas and provide feedback to the computer for control of the air-fuel
ratio.
When the air-fuel ratio becomes LEAN, the oxygen concentration in the exhaust increases and the
oxygen sensor informs the ECM of the LEAN condition (small electromotive force: 0 V).
When the air-fuel ratio is RICHER than the stoichiometric air-fuel ratio the oxygen concentration in
the exhaust gas is reduced and the oxygen sensor informs the ECM of the RICH condition (large
electromotive force: 1 V).
The ECM judges by the electromotive force from the oxygen sensor whether the air-fuel ratio is
RICH or LEAN and controls the injection time accordingly. However, if malfunction of the oxygen
sensor causes output of abnormal electromotive force, the ECM is unable to perform accurate
air-fuel ratio control.
The heated oxygen sensors include a heater which heats the Zirconia element. The heater is
controlled by the ECM. When the intake air volume is low (the temperature of the exhaust gas is
low) current flows to the heater to heat the sensor for accurate oxygen concentration detection.
Page 1324
NOTE: If using a standard bearing, replace with one having the same number. If the number of the
bearing cannot be determined, select the correct bearing by adding together the numbers imprinted
on the cylinder block and crankshaft, then selecting the bearing with the same number as the total.
There are 5 sizes of standard bearings, marked "1", "2", "3", "4", and "5" accordingly.
Reference: Standard sized bearing center wall thickness:
No. 1:
Mark "1": 1.991 - 1.994 mm (0.0784 - 0.0785 inch) Mark "2": 1.994 - 1.997 mm (0.0785 - 0.0786
inch) Mark "3": 1.997 - 2.000 mm (0.0786 - 0.0787 inch) Mark "4": 2.000 - 2.003 mm (0.0787 0.0789 inch) Mark "5": 2.003 - 2.006 mm (0.0789 - 0.0790 inch)
Others:
Mark "1": 1.989 - 1.992 mm (0.0783 - 0.0784 inch) Mark "2": 1.992 - 1.995 mm (0.0784 - 0.0785
inch) Mark "3": 1.995 - 1.998 mm (0.0785 - 0.0787 inch) Mark "4": 1.998 - 2.001 mm (0.0787 0.0788 inch) Mark "5": 2.001 - 2.004 mm (0.0788 - 0.0789 inch)
Cylinder block Main journal bore diameter:
Mark "1": 68.010 - 68.016 mm (2.6776 - 2.6778 inch) Mark "2": 68.016 - 68.022 mm (2.6778 2.6780 inch) Mark "3": 68.022 - 68.028 mm (2.6780 - 2.6783 inch)
Crankshaft main journal diameter:
Mark "O": 63.996 - 64.000 mm (2.5195 - 2.5197 inch) Mark "1": 63.990 - 63.996 mm (2.5193 2.5195 inch) Mark "2": 63.985 - 63.990 mm (2.5191 - 2.5193 inch)
(k) Completely remove the Plastigage.
Page 2154
Torque: 5.4 Nm (55 kgf-cm, 48 inch lbs.)
8. CONNECT NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
Page 762
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
ON-VEHICLE REPAIR
1 DISCONNECT NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
2. REMOVE NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
a. Remove the bolt and No.1 vehicle speed sensor assembly. b. Remove the speedometer driven
gear and O-ring from the No.1 vehicle speed sensor.
3. INSTALL NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR ASSEMBLY
a. Coat a new O-ring with ATF. b. Install the O-ring and speedometer driven gear to the No.1
vehicle speed sensor. c. Install the No.1 vehicle speed sensor to the extension housing and torque
the bolt.
Torque: 16 Nm (160 kgf-cm, 12 ft. lbs.)
4. CONNECT NO.1 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR 5. DISCONNECT NO.2 VEHICLE
SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
6. REMOVE NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
a. Remove the bolt and No.2 vehicle speed sensor. b. Remove the O-ring from the No.2 vehicle
speed sensor.
7. INSTALL NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR
a. Coat a new O-ring with ATF and install it to the No.2 vehicle speed sensor. b. Install the No.2
vehicle speed sensor and torque the bolt.
Power Window Switch / Master Switch
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Window Switch / Master Switch
INSPECT POWER WINDOW MASTER SWITCH CONTINUITY
Driver's Switch / Window Unlock
Driver's switch: Window unlock
Driver's Switch / Window Lock
Driver's switch: Window lock
Passenger's Switch / Window Unlock
Passenger's switch: Window unlock
Passenger's Switch / Window Lock
Passenger's switch: Window lock
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
Testing and Inspection
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
Inspect shift lock solenoid.
a. Disconnect the solenoid connector. b. Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance at each
terminal.
Standard Resistance 20-28 ohms.
If resistance value is not as specified. Replace the solenoid.
c. Apply battery positive voltage at each terminal. At this time, confirm that the solenoid operates. If
the solenoid does not operate, replace the
solenoid.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2330
Page 4157
b. Using a dial indicator, check the ring gear runout.
Maximum runout: 0.10 mm (0.0039 inch)
c. Remove the differential case.
5. Install new oil strange ring and drive pinion front and rear bearing outer races.
a. Using SST 09316-60011 (09316-00011, 09316-00021) and a hammer, install new oil storage
ring.
b. Using SST 09316-60011 (09316-00011, 09316-00021, 09316-00051) and a press, install the
outer races.
6. Install drive pinion front bearing.
a. Install the plate washer on the drive pinion. b. Using SST 09506-30012 and a press, install the
rear bearing onto the drive pinion.
7. Temporarily adjust drive pinion preload.
a. Install the drive pinion, front bearing and oil slinger.
HINT: Assemble the spacer and oil seal After adjusting the gear contact pattern.
b. Install the companion flange with SST 09950-30010 (09951-03010, 09953-03010, 09954-03010,
09955-03030, 09956-03020).
Page 3786
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 2431
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Specifications
Radiator: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Radiator Support To Body
...........................................................................................................................................................
12 Nm (107 in. lbs.)
Page 2348
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
INSPECTION
HINT: Inspect and adjust the valve clearance when the engine is cold.
1. REMOVE INTAKE AIR CONNECTOR 2. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVERS 3. SET NO.1
CYLINDER TO TDC/COMPRESSION
a. Turn the crankshaft pulley, and align its groove with the timing mark "0" of the No.1 timing belt
cover.
b. Check that the timing marks (1 dot) of the camshaft drive and driven gears are in straight line on
the cylinder heads surface as shown in the
illustration. If not, turn the crankshaft 1 revolution (360°) and align the marks.
4. INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE
a. Check only those valves indicated in the illustration.
1. Using a thickness gauge, measure the clearance between the valve lifter and camshaft.
Valve Clearance (Cold):
2. Record out of specification valve clearance measurements. They will be used later to determine
the required replacement adjusting shim.
Page 1040
6. ADJUST ELECTRODE GAP
Carefully bend the outer electrode to obtain the correct electrode gap.
Correct electrode gap: 1.1 mm (0.043 in.)
7. REINSTALL SPARK PLUGS
Torque: 18 N.m (180 kgf.cm, 13 ft.lbf)
8. REINSTALL IGNITION COILS 9. RECONNECT HIGH-TENSION CORDS
Page 323
Inspection Procedure / Stop Light Switch Circuit (2 Of 4)
Inspection Procedure / Stop Light Switch Circuit (3 Of 4)
Standard Value of ECM Terminals
Engine Control Module: Testing and Inspection Standard Value of ECM Terminals
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 1 Of 2
Page 3226
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER INSPECTION
1. INSPECT MAF METER RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals THA and E2.
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the MAF meter.
2. INSPECT MAF METER OPERATION
(a) Connect the MAF meter connector.
(b) Using a voltmeter, connect the positive (+) tester probe to terminal VG and negative (-) tester
probe to terminal E3. (c) Blow air into the MAF meter and check that the voltage fluctuates.
If operation is not as specified. replace the MAF meter.
(d) Disconnect the MAF meter connector.
Page 4176
c. Using SST 09330-00021 to hold the flange, torque the nut.
Torque to 147 Nm (109 ft lbs.)
19. Adjust drive pinion preload. Using a torque wrench, measure the preload of the backlash
between the drive pinion and ring gear.
Preload (at starting):
New bearing: 1.1 - 1.7 Nm (10.0 - 15.2 inch lbs.) Reused bearing: 0.6 - 0.9 Nm (5.7 - 8.3 inch lbs.)
If the preload is greater than the specification, replace the bearing spacer.
If the preload is less than the specification, retighten the nut 13 Nm (9 ft. lbs.) a little at a time until
the specified preload is reached.
Maximum torque: 451 Nm (333 ft. lbs.)
If the maximum torque is exceeded while retightening the nut, replace the bearing spacer and
repeat the preload procedure. Do not back off the pinion nut to reduce the preload.
20. Check total preload. Using a torque wrench, measure the preload with the teeth of the drive
pinion and ring gear in contact.
Total preload (at starting): Drive pinion preload plus: 0.4 - 0.6 Nm (3.5 - 5.2 inch lbs.)
21. Check ring gear backlash. Using a dial indicator, measure the ring gear backlash.
Backlash: 0.13 - 0.18 mm (0.0051 - 0.0071 inch)
22. Recheck tooth contact between ring gear and drive pinion. 23. Check runout of companion
flange. 24. Stake drive pinion nut.
With Differential Lock
1. Remove dust deflector to companion flange. Using SST 09950-00020 and a press, remove the
dust deflector.
Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Locations
Automatic Differential Disconnect (A.D.D.) Component Locations
Page 56
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Testing and Inspection
Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Inspect relay operation.
a. Jack up the vehicle. b. Use a heater main relay and connect it, as shown below. c. Rotate the
tire and check that differential lock has occurred. if operation is not as specified, replace the
actuator.
2. Inspect Diff. Lock control switch continuity. Inspect the switch continuity between terminal 1 to
terminal 4.
HINT: If it is not continuity, replace the switch.
3. Inspect Diff. Lock position switch.
a. Check that there is continuity between terminals when the switch is pushed (differential
connected position). b. Check that there is no continuity when the switch is free (differential
disconnected position).
HINT: If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
4. Inspect transfer 4WD switch. 5. Inspect vehicle speed sensor.
Page 3060
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2003
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 1532
Timing Belt: Diagrams
Page 3908
Shift Indicator: Electrical Diagrams
Electronically Controlled Transmission And A/T Indicator (Part 1 Of 3)
Page 1170
Engine Oil: Testing and Inspection Oil Pressure Check
1. Check engine oil quality.
Check the oil for deterioration, entry of water, discoloring or thinning. If the oil quality is visibly poor,
replace it.
2. Check engine oil level.
The oil level should be between the "L" and "F" marks on the dipstick. If low, check for leakage and
add oil up to the "F" mark.
3. Remove oil pressure switch.
Using Special Service Tool (SST) Oil Pressure Switch Socket # 09816 - 30010 or equivalent,
remove the oil pressure switch.
4. Install oil pressure gauge. 5. Start engine.
Allow the engine to warm up to normal operating temperature.
6. Measure oil pressure.
Oil pressure:
At idle speed: 29 kPa (4.3 psi) or more At 3,000 rpm: 245 - 520 kPa (36 - 75 psi)
7. Turn engine off. 8. Remove oil pressure gauge. 9. Install oil pressure switch.
(a) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the oil pressure switch. Adhesive: Part No. 08833 - 00080,
THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE 242 or equivalent.
(b) Using SST Oil Pressure Switch Socket # 09816 - 30010 or equivalent, install the oil pressure
switch.
10. Start engine and check for leaks.
Page 1372
1. Using a micrometer, measure the thickness of the removed shim. 2. Calculate the thickness of a
new shim so the valve clearance comes within the specified value.
T-Thickness of used shim A-Measured valve clearance N-Thickness of new shim Intake: N = T +
(A - 0.18 mm (0.007 inch)) Exhaust: N = T + (A - 0.32 mm (0.013 inch))
3. Select a new shim with a thickness as close as possible to the calculated values.
HINT: Shims are available in 17 sizes in increments of 0.050 mm (0.0020 inch), from 2.500 mm
(0.0984 inch) to 3.300 mm (0.1299 inch).
c. Install a new adjusting shim.
1. Place a new adjusting shim on the valve lifter, with imprinted numbers facing down.
2. Press down the valve lifter with SST (A), and remove SST (B).
SST 09248-55040 (09248-05410, 09248-05420)
d. Recheck the valve clearance.
6. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVERS 7. INSTALL INTAKE AIR CONNECTOR
Specifications
Accumulator: Specifications
ACCUMULATOR SPRING (A340F)
ACCUMULATOR SPRING (A343F)
Electrical Specifications
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Measure Terminals THA - E2 10 - 20 K ohms at -4 deg F
4 - 7 K ohms at 32 deg F
2 - 3 K ohms at 68 deg F
0.9 - 1.3 K ohms at 104 deg F
0.4 - 0.7 K ohms at 140 deg F
0.2 - 0.4 K ohms at 176 deg F
Page 4425
6. Remove hub sleeve No.2 assembly and 3rd gear assembly.
a. Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring. b. Using a press, remove the hub sleeve
No.2 assembly and 3rd gear assembly. c. Remove the needle roller bearing.
7. Remove shifting key and spring from hub sleeve No.2 assembly.
Using a screwdriver, remove the 3 shifting keys and 2 springs.
Page 3105
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 3128
(e) While holding port F closed, apply vacuum (2.94 kPa 22 mm Hg, 0.87 in. Hg) to port D, check
that the vacuum does not decrease when port
C is closed and check that the vacuum decreases when port C is released. If a problem is found,
replace the charcoal canister.
(f) Remove the plugs.
5. REINSTALL CHARCOAL CANISTER
Page 2821
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 4614
If the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the shift fork or clutch sleeve.
ASSEMBLY
1. Install front drive clutch sleeve onto drive sprocket.
Install the front drive clutch sleeve onto the drive sprocket.
HINT: Make sure to install the clutch sleeve in the correct direction.
2. Install drive sprocket with front drive clutch sleeve, spacer and bearing.
a. Apply gear oil to the shaft and needle roller bearing. b. Install the needle roller bearing in the
drive sprocket. c. Install the drive sprocket with the front drive clutch sleeve assembly.
d. Install the spacer to align it with the ball. e. Using SST 09316-60011 (09316-00011
,09316-00071) and a press, install a new bearing with the outer race snap ring groove toward the
rear.
3. Inspect drive sprocket thrust clearance.
Using a feeler gauge, measure the drive sprocket thrust clearance.
Standard Clearance. 0.10-0.25 mm (0.0039-0.0098 inch)
Page 3498
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 4170
HINT: First fit a washer with the same thickness as the washer which was removed, then after
checking the tooth contact pattern, replace the washer with one of a different thickness if
necessary.
6. Install drive pinion rear bearing. Using SST 09506-35010 and a press, install the rear bearing
onto the drive pinion. 7. Temporarily adjust drive pinion preload.
a. Install the drive pinion and front bearing.
HINT: Assemble the spacer, washers and oil seal after adjusting the gear contact pattern.
b. Using SST 09950-30010 (09951-03010, 09953-03010, 09954-03010, 09955-03030,
09956-03050), install the companion flange. c. Coat the threads of the nut with hypoid gear oil.
d. Adjust the drive pinion preload by tightening the companion flange nut. Using SST 09330-00021
to hold the flange, torque the nut.
NOTICE: As there is no spacer, tighten the nut a little at a time, being careful not to overtighten it.
e. Using a torque wrench, measure the preload.
Preload (at starting):
New bearing: 1.1 - 1.7 N*m (10.0 - 15.2 inch lbs.) Reused bearing: 0.6 - 0.9 Nm (5.7 - 8.3 inch lbs.)
Page 4139
f. Inspect the tooth contact pattern. If the teeth are not contacting properly, use the following chart
to select a proper washer for correction.
Washer thickness
1.69 - 1.71 mm (0.0665 - 0.0673 inch) 1.72 - 1.74 mm (0.0677 - 0.0685 inch) 1.75 - 1.77 mm
(0.0689 - 0.0697 inch) 1.78 - 1.80 mm (0.0701 - 0.0709 inch) 1.81 - 1.83 mm (0.0713 - 0.0720 inch)
1.84 - 1.86 mm (0.0724 - 0.0732 inch) 1.87 - 1.89 mm (0.0736 - 0.0744 inch) 1.90 - 1.92 mm
(0.0748 - 0.0756 inch) 1.93 - 1.95 mm (0.0760 - 0.0768 inch) 1.96 - 1.98 mm (0.0772 - 0.0780 inch)
1.99 - 2.01 mm (0.0783 - 0.0791 inch) 2.02 - 2.04 mm (0.0795 - 0.0803 inch) 2.05 - 2.07 mm
(0.0807 - 0.0815 inch) 2.08 - 2.10 mm (0.0819 - 0.0827 inch) 2.11 - 2.13 mm (0.0831 - 0.0839 inch)
2.14 - 2.16 mm (0.0843 - 0.0850 inch) 2.17 - 2.19 mm (0.0854 - 0.0862 inch) 2.20 - 2.22 mm
(0.0866 - 0.0874 inch) 2.23 - 2.25 mm (0.0878 - 0.0886 inch) 2.26 - 2.28 mm (0.0890 - 0.0898 inch)
2.29 - 2.31 mm (0.0902 - 0.0909 inch) 2.32 - 2.34 mm (0.0913 - 0.0921 inch)
14. Remove companion flange and oil slinger. 15. Remove rear bearing.
Page 3855
Overdrive Brake
Page 3511
Page 1143
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection
1. Operate vehicle, allow transmission fluid temperature to reach 158-176 °F.
2. Position vehicle on level surface, apply parking brake.
3. Allow engine to idle, depress brake pedal, then move shift lever through all positions.
4. Remove transaxle dipstick, wipe clean, then replace.
5. Remove again, then check fluid level in HOT range.
NOTICE: Do not overfill.
(a) Check the fluid condition. If the fluid smells burnt or is black, replace it.
(b) Replace the ATF.
(1) Remove the drain plug and drain the fluid. (2) Reinstall the drain plug securely.
7. On A340D units: Dry capacity is 6.9 US quarts. Drain and Refill: 2.4 Liters (2.5 US qts, 2.1 Imp.
qts.)
8. On A340E units: Dry capacity is 7.6 US quarts. Drain and Refill: 1.6 Liters (1.7 US qts, 1.4 Imp.
qts.)
9. On A340F units: Dry capacity 1996 9.3 US quarts. Dry capacity 1997-99 10.7 US quarts. Drain
and Refill: 2.0 Liters (2.1 US qts, 1.8 Imp. qts.)
10. On A340H units, dry capacity for transaxle and transfer is 10.9 US quarts.
Electrical Specifications
Oxygen Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Bank 1: Sensor 1, Terminals +B & HT 11 - 16 ohms at 68 deg F
Bank 1: Sensor 2, Terminals +B & HT 11 - 16 ohms at 68 deg F
Bank 1 Sensor 1
Bank 1 Sensor 2
Page 3769
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Diagrams
Page 3995
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 866
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Testing and Inspection
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. INSTALL MANIFOLD GAUGE SET
See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Manifold Gauge Installation/Removal
2. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR
3. DISCONNECT CONNECTOR FROM PRESSURE SWITCH
4. RUN ENGINE AT APPROX. 1,500 RPM
5. INSPECT PRESSURE SWITCH OPERATION
Check continuity between 3 and 4 terminals when refrigerant pressure is changed. as shown, in the
illustration.
If operation is not as specified, replace the pressure switch.
6. STOP ENGINE AND REMOVE MANIFOLD GAUGE SET
7. CONNECT CONNECTOR TO PRESSURE SWITCH
8. INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR
Page 2765
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
MAF Meter to Air Cleaner Cap 61 in.lb
Specifications
Fuel Supply Line: Specifications
Fuel Line (Union Bolt & Flare Nut Type) 25 ft.lb
Fuel Line (Flare Nut Type) Using/SST 21 ft.lb
Fuel Inlet Pipe to Intake Manifold 71 in.lb
Torque Specifications
Case: Specifications Torque Specifications
Overdrive support x Transmission case
.................................................................................................................................................... 25
Nm (19 ft. lbs.) Oil pan x Transmission case .......................................................................................
.......................................................................... 7.4 Nm (65 inch lbs.) Transmission housing 14 mm
bolt
............................................................................................................................................................
34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.) Transmission housing 17 mm bolt
............................................................................................................................................................
57 Nm (42 ft. lbs.) Union ......................................................................................................................
.................................................................................. 29 Nm (22 ft. lbs.) Transmission case x
Transfer adaptor
...................................................................................................................................................... 34
Nm (25 ft. lbs.) Transfer adaptor x Transfer ........................................................................................
.............................................................................. 36 Nm (27 ft. lbs.) Park/Neutral position switch ....
............................................................................................................................................................
6.9 Nm (61 inch lbs.) Park/Neutral position switch adjusting bolt
................................................................................................................................................ 13 Nm
(9 ft. lbs.) Vehicle speed sensor ..........................................................................................................
...................................................................... 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.) Control Shaft Lever .........................
....................................................................................................................................... 16 N.m (160
kgf-cm, 12 ft.lb.) Dynamic Damper ......................................................................................................
............................................................. 37 N.m (380 kgf-cm, 27 ft.lb.)
Page 2418
Step 2
Step 3
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Page 2977
Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2434
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
Intake 0.13 - 0.23 mm
Exhaust 0.27 - 0.37 mm
Page 4890
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Disassembly and Reassembly
Front Brake Components (4WD)
DISASSEMBLY
1. Remove cylinder boot set rings and boots.
Using a screwdriver, remove the 4 cylinder boot set rings and 4 boots from the caliper.
Page 2078
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 3592
Knock Sensor: Oscilloscope Patterns and Waveforms
Page 2940
CHART 14
Page 805
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 1612
1. Using a micrometer, measure the thickness of the removed shim. 2. Calculate the thickness of a
new shim so the valve clearance comes within the specified value.
T-Thickness of used shim A-Measured valve clearance N-Thickness of new shim Intake: N = T +
(A - 0.18 mm (0.007 inch)) Exhaust: N = T + (A - 0.32 mm (0.013 inch))
3. Select a new shim with a thickness as close as possible to the calculated values.
HINT: Shims are available in 17 sizes in increments of 0.050 mm (0.0020 inch), from 2.500 mm
(0.0984 inch) to 3.300 mm (0.1299 inch).
c. Install a new adjusting shim.
1. Place a new adjusting shim on the valve lifter, with imprinted numbers facing down.
2. Press down the valve lifter with SST (A), and remove SST (B).
SST 09248-55040 (09248-05410, 09248-05420)
d. Recheck the valve clearance.
6. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVERS 7. INSTALL INTAKE AIR CONNECTOR
Page 4538
Location Of Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness, Ground Points (Fig 36)
Junction Block and Wire Harness Connector
Junction Block And Wire Harness Connector
Page 2276
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 4237
Rear Axle Shaft (2 Of 2)
Page 4694
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 3396
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Knock Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Locations
Actuator Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 829
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 3084
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 590
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Removal
Piston Ring: Service and Repair Removal
1. Using a piston ring expander, remove the 2 compression rings. 2. Remove the 2 side rails and
oil ring by hand.
NOTE: Arrange the piston rings in the correct order only.
Page 939
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 81
Control Module HVAC: Service and Repair
AMPLIFIER REMOVAL
1. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR
Remove the 2 screws and the glove compartment door.
2. REMOVE A/C AMPLIFIER
a. Disconnect the connector from the amplifier. b. Remove amplifier cover. c. Remove the amplifier
from the cooling unit.
AMPLIFIER INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 334
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 756
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 4429
10. Install output shaft center bearing.
Using SST 09316-60011 (09316-00011, 09316-00071) and a hammer, drive in the bearing with the
outer race snap ring groove toward the rear.
11. Inspect 1st gear thrust clearance. 12. Inspect 2nd gear thrust clearance.
13. Install 5th gear.
Using SST 09316-60011 (09316-00031) and a press, install the 5th gear.
Page 3658
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Specifications
Drain Plug: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Plug:
Front ....................................................................................................................................................
........................................... 39 Nm (29 ft. lbs.) Rear ...........................................................................
..................................................................................................................... 49 Nm (39 ft. lbs.)
Page 931
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 2485
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 4666
Position Of Parts In Instrument Panel (1 Of 2) (Fig 28)
Drivetrain - Propeller Shaft Joint Grease/Fittings
Universal Joint: Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Propeller Shaft Joint Grease/Fittings
DRIVELINE & DIFFERENTIAL DL001-99
Title: PROPELLER SHAFT JOINT GREASE
Models: '96-'99 4Runner 4WD, '95-'99 Tacoma 4WD, '98-'99 PreRunner, & '00 Tundra 4WD
August 27, 1999
Introduction
This Service Bulletin provides the location of the grease fittings for the propeller shaft joints as well
as the type of grease to use with each fitting location. See the Scheduled Maintenance Guide of
each vehicle for recommended lubrication intervals.
Applicable Vehicles
^ 1996-1999 4Runner 4WD, 1995-1999 Tacoma 4WD, 1998-1999 PreRunnner, & 2000 Tundra
4WD
Warranty Information
Procedure for 4Runner
Use a grease gun to apply multi-purpose grease to the No. 1, 2, 3, 7 and 8 grease fittings. Apply
molybdenum disulfide lithium base chassis grease, NLGI No. 2, to the No. 4, 5 and 6 grease fittings
(double cardan joint).
Page 354
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Service Precautions
Fuel Pressure Release: Service Precautions
WARNING: Adhere to the following procedures any time the fuel system is being worked on in
order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury:
- Keep a dry chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher near the work area.
- Place a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the work area.
- Work in a well-ventilated area. Do not smoke, and keep sparks and open flames away.
- Wear eye protection.
- Use caution when working near the catalytic converter to prevent the possibility of burns or fire.
(The temperatures within the converter can exceed 537°C (1000°F).)
- Relieve the fuel system pressure prior to disconnecting fuel system components.
- Disconnect the negative battery cable except for tests where battery voltage is required.
- Use a suitable container to store or catch fuel.
- Do not replace fuel pipe with fuel hose.
- Plug all disconnected fuel line fittings and hoses.
- After making any fuel system repairs ALWAYS inspect for fuel leaks.
- If available, use system bleed (schrader) valve to relieve fuel system pressure.
Page 351
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 4553
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 4364
Shift Indicator: Connector Views
Electronically Controlled Transmission And A/T Indicator-Connectors
Page 3262
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 2649
A/F and 02 Sensor Identification
Page 3439
Pressure Specification
Fuel Pressure: Specifications Fuel System Pressure
Fuel System Pressure
Idle Pressure - No Vacuum 38 to 44 PSI psi
Idle Pressure - With Vacuum 33-38 PSI
5 Minutes After Ignition Off 21 PSI or More
Page 2872
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Firing Order: 1-2-3-4-5-6
Page 2831
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Electrode Gap Specification
Spark Plug: Specifications Electrode Gap Specification
Electrode Gap
Correct Gap .........................................................................................................................................
...................................................... 1.1 mm (0.043 in.)
Page 727
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 4607
1. Inspect rear output shaft.
Using a micrometer, measure the outer diameter of the rear output shaft journal surface.
Minimum Diameter:
Part A: 27.98 mm (1.1016 inch) Part B: 36.98 mm (1.4561 inch)
2. Inspect drive sprocket radial clearance.
Using a dial indicator, measure the radial clearance between the sprocket and shaft with the needle
roller bearing installed.
Standard Clearance: 0.010-0.055 mm (0.0004-0.0022 inch) Maximum Clearance: 0.055 mm
(0.0022 inch) If the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the drive sprocket, rear output shaft
or needle roller bearing.
3. Inspect front drive shift fork and clutch sleeve clearance.
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the front drive shift fork and clutch sleeve.
Maximum Clearance: 1.0 mm (0.039 inch) If the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the shift
fork or clutch sleeve.
4. Inspect high and low shift fork and clutch sleeve clearance.
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the high and low shift fork and clutch sleeve.
Maximum Clearance: 1.0 mm (0.039 inch)
Page 989
Alignment: Specifications
Model Front (A-B) Rear (C-D)
A: Ground clearance of spindle center. B: Ground clearance C: Ground clearance of leaf spring
front hanger pin center.
of front adjusting cam bolt center. D: Ground clearance of rear axle shaft center
2.7L SWB M/T 46 mm 38 mm
2.7L SWB A/T 46 mm 38 mm
3.4L SWB 46 mm 38 mm
2.7L LWB M/T 44 mm 34 mm
2.7L LWB A/T 44 mm 34 mm
3.4 LWB M/T DLX 44 mm 35 mm
3.4 LWB A/T DLX 44 mm 35 mm
3.4 LWB M/T SR5 44 mm 34 mm
3.4 LWB A/T SR5 44 mm 34 mm
Page 755
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Diagrams
Specifications
Tires: Specifications
Tire Runout ..........................................................................................................................................
............................... less than 3.0 mm (0.118 inch) Tire Size And Pressure (Cold):
P225/75R15 31 x 10.5R 15LT
Front ....................................................................................................................................................
......................................... 180 kPa (26 psi) Rear ................................................................................
.............................................................................................................. 200 kPa (29 psi)
Page 1050
HINT: Apply SST (B) at a slight angle on the side marked with "9" or "7", at the position shown in the
illustration.
- When SST (B) is inserted too deeply, it will get pinched by the shim. To prevent it from being
stuck, insert it gently from the intake side, at a slight angle.
4. Using a small screwdriver and magnetic finger, remove the adjusting shim.
b. Determine the replacement adjusting shim size according to these Formula or Charts:
Page 2090
Page 371
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 3791
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 566
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3343
Specifications
Piston Ring: Specifications
DIMENSIONS
End Gap
Standard:
No. 1
......................................................................................................................................................
0.300 - 0.500 mm (0.0118 - 0.0197 inch) No. 2
......................................................................................................................................................
0.400 - 0.600 mm (0.0157 - 0.0236 inch) Oil
.........................................................................................................................................................
0.150 - 0.550 mm (0.0059 - 0.0217 inch)
Maximum:
No. 1 ....................................................................................................................................................
............................ 1.100 mm (0.0433 inch) No. 2 ................................................................................
................................................................................................ 1.200 mm (0.0472 inch) Oil ................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...... 1.150 mm (0.0453 inch)
Page 3387
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 1783
Heat Shield: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Heat Insulator To Exhaust Manifold
............................................................................................................................................. 8 Nm (71
inch lbs.)
Page 2488
Cranking Signal: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the engine is cranked, the intake air flow is slow, so fuel vaporization is poor. A rich mixture
is therefore necessary in order to achieve good startability. While the engine is being cranked, the
battery positive voltage is applied to terminal STA of the ECM. The starter signal is mainly used to
increase the fuel injection volume for the starting injection control and after-start injection control.
Specifications
Fan Blade: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Fan To Fluid Coupling .........................................................................................................................
...................................... 7.4 Nm (65 inch lbs.) Fluid Coupling To Fan Bracket
.................................................................................................................................................. 5.4
Nm (48 inch lbs.)
Page 541
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3842
Second Coast Brake
Page 2549
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 1108
Contents of Parts Kits
Warranty Information
Applicable Warranty:
This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect for 36 months or
36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in-service date.
Repair Procedure
1. Replacement of the Liquid and Suction Tube Assembly.
A. Remove evaporator unit from vehicle.
B. Disassemble the evaporator unit and remove the Liquid and Suction Tube assembly from
evaporator.
Page 1711
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 949
Description and Operation
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
OBD II regulations require that the vehicle's on-board computer lights up the Malfunction Indicator
Lamp (MIL) on the instrument panel when the computer detects a malfunction in the computer itself
or in drive system components which affect vehicle emissions. In addition to the MIL lighting up
when a malfunction is detected, the applicable DTC prescribed by SAE J2012 are recorded in the
ECM memory.
If the malfunction does not reoccur in 3 trips, the MIL goes off but the DTC remain recorded in the
ECM memory.
Page 2982
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 2617
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Firing Order: 1-2-3-4-5-6
Page 1144
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair
1. Operate vehicle, allow transmission fluid temperature to reach 158-176 °F.
2. Position vehicle on level surface, apply parking brake.
3. Allow engine to idle, depress brake pedal, then move shift lever through all positions.
4. Remove transaxle dipstick, wipe clean, then replace.
5. Remove again, then check fluid level in HOT range.
NOTICE: Do not overfill.
(a) Check the fluid condition. If the fluid smells burnt or is black, replace it.
(b) Replace the ATF.
(1) Remove the drain plug and drain the fluid. (2) Reinstall the drain plug securely.
7. On A340D units: Dry capacity is 6.9 US quarts. Drain and Refill: 2.4 Liters (2.5 US qts, 2.1 Imp.
qts.)
8. On A340E units: Dry capacity is 7.6 US quarts. Drain and Refill: 1.6 Liters (1.7 US qts, 1.4 Imp.
qts.)
9. On A340F units: Dry capacity 1996 9.3 US quarts. Dry capacity 1997-99 10.7 US quarts. Drain
and Refill: 2.0 Liters (2.1 US qts, 1.8 Imp. qts.)
10. On A340H units, dry capacity for transaxle and transfer is 10.9 US quarts.
Page 1960
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 1003
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
FUEL PRESSURE INSPECTION
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
(a) Check the battery positive voltage is above 12 V. (b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable
from the battery. (c) Remove the 6 bolts and disconnect the No.2 timing belt cover.
(d) Remove the union bolt holding the fuel pipe to the delivery pipe and gasket.
CAUTION: Put a shop towel under the delivery pipe.
- Slowly loosen the union bolt.
(e) Install SST (pressure gauge) to the delivery pipe with the 2 gaskets and SST (union and union
bolt). SST 09268-45012
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf)
(f) Wipe off any splattered gasoline.
(g) Connect the TOYOTA hand-held tester to the DLC3. (h) Reconnect the negative (-) terminal
cable to the battery. (i) Turn the ignition switch ON. (j) Measure the fuel pressure.
Fuel pressure: 265 - 304 kPa (2.7 - 3.1 kgf/sq.cm, 38 - 44 psi)
If pressure is high. replace the fuel pressure regulator. If pressure is low, check these parts: Fuel hoses and connections
- Fuel pump
- Fuel filter
- Fuel pressure regulator
(k) Disconnect the TOYOTA hand-held tester from the DLC3.
Page 4366
Shift Indicator: Electrical Diagrams
Electronically Controlled Transmission And A/T Indicator (Part 1 Of 3)
Specifications
Connecting Rod Bearing: Specifications
Connecting Rod Bearing Oil Clearance:
STD
.............................................................................................................................................................
0.024 - 0.053 mm (0.0009 - 0.0021 inch) U/S 0.25
.....................................................................................................................................................
0.023 - 0.069 mm (0.0009 - 0.0027 inch) Maximum ............................................................................
..................................................................................................... 0.08 mm (0.0031 inch)
Page 639
2. Start the engine.
3. Perform the drive pattern to run and complete the Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Monitor.
HINT:
The 02S Monitor is completed when the following conditions are met:
^ Two (2) minutes or more passed after the engine start.
^ The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) is 167°F (75°C) or more.
^ Cumulative running time at 30 mph (48 km/h) or more exceeds 6 minutes.
^ Vehicle is in closed loop.
^ The fuel-cut is operated for 8 seconds or more (for Rear O2S Monitor).
A. Allow the engine to idle for two minutes.
B. Warm up the engine until the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) reaches 167°F (75°C).
C. Drive the vehicle over 30 mph (48 km/h) for more than 40 seconds.
D. Stop the vehicle and allow the engine to idle for more than 20 seconds.
E. Repeat steps C and D at least 8 times in one driving cycle. (Do not cycle the ignition key.)
In addition, perform the following steps for the Rear O2S Readiness Monitor:
A. Select second gear.
B. Allow the vehicle to run at 30 mph (48 km/h) or more.
C. Keep the accelerator pedal "off-idle" for more than 10 seconds.
D. Immediately after step C, release the accelerator pedal for at least 10 seconds without
depressing the brake pedal (to execute the fuel-cut).
E. Decelerate the vehicle until the vehicle speed reaches less than 6mph (10km/h).
F. Repeat steps B - E at least twice in one driving cycle.
Accessing O2S Test Results
1. On the Diagnostic Tester* screen, select the following menus:
^ DIAGNOSTICS
^ CARB OBD II
Page 4349
Position Of Parts In Engine Compartment (Part 1 Of 2) (Fig 24)
Page 1851
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Testing and Inspection
Shift Interlock Control Module: Testing and Inspection
Shift Lock ECU, Harness Side: Floor Shift
Floor Shift:
Inspect shift lock control ECU. Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage at terminal.
HINT: Do not disconnect the ECU connector.
Page 4912
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Tools and Equipment
Load Sensing Proportioning Valve (LSPV) gauge set
..................................................................................................................................... 09709 - 29017
Union nut wrench 10 mm .....................................................................................................................
........................................................... 09023 - 00100
Testing and Inspection
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT WASHER SWITCH CONTINUITY
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Page 2509
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Specifications
Brake Shoe: Specifications
Standard Lining Thickness 0.236 in
Minimum Lining Thickness 0.039 in
Page 612
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2996
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2743
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 2 Of 2
Diagram Information and Instructions
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2712
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2572
Step 7
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Page 4674
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 143
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Specifications
Gear Sensor/Switch: Specifications
4WD-position Switch ...........................................................................................................................
................................................... 37 N.m (27 ft. lbs.) L4 Position Switch .............................................
...................................................................................................................................... 37 N.m (27 ft.
lbs.) Neutral Position Switch ................................................................................................................
........................................................... 37 N.m (27 ft. lbs.)
Page 2146
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control: Testing and Inspection Vehicle Speed Sensor
INSPECT VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR OPERATION
Check that there is continuity between terminals A and B 4 times for every revolution of the
speedometer shaft.
If operation is not as specified, replace the speedometer.
Page 2829
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2656
2. Start the engine.
3. Perform the drive pattern to run and complete the Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Monitor.
HINT:
The 02S Monitor is completed when the following conditions are met:
^ Two (2) minutes or more passed after the engine start.
^ The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) is 167°F (75°C) or more.
^ Cumulative running time at 30 mph (48 km/h) or more exceeds 6 minutes.
^ Vehicle is in closed loop.
^ The fuel-cut is operated for 8 seconds or more (for Rear O2S Monitor).
A. Allow the engine to idle for two minutes.
B. Warm up the engine until the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) reaches 167°F (75°C).
C. Drive the vehicle over 30 mph (48 km/h) for more than 40 seconds.
D. Stop the vehicle and allow the engine to idle for more than 20 seconds.
E. Repeat steps C and D at least 8 times in one driving cycle. (Do not cycle the ignition key.)
In addition, perform the following steps for the Rear O2S Readiness Monitor:
A. Select second gear.
B. Allow the vehicle to run at 30 mph (48 km/h) or more.
C. Keep the accelerator pedal "off-idle" for more than 10 seconds.
D. Immediately after step C, release the accelerator pedal for at least 10 seconds without
depressing the brake pedal (to execute the fuel-cut).
E. Decelerate the vehicle until the vehicle speed reaches less than 6mph (10km/h).
F. Repeat steps B - E at least twice in one driving cycle.
Accessing O2S Test Results
1. On the Diagnostic Tester* screen, select the following menus:
^ DIAGNOSTICS
^ CARB OBD II
Page 1898
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 2512
Page 483
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 3543
Ignition Coil: Mechanical Specifications
Ignition Coil to Cylinder Head 69 in.lb
Electrical Specifications
EGR Control Solenoid: Electrical Specifications
Note: Except Model VZN170 (Long wheel base 4WD Pickup)
Resistance 33 - 39 ohms at 68 deg F
Page 1928
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 4856
Brake Rotor/Disc: Testing and Inspection
DISC THICKNESS
1. Using a micrometer, measure the disc thickness.
- Standard thickness: 22.0 mm (0.866 inch)
- Minimum thickness: 20.0 mm (0.787 inch)
2. If the disc is scored or worn, or if Its thickness is less than the minimum, repair or replace the
disc.
NOTE: Before measuring the runout, confirm that the front bearing play is within specification.
DISC RUNOUT
1. Tighten the disc with the 3 hub nuts. 2. Using a dial indicator, measure the disc runout at a
position 10 mm (0.39 inch) from the outside edge.
- Maximum disc runout: 0.07 mm (0.0028 inch)
3. If the runout is greater than maximum, replace the disc. 4. If necessary, adjust disc runout. See:
Adjustments
Page 2374
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 3297
Fuel Pressure: Specifications Volume Specification
Information not supplied by the manufacturer.
Page 3202
Idle Speed: Specifications
Idle Speed 700 +/- 50 rpm
Removal
Camshaft: Service and Repair Removal
1. Remove camshafts of RH cylinder head.
CAUTION: Since the thrust clearance of the camshaft is small, the camshaft must be kept level
while it is being removed. If the camshaft is not kept level, the portion of the cylinder head receiving
the shaft thrust may crack or be damaged, causing the camshaft to seize or break. To avoid this,
these steps should be carried out.
A. Exhaust:
(a) Boring the service bolt hole of the driven sub-gear upward by turning the hexagon wrench head
portion of the exhaust camshaft with a wrench.
(b) Align the timing marks (2 dot marks) of the camshaft drive and driven gears by turning the
camshaft with a wrench.
(c) Secure the exhaust camshaft sub-gear to the main gear with a service bolt. Recommended
service bolt:
Thread diameter: 6.0 mm Thread pitch: 1.0 mm Bolt length: 16 - 20 mm
NOTE: When removing the camshaft, make sure that the torsional spring force of the sub-gear has
been eliminated by the above operation.
(d) Uniformly loosen and remove the 8 bearing cap bolts, in several passes, in the sequence
shown. (e)
Remove the 4 bearing caps and exhaust camshaft.
B. Intake:
Page 4904
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Testing and Inspection
Load Sensing Proportioning And By-Pass Valve Components
FLUID PRESSURE INSPECTION
1. Set rear axle load.
Rear axle load (include vehicle weight): 850 kg (1,874 lbs.)
Page 1862
Page 4806
Check Pedal Freeplay
(b) Push in the pedal by hand until the beginning of the resistance is felt, then measure the
distance, as shown.
Pedal freeplay: 3 - 6 mm (0.12 - 0.24 inch)
NOTE: The freeplay to the 1st point of resistance is due to the play between the clevis and pin. It is
1 - 3 mm (0.04 - 0.12 inch) on the pedal. If incorrect, check the stop light switch clearance. If the
clearance is OK, then troubleshoot the brake system.
4. Check pedal reserve distance.
Release the parking brake.
Check Pedal Reserve Distance
With the engine running, depress the pedal and measure the pedal reserve distance, as shown.
Pedal reserve distance, "a" at 490 N (110.2 lbs.): More than 72 mm (2.83 inch) If the reserve
distance incorrect, troubleshoot the brake system.
Page 4780
(j) Depress the brake pedal and hold it for about 15 seconds. As you hold the pedal down. push the
MOTOR switch for a few seconds. Check that
the brake pedal does not pulsate.
(k) Release the brake pedal.
5. Inspect the other wheels.
(a) Change the connection of the actuator checker (SST) to the sub-wire harness E (SST) from the
sub-wire harness MAIN connector to the SUB
connector, or vice versa.
(b) Repeating (c) to (j) of the step 4, check the actuator operation similarly.
6. Inspect the rear wheel.
Depress MOTOR Switch And Brake Pedal
(a) Turn the selector switch to the "REAR" position. (b) Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a
few seconds. (c) Depress the brake pedal and hold it until the step (g) is completed.
Depress POWER Switch
(d) Push the REAR switch while pressing the POWER switch. and check that the brake pedal does
not go down.
CAUTION: Do not keep the POWER switch pushed down for more than 10 seconds.
(e) Release the REAR switch then the POWER switch, and check that the brake pedal goes down.
Depress MOTOR Switch
(f) Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few seconds, and check that the pedal returns. (g)
Release the brake pedal.
Page 2833
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A thermistor built into the engine coolant temperature sensor changes the resistance value
according to the engine coolant temperature. The structure of the sensor and connection to the
ECM is the same as in the intake air temp. circuit malfunction.
Specifications
Ignition Cable: Specifications
Maximum Resistance per Cord 25 K ohms
Page 4493
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 3066
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 635
Electrical - SRS And HV Wiring Repairs
Battery System, Hybrid Drive: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - SRS And HV Wiring Repairs
TITLE: SRS & HV WIRING REPAIRS
SECTION: ELECTRICAL
BULLETIN # 156
MODELS: ALL TOYOTA LEXUS and SCION MODELS
DATE: AUGUST 2007
There are no approved repairs to Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) or High Voltage (HV)
wiring or connectors. SRS system wiring and connectors are color coded yellow and HV wiring is
orange however vehicle-specific wiring diagrams are the best source for identifying wiring in these
circuits. Wiring diagrams are available through the Technical Information System (TIS)
www.techinfo.toyota.com.
If SRS or HV wiring or connectors are suspected of damage they should be inspected thoroughly.
Damaged wiring and/or connectors require replacement of the affected harness. Follow all
precautions and procedures outlined in model-specific repair manuals for replacing SRS wiring or
components. Only Certified Hybrid Service Technicians are qualified to replace HV system wiring
and components.
Page 290
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3332
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 4162
c. Using SST 09950-30010 (09951-03010, 09953-03010, 09954-03010, 09955-03030,
09956-03020) and the companion flange, install the front
bearing then remove the companion flange.
15. Install oil seal.
a. Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
b. Using SST 09214-76011, install a new oil seal.
Oil seal drive in depth: 1.0 mm (0.039 inch)
16. Install companion flange.
a. Place the companion flange on the drive pinion. b. Install a new nut.
HINT: Coat the threads of a new nut with hypoid gear oil.
c. Using SST 09330-00021 to hold the flange, tighten the nut.
Torque to 196 Nm (145 ft. lbs.)
17. Adjust drive pinion preload. Using a torque wrench, measure the preload of the backlash
between the drive pinion and ring gear.
Preload (starting):
New bearing: 0.9 - 1.6 Nm (8.7 - 13.9 inch lbs.) Reuse bearing: 0.5 - 0.8 Nm (4.3 - 6.9 inch lbs.)
If preload is greater than specification, replace the bearing spacer. If preload is less than
specification, retighten the nut a little at a time with a
Page 804
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 1742
(b) Install the thermostat with the jiggle valve downward. (c)
Install the water inlet with the 3 bolts. Torque: 20 Nm (14 ft. lbs.)
2. Connect lower radiator hose. 3. Fill with engine coolant. 4. Start engine and check for leaks.
Page 57
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 3546
Ignition Coil: Service and Repair
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
IGNITION COILS REMOVAL
1. REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE 2. DISCONNECT HIGH-TENSION CORDS FROM IGNITION
COILS 3. REMOVE IGNITION COILS
(a) Disconnect the 3 connectors from the ignition coils.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and 3 ignition coils from the LH cylinder head.
Torque: 7.8 N.m (80 kgf.cm, 69 in.lbf)
HINT: Arrange the ignition coils in correct order.
IGNITION COILS INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Clutch Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
One Touch 2-4 Selector System
Page 1932
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Specifications
Timing Cover: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
No. 1 Timing Belt Cover To Oil Pump
............................................................................................................................................... 9 Nm
(80 inch lbs.) No. 2 Timing Belt Cover To No. 3 Timing Belt
Cover......................................................................................................................... 9 Nm (80 inch
lbs.) No. 3 Timing Belt Cover To Cylinder Head
....................................................................................................................................... 9 Nm (80
inch lbs.)
Page 3218
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Locations
Transmission Speed Sensor: Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor Location
Page 4665
Position Of Parts In Engine Compartment (Part 2 Of 2) (Fig 25)
Page 3495
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Specifications
Hydraulic Hose: Specifications
Clutch Line Union ................................................................................................................................
................................................... 15 N.m (11 ft. lbs.)
Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications
Power Steering Fluid: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications
Fluid Pressure .....................................................................................................................................
............................. 8,336 kPa (1,209 psi) Minimum
Page 3527
Page 2953
Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
ENGINE OIL Dry Fill ............................................................................................................................
.................................................................................. 5.9L (6.2 Qt)
Drain And Refill w/o Oil Filter Change .................................................................................................
....................................................................................... 4.9L (5.2 Qt) w/ Oil Filter Change ................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............ 5.2L (5.5 Qt)
Page 3787
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Front Drive Shaft Lock Nut 235 Nm (174 ft.lb)
Page 2956
CHART 27
Page 4048
Upper Valve Body
VALVE BODY SPRING SPECIFICATIONS HINT: During reassembly please refer to the spring
specifications below to help you to identify the different springs.
Page 2730
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Testing and Inspection
Shift Interlock Switch: Testing and Inspection
Inspect shift lock control switch.
Inspect that there is continuity between each terminal. If the continuity is not as specified. Replace
the switch.
Service and Repair
Solenoid: Service and Repair
1. Remove A.D.D. switch. 2. Remove sleeve fork pin.
a. Using a hexagon wrench, remove the screw plug. b. Using a pin punch and a hammer, remove
the pin through the hole of clutch case cover.
3. Separate actuator from clutch case cover and remove sleeve fork. Using a hexagon wrench,
remove the screw plug.
b. Remove the spring seat, spring and steel ball. c. Remove the 2 bolts and actuator from the
clutch case cover. d. Separate the actuator from the clutch case cover and remove the sleeve fork.
e. Remove the O-ring from the actuator.
4. Install sleeve fork and actuator into clutch case cover.
a. Install a new O-ring to the actuator. b. Coat the O-ring with MP grease. c. Place the sleeve fork
and install the actuator to the clutch case cover. d. Torque the 2 bolts.
Torque to 21 Nm (15 ft. lbs.)
e. Install the steel ball, spring and spring seat. f.
Coat the threads of screw plug with FIPG.
FIPG: Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281, or equivalent.
g. Using a hexagon wrench, install the screw plug.
Torque to 13 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
5. Install sleeve fork pin.
a. Using a pin punch and a hammer, install the pin through the hole of clutch case cover. b. Coat
the threads of screw plug with FIPG: Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281, or equivalent. c.
Using a hexagon wrench, install the screw plug.
Torque to 20 Nm (14 ft. lbs.)
6. Install A.D.D. switch. Install a new gasket and indicator switch.
Torque to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
Page 3041
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 3024
Page 1929
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 480
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
MAF Meter to Air Cleaner Cap 61 in.lb
Page 2484
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 1400
Valve: Testing and Inspection
1. Inspect and grind valves.
(a) Grind the valve enough to remove pits and carbon.
(b) Check that the valve is ground to the correct valve face angle.
Valve face angle: 44.5°
(c) Check the valve head margin thickness. Standard margin thickness: 1.0 mm (0.039 inch)
Minimum margin thickness: 0.5 mm (0.020 inch) If the margin thickness is less than the minimum,
replace the valve.
(d) Check the valve overall length.
Standard overall length:
Intake: 95.15 mm (3.7461 inch) Exhaust: 94.90 mm (3.7362 inch)
Minimum overall length:
Intake: 94.60 mm (3.7244 inch) Exhaust: 94.40 mm (3.7165 inch)
If the overall length is less than the minimum, replace the valve.
(e) Check the surface of the valve stem tip for wear.
Page 4784
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Tools and Equipment
Union nut wrench 10 mm, to disconnect Brake lines from Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) actuator
............................................................ 09023 - 00100 ABS actuator checker and sub-harness
...........................................................................................................................................................
09990 - 00150 ABS actuator checker sub-harness "C"
...........................................................................................................................................................
09990 - 00200 ABS actuator checker sub-harness "E"
...........................................................................................................................................................
09990 - 00210 ABS actuator checker sheet "L" ..................................................................................
.................................................................................... 09990 - 00370
Page 4183
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Firing Order: 1-2-3-4-5-6
Page 793
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 2749
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 1 Of 2
Page 2535
Data Link Connector: Testing and Inspection
Data Link Connector (DLC3) Terminal Identification
Reference
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 3 (DLC3) INSPECTION
The vehicle's ECM uses the ISO 9141-2 communication protocol for communication. The terminal
arrangement of DLC3 complies with SAE J1962 and matches the ISO 9141-2 format.
HINT: If your display shows "UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE" when you have connected the
cable of the OBD II scan tool or TOYOTA hand-held tester to DLC3, turned the ignition switch ON
and operated the scan tool, there is a problem on the vehicle side or tool side.
(1) If communication is normal when the tool is connected to another vehicle, inspect DLC3 on the
original vehicle. (2) If communication is still not possible when the tool is connected to another
vehicle, the problem is probably in the tool itself, so consult the
Service Department listed in the tool's instruction manual.
Page 2231
Page 867
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Fuel - Idle Speed Increased by Replacement ECM
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Idle Speed Increased by Replacement
ECM
ENGINE EG001-98
FEBRUARY 13, 1998
2RZ ECM IDLE SPEED
MODELS: '95-'97 TACOMA
Introduction Operating logic of 1995-1997 Tacoma ECMs has been revised to improve engine idle
smoothness (with transmission in "D" range) by increasing idle speed (A/C "OFF") from 600 RPM
to 700 RPM. The change has also narrowed the RPM transition between A/C "OFF" and A/C "ON"
engagement.
Affected Vehicles 1995-1997 Tacoma 4x2 equipped with 2RZ-FE four cylinder engine and automatic transmission.
Part Number Information
Production Change Information No production changes have been made.
- This change applies only to replacement ECMs available through parts supply.
Warranty Information
Applicable Warranty: This repair is covered under the Toyota Powertrain Warranty. This warranty Is
in effect for 60 months or 60,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in service date.
Page 4004
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 3575
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 721
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The throttle position sensor is mounted in the throttle body and detects the throttle valve opening
angle. When the throttle valve is fully closed, a voltage of approximately 0.7 V is applied to terminal
VTA of the ECM. The voltage applied to the terminals VTA of the ECM increases in proportion to
the opening angle of the throttle valve and becomes approximately 2.7 ~ 5.2 V when the throttle
valve is fully opened. The ECM judges the vehicle driving conditions from these signals input from
terminals VTA and uses them as one of the conditions for deciding the air-fuel ratio correction,
power increase correction and fuel-cut control etc.
Page 4172
f. Remove the plate washers and differential case.
g. Install the plate washer into the ring gear back side of the carrier. h. Place the other plate washer
onto the differential case together with the outer race, and install the differential case with the outer
race into the
carrier.
i. Using a plastic hammer, snug down the washer and bearing by tapping the ring gear.
j. Using a dial indicator, measure the ring gear backlash.
Backlash: 0.13 - 0.18 mm (0.0051 - 0.0071 inch)
k. If the backlash is not within the specification, adjust by either increasing or decreasing the
number of washers on both sides by an equal
amount. Ensure that there is ring gear backlash.
HINT: There should be no clearance between the plate washer and case.
10. Adjust side bearing preload.
a. after adjustment with the backlash as reference, remove the ring gear teeth side plate washer
and measure the thickness.
b. Install a new washer of 0.06 - 0.09 mm (0.0024 - 0.0035 inch) thicker than the washer removed.
HINT: Select a washer which can be pressed in 2/3 of the way by finger.
c. Using a plastic hammer, install the plate washer.
Page 3038
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 70
Standard Values Of ECU Terminals (2 Of 2) 5VZ-FE
Page 342
Park / Neutral Position Switch
Brakes - Pad Clicking Noise
Brake Pad: Customer Interest Brakes - Pad Clicking Noise
BRAKES BR004-00
October 20, 2000
Title: BRAKE PAD CLICKING NOISE
Models: '90- '00 All Models
Introduction A clicking type noise may be noticed when first applying the brakes after changing
vehicle travel direction (Drive/Forward to Reverse, Reverse to Drive/Forward). This is a normal
noise caused by the required brake pad-to-caliper clearances. When the direction of travel is
changed, the brake pads may "shift" towards the new direction of travel. When the brake pad
contacts the caliper, a clicking noise may be heard.
To minimize this clicking noise, a disc brake caliper grease has been made available for use during
brake service/maintenance operations. Under normal usage conditions this grease should be
effective for a period of 6 months to 1 year.
Applicable Vehicles ^
1990 - 2000 model year Toyota vehicles, all models.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Application Procedure There are two types of brake calipers: floating and fixed. Check the type of
brake caliper installed on the vehicle by removing the wheel assembly.
1. Floating Type Brake Caliper
A. Lift up or remove the brake caliper and suspend it securely.
HINT:
Do not disconnect the flexible hose from the brake caliper.
B. If equipped with anti-squeal spring: Remove the anti-squeal springs.
C. Remove the brake pads with anti-squeal shims.
D. Remove the pad support plates from the torque plate. Clean any dust from the pad support
plates, torque plates and brake pads.
ABS Control (Motor) Relay
ABS Main Relay: Description and Operation ABS Control (Motor) Relay
Codes 13, 14: ABS Control (Motor) Relay Circuit DTC Chart
ABS Control (Motor) Relay Circuit Wiring Diagram
Page 3083
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 4312
Universal Joint: Testing and Inspection
Inspect spider bearings.
a. Inspect the spider bearings for wear or damage. b. Using a dial indicator, check the spider
bearing axial play by turning the yoke while holding the shaft tightly.
Bearing axial play: w/o double cardan joint propeller shaft
Maximum 0.05 mm (0.0020 inch.) If necessary, replace the spider bearing.
w/ double cardan joint propeller shaft
Maximum 0.05 mm (0.0020 inch.) If necessary, replace the propeller shaft.
Page 1798
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 2032
A. The Diagnostic Tester displays 17" as a value of the Time $81" (see illustration).
B. Find the Conversion Factor value of Time $81" in the O2S Failure Threshold chart. 0.3906 is
specified for Time $81 in this chart.
C. Multiply "17" in step "A" by 0.3906 (Conversion Factor) in step "B."
17 x 0.3906 = 6.6%
D. If the answer is within the Standard Value of TEST LIMIT, the Time $81" can be confirmed to be
normal.
NOTE:
^ "LOW SW V" indicates the O2S voltage when the O2S status changes from rich to lean.
^ "HIGH SW V" indicates the O2S voltage when the O2S status changes from lean to rich.
^ If the O2S voltage is lower than "LOW SW V," the O2S status is lean.
^ If the O2S voltage is higher than "HIGH SW V," the O2S status is rich.
NOTE:
Before the O2S Monitor completes or after the ignition switch is turned OFF, the Diagnostic Tester
displays the viewable upper limit or a lower limit of the test value (example: 0 V, 1.275 V, Os
[seconds], 10.2s, 0 and 255).
Page 2929
Page 2935
CHART 7
Page 4171
8. Install differential case in carrier.
a. Place the bearing outer races on their respective bearings. Make sure the left and right races are
not interchanged. b. Install the differential case in the carrier.
9. Adjust ring gear backlash.
a. Only install the plate washer on the ring gear backside.
HINT: Ensure that the ring gear has a backlash.
b. Using a plastic hammer, snug down the washer and bearing by tapping the ring gear.
c. Hold the side bearing boss on the teeth surface of the ring gear and measure the backlash.
Backlash (reference): 0.13 - 0.18 mm (0.0051 - 0.0071 inch)
d. Select a ring gear back side plate washer, using the backlash as reference.
e. Select a ring gear teeth side plate washer of a thickness which eliminates any clearance
between the outer race and case.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Locations
ECT Temperature Sender Gauge / Low Oil Pressure Warning Switch
Page 3566
Ignition Control Module: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A DIS (Direct Ignition System) has been adopted. The DIS improves the ignition timing accuracy,
reduces high-voltage loss and enhances the overall reliability of the ignition system by eliminating
the distributor.
The DIS is a 2-cylinder simultaneous ignition system which ignites 2 cylinders simultaneously with
one ignition coil. In the 2-cylinder simultaneous ignition system, each of the 2 spark plugs is
connected to the end of the secondary winding. High voltage generated in the secondary winding is
applied directly to the 2 spark plugs. The sparks of the 2 spark plugs pass simultaneously from the
center electrode to the ground electrode.
The ECM determines ignition timing and outputs the ignition signals (IGT) for each cylinder. Based
on IGT signals, the igniter controls the primary ignition signals (IGC) for all ignition coils. At the
same time, the igniter also sends an ignition confirmation signal (IGF) as a fail-safe measure to the
ECM.
Page 735
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2773
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2847
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 2264
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR REMOVAL
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the crankshaft position sensor connector. (b) Remove the bolt crankshaft position
sensor.
Torque: 7.8 N.m (80 kgf.cm, 69 in.lbf)
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 3389
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 4355
Location Of Splice Points (Fig 36)
System Outline
Previous automatic transmissions have selected each gear shift using mechanically controlled
throttle hydraulic pressure, governor hydraulic pressure and lock-up hydraulic pressure. The
Electronically Controlled Transmission, however, electrically controls the governor pressure and
lock-up pressure through the solenoid valve. Control of the solenoid valve by the Engine Control
Module based on the input signals from each sensor makes smooth driving possible by shift
selection for each gear which is most appropriate to the driving conditions at that time.
1. GEAR SHIFT OPERATION
During driving, the Engine Control Module selects the shift for each gear which is most appropriate
to the driving conditions, based on input signals from the Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor to
TERMINAL THW of the Engine Control Module and also the input signals to TERMINAL SP2+ of
the Engine Control Module from the Vehicle Speed Sensor devoted to the Electronically Controlled
Transmission. Current is then output to the Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid. When
shifting to 1st speed, current flows from TERMINAL S1 of the Engine Control Module -->
TERMINAL 1 of the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid --> GROUND, and continuity
to the No.1 solenoid causes the shift.
For 2nd speed, current flows from TERMINAL S1 of the Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 1 of
the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid --> GROUND, and from TERMINAL S2 of the
Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 2 of the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid -->
GROUND. and continuity to Solenoid No.1 and No.2 causes the shift.
For 3rd speed. there is no continuity to No.1 solenoid, only to No.2 causing the shift. Shifting into
4th speed (Overdrive) takes place when there is no continuity to either No.1 or No.2 Solenoid.
2. LOCK-UP OPERATION
When the Engine Control Module judges from each signal that lock-up operation conditions have
been met, current flows from TERMINAL SL of the Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 3 of the
Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid --> GROUND, causing continuity to the lock-up
solenoid and causing lock-up operation.
3. STOP LIGHT SW CIRCUIT
If the brake pedal is depressed (Stop Light SW ON) when driving in lock-up condition, a signal is
input to TERMINAL BK of the Engine Control Module, the Engine Control Module operates and
continuity to the lock-up solenoid is cut.
4. OVERDRIVE CIRCUIT
^ O/D Main SW ON When the O/D main SW is turned ON, a signal is input to TERMINAL OD2 of
the Engine Control Module and Engine Control Module
Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
Intake 0.13 - 0.23 mm
Exhaust 0.27 - 0.37 mm
Page 2127
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2852
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 1516
Valve Guide Seal: Service and Repair
1. w/ Snap ring: Insert an old valve wrapped with tape into the valve guide bushing, and break off
the valve guide bushing by hitting it with a
hammer. Remove the snap ring.
NOTE: Wrap the tape approximately 8 mm (0.31 inch) from the valve stem end.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the valve lifter hole.
2. Gradually heat the cylinder head to 80° - 100° C (176° - 212° F).
3. Using Special Service Tool (SST) Valve Guide Bushing Remover & Replacer Set # 09201 10000 (Valve Guide Bushing Remover & Replacer 6
# 09201 - 01060), Handle Set # 09950 - 70010 (Handle 150 # 09951 - 07150) or equivalents and a
hammer, tap out the guide bushing.
4. Using a caliper gauge, measure the bushing bore diameter of the cylinder head.
Page 710
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 157
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 1 Of 2
Page 3702
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Components For Removal And Installation Part 1 Of 2
Page 2427
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 1547
(c) Install the starter wire bracket with the 2 bolts.
13. Install crankshaft pulley.
(a) Align the pulley set key with the key groove of the pulley, and slide the pulley.
(b) Using SST Crankshaft Pulley Holding Tool # 09213 - 54015 (Bolt # 90119 - 08216), Companion
Flange Holding Tool # 09330 - 00021 or
equivalents, install and torque the bolt. Torque: 250 Nm (184 ft. lbs.)
14. Install fan bracket.
(a) Install the fan bracket with the bolt and nut.
(b) Install the PS pump adjusting strut with the nut.
15. Install No. 2 timing belt cover.
(a) Check that the timing belt cover gasket has no cracks or peeling, etc. If the gasket has cracks
or peeling, etc., replace it using these steps: ^
Using a screwdriver and gasket scraper, remove all the old gasket material.
^ Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the loose material.
^ Remove the backing paper from a new gasket and install the gasket evenly to the part of the
timing belt cover shaded black in the illustration.
(b) Install the timing belt cover with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.)
(c) Connect the 4 high-tension cord clamps and camshaft position sensor connector to the No. 2
timing belt cover.
16. Install oil dipstick and guide.
(a) Install a new O-ring to the dipstick guide.
(b) Install the oil dipstick and guide to the cylinder block. (c)
Install the bolt to the generator bracket. Torque: 8 Nm (71 inch lbs.)
17. w/ A/C: Install A/C compressor bracket.
Torque: 47 Nm (35 ft. lbs.)
18. w/ A/C: Connect A/C compressor to engine. 19. Connect PS pump to engine. 20. Install fan
with fluid coupling and fan pulleys.
Page 539
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2436
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2363
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 2371
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2571
Step 3
Step 4
Step 5
Step 6
Page 1727
6. INSPECT ECT SENSOR
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Resistance: Refer to the graph
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the ECT sensor.
7. REINSTALL ECT SENSOR
(a) Install a new gasket to the ECT sensor. (b) Using a 19 mm deep socket, install the ECT sensor.
Torque: 20 N.m (200 kgf.cm, 14 ft.lbf)
(c) Connect the ECT sensor connector.
8. REINSTALL FUEL PIPE
Install the fuel pipe with 4 new gaskets and the 2 union bolts.
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm. 25 ft.lbf)
9. REINSTALL NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER
10. RECONNECT UPPER RADIATOR HOSE TO WATER OUTLET 11. REFILL WITH ENGINE
COOLANT
Page 3603
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 3585
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 3040
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2508
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
One Touch 2-4 Selector System
Page 338
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 3655
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Specifications
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Attaching Nuts .....................................................................................................................................
................................................. 19 Nm (14 ft. lbs.) Bracket Attaching Nuts ........................................
............................................................................................................................. 5.4 Nm (48 inch
lbs.) Brake Line Union .........................................................................................................................
......................................................... 15 Nm (11 ft.lbs.)
Page 2277
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Electrical Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Cold Hot
Between Terminals NE+ and NE- 1,630 - 2,740 ohms at 14 - 122 deg F 2,065 - 3,225 ohms at 122
- 212 deg F
Page 2179
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2376
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
System Schematic
Sensor Cut-Away
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The mass air flow meter uses a platinum hot wire. The hot wire air flow meter consists of a
platinum hot wire, thermistor and a control circuit installed in a plastic housing. The hot wire air flow
meter works on the principle that the hot wire and thermistor located in the intake air bypass of the
housing detect any changes in the intake air temperature. The hot wire is maintained at the set
temperature by controlling the current flow through the hot wire. This current flow is then measured
as the output voltage of the air flow meter. The circuit is constructed so that the platinum hot wire
and thermistor provide a bridge circuit, with the power transistor controlled so that the potential of
(A) and (B) remains equal to maintain the set temperature.
Page 779
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
MAF Meter to Air Cleaner Cap 61 in.lb
Page 2800
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4250
a. Remove the free wheel hub.
b. Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring. c. Remove the spacer.
5. Disconnect drive shaft. Using a brass bar and hammer, disconnect the drive shaft
Removal Hint: When it is difficult to disconnect the drive shaft, tap in a screwdriver between
differential tube/differential carrier and drive shaft.
Installation Hint: Before installation, set the snap ring opening side facing downward. Using SST
09631-10030 and a hammer, strike the inboard joint into the differential. At that time, strike the
snags evenly to avoid snags deformation. Check that the drive shaft cannot be pull out by hand
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the dust cover of the drive shaft.
6. Disconnect lower suspension arm.
a. Remove the cotter pin and nut.
Torque to 140 Nm (103 ft. lbs.)
b. Using SST 09628-62011, disconnect the lower suspension arm.
Installation Hint: Face the cotter pin hole of the lower ball joint forward.
Page 2289
Page 3263
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 31
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Firing Order: 1-2-3-4-5-6
Page 52
Cruise Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 4311
Universal Joint: Application and ID
TMC-made:
Mark .....................................................................................................................................................
.................................................... Thickness
1 ...........................................................................................................................................................
..... 2.100-2.150 mm (0.0827-0.0846 inch) 2 .......................................................................................
......................................................................... 2.150-2.200 mm (0.0846-0.0866 inch) 3 ...................
.............................................................................................................................................
2.200-2.250 mm (0.0866-0.0886 inch) Brown
........................................................................................................................................................
2.250-2.300 mm (0.0886-0.0906 inch) Blue
...........................................................................................................................................................
2.300-2.350 mm (0.0906-0.0925 inch) 6 .............................................................................................
................................................................... 2.350-2.400 mm (0.0925-0.0945 inch) 7 .........................
....................................................................................................................................... 2.400-2.450
mm (0.0945-0.0965 inch) 8 .................................................................................................................
............................................... 2.450-2.500 mm (0.0965-0.0984 inch)
Dana-made:
Color ....................................................................................................................................................
.................................................... Thickness
Green ...................................................................................................................................................
............................ 1.384 mm (0.0545 inch) Red ..................................................................................
................................................................................................. 1.435 mm (0.0565 inch) Black ...........
..............................................................................................................................................................
....... 1.486 mm (0.0585 inch) Copper ..................................................................................................
........................................................................... 1.511 mm (0.0595 inch) Silver .................................
............................................................................................................................................... 1.537
mm (0.0605 inch) Yellow .....................................................................................................................
........................................................ 1.588 mm (0.0625 inch) Blue .....................................................
............................................................................................................................ 1.638 mm (0.0645
inch)
Page 2463
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor Location
Page 2466
Specifications
Brake Caliper: Specifications
Line Union 22 ft.lb
Mounting Bolt 90 ft.lb
Page 2224
Camshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 1651
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 1830
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 317
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Service Precautions
Fuel Pressure Release: Service Precautions
WARNING: Adhere to the following procedures any time the fuel system is being worked on in
order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury:
- Keep a dry chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher near the work area.
- Place a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the work area.
- Work in a well-ventilated area. Do not smoke, and keep sparks and open flames away.
- Wear eye protection.
- Use caution when working near the catalytic converter to prevent the possibility of burns or fire.
(The temperatures within the converter can exceed 537°C (1000°F).)
- Relieve the fuel system pressure prior to disconnecting fuel system components.
- Disconnect the negative battery cable except for tests where battery voltage is required.
- Use a suitable container to store or catch fuel.
- Do not replace fuel pipe with fuel hose.
- Plug all disconnected fuel line fittings and hoses.
- After making any fuel system repairs ALWAYS inspect for fuel leaks.
- If available, use system bleed (schrader) valve to relieve fuel system pressure.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 658
CHART 18
CHART 19
Page 3197
- Using SST, tighten the flare nut to specified torque. (SST 09631-22020)
HINT: Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 30 cm (11.81 in.).
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf) Torque for using SST: 28 N.m (285 kgf.cm, 21 ft.lbf)
NOTICE: Do not rotate the fuel pipe, when tightening the flare nut.
Page 889
Knock Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Specifications
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Knock Sensor to Cylinder Block 29 ft.lb
Page 336
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3900
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3788
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2853
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 813
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Restraints - OCS System Initialization
Seat Occupant Classification Module - Air Bag: Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - OCS
System Initialization
COLLISION REPAIR INFORMATION FOR THE COLLISION REPAIR PROFESSIONAL
TITLE: SRS OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM INITIALIZATION
SECTION: ELECTRICAL BULLETIN # 177
MODELS: ALL EQUIPPED TOYOTA LEXUS and SCION MODELS
DATE: MARCH 2010
Models equipped with a Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Occupant Classification System
(OCS) will enable or disable the passenger front and side airbags based on seat occupancy
passenger weight and seat belt latch engagement.
If an equipped vehicle sustains collision damage or if the front passenger seat or any of the OCS
components are serviced the SRS Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) may illuminate setting a
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC).
NOTE:
It is necessary to diagnose and repair the root cause of a SRS or OCS DTC before initializing the
OCS system. If SRS and OCS DTC's are not cleared the system may not operate properly.
Be sure to check and clear DTC's and perform OCS initialization per repair manual instructions
with a Techstream Special Service Tool (SST) or capable diagnostic tester.
Any of the following conditions could set a DTC illuminate the SRS MIL or cause the PASSENGER
AIRBAG light to indicate incorrectly regardless of occupancy:
^ The OCS Electronic Control Unit (ECU) is replaced
^ Accessories such as a seatback tray are installed on the passenger seat
^ The passenger seat is removed and replaced or reinstalled
^ The vehicle is involved in an accident or collision
Model-specific repair manuals can be accessed through the Technical Information System (TIS)
www.techinfo.toyota.com
Page 2350
HINT: Apply SST (B) at a slight angle on the side marked with "9" or "7", at the position shown in the
illustration.
- When SST (B) is inserted too deeply, it will get pinched by the shim. To prevent it from being
stuck, insert it gently from the intake side, at a slight angle.
4. Using a small screwdriver and magnetic finger, remove the adjusting shim.
b. Determine the replacement adjusting shim size according to these Formula or Charts:
Page 3274
Components For Removal And Installtion Part 2 Of 2
Page 2851
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Specifications
Throttle Valve Cable/Linkage: Specifications
Throttle Cable Adjustment (Throttle Valve Fully Closed)
Between Boot And Face:
And Inner Cable Stopper
.............................................................................................................................................................
0 - 1 mm (0.04 inch)
Page 3740
Location Of Splice Points (Fig 36)
System Outline
Previous automatic transmissions have selected each gear shift using mechanically controlled
throttle hydraulic pressure, governor hydraulic pressure and lock-up hydraulic pressure. The
Electronically Controlled Transmission, however, electrically controls the governor pressure and
lock-up pressure through the solenoid valve. Control of the solenoid valve by the Engine Control
Module based on the input signals from each sensor makes smooth driving possible by shift
selection for each gear which is most appropriate to the driving conditions at that time.
1. GEAR SHIFT OPERATION
During driving, the Engine Control Module selects the shift for each gear which is most appropriate
to the driving conditions, based on input signals from the Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor to
TERMINAL THW of the Engine Control Module and also the input signals to TERMINAL SP2+ of
the Engine Control Module from the Vehicle Speed Sensor devoted to the Electronically Controlled
Transmission. Current is then output to the Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid. When
shifting to 1st speed, current flows from TERMINAL S1 of the Engine Control Module -->
TERMINAL 1 of the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid --> GROUND, and continuity
to the No.1 solenoid causes the shift.
For 2nd speed, current flows from TERMINAL S1 of the Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 1 of
the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid --> GROUND, and from TERMINAL S2 of the
Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 2 of the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid -->
GROUND. and continuity to Solenoid No.1 and No.2 causes the shift.
For 3rd speed. there is no continuity to No.1 solenoid, only to No.2 causing the shift. Shifting into
4th speed (Overdrive) takes place when there is no continuity to either No.1 or No.2 Solenoid.
2. LOCK-UP OPERATION
When the Engine Control Module judges from each signal that lock-up operation conditions have
been met, current flows from TERMINAL SL of the Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 3 of the
Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid --> GROUND, causing continuity to the lock-up
solenoid and causing lock-up operation.
3. STOP LIGHT SW CIRCUIT
If the brake pedal is depressed (Stop Light SW ON) when driving in lock-up condition, a signal is
input to TERMINAL BK of the Engine Control Module, the Engine Control Module operates and
continuity to the lock-up solenoid is cut.
4. OVERDRIVE CIRCUIT
^ O/D Main SW ON When the O/D main SW is turned ON, a signal is input to TERMINAL OD2 of
the Engine Control Module and Engine Control Module
Page 4528
3. If necessary, replace extension housing oil seal.
a. Using a screwdriver and hammer, drive out the oil seal. b. Using SST 09554-22010 and a
hammer, drive in a new oil seal until its surface is flush with the housing upper surface. c. Coat the
lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
4. If necessary, replace front and rear companion flange oil seals.
a. Using a screwdriver and hammer, drive out the oil seals from the 2 flanges. b. Using SST
09950-60010 (09951-00220, 09951-00350, 09952-06010), 09950-70010 (09951-07100) and a
hammer, drive in a new oil seal. c. Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
5. If necessary, replace shift fork shaft oil seals.
a. Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal. b. Using SST 09304-12012 and a hammer, drive in a
new oil seal.
Oil seal depth: -0.5 to 0.5 mm (-0.020 to 0.020 inch)
Page 4762
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Specifications
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Rear Oil Seal Retainer To Cylinder Block
.................................................................................................................................... 8 Nm (71 inch
lbs.)
Page 4492
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 324
Inspection Procedure / Stop Light Switch Circuit (4 Of 4)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Service Precautions
Fuel Pressure Release: Service Precautions
WARNING: Adhere to the following procedures any time the fuel system is being worked on in
order to reduce the risk of fire and personal injury:
- Keep a dry chemical (Class B) fire extinguisher near the work area.
- Place a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the work area.
- Work in a well-ventilated area. Do not smoke, and keep sparks and open flames away.
- Wear eye protection.
- Use caution when working near the catalytic converter to prevent the possibility of burns or fire.
(The temperatures within the converter can exceed 537°C (1000°F).)
- Relieve the fuel system pressure prior to disconnecting fuel system components.
- Disconnect the negative battery cable except for tests where battery voltage is required.
- Use a suitable container to store or catch fuel.
- Do not replace fuel pipe with fuel hose.
- Plug all disconnected fuel line fittings and hoses.
- After making any fuel system repairs ALWAYS inspect for fuel leaks.
- If available, use system bleed (schrader) valve to relieve fuel system pressure.
Page 49
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 451
Brake Light Switch: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
STOP LIGHT SWITCH CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
When the brake is on, battery positive voltage normally applies through the STOP fuse and stop
light switch to terminal STP- of the ECU, and the ECU turns the cruise control off.
A fail-safe function is provided so that cancel functions normally, even if there is a malfunction in
the stop light signal circuit.
If the harness connected to terminal STP- has an open circuit, terminal STP- will have battery
positive voltage and the cruise control will be turned off.
Also, when the brake is on, the magnetic clutch is cut mechanically by the stop light switch, turning
the cruise control off.
Stop Light Switch Circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
Inspection Procedure / Stop Light Switch Circuit (1 Of 4)
Page 4163
torque of 13 Nm (9 ft. lbs.) until the specified preload is reached.
Maximum torque: 343 Nm (253 ft. lbs.)
If the maximum torque is exceeded while retightening the nut, replace the bearing spacer and
repeat the preload procedure. Do not back off the pinion nut to reduce the preload.
18. Recheck ring gear backlash. 19. Recheck tooth contact between ring gear and drive pinion. 20.
Check runout of companion flange. 21. Stake drive pinion nut.
22. Install adjusting nut locks.
a. Install 2 new nut locks on the bearing caps.
Torque to 13 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
b. after tightening bolts, bend the nut locks.
23. Install shift fork shaft.
a. Apply MP grease onto the outer circuit of the fork shaft.
b. Install the fork shaft to match the hole of the shift fork and that of the shift fork shaft c. Remove
any FIPG material and be careful not to drop oil on the contacting surface of the differential carrier
and shaft retainer.
d. Apply FIPG Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281, or equivalent, to the carrier, as shown.
HINT: Install the shaft retainer within 10 minutes after applying FIPG.
e. Clean the threads of the bolts and retainer bolts holes with toluene or trichloroethylene.
Page 806
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 3217
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
ENGINE OIL Dry Fill ............................................................................................................................
.................................................................................. 5.9L (6.2 Qt)
Drain And Refill w/o Oil Filter Change .................................................................................................
....................................................................................... 4.9L (5.2 Qt) w/ Oil Filter Change ................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............ 5.2L (5.5 Qt)
Page 3555
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 289
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2676
CHART 20
Page 4119
Maximum vertical runout: 0.10 mm (0.0039 inch) Maximum lateral runout: 0.10 mm (0.0039 inch)
2. Check ring gear runout. Using a dial indicator, measure the ring gear runout.
Maximum runout: 0.10 mm (0.0039 inch)
If the runout is not within the specification, replace the ring gear.
3. Check ring gear backlash. Using a dial indicator, measure the ring gear backlash.
Backlash: 0.13 - 0.18 mm (0.0051 - 0.0071 inch)
If the backlash is not within the specification, adjust the side bearing preload or repair as
necessary.
Locations
Ignition Switch
Page 165
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 2461
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2478
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 3063
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Knock Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
KNOCK SENSOR INSPECTION
1. REMOVE KNOCK SENSORS
See: Service and Repair
2. INSPECT KNOCK SENSORS
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between the terminal and body. If there is
continuity, replace the sensor.
Page 2628
Knock Sensor: Oscilloscope Patterns and Waveforms
Page 3419
Page 4443
e. Select a snap ring that will allow minimum axial play.
Mark A: 2.00-2.05 mm (0.0787-0.0807 inch) Mark B: 2.05-2.10 mm (0.0807-0.0827 inch) Mark C:
2.10-2.15 mm (0.0827-0.0846 inch) Mark D: 2.15-2.20 mm (0.0846-0.0866 inch) Mark E: 2.20-2.25
mm (0.0866-0.0886 inch) Mark F: 2.25-2.30 mm (0.0886-0.0906 inch)
f. Using a snap ring expander, install the snap ring.
Page 3910
Electronically Controlled Transmission And A/T Indicator (Part 3 Of 3)
Page 1957
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4790
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
Speed Sensor Circuit Description
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The speed sensor detects wheel speed and sends the appropriate signals to the Electronic Control
Unit (ECU). These signals are used to control of the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) system. The
front and rear rotors each have 48 serrations. When the Rotors rotate, the magnetic field emitted
by the permanent magnet in the speed sensor generates an AC voltage. Since the frequency of
this AC voltage changes in direct proportion to the speed of the rotor, the frequency is used by the
ECU to detect the speed of each wheel.
FAIL SAFE FUNCTION
If trouble occurs in the speed sensor circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS control (solenoid)
relay and prohibits ABS control.
Page 2529
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3067
Page 2062
CHART 27
Page 4716
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 2704
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 1404
Valve: Service and Repair Cleaning
1. Using a gasket scraper, chip off any carbon from the valve head. 2. Using a wire brush,
thoroughly clean the valve.
Page 1926
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
On models with serviceable wheel bearings, use a Lithium Multipurpose Grease.
Page 1107
Hose/Line HVAC: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Suction Hose Improved
HEATING & AIR CONDITIONING AC006-97
December 5, 1997
Title: A/C SUCTION HOSE IMPROVEMENT
Models: '95 - '97 Tacoma
Introduction
The air conditioning Suction Hose on Tacoma has been changed:
^ The Suction Hose length has been increased from 316 mm to 356 mm to reduce vibrations
transmitted by compressor movement.
Affected Vehicles
1995-1997 model year Tacomas.
Parts Information
In addition One (1) O-ring (P/N 90099-14122) for the pressure switch is required.
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Fuel Injector: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
INJECTORS INSPECTION
1. INSPECT INJECTOR RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Resistance: At 2O°C (68°F): Approx. 13.8 ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the injector.
2. INSPECT INJECTOR INJECTION
CAUTION: Keep injector clear of sparks during the test.
(a) Disconnect the fuel inlet pipe from the fuel tube.
(b) Connect SST (attachment and hose) to the fuel tube. SST 09288-41046 (09268-52011) (c)
Connect the fuel return hose, SST (union) and SST (hose) to the fuel pressure regulator. SST
09268-41046 (09268-41091) (d) Install the O-ring to the injector.
(e) Connect SST (union and hose) to the injector and hold the injector and union with SST (clamp).
SST 09268-41046 (f) Put the injector into the graduated cylinder.
HINT: Install a suitable vinyl hose onto the injector to prevent gasoline from splashing out.
Page 508
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 1864
Bleeding the Brake System
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Bleeding the Brake System
CAUTION: Do not let brake fluid remain on a painted surface. Wash it off immediately.
NOTE: If any work is done on the brake system or if air is suspected in the brake lines, bleed the
system of air.
Fill Brake Reservoir
BRAKE FLUID BLEEDING
1. Fill brake reservoir with brake fluid.
Check the fluid level in the reservoir after bleeding each wheel. Add fluid, if necessary. Fluid:
SAEJ17O3 or FMVSS No.116 DOT 3
2. Bleed master cylinder.
NOTE: If the master cylinder has been disassembled or if the reservoir becomes empty, bleed the
air from the master cylinder.
(a) Disconnect the brake lines from the master cylinder.
(b) Slowly depress the brake pedal and hold it.
(c) Block off the outlet plugs with your fingers, and release the Brake Pedal. (d) Repeat (b) and (c)
3 or 4 times.
3. Connect vinyl tube to brake caliper or wheel cylinder bleeder plug.
Page 2013
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Components For Removal And Installation Part 1 Of 2
Page 1039
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
SPARK PLUGS INSPECTION
1. DISCONNECT HIGH -TENSION CORDS 2. REMOVE IGNITION COILS
3. REMOVE SPARK PLUGS
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the 6 spark plugs from the RH and LH cylinder heads.
4. CLEAN SPARK PLUGS
If the electrode has traces of wet carbon, allow it to dry and then clean with a spark plug cleaner.
Air pressure: Below 588 kPa (6 kgf/sq.cm, 85 psi)
Duration: 20 seconds or less
HINT: If there are traces of oil, remove it with gasoline before using the spark plug cleaner.
5. VISUALLY INSPECT SPARK PLUGS
Check the spark plug for thread damage and insulator damage. If abnormal, replace the spark
plug.
Recommended spark plug:
ND: K16TR11 NGK: BKR5EKB-11
Page 651
CHART 8
CHART 9
Testing and Inspection
Piston Pin: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT PISTON PIN OIL CLEARANCE
1. Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside diameter of the connecting rod bushing.
Bushing inside diameter: 22.005 - 22.017 mm (0.8663 - 0.8668 inch)
2. Using a micrometer, measure the piston pin diameter.
Piston pin diameter: 21.997 - 22.009 mm (0.8660 - 0.8665 inch)
3. Subtract the piston pin diameter measurement from the bushing inside diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance: 0.005 - 0.011 mm (0.0002 - 0.0004 inch) Maximum oil clearance: 0.05 mm
(0.0020 inch) If the oil clearance is greater than maximum, replace the bushing. If necessary,
replace the piston and piston pin as a set.
Page 1412
Drive Belt: Specifications Alternator Belt
GENERATOR / SERVICE DATA
DRIVE BELT
New belt
2RZ-FE, 3RZ-FE:
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 165 ± 10 lb.
5VZ-FE:
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 160 ± 25 lb.
Used belt
2RZ-FE, 3RZ-FE:
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 115 ± 20 lb.
5VZ-FE:
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 100 ± 20 lb.
Page 733
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3742
Shift Indicator: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 3261
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Locations
One Touch 2-4 Selector System
Page 2700
Page 2947
CHART 22
Page 3747
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 830
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 794
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 4766
ABS Control (Motor) Relay Circuit Inspection Procedure (Part 2 Of 2)
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) control (motor) relay supplies power to the ABS pump motor.
While the ABS is activated, the Electronic Control Unit (ECU) switches the ABS control (motor)
relay ON and operates the ABS pump motor.
FAIL SAFE FUNCTION
If trouble occurs in the ABS control (motor) relay circuit, the ECU cuts off current to the ABS control
(solenoid) relay and prohibits ABS control.
Disassembly
Output Shaft: Service and Repair Disassembly
NOTE: For removal and installation procedures refer to "Manual Transmission/Transaxle, Service
and Repair."
1. Inspect each gear thrust clearance.
Measure the thrust clearance of each gear.
Standard Clearance:
1st gear: 0.16-0.45 mm (0.0059-0.0177 inch) 2nd and 3rd gears: 0.10-0.25 mm (0.0039-0.0098
inch)
Maximum Clearance:
1st gear: 0.50 mm (0.0197 inch) 2nd and 3rd gears: 0.30 mm (0.0118 inch)
Page 2479
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2102
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 380
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Knock Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2499
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 178
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
EFI MAIN RELAY INSPECTION
1. REMOVE EFI MAIN RELAY (Marking: EFI) 2. INSPECT EFI MAIN RELAY
A. Inspect relay continuity
(a) Using an ohmmeter. check that there is continuity between terminals 1 and 2.
If there is no continuity. replace the relay.
(b) Check that there is no continuity between terminals and 5.
If there is continuity. replace the relay.
B. Inspect relay operation
(a) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 1 and 2. (b) Using an ohmmeter, check that
there is continuity between terminals 3 and 5.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
3. REINSTALL EFI MAIN RELAY
Page 3659
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 4504
Torque: 5.4 Nm (55 kgf-cm, 48 inch lbs.)
8. CONNECT NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
Page 4336
Flywheel: Specifications Tightening Specifications
Sequence
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Flywheel To Crankshaft: 83 N.m (61 ft. lbs.)
Page 3988
^ Torque the bolts to the specification found in the applicable Repair Manual.
NOTE
In most applications there will be 1 black torque converter bolt, be sure to install this bolt first to aid
in aligning the torque converter to the flywheel assembly.
Page 4085
b. Check that there is no continuity when connecting the positive (+) lead from the ohmmeter to
terminal 3 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 1. c. Check the there is no continuity between
terminals 2 and 3. If the continuity is not as specified, replace the clutch start cancel switch.
9. Check operation of clutch start cancel switch.
a. Connect positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal 3 and connect negative lead to terminal 1.
b. Check that there is no continuity when connecting the positive (+) lead from the ohmmeter to
terminal 2 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 1.
c. When pushing the switch and check that the indicator light comes on and there is continuity
between terminal 1 and 2.
d. Check that there is no continuity between terminals 1 and 2 when disconnect the battery lead. If
continuity is not as specified, replace the clutch start cancel switch.
Page 636
Engine Bank Identification
Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Firing Order: 1-2-3-4-5-6
Cooling System - Radiator Cap Inspection Procedure
Radiator Cap: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - Radiator Cap Inspection Procedure
ENGINE EG014-05
Title: RADIATOR CAP INSPECTION
Models: All Toyota Models
March 28, 2005
Introduction
The procedure for inspecting the radiator cap has been revised. Please refer to the following
procedures when inspecting the radiator cap on all Toyota models.
Applicable Vehicles
^ All Toyota and Scion models.
Required Equipment
Warranty Information
Page 2914
Applicable Vehicles
Page 2203
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2091
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
Sensor Cut-Away
Reference
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
To obtain a high purification rate for the CO, HC and NOx components of the exhaust gas, a
three-way catalytic converter is used, but for the most efficient use of the three-way catalytic
converter, the air-fuel ratio must be precisely controlled so that it is always close to the
stoichiometric air-fuel ratio.
The oxygen sensor has the characteristic whereby its output voltage changes suddenly in the
vicinity of the stoichiometric air-fuel ratio. This characteristic is used to detect the oxygen
concentration in the exhaust gas and provide feedback to the computer for control of the air-fuel
ratio.
When the air-fuel ratio becomes LEAN, the oxygen concentration in the exhaust increases and the
oxygen sensor informs the ECM of the LEAN condition (small electromotive force: 0 V).
When the air-fuel ratio is RICHER than the stoichiometric air-fuel ratio the oxygen concentration in
the exhaust gas is reduced and the oxygen sensor informs the ECM of the RICH condition (large
electromotive force: 1 V).
The ECM judges by the electromotive force from the oxygen sensor whether the air-fuel ratio is
RICH or LEAN and controls the injection time accordingly. However, if malfunction of the oxygen
sensor causes output of abnormal electromotive force, the ECM is unable to perform accurate
air-fuel ratio control.
The heated oxygen sensors include a heater which heats the Zirconia element. The heater is
controlled by the ECM. When the intake air volume is low (the temperature of the exhaust gas is
low) current flows to the heater to heat the sensor for accurate oxygen concentration detection.
Page 2073
Oxygen Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Heated Oxygen Sensor to Exhaust Pipe 14 ft.lb
Page 4259
b. Using SST 09950-60020 (09951-00710), 09950-70010 (09951-07150), install a new oil seal. c.
Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip.
10. install rear axle shaft in backing plate.
a. Apply MP grease to the oil seal lip. b. Install the backing plate and bearing retainer on the rear
axle shaft.
c. Using SST and a press, install the rear axle shaft into the backing plate. d. Using snap ring
pliers, install a new snap ring.
11. w/ ABS: Install ABS speed sensor rotor and bearing retainer (differential side). Using SST
09316-60011 (09316-00051) and a press, install a new
sensor rotor and new bearing retainer to the axle shaft.
Standard length: 122.2 ±1.0 mm (4.811 ±0.039 inch)
Removal and Installation
Page 1911
Page 1620
(c) Install the water pump with the 7 bolts. Torque: 20 Nm (14 ft. lbs.)
2. Connect No. 2 oil cooler hose. 3. Install thermostat and water inlet. 4. Install timing belt. Refer to
Engine.
Page 2455
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 3684
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 4495
Page 2546
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 4123
6. Check drive pinion preload. Using a torque wrench, measure the preload of backlash between
the drive pinion and ring gear.
Preload (at starting): 0.6 - 0.9 Nm (5.7 - 8.3 inch lbs.)
7. Check total preload. Using a torque wrench, measure the preload with the teeth of the drive
pinion and ring gear in contact.
Total preload (at starting): Drive pinion preload plus: 0.4 - 0.6 Nm (3.5 - 5.2 inch lbs.)
If necessary, disassemble and inspect the differential.
Page 2087
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2532
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 720
Page 1063
1. Remove engine under cover. 2. Drain engine coolant. 3. Disconnect upper radiator hose. 4.
Remove drive belt for Power Steering (PS) pump. 5. w/ A/C: Remove drive belt for A/C
compressor. 6. Remove drive belt for generator. 7. Remove No. 2 fan shroud. 8. Remove fan with
fluid coupling and fan pulleys. 9. Disconnect PS pump from engine.
Page 3447
(a) Disconnect these vacuum hoses from the throttle body:
(1) Vacuum hose of throttle opener (2) w/EGR:
Vacuum hose (from port R of EGR vacuum modulator)
(3) w/EGR:
Vacuum hose (from port E of EGR vacuum modulator)
(b) Disconnect these hoses from the IAC valve:
(1) Water bypass hose (w/ EGR: from EGR valve.
w/o EGR: from water bypass pipe)
(2) Water hose (from intake manifold) (3) Air assist hose
(c) Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts. throttle body and gasket.
Torque: 18 N.m (180 kgf.cm, 13 ft.lbf)
INSTALLATION HINT: Place a new gasket on the air intake chamber facing the protusion upward.
THROTTLE BODY INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 2197
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 4922
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Tools and Equipment
Union nut wrench 10 mm, to disconnect Brake lines from Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) actuator
............................................................ 09023 - 00100 ABS actuator checker and sub-harness
...........................................................................................................................................................
09990 - 00150 ABS actuator checker sub-harness "C"
...........................................................................................................................................................
09990 - 00200 ABS actuator checker sub-harness "E"
...........................................................................................................................................................
09990 - 00210 ABS actuator checker sheet "L" ..................................................................................
.................................................................................... 09990 - 00370
Exhaust System - Sulfur Smell
Fuel: Technical Service Bulletins Exhaust System - Sulfur Smell
ENGINE EG003-03
February 24, 2003
Title: SULFUR ODOR FROM EXHAUST
Models: All Models
Introduction
Some owners of Toyota vehicles may experience a sulfur-like or "rotten egg" odor from the exhaust
system. Sulfur is a natural component of crude oil from which gasoline is refined and the amount of
sulfur can be decreased through the refining process. The amount of sulfur in fuel sold in California
is regulated, however gasoline sold in other states can have substantially higher sulfur content.
Sulfur content also varies considerably between gasoline brands and locations.
Applicable Vehicles
^ All Models.
Repair Procedure
A sulfur odor emitted from the vehicle's tailpipe does not necessarily indicate that there is an issue
with the engine's running condition, but is most likely directly related to the fuel.
^ If the vehicle is exhibiting an excessive sulfur odor, the following checks should be performed:
^ If the MIL light is ON, check for DTCs and repair as necessary.
If no trouble is found after performing the above check, recommend the customer try a different
source of fuel.
Replacement of oxygen sensors, air/fuel ratio sensors or catalytic converters will not reduce the
odor and will therefore not be considered warrantable.
Warranty Information
Page 2049
CHART 18
CHART 19
Page 3897
Location Of Splice Points (Fig 36)
System Outline
Previous automatic transmissions have selected each gear shift using mechanically controlled
throttle hydraulic pressure, governor hydraulic pressure and lock-up hydraulic pressure. The
Electronically Controlled Transmission, however, electrically controls the governor pressure and
lock-up pressure through the solenoid valve. Control of the solenoid valve by the Engine Control
Module based on the input signals from each sensor makes smooth driving possible by shift
selection for each gear which is most appropriate to the driving conditions at that time.
1. GEAR SHIFT OPERATION
During driving, the Engine Control Module selects the shift for each gear which is most appropriate
to the driving conditions, based on input signals from the Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor to
TERMINAL THW of the Engine Control Module and also the input signals to TERMINAL SP2+ of
the Engine Control Module from the Vehicle Speed Sensor devoted to the Electronically Controlled
Transmission. Current is then output to the Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid. When
shifting to 1st speed, current flows from TERMINAL S1 of the Engine Control Module -->
TERMINAL 1 of the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid --> GROUND, and continuity
to the No.1 solenoid causes the shift.
For 2nd speed, current flows from TERMINAL S1 of the Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 1 of
the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid --> GROUND, and from TERMINAL S2 of the
Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 2 of the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid -->
GROUND. and continuity to Solenoid No.1 and No.2 causes the shift.
For 3rd speed. there is no continuity to No.1 solenoid, only to No.2 causing the shift. Shifting into
4th speed (Overdrive) takes place when there is no continuity to either No.1 or No.2 Solenoid.
2. LOCK-UP OPERATION
When the Engine Control Module judges from each signal that lock-up operation conditions have
been met, current flows from TERMINAL SL of the Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 3 of the
Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid --> GROUND, causing continuity to the lock-up
solenoid and causing lock-up operation.
3. STOP LIGHT SW CIRCUIT
If the brake pedal is depressed (Stop Light SW ON) when driving in lock-up condition, a signal is
input to TERMINAL BK of the Engine Control Module, the Engine Control Module operates and
continuity to the lock-up solenoid is cut.
4. OVERDRIVE CIRCUIT
^ O/D Main SW ON When the O/D main SW is turned ON, a signal is input to TERMINAL OD2 of
the Engine Control Module and Engine Control Module
Page 101
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Testing and Inspection
Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Inspect relay operation.
a. Jack up the vehicle. b. Use a heater main relay and connect it, as shown below. c. Rotate the
tire and check that differential lock has occurred. if operation is not as specified, replace the
actuator.
2. Inspect Diff. Lock control switch continuity. Inspect the switch continuity between terminal 1 to
terminal 4.
HINT: If it is not continuity, replace the switch.
3. Inspect Diff. Lock position switch.
a. Check that there is continuity between terminals when the switch is pushed (differential
connected position). b. Check that there is no continuity when the switch is free (differential
disconnected position).
HINT: If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
4. Inspect transfer 4WD switch. 5. Inspect vehicle speed sensor.
Page 498
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER INSPECTION
1. INSPECT MAF METER RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals THA and E2.
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the MAF meter.
2. INSPECT MAF METER OPERATION
(a) Connect the MAF meter connector.
(b) Using a voltmeter, connect the positive (+) tester probe to terminal VG and negative (-) tester
probe to terminal E3. (c) Blow air into the MAF meter and check that the voltage fluctuates.
If operation is not as specified. replace the MAF meter.
(d) Disconnect the MAF meter connector.
Page 2237
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR REMOVAL
1. REMOVE NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER 2. REMOVE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the camshaft position sensor connector.
(b) Remove the bolts and camshaft position sensor.
Torque: 7.8 N.m (80 kgf.cm, 69 in.lbf)
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Specifications
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Mechanical: Specifications Setting Specifications
Setting Specifications
Actuator Setting Speed 900 - 1,950 rpm
Page 152
Engine Control-Connectors
Locations
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 572
Page 4158
c. Adjust the drive pinion preload by tightening the companion flange nut. d. Using SST
09330-00021 to hold the flange, tighten the nut.
NOTICE: As there is no spacer, tighten a little at a time, being careful not to overtighten.
e. Using a torque wrench, measure the preload.
Preload (starting):
New bearing: 0.9 - 1.6 Nm (8.7 - 13.9 inch lbs.) Reused bearing: 0.5 - 0.8 Nm (4.3 - 6.9 inch lbs.)
HINT: Measure the total preload after first turning the bearing clockwise and counterclockwise
several times to mark the bearing smooth.
8. Install differential case in carrier.
a. Apply MP grease on the rack of the shift fork and connecting part of the indicator switch.
b. Insert the shift fork into the differential carrier, as shown.
c. Place the outer races, adjusting nuts and left side to sleeve.
HINT: Check that the sleeve moves smoothly.
Page 785
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 1876
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 4242
3. Disconnect drive shaft.
w/o Free wheel hub: a. Using a screwdriver, remove the grease cap. b. Remove the cotter pin and
lock cap. c. With applying the brakes, remove the lock nut.
Torque to 235 Nm (174 ft. lbs.)
w/ Free wheel hub: a. Remove the free wheel hub.
b. Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring. c. Remove the spacer.
4. w/ABS: Remove ABS speed sensor and wire harness clamp from steering knuckle.
Torque to 8.0 Nm (71 inch lbs.)
5. Remove front brake caliper and disc.
6. Disconnect lower ball joint. Remove the 4 bolts and disconnect the lower ball joint.
Torque to 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs.)
7. Remove steering knuckle.
a. Remove the cotter pin and loosen the nut.
Torque to 105 Nm (80 ft. lbs.)
b. Using SST 09950-40010 (09951-04010, 09952-04010, 09553-04020, 09554-04010,
09955-04030, 09958-04010), disconnect the steering
knuckle.
c. Remove the nut and steering knuckle.
Page 2887
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 2974
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 4121
Differential Carrier (3RZ-FE, 5VZ-FE w/o Differential Lock)
INSPECTION
1. Check runout of companion flange. Using a dial indicator, measure the vertical and lateral runout
of the companion flange.
Front Planetary Gear
Front Planetary Gear
Page 2826
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4693
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 4315
1. Place matchmarks on shaft and yoke.
2. Remove snap rings.
a. Using a brass bar and hammer, slightly tap in the bearing outer races. b. Using 2 screwdrivers,
remove the 4 snap rings from the grooves.
3. Remove spider bearings.
a. Using Special Service Tool (SST) 09332-25010, push out the bearing from the propeller shaft.
HINT: Sufficiently raise the part indicated by a so that it does not come into contact with the
bearing.
b. Clamp the bearing outer race in a vise and tap off the propeller shaft with a hammer.
HINT: Remove the bearing on opposite side in the same procedure.
c. Install the 2 removed bearing outer races to the spider. d. Using SST 09332-25010, push out the
bearing from the yoke. e. Clamp the outer bearing race in a vise and tap off the yoke with a
hammer.
HINT: Remove the bearing on the opposite side in the same procedure.
4. Select spider bearing.
Select the bearing according to whether or not there is a drill mark on the yoke section.
Page 2530
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3737
Position Of Parts In Instrument Panel (2 Of 2) (Fig 29)
Relay Blocks
Relay Blocks
Page 4930
Torque: 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.)
4. Remove master cylinder.
(a) Remove the 4 mounting nuts and 3-way and check valve bracket.
Torque: 13 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
(b) Pull out the master cylinder and gasket.
Page 2830
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 2934
CHART 5
CHART 6
Page 1824
Step 3
Step 4
Step 5
Step 6
Page 608
Knock Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 3363
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 2128
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 2290
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Knock sensors are fitted one each to the right bank and left bank of the cylinder block to detect
engine knocking. This sensor contains a piezoelectric element which generates a voltage when it
becomes deformed, which occurs when the cylinder block vibrates due to knocking. If engine
knocking occurs, ignition timing is retarded to suppress it.
Page 440
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2249
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 2186
Page 4881
Loosen/Tighten Bleeder Plug
Insert other end of the tube in a half-full container of brake fluid.
NOTE: Begin air bleeding from the wheel cylinder with the longest hydraulic line.
4. Bleed brake line.
(a) Slowly depress the brake pedal several times. (b) While an assistant depresses the pedal,
loosen the bleeder plug until fluid starts to run out. Then tighten the bleeder plug. (c) Repeat this
procedure until there are no more air bubbles in the fluid.
Bleeder plug tightening torque: 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs.)
5. Repeat procedure for each wheel. 6. Bleed Load Sensing Proportioning (LSP) & By-Pass Valve
(BV).
LOAD SENSING PROPORTIONING AND BY-PASS VALVE (LSP & BV) ON-VEHICLE
INSPECTION
HINT: Pre runner is described below.
RZN191L-TRPDKAB, RZN196LCRPDKAB, VZN195L-CRPDKAB
1. SET REAR AXLE LOAD
Rear axle load (includes vehicle weight):
2. INSTALL LSP & BV GAUGE (SST) AND BLEED AIR SST 09709-29018
Page 1528
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications Tightening Specifications
Camshaft Timing Pulley
Torque .................................................................................................................................................
......................... 110 N-m (1,100 kgf-cm, 91 ft-lbf)
Page 3287
Fuel Pressure Regulator: Diagrams
Components For Removal And Installation Part 1 Of 2
Page 670
Page 1113
Hose/Line HVAC: Testing and Inspection
Refrigerant Lines
1. INSPECT HOSE AND TUBE CONNECTIONS FOR LOOSENESS
2. INSPECT HOSES AND TUBES FOR LEAKAGE
Using a gas leak detector, check for leakage of refrigerant. See: Heating and Air
Conditioning/Testing and Inspection/Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview/Leakage of
Refrigerant
Page 3331
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 4622
3. If necessary, replace planetary gear outer bearing.
a. Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring. b. Using Special Service Tool (SST)
09554-30011, 09555-55010 and a press, remove the bearing.
c. Using SST 09223-15020, 09515-30010, 09950-70010 (09951-07100) and a press, install a new
bearing with the groove faced forward.
d. Select a snap ring that will allow minimum axial play.
Using a snap ring expander, install the snap ring.
4. If necessary, replace planetary gear thrust inner bearing.
a. Using SST 09612-65014 (09612-01030, 09612-01050) and a press, remove the bearing.
NOTICE: Hang SST securely to the clearance between the thrust inner bearing and planetary gear.
b. Using SST 09950-60010 (09951-00570), 09950-70010 (09951-07100) and a press, install a new
bearing.
Bearing depth: 7.7-8.3 mm (0.303-0.327 inch)
Page 1821
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 1 Of 2
Specifications
Timing Belt: Specifications
Timing Belt Replacement Interval
60,000 miles (96,000 km)
Page 1084
Drive Belt: Service and Repair
DRIVE BELT REMOVAL
1. REMOVE PS PUMP DRIVE BELT
2. REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER
3. LOOSEN IDLE PULLEY LOCK NUT
Torque: 39 N.m (400 kg.cm, 29 ft.lb)
4. LOOSEN AND REMOVE COMPRESSOR DRIVE BELT
DRIVE BELT INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 940
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 4352
Position Of Parts In Instrument Panel (2 Of 2) (Fig 29)
Relay Blocks
Relay Blocks
Page 753
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 331
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Diagram Information and Instructions
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 3888
Junction Block And Wire Harness Connector
Page 4084
position.
Standard Distance: 5 mm (0.98 inch) or more. (from pedal stroke end position to release point)
If the distance not as specified, perform the following operations. ^
Check pedal height.
^ Check push rod play and pedal freeplay.
^ Bleed the clutch line.
^ Check the clutch cover and disc.
6. Check clutch start system
a. Check that the engine does not start when the clutch pedal is released. b. Check that the engine
starts when the clutch pedal is fully depressed.
If necessary, replace the clutch start switch.
7. Check continuity of clutch start switch check the continuity between terminals when the switch is
ON and OFF.
Switch ON (Pushed): Continuity. Switch OFF (Free): No Continuity.
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
8. Check continuity of clutch start cancel switch.
a. Check that there is no continuity when connecting the positive (+) lead from the ohmmeter to
terminal 2 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 1.
Page 3607
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 353
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 3956
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch goes on when the shift lever is in the N or P shift position. When it
goes on terminal NSW of the ECM is grounded to body ground via the starter relay, thus the
terminal NSW voltage becomes 0 V. When the shift lever is in the D, 2, L or R position, the
park/neutral position switch goes off, so the voltage of ECM, terminal NSW becomes battery
voltage, the voltage of the ECM internal power source.
If the shift lever is moved from the N position to the D position, this signal is used for air-fuel ratio
correction and for idle speed control (estimated control), etc.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Ignition Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 1287
Camshaft: Service and Repair Assembly
1. Assemble exhaust camshafts.
(a) Mount the hexagonal wrench head portion of the camshaft in a vise.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
(b) Install these parts:
(1) Camshaft gear spring. (2) Camshaft sub-gear.
NOTE: Attach the pins on the gears to the gear spring ends.
(3) Wave washer.
(c) Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring.
(d) Using Special Service Tool (SST) Variable Pin Wrench Set # 09960 - 10010 (Variable Pin
Wrench Arm Assembly # 09962 - 01000, Pin #
09963 - 00600) or equivalents, align the holes of the camshaft main gear and sub-gear by turning
camshaft sub-gear clockwise, and temporarily install a service bolt.
(e) Align the gear teeth of the main gear and sub-gear, and tighten the service bolt.
Page 3996
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 3613
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 1652
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2025
Applicable Vehicles
Page 573
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The crankshaft position sensor, which detects the engine speed and crankshaft angle signal (NE
signal), has been installed on the oil pump body. The NE signal plate has 34 teeth. The NE signal
sensor generates 34 signals for every engine revolution. The ECM detects the standard crankshaft
angle based on the G signals and the actual crankshaft angle and the engine speed by the NE
signals.
Page 594
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 3564
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Testing and Inspection
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT LOW OIL PRESSURE WARNING LIGHT
1. Disconnect the connector from the warning switch and ground terminal on the wire harness side
connector. 2. Turn the ignition switch ON and check that the warning light lights up.
If the warning light does not light up, test the bulb.
Page 4849
Brake Pad: Specifications
Front Brake Pad Thickness Standard Thickness 0.453 in
Minimum Thickness 0.039 in
Page 497
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
System Schematic
Sensor Cut-Away
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The mass air flow meter uses a platinum hot wire. The hot wire air flow meter consists of a
platinum hot wire, thermistor and a control circuit installed in a plastic housing. The hot wire air flow
meter works on the principle that the hot wire and thermistor located in the intake air bypass of the
housing detect any changes in the intake air temperature. The hot wire is maintained at the set
temperature by controlling the current flow through the hot wire. This current flow is then measured
as the output voltage of the air flow meter. The circuit is constructed so that the platinum hot wire
and thermistor provide a bridge circuit, with the power transistor controlled so that the potential of
(A) and (B) remains equal to maintain the set temperature.
Page 1698
7. Pump the radiator cap tester several times, and check the maximum pressure.
Pumping speed: 1 pump/second
HINT:
Stop pumping when the valve opens and read the gauge. The gauge must be within the standard
values listed below when the pressure valve opens. The cap is considered OK when the pressure
holds steady or falls very slowly, but holds within the standard values listed below for one minute.
Specification:
If the maximum pressure is less than the minimum standard value, replace the radiator cap
sub-assembly.
Type: Plastic Cap, 108 kPa
1. Remove coolant and any foreign material on 0-ring "A."
2. Check that 0-ring "A" is not deformed, cracked, or swollen.
3. Apply engine coolant to 0-ring "A" and rubber point "B" before using the radiator cap tester.
^ Radiator Cap Tester: Snap-On/Sun P/N SVTS262A (or equivalent)
4. Before installing the radiator cap tester, use the applicable radiator cap adaptor provided in the
following SST kits in conjunction with the radiator cap tester:
^ SST P/N 09230-00030-01 (09231-10080-01) or 09230-00020-01 (09231-10060-01) or
09230-00050-01(09231-10110-01
Page 3802
Page 891
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Front
Companion Flange: Specifications Front
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Flange Nuts .........................................................................................................................................
................................................. 108 Nm (80 ft lbs.)
Front
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair Front
HUB BOLT REPLACEMENT
1. Remove front wheel. 2. Remove brake caliper and disc. 3. Remove hub bolt. Using Special
Service Tool (SST), remove the hub bolt.
4. Install hub bolt.
Install a washer and nut to the hub bolt, as shown in the illustration, and install the hub bolt by
tightening the nut.
5. Install brake disc and caliper. 6. Install front wheel.
Torque: 110 Nm (83 ft. lbs.)
Page 938
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 381
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2709
Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2561
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 1 Of 2
Page 3639
Page 2027
Engine Bank Identification
Page 654
CHART 12
CHART 13
Page 3689
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2890
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 2426
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2893
Knock Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 1616
Water Pump: Testing and Inspection
1. Inspect water pump.
(a) Visually check the drain hole for coolant leakage. If leakage is found, replace the water pump. If
engine coolant has leaked onto the timing belt, replace the timing belt.
(b) Turn the pulley, and check that the water pump bearing moves smoothly and quietly.
If necessary, replace the water pump.
2. Inspect fluid coupling.
(a) Remove the 4 nuts and fan from the fluid coupling.
(b) Check the fluid coupling for damage and silicon oil leakage.
If necessary, replace the fluid coupling.
(c) Install the fan and fluid coupling with the 4 nuts. Torque: 7.4 Nm (65 inch lbs.)
3. Inspect fan pulley bracket.
Check the turning smoothness of the fan pulley. If necessary, replace the fan pulley bracket.
4. Inspect timing belt. Refer to Engine.
Page 2280
Knock Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2092
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
HEATED OXYGEN SENSORS INSPECTION (Bank 1, Sensor 1, Bank 1 Sensor 2)
INSPECT HEATER RESISTANCE OF HEATED OXYGEN SENSORS
(a) Disconnect the oxygen sensor connector.
Bank 1 Sensor 1
Bank 1 Sensor 2
(b) Using an ohmmeter. measure the resistance between the terminals +B and HT.
Resistance: At 20°C (68°F): 11 - 16 ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the sensor.
Torque: 20 N.m (200 kgf.cm, 14 ft.lbf)
(c) Reconnect the oxygen sensor connector.
Page 4733
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
The No.1 vehicle speed sensor outputs a 4-pulse signal for every revolution of the rotor shaft,
which is rotated by the transmission output shaft via the driven gear.
After this signal is converted into a more precise rectangular waveform by the waveform shaping
circuit inside the combination meter, it is then transmitted to the ECM. The ECM determines the
vehicle speed based on the frequency of these pulse signals.
The No.2 vehicle speed sensor detects the rotation speed of the transmission output shaft and
sends signals to the ECM. The ECM determines the vehicle speed based on these signals.
An AC voltage is generated in the No.2 vehicle speed sensor coil as the rotor mounted on the
output shaft rotates, and this voltage is sent to the ECM.
The gear shift point and lock-up timing are controlled by the ECM based on the signals from this
vehicle speed sensor and the throttle position sensor signal.
If the No.2 vehicle speed sensor malfunctions, the ECM uses input signals from the No.1 vehicle
speed sensor as a back-up signal.
Page 3666
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 2900
Knock Sensor: Exploded Views
Components For Removal And Installation Part 1 Of 2
Testing and Inspection
Shift Interlock Control Module: Testing and Inspection
Shift Lock ECU, Harness Side: Floor Shift
Floor Shift:
Inspect shift lock control ECU. Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage at terminal.
HINT: Do not disconnect the ECU connector.
Page 1104
Warranty information
Applicable Warranty:
This repair Is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in effect for 36 months or
36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's In-service date.
Repair Procedure
1. Replace Condenser Bracket
A. Remove the 6 x 30 mm bolt with large washer (see illustration).
B. Remove the original condenser bracket and 6 x 16 mm condenser mounting bolts (see
illustration).
CAUTION:
Remove the 6 x 30 mm bolts first, then the 6 x 16 mm bolts to prevent damage to the condenser's
plastic supports.
C. Remove the 6 x 18 mm radiator mounting bolts (see illustration).
D. Replace the original condenser brackets with the (2) new brackets, retaining the original collars
and rubber mounts for use on the new brackets
(see illustration).
Page 3369
(b) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between terminals +B and FP.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
3. REINSTALL CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
Page 2174
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 3406
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 4864
2. Pull the parking brake lever all the way up until a clicking sound can no longer be heard. 3.
Check clearance between brake shoes and drum.
(a) Remove the drum.
Check Clearance Between Brake Shoes And Drum
(c) Measure the brake drum inside diameter and diameter of the brake shoes. Check that the
difference between the diameters is the correct shoe
clearance. Shoe clearance: 0.6 mm (0.024 inch)
- If it is incorrect, check the parking brake system.
Page 4667
Position Of Parts In Instrument Panel (2 Of 2) (Fig 29)
Relay Blocks
Relay Blocks
Page 1134
Coolant: Service and Repair
1. Drain engine coolant.
(a) Remove the radiator cap.
WARNING: To avoid the danger of being burned, do not remove the radiator cap while the engine
and radiator are still hot, as fluid and steam can be blown out under pressure.
(b) Loosen the drain plugs, and drain the engine coolant. (c)
Close the drain plugs.
2. Fill engine coolant.
(a) Slowly fill the system with engine coolant. ^
Use a good brand of ethylene-glycol base coolant and mix it according to the manufacturer's
directions.
^ Using coolant which includes more than 50 % ethylene-glycol (but not more than 70 %) is
recommended.
CAUTION: Do not use an alcohol type engine coolant.
- The engine coolant should be mixed with demineralized water or distilled water.
Capacity:
A/T: 9.5 liters (10.0 US qts.) M/T: 9.7 liters (10.3 US qts.)
(b) Reinstall the radiator cap. (c)
Start the engine, and bleed the cooling system.
(d) If necessary, refill the radiator reservoir with coolant until it reaches the "FULL" line.
3. Check engine coolant for leaks.
Page 4681
Shift Indicator: Electrical Diagrams
Electronically Controlled Transmission And A/T Indicator (Part 1 Of 3)
Component Locations
Fig. 68 Air Bag Sensor Assembly Replacement
Page 4137
b. Using SST 09950-30010 (09951-03010, 09953-03010, 09954-03010, 09955-03030,
09956-03020), install the rear bearing, oil slinger and
companion flange.
c. Coat the threads of the nut with hypoid gear oil.
d. Adjust the drive pinion preload by tightening the companion flange nut. Using SST 09330-00021
to hold the flange, tighten the nut.
NOTICE: As there is no spacer, tighten the nut a little at a time, being careful not to overtighten it.
e. Using a torque wrench, measure the preload.
New bearing preload (at starting): 1.2 - 1.9 Nm (10.4 - 16.5 inch lbs.)
Reused bearing preload (at starting): 0.6 - 1.0 Nm (5.2 - 8.7 inch lbs.)
10. Install differential case in differential carrier. 11. Adjust ring gear backlash.
a. Install the side bearing retainer with the 10 bolts.
Torque to 69 Nm (51 ft. lbs.)
b. Using SST 09564-32011 and a dial indicator, measure the ring gear backlash. If it is not within
the specification, adjust by either in creasing or
decreasing the washers on both sides by an equal amount.
Backlash: 0.13 - 0.18 mm (0.0051 - 0.0071 inch)
HINT: There should be no clearance between the plate washer and case. Ensure that there is ring
gear backlash.
Page 682
Oxygen Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Heated Oxygen Sensor to Exhaust Pipe 14 ft.lb
Page 4850
Brake Pad: Testing and Inspection
MEASURE PAD LINING THICKNESS
Using a ruler, measure the pad lining thickness. Standard thickness: 11.5 mm (0.453 inch)
- Minimum thickness: 1.0 mm (0.039 inch)
- Replace the pad if the pad's thickness is at the minimum thickness or less (the 1.0 mm slit is no
longer visible), or if the pad shows signs of uneven wear.
Page 4684
Shift Indicator: Description and Operation
Previous automatic transmissions have selected each gear shift using mechanically controlled
throttle hydraulic pressure, governor hydraulic pressure and lock-up hydraulic pressure. The
Electronically Controlled Transmission, however, electrically controls the governor pressure and
lock-up pressure through the solenoid valve. Control of the solenoid valve by the Engine Control
Module based on the input signals from each sensor makes smooth driving possible by shift
selection for each gear which is most appropriate to the driving conditions at that time.
1. GEAR SHIFT OPERATION
During driving, the Engine Control Module selects the shift for each gear which is most appropriate
to the driving conditions, based on input signals from the Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor to
TERMINAL THW of the Engine Control Module and also the input signals to TERMINAL SP2+ of
the Engine Control Module from the Vehicle Speed Sensor devoted to the Electronically Controlled
Transmission. Current is then output to the Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid. When
shifting to 1st speed, current flows from TERMINAL S1 of the Engine Control Module -->
TERMINAL 1 of the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid --> GROUND, and continuity
to the No.1 solenoid causes the shift.
For 2nd speed, current flows from TERMINAL S1 of the Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 1 of
the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid --> GROUND, and from TERMINAL S2 of the
Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 2 of the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid -->
GROUND. and continuity to Solenoid No.1 and No.2 causes the shift.
For 3rd speed. there is no continuity to No.1 solenoid, only to No.2 causing the shift. Shifting into
4th speed (Overdrive) takes place when there is no continuity to either No.1 or No.2 Solenoid.
2. LOCK-UP OPERATION
When the Engine Control Module judges from each signal that lock-up operation conditions have
been met, current flows from TERMINAL SL of the Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 3 of the
Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid --> GROUND, causing continuity to the lock-up
solenoid and causing lock-up operation.
3. STOP LIGHT SW CIRCUIT
If the brake pedal is depressed (Stop Light SW ON) when driving in lock-up condition, a signal is
input to TERMINAL BK of the Engine Control Module, the Engine Control Module operates and
continuity to the lock-up solenoid is cut.
4. OVERDRIVE CIRCUIT
^ O/D Main SW ON When the O/D main SW is turned ON, a signal is input to TERMINAL OD2 of
the Engine Control Module and Engine Control Module operation causes gear shift when the
conditions for overdrive are met.
^ O/D Main SW OFF When the O/D main SW is turned to OFF, the current flowing through the O/D
OFF indicator light flows through the O/D main SW to GROUND, causing the indicator light to light
up. At the same time, a signal is input to TERMINAL OD2 of the Engine Control Module and
Engine Control Module operation prevents shift into overdrive.
5. A/T OIL TEMP. WARNING
When the A/T Oil Temp. Sensor affixed to the transmission case detects that the fluid temp. is
150°C (302°F) or more, the Engine Control Module operates and the current flowing through the
GAUGE fuse flows to the A/T Oil Temp. warning light --> TERMINAL OIL-W of the Engine Control
Module --> Ground, so that the warning light lights up, informing that the Oil Temp. is high. When
the Oil Temp. drops to 120°C (248°F) or less, the Engine Control Module stops operating and the
warning light goes out.
Page 4613
1. Inspect rear output shaft.
Using a micrometer, measure the outer diameter of the rear output shaft journal surface.
Minimum Diameter:
Part A: 27.98 mm (1.1016 inch) Part B: 36.98 mm (1.4561 inch)
2. Inspect drive sprocket radial clearance.
Using a dial indicator, measure the radial clearance between the sprocket and shaft with the needle
roller bearing installed.
Standard Clearance: 0.010-0.055 mm (0.0004-0.0022 inch) Maximum Clearance: 0.055 mm
(0.0022 inch) If the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the drive sprocket, rear output shaft
or needle roller bearing.
3. Inspect front drive shift fork and clutch sleeve clearance.
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the front drive shift fork and clutch sleeve.
Maximum Clearance: 1.0 mm (0.039 inch) If the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the shift
fork or clutch sleeve.
4. Inspect high and low shift fork and clutch sleeve clearance.
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the high and low shift fork and clutch sleeve.
Maximum Clearance: 1.0 mm (0.039 inch)
Page 2161
EGR Temperature Sensor: Testing and Inspection
EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR INSPECTION Except Model No. VZN17O - 4wd Long
Wheel Base
1. REMOVE EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
2. INSPECT EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Resistance:
At 50°C (122°F): 84 - 97 K ohms At 100°C (212°F): 11 - 16 K ohms At 150°C (302°F): 2 - 4 K ohms
If the resistance is not as specified. replace the sensor.
3. REINSTALL EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Torque: 20 N.m (200 kgf.cm, 14 ft.lbf)
Testing and Inspection
Pilot Bearing: Testing and Inspection
Inspect pilot bearing.
Turn the bearing by hand while applying force in the rotation direction. If the bearing sticks or has
much resistance, replace the pilot bearing.
HINT: the bearing is permanently lubricated and re-quires no clearing or lubrication.
Page 2688
CHART 27
Specifications
Water Pump: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Water Pump To Cylinder Block
..................................................................................................................................................... 20
Nm (14 ft. lbs.) Water Inlet To Water Pump
............................................................................................................................................................
20 Nm (14 ft. lbs.)
Diagram Information and Instructions
Cruise Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 839
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 2899
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 3523
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 640
^ O2S TEST RESULTS
A list of the available oxygen sensors will be displayed.
2. Select the desired oxygen sensor and press Enter.
NOTE:
The monitor result of the A/F sensor will not be displayed. If you select "Bank 1-Sensor 1" or Bank
2-Sensor 1" for a vehicle equipped with an A/F sensor, the Diagnostic Tester will display "No
parameter to display."
3. Compare the test results with the values listed in the Failure Threshold Chart.
* Although this procedure references the Toyota Diagnostic Tester, the O2S test results can be
checked using a generic OBD II scantool. Refer to your OBD II scantool operator's manual for
specific procedures.
Comparing O2S Test Results to Failure Thresholds
1. Determine the correct O2S Failure Threshold Chart for your vehicle by looking in the "O2S
Application Table," in this bulletin.
2. Select appropriate year, model, and engine for specified O2S Failure Threshold Chart.
3. Compare O2S test results with the specified O2S Failure Threshold Chart. It may be necessary
to convert O2S test results to a specific measurement unit using the conversion factor that is
supplied in the specified table. See example.
Example:
Page 2556
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 4264
6. Replace rear axle bearing.
a. Using SST 09223-56010, 09950-60010 (09951-00560), remove the bearing.
b. Using SST 09515-30010, 09950-60020 (09951-00890), install a new bearing.
7. Install new outer oil seal.
a. Using SST 09950-60010 (09951-00610), 09950-70010 (09951-07150), install a new oil seal. b.
install 4 nuts to the serration bolts. c. Using a hammer, remove the serration bolts and remove the
bearing case. d. Position the backing plate on a new bearing case and, using 2 socket wrenches,
install the serration bolts. Install a new bearing and oil seal
(outer side).
8. Replace bearing case.
a. Remove the oil seal (outer side) and bearing. b. Install 4 nuts to the serration bolts. c. using a
hammer, remove the serration bolts and the bearing case.
d. Position the backing plate on a new bearing case and, using 2 socket wrenches, install the
serration bolts. e. Install a new bearing and outer oil seal.
Page 1349
Piston: Service and Repair Installation
INSTALL PISTON AND CONNECTING ROD ASSEMBLIES
1. Cover the connecting rod bolts with a short piece of hose to protect the crankshaft from damage.
2. Using a piston ring compressor, push the correctly numbered piston and connecting rod
assemblies into each cylinder with the front mark of the
piston facing forward.
Page 3152
EGR Temperature Sensor: Testing and Inspection
EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR INSPECTION Except Model No. VZN17O - 4wd Long
Wheel Base
1. REMOVE EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
2. INSPECT EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Resistance:
At 50°C (122°F): 84 - 97 K ohms At 100°C (212°F): 11 - 16 K ohms At 150°C (302°F): 2 - 4 K ohms
If the resistance is not as specified. replace the sensor.
3. REINSTALL EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Torque: 20 N.m (200 kgf.cm, 14 ft.lbf)
Page 4412
Input Shaft: Testing and Inspection
Inspect synchronizer ring. a. Check for wear or damage.
b. Check the braking effect of the synchronizer ring.
^ Turn the synchronizer ring in one direction while pushing it to the gear cone. Check that the ring
locks.
^ If the braking effect is insufficient, apply a small amount of fine lapping compound between the
synchronizer ring and gear cone. lightly rub the synchronizer ring and gear cone together.
NOTICE: ensure the fine lapping compound is completely washed off after rubbing.
c. Check again the braking effect of the synchronizer ring.
d. Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the synchronizer ring back and gear
spline end.
Minimum Clearance: 0.8 mm (0.031 inch)
If the clearance is less than the minimum, replace the synchronizer ring and gear cone by applying
a small amount of fine lapping compound.
NOTICE: ensure the fine lapping compound is completely washed off after rubbing.
Page 1967
Page 1083
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection Power Steering
TENSION CHECK
Using a belt tension gauge, check the tension.
Belt tension gauge:
Nippondenso BTG-20 (95506-00020) or Borroughs No.BT-33-73F
Drive belt tension:
New belt: 135 - 180 lbs. Used belt: 85 - 120 lbs.
NOTICE: After installing the belt, check that it fits properly in the ribbed grooves.
HINT: New belt refers to a belt which has been less than 5 minutes on a running engine.
- Used belt refers to a belt which has been used on a running engine for 5 minutes or more.
Page 4682
Electronically Controlled Transmission And A/T Indicator (Part 2 Of 3)
Page 1931
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2103
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 1473
TOY 730 - 73mm Toyota Oil Filter Wrench
M 0219 - 74mm Oil Filter Wrench
Page 4140
16. Install new bearing spacer, rear bearing and oil slinger.
a. Install a new bearing spacer and place the rear bearing and oil slinger. b. Using SST
09950-30010 (09951-03010, 09953-03010, 09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03020) and the
companion flange, install the rear
bearing then remove the companion flange.
17. Install oil seal.
a. Coat a new oil seal lip with MP grease.
b. Using SST 09554-22010 and a hammer, install the oil seal.
Oil seal drive in depth: 4.5 mm (0.177 inch)
18. Install companion flange.
a. Place the companion flange on the drive pinion. b. Coat the threads of a new nut with hypoid
gear oil.
c. Using SST 09330-00021 to hold the flange, torque the nut.
Torque to 108 Nm (80 ft. lbs.)
19. Adjust drive pinion preload. Using a torque wrench, measure the preload of the backlash
between the drive pinion and ring gear.
If the preload is less than the specification, retighten the nut 13 Nm (9 ft. lbs.) a little at a time until
the specified preload is reached.
Maximum torque: 223 Nm (165 ft. lbs.)
Page 3039
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Specifications
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Crankshaft Pulley To Crankshaft
................................................................................................................................................ 250 Nm
(184 ft. lbs.)
Page 2775
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Specifications
Gear Sensor/Switch: Specifications
4WD-position Switch ...........................................................................................................................
................................................... 37 N.m (27 ft. lbs.) L4 Position Switch .............................................
...................................................................................................................................... 37 N.m (27 ft.
lbs.) Neutral Position Switch ................................................................................................................
........................................................... 37 N.m (27 ft. lbs.)
Page 3385
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 4381
6. Inspect reverse idler gear and shift arm clearance.
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the reverse idler gear and shift arm.
Standard Clearance: 0.05-0.35 mm (0.0020-0.0138 inch) Maximum Clearance: 0.50 mm (0.0197
inch)
If the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the shift arm or reverse idler gear.
Page 59
ECU Power Source Circuit
Page 4496
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch goes on when the shift lever is in the N or P shift position. When it
goes on terminal NSW of the ECM is grounded to body ground via the starter relay, thus the
terminal NSW voltage becomes 0 V. When the shift lever is in the D, 2, L or R position, the
park/neutral position switch goes off, so the voltage of ECM, terminal NSW becomes battery
voltage, the voltage of the ECM internal power source.
If the shift lever is moved from the N position to the D position, this signal is used for air-fuel ratio
correction and for idle speed control (estimated control), etc.
Page 3281
Components For Removal And Installtion Part 2 Of 2
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
INJECTORS REMOVAL
1. REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE 2. REMOVE INTAKE AIR CONNECTOR 3. REMOVE FUEL
PRESSURE REGULATOR 4. DISCONNECT FUEL INLET PIPE
CAUTION: Catch leaking fuel in a container.
5. REMOVE FUEL PIPE 6. DISCONNECT INJECTOR CONNECTORS
7. REMOVE DELIVERY PIPES AND INJECTORS
NOTICE: Be careful not to drop the injectors when removing the delivery pipes.
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and delivery pipes together with the 6 injectors (b) Remove the 4 spacers
from the intake manifold. (c) Pull out the 6 injectors from the delivery pipes.
Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Locations
Automatic Differential Disconnect (A.D.D.) Component Locations
Page 2253
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 842
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The camshaft position sensor, which detects the crankshaft angle signal (G signal), has been
installed on the front of right bank cylinder head. The timing rotor has been integrated with the right
bank camshaft timing pulley. When the camshafts rotate, the protrusion on the timing rotor and the
air gap on the pick up coil change, causing fluctuations, in the magnetic field and generating an
electromotive force in the pick up coil. The NE signal plate has 34 teeth and is mounted on the
crankshaft. The NE signal sensor generates 34 signals for every engine revolution. The ECM
detects the standard crankshaft angle based on the 6 signals and the actual crankshaft angle and
the engine speed by the NE signals.
Page 3973
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 1910
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 1678
w/ Tachometer
w/o Tachometer
HINT: Connect the test leads so that the current from the ohmmeter can flow according to the
above order. This circuit includes the diode.
If resistance value is not as specified, replace the receiver gauge.
Page 2591
Page 852
Page 719
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 311
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 3397
Page 4419
Output Shaft: Testing and Inspection
1. Inspect output shaft.
a. Using a micrometer, measure the output shaft flange thickness.
Minimum thickness: 4.70 mm (0.1850 inch)
If the thickness is less than the minimum, replace the output shaft.
b. Using a micrometer, measure the outer diameter of the output shaft journal.
Minimum Diameter: A 1st gear: 38.860 mm (1.5299 inch) B 2nd gear: 46.860 mm (1.8449 inch) C
3rd gear: 37.860 mm (1.4905 inch)
If the outer diameter is less than the minimum, replace the output shaft.
Page 632
A/F and 02 Sensor Identification
Page 4144
Differential Carrier: Service and Repair Rear Differential Carrier
With Differential Lock
Differential Carrier (3RZ-FE, 5VZ-FE w/Differential Lock)
INSPECTION
1. Check runout of companion flange. Using a dial indicator, measure the vertical and lateral runout
of the companion flange. If the runout are not
within the specification, replace the companion flange.
Diagrams
Fuel Return Line: Diagrams
CAUTION:
- Always use new gaskets when replacing the fuel tank or component parts.
- Apply the proper torque to all tightened parts.
Page 2609
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 1857
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Specifications
Center Support: Specifications
Center Bearing To Frame ....................................................................................................................
.................................................... 36 N.m (27 ft. lbs.) Intermediate Shaft To Center Support Bearing
To Joint Flange
1st Pass ...............................................................................................................................................
............................................. 181 N.m (134 ft. lbs.) 2nd Pass .............................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. Loosen
Nut 3rd Pass ........................................................................................................................................
....................................................... 69 N.m (51 ft. lbs.)
Page 611
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 4102
Pressure Plate: Testing and Inspection
Inspect diaphragm spring for wear.
Using calipers, measure the diaphragm spring for depth and width of wear.
Maximum Depth: A: 0.6 mm (0.024 inch) Maximum Width: B: 5.0 mm (0.197 inch)
If necessary, replace the clutch cover.
Page 3420
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The throttle position sensor is mounted in the throttle body and detects the throttle valve opening
angle. When the throttle valve is fully closed, a voltage of approximately 0.7 V is applied to terminal
VTA of the ECM. The voltage applied to the terminals VTA of the ECM increases in proportion to
the opening angle of the throttle valve and becomes approximately 2.7 ~ 5.2 V when the throttle
valve is fully opened. The ECM judges the vehicle driving conditions from these signals input from
terminals VTA and uses them as one of the conditions for deciding the air-fuel ratio correction,
power increase correction and fuel-cut control etc.
Page 1092
- Using SST, tighten the flare nut to specified torque. (SST 09631-22020)
HINT: Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 30 cm (11.81 in.).
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf) Torque for using SST: 28 N.m (285 kgf.cm, 21 ft.lbf)
NOTICE: Do not rotate the fuel pipe, when tightening the flare nut.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Shift Indicator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Connector Joining Wire Harness and Wire Harness
Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness
Location Of Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness, Ground Points (Fig 32)
Page 1947
Page 4003
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 894
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Diagram Information and Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2147
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2862
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR REMOVAL
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the crankshaft position sensor connector. (b) Remove the bolt crankshaft position
sensor.
Torque: 7.8 N.m (80 kgf.cm, 69 in.lbf)
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 3362
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 309
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 2209
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The throttle position sensor is mounted in the throttle body and detects the throttle valve opening
angle. When the throttle valve is fully closed, a voltage of approximately 0.7 V is applied to terminal
VTA of the ECM. The voltage applied to the terminals VTA of the ECM increases in proportion to
the opening angle of the throttle valve and becomes approximately 2.7 ~ 5.2 V when the throttle
valve is fully opened. The ECM judges the vehicle driving conditions from these signals input from
terminals VTA and uses them as one of the conditions for deciding the air-fuel ratio correction,
power increase correction and fuel-cut control etc.
Page 647
CHART 1
Page 2728
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 2557
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Service Data
Flywheel: Specifications Service Data
Flywheel Runout:
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
.............................................. 0.1 mm (0.004 inch)
Page 4829
Type "B" Brake Pad
A. Remove the clip, pins and anti-rattle spring/pad retainer clip.
B. Remove the brake pads with the anti-squeal shims.
C. Clean any dust from the brake pads.
D. Apply a small amount of the disc brake caliper grease (1-2 mm thick) to the areas indicated in
the illustration.
NOTE:
Do NOT apply grease to the friction surfaces of the brake pads or the disc rotor.
E. Install the brake pads with the anti-squeal shims.
NOTE:
Clean excess grease from the brake pads and caliper.
F. Install the pad guide pin, clip and anti-squeal spring.
G. Install the wheel assembly.
Page 3521
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant: Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant R134A 20.8 oz
Page 4118
Differential Carrier: Testing and Inspection Rear Differential Carrier
With Differential Lock
Differential Carrier (3RZ-FE, 5VZ-FE w/Differential Lock)
INSPECTION
1. Check runout of companion flange. Using a dial indicator, measure the vertical and lateral runout
of the companion flange. If the runout are not
within the specification, replace the companion flange.
Page 1976
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 1598
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
SPARK PLUGS INSPECTION
1. DISCONNECT HIGH -TENSION CORDS 2. REMOVE IGNITION COILS
3. REMOVE SPARK PLUGS
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the 6 spark plugs from the RH and LH cylinder heads.
4. CLEAN SPARK PLUGS
If the electrode has traces of wet carbon, allow it to dry and then clean with a spark plug cleaner.
Air pressure: Below 588 kPa (6 kgf/sq.cm, 85 psi)
Duration: 20 seconds or less
HINT: If there are traces of oil, remove it with gasoline before using the spark plug cleaner.
5. VISUALLY INSPECT SPARK PLUGS
Check the spark plug for thread damage and insulator damage. If abnormal, replace the spark
plug.
Recommended spark plug:
ND: K16TR11 NGK: BKR5EKB-11
Page 4252
a. Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap ring. b. Place matchmarks on the shaft and tripod.
c. Using a brass bar and hammer, remove the tripod joint.
NOTICE: Do not tap the roller.
5. Remove inboard and outboard joint boots.
a. Remove the inboard joint boot from the drive shaft b. Using a side cutter, cut the outboard boot
clamps. c. Remove the outboard joint boot from the drive shaft.
NOTICE: Do not disassemble the outboard joint.
6. Remove dust cover. Using a screwdriver, remove the dust cover from the inboard joint tulip. 7.
Remove dust seal. Using a screwdriver and hammer, remove the dust seal from the drive shaft
ASSEMBLY
1. Install dust cover. Using a screwdriver and hammer, install a new cover. 2. Install dust seal.
Using a screwdriver and hammer, install a new dust seal. 3. Temporarily install new boots to drive
shaft.
HINT: ^
Before installing the boots, wrap vinyl tape around the spline of the shaft to prevent damaging the
boot.
^ Place new clamps to boot's small ends and install its to the drive shaft.
4. Assemble tripod joint.
a. Place the beveled side of the tripod axial spline toward the outboard joint. b. Align the
matchmarks placed before disassembly. c. Using a brass bar and a hammer, install the tripod joint
onto the drive shaft.
NOTICE: Do not tap the roller.
d. Using a snap ring expander, install a new snap ring.
5. Assemble boot to outboard joint. Before assembling the boot, pack in grease.
HINT: Use the grease supplied in the boot kit.
6. Assemble boot and inboard joint tulip.
a. Pack the inboard joint and boot with grease.
HINT: Use the grease supplied in the boot kit.
b. Align the matchmarks placed before assembly. c. Install the inboard joint tulip to the drive shaft
d. Temporarily install the boot to the inboard joint tulip.
7. Assemble new boot clamps to both boots.
a. Ensure that the boots are in the shaft groove. b. Ensure that the boots are not stretched or
contracted when the drive shaft is at standard length.
Drive shaft standard length: 436.2 ± 2.0 mm (17.173 ± 0.079 inch)
c. Place a new inboard joint large boot clamp. d. Holding the clamp near the closing hooks, position
the holes in the clamp's free end over the closing hooks with pliers. e. Secure clamps by drawing
the closing hooks together. To assemble the other boot clamps, pinch the clamps and adjust
clearance with SST.
NOTICE: Do not overtighten the SST 09521-24010.
g. Measure the clearance of the boot clamps with SST 09240-00020.
Clearance: 1.0 - 1.5 mm (0.039 - 0.059 inch)
8. Check drive shaft.
Page 1060
(a) Visually check the seal portion of the tensioner for oil leakage.
NOTE: If there is only the faintest trace of oil on the seal on the push rod side, the tensioner is all
right. If leakage is found, replace the tensioner.
(b) Hold the tensioner with both hands and push the push rod strongly as shown to check that it
doesn't move.
If the push rod moves, replace the tensioner.
CAUTION: Never hold the tensioner push rod facing downward.
(c) Measure the protrusion of the push rod from the housing end. Protrusion: 10.0 - 10.8 mm (0.394
- 0.425 inch) If the protrusion is not as specified, replace the tensioner.
Page 1544
(c) Using SST Variable Pin Wrench Set # 09960 - 10010 (Variable Pin Wrench Arm Assembly #
09962 - 01000, Pin 10 # 09963 - 01000) or equivalents, install the pulley bolt. Torque: 110 Nm (81
ft. lbs.)
6. Set No. 1 cylinder to Top Dead Center (TDC)/compression.
(a) Crankshaft Timing Pulley Position: ^
Temporarily install the crankshaft pulley bolt to the crankshaft.
^ Turn the crankshaft, and align the timing marks of the crankshaft timing pulley and oil pump body.
(b) Camshaft Timing Pulley Positions:
Using SST Variable Pin Wrench Set # 09960 - 10010 (Variable Pin Wrench Arm Assembly # 09962
- 01000, Pin 10 # 09963 - 01000) or equivalents, turn the camshaft pulley, align the timing marks of
the timing pulley and No. 3 timing belt cover.
7. Install timing belt.
CAUTION: The engine should be cold.
(a) Remove any oil or water on the pulleys, and keep them clean.
CAUTION: Only wipe the pulleys; do not use any cleansing agent.
(b) Face the front mark on the timing belt forward. (c)
Align the installation mark on the timing belt with the timing mark of the crankshaft timing pulley.
(d) Align the installation marks on the timing belt with the timing marks of the camshaft timing
pulleys.
Page 2047
CHART 15
Page 3445
(c) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between each terminal.
Page 3602
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 1230
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection
Check the MIL (1) The MIL comes on when the ignition switch is turned ON and the engine is not
running.
HINT: If the MIL does not light up, troubleshoot the combination meter.
(2) When the engine started, the MIL should go off. If the lamp remains on, the diagnosis system
has detected a malfunction or abnormality in the
system
Page 1715
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2892
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 827
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor Location
Page 2727
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 1480
Oil Pan: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove the 15 bolts and 4 nuts.
2. Using Special Service Tool (SST) Oil Pan Seal Cutter # 09032 - 00100 or equivalent and a brass
bar, separate the oil pan from the cylinder block.
NOTE: When removing the oil pan, be careful not to damage the oil pan flange.
INSTALLATION
1. Apply seal packing to the oil pan, as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826 - 00080 or equivalent. Install a nozzle that has been cut to a 3 - 4 mm (0.12 - 0.16 inch) opening.
NOTE: Avoid applying an excess amount to the surface.
- If parts are not assembled within 5 minutes of applying the seal packing, the effectiveness of the
seal packing is lost and the seal packing must be removed and reapplied.
- Immediately remove the nozzle from the tube and reinstall the cap after using the seal packing.
2. Install the oil pan with the 2 nuts and 17 bolts.
Torque: 7.6 Nm (67 inch lbs.)
Page 335
Clutch Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 3135
(c) Check that air flows from ports E to F and does not flow from ports E to P.
If operation is not as specified, replace the VSV.
3. REINSTALL VSV
Page 2741
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 2 Of 2
Page 4173
d. Recheck the ring gear backlash.
Backlash: 0.13 - 0.18 mm (0.0051 - 0.0071 inch) If the backlash is not within the specification,
adjust by either increasing or decreasing the washers on both sides by equal amounts.
HINT: The backlash will change about 0.20 mm (0.0079 inch) with 0.03 mm (0.0012 inch) alteration
of the side washer.
Mark and Washer thickness: 58 2.58 (0.1015) 60 2.60 (0.1024) 62 2.62 (0.1031) 64 2.64 (0.1039)
66 2.66 (0.1047) 68 2.68 (0.1055) 70 2.70 (0.1063) 72 2.72 (0.1071) 74 2.74 (0.1079) 76 2.76
(0.1087) 78 2.78 (0.1094) 80 2.80 (0.1102) 82 2.82 (0.1110) 84 2.84 (0.1118) 86 2.86 (0.1126) 88
2.88 (0.1134) 90 2.90 (0.1142) 92 2.92 (0.1150) 94 2.94 (0.1157) 96 2.96 (0.1165) 98 2.98
(0.1173) 00 3.00 (0.1181) 02 3.02 (0.1189) 04 3.04 (0.1197) 06 3.06 (0.1205) 08 3.08 (0.1213) 10
3.10 (0.1220) 12 3.12 (0.1228) 14 3.14 (0.1236) 16 3.16 (0.1244) 18 3.18 (0.1252) 20 3.20
(0.1260) 24 3.24 (0.1276) 26 3.26 (0.1283) 28 3.28 (0.1291) 30 3.30 (0.1299) 32 3.32 (0.1307) 34
3.34 (0.1315) 36 3.36 (0.1323) 38 3.38 (0.1331) 40 3.40 (0.1339) 42 3.42 (0.1346) 44 3.44
(0.1354) 46 3.46 (0.1362) 48 3.48 (0.1370)
11. Install side bearing cap.
a. Align the matchmarks on the cap and carrier. b. Torque the 4 bolts.
Torque to 113 Nm (83 ft. lbs.)
12. Measure total preload. Using a torque wrench, measure the preload with the teeth of the drive
pinion and ring gear in contact.
Total preload (at starting):
Drive pinion preload plus: 0.4 - 0.6 Nm (3.5 - 5.2 inch lbs.)
Page 1059
Timing Belt: Testing and Inspection
INSPECTION
1. Inspect timing belt.
CAUTION: Do not bend, twist or turn the timing belt inside out.
- Do not allow the timing belt to come into contact with oil, water or steam.
- Do not utilize timing belt tension when installing or removing the mounting bolt of the camshaft
timing pulley.
If there are any defects as shown in the illustration, check these points: (a)
Premature parting. ^
Check for proper installation.
^ Check the timing cover gasket for damage and proper installation.
(b) If the belt teeth are cracked or damaged, check to see if either camshaft is locked. (c)
If there is noticeable wear or cracks on the belt face, check to see if there are nicks on the side of
the idler pulley lock and water pump.
(d) If there is wear or damage on only one side of the belt, check the belt guide and the alignment
of each pulley. (e)
If there is noticeable wear on the belt teeth, check the timing belt cover for damage and check
gasket has been installed correctly and for foreign material on the pulley teeth. If necessary,
replace the timing belt.
2. Inspect idler pulleys.
(a) Visually check the seal portion of the idler pulley for oil leakage. If leakage is found, replace the
idler pulley.
(b) Check that the idler pulley turns smoothly.
If necessary, replace the idler pulley.
3. Inspect timing belt tensioner.
Page 4863
Brake Drum: Service and Repair
Rear Brake Components (4WD)
REMOVAL
1. Remove rear wheel. 2. Remove brake drum.
NOTE: If the brake drum cannot be removed easily, do the following steps.
(a) Remove the adjusting hole plug in the backing plate.
(b) Insert a screwdriver through the hole in the backing plate, and hold the automatic adjusting
lever away from the adjusting bolt. (c) Using another screwdriver, reduce the brake shoe
adjustment by turning the adjusting bolt.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the drum.
Page 1285
^ Arrange the camshafts in the correct order.
^ Arrange the bearing caps in the correct order.
Page 1439
Idler Pulley: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS No. 1 Idler Pulley To Oil Pump:
..............................................................................................................................................................
................................................ 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.)
No. 2 Idler Pulley To No. 2 Idler Pulley Bracket:
..............................................................................................................................................................
................................................. 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
Locations
Page 2332
5. RECONNECT HIGH-TENSION CORDS TO IGNITION COILS
(a) Assemble the holder and grommet.
(b) Align the spline of the ignition coil with the spline of the holder and push in the cord.
NOTICE: Check that the holder is correctly installed to the grommet and distributor cap as shown in
the illustration.
(c) Check that the lock claw of the holder is engaged by lightly pulling the holder.
6. RECONNECT HIGH-TENSION CORDS TO SPARK PLUGS 7. REINSTALL AIR CLEANER
HOSE
Page 696
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 3033
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 1342
Piston: Testing and Inspection Piston Pin Fit
At 60° C (140° F), you should be able to push the piston pin into the piston pin hole with your
thumb.
Page 2131
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch goes on when the shift lever is in the N or P shift position. When it
goes on terminal NSW of the ECM is grounded to body ground via the starter relay, thus the
terminal NSW voltage becomes 0 V. When the shift lever is in the D, 2, L or R position, the
park/neutral position switch goes off, so the voltage of ECM, terminal NSW becomes battery
voltage, the voltage of the ECM internal power source.
If the shift lever is moved from the N position to the D position, this signal is used for air-fuel ratio
correction and for idle speed control (estimated control), etc.
Page 616
Components For Removal And Installation Part 2 Of 2
Electrode Gap Specification
Spark Plug: Specifications Electrode Gap Specification
Electrode Gap
Correct Gap .........................................................................................................................................
...................................................... 1.1 mm (0.043 in.)
Page 4527
Case: Service and Repair
1. If necessary, replace front bearing retainer oil seal.
a. Using a screwdriver and hammer, drive out the oil seal.
b. Using Special Service Tool (SST) 09950-60010 (09951-00590), 09950-70010 (09951-07100)
and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal until its
surface is flush with the retainer upper surface.
c. Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
2. If necessary, replace front case oil seal.
a. Using a screwdriver and hammer, drive out the oil seal. b. Using SST 09316-60011
(09316-00011) and a hammer, drive in a new oil seal until its surface is flush with the case upper
surface. c. Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
Page 4030
C. Lift off upper valve body and plate as a single unit holding the valve body plate to the upper
valve body as shown in the illustration.
Caution: Be careful that the check balls and strainer do not fall out.
2. Modification:
A. Turn over the upper valve body, remove plate & gaskets. B. Add new check ball in the location
shown in illustration.
3. Assembly:
A. GReassemble upper and lower valve body halves using new gaskets. B. GInstall 25 bolts to
upper valve body.
Torque: 56 in. lbs. (6.4 N/m, 65 kgf/cm)
Caution: Careful to reinstall the bolts in their proper locations as shown in the illustration.
Bolt Length: A:
38 mm (1.50")
B: 20 mm (0.79")
C: 28 mm (1.10")
C. Complete reassembly as described in the Repair Manual for the vehicle being serviced.
Page 3735
Position Of Parts In Engine Compartment (Part 2 Of 2) (Fig 25)
Page 3605
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 637
A/F and 02 Sensor Identification
Page 2121
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 1258
NOTE: After "Dinghy" Towing, or at the recommended distance limits, let the Engine idle for more
than 3 minutes before operating the vehicle or resuming towing.
NOTE: Vehicles that are Dinghy towable will not sustain internal damage to the transmission or
transfer components, as long as speed/distance limits are observed. The transmission must be
placed in the "neutral" position when Dinghy towing. Dinghy towing these vehicles does not
eliminate the possibility of damage to other vehicle systems (Body, Chassis, Electrical Systems,
etc.).
Page 2961
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Emissions - Oxygen Sensor Modified
ENGINE EG011-99
October 15, 1999
Title: 5VZ OXYGEN SENSOR IMPROVEMENT
Models: '96 - '99 Tacoma
Introduction
The design of the 5VZ Oxygen Sensor inner cover has been changed to reduce the possibility of
moisture contacting the ceramic element.
Applicable Vehicles
^ 1996-1999 model year Tacomas built before the VIN listed.
Repair Procedure Please refer to the appropriate repair manual for diagnostic and installation
information for the Oxygen Sensor.
Part Number Information
Warranty Information
Applicable Warranty*: This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in
effect for 36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in-service date.
Coverage is extended to 36 months or 50,000 miles, whichever occurs first, in the states of
California and Massachusetts due to state emissions warranty legislation.
Page 2610
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Testing and Inspection
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY INSPECTION
1. REMOVE CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY 2. INSPECT CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
A. Inspect relay continuity
(a) Using an ohmmeter, check that there is continuity between terminals ST and E1
If there no continuity, replace the relay.
(b) Check that there is continuity between terminals +B and FC.
If there no continuity, replace the relay.
(c) Check that there is no continuity between terminals +B and FP.
If there no continuity, replace the relay.
B. Inspect relay operation
(a) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals ST and E1.
Page 1999
Knock Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 1133
Coolant: Testing and Inspection
COOLANT CHECK
1. Check engine coolant level at radiator reservoir.
The engine coolant level should be between the "LOW" and "FULL" lines, when the engine is cold.
If low, check for leaks and add engine coolant up to the "FULL" line.
2. Check engine coolant quality.
(a) Remove the radiator cap from the water outlet.
WARNING: To avoid the danger of being burned, do not remove the radiator cap while the engine
and radiator are still hot, as fluid and steam can be blown out under pressure.
(b) There should not be any excessive deposits of rust or scale around the radiator cap or radiator
filler hole, and the coolant should be free from
oil. If excessively dirty, clean the coolant passages and replace the coolant.
(c) Reinstall the radiator cap.
Page 3374
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Page 2731
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 699
Page 3023
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 2681
CHART 23
Page 4386
f. Turn the reverse synchronizer pull ring.
g. while pushing the 3 shifting keys, install the synchronizer ring assembly to the hub sleeve No.3.
Specifications
Fluid Pump: Specifications
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Oil Pump Body
Body Clearance
Standard
........................................................................................................................................................
0.09-0.16 mm (0.0035-0.0063 inch) Maximum ....................................................................................
....................................................................................... 0.16 mm (0.0063 inch)
Tip Clearance
Standard
........................................................................................................................................................
0.05-0.15 mm (0.0020-0.0059 inch) Maximum ....................................................................................
....................................................................................... 0.15 mm (0.0059 inch)
Side Clearance
Standard
........................................................................................................................................................
0.03-0.10 mm (0.0012-0.0039 inch) Maximum ....................................................................................
....................................................................................... 0.10 mm (0.0039 inch)
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Relief Valve .........................................................................................................................................
............................................. 29.4 N.m (21 ft. lbs.) Oil Pump Plate .....................................................
........................................................................................................................... 7.4 N.m (65 inch
lbs.)
Page 3334
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Knock Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
KNOCK SENSOR INSPECTION
1. REMOVE KNOCK SENSORS
See: Service and Repair
2. INSPECT KNOCK SENSORS
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between the terminal and body. If there is
continuity, replace the sensor.
Page 2869
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 490
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2533
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 3743
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4255
5. Disconnect brake line and parking brake cable. Using SST 09751-36011, disconnect the brake
line from the wheel cylinder.
Installation Hint: Torque to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.)
6. Remove rear axle shaft assembly.
a. Remove the 4 backing plate mounting nuts.
Installation Hint: Torque to 68 Nm (50 ft. lbs.)
b. Pull out the rear axle shaft assembly from the rear axle housing.
NOTICE: Be careful not to damage the oil seal.
7. Remove o-ring from rear axle housing.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
HINT: After installation, bleed brake system and check ABS speed sensor signal.
Hub Bolt
HUB BOLT REPLACEMENT
1. Remove wheel and brake drum. 2. Remove hub bolt.
Using SST, 09650-17011
Page 3661
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 868
Page 4175
05 2.05 mm (0.0807 inch) 06 2.06 mm (0.0811 inch) 07 2.07 mm (0.0815 inch) 08 2.08 mm
(0.0819 inch) 09 2.09 mm (0.0823 inch) 10 2.10 mm (0.0827 inch) 11 2.11 mm (0.0831 inch) 12
2.12 mm (0.0835 inch) 13 2.13 mm (0.0839 inch) 14 2.14 mm (0.0843 inch) 15 2.15 mm (0.0846
inch) 16 2.16 mm (0.0850 inch) 17 2.17 mm (0.0854 inch) 18 2.18 mm (0.0858 inch) 19 2.19 mm
(0.0862 inch) 20 2.20 mm (0.0866 inch) 21 2.21 mm (0.0870 inch) 22 2.22 mm (0.0874 inch) 23
2.23 mm (0.0878 inch) 24 2.24 mm (0.0882 inch) 25 2.25 mm (0.0886 inch) 26 2.26 mm (0.0890
inch) 27 2.27 mm (0.0894 inch) 28 2.28 mm (0.0898 inch)
14. Remove companion flange. 15. Remove front bearing. 16. Install new bearing spacer, 2
washers and front bearing.
a. install a new bearing spacer and 2 washers, and place the front bearing.
b. Using SST 09950-30010 (09951-03010, 09953-03010, 09954-03010, 09955-03030,
09956-03050) and the companion flange, install the front
bearing then remove the companion flange.
17. Install new oil seal.
a. Coat a new oil seal lip with MP grease.
b. Using SST 09649-17010, 09316-12010, install the oil seal until its surface is flush with the
differential carrier end.
HINT: Connect SST with vinyl tape.
18. Install companion flange.
a. Place the companion flange. b. Coat the threads of a new nut with hypoid gear oil.
Page 4133
Differential Carrier
ASSEMBLY
1. W/A.D.D.: Install new bearings. Using SST 09950-60010 (09951-00380) and a press, install new
bearings.
Bearing press in depth: 0.3 ± 0.3 mm (0.012 ± 0.012 inch)
Page 2952
CHART 25
Locations
Page 1200
3. RAISE FRONT BRAKE PRESSURE TO 7,845 kPa (8Q kgf/cm2, 1,138 psi) AND CHECK REAR
BRAKE PRESSURE
Rear brake pressure
HINT The brake pedal should not be depressed twice and/or returned while setting to the specified
pressure. Read the value of rear brake pressure 2 seconds after adjusting the specified fluid
pressure. If the brake pressure is incorrect adjust the fluid pressure.
4. IF NECESSARY, ADJUST FLUID PRESSURE
(a) Adjust the length of the No.2 shackle.
Low pressure - Lengthen A High pressure - Shorten A
Initial set
Adjustment range
HINT: One turn of the nut changes the fluid pressure as shown in the following table.
Rear brake pressure:
(b) If the pressure cannot be adjusted by the No.2 shackle, raise or lower the valve body.
Low pressure - Lower body High pressure - Raise body
(c) Torque the nuts. Torque: 13 N.m (130 kgf.cm, 9 ft.lbf) (d) Adjust the length of the No.1 shackle
again. If it cannot be adjusted, inspect the valve housing.
Locations
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 3318
Fuel Supply Line: Service and Repair
1. Before working on the fuel System, disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery.
HINT: Any diagnostic trouble code retained by the computer will be erased when the negative (-)
terminal cable is removed from the battery. Therefore, if necessary, read the diagnosis before
removing the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery.
2. Do not smoke or work near an open flame when working on the fuel system. 3. Keep gasoline
away from rubber or leather parts.
FUEL SYSTEM
1. When disconnecting the high fuel pressure line, a large amount of gasoline will spill out, so
observe these procedures:
(a) Disconnect the fuel pump connector. (b) Start the engine. After the engine has stopped on its
own, turn the ignition switch to LOCK.
(c) Put a container under the connection. (d) Slowly loosen the connection. (e) Disconnect the
connection. (f) Plug the connection with a rubber plug.
2. When connecting the flare nut or union bolt on the high pressure pipe union, observe these
procedures:
Union Bolt Type:
(a) Always use 2 new gaskets. (b) Tighten the union bolt by hand. (c) Tighten the union bolt to the
specified torque.
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf)
Flare Nut Type: (a) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the flare nut and tighten the flare nut by hand.
Page 4927
Brake Master Cylinder: Adjustments
Set SST On Gasket
1. Install the gasket on the master cylinder. 2. Set the Special Service Tool (SST) # 09737-00010
on the gasket, and lower the pin until its tip slightly touches the piston. 3. Turn the SST upside
down, and set it on the booster. 4. Measure the clearance between the booster push rod and pin
head (SST). Clearance: 0 mm (0 inch)
5. Adjust the booster push rod length until the push rod lightly touches the pin head.
Page 2846
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Testing and Inspection
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
Inspect shift lock solenoid.
a. Disconnect the solenoid connector. b. Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance at each
terminal.
Standard Resistance 20-28 ohms.
If resistance value is not as specified. Replace the solenoid.
c. Apply battery positive voltage at each terminal. At this time, confirm that the solenoid operates. If
the solenoid does not operate, replace the
solenoid.
Testing and Inspection
Instrument Panel Relay: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT BULB CHECK RELAY OPERATION
1. Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal C through a 1.4 W test bulb and the
negative (-) lead to terminal B, check that the test
bulb does not light up.
2. Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal A and check that the test bulb lights up.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
Page 1749
REMOVAL
1. Remove timing belt. Refer to Engine. 2. Remove water inlet and thermostat. 3. Disconnect No. 2
oil cooler hose from water pump.
4. Remove water pump.
INSTALLATION
1. Install water pump.
(a) Remove any old packing Formed In Place Gasket (FIPG) material and be careful not to drop
any oil on the contact surfaces of the water pump and cylinder block. ^
Using a razor blade and gasket scraper, remove all the old packing FIPG material from the gasket
surfaces and sealing groove.
^ Thoroughly clean all components to remove all the loose material.
^ Using a non-residue solvent, clean both sealing surfaces.
(b) Apply seal packing to the water pump groove as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing: Part No. 08826 - 00100 or equivalent. ^
Install a nozzle that has been cut to a 2 - 3 mm (0.08 - 0.12 inch) opening.
^ Parts must be assembled within 5 minutes of application. Otherwise the material must be
removed and reapplied.
^ Immediately remove nozzle from the tube and reinstall cap.
Page 4145
Maximum vertical runout: 0.10 mm (0.0039 inch) Maximum lateral runout: 0.10 mm (0.0039 inch)
2. Check ring gear runout. Using a dial indicator, measure the ring gear runout.
Maximum runout: 0.10 mm (0.0039 inch)
If the runout is not within the specification, replace the ring gear.
3. Check ring gear backlash. Using a dial indicator, measure the ring gear backlash.
Backlash: 0.13 - 0.18 mm (0.0051 - 0.0071 inch)
If the backlash is not within the specification, adjust the side bearing preload or repair as
necessary.
Page 562
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 3044
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 1607
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
INSPECTION
HINT: Inspect and adjust the valve clearance when the engine is cold.
1. REMOVE INTAKE AIR CONNECTOR 2. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVERS 3. SET NO.1
CYLINDER TO TDC/COMPRESSION
a. Turn the crankshaft pulley, and align its groove with the timing mark "0" of the No.1 timing belt
cover.
b. Check that the timing marks (1 dot) of the camshaft drive and driven gears are in straight line on
the cylinder heads surface as shown in the
illustration. If not, turn the crankshaft 1 revolution (360°) and align the marks.
4. INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE
a. Check only those valves indicated in the illustration.
1. Using a thickness gauge, measure the clearance between the valve lifter and camshaft.
Valve Clearance (Cold):
2. Record out of specification valve clearance measurements. They will be used later to determine
the required replacement adjusting shim.
Page 1863
Ignition Control Module: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A DIS (Direct Ignition System) has been adopted. The DIS improves the ignition timing accuracy,
reduces high-voltage loss and enhances the overall reliability of the ignition system by eliminating
the distributor.
The DIS is a 2-cylinder simultaneous ignition system which ignites 2 cylinders simultaneously with
one ignition coil. In the 2-cylinder simultaneous ignition system, each of the 2 spark plugs is
connected to the end of the secondary winding. High voltage generated in the secondary winding is
applied directly to the 2 spark plugs. The sparks of the 2 spark plugs pass simultaneously from the
center electrode to the ground electrode.
The ECM determines ignition timing and outputs the ignition signals (IGT) for each cylinder. Based
on IGT signals, the igniter controls the primary ignition signals (IGC) for all ignition coils. At the
same time, the igniter also sends an ignition confirmation signal (IGF) as a fail-safe measure to the
ECM.
Electrical Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Resistance Cold Resistance Hot
835 - 1,400 ohms at 14 - 122 deg F 1,060 - 1,645 ohms at 122 - 212 deg F
Page 738
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 744
Page 992
Adjustment Chart
Example (VZN160L):
Camber: 0° 15' (0.25°) Caster: 1° 35'(1.58°)
c. Mark on the adjustment chart the alignment values measured at the non-loaded vehicle height.
Example:
Camber: 0° 10'(0.17°) Caster: 2° 20' (2.33`°)
d. As shown in the illustration, read the distance from the standard value to the measured value,
and adjust the front and/or rear adjusting cams
accordingly.
Example:
Front cam: +(Longer) 2.4 Rear cam: -(Shorter) 2.4
Page 4353
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (Canada) (Fig 19)
Service Hints
E 2 ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED TRANSMISSION SOLENOID
1, 2, 3-Ground: Approx 13 Ohms
Page 2119
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 3094
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 690
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 1722
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 4732
Page 3064
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 378
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 1440
Idler Pulley: Testing and Inspection
INSPECTION
1. Visually check the seal portion of the idler pulley for oil leakage.
If leakage is found, replace the idler pulley.
2. Check that the idler pulley turns smoothly.
If necessary, replace the idler pulley.
Page 2014
Components For Removal And Installation Part 2 Of 2
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
KNOCK SENSORS REMOVAL
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT 2. REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE 3. REMOVE INTAKE AIR
CONNECTOR 4. REMOVE HIGH-TENSION CORDS WITH IGNITION COILS 5. REMOVE FUEL
PRESSURE REGULATOR 6. REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY 7. REMOVE WATER
BYPASS PIPE AND KNOCK SENSOR WIRE
Page 859
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 3616
Ignition Control Module: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
A DIS (Direct Ignition System) has been adopted. The DIS improves the ignition timing accuracy,
reduces high-voltage loss and enhances the overall reliability of the ignition system by eliminating
the distributor.
The DIS is a 2-cylinder simultaneous ignition system which ignites 2 cylinders simultaneously with
one ignition coil. In the 2-cylinder simultaneous ignition system, each of the 2 spark plugs is
connected to the end of the secondary winding. High voltage generated in the secondary winding is
applied directly to the 2 spark plugs. The sparks of the 2 spark plugs pass simultaneously from the
center electrode to the ground electrode.
The ECM determines ignition timing and outputs the ignition signals (IGT) for each cylinder. Based
on IGT signals, the igniter controls the primary ignition signals (IGC) for all ignition coils. At the
same time, the igniter also sends an ignition confirmation signal (IGF) as a fail-safe measure to the
ECM.
Page 4583
ASSEMBLY
1. Install rear bearing.
Using a press, install a new rear bearing.
2. Install front bearing.
Using a press, install a new front bearing.
Page 3524
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 3615
Fuel - Idle Speed Increased by Replacement ECM
Idle Speed: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Idle Speed Increased by Replacement ECM
ENGINE EG001-98
FEBRUARY 13, 1998
2RZ ECM IDLE SPEED
MODELS: '95-'97 TACOMA
Introduction Operating logic of 1995-1997 Tacoma ECMs has been revised to improve engine idle
smoothness (with transmission in "D" range) by increasing idle speed (A/C "OFF") from 600 RPM
to 700 RPM. The change has also narrowed the RPM transition between A/C "OFF" and A/C "ON"
engagement.
Affected Vehicles 1995-1997 Tacoma 4x2 equipped with 2RZ-FE four cylinder engine and automatic transmission.
Part Number Information
Production Change Information No production changes have been made.
- This change applies only to replacement ECMs available through parts supply.
Warranty Information
Applicable Warranty: This repair is covered under the Toyota Powertrain Warranty. This warranty Is
in effect for 60 months or 60,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in service date.
Page 3668
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The crankshaft position sensor, which detects the engine speed and crankshaft angle signal (NE
signal), has been installed on the oil pump body. The NE signal plate has 34 teeth. The NE signal
sensor generates 34 signals for every engine revolution. The ECM detects the standard crankshaft
angle based on the G signals and the actual crankshaft angle and the engine speed by the NE
signals.
Page 2679
CHART 22
Page 3032
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Specifications
Knock Sensor: Specifications
Knock Sensor to Cylinder Block 29 ft.lb
Page 2233
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The camshaft position sensor, which detects the crankshaft angle signal (G signal), has been
installed on the front of right bank cylinder head. The timing rotor has been integrated with the right
bank camshaft timing pulley. When the camshafts rotate, the protrusion on the timing rotor and the
air gap on the pick up coil change, causing fluctuations, in the magnetic field and generating an
electromotive force in the pick up coil. The NE signal plate has 34 teeth and is mounted on the
crankshaft. The NE signal sensor generates 34 signals for every engine revolution. The ECM
detects the standard crankshaft angle based on the 6 signals and the actual crankshaft angle and
the engine speed by the NE signals.
Page 1240
Wheels: Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Full Wheel Cap Improvement
BODY BO009-97
April 4, 1997
Title: TACOMA 4X4 FULL WHEEL CAP IMPROVEMENT
Models: '97 Tacoma 4X2
Introduction
To prevent rotation of the outer wheel cap face, a strip of butyl rubber has been added between the
wheel cap retainer (inner portion) and the wheel cover face (outer portion).
Production Change Information
^ 1997 Tacoma 4x2 models starting with VIN 4TA ***** VZ221212
Parts Information
PREVIOUS PART NUMBER NEW PART NUMBER PART NAME
42621-AD010 Same Wheel Cap
NOTE:
New style service parts are identified by a "B" after the part number or a manufacturing date code
after 8/21/96. This information is located after the part number that is printed on a label adhered to
the back side of the wheel cover.
Page 602
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 877
Ignition Switch: Testing and Inspection
IGNITION SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT SWITCH CONTINUITY
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Page 3693
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Locations
Ignition Switch
Testing and Inspection
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT LIGHT CONTROL SWITCH CONTINUITY
Reference
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Page 36
ABS Main Relay: Description and Operation ABS Control (Solenoid) Relay
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This relay supplies power to each Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) solenoid. After the ignition switch
is turned ON, if the initial check is OK, the relay goes on.
FAIL SAFE FUNCTION
If trouble in the ABS control (solenoid) relay circuit, the Electronic Control Unit (ECU) cuts off
current to the ABS control (solenoid) relay and prohibits ABS control.
Page 1886
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 689
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 2315
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
PRECAUTION
1. BEFORE WORKING ON FUEL SYSTEM, DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (-) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
HINT: Any diagnostic trouble code retained by the computer will be erased when the negative (-)
terminal cable is removed from the battery. Therefore, if necessary, read the diagnosis before
removing the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery.
2. DO NOT SMOKE OR WORK NEAR AN OPEN FLAME WHEN WORKING ON FUEL SYSTEM
FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE PROCEDURE
WHEN DISCONNECTING THE HIGH FUEL PRESSURE LINE, A LARGE AMOUNT OF
GASOLINE WILL SPILL OUT, SO OBSERVE THESE PROCEDURES:
(1) Disconnect the fuel pump connector. (2) Start the engine. After the engine has stopped on its
own, turn the ignition switch to LOCK.
(3) Put a container under the connection. (4) Slowly loosen the connection. (5) Disconnect the
connection. (6) Plug the connection with a rubber plug.
WHEN CONNECTING THE FLARE NUT OR UNION BOLT ON THE HIGH PRESSURE PIPE
UNION, OBSERVE THESE PROCEDURES:
Union Bolt Type:
- Always use 2 new gaskets.
- Tighten the union bolt by hand.
- Tighten the union bolt to the specified torque.
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf)
Flare Nut Type: Apply a light coat of engine oil to the flare nut and tighten the flare nut by hand.
Page 2029
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - O2 Sensor Monitor Threshold
Values
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS SS002-03
December 17, 2003
Title O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05)
Models All '96 - '03, '04 Corolla, ECHO, Matrix, Sienna & Scion xA & xB
Introduction
This Service Bulletin contains Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Monitor threshold values for all models from
1996 to 2003 and some 2004 models. Starting in 2004, the O2S Monitor threshold values can be
found in the repair manual. These values are used when analyzing the O2S test results to
determine the O2S condition.
Applicable Vehicles ^
All 1996 - 2003 model year Toyota vehicles.
^ 2004 model year Corolla, ECHO, Matrix and Sienna vehicles.
^ 2004 model year Scion xA and xB vehicles.
Function Description
Checking O2S Test Results
To view O2S test results, the O2S Monitor must be completed and the test results must be
checked within the same key cycle. If the ignition key is cycled OFF, the O2S test results will be set
to the minimum or maximum limits, and all test results will be erased. The O2S test results are
stored in the ECU (SAE term: Powertrain Control Module/PCM) when the monitor is completed.
The test results are static and will not change once the monitor is complete.
The process for checking 02S test results is described in the following three basic steps:
1. Completing the O2S Readiness Monitor.
2. Accessing O2S Test Results.
3. Comparing O2S Test Results to Failure Thresholds.
Required SSTs
NOTE:
Additional Diagnostic Tester Kits, Program Cards or other SSTs may be ordered by calling
SPX-OTC at 1-800-933-8335.
Warranty Information
Completing O2S Readiness Monitor
1. Clear any stored Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) using the Toyota Diagnostic Tester.
Page 4377
Page 3247
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
PRECAUTION
1. BEFORE WORKING ON FUEL SYSTEM, DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (-) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
HINT: Any diagnostic trouble code retained by the computer will be erased when the negative (-)
terminal cable is removed from the battery. Therefore, if necessary, read the diagnosis before
removing the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery.
2. DO NOT SMOKE OR WORK NEAR AN OPEN FLAME WHEN WORKING ON FUEL SYSTEM
FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE PROCEDURE
WHEN DISCONNECTING THE HIGH FUEL PRESSURE LINE, A LARGE AMOUNT OF
GASOLINE WILL SPILL OUT, SO OBSERVE THESE PROCEDURES:
(1) Disconnect the fuel pump connector. (2) Start the engine. After the engine has stopped on its
own, turn the ignition switch to LOCK.
(3) Put a container under the connection. (4) Slowly loosen the connection. (5) Disconnect the
connection. (6) Plug the connection with a rubber plug.
WHEN CONNECTING THE FLARE NUT OR UNION BOLT ON THE HIGH PRESSURE PIPE
UNION, OBSERVE THESE PROCEDURES:
Union Bolt Type:
- Always use 2 new gaskets.
- Tighten the union bolt by hand.
- Tighten the union bolt to the specified torque.
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf)
Flare Nut Type: Apply a light coat of engine oil to the flare nut and tighten the flare nut by hand.
Page 2526
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 1413
Drive Belt: Specifications Power Steering Belt
Drive Belt - Power Steering / Tension:
New Belt ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 135 - 180 lbs. Used Belt ...................................................................
............................................................................................................................... 85 - 120 lbs.
Page 3948
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 1562
Fuel Pressure: Testing and Inspection
FUEL PRESSURE INSPECTION
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
(a) Check the battery positive voltage is above 12 V. (b) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable
from the battery. (c) Remove the 6 bolts and disconnect the No.2 timing belt cover.
(d) Remove the union bolt holding the fuel pipe to the delivery pipe and gasket.
CAUTION: Put a shop towel under the delivery pipe.
- Slowly loosen the union bolt.
(e) Install SST (pressure gauge) to the delivery pipe with the 2 gaskets and SST (union and union
bolt). SST 09268-45012
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf)
(f) Wipe off any splattered gasoline.
(g) Connect the TOYOTA hand-held tester to the DLC3. (h) Reconnect the negative (-) terminal
cable to the battery. (i) Turn the ignition switch ON. (j) Measure the fuel pressure.
Fuel pressure: 265 - 304 kPa (2.7 - 3.1 kgf/sq.cm, 38 - 44 psi)
If pressure is high. replace the fuel pressure regulator. If pressure is low, check these parts: Fuel hoses and connections
- Fuel pump
- Fuel filter
- Fuel pressure regulator
(k) Disconnect the TOYOTA hand-held tester from the DLC3.
Page 4007
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch goes on when the shift lever is in the N or P shift position. When it
goes on terminal NSW of the ECM is grounded to body ground via the starter relay, thus the
terminal NSW voltage becomes 0 V. When the shift lever is in the D, 2, L or R position, the
park/neutral position switch goes off, so the voltage of ECM, terminal NSW becomes battery
voltage, the voltage of the ECM internal power source.
If the shift lever is moved from the N position to the D position, this signal is used for air-fuel ratio
correction and for idle speed control (estimated control), etc.
Page 3108
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Vehicle NO.2 Speed Sensor Inspection Procedure
- Remove NO.2 vehicle speed sensor. - Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of NO.2
vehicle speed sensor.
Resistance: 560 Ohms to 680 Ohms
- Check voltage between terminals 1 and 2 of the NO.2 speed sensor when a magnet is put close
to the front end of the NO.2 vehicle speed sensor
then taken away quickly.
- Voltage is generated intermittenly.
Note: The voltages generated is extremely low.
Page 437
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 1004
(l) Reinstall the No.2 timing belt cover with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 9 N.m (90 kgf.cm, 80 in.lbf)
(m)Start the engine.
(n) Disconnect the vacuum sensing hose from the fuel pressure regulator. and plug the hose end.
(o) Measure the fuel pressure at idle.
Fuel pressure 265 - 304 kPa (2.7 - 3.1 kgf/sq.cm, 38 - 44 psi)
(p) Stop the engine. (q) Check that the fuel pressure remains as specified for 5 minutes after the
engine has stopped.
Fuel pressure: 147 kPa (1.5 kgf/sq.cm. 21 psi) or more
If pressure is not as specified. check the fuel pump, pressure regulator and/or injectors.
(r) After checking fuel pressure, disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery and
carefully remove the SST to prevent gasoline from
splashing. SST 09268-45012
(s) Remove the other union bolt. 3 gaskets and fuel pipe from the delivery pipes. (t) Reinstall the
fuel pipe with 4 new gaskets and the 2 union bolts.
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf)
(u) Reconnect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery. (v) Check for fuel leakage.
Page 2873
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2052
CHART 21
Page 3458
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 3574
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 1618
Page 1739
Thermostat: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications
Valve Opening Temperature
..........................................................................................................................................................
80 - 84° C (176 - 183° F)
Page 2630
Components For Removal And Installation Part 2 Of 2
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
KNOCK SENSORS REMOVAL
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT 2. REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE 3. REMOVE INTAKE AIR
CONNECTOR 4. REMOVE HIGH-TENSION CORDS WITH IGNITION COILS 5. REMOVE FUEL
PRESSURE REGULATOR 6. REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY 7. REMOVE WATER
BYPASS PIPE AND KNOCK SENSOR WIRE
Engine Controls - A/F And O2 Sensor Identification
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - A/F And O2 Sensor Identification
T-SB-0398-09
December 23, 2009
Engine Bank 1 and Bank 2 A/F and 02 Identification
Service Category Engine/Hybrid System
Section Engine Control
Market USA
Applicability
TSB SUPERSESSION NOTICE
The information contained in this TSB supersedes TSB No. EG034-07.
^ Applicability has been updated to include 2009 - 2010 model year vehicles and 2006 - 2010
model year Highlander HV.
TSB No. EG034-07 is Obsolete and any printed versions should be discarded. Be sure to review
the entire content of this service bulletin before proceeding.
Introduction
This service bulletin provides information on the proper identification of engine bank 1 and engine
bank 2 for correct A/F sensor and oxygen sensor replacement.
This bulletin contains information that identifies engine bank 1 and engine bank 2 on the following
engines: 1AZ-FE, 2AZ-FE, 2AZ-FE (PZEV), 1GR-FE, 2GR-FE, 2JZ-GE, 1MZ-FE, 3MZ-FE,
1UR-FE, 3UR-FE, 2UZ-FE 5VZ-FE and 1ZZ-FE.
^ Bank 1 (B1) refers to the bank that includes cylinder No. 1.
^ Bank 2 (B2) refers to the bank opposite bank 1.
^ Sensor 1 (S1) refers to the sensor that is located before the catalytic converters.
^ Sensor 2 (S2) refers to the sensor that is located after the catalytic converters.
Warranty Information
Page 1376
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
PRECAUTION
1. BEFORE WORKING ON FUEL SYSTEM, DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (-) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
HINT: Any diagnostic trouble code retained by the computer will be erased when the negative (-)
terminal cable is removed from the battery. Therefore, if necessary, read the diagnosis before
removing the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery.
2. DO NOT SMOKE OR WORK NEAR AN OPEN FLAME WHEN WORKING ON FUEL SYSTEM
FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE PROCEDURE
WHEN DISCONNECTING THE HIGH FUEL PRESSURE LINE, A LARGE AMOUNT OF
GASOLINE WILL SPILL OUT, SO OBSERVE THESE PROCEDURES:
(1) Disconnect the fuel pump connector. (2) Start the engine. After the engine has stopped on its
own, turn the ignition switch to LOCK.
(3) Put a container under the connection. (4) Slowly loosen the connection. (5) Disconnect the
connection. (6) Plug the connection with a rubber plug.
WHEN CONNECTING THE FLARE NUT OR UNION BOLT ON THE HIGH PRESSURE PIPE
UNION, OBSERVE THESE PROCEDURES:
Union Bolt Type:
- Always use 2 new gaskets.
- Tighten the union bolt by hand.
- Tighten the union bolt to the specified torque.
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf)
Flare Nut Type: Apply a light coat of engine oil to the flare nut and tighten the flare nut by hand.
Page 340
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 3994
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 2281
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4482
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 2221
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 607
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 1239
Part numbers remain the same.
Wheel Weight Part Numbers
Repair Procedure
On vehicles produced before the production change reduce the clamp width on Toyota wheel
weights.
Warranty Information
Page 731
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2779
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 4916
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Testing and Inspection
ABS ACTUATOR INSPECTION
1. Inspect battery positive voltage.
Battery positive voltage: 10-14 Volts.
2. Disconnect connectors.
Disconnect Connector
(a) Disconnect the connector from the actuator. (b) Disconnect the 2 connectors from the control
relay.
3. Connect actuator checker Special Service Tool (SST) to actuator.
Sub-Wire Harness C And Sub-Wire Harness E
(a) Connect the actuator checker (SST) to the actuator, control relay and body side wire harnesses
through the sub - wire harnesses C and E (SST),
as shown. SST 09990-00150, 09990-00200,09990-00210
(b) Connect the red cable of the checker to the battery positive (+) terminal and black cable to the
negative (-) terminal. Connect the black cable of
the sub-wire harnesses to the battery negative (-) terminal or body ground.
(c) Place the "SHEET L" (SST) on the actuator checker.
SST 09990 - 00370
4. Inspect brake actuator operation.
(a) Start the engine, and run it at idle.
Page 2204
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 3215
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2389
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 1500
Intake Manifold: Testing and Inspection
INSPECTION
Using precision straight edge and feeler gauge, measure the surfaces contacting the cylinder head
and intake air connector for warpage. Maximum warpage: 0.10 mm (0.0039 inch) If warpage is
greater than the maximum, replace the intake manifold.
Page 357
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2284
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 444
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 571
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 4871
(c) Using a screwdriver, remove the C-washer and bellcrank No.3 from the backing plate with
parking brake cable No.2. (d) Remove the parking brake bellcrank and dust cover with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 13 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
(e) Remove the bellcrank boot from the bellcrank bracket.
(f) Remove the C-washer and pin. (g) Remove the parking brake bellcrank from the bellcrank
bracket.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal, noting the following: Adjust bellcrank. See: Adjustments
- Check operation of automatic adjusting mechanism. See: Adjustments
- Check clearance between brake shoes and drum.
Specifications
Gear Sensor/Switch: Specifications
4WD-position Switch ...........................................................................................................................
................................................... 37 N.m (27 ft. lbs.) L4 Position Switch .............................................
...................................................................................................................................... 37 N.m (27 ft.
lbs.) Neutral Position Switch ................................................................................................................
........................................................... 37 N.m (27 ft. lbs.)
Page 2703
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 1979
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Locations
Door Lock Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 3373
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 3068
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The throttle position sensor is mounted in the throttle body and detects the throttle valve opening
angle. When the throttle valve is fully closed, a voltage of approximately 0.7 V is applied to terminal
VTA of the ECM. The voltage applied to the terminals VTA of the ECM increases in proportion to
the opening angle of the throttle valve and becomes approximately 2.7 ~ 5.2 V when the throttle
valve is fully opened. The ECM judges the vehicle driving conditions from these signals input from
terminals VTA and uses them as one of the conditions for deciding the air-fuel ratio correction,
power increase correction and fuel-cut control etc.
Page 1641
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Mechanical Specifications
ECT sensor to Intake Manifold 14 ft.lb
Page 2453
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 64
Inspection Procedure / Diagnosis Circuit (2 Of 2)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
ECU Power Source Circuit
ECU POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The ECU power source supplies power to the actuator and sensors, etc.. When terminal GND and
the cruise control ECU case are grounded.
ECU Power Source Circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
Page 1655
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Electrical Specifications
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Measure Terminals THA - E2 10 - 20 K ohms at -4 deg F
4 - 7 K ohms at 32 deg F
2 - 3 K ohms at 68 deg F
0.9 - 1.3 K ohms at 104 deg F
0.4 - 0.7 K ohms at 140 deg F
0.2 - 0.4 K ohms at 176 deg F
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSPECTION
NOTICE: "Cold" and "Hot" in these sentences express the temperature of the sensors themselves.
"Cold" is from -10°C (14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals.
Resistance:
Cold: 1,630 - 2,740 Ohms Hot: 2,065 - 3,225 Ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the crank shaft position sensor.
Page 230
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 3545
Ignition Coil: Testing and Inspection
IGNITION COIL INSPECTION
NOTICE: "Cold" and "Hot" in these sentences express the temperature of the coils themselves.
"Cold" is from -10°C (14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
1. REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE 2. DISCONNECT HIGH-TENSION CORDS AND IGNITION
COIL CONNECTORS FROM IGNITION COILS
3. INSPECT PRIMARY COIL RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the positive (+) and negative (-) terminals.
Primary coil resistance
Cold: 0.67 - 1.05 Ohms Hot: 0.85 - 1.23 Ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the ignition coil.
4. REMOVE IGNITION COILS
5. INSPECT SECONDARY COIL RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the positive (+) and high-tension terminals.
Secondary coil resistance:
Cold: 9.3 - 16.0 K ohms Hot: 11.7 - 18.8 K ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the ignition coil.
6. REINSTALL IGNITION COILS 7. RECONNECT IGNITION COIL CONNECTORS AND
HIGH-TENSION CORDS 8. REINSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE
Page 1861
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 1386
Valve Guide: Testing and Inspection
1. Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside diameter of the guide busing.
Bushing inside diameter: 6.010 - 6.030 mm (0.2366 - 0.2374 inch)
2. Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of the valve stem.
Valve stem diameter:
Intake: 5.970 - 5.985 mm (0.2350 - 0.2356 inch) Exhaust: 5.965 - 5.980 mm (0.2348 - 0.2354 inch)
3. Subtract the valve stem diameter measurement from the guide bushing inside diameter
measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
Intake: 0.025 - 0.060 mm (0.0010 - 0.0024 inch) Exhaust: 0.030 - 0.065 mm (0.0012 - 0.0026 inch)
maximum oil clearance:
Intake: 0.08 mm (0.0031 inch) Exhaust: 0.10 mm (0.0039 inch)
If the clearance is greater than the maximum, replace the valve and guide bushing.
Page 4932
Using a screwdriver, push the pistons in all the way and remove the piston stopper bolt and gasket.
NOTE: Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Torque 10 Nm (7 ft. lbs.)
5. Remove 2 pistons and springs.
Remove Snap Ring With Snap Ring Pliers
(a) Push in the piston with a screwdriver and remove the snap ring with snap ring pliers.
NOTE: Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the No.1 piston and spring by hand, pulling straight out, not at an angle.
CAUTION: If pulled out and install at an angle, there is a possibility that the cylinder bore could be
damaged.
REASSEMBLY CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the rubber lips on the pistons.
(c) Place a rag and 2 wooden blocks on the work table and lightly tap the cylinder flange against
the blocks until the No. 2 piston drops out of the
cylinder.
NOTE: Make sure the distance (A) from the rag to the top of the blocks is at least 100 mm (3.94
inch).
INSPECTION
NOTE: Clean the disassembled parts with compressed air.
1. Inspect cylinder bore for rust or scoring. 2. Inspect cylinder for wear or damage.
If necessary, clean or replace the cylinder.
REASSEMBLY
Page 3907
Electronically Controlled Transmission And A/T Indicator-Connectors
Service Specifications
Valve Body: Specifications Service Specifications
Keys
Drivetrain - Revised Rear Axle Oil Seal/Installation
Seals and Gaskets: Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Revised Rear Axle Oil Seal/Installation
DRIVELINE & DIFFERENTIAL DL002-03
August 6, 2003
Title: REAR AXLE SEAL DESIGN CHANGE
Models: '01 - '02 Sequoia, '95 - '02 Tacoma & '00 - '02 Tundra
Introduction
The rear axle seal lip design has been changed from a flat face type to an angled face type. A
different SST seal driver is required to install the seal properly and prevent damaging the oil seal
during the installation process.
NOTE:
Use of SST part number 09951-00610 (Replacer 6-4) as listed in the Repair Manual to install the
newly designed rear axle seal can damage the seal assembly causing it to leak. Repair Manual
update on Technical Information System (TIS) is in process.
Applicable Vehicles ^
2001 - 2002 model year Sequoia vehicles.
^ 1995 - 2002 model year Tacoma vehicles.
^ 2000 - 2002 model year Tundra vehicles.
Parts Information
Required SSTs
NOTE:
Additional SSTs may be ordered by calling SPX/OTC at 1-800-933-8335.
Required Tools & Material
Warranty Information
Identification Procedure
Description and Operation
Fillpipe Restrictor: Description and Operation
Fillpipe Restrictor
The fillpipe restrictor is used to prevent leaded fuel from being added to the fuel tank. The gasoline
pump for unleaded fuel has a smaller nozzle. The fillpipe restrictor will only allow the unleaded type
nozzle to be inserted into the fuel tank.
Page 1110
@ Compressor 7.2 ft/lbf (9.8 N.m, 100 Kgf/cm) @ Evaporator 24 ft/lbf (32.3 N.m, 330 Kgf/cm)
CAUTION:
Maintain clearance between the suction hose and other parts.
A. 4 Cylinder (L4) engine models:
a. Remove original suction hose.
b. Install new suction hose.
B. 6 Cylinder (V6) engine models:
a. Remove original suction hose.
b. Route the new suction hose around the power steering hose to install.
3. Perform Gas Charge and Leak Check procedures as explained in the A/C Installation Manual.
Page 4244
b. Using SST 09950-60020 (09951-00810), 09950-70010 (09951-07150) and a press, remove the
bearing from the steering knuckle.
ASSEMBLY
1. Install new bearing.
a. Using SST 09527-17011, 09950-60020 (09951-00910) and a press, install a new bearing to the
steering knuckle. b. Using snap ring pliers, install the snap ring.
2. Install new oil seal (Outside).
a. Using SST 09223-15030, 09527-17011 and a plastic hammer, install a new oil seal (outside). b.
Coat MP grease to the oil seal lip.
3. Install axle hub to steering knuckle.
a. Install the brake dust cover to the steering knuckle with the 4 bolts.
Torque to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
b. Using SST 09649-17010 and a press, install the axle hub to the steering knuckle.
4. Install ABS speed sensor rotor/spacer.
Page 649
CHART 5
CHART 6
Page 188
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 1682
Diagram Information and Instructions
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Testing and Inspection
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT BRAKE FLUID LEVEL WARNING SWITCH CONTINUITY
1. Check that there is no continuity between terminals with the switch OFF (float up). 2. Check that
there is continuity between terminals with the switch ON (float down).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
Page 4782
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Service and Repair
ABS Actuator Components
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect brake lines.
Disconnect Brake Lines
Page 2483
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2391
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4033
Springs / Upper Valve Body
Page 146
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 3902
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 4049
RETAINERS, PIN, STOPPER, CHECK BALLS AND STRAINER LOCATION
1. RETAINER, STOPPER AND PIN
Specifications
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Specifications
Main Bearing Cap Bolts:
Torque:
1st Pass ...............................................................................................................................................
...................................... 61 Nm (45 ft. lbs.) 2nd Pass .........................................................................
................................................................................................................................ + 90°
Main Bearing Clearance:
Standard:
No. 1: Standard
................................................................................................................................................ 0.020 0.038 mm (0.0008 - 0.0015 inch) U/S 0.25
................................................................................................................................................ 0.019 0.059 mm (0.0007 - 0.0023 inch)
Others:
STD
.......................................................................................................................................................
0.024 - 0.042 mm (0.0009 - 0.0017 inch) U/S
.................................................................................................................................................
0.250.023 - 0.063 mm (0.0009 - 0.0025 inch) Maximum clearance
...........................................................................................................................................................
0.08 mm (0.0031 inch)
If replacing the cylinder block subassembly, the bearing standard clearance will be:
No. 1
......................................................................................................................................................
0.010 - 0.049 mm (0.0004 - 0.0020 inch) Others
.................................................................................................................................................... 0.014
- 0.053 mm (0.0006 - 0.0021 inch)
Bearing Size Codes
Page 3798
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The park/neutral position switch goes on when the shift lever is in the N or P shift position. When it
goes on terminal NSW of the ECM is grounded to body ground via the starter relay, thus the
terminal NSW voltage becomes 0 V. When the shift lever is in the D, 2, L or R position, the
park/neutral position switch goes off, so the voltage of ECM, terminal NSW becomes battery
voltage, the voltage of the ECM internal power source.
If the shift lever is moved from the N position to the D position, this signal is used for air-fuel ratio
correction and for idle speed control (estimated control), etc.
Locations
One Touch 2-4 Selector System
Page 2551
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 860
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 659
CHART 20
Diagram Information and Instructions
Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 3682
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 2429
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 1962
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 1509
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Service and Repair
NOTE: There are 2 methods (A and B) to replace the oil seal which are as follows:
A. If rear oil seal retainer is removed from cylinder block.
1. Using a screwdriver and a hammer, tap out the oil seal.
2. Using Special Service Tool (SST) Oil Seal & Bearing Replacer # 09223 - 15030, Handle Set #
09950 - 70010 (Handle 150 # 09951 - 07150)
or equivalents and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal until its surface is flush with the oil seal retainer
edge.
3. Apply Multipurpose (MP) grease to the oil seal lip.
B. If rear oil seal retainer is installed to cylinder block.
1. Using a knife, cut off the oil seal lip. 2. Using a screwdriver, pry out the oil seal.
CAUTION: Be careful not to damage the crankshaft. Tape the screwdriver tip.
3. Apply MP grease to a new oil seal lip.
4. Using SST Oil Seal & Bearing Replacer # 09223 - 15030, Handle Set # 09950 - 70010 (Handle
150 # 09951 - 07150) or equivalents and a
hammer, tap in the oil seal until its surface is flush with the rear oil seal retainer edge.
Locations
Starter Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 2641
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Testing and Inspection
Check the MIL (1) The MIL comes on when the ignition switch is turned ON and the engine is not
running.
HINT: If the MIL does not light up, troubleshoot the combination meter.
(2) When the engine started, the MIL should go off. If the lamp remains on, the diagnosis system
has detected a malfunction or abnormality in the
system
Page 1699
5. When using the radiator cap tester, tilt it more than 30 degrees.
6. Pump the radiator cap tester several times, and check the maximum pressure.
Pumping speed: 1 pump/second
HINT:
Stop pumping when the valve opens and read the gauge. The gauge must be within the standard
values listed below when the pressure valve opens. The cap is considered OK when the pressure
holds steady or falls very slowly, but holds within the standard values listed below for one minute.
Specification:
If the maximum pressure is less than the minimum standard value, replace the radiator cap
sub-assembly.
Page 2523
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Testing and Inspection
Shift Interlock Control Module: Testing and Inspection
Shift Lock ECU, Harness Side: Floor Shift
Floor Shift:
Inspect shift lock control ECU. Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage at terminal.
HINT: Do not disconnect the ECU connector.
Page 4910
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Service and Repair Disassembly and Assembly
DISASSEMBLY
1. Remove valve bracket.
(a) Remove the nut, bolt and plate washers. (b) Remove the 2 nuts, and remove the valve bracket
and set plate from the valve body.
2. Disconnect spring from valve.
Using pliers, remove the clip, and remove the spring from the valve.
3. Remove shackles No.1 and No.2.
(a) Remove the nut and bolt, and then remove the load sensing spring and 2 plate washers. (b)
Loosen the 2 nuts, and remove the shackle No.1 from the shackle No.2.
4. Disassemble load sensing spring.
Disassembly the these parts: 4 Bushings.
- 2 Collars.
- 2 Rubber plates.
- Load sensing valve boot.
- Load sensing spring boot.
INSPECTION
Page 759
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 3466
Page 1452
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Engine Oil
API Classification ................................................................................................... SH Energy
Conserving II, SJ Energy Conserving, or ILAC Multigrade Above 0° F (-18°C) ..................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
... 10W-30 All Temperatures ................................................................................................................
.......................................................................................... 5w-30
Page 3704
8. REMOVE KNOCK SENSORS
Using SST. remove the knock sensor. SST 09817-16011
KNOCK SENSOR INSTALLATION
1. REINSTALL KNOCK SENSORS
Using SST, install the knock sensor. SST 09817-16011
Torque: 39 N.m (400 kgf.cm. 29 ft.lbf)
2. REINSTALL WATER BYPASS PIPE AND KNOCK SENSOR WIRE 3. REINSTALL INTAKE
MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY 4. REINSTALL FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR 5. REINSTALL
HIGH-TENSION CORDS WITH IGNITION COILS 6. REINSTALL INTAKE AIR CONNECTOR 7.
REINSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE 8. REFILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT 9. RECHECK ENGINE
COOLANT LEVEL
Page 4288
Companion Flange: Specifications Rear
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Flange Nuts .........................................................................................................................................
.............................................. 196 Nm (145 ft. lbs.)
Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 1895
Camshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Cam Sensor to Cylinder Head 69 in.lb
Testing and Inspection
Shift Interlock Switch: Testing and Inspection
Inspect shift lock control switch.
Inspect that there is continuity between each terminal. If the continuity is not as specified. Replace
the switch.
Locations
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 3750
Electronically Controlled Transmission And A/T Indicator-Connectors
Page 3339
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 518
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 2068
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer's complaint.
Page 1139
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Fluid Type T-IV Replaces Type T-II
TRANSMISSION & CLUTCH TC003-98
June 19, 1998
Title: AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID TYPE T-IV
Models: ALL MODELS
Introduction
The introduction of Automatic Transmission Fluid type T-IV makes type T-II obsolete. Use type T-IV
for all applications that specify ATF type T-II.
Affected Vehicles
^ All vehicles with Automatic Transmissions specified to use ATF Types T-II or T-IV.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Page 2525
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 3633
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4817
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Disassembly and Reassembly
Front Brake Components (4WD)
DISASSEMBLY
1. Remove cylinder boot set rings and boots.
Using a screwdriver, remove the 4 cylinder boot set rings and 4 boots from the caliper.
Page 4318
HINT: When replacing the rear propeller shaft spider on 4WD vehicles, be sure that the grease
fitting assembly hole is facing in the direction shown in the illustration.
Page 4591
Page 3489
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 3160
EGR Valve: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT EGR VALVE
Check for sticking and heavy carbon deposits. If a problem is found, replace the EGR valve.
Page 2757
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 1599
6. ADJUST ELECTRODE GAP
Carefully bend the outer electrode to obtain the correct electrode gap.
Correct electrode gap: 1.1 mm (0.043 in.)
7. REINSTALL SPARK PLUGS
Torque: 18 N.m (180 kgf.cm, 13 ft.lbf)
8. REINSTALL IGNITION COILS 9. RECONNECT HIGH-TENSION CORDS
Page 1802
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Pressure Specification
Fuel Pressure: Specifications Fuel System Pressure
Fuel System Pressure
Idle Pressure - No Vacuum 38 to 44 PSI psi
Idle Pressure - With Vacuum 33-38 PSI
5 Minutes After Ignition Off 21 PSI or More
Page 2780
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 3858
Forward Clutch
Page 2653
Engine Bank Identification
Capacity Specifications
Fluid - Differential: Capacity Specifications
Front Differential
TYPE....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ GL-5* CAPACITY Front ..............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. 1.10L (1.16 Qt) With A.D.D [1] ..........................................................................................................
................................................................................... 1.15L (1.22 Qt) VISCOSITY Below -18° C (0°
F) .........................................................................................................................................................
............................... 80W, 80W-90 Above -18° C (0° F) ......................................................................
..................................................................................................................................... 90 With A.D.D
..............................................................................................................................................................
................................................. 75W-90
[1] Automatic Disconnecting Differential
Rear Differential
Rear Differential Fluid Capacity*
4WD Extra Long Model: 2.05L (2.17 Qt) w/ Differential Lock Short Model: 2.65L (2.80 Qt) w/
Differential Lock Extra Long Model: 2.95L (3.18 Qt) w/o Differential Lock: 2.55L (2.69 Qt)
Fluid level should be less than 0.20 in (5mm) below the fill plug.
*Capacities are approximate
Page 3751
Shift Indicator: Electrical Diagrams
Electronically Controlled Transmission And A/T Indicator (Part 1 Of 3)
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Camshaft Position Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSPECTION
NOTICE: "Cold" and "Hot" in these sentences express the temperature of the sensors themselves.
"Cold" is from -10°C (14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
1. DISCONNECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR CONNECTOR
2. INSPECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals.
Resistance:
Cold: 835 - 1,400 Ohms Hot: 1,060 - 1,645 Ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the camshaft position sensor.
3. RECONNECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR CONNECTOR
Page 2352
Adjusting Shim Selection Chart (Exhaust)
Page 1815
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 2 Of 2
Page 2279
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 749
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 1484
Oil Pressure Sender: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT LOW OIL PRESSURE WARNING SWITCH
1. Disconnect the connector from the switch. 2. Check that there is continuity between terminal and
ground with the engine stopped. 3. Check that there is no continuity between terminal and ground
with the engine running.
HINT: Oil pressure should be over 49 kPa (0.5 kg/Sq.cm, 7.1 psi).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
Page 2547
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 4610
K: 2.00-2.05 mm (0.0787-0.0807 inch) L: 2.05-2.10 mm (0.0807-0.0827 inch)
Page 1589
Page 3857
First and Reverse Brake
Page 345
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Page 3036
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2655
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - O2 Sensor Monitor Threshold
Values
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS SS002-03
December 17, 2003
Title O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05)
Models All '96 - '03, '04 Corolla, ECHO, Matrix, Sienna & Scion xA & xB
Introduction
This Service Bulletin contains Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Monitor threshold values for all models from
1996 to 2003 and some 2004 models. Starting in 2004, the O2S Monitor threshold values can be
found in the repair manual. These values are used when analyzing the O2S test results to
determine the O2S condition.
Applicable Vehicles ^
All 1996 - 2003 model year Toyota vehicles.
^ 2004 model year Corolla, ECHO, Matrix and Sienna vehicles.
^ 2004 model year Scion xA and xB vehicles.
Function Description
Checking O2S Test Results
To view O2S test results, the O2S Monitor must be completed and the test results must be
checked within the same key cycle. If the ignition key is cycled OFF, the O2S test results will be set
to the minimum or maximum limits, and all test results will be erased. The O2S test results are
stored in the ECU (SAE term: Powertrain Control Module/PCM) when the monitor is completed.
The test results are static and will not change once the monitor is complete.
The process for checking 02S test results is described in the following three basic steps:
1. Completing the O2S Readiness Monitor.
2. Accessing O2S Test Results.
3. Comparing O2S Test Results to Failure Thresholds.
Required SSTs
NOTE:
Additional Diagnostic Tester Kits, Program Cards or other SSTs may be ordered by calling
SPX-OTC at 1-800-933-8335.
Warranty Information
Completing O2S Readiness Monitor
1. Clear any stored Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) using the Toyota Diagnostic Tester.
Page 2867
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Fuel - Idle Speed Increased by Replacement ECM
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Idle Speed Increased by Replacement
ECM
ENGINE EG001-98
FEBRUARY 13, 1998
2RZ ECM IDLE SPEED
MODELS: '95-'97 TACOMA
Introduction Operating logic of 1995-1997 Tacoma ECMs has been revised to improve engine idle
smoothness (with transmission in "D" range) by increasing idle speed (A/C "OFF") from 600 RPM
to 700 RPM. The change has also narrowed the RPM transition between A/C "OFF" and A/C "ON"
engagement.
Affected Vehicles 1995-1997 Tacoma 4x2 equipped with 2RZ-FE four cylinder engine and automatic transmission.
Part Number Information
Production Change Information No production changes have been made.
- This change applies only to replacement ECMs available through parts supply.
Warranty Information
Applicable Warranty: This repair is covered under the Toyota Powertrain Warranty. This warranty Is
in effect for 60 months or 60,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in service date.
Specifications
Ignition Cable: Specifications
Maximum Resistance per Cord 25 K ohms
Page 3504
Page 2975
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 55
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Locations
Actuator Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 1951
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 688
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 3275
Page 1391
4. Hand-lap the valve and valve seat with an abrasive compound. 5. After hand-lapping, clean the
valve and valve seat.
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Knock Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
KNOCK SENSOR INSPECTION
1. REMOVE KNOCK SENSORS
See: Service and Repair
2. INSPECT KNOCK SENSORS
Using an ohmmeter, check that there is no continuity between the terminal and body. If there is
continuity, replace the sensor.
Page 3733
Locations-J/B No.3 Behind The Instrument Panel Center (Fig 22)
Parts Location
Parts Location
Page 763
Torque: 5.4 Nm (55 kgf-cm, 48 inch lbs.)
8. CONNECT NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
Page 3732
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Page 2415
Page 19
Engine Compartment (Fig 18)
Instrument Panel (Fig 18)
Locations
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Camshaft Position Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSPECTION
NOTICE: "Cold" and "Hot" in these sentences express the temperature of the sensors themselves.
"Cold" is from -10°C (14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
1. DISCONNECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR CONNECTOR
2. INSPECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals.
Resistance:
Cold: 835 - 1,400 Ohms Hot: 1,060 - 1,645 Ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the camshaft position sensor.
3. RECONNECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR CONNECTOR
Page 4321
Yoke: Bearing With drill mark: With color mark (Red) No drill mark: No color mark
5. Install spider bearings.
a. Apply MP grease to a new spider and bearings.
NOTICE: Be careful not to apply too much grease.
b. Align the matchmarks on the yoke and shaft.
c. Fit the spider into the yoke. d. Using SST 09332-25010, install new bearings on the spider.
e. Using SST, adjust both bearings so that the snap ring grooves are at Maximum and equal
widths.
DANA
6. Install snap rings.
a. Install 2 new snap rings of equal thickness which will allow 0-0.05 mm (0-0.0020 inch) axial play.
HINT: Do not reuse the snap rings.
Color: Thickness Green: 1.384 mm (0.0545 inch) Red: 1.435 mm (0.0565 inch) Black: 1.486 mm
(0.0585 inch) Copper: 1.511 mm (0.0595 inch) Silver: 1.537 mm (0.0605 inch) Yellow: 1.588 mm
(0.0625 inch) Blue: 1.638 mm (0.0645 inch)
Front Differential Pinion Seal
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Front Differential Pinion Seal
REPLACEMENT
1. REMOVE UNDER COVER 2. REMOVE FRONT PROPELLER SHAFT 3. REMOVE
COMPANION FLANGE
a. Using a chisel and hammer, unstake the nut. b. Using SST to hold the flange, remove the nut.
SST 09330-00021
c. Using SST, remove the companion flange.
SST 09950-30011 (09951-03010, 09953-03010, 09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03020)
Fuel - Idle Speed Increased by Replacement ECM
Idle Speed: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Idle Speed Increased by Replacement ECM
ENGINE EG001-98
FEBRUARY 13, 1998
2RZ ECM IDLE SPEED
MODELS: '95-'97 TACOMA
Introduction Operating logic of 1995-1997 Tacoma ECMs has been revised to improve engine idle
smoothness (with transmission in "D" range) by increasing idle speed (A/C "OFF") from 600 RPM
to 700 RPM. The change has also narrowed the RPM transition between A/C "OFF" and A/C "ON"
engagement.
Affected Vehicles 1995-1997 Tacoma 4x2 equipped with 2RZ-FE four cylinder engine and automatic transmission.
Part Number Information
Production Change Information No production changes have been made.
- This change applies only to replacement ECMs available through parts supply.
Warranty Information
Applicable Warranty: This repair is covered under the Toyota Powertrain Warranty. This warranty Is
in effect for 60 months or 60,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in service date.
Page 442
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4129
b. Using SST 09950-60010 (09951-00650), 09950-70010 (09951-07150) and a press, remove the
plate washer and outer race from the
differential carrier.
15. Remove ring gear.
a. Place matchmarks on the ring gear and differential case.
b. Using a screwdriver, unstake the lock plates. c. Remove the 10 bolts and 5 lock plates. d. Using
a plastic hammer, tap on the ring gear to separate it from the differential case.
16. Remove side bearings. Using SST 09950-40010 (09951-04010, 09952-04010, 09953-04020,
09954-04010, 09955-04060, 09957-04010,
09958-04010), 09950-60010 (09951-00480), remove the side bearings from the differential case.
HINT: Fix the claws of SST to the notch in the differential case.
17. Disassemble differential case assembly.
a. Using a pin punch and a hammer, remove the straight pin. b. Remove these parts from the
differential case:
^ Pinion shaft.
^ 2 pinion gears.
^ 2 pinion gear thrust washers.
^ 2 side gears.
^ 2 side gear thrust washers.
Locations
Shift Interlock Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 3612
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 195
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 747
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 2776
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2111
Page 200
Locations
Power Distribution Relay: Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 2844
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 2098
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 3932
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 2285
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Locations
Four Wheel Drive Selector Relay: Locations
Automatic Differential Disconnect (A.D.D.) Component Locations
Page 2406
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 1714
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 1305
Connecting Rod: Specifications Connecting Rod Nut
Connecting Rod Nut
Torque:
1st Pass ...............................................................................................................................................
......................... 25 N-m (250 kgf-cm, 18 ft-lbf) 2nd Pass ....................................................................
........................................................................................................................................... + 90°
Page 1901
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Pressure Specification
Fuel Pressure: Specifications Fuel System Pressure
Fuel System Pressure
Idle Pressure - No Vacuum 38 to 44 PSI psi
Idle Pressure - With Vacuum 33-38 PSI
5 Minutes After Ignition Off 21 PSI or More
Page 3465
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 1881
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3014
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 1644
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Specifications
Between Terminals Measured Resistance
At Clearance: 0 mm (0 in.) VTA - E2 0.2 - 5.7 K ohms
Throttle Fully Opened VTA - E2 2.0 - 10.2 K ohms
At all Times VC - E2 2.5 - 5.9 K ohms
Ohmmeter Connection
Page 2501
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Direct Clutch
Direct Clutch
Page 3393
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 643
Page 507
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 2118
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 3853
First and Reverse Brake
Page 4723
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated
Procedures
DTC P0505 Idle Control System Malfunction
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The rotary solenoid type IAC valve is located in front of the intake air chamber and intake air
bypassing the throttle valve is directed to the IAC valve through a passage. In this way the intake
air volume bypassing the throttle valve is regulated, controlling the engine speed. The ECM
operates only the IAC valve to perform idle-up and provide feedback for the target idling speed and
a VSV for idle up control is also added (for air conditioning).
DETECTING CONDITION
WIRING DIAGRAM
Step 1
Page 582
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 4216
7. 3RZ-FE, 5VZ-FE W/ Diff. lock:
REMOVE FRONT BEARING OUTER RACE AND OIL STORAGE RING a. Using SST, remove the
front bearing outer race.
SST 09308-00010
b. Using a screwdriver, bend the oil storage ring and remove it.
8. REMOVE BEARING SPACER
a. 3RZ-FE, 5VZ-FE w/o Diff. lock:
Remove the 2 washers.
b. Remove the bearing spacer.
9. INSTALL NEW BEARING SPACER
a. Install a new bearing spacer. b. 3RZ-FE, 5VZ-FE w/o Diff. lock:
Install the 2 washers.
10. 3RZ-FE, 5VZ-FE w/ Diff. lock:
INSTALL OIL STORAGE RING AND FRONT BEARING OUTER RACE a. Using SST and a
hammer, install a new oil storage ring.
SST 09316-60011 (09316-00011, 09316-00021)
b. Using SST and a hammer, install the front bearing outer race.
SST 09316-60011 (09316-00011, 09316-00021)
11. INSTALL FRONT BEARING
a. Place the front bearing. b. Except 3RZ-FE, 5VZ-FE w/o Diff. lock: Place the oil slinger. c. Using
SST and the companion flange, install the front bearing then remove the companion flange.
SST 09950-30011 (09951-03010, 09953-03010, 09954-03010, 09955-03030, 09956-03020,
09956-03050)
12. INSTALL NEW OIL SEAL
Page 609
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 176
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 4569
3. Remove oil pump plate.
a. Using a Torx socket wrench, unscrew the 3 Torx screws. (Torx socket wrench (T30
09042-00010).
Torque: 7.4 N.m (65 inch lbs.)
b. Remove the oil pump plate.
4. Remove drive rotor and driven rotor.
INSTALLATION HINT: Apply gear oil to the both rotors.
INSPECTION
1. Inspect driven rotor body clearance.
Push the driven rotor to one side of the body. Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance.
Standard Clearance: 0.09-0.16 mm (0.0035-0.0063 inch) Maximum Clearance: 0.16 mm (0.0063
inch)
If the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the drive rotor, driven rotor or pump body.
2. Inspect both rotor tips clearance.
Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between both rotor tips.
Standard Clearance: 0.05-0.15 mm (0.0020-0.0059 inch) Maximum Clearance: 0.15 mm (0.0059
inch)
If the clearance exceeds the Maximum, replace the drive rotor, driven rotor or pump body.
3. Inspect both rotors side clearance.
Using a steel straight edge and feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the rotors and
straight edge.
Standard Clearance: 0.03-0.10 mm (0.0012-0.0039 inch) Maximum Clearance: 0.10 mm (0.0039
inch)
Service Specifications
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications Service Specifications
DIMENSIONS
Free Distance
..............................................................................................................................................................
18.2 - 18.8 mm (0.712 -0.740 inch) Gear Backlash:
STD
.............................................................................................................................................................
0.020 - 0.200 mm (0.0008 - 0.0079 inch) Maximum ............................................................................
..................................................................................................... 0.30 mm (0.0188 inch)
Page 3544
Page 796
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
System Schematic
Sensor Cut-Away
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The mass air flow meter uses a platinum hot wire. The hot wire air flow meter consists of a
platinum hot wire, thermistor and a control circuit installed in a plastic housing. The hot wire air flow
meter works on the principle that the hot wire and thermistor located in the intake air bypass of the
housing detect any changes in the intake air temperature. The hot wire is maintained at the set
temperature by controlling the current flow through the hot wire. This current flow is then measured
as the output voltage of the air flow meter. The circuit is constructed so that the platinum hot wire
and thermistor provide a bridge circuit, with the power transistor controlled so that the potential of
(A) and (B) remains equal to maintain the set temperature.
Wheels - Aluminum Weight Retention Improvement
Wheels: Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Aluminum Weight Retention Improvement
SUSPENSION SU001-98
May 29, 1998
Title: ALUMINUM WHEEL WEIGHT RETENTION IMPROVEMENT
Models: '97 4Runner & Tacoma
Introduction
A groove has been added to both the inner and outer wheel flanges to improve wheel weight
retention on 1997 4Runner and Tacoma vehicles.
NOTE:
If wheel identification is necessary, break the tire bead from the aluminum wheel and inspect the
wheel flange for the added groove.
Production Change Information
^ 1997 4Runners starting with the following VINs:
JT3GM84R * V0010422 JT3GN86R * V0029236 JT3GN87R * V0029236 JT3HM84R * V0020616
JT3HM84R * V9002018 JT3HN86R * V0079293 JT3HN87R * V0079293
^ 1997 Tacomas starting with the following VINs:
4TANL42N * VZ258665 4TAVL52N * VZ258598 4TAVN52N * VZ258534 4TAPM62N * VZ258494
4TAPN62N * VZ258175 4TAWM72N * VZ258616 4TAWN72N * VZ258593 4TAWN74N *
VZ258593
Parts Information
Page 429
Backup Lamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
BACK-UP LIGHT SWITCH INSPECTION
INSPECT SWITCH CONTINUITY
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Disassembly
Connecting Rod: Service and Repair Disassembly
1. Using a small screwdriver, pry out the 2 snap rings.
2. Gradually heat the piston to about 60° C (140° F).
3. Using a plastic-faced hammer and brass bar, lightly tap out the piston pin and remove the
connecting rod.
NOTE: ^
The piston and pin are a matched set.
^ Arrange the pistons, pins, rings, connecting rods and bearings in the correct order.
Page 150
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 1 Of 2
Page 2568
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 1 Of 2
Page 3117
Catalytic Converter: Service and Repair
CATALYTIC CONVERTER REPLACEMENT
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
REMOVE CENTER EXHAUST PIPE
Remove the 4 bolts, TWC joint retainer. center exhaust pipe and 2 gasket.
Torque: 62 N.m (632 kgf.cm. 40 ft.lbf)
INSTALLATION HINT: Place 2 new gaskets on the front exhaust and tail pipes. and temporarily
install the center exhaust pipe.
Page 4670
Location Of Splice Points (Fig 36)
System Outline
Previous automatic transmissions have selected each gear shift using mechanically controlled
throttle hydraulic pressure, governor hydraulic pressure and lock-up hydraulic pressure. The
Electronically Controlled Transmission, however, electrically controls the governor pressure and
lock-up pressure through the solenoid valve. Control of the solenoid valve by the Engine Control
Module based on the input signals from each sensor makes smooth driving possible by shift
selection for each gear which is most appropriate to the driving conditions at that time.
1. GEAR SHIFT OPERATION
During driving, the Engine Control Module selects the shift for each gear which is most appropriate
to the driving conditions, based on input signals from the Engine Coolant Temp. Sensor to
TERMINAL THW of the Engine Control Module and also the input signals to TERMINAL SP2+ of
the Engine Control Module from the Vehicle Speed Sensor devoted to the Electronically Controlled
Transmission. Current is then output to the Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid. When
shifting to 1st speed, current flows from TERMINAL S1 of the Engine Control Module -->
TERMINAL 1 of the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid --> GROUND, and continuity
to the No.1 solenoid causes the shift.
For 2nd speed, current flows from TERMINAL S1 of the Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 1 of
the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid --> GROUND, and from TERMINAL S2 of the
Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 2 of the Electronically Controlled Transmission solenoid -->
GROUND. and continuity to Solenoid No.1 and No.2 causes the shift.
For 3rd speed. there is no continuity to No.1 solenoid, only to No.2 causing the shift. Shifting into
4th speed (Overdrive) takes place when there is no continuity to either No.1 or No.2 Solenoid.
2. LOCK-UP OPERATION
When the Engine Control Module judges from each signal that lock-up operation conditions have
been met, current flows from TERMINAL SL of the Engine Control Module --> TERMINAL 3 of the
Electronically Controlled Transmission Solenoid --> GROUND, causing continuity to the lock-up
solenoid and causing lock-up operation.
3. STOP LIGHT SW CIRCUIT
If the brake pedal is depressed (Stop Light SW ON) when driving in lock-up condition, a signal is
input to TERMINAL BK of the Engine Control Module, the Engine Control Module operates and
continuity to the lock-up solenoid is cut.
4. OVERDRIVE CIRCUIT
^ O/D Main SW ON When the O/D main SW is turned ON, a signal is input to TERMINAL OD2 of
the Engine Control Module and Engine Control Module
Page 3299
(l) Reinstall the No.2 timing belt cover with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 9 N.m (90 kgf.cm, 80 in.lbf)
(m)Start the engine.
(n) Disconnect the vacuum sensing hose from the fuel pressure regulator. and plug the hose end.
(o) Measure the fuel pressure at idle.
Fuel pressure 265 - 304 kPa (2.7 - 3.1 kgf/sq.cm, 38 - 44 psi)
(p) Stop the engine. (q) Check that the fuel pressure remains as specified for 5 minutes after the
engine has stopped.
Fuel pressure: 147 kPa (1.5 kgf/sq.cm. 21 psi) or more
If pressure is not as specified. check the fuel pump, pressure regulator and/or injectors.
(r) After checking fuel pressure, disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery and
carefully remove the SST to prevent gasoline from
splashing. SST 09268-45012
(s) Remove the other union bolt. 3 gaskets and fuel pipe from the delivery pipes. (t) Reinstall the
fuel pipe with 4 new gaskets and the 2 union bolts.
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf)
(u) Reconnect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery. (v) Check for fuel leakage.
Page 496
Specifications
Fill Plug: Specifications
Fill Plug ................................................................................................................................................
................................................... 37 N.m (27 ft. lbs.)
Page 3792
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2584
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 3660
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 3847
Case: Specifications Service Specifications
TRANSMISSION CASE Transmission Case Bushing, Maximum
........................................................................................................................................... 38.19 mm
(1.5035 inch)
Page 1955
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Testing and Inspection
Shift Interlock Switch: Testing and Inspection
Inspect shift lock control switch.
Inspect that there is continuity between each terminal. If the continuity is not as specified. Replace
the switch.
Page 4395
Extension Housing: Service and Repair
1. Remove reverse restrict pin.
a. Using a Torx socket wrench (T40), remove the screw plug. b. Using a pin punch and hammer,
drive out the slotted spring pin. c. Remove the reverse restrict pin.
2. Inspect reverse restrict pin.
Turn and push the reverse restrict pin by hand. Check for smooth operation.
3. Install reverse restrict pin.
a. Install the reverse restrict pin to the extension houseing or transfer adaptor. b. Using a pin punch
and hammer, drive in the slotted spring pin, as shown. c. Apply sealant to the plug threads.
Sealant: THREE BOND 1344, LOCTITE 242 or equivalent.
d. Using a Torx socket wrench (T40), install and torque the screw plug.
Torque: 19 N.m (14 ft. lbs.)
Page 439
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 1459
Engine Oil: Testing and Inspection Oil Quality Check
1. Check engine oil quality.
Check the oil for deterioration, entry of water, discoloring or thinning. If the oil quality is visibly poor,
replace it.
2. Oil grade:
API grade SH, Energy-Conserving II multigrade engine oil or ILSAC multigrade engine oil.
Recommended viscosity is as shown in the illustration. SAE 5W-30 being the preferred engine oil.
Page 296
Diagram Information and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 1070
(e) Install the timing belt in this order: (1) LH camshaft timing pulley. (2) No. 2 idler pulley. (3) RH
camshaft timing pulley. (4) Water pump pulley. (5) Crankshaft timing pulley. (6) No. 1 idler pulley.
8. Set timing belt tensioner.
(a) Using a press, slowly press in the push rod using 981 - 9,807 N (200 - 2,205 lbs.) of pressure.
(b) Align the holes of the push rod and housing, pass a 1.27 mm hexagon wrench through the
holes to keep the setting position of the push rod. (c)
Release the press.
(d) Install the dust boot to the tensioner.
9. Install timing belt tensioner.
(a) Temporarily install the tensioner with the 2 bolts.
(b) Alternately tighten the 2 bolts.
Torque: 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.) Remove the 1.27 mm hexagon wrench from the tensioner.
10. Check valve timing.
Page 3212
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 4182
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 448
Stop Light Switch Circuit
Page 4331
Flex Plate: Specifications Service Specifications
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Drive Plate Runout:
Maximum .............................................................................................................................................
.................................... 0.20 mm (0.0079 inch)
Page 3459
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 4567
Page 3289
Fuel Pressure Regulator: Service and Repair
Components For Removal And Installation Part 1 Of 2
Page 3665
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 383
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 811
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3174
5. REINSTALL PCV VALVE
Specifications
Output Shaft: Specifications
OUTPUT SHAFT Thrust Play ..............................................................................................................
................................................. 0.27 - 0.86 mm (0.0106 - 0.0339 inch)
Page 583
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 2924
2. Start the engine.
3. Perform the drive pattern to run and complete the Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Monitor.
HINT:
The 02S Monitor is completed when the following conditions are met:
^ Two (2) minutes or more passed after the engine start.
^ The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) is 167°F (75°C) or more.
^ Cumulative running time at 30 mph (48 km/h) or more exceeds 6 minutes.
^ Vehicle is in closed loop.
^ The fuel-cut is operated for 8 seconds or more (for Rear O2S Monitor).
A. Allow the engine to idle for two minutes.
B. Warm up the engine until the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) reaches 167°F (75°C).
C. Drive the vehicle over 30 mph (48 km/h) for more than 40 seconds.
D. Stop the vehicle and allow the engine to idle for more than 20 seconds.
E. Repeat steps C and D at least 8 times in one driving cycle. (Do not cycle the ignition key.)
In addition, perform the following steps for the Rear O2S Readiness Monitor:
A. Select second gear.
B. Allow the vehicle to run at 30 mph (48 km/h) or more.
C. Keep the accelerator pedal "off-idle" for more than 10 seconds.
D. Immediately after step C, release the accelerator pedal for at least 10 seconds without
depressing the brake pedal (to execute the fuel-cut).
E. Decelerate the vehicle until the vehicle speed reaches less than 6mph (10km/h).
F. Repeat steps B - E at least twice in one driving cycle.
Accessing O2S Test Results
1. On the Diagnostic Tester* screen, select the following menus:
^ DIAGNOSTICS
^ CARB OBD II
Page 1371
Adjusting Shim Selection Chart (Exhaust)
Page 537
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Knock Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2673
CHART 15
Page 994
RZN171L Camber: ..............................................................................................................................
..................................................... 0° 20' ± 45' (0.33° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
Caster: .................................................................................................................................................
.................................... 1° 45' ± 45' (1.75° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
Steering Inclination:
..............................................................................................................................................................
10° 30' ± 45' (10.5° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
VZN170L Camber: ...............................................................................................................................
.................................................... 0° 20' ± 45' (0.33° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
Caster: .................................................................................................................................................
.................................... 1° 45' ± 45' (1.75° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
Steering Inclination:
..............................................................................................................................................................
10° 30' ± 45' (10.5° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
3. inspect camber, caster and steering axis inclination. If the steering axis inclination is not within
the specification, after camber and caster have
correctly adjusted, recheck the steering knuckle front wheel for bearing or looseness.
Measuring Point Reference
4. Inspect toe-in. If the toe-in is not within the specification, adjust the rack ends.
(A + B) = 0° 12' ± 12' (0.02° ± 0.02°) (C - D) = 2 ± 2 mm (0.08 ± 0.08 inch)
5. Adjust camber and caster.
a. Loosen the front and/or rear adjusting cam nuts. b. Adjust the camber and caster by front and/or
rear adjusting cams.
HINT: Try to adjust the camber and caster to the center value.
c. Torque the front and/or rear adjusting cam nuts.
Torque to 130 Nm (96 ft. lbs.)
6. Adjust toe-in and wheel angle. Tie rod end length left-right error: Less than 1.5 mm (0.059 inch)
HINT: First, check or adjust the lengths of the tie rod ends, then adjust the toe-in.
a. Remove the boot clamps. b. Loosen the rack end lock nuts.
Page 3610
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4239
Axle Shaft: Application and ID
Joint Color ID:
Outboard ..............................................................................................................................................
............................................................... Black
Inboard ................................................................................................................................................
............................................................. Yellow
Page 1852
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 2822
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 606
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 4870
(a) Using Special Service Tool (SST) # 09703 - 30010, disconnect the return spring.
(b) Using SST, remove the shoe hold-down spring, cups and pin.
SST 09718 - 00010
(c) Disconnect the anchor spring from the rear shoe and remove the rear shoe. (d) Remove the
anchor spring from the front shoe.
4. Remove front shoe.
(a) Using SST, remove the shoe hold-down spring, cups and pin.
SST 09718 - 00010
(b) Remove the return spring from the front shoe. (c) Disconnect the parking brake cable No.1 from
the parking brake bellcrank No.3. (d) Remove the front shoe with adjuster. (e) Disconnect the
parking brake cable from the front shoe.
5. Remove adjuster from front shoe.
(a) Remove the adjusting lever spring. (b) Remove the adjuster.
6. Remove automatic adjusting lever and parking brake lever.
Remove E-Ring And C-Washer
(a) Remove the E-ring. (b) Remove the automatic adjusting lever. (c) Remove the C-washer. (d)
Remove the parking brake lever.
7. Remove and disassemble parking brake bellcrank.
(a) Remove the clip and disconnect the parking brake cable. (b) Remove the tension spring.
Removal and Installation
Radiator: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
1. Drain engine coolant. 2. Remove front bumper filler. 3. Remove radiator grille.
(a) Remove the 4 screws and clearance lights.
A/T - Fluid Interchangeability
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Fluid Interchangeability
TRANSMISSION & CLUTCH TC003-99
Title: AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUIDS
Models: All Models
May 21, 1999
REVISION NOTICE:
The information contained in this TSB updates TC003-98 dated June 19, 1998.
Introduction
Automatic Transmission Fluid Type T-IV now replaces Type T-II fluid. Use Type T-IV for all
applications that specify ATF Type T-II.
Please refer to the following table for the interchangeability between each ATF.
Affected Vehicles
^ All vehicles produced after 1993 with Automatic Transmissions specified to use ATF Type T, T-II
and T-IV.
NOTICE:
With the exception of mixing ATF Type T with Type T-IV fluids, different types of fluids must not be
mixed.
Parts Information
SIZE NEW PART NUMBER PART NAME
4 Liter 08886-01705 ATF Type T-IV
Warranty Information
Page 3608
Ignition Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2229
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 3411
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 4761
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 2045
CHART 12
CHART 13
Page 1348
(c) Position the piston rings so that the ring ends are as shown.
CAUTION: Do not align the end gaps.
3. Install bearings.
(a) Align the bearing claw with the groove of the connecting rod or connecting cap.
(b) Install the bearings in the connecting rod and connecting rod cap.
Page 1281
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the backlash.
Standard backlash: 0.020 - 0.200 mm (0.0008 - 0.0079 inch) Maximum backlash: 0.30 mm (0.0188
inch) If the backlash is greater than the maximum, replace the camshafts.
Page 4774
Electronic Brake Control Module: Testing and Inspection
NOTE: - Tools Required:
- TOYOTA hand-held tester, or equivalent.
- TOYOTA break-out-box, or equivalent.
Connect Hand-Held Tester And Break-Out-Box
1. Hook up the hand-held tester and break-out-box to the vehicle. 2. Read the ECU input/output
values by following the prompts on the tester screen.
NOTE: Hand-held tester has a "Snapshot" function. This records the measured values and is effective in
the diagnosis of intermittent problems.
Please refer to the hand-held tester/break-out-box operator's manual for further details.
Page 4052
RETAINERS, CLIP, CHECK BALLS, STRAINERS, SPRINGS AND VALVES AND LOCATION
1. RETAINER AND CLIP
Page 3898
operation causes gear shift when the conditions for overdrive are met.
^ O/D Main SW OFF When the O/D main SW is turned to OFF, the current flowing through the O/D
OFF indicator light flows through the O/D main SW to GROUND, causing the indicator light to light
up. At the same time, a signal is input to TERMINAL OD2 of the Engine Control Module and
Engine Control Module operation prevents shift into overdrive.
5. A/T OIL TEMP. WARNING
When the A/T Oil Temp. Sensor affixed to the transmission case detects that the fluid temp. is
150°C (302°F) or more, the Engine Control Module operates and the current flowing through the
GAUGE fuse flows to the A/T Oil Temp. warning light --> TERMINAL OIL-W of the Engine Control
Module --> Ground, so that the warning light lights up, informing that the Oil Temp. is high. When
the Oil Temp. drops to 120°C (248°F) or less, the Engine Control Module stops operating and the
warning light goes out.
Page 3606
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 1545
(e) Install the timing belt in this order: (1) LH camshaft timing pulley. (2) No. 2 idler pulley. (3) RH
camshaft timing pulley. (4) Water pump pulley. (5) Crankshaft timing pulley. (6) No. 1 idler pulley.
8. Set timing belt tensioner.
(a) Using a press, slowly press in the push rod using 981 - 9,807 N (200 - 2,205 lbs.) of pressure.
(b) Align the holes of the push rod and housing, pass a 1.27 mm hexagon wrench through the
holes to keep the setting position of the push rod. (c)
Release the press.
(d) Install the dust boot to the tensioner.
9. Install timing belt tensioner.
(a) Temporarily install the tensioner with the 2 bolts.
(b) Alternately tighten the 2 bolts.
Torque: 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.) Remove the 1.27 mm hexagon wrench from the tensioner.
10. Check valve timing.
Locations
One Touch 2-4 Selector System
Page 3806
Torque: 5.4 Nm (55 kgf-cm, 48 inch lbs.)
8. CONNECT NO.2 VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR
Page 4783
Using Special Service Tool (SST) # 09023 - 00100, disconnect the 5 brake lines from the Anti-Lock
Brake System (ABS) actuator. Torque: 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.)
2. Disconnect connectors.
Disconnect the 2 connectors from the actuator.
3. Remove control relay from actuator bracket. 4. Remove ABS actuator.
(a) Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts and ABS actuator assembly.
Torque: 19 Nm (14 ft. lbs.)
(b) Remove the bolt and connector clamp. (c) Remove the 3 nuts and ABS actuator from the
actuator bracket.
Torque: 5.4 Nm (48 inch lbs.)
(d) Remove the 3 holders and cushions from the ABS actuator.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. After installation, fill brake reservoir with brake fluid,
bleed brake system. Refer to Brakes. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair Check for leaks.
Page 2112
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The throttle position sensor is mounted in the throttle body and detects the throttle valve opening
angle. When the throttle valve is fully closed, a voltage of approximately 0.7 V is applied to terminal
VTA of the ECM. The voltage applied to the terminals VTA of the ECM increases in proportion to
the opening angle of the throttle valve and becomes approximately 2.7 ~ 5.2 V when the throttle
valve is fully opened. The ECM judges the vehicle driving conditions from these signals input from
terminals VTA and uses them as one of the conditions for deciding the air-fuel ratio correction,
power increase correction and fuel-cut control etc.
Page 2504
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 1002
Fuel Pressure: Specifications Volume Specification
Information not supplied by the manufacturer.
Page 4609
4. Insert high and low clutch hub onto clutch sleeve.
a. Install the clutch hub and 3 shifting keys onto the clutch sleeve. b. Install the-2-shifting key
springs under the shifting keys.
NOTICE: Install the key springs positioned so that their end gaps are not in line.
5. Install high and low clutch hub assembly.
Using SST 09316-60011 (09316-00011) and a hammer, drive in a new key retainer.
NOTICE: Be careful not to deform or damage the key retainer.
b. Using a press, install the high and low clutch hub assembly.
6. Install snap ring.
Select a snap ring that will allow minimum axial play and install it to the shaft.
A: 2.10-2.15 mm (0.0827-0.0846 inch) B: 2.15-2.20 mm (0.0846-0.0866 inch) C: 2.20-2.25 mm
(0.0866-0.0886 inch) D: 2.25-2.30 mm (0.0886-0.0906 inch) E: 2.30-2.35 mm (0.0906-0.0925 inch)
F: 2.35-2.40 mm (0.0925-0.0945 inch) G: 2.40-2.45 mm (0.0945-0.0965 inch) H: 2.45-2.50 mm
(0.0965-0.0984 inch) J: 2.50-2.55 mm (0.0984-0.1004 inch)
Page 2260
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The crankshaft position sensor, which detects the engine speed and crankshaft angle signal (NE
signal), has been installed on the oil pump body. The NE signal plate has 34 teeth. The NE signal
sensor generates 34 signals for every engine revolution. The ECM detects the standard crankshaft
angle based on the G signals and the actual crankshaft angle and the engine speed by the NE
signals.
Locations
Page 2998
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 718
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 3686
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 375
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2061
Page 3518
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 4378
Counter Gear: Application and ID
Counter Gear Snap Ring Thickness, Front
Mark A .................................................................................................................................................
............... 2.00-2.05 mm (0.0787-0.0807 inch) Mark B ........................................................................
........................................................................................ 2.05-2.10 mm (0.0807-0.0827 inch) Mark C
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. 2.10-2.15 mm (0.0827-0.0846 inch) Mark D .....................................................................................
........................................................................... 2.15-2.20 mm (0.0846-0.0866 inch) Mark E ............
....................................................................................................................................................
2.20-2.25 mm (0.0866-0.0886 inch) Mark F ........................................................................................
......................................................................... 2.25-2.30 mm (0.0886-0.0906 inch)
Counter Gear Snap Ring Thickness, Rear
Mark A .................................................................................................................................................
............... 2.80-2.85 mm (0.1102-0.1122 inch) Mark B ........................................................................
........................................................................................ 2.85-2.90 mm (0.1122-0.1142 inch) Mark C
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. 2.90-2i95 mm (0.1142-0.1161 inch) Mark D .....................................................................................
........................................................................... 2.95-3.00 mm (0.1161-0.1181 inch) Mark E ............
....................................................................................................................................................
3.00-3.05 mm (0.1181-0.1201 inch) Mark F ........................................................................................
......................................................................... 3.05-3.10 mm (0.1201-0.1220 inch) Mark G .............
...................................................................................................................................................
3.10-3.15 mm (0.1220-0.1240 inch)
Page 3409
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Page 4734
Transmission Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Vehicle NO.2 Speed Sensor Inspection Procedure
- Remove NO.2 vehicle speed sensor. - Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of NO.2
vehicle speed sensor.
Resistance: 560 Ohms to 680 Ohms
- Check voltage between terminals 1 and 2 of the NO.2 speed sensor when a magnet is put close
to the front end of the NO.2 vehicle speed sensor
then taken away quickly.
- Voltage is generated intermittenly.
Note: The voltages generated is extremely low.
Page 3181
EGR Temperature Sensor: Testing and Inspection
EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR INSPECTION Except Model No. VZN17O - 4wd Long
Wheel Base
1. REMOVE EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
2. INSPECT EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between the terminals.
Resistance:
At 50°C (122°F): 84 - 97 K ohms At 100°C (212°F): 11 - 16 K ohms At 150°C (302°F): 2 - 4 K ohms
If the resistance is not as specified. replace the sensor.
3. REINSTALL EGR GAS TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Torque: 20 N.m (200 kgf.cm, 14 ft.lbf)
Page 2599
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Service and Repair
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
IAC VALVE REMOVAL
1. REMOVE THROTTLE BODY
2. REMOVE IAC VALVE
Remove the 4 screws. IAC valve and gasket.
INSTALLATION HINT: Place a new gasket on the throttle body.
IAC VALVE INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 25
Power Door Lock Relay: Testing and Inspection Integration Relay Inspection
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY OPERATION
Key-Off Power Window Signal:
HINT: When the relay circuit is as specified, inspect the key-off power window signal.
1. Connect the connector to the relay. 2. Connect the positive (+) lead from the voltmeter to
terminal 5 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 11. 3. Close the door with ignition switch turned to
LOCK or ACC, check that the meter needle indicates battery positive voltage. 4. Open the door.
check that the meter needle indicates 0.0V.
5. Turn the ignition switch ON, check that the meter needle indicate battery positive voltage again.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
Page 4174
13. Inspect tooth contact between ring gear and drive pinion.
a. Coat 3 or 4 teeth at three different position on the ring gear with red lead. b. Hold the companion
flange firmly and rotate the ring gear in both directions.
c. Inspect the teeth pattern. If the teeth are not contacting properly, use the following chart to select
a proper washer for correction.
Washer thickness (Mark and Thickness): 87 1.87 mm (0.0736 inch) 88 1.88 mm (0.0740 inch) 89
1.89 mm (0.0744 inch) 90 1.90 mm (0.0748 inch) 91 1.91 mm (0.0752 inch) 92 1.92 mm (0.0756
inch) 93 1.93 mm (0.0760 inch) 94 1.94 mm (0.0764 inch) 95 1.95 mm (0.0768 inch) 96 1.96 mm
(0.0772 inch) 97 1.97 mm (0.0776 inch) 98 1.98 mm (0.0780 inch) 99 1.99 mm (0.0783 inch) 00
2.00 mm (0.0787 inch) 01 2.01 mm (0.0791 inch) 02 2.02 mm (0.0795 inch) 03 2.03 mm (0.0799
inch) 04 2.04 mm (0.0803 inch)
Page 2450
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Mechanical Specifications
ECT sensor to Intake Manifold 14 ft.lb
Page 2207
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 700
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
Sensor Cut-Away
Reference
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
To obtain a high purification rate for the CO, HC and NOx components of the exhaust gas, a
three-way catalytic converter is used, but for the most efficient use of the three-way catalytic
converter, the air-fuel ratio must be precisely controlled so that it is always close to the
stoichiometric air-fuel ratio.
The oxygen sensor has the characteristic whereby its output voltage changes suddenly in the
vicinity of the stoichiometric air-fuel ratio. This characteristic is used to detect the oxygen
concentration in the exhaust gas and provide feedback to the computer for control of the air-fuel
ratio.
When the air-fuel ratio becomes LEAN, the oxygen concentration in the exhaust increases and the
oxygen sensor informs the ECM of the LEAN condition (small electromotive force: 0 V).
When the air-fuel ratio is RICHER than the stoichiometric air-fuel ratio the oxygen concentration in
the exhaust gas is reduced and the oxygen sensor informs the ECM of the RICH condition (large
electromotive force: 1 V).
The ECM judges by the electromotive force from the oxygen sensor whether the air-fuel ratio is
RICH or LEAN and controls the injection time accordingly. However, if malfunction of the oxygen
sensor causes output of abnormal electromotive force, the ECM is unable to perform accurate
air-fuel ratio control.
The heated oxygen sensors include a heater which heats the Zirconia element. The heater is
controlled by the ECM. When the intake air volume is low (the temperature of the exhaust gas is
low) current flows to the heater to heat the sensor for accurate oxygen concentration detection.
Page 2458
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2409
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Service and Repair
Solenoid: Service and Repair
1. Remove A.D.D. switch. 2. Remove sleeve fork pin.
a. Using a hexagon wrench, remove the screw plug. b. Using a pin punch and a hammer, remove
the pin through the hole of clutch case cover.
3. Separate actuator from clutch case cover and remove sleeve fork. Using a hexagon wrench,
remove the screw plug.
b. Remove the spring seat, spring and steel ball. c. Remove the 2 bolts and actuator from the
clutch case cover. d. Separate the actuator from the clutch case cover and remove the sleeve fork.
e. Remove the O-ring from the actuator.
4. Install sleeve fork and actuator into clutch case cover.
a. Install a new O-ring to the actuator. b. Coat the O-ring with MP grease. c. Place the sleeve fork
and install the actuator to the clutch case cover. d. Torque the 2 bolts.
Torque to 21 Nm (15 ft. lbs.)
e. Install the steel ball, spring and spring seat. f.
Coat the threads of screw plug with FIPG.
FIPG: Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281, or equivalent.
g. Using a hexagon wrench, install the screw plug.
Torque to 13 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
5. Install sleeve fork pin.
a. Using a pin punch and a hammer, install the pin through the hole of clutch case cover. b. Coat
the threads of screw plug with FIPG: Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281, or equivalent. c.
Using a hexagon wrench, install the screw plug.
Torque to 20 Nm (14 ft. lbs.)
6. Install A.D.D. switch. Install a new gasket and indicator switch.
Torque to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
Page 2353
1. Using a micrometer, measure the thickness of the removed shim. 2. Calculate the thickness of a
new shim so the valve clearance comes within the specified value.
T-Thickness of used shim A-Measured valve clearance N-Thickness of new shim Intake: N = T +
(A - 0.18 mm (0.007 inch)) Exhaust: N = T + (A - 0.32 mm (0.013 inch))
3. Select a new shim with a thickness as close as possible to the calculated values.
HINT: Shims are available in 17 sizes in increments of 0.050 mm (0.0020 inch), from 2.500 mm
(0.0984 inch) to 3.300 mm (0.1299 inch).
c. Install a new adjusting shim.
1. Place a new adjusting shim on the valve lifter, with imprinted numbers facing down.
2. Press down the valve lifter with SST (A), and remove SST (B).
SST 09248-55040 (09248-05410, 09248-05420)
d. Recheck the valve clearance.
6. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVERS 7. INSTALL INTAKE AIR CONNECTOR
Page 2099
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 3107
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
The No.1 vehicle speed sensor outputs a 4-pulse signal for every revolution of the rotor shaft,
which is rotated by the transmission output shaft via the driven gear.
After this signal is converted into a more precise rectangular waveform by the waveform shaping
circuit inside the combination meter, it is then transmitted to the ECM. The ECM determines the
vehicle speed based on the frequency of these pulse signals.
The No.2 vehicle speed sensor detects the rotation speed of the transmission output shaft and
sends signals to the ECM. The ECM determines the vehicle speed based on these signals.
An AC voltage is generated in the No.2 vehicle speed sensor coil as the rotor mounted on the
output shaft rotates, and this voltage is sent to the ECM.
The gear shift point and lock-up timing are controlled by the ECM based on the signals from this
vehicle speed sensor and the throttle position sensor signal.
If the No.2 vehicle speed sensor malfunctions, the ECM uses input signals from the No.1 vehicle
speed sensor as a back-up signal.
Replacement
Clutch Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Draw out fluid with syringe.
2. Disconnect clutch line.
Using Special Service Tool (SST) 09023-00100, disconnect the line. use a container to catch the
fluid.
Torque: 15 N.m (132 inch lbs.)
3. Remove clip and clevis pin. 4. Remove mounting nuts and pull out master cylinder.
Torque: 13 N.m (108 inch lbs.)
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
HINT: After installation, bleed system and adjust clutch pedal.
Page 698
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 4489
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4122
Maximum vertical runout: 0.09 mm (0.0035 inch) Maximum lateral runout: 0.09 mm (0.0035 inch) If
the runout is not within the specification, replace the companion flange.
2. Check ring gear runout. Using a dial indicator, measure the ring gear runout.
Maximum runout: 0.05 mm (0.0020 inch) If the runout is not within the specification, replace the
ring gear.
3. Check ring gear backlash. Using a dial indicator, measure the ring gear backlash.
Backlash: 0.13 - 0.18 mm (0.0051 - 0.0071 inch)
If the backlash is not within the specification, adjust the side bearing preload or repair as
necessary.
4. Check tooth contact between ring gear and drive pinion.
5. Check side gear backlash. Measure the side gear backlash with holding one pinion gear toward
the case.
Backlash: 0.05 - 0.20 mm (0.0020 - 0.0079 inch)
Page 1748
Locations
Page 1995
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 453
Inspection Procedure / Stop Light Switch Circuit (4 Of 4)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Page 2259
Page 1465
Oil Cooler: Testing and Inspection
INSPECTION
Check the oil cooler for damage or clogging. If necessary, replace the oil cooler.
Page 3416
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 663
Page 4611
Output Shaft: Service and Repair Without Automatic Disconnecting Differential
NOTE: For removal and installation procedures refer to "Transfer Case, Service and Repair."
DISASSEMBLY
Page 3456
Power Window
A: System Title
B: Indicates a Relay Block. No shading is used and only the Relay Block No. is shown to
distinguish it from the J/B.
Example: 1 Indicates Relay Block No. 1.
C: Indicates the connector to be connected to a part (the numeral indicates the pin No.)
Explanation of pin use.
Testing and Inspection
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT MIRROR SWITCH CONTINUITY
Left side:
Right side:
If continuity is not as specified, replace the switch.
Specifications
Clutch Master Cylinder: Specifications
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Slotted Spring Pin Protrusion
............................................................................................................................................ 1.5-3.5
mm (0.059-0.138 inch)
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Master Cylinder Installation Nut
.................................................................................................................................................... 13
N.m (108 inch lbs.)
Page 285
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 1065
16. Remove starter wire bracket and No. 1 timing belt cover.
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and starter wire bracket.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts and timing belt cover.
17. Remove timing belt guide.
18. Set No. 1 cylinder at Top Dead Center (TDC)/compression.
(a) Temporarily install the crankshaft pulley bolt to the crankshaft.
(b) Turn the crankshaft, and align the timing marks of the crankshaft timing pulley and oil pump
body.
CAUTION: Always turn the crankshaft clockwise.
(c) Check that the timing marks of the camshaft timing pulleys and No. 3 timing belt cover are
aligned. If not, turn the crankshaft pulley 1 revolution (360°).
(d) Remove the crankshaft pulley bolt.
19. If reusing timing belt, check installation marks on timing belt.
Check that there are 3 installation marks and front mark on the timing belt. If the installation and
front marks have disappeared, before removing the timing belt, place 3 new installation marks on
the timing belt to match the timing marks of the timing pulleys, and place a new front mark on the
timing belt.
20. Remove timing belt tensioner.
Page 504
Camshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Cam Sensor to Cylinder Head 69 in.lb
Page 2490
Step 2
TOYOTA hand-held tester
Step 1
Step 2
OBD II scan tool (excluding TOYOTA hand-held tester)
Page 4346
Junction Block And Wire Harness Connector
Page 2621
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 788
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor Location
Page 2390
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 18
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 3211
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 3446
Throttle Body: Service and Repair
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
THROTTLE BODY REMOVAL
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT 2. DISCONNECT THESE CABLES:
(a) w/ Cruise control:
Cruise control actuator cable
(b) Accelerator cable (c) A/T:
Throttle cable
3. REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE 4. DISCONNECT THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
CONNECTOR 5. DISCONNECT IAC VALVE CONNECTOR 6. REMOVE THROTTLE BODY
Page 2550
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 2408
Brake Signal: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 2416
Brake Signal: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
This signal is used to detect when the brakes have been applied. The STP signal voltage is the
same as the voltage supplied to the stop lights. The STP signal is used mainly to control the fuel
cut-off engine speed. (The fuel cut-off engine speed is reduced slightly when the vehicle is
braking.)
Page 588
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Disconnection of Male and Female Connectors
Disconnection Of Male And Female Connectors
To pull apart the connectors, pull on the connector itself, not the wire harness.
HINT: Check to see what kind of connector you are disconnecting before pulling apart.
How to Replace Terminals
Special Tool
1. Prepare The Special Tool
HINT: To remove the terminal from the connector, please construct and use the special tool or like
object shown on the left.
2. Disconnect Connector
Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer
3. Disengage The Secondary Locking Device Or Terminal Retainer.
a. Locking device must be disengaged before the terminal locking clip can be released and the
terminal removed from the connector.
Page 1756
Catalytic Converter: Testing and Inspection
EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY INSPECTION
1. CHECK CONNECTIONS FOR LOOSENESS OR DAMAGE 2. CHECK CLAMPS FOR
WEAKNESS, CRACKS OR DAMAGE.
THREE - WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER INSPECTION CHECK FOR DENTS OR DAMAGE
If any part of the protector is damaged or dented to the extent that it contacts the three-way
catalytic converter. repair or replace it.
HEAT INSULATOR INSPECTION
1. CHECK HEAT INSULATOR FOR DAMAGE 2. CHECK FOR ADEQUATE CLEARANCE
BETWEEN CATALYTIC CONVERTER AND HEAT INSULATOR
Page 2242
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Crankshaft Sensor to Oil Pump 69 in.lb
Page 3960
Page 4442
Reverse Idler Gear: Service and Repair Bearing Replacement
If necessary, replace counter gear front bearing. a. Using a snap ring expander, remove the snap
ring.
b. Using SST 09950-00020 and a press, remove the bearing. c. Replace the side race.
d. Using a socket wrench and press, install a new bearing and side race.
Specifications
Pinion Gear: Specifications
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
Preload (At Starting)
....................................................................................................................................................... 0.6
- 1.0 Nm (5.2 - 8.7 inch lbs.)
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Pinion Nut [1] .......................................................................................................................................
........................... 223 Nm (165 ft. lbs.) Maximum
[1]: Tighten in 13 Nm (9 ft. lbs.) increments (a little at a time until the specified preload is reached).
Page 3645
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR REMOVAL
1. REMOVE NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER 2. REMOVE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the camshaft position sensor connector.
(b) Remove the bolts and camshaft position sensor.
Torque: 7.8 N.m (80 kgf.cm, 69 in.lbf)
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Testing and Inspection
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve: Testing and Inspection
PCV VALVE INSPECTION
1. REMOVE PCV VALVE
(a) Disconnect the PCV hose from the PCV valve. (b) Remove the PCV valve.
2. INSTALL CLEAN HOSE TO PCV VALVE 3. INSPECT PCV VALVE OPERATION
(a) Blow air into the cylinder head cover side and check that air passes through easily.
CAUTION: Do not suck air through the valve. Petroleum substances inside the valve are harmful.
(b) Blow air into the air intake chamber side and check that air passes through with difficulty.
(c) Blow air into the air intake chamber side when lift up the inside valve and check that there is a
strong resistance to air flow.
If operation is not as specified, replace the PCV valve.
4. REMOVE CLEAN HOSE FROM PCV VALVE
Page 493
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2916
Engine Bank Identification
Page 3388
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 1051
Adjusting Shim Selection Chart (Intake)
Page 2031
^ O2S TEST RESULTS
A list of the available oxygen sensors will be displayed.
2. Select the desired oxygen sensor and press Enter.
NOTE:
The monitor result of the A/F sensor will not be displayed. If you select "Bank 1-Sensor 1" or Bank
2-Sensor 1" for a vehicle equipped with an A/F sensor, the Diagnostic Tester will display "No
parameter to display."
3. Compare the test results with the values listed in the Failure Threshold Chart.
* Although this procedure references the Toyota Diagnostic Tester, the O2S test results can be
checked using a generic OBD II scantool. Refer to your OBD II scantool operator's manual for
specific procedures.
Comparing O2S Test Results to Failure Thresholds
1. Determine the correct O2S Failure Threshold Chart for your vehicle by looking in the "O2S
Application Table," in this bulletin.
2. Select appropriate year, model, and engine for specified O2S Failure Threshold Chart.
3. Compare O2S test results with the specified O2S Failure Threshold Chart. It may be necessary
to convert O2S test results to a specific measurement unit using the conversion factor that is
supplied in the specified table. See example.
Example:
Page 714
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 2002
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Diagrams
Page 2619
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2689
Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Specifications
Between Terminals Measured Resistance
At Clearance: 0 mm (0 in.) VTA - E2 0.2 - 5.7 K ohms
Throttle Fully Opened VTA - E2 2.0 - 10.2 K ohms
At all Times VC - E2 2.5 - 5.9 K ohms
Ohmmeter Connection
Page 2338
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Recommended Spark Plugs
ND K16TR11
NGK BKR5EKB-11
Page 3256
Fuel Injector: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications Pressure Drop
Pressure Drop
Resistance Per Injector Approx. 13.8 ohms
Injection Volume 3.4 - 4.2 cu in. Per 15 seconds
Difference Between Injectors 0.31 or less
Leakage Rate Per Injector 1 drop or less per Minute
Page 4659
Location Of Connector Joining Wire Harness And Wire Harness, Ground Points (Fig 36)
Ground Points
Ground Points
Page 2184
Finding A Short Circuit
a. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect all loads of the fuse. b. Connect a test light in place of
the fuse. c. Establish conditions in which the test light comes ON.
Example: A- Ignition SW ON B- Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C- Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(Connect the Relay) and SW 2 OFF (or Disconnect SW 2)
d. Disconnect and reconnect the connectors while watching the test light.
The short lies between the connector where the test light stays lit and the connector where the light
goes out.
e. Find the exact location of the short by lightly shaking the problem wire along the body.
CAUTION:
a. Do not open the cover or the case of the ECU unless absolutely necessary. (If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be destroyed by
static electricity.)
B. When replacing the internal mechanism (ECU part) of the digital meter, be careful that no part of
your body or clothing comes in contact
with the terminals of leads from the IC, etc. of the replacement part (spare part).
Voltage Check
Page 218
Locations-J/B No.1 Left Kick Panel (Fig 20)
Details
Page 2222
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2054
Page 4040
Lower Valve Body / Strainer, Spring and Valve
Page 3946
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 2384
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 1 Of 2)
Page 1574
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
PRECAUTION
1. BEFORE WORKING ON FUEL SYSTEM, DISCONNECT NEGATIVE (-) TERMINAL CABLE
FROM BATTERY
HINT: Any diagnostic trouble code retained by the computer will be erased when the negative (-)
terminal cable is removed from the battery. Therefore, if necessary, read the diagnosis before
removing the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery.
2. DO NOT SMOKE OR WORK NEAR AN OPEN FLAME WHEN WORKING ON FUEL SYSTEM
FUEL PRESSURE RELEASE PROCEDURE
WHEN DISCONNECTING THE HIGH FUEL PRESSURE LINE, A LARGE AMOUNT OF
GASOLINE WILL SPILL OUT, SO OBSERVE THESE PROCEDURES:
(1) Disconnect the fuel pump connector. (2) Start the engine. After the engine has stopped on its
own, turn the ignition switch to LOCK.
(3) Put a container under the connection. (4) Slowly loosen the connection. (5) Disconnect the
connection. (6) Plug the connection with a rubber plug.
WHEN CONNECTING THE FLARE NUT OR UNION BOLT ON THE HIGH PRESSURE PIPE
UNION, OBSERVE THESE PROCEDURES:
Union Bolt Type:
- Always use 2 new gaskets.
- Tighten the union bolt by hand.
- Tighten the union bolt to the specified torque.
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf)
Flare Nut Type: Apply a light coat of engine oil to the flare nut and tighten the flare nut by hand.
Page 2903
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
Knock sensors are fitted one each to the right bank and left bank of the cylinder block to detect
engine knocking. This sensor contains a piezoelectric element which generates a voltage when it
becomes deformed, which occurs when the cylinder block vibrates due to knocking. If engine
knocking occurs, ignition timing is retarded to suppress it.
Page 3351
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Service and Repair
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
IAC VALVE REMOVAL
1. REMOVE THROTTLE BODY
2. REMOVE IAC VALVE
Remove the 4 screws. IAC valve and gasket.
INSTALLATION HINT: Place a new gasket on the throttle body.
IAC VALVE INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Specifications
Timing Belt: Specifications
Timing Belt Replacement Interval
60,000 miles (96,000 km)
Page 2037
O2S Application Table
O2S Failure Threshold Charts
Page 4484
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 1922
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Mechanical Specifications
ECT sensor to Intake Manifold 14 ft.lb
Page 1723
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Diagrams
Standard Value Of ECU Terminals
Page 1181
Power Steering Fluid: Testing and Inspection Fluid Pressure Check
1. Remove air cleaner assembly. Loosen the 3 bolts. 2. Connect SST.
a. Disconnect the pressure feed tube from the PS vane pump. b. Connect the SST 09640-10010
(09641-01010, 09641-01030, 09641-01060), as shown.
NOTICE: Check that the valve of the SST is in the open position.
3. bleed power steering system. 4. Boost fluid temperature.
a. Start the engine and run it at idle. b. Turn the steering wheel from lock to lock several times to
boost fluid temperature.
Fluid temperature: 80° C (176° F)
5. Check fluid pressure reading with valve closed. With the engine idling, close the valve of the
SST and observe the reading on the SST.
Fluid pressure: 8,336 kPa (1,209 psi) Minimum
NOTICE: ^
Do not keep the valve closed for more than 10 seconds.
^ Do not let the fluid temperature become too high.
Page 1112
Refrigerant Lines
Page 2985
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
Sensor Cut-Away
Reference
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
To obtain a high purification rate for the CO, HC and NOx components of the exhaust gas, a
three-way catalytic converter is used, but for the most efficient use of the three-way catalytic
converter, the air-fuel ratio must be precisely controlled so that it is always close to the
stoichiometric air-fuel ratio.
The oxygen sensor has the characteristic whereby its output voltage changes suddenly in the
vicinity of the stoichiometric air-fuel ratio. This characteristic is used to detect the oxygen
concentration in the exhaust gas and provide feedback to the computer for control of the air-fuel
ratio.
When the air-fuel ratio becomes LEAN, the oxygen concentration in the exhaust increases and the
oxygen sensor informs the ECM of the LEAN condition (small electromotive force: 0 V).
When the air-fuel ratio is RICHER than the stoichiometric air-fuel ratio the oxygen concentration in
the exhaust gas is reduced and the oxygen sensor informs the ECM of the RICH condition (large
electromotive force: 1 V).
The ECM judges by the electromotive force from the oxygen sensor whether the air-fuel ratio is
RICH or LEAN and controls the injection time accordingly. However, if malfunction of the oxygen
sensor causes output of abnormal electromotive force, the ECM is unable to perform accurate
air-fuel ratio control.
The heated oxygen sensors include a heater which heats the Zirconia element. The heater is
controlled by the ECM. When the intake air volume is low (the temperature of the exhaust gas is
low) current flows to the heater to heat the sensor for accurate oxygen concentration detection.
Page 2733
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 13
Inspect Relay Circuit
2. INSPECT RELAY CIRCUIT
Remove the relay from the junction block No.1 and inspect the connectors on the junction block
side.
If circuit is as specified, try replacing the relay with a new one. If circuit is not as specified, inspect
the circuits connected to other parts.
Page 4931
Components
DISASSEMBLY
1. Remove reservoir.
(a) Remove the set screw and pull out the reservoir.
Torque: 1.7 Nm (16 inch lbs.)
(b) Remove the cap and strainer from the reservoir.
2. Remove 2 grommets. 3. Place cylinder in vise. 4. Remove piston stopper bolt.
Page 3413
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Service and Repair
Solenoid: Service and Repair
1. Remove A.D.D. switch. 2. Remove sleeve fork pin.
a. Using a hexagon wrench, remove the screw plug. b. Using a pin punch and a hammer, remove
the pin through the hole of clutch case cover.
3. Separate actuator from clutch case cover and remove sleeve fork. Using a hexagon wrench,
remove the screw plug.
b. Remove the spring seat, spring and steel ball. c. Remove the 2 bolts and actuator from the
clutch case cover. d. Separate the actuator from the clutch case cover and remove the sleeve fork.
e. Remove the O-ring from the actuator.
4. Install sleeve fork and actuator into clutch case cover.
a. Install a new O-ring to the actuator. b. Coat the O-ring with MP grease. c. Place the sleeve fork
and install the actuator to the clutch case cover. d. Torque the 2 bolts.
Torque to 21 Nm (15 ft. lbs.)
e. Install the steel ball, spring and spring seat. f.
Coat the threads of screw plug with FIPG.
FIPG: Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281, or equivalent.
g. Using a hexagon wrench, install the screw plug.
Torque to 13 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
5. Install sleeve fork pin.
a. Using a pin punch and a hammer, install the pin through the hole of clutch case cover. b. Coat
the threads of screw plug with FIPG: Part No. 08826-00090, THREE BOND 1281, or equivalent. c.
Using a hexagon wrench, install the screw plug.
Torque to 20 Nm (14 ft. lbs.)
6. Install A.D.D. switch. Install a new gasket and indicator switch.
Torque to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
Page 2908
Components For Removal And Installation Part 2 Of 2
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
KNOCK SENSORS REMOVAL
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT 2. REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE 3. REMOVE INTAKE AIR
CONNECTOR 4. REMOVE HIGH-TENSION CORDS WITH IGNITION COILS 5. REMOVE FUEL
PRESSURE REGULATOR 6. REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY 7. REMOVE WATER
BYPASS PIPE AND KNOCK SENSOR WIRE
Page 4047
4. PLACE UPPER VALVE BODY WITH PLATE AND GASKETS ON TOP OF LOWER VALVE
BODY
Align each bolt hole and gasket in the valve body.
5. INSTALL 25 BOLTS TO UPPER VALVE BODY
HINT: Each bolt length is indicated below.
Torque: 6.4 Nm (66 kgf-cm, 56 inch lbs.)
Bolt length:
Bolt A: 38 mm (1.50 inch) Bolt B: 20 mm (0.79 inch) Bolt C: 28 mm (1.10 inch)
6. INSTALL MANUAL VALVE
7. INSTALL DETENT SPRING
Torque: 10 Nm (100 kgf -cm, 7 ft. lbs.)
8. MAKE SURE MANUAL VALVE MOVES SMOOTHLY
UPPER VALVE BODY
COMPONENTS
Page 2278
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 3144
EGR Control Solenoid: Mechanical Specifications
Note: Except Model VZN170 (Long wheel base 4WD Pickup)
VSV Assembly to Intake Manifold 71 in.lb
Page 2150
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 615
Knock Sensor: Exploded Views
Components For Removal And Installation Part 1 Of 2
Page 1683
Radiator: Testing and Inspection
1. Remove radiator cap.
WARNING: To avoid the danger of being burned, do not remove the radiator cap while the engine
and radiator are still hot, as fluid and steam can be blown out under pressure.
2. Inspect radiator cap.
NOTE: If the radiator cap contaminations, always rinse it with water.
Using a radiator cap tester, pump the tester and measure the relief valve opening pressure.
Standard opening pressure: 74 - 103 kPa (10.7 - 14.9 psi) Minimum opening pressure: 59 kPa (8.5
psi)
NOTE: Use the tester's maximum reading as the opening pressure.
If the opening pressure is less than minimum, replace the radiator cap.
3. Inspect cooling system for leaks.
(a) Fill the radiator with coolant and attach a radiator cap tester.
(b) Warm up the engine. (c)
Pump it to 118 kPa (17.1 psi), and check that the pressure does not drop. If the pressure drops,
check the hoses, radiator or water pump for leaks. If no external leaks are found, check the heater
core, cylinder block and head.
4. Reinstall radiator cap.
Capacity Specifications
Fluid - M/T: Capacity Specifications
M/T Fluid ..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................ 2.2L (4.6 pints)
Page 3594
Components For Removal And Installation Part 2 Of 2
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
KNOCK SENSORS REMOVAL
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT 2. REMOVE AIR CLEANER HOSE 3. REMOVE INTAKE AIR
CONNECTOR 4. REMOVE HIGH-TENSION CORDS WITH IGNITION COILS 5. REMOVE FUEL
PRESSURE REGULATOR 6. REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY 7. REMOVE WATER
BYPASS PIPE AND KNOCK SENSOR WIRE
Page 3220
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2527
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Fuel - Idle Speed Increased by Replacement ECM
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Idle Speed Increased by Replacement
ECM
ENGINE EG001-98
FEBRUARY 13, 1998
2RZ ECM IDLE SPEED
MODELS: '95-'97 TACOMA
Introduction Operating logic of 1995-1997 Tacoma ECMs has been revised to improve engine idle
smoothness (with transmission in "D" range) by increasing idle speed (A/C "OFF") from 600 RPM
to 700 RPM. The change has also narrowed the RPM transition between A/C "OFF" and A/C "ON"
engagement.
Affected Vehicles 1995-1997 Tacoma 4x2 equipped with 2RZ-FE four cylinder engine and automatic transmission.
Part Number Information
Production Change Information No production changes have been made.
- This change applies only to replacement ECMs available through parts supply.
Warranty Information
Applicable Warranty: This repair is covered under the Toyota Powertrain Warranty. This warranty Is
in effect for 60 months or 60,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in service date.
Page 2462
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 769
EGR Temperature Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Note: Except Model VZN170 (Long wheel base 4WD Pickup)
EGR Sensor to EGR Valve 14 ft.lb
Testing and Inspection
Door Switch: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT DOOR COURTESY SWITCH CONTINUITY
1. Check that there is no continuity between terminal and the switch body in the ON position
(switch pin released/opened door). 2. Check that there is continuity between terminal and the
switch body in the OFF position (switch pin pushed in/closed door).
If operation is not as specified, replace the switch.
A/T - Fluid Interchangeability
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Fluid Interchangeability
TRANSMISSION & CLUTCH TC003-99
Title: AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUIDS
Models: All Models
May 21, 1999
REVISION NOTICE:
The information contained in this TSB updates TC003-98 dated June 19, 1998.
Introduction
Automatic Transmission Fluid Type T-IV now replaces Type T-II fluid. Use Type T-IV for all
applications that specify ATF Type T-II.
Please refer to the following table for the interchangeability between each ATF.
Affected Vehicles
^ All vehicles produced after 1993 with Automatic Transmissions specified to use ATF Type T, T-II
and T-IV.
NOTICE:
With the exception of mixing ATF Type T with Type T-IV fluids, different types of fluids must not be
mixed.
Parts Information
SIZE NEW PART NUMBER PART NAME
4 Liter 08886-01705 ATF Type T-IV
Warranty Information
Page 4801
5. IF NECESSARY, CHECK VALVE BODY
(a) Assemble the valve body in the uppermost position.
HINT: When the brakes are applied, the position will move down about 0.8 mm (0.03 in.). Even at
this time, the piston should not make contact with or move the load sensing spring.
(b) In this position, check the rear brake pressure. if the measured value is not within the standard,
replace the valve body.
Specifications
Valve Seat: Specifications
Refacing Angle ....................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 30°, 45°, 60° Contacting Angle .......................................................
............................................................................................................................................. 45°
Contacting Width
.................................................................................................................................................... 1.0 1.4 mm (0.039 - 0.055 inch)
Page 3640
Page 3392
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 292
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2309
Idle Speed: Specifications
Idle Speed 700 +/- 50 rpm
Page 1467
Union bolt:
Torque: 59 Nm (43 ft. lbs.)
Page 2468
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Testing and Inspection
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
ECT SENSOR INSPECTION
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT 2. DISCONNECT UPPER RADIATOR HOSE FROM WATER
OUTLET 3. REMOVE NO.2 TIMING BELT COVER 4. REMOVE FUEL PIPE 5. REMOVE ECT
SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the ECT sensor connector.
(b) Using a 19 mm deep socket wrench. remove the ECT sensor and gasket.
Page 3962
Transmission Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Vehicle NO.2 Speed Sensor Inspection Procedure
- Remove NO.2 vehicle speed sensor. - Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of NO.2
vehicle speed sensor.
Resistance: 560 Ohms to 680 Ohms
- Check voltage between terminals 1 and 2 of the NO.2 speed sensor when a magnet is put close
to the front end of the NO.2 vehicle speed sensor
then taken away quickly.
- Voltage is generated intermittenly.
Note: The voltages generated is extremely low.
Page 622
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Components For Removal And Installation Part 1 Of 2
Page 4013
Transmission Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Vehicle NO.2 Speed Sensor Inspection Procedure
- Remove NO.2 vehicle speed sensor. - Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of NO.2
vehicle speed sensor.
Resistance: 560 Ohms to 680 Ohms
- Check voltage between terminals 1 and 2 of the NO.2 speed sensor when a magnet is put close
to the front end of the NO.2 vehicle speed sensor
then taken away quickly.
- Voltage is generated intermittenly.
Note: The voltages generated is extremely low.
Page 1345
Piston: Service and Repair Disassembly
1. Using a small screwdriver, pry out the 2 snap rings.
2. Gradually heat the piston to about 60° C (140° F).
3. Using a plastic-faced hammer and brass bar, lightly tap out the piston pin and remove the
connecting rod.
NOTE: ^
The piston and pin are a matched set.
^ Arrange the pistons, pins, rings, connecting rods and bearings in the correct order.
Page 4420
c. Using a dial indicator, check the shaft runout.
Maximum Runout: 0.06 mm (0.0024 inch)
If the runout exceeds the Maximum, replace the output shaft.
2. Inspect 1st and 3rd gears synchronizer ring.
a. Check for wear or damage. b. Check the braking effect of the synchronizer ring. turn the
synchronizer ring in one direction while pushing it to the gear cone. check that the
ring locks. If the braking effect is insufficient, apply a small amount of fine lapping compound
between the synchronizer ring and gear cone. lightly rub the synchronizer ring and gear cone
together.
NOTICE: Ensure the fine lapping compound is completely washed off after rubbing.
c. Check again the braking effect of the synchronizer ring.
d. Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance between the synchronizer ring back and gear
spline end.
Minimum Clearance: 0.8 mm (0.031 inch)
If the clearance is less than the minimum, replace the synchronizer ring and gear cone by applying
a small amount of fine lapping compound.
NOTICE: Ensure the fine lapping compound is completely washed off after rubbing.
3. Inspect 2nd gear synchronizer ring.
a. Check for wear or damage.
Page 3552
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 516
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2690
CHART 28
Page 3593
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
Components For Removal And Installation Part 1 Of 2
Page 358
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 638
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - O2 Sensor Monitor Threshold
Values
SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS SS002-03
December 17, 2003
Title O2S TEST RESULTS (MODE 05)
Models All '96 - '03, '04 Corolla, ECHO, Matrix, Sienna & Scion xA & xB
Introduction
This Service Bulletin contains Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Monitor threshold values for all models from
1996 to 2003 and some 2004 models. Starting in 2004, the O2S Monitor threshold values can be
found in the repair manual. These values are used when analyzing the O2S test results to
determine the O2S condition.
Applicable Vehicles ^
All 1996 - 2003 model year Toyota vehicles.
^ 2004 model year Corolla, ECHO, Matrix and Sienna vehicles.
^ 2004 model year Scion xA and xB vehicles.
Function Description
Checking O2S Test Results
To view O2S test results, the O2S Monitor must be completed and the test results must be
checked within the same key cycle. If the ignition key is cycled OFF, the O2S test results will be set
to the minimum or maximum limits, and all test results will be erased. The O2S test results are
stored in the ECU (SAE term: Powertrain Control Module/PCM) when the monitor is completed.
The test results are static and will not change once the monitor is complete.
The process for checking 02S test results is described in the following three basic steps:
1. Completing the O2S Readiness Monitor.
2. Accessing O2S Test Results.
3. Comparing O2S Test Results to Failure Thresholds.
Required SSTs
NOTE:
Additional Diagnostic Tester Kits, Program Cards or other SSTs may be ordered by calling
SPX-OTC at 1-800-933-8335.
Warranty Information
Completing O2S Readiness Monitor
1. Clear any stored Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) using the Toyota Diagnostic Tester.
Page 2592
Page 1656
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 1291
(i) Install and uniformly tighten the 10 bearing cap bolts, in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
B. Exhaust.
(a) Apply new engine oil to the thrust portion and journal of the camshaft.
(b) Align the timing marks (1 dot mark) of the camshaft drive and driven gears. (c)
Place the exhaust camshaft on the cylinder head.
(d) Install the 4 bearing caps in their proper locations. (e)
Apply a light coat of engine oil on the threads and under the heads of bearing cap bolts.
(f) Install and uniformly tighten the 8 bearing cap bolts, in several passes, in the sequence shown.
Torque: 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
(g) Remove the service bolt.
Page 1538
1. Remove engine under cover. 2. Drain engine coolant. 3. Disconnect upper radiator hose. 4.
Remove drive belt for Power Steering (PS) pump. 5. w/ A/C: Remove drive belt for A/C
compressor. 6. Remove drive belt for generator. 7. Remove No. 2 fan shroud. 8. Remove fan with
fluid coupling and fan pulleys. 9. Disconnect PS pump from engine.
Testing and Inspection
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
Inspect shift lock solenoid.
a. Disconnect the solenoid connector. b. Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance at each
terminal.
Standard Resistance 20-28 ohms.
If resistance value is not as specified. Replace the solenoid.
c. Apply battery positive voltage at each terminal. At this time, confirm that the solenoid operates. If
the solenoid does not operate, replace the
solenoid.
Page 4132
than the maximum, replace the companion flange.
Maximum runout: 0.10 mm (0.0039 inch)
2. Check ring gear backlash. Using SST 09564-32011 and a dial indicator, measure the ring gear
backlash. If the backlash is not within the
specification, adjust the side bearing preload or repair as necessary.
Backlash: 0.13 - 0.18 mm (0.0051 - 0.0071 inch)
3. Measure drive pinion preload. Using a torque wrench, measure the preload of backlash between
the drive pinion and ring gear.
Preload (at starting): 0.6 - 1.0 Nm (5.2 - 8.7 inch lbs.)
4. Check total preload. Using a torque wrench, measure the preload with the teeth of the drive
pinion and ring gear in contact. If necessary,
disassemble and inspect the differential.
Total preload (at starting):
Drive pinion preload plus 0.4 - 0.6 Nm (3.5 - 5.2 inch lbs.)
Assembly
Page 4673
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4862
Brake Drum: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 3 Measuring Brake Drum Inside Diameter
DRUM DIAMETER
1. Using vernier calipers, measure the inside diameter of the drum.
- Standard inside diameter: 295.0 mm (11.614 inch)
- Maximum inside diameter: 297.0 mm (11.693 inch)
2. If the drum is scored or worn, the brake drum may be lathed to the maximum inside diameter.
Page 3046
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Vehicle NO.2 Speed Sensor Inspection Procedure
- Remove NO.2 vehicle speed sensor. - Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of NO.2
vehicle speed sensor.
Resistance: 560 Ohms to 680 Ohms
- Check voltage between terminals 1 and 2 of the NO.2 speed sensor when a magnet is put close
to the front end of the NO.2 vehicle speed sensor
then taken away quickly.
- Voltage is generated intermittenly.
Note: The voltages generated is extremely low.
Page 291
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 1952
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 2516
Axle Shaft Assembly, Constant Velocity Type
Axle Shaft: Service and Repair Axle Shaft Assembly, Constant Velocity Type
Removal and Installation
Front Axle Hub / 4WD
REMOVAL
1. Remove front wheel.
Torque to 110 Nm (83 ft. lbs.)
2. Remove shock absorber.
Page 2310
Idle Speed: Adjustments
1. Initial conditions.
(a) Engine coolant at normal operating temperature.
(b) Air cleaner installed. (c)
All pipes and hoses of air induction system connected.
(d) All accessories switched OFF. (e)
All vacuum lines properly connected.
NOTE: All vacuum hoses for Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) systems, etc. should be properly
connected.
(f) Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection (SFI) system wiring connectors fully plugged.
(g) Ignition timing set correctly. (h) Transmission in neutral position. (i)
A/C switch is OFF.
2. Connect TOYOTA hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool or equivalent. 3. Inspect idle speed.
(a) Race the engine speed at 2,500 rpm for approximately 90 seconds.
(b) Check the idle speed.
Idle speed: 700 +/- 50 rpm
NOTE: If the idle speed is not as specified, check the Idle Air Control (IAC) valve and air intake
system.
4. Disconnect TOYOTA hand-held tester or OBD II scan tool or equivalent.
Page 679
Warranty Information
Applicable warranty*: This repair is covered under the Toyota Basic Warranty. This warranty is in
effect for 36 months or 36,000 miles, whichever occurs first, from the vehicle's in-service date.
Coverage is extended to 36 months or 50,000 miles, whichever occurs first, in the states of
California and Massachusetts due to state emissions warranty legislation.
* Warranty application is limited to correction of a problem based upon a customer's complaint.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 534
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 4550
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 4933
Reassembly is in the reverse order of disassembly.
CAUTION: Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to the rubber parts indicated by the arrows in
EXPLODED VIEW of system.
INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal. Before installation, adjust length of brake booster
push rod. After installation, fill brake reservoir with brake fluid, bleed brake system. See: Brake
Bleeding/Service and Repair Check for leaks, check and adjust brake pedal. See: Brake Pedal
Assy/Adjustments
Page 46
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Specifications
Ignition Cable: Specifications
Maximum Resistance per Cord 25 K ohms
Page 3315
Fuel Supply Line: Diagrams
CAUTION:
- Always use new gaskets when replacing the fuel tank or component parts.
- Apply the proper torque to all tightened parts.
Page 3923
Planetary Sun Gear
Page 1813
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 2 Of 2
Page 3486
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 898
Page 2894
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Electrical Specifications
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Cold Hot
Between Terminals NE+ and NE- 1,630 - 2,740 ohms at 14 - 122 deg F 2,065 - 3,225 ohms at 122
- 212 deg F
Page 2130
Page 1983
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 2567
Standard Values Of ECM Terminals Chart 2 Of 2
Specifications
Exhaust Crossover Pipe: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Exhaust Crossover Pipe To Exhaust
Manifold................................................................................................................................. 45 Nm
(33 ft. lbs.)
Page 3630
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 3190
Fuel Pressure: Specifications Volume Specification
Information not supplied by the manufacturer.
Page 3453
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Page 1968
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
COMPONENTS FOR REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR REMOVAL
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the crankshaft position sensor connector. (b) Remove the bolt crankshaft position
sensor.
Torque: 7.8 N.m (80 kgf.cm, 69 in.lbf)
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Specifications
Oil Pick Up/Strainer: Specifications
TIGHTENING SPECIFICATIONS
Oil Strainer To Cylinder Block
.................................................................................................................................................. 7.5
Nm (66 inch lbs.)
Page 993
Alignment: Service and Repair Front
Front
NOTICE: Before inspecting the wheel alignment, adjust the vehicle height to specification.
1. Measure vehicle height. If the vehicle height is not within the specification, try to adjust it by
pushing down on or lifting the body.
Vehicle height (Front: A - B; Rear: C - D)
Measuring points:
A: Ground clearance of spindle center. B: Ground clearance of front adjusting cam bolt center. C:
Ground clearance of leaf spring front hanger pin center. D: Ground clearance of rear axle shaft
center.
2. Install camber-caster-kingpin gauge or onto wheel alignment tester. Follow the specific
instructions of the equipment manufacturer.
RZN161L Camber: ..............................................................................................................................
...................................................... 0°15' ± 45' (0.25° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
Caster: .................................................................................................................................................
.................................... 1° 35' ± 45' (1.58° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
Steering Inclination: .............................................................................................................................
.................................... 10° 00' ± 45' (10° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
VZN160L Camber: ...............................................................................................................................
.................................................... 0° 15' ± 45' (0.25° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
Caster: .................................................................................................................................................
.................................... 1° 35' ± 45' (1.58° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
Steering Inclination:
..............................................................................................................................................................
10° 30' ± 45' (10.5° ± 0.75°)
Left/Right Error ....................................................................................................................................
........................................... 30' (0.05°) or less
Specifications
Case: Specifications
Front Case To:
Control Retainer ..................................................................................................................................
................................................ 18 N.m (13 ft. lbs.) Upper Cover .........................................................
............................................................................................................................... 18 N.m (13 ft. lbs.)
Separator With Oil Strainer
.............................................................................................................................................................
7.5 N.m (69 inch lbs.) Oil Pump Body .................................................................................................
............................................................................... 7.5 N.m (69 inch lbs.)
Rear Case To:
Extension Housing ...............................................................................................................................
.......................................... 12 N.m (108 inch lbs.) Front Case ............................................................
................................................................................................................................ 28 N.m (21 ft.
lbs.)
Locations
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Locations
Locations-R/B No.2-Engine Compartment Left (USA) (Fig 19)
Page 3227
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT AIR CLEANER CAP FROM MAF METER
2. REMOVE MAF METER
(a) Disconnect the MAF meter connector. (b) Remove the 2 bolts and MAF meter.
Torque: 6.9 N.m (72 kgf.cm, 61 in.lbf)
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 2958
CHART 28
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR INSPECTION
NOTICE: "Cold" and "Hot" in these sentences express the temperature of the sensors themselves.
"Cold" is from -10°C (14°F) to 50°C (122°F) and "Hot" is from 50°C (122°F) to 100°C (212°F).
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR RESISTANCE
Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance between terminals.
Resistance:
Cold: 1,630 - 2,740 Ohms Hot: 2,065 - 3,225 Ohms
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the crank shaft position sensor.
Page 1367
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
INSPECTION
HINT: Inspect and adjust the valve clearance when the engine is cold.
1. REMOVE INTAKE AIR CONNECTOR 2. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVERS 3. SET NO.1
CYLINDER TO TDC/COMPRESSION
a. Turn the crankshaft pulley, and align its groove with the timing mark "0" of the No.1 timing belt
cover.
b. Check that the timing marks (1 dot) of the camshaft drive and driven gears are in straight line on
the cylinder heads surface as shown in the
illustration. If not, turn the crankshaft 1 revolution (360°) and align the marks.
4. INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE
a. Check only those valves indicated in the illustration.
1. Using a thickness gauge, measure the clearance between the valve lifter and camshaft.
Valve Clearance (Cold):
2. Record out of specification valve clearance measurements. They will be used later to determine
the required replacement adjusting shim.
Page 1541
Alternately loosen the 2 bolts and remove them, then remove the belt tensioner and dust boot.
21. Remove timing belt. 22. Remove RH camshaft timing pulley.
(a) Using SST Variable Pin Wrench Set # 09960 - 10010 (Variable Pin Wrench Arm Assembly #
09962 - 01000, Pin 10 # 09963 - 01000) or equivalents, loosen the pulley bolt.
(b) Remove the bolt, knock pin and camshaft timing pulley with timing belt.
23. Remove LH camshaft timing pulley.
(a) Using SST Variable Pin Wrench Set # 09960 - 10010 (Variable Pin Wrench Arm Assembly #
09962 - 01000, Pin 10 # 09963 - 01000) or equivalents, loosen the pulley bolt.
(b) Remove the bolt, knock pin and camshaft timing pulley.
24. Remove No. 2 idler pulley.
Remove the bolt and No. 2 idler pulley.
25. Remove No. 1 idler pulley.
Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, remove the pivot bolt, No. 1 idler pulley and plate washer.
26. Remove crankshaft timing pulley.
NOTE: If the pulley cannot be removed by hand, use SST Puller C Set # 09950 - 50010 (Hanger
150 # 09551 - 05010, Slide Arm # 09552 -
Page 604
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 2304
(l) Reinstall the No.2 timing belt cover with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 9 N.m (90 kgf.cm, 80 in.lbf)
(m)Start the engine.
(n) Disconnect the vacuum sensing hose from the fuel pressure regulator. and plug the hose end.
(o) Measure the fuel pressure at idle.
Fuel pressure 265 - 304 kPa (2.7 - 3.1 kgf/sq.cm, 38 - 44 psi)
(p) Stop the engine. (q) Check that the fuel pressure remains as specified for 5 minutes after the
engine has stopped.
Fuel pressure: 147 kPa (1.5 kgf/sq.cm. 21 psi) or more
If pressure is not as specified. check the fuel pump, pressure regulator and/or injectors.
(r) After checking fuel pressure, disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the battery and
carefully remove the SST to prevent gasoline from
splashing. SST 09268-45012
(s) Remove the other union bolt. 3 gaskets and fuel pipe from the delivery pipes. (t) Reinstall the
fuel pipe with 4 new gaskets and the 2 union bolts.
Torque: 34.3 N.m (350 kgf.cm, 25 ft.lbf)
(u) Reconnect the negative (-) terminal cable to the battery. (v) Check for fuel leakage.
Page 1902
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Specifications
Piston: Specifications
DIMENSIONS
Diameter:
STD
Mark 1 ...............................................................................................................................................
93.356 - 93.366 mm (3.6754 - 3.6758 inch) Mark 2
............................................................................................................................................... 93.367 93.376 mm (3.6759 - 3.6762 inch) Mark 3
............................................................................................................................................... 93.377 93.386 mm (3.6763 - 3.6766 inch)
O/S 0.50
.................................................................................................................................................. 93.856
- 93.886 mm (3.6951 - 3.6963 inch)
Oil Clearance:
STD
.............................................................................................................................................................
0.134 - 0.154 mm (0.0053 - 0.0060 inch) Maximum ............................................................................
................................................................................................... 0.174 mm (0.0069 inch)
Ring Groove Clearance:
No. 1
............................................................................................................................................................
0.040 - 0.080 mm (0.0016 - 0.0031 inch) No. 2
............................................................................................................................................................
0.030 - 0.070 mm (0.0012 - 0.0028 inch)
Page 4039
Valve Body: Locations Lower Valve Body
Lower Valve Body / Check Balls
Lower Valve Body / Retainer and Clip
Page 2151
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
The No.1 vehicle speed sensor outputs a 4-pulse signal for every revolution of the rotor shaft,
which is rotated by the transmission output shaft via the driven gear.
After this signal is converted into a more precise rectangular waveform by the waveform shaping
circuit inside the combination meter, it is then transmitted to the ECM. The ECM determines the
vehicle speed based on the frequency of these pulse signals.
The No.2 vehicle speed sensor detects the rotation speed of the transmission output shaft and
sends signals to the ECM. The ECM determines the vehicle speed based on these signals.
An AC voltage is generated in the No.2 vehicle speed sensor coil as the rotor mounted on the
output shaft rotates, and this voltage is sent to the ECM.
The gear shift point and lock-up timing are controlled by the ECM based on the signals from this
vehicle speed sensor and the throttle position sensor signal.
If the No.2 vehicle speed sensor malfunctions, the ECM uses input signals from the No.1 vehicle
speed sensor as a back-up signal.
Page 2055
CHART 23
Page 268
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications
Mounting Bolt 71 in.lb
Page 138
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Testing and Inspection
Shift Interlock Switch: Testing and Inspection
Inspect shift lock control switch.
Inspect that there is continuity between each terminal. If the continuity is not as specified. Replace
the switch.
Page 1998
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Timing Belt Removal
Timing Belt: Service and Repair Timing Belt Removal
Page 3364
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
EFI MAIN RELAY INSPECTION
1. REMOVE EFI MAIN RELAY (Marking: EFI) 2. INSPECT EFI MAIN RELAY
A. Inspect relay continuity
(a) Using an ohmmeter. check that there is continuity between terminals 1 and 2.
If there is no continuity. replace the relay.
(b) Check that there is no continuity between terminals and 5.
If there is continuity. replace the relay.
B. Inspect relay operation
(a) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 1 and 2. (b) Using an ohmmeter, check that
there is continuity between terminals 3 and 5.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
3. REINSTALL EFI MAIN RELAY
Testing and Inspection
Oil Pressure Warning Lamp/Indicator: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT LOW OIL PRESSURE WARNING LIGHT
1. Disconnect the connector from the warning switch and ground terminal on the wire harness side
connector. 2. Turn the ignition switch ON and check that the warning light lights up.
If the warning light does not light up, test the bulb.
Page 617
Diagram Information and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 359
"Case 2"
Type which cannot be pulled as far as Power Lock insert the tool straight into the access hole of
terminal retainer as shown.
Terminal Retainer
Push the terminal retainer down to the temporary lock position.
Locking Lug
c. Release the locking lug from terminal and pull the terminal out from rear.
Installation Of Terminal To Connector
4. Install Terminal To Connector
a. Insert the terminal.
HINT: 1. Make sure the terminal is positioned correctly. 2. Insert the terminal until the locking lug
locks firmly. 3. Insert the terminal with terminal retainer in the temporary lock position.
Page 2669
CHART 10
Page 522
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The camshaft position sensor, which detects the crankshaft angle signal (G signal), has been
installed on the front of right bank cylinder head. The timing rotor has been integrated with the right
bank camshaft timing pulley. When the camshafts rotate, the protrusion on the timing rotor and the
air gap on the pick up coil change, causing fluctuations, in the magnetic field and generating an
electromotive force in the pick up coil. The NE signal plate has 34 teeth and is mounted on the
crankshaft. The NE signal sensor generates 34 signals for every engine revolution. The ECM
detects the standard crankshaft angle based on the 6 signals and the actual crankshaft angle and
the engine speed by the NE signals.
Page 893
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 320
Voltage Check
a. Establish conditions in which voltage is present at the check point.
Example: A. Ignition SW ON B. Ignition SW and SW 1 ON C. Ignition SW, SW 1 and Relay ON
(SW 2 OFF)
b. Using a voltmeter, connect the negative lead to a good ground point or negative battery terminal,
and the positive lead to the connector or
component terminal. This check can be done with a test a light instead of a voltmeter.
Page 2339
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
SPARK PLUGS INSPECTION
1. DISCONNECT HIGH -TENSION CORDS 2. REMOVE IGNITION COILS
3. REMOVE SPARK PLUGS
Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the 6 spark plugs from the RH and LH cylinder heads.
4. CLEAN SPARK PLUGS
If the electrode has traces of wet carbon, allow it to dry and then clean with a spark plug cleaner.
Air pressure: Below 588 kPa (6 kgf/sq.cm, 85 psi)
Duration: 20 seconds or less
HINT: If there are traces of oil, remove it with gasoline before using the spark plug cleaner.
5. VISUALLY INSPECT SPARK PLUGS
Check the spark plug for thread damage and insulator damage. If abnormal, replace the spark
plug.
Recommended spark plug:
ND: K16TR11 NGK: BKR5EKB-11
ABS Control (Motor) Relay
ABS Main Relay: Description and Operation ABS Control (Motor) Relay
Codes 13, 14: ABS Control (Motor) Relay Circuit DTC Chart
ABS Control (Motor) Relay Circuit Wiring Diagram
Page 862
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Diagram Information and Instructions
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2187
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
System Schematic
Sensor Cut-Away
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The mass air flow meter uses a platinum hot wire. The hot wire air flow meter consists of a
platinum hot wire, thermistor and a control circuit installed in a plastic housing. The hot wire air flow
meter works on the principle that the hot wire and thermistor located in the intake air bypass of the
housing detect any changes in the intake air temperature. The hot wire is maintained at the set
temperature by controlling the current flow through the hot wire. This current flow is then measured
as the output voltage of the air flow meter. The circuit is constructed so that the platinum hot wire
and thermistor provide a bridge circuit, with the power transistor controlled so that the potential of
(A) and (B) remains equal to maintain the set temperature.
Page 318
Secondary Locking Device
b. Push the secondary locking device or terminal retainer in to the full lock position.
5. Connect Connector
Continuity and Resistance Check
Continuity And Resistance Check
a. Disconnect the battery terminal or wire so there is no voltage between the check points. b.
Contact the two leads of an ohmmeter to each of the check points.
Continuity And Resistance Check
If the circuit has diodes, reverse the two leads and check again. When contacting the negative lead
to the diode positive side and the positive lead to the negative side, there should be continuity.
When contacting the two leads in reverse, there should be no continuity.
Continuity And Resistance Check
c. Use a Volt/Ohm meter with high impedance (10 K Ohms/Volts minimum) for troubleshooting of
the electrical circuit.
Finding A Short Circuit
Page 77
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection
INSPECT HEATER MAIN RELAY CONTINUITY
If continuity is not as specified, replace the relay.
Page 951
Transmission Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Vehicle NO.2 Speed Sensor Inspection Procedure
- Remove NO.2 vehicle speed sensor. - Measure resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of NO.2
vehicle speed sensor.
Resistance: 560 Ohms to 680 Ohms
- Check voltage between terminals 1 and 2 of the NO.2 speed sensor when a magnet is put close
to the front end of the NO.2 vehicle speed sensor
then taken away quickly.
- Voltage is generated intermittenly.
Note: The voltages generated is extremely low.
Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Firing Order: 1-2-3-4-5-6
Page 2759
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
EFI MAIN RELAY INSPECTION
1. REMOVE EFI MAIN RELAY (Marking: EFI) 2. INSPECT EFI MAIN RELAY
A. Inspect relay continuity
(a) Using an ohmmeter. check that there is continuity between terminals 1 and 2.
If there is no continuity. replace the relay.
(b) Check that there is no continuity between terminals and 5.
If there is continuity. replace the relay.
B. Inspect relay operation
(a) Apply battery positive voltage across terminals 1 and 2. (b) Using an ohmmeter, check that
there is continuity between terminals 3 and 5.
If operation is not as specified, replace the relay.
3. REINSTALL EFI MAIN RELAY
Page 4779
Depress MOTOR Switch
(b) Turn the selector switch of the actuator checker to "FRONT" position. (c) Push and hold in the
MOTOR switch for a few seconds. (d) Depress the brake pedal and hold it until the step (g) is
completed.
Depress POWER Switch
(e) Push the POWER switch, and check that the brake pedal does not go down.
CAUTION: Do not keep the POWER switch pushed down for more than 10 seconds.
(f) Release the switch, and check that the pedal goes down.
Depress MOTOR Switch
(g) Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few seconds, and check that the pedal returns. (h)
Release the brake pedal.
Depress MOTOR Switch And Brake Pedal
(i) Push and hold in the MOTOR switch for a few seconds.
Page 610
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3609
b. Use a special tool or the terminal pick to unlock the secondary locking device or terminal
retainer.
NOTE: Do not remove the terminal retainer from connector body.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
A - For Non-Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (number of terminals
etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
"Case 1"
Raise the terminal retainer up to the temporary lock position.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 2"
Open the secondary locking device.
Non-Waterproof Type Connector
Specifications
Brake Fluid: Specifications
Required Brake Fluid SAE DOT3
Page 2023
A/F and 02 Sensor Identification
Page 308
Power Source (Current Flow Chart)
Power Source
The "Current Flow Chart" describes which parts each power source (fuses, fusible links, and circuit
breakers) transmits current to. In the power source circuit diagram, the conditions when battery
power is supplied to each system are explained. Since all system circuit diagram start from the
power source, the power source system must be fully understood.
Current Flow Chart The chart shows the route by which current flows from the battery to each
electrical source (Fusible Link, Circuit Breaker, Fuse, etc.) and other parts.
Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Specifications
Between Terminals Measured Resistance
At Clearance: 0 mm (0 in.) VTA - E2 0.2 - 5.7 K ohms
Throttle Fully Opened VTA - E2 2.0 - 10.2 K ohms
At all Times VC - E2 2.5 - 5.9 K ohms
Ohmmeter Connection
Page 2707
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Electrical Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Electrical Specifications
Resistance 10 - 20 K ohms at -4 deg F
4 - 7 K ohms at 32 deg F
2 - 3 K ohms at 68 deg F
0.9 - 1.3 K ohms at 104 deg F
0.4 - 0.7 K ohms at 140 deg F
0.2 - 0.4 K ohms at 176 deg F
Page 2708
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter indicates the color of the stripe.
Wiring Color
K: Indicates a wiring Splice Point (Codes are "E" for the Engine Room, "I" for the Instrument Panel,
and "B" for Body).
Example:
Splice Point
The Location of Splice Point I 5 is indicated by the shaded section
L: Page No.
M: Indicates a shielded cable
Shielded Cable
N: Indicates a ground point
The first letter of the code for each ground point(S) indicates the component's location, e.g, "E" for
the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body
and Surrounding area.
O: Indicates the pin number of the connector.
The numbering system is different for female and male connectors.
Pin Number Of The Connector
P: When 2 parts both use one connector in common, the parts connector name used in the wire
routing section is shown in square brackets [ ].
Page 671
CHART 27
Page 3961
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
The No.1 vehicle speed sensor outputs a 4-pulse signal for every revolution of the rotor shaft,
which is rotated by the transmission output shaft via the driven gear.
After this signal is converted into a more precise rectangular waveform by the waveform shaping
circuit inside the combination meter, it is then transmitted to the ECM. The ECM determines the
vehicle speed based on the frequency of these pulse signals.
The No.2 vehicle speed sensor detects the rotation speed of the transmission output shaft and
sends signals to the ECM. The ECM determines the vehicle speed based on these signals.
An AC voltage is generated in the No.2 vehicle speed sensor coil as the rotor mounted on the
output shaft rotates, and this voltage is sent to the ECM.
The gear shift point and lock-up timing are controlled by the ECM based on the signals from this
vehicle speed sensor and the throttle position sensor signal.
If the No.2 vehicle speed sensor malfunctions, the ECM uses input signals from the No.1 vehicle
speed sensor as a back-up signal.
Service and Repair
Heater Control Valve: Service and Repair
WATER VALVE REMOVAL
1. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT FROM RADIATOR REMOVAL
HINT: It is not necessary to drain out all the coolant.
2. DISCONNECT WATER VALVE CONTROL CABLE
INSTALLATION HINT: For installing the control cable, refer to HEATER CONTROL CABLES
ADJUSTMENT. See: Heating and Air Conditioning/Air Door/Air Door Cable/Adjustments
3. DISCONNECT WATER HOSE
4. REMOVE WATER VALVE
a. Disconnect the water hose from the heater radiator pipe. b. Remove the bolt and the water
valve.
INSTALLATION HINT: Push the water hose onto the heater radiator pipe as far as the ridge on the pipe.
- Install the hose clip in a position as shown.
WATER VALVE INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Mechanical Specifications
Thermostat: Mechanical Specifications
DIMENSIONS
Valve Lift @ 95° C (203° F)
.......................................................................................................................................... 8.5 mm
(0.335 inch) or more
Page 3752
Electronically Controlled Transmission And A/T Indicator (Part 2 Of 3)
Page 3950
Waterproof Type Connector
B - For Waterproof Type Connector
HINT: Terminal retainer color is different according to connector body.
Example: Terminal Retainer
: Connector Body
Black or White : Gray
Black or White : Dark Gray
Gray or White : Black
Waterproof Type Connector
"Case 1"
Type where terminal retainer is pulled up to the temporary lock position (Pull Type)
Insert the special tool into the terminal retainer access hole and pull the terminal retainer up to the
temporary lock position.
HINT: The needle insertion position varies according to the connector's shape (Number of
terminals etc.), so check the position before inserting it.
Waterproof Type Connector
Page 3398
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
System Schematic
Sensor Cut-Away
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The mass air flow meter uses a platinum hot wire. The hot wire air flow meter consists of a
platinum hot wire, thermistor and a control circuit installed in a plastic housing. The hot wire air flow
meter works on the principle that the hot wire and thermistor located in the intake air bypass of the
housing detect any changes in the intake air temperature. The hot wire is maintained at the set
temperature by controlling the current flow through the hot wire. This current flow is then measured
as the output voltage of the air flow meter. The circuit is constructed so that the platinum hot wire
and thermistor provide a bridge circuit, with the power transistor controlled so that the potential of
(A) and (B) remains equal to maintain the set temperature.
Page 2928
Upper Valve Body
Valve Body: Locations Upper Valve Body
Upper Valve Body / Retainer, Stopper and Pin
Upper Valve Body / Check Balls
Page 1724
Page 1308
Connecting Rod: Testing and Inspection Connecting Rod Alignment
USING A ROD ALIGNER AND THICKNESS GAUGE, CHECK THE CONNECTING ROD
ALIGNMENT
1. Check for bend.
Maximum bend: 0.05 mm (0.0020 inch) per 100 mm (3.94 inch) If bend is greater than maximum,
replace the connecting rod assembly.
2. Check for twist.
Maximum twist: 0.15 mm (0.0059 inch) per 100 mm (3.94 inch) If twist is greater than maximum,
replace the connecting rod assembly.
Diagram Information and Instructions
Cruise Control Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
How To Read Ground Points
Ground Points
The Ground Point circuit diagram shows the connections from all major parts to the respective
ground points. When troubleshooting a faulty ground point, checking the system circuits which use
a common ground may help you identify the problem ground quickly. The relationship between
ground points (EA, IB and IC) can also be checked this way.
How to Read Power Source
Page 2631
8. REMOVE KNOCK SENSORS
Using SST. remove the knock sensor. SST 09817-16011
KNOCK SENSOR INSTALLATION
1. REINSTALL KNOCK SENSORS
Using SST, install the knock sensor. SST 09817-16011
Torque: 39 N.m (400 kgf.cm. 29 ft.lbf)
2. REINSTALL WATER BYPASS PIPE AND KNOCK SENSOR WIRE 3. REINSTALL INTAKE
MANIFOLD ASSEMBLY 4. REINSTALL FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR 5. REINSTALL
HIGH-TENSION CORDS WITH IGNITION COILS 6. REINSTALL INTAKE AIR CONNECTOR 7.
REINSTALL AIR CLEANER HOSE 8. REFILL WITH ENGINE COOLANT 9. RECHECK ENGINE
COOLANT LEVEL
Page 2646
Applicable Vehicles
Page 2142
Connector
The pins shown are only for the highest grade, or only include those in the specification.
D: Connector Color
Connectors not indicated are milky white in color.
E: ( ) is used to indicate different wiring and connector, etc. when the vehicle model, Engine type,
or specification is different.
F: Indicates related system.
G: Indicates the wiring harness and wiring harness connector. The wiring harness with male
terminal is shown with arrows (V V) Outside numerals
are pin numbers.
Wiring Harness Connector
The first letter of the code for each wiring harness and wiring harness connector(s) indicates the
component's location, e.g, "E" for the Engine Compartment, "I" for the Instrument Panel and
Surrounding area, and "B" for the Body and Surrounding area.
When more than one code has the first and second letters in common, followed by numbers (e.g,
IH1, lH2) this indicates the same type of wiring harness and wiring harness connector.
H: Represent a part (all parts are shown in sky blue). The code is the same as the code used in
parts position
I: Junction Block (The number in the circle is the J/B No. and the connector code is shown beside
it). Junction Block are shaded to clearly separate
them from other parts (different junction blocks are shaded differently for further clarification).
Example:
Junction Block
J : Indicates the wiring color.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code.
B = Black BR = Brown G = Green GR = Gray L = Blue LG = Light Green 0 = Orange P = Pink R =
Red V = Violet W = White Y = Yellow
Page 561
Glossary Of Term And Symbols (Part 2 Of 2)
Key to Diagram
Page 3208
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
MAF Meter to Air Cleaner Cap 61 in.lb
Page 2378
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER REMOVAL
1. DISCONNECT AIR CLEANER CAP FROM MAF METER
2. REMOVE MAF METER
(a) Disconnect the MAF meter connector. (b) Remove the 2 bolts and MAF meter.
Torque: 6.9 N.m (72 kgf.cm, 61 in.lbf)
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) METER INSTALLATION
Installation is in the reverse order of removal.
Page 3162
(b) Remove the 2 nuts, EGR valve and gasket.
Torque: 18.5 N.m (185 kgf.cm, 14 ft.lbf)
INSTALLATION HINT: Use a new gasket.